College Panda The College SAT SAT Math Advanced and Workbook Advanced Guide Guide and Workbook 2nd 2nd Edition Edition Copyright Copyright © 2020 The The College College Panda Panda All A l l rights rights reserved reserved.. ISBN: 978-1-7331927-2-9 978-1-7331927-2-9 No part part of this this book book may may be be reproduced reproduced without without written written permission permission from the the author. author. *SAT does not endorse this product. ‘SAT is aa registered registered trademark trademark of the the College College Board, Board, which which does n o t endorse product. m o r e information, information, visit visit thecollegepanda.com thecollegepanda.com For more Discounts available available for teachers teachers and and companies. companies. Please Please contact thecollegepanda®gmail.com for details. details. Discounts contact thecollegepanda@gmail.com / Introduction Introduction The best best way to do do well well on on any any test test is is to to be be experienced experienced with material. Nowhere is this this more true than than on on The way to with the the material. Nowhere is more true the SAT, which which is standardized standardized to to repeat repeat the the same same question question types and again. again. The The purpose this book book is the SAT, types again again and purpose of this to teach teach you you the the concepts concepts and and battle-tested battle‐tested approaches approaches you questions types types.. If it's you need need to know know for all these these questions If it's n o t in in this this book, book, it's it’s not not on on the the test. test. The The goal goal is is for every every SAT question be a simple reflex, you not question to be a simple reflex, something something you know how to to handle handle instinctively instinctively because because you've you’ve seen seen it so times before. before. know how so many many times won’t find any any cheap cheap tricks tricks in in this this book, book, simply simply because because there there aren’t that work work consistently. consistently. Don't Don’t buy You won't aren't any any that buy into the the idea idea that that you you can can improve improve your your score score significantly significantly without work.. into without hard hard work Format Format of the Test There math sections be done minutes without without aa There are are two t w o math sections on on the the SAT. The The first contains contains 20 questions questions to be done in 25 25 minutes calculator. and a a calculator calculator. The The second second contains contains 38 38 questions questions to be be done done in 55 55 minutes minutes and calculator is permitted permitted.. Some made sure accurately divide the practice practice questions Some topics topics only only show show up up in the the calculator calculator section. section. I've I’ve made sure to accurately divide the questions into into non-calculator non-calculator and and calculator calculator components. components. How How to Read Read this this Book Book For beginning to end. chapter was was For aa complete complete understanding, understanding, this this book book is best best read read from from beginning end. That That being being said, said, each each chapter written possible. After all, you may already already be written to be be independent independent of the others others as as much much as aspossible. After all, you may be proficient proficient in some some topics yet weak others. If so, feel free to on the the chapters chapters that are most most relevant topics weak in others. to jump jump around, around, focusing focusing on that are relevant to your your improvement. improvement. All chapters won't master master the the material material until think through through the chapters come come with with exercises. exercises. Do them them.. You won’t until you you think the questions yourself. If you get stuck on a question, give yourself a few minutes to figure it out. If you’re que stions yourself. you stuck on a question, give yourself a minutes figure out. If you're still stuck, stuck, then then look look at at the solution and and take take the the time time to fully understand Then circle circle the the question number still the solution understand it. Then question number or make make aa note note of it somewhere somewhere so so that that you you can can redo redo the the question Revisiting questions missed is question later. later. Revisiting questions you’ve you've missed the best best way way to improve improve your your score. score. About About the the Author Nielson Phu Phu graduated graduated from New New York University, University, where where he he studied science. He He has obtained perfect perfect Nielson studied actuarial actuarial science. has obtained scores on the SAT and and on the the SAT math math subject subject test. test. As aa teacher, he has has helped helped hundreds students scores teacher, he hundreds of students throughout Boston Boston and and Hong Hong Kong Kong perform perform better better on on standardized standardized tests. Although he he continues pursue throughout tests. Although continues to pursue his interests interests in education, education, he n o w an an engineer engineer in the the Boston Boston area. his he is now area. THE COLLEGE A COLLEGE PAND PANDA Table of Contents Contents 1 Exponents Exponents & Radicals Radicals 7 Laws Laws of exponents exponents Evalua ting expressions nen ts Evaluating expressions with with expo exponents Solving equations with exponents Solving equations with exponents Simplifying Simplifying square square roots roots 2 15 15 Percent Percent Percent Percent change change Compound Compound interest interest Percent problems Percent word word problems 33 Exponential Exponential vs vs.. Linear Linear Growth Growth 23 Linear growth and and decay decay Linear growth Exponentia Exponentiall growth growth and and decay decay Positive tion Positive and and negative negative associa association 4 Rates Rates 32 Conversion factors factors Conversion 5 6 6 Ratio Ratio & Proportion Proportion 38 38 44 44 Expressions Expressions Combining like terms terms Combining like Expansion and factoring Expans ion and factoring Combining, dividing dividing,, and and splitting splitting fractions fractions Combining, 7 8 Constructing Models Models Constructing 52 Manipulating & & Solving Solving Equations Equations Manipulating 57 Common mistakes mistakes to avoid avoid Common isolating variables variables Tools for isolating Strategies for solving solving complicated complicated equations equations Strategies 9 More Equation Equation Solving Solving Strategies Strategies More 71 Matching coefficients coefficients Matching lnfinitely many many solutions solutions Infinitely solutions No soluti ons Clearing denominators denominators Clearing 10 10 Systems of of Equations Equations Systems 78 Substitution Substitution Elimination Elimination Systems with with no solutions solutions and and infinite infinite solutions solutions Systems problems Word problems More comp complex systems More lex systems Graphs of systems systems of equations equations Graphs 4 .r THE COLLEGE PANDA COLLEGE PANDA 11 Inequalities Inequalities 91 inequalities solve inequalities H o w to solve How problems word problems Inequality Inequality word inequalities Graphs Graphs of inequalities 12 13 13 14 14 Problems Word Problems 100 Problems & Maximum Minimum M i n i m u m 8: Maximum Word Problems 109 Lines Lines 117 y-intercept and y-intercept Slope and Slope point-slope form and point-slope form and lines: slope-intercept Equations of lines: Equations slope-intercept form form intersection of two the intersection Finding the Finding t w o lines lines lines perpendicular lines and perpendicular Parallel and Parallel vertica l lines and vertical Horizontal and Horizontal lines 15 15 16 126 132 132 Linear Models Interpreting Models Interpreting Linear Functions Functions function? a function? What is a What undefined? function undefined? When is a function When functions Composite functions Composite Finding solutions to a function a function the solutions Finding the graphs function graphs Identifying function Identifying transformations Function transformations Function 17 146 146 Quadratics Quadratics Tactics for finding roots finding the roots Completing the square square the Completing The vertex form vertex form and vertex ver tex and The discriminant The discriminant Quadratic models Quadratic models 18 18 Synthetic Division Synthetic Division 161 Performing synthetic division division Performing synthetic Equivalent expressions expressions Equivalent The remainder theorem remainder theorem 19 20 21 21 Complex Numbers Complex Numbers Absolute Value Absolute Value Angles Angles 170 170 174 180 180 Exterior theorem angle theorem Exterior angle Parallel lines Parallel lines Polygons Polygons 5 THE COLLEGE PANDA 22 Triangles 187 Isosceles and and equilateral equi lateral triangles lsosceles triangles Right triangles Right triangles Specia l right Special right triangles triangles Similar Similar triangles triangles Parallel Parallel Lines and Proportionality and Proportionality Radians Radians 23 Circles Circles 207 Area and and circumference circumference Arc length length Area of a sector sector Centra l and and inscribed inscribed angles Central ang les Equa tion s of circles Equations 24 Trigonometry Trigonometry 216 and tangent tangent Sine, cosine, cosine, and Trigonometric identities Trigonometric identities Evaluating trigonometric Evaluating trigonometric expressions expressions 25 26 27 Reading Data Reading Data Probability Probability 225 234 244 Statistics Statistics II Mean, and mode Mean, median, median, and mode Range standard Range and and standard deviation deviation Histograms Histograms and and dot dot plots plots problems involving involving averages averages Word problems Boxplots Boxplots 28 Statistics II II Statistics 254 Statistical sampling Statistica l sampling Using and and interpreting interpreting the the line line of best fit Using Margin error Margin of error Confidence intervals Confidence intervals Experimental Experimental design design and and conclusions conclusions 29 Volume Volume 267 30 Answers Answers to the Exercises Exercises 272 6 Ex ponents & Ra Exponents Radicals dicals Here are the Here are the laws laws of exponents exponents you you should should know: know: Example Example Law Law 1 xx1z = Xx F 1 331z = 33 , L \U_ XO = 11 A 30_ 3D= 11 1 m 0n 111In I 1 111 11 xX", 34 35 Z 39 34. 35 = 39 · x" = x + x111 if: : _= 7 27 Z 34 34 37 = xm‐n XIII -II x" 33 4 (32)-l : 38 38 (32)4 = (XVII) Z _mn 111 (x )11= x 11111 (2 , 3)3 Z 23 3 .33 3 my)!” = : xlllylll xmym (xy)"' I "I (2 · 3) 3 Xm (~)m (y) =z ;:: w 2 , '1 W1 7 xA_,-mIn = xm 7 3 ·3 23 (~)3 (g) =z ~: 3‐3 33 -‐44 1 =2 1 _ g _ 2_ = 34 CHAPTER 1 EXPONENTS & RADICALS Many students don 't know the difference between ( - 3) 2 and - 32 Order of operations (PEMDAS) dictates that parentheses take precedence . So, ( - 3) 2 = (- 3) · (- 3) =9 Without parentheses, exponents take precedence: - 32 = - 3 · 3 = - 9 The negative is not applied until the exponent operation is carried through. Make sure you understand this so you don't make this common mistake . Sometimes, the result turns out to be the same, as in : ( - 2) 3 and - 23 Make sure you see why they yield the same result. EXERCISE1: Evaluate WITHOUT a calculator . Answers for this chapter start on page 272. (- 1)4 1. l. t‐1)4 3)3 10. -(‐(‐3)3 50 19. 50 (- 1)5 2 2. (‐1)5 11. -(- 6)2 2 20. 332 ( - 1) 10 3. 3. (‐])lo 12. - (- 4)3 3‐22 21. 3- - 1) 15 4. ((21)15 4. 13. 23 X 32 (- 1)8 5.(‐-1)8 5. 14. ( - 1)4 - 18 6. 6. ‐18 15. (- 2)3 X (- 3 )4 2 24. 772 7.-‐(‐1)8 7. - ( - 1)8 16. 30 7- 2 25. 7‐2 s.(‐3)3 8. ( - 3)3 17. 6- 1 3 103 26. 10 9.-‐33 9. - 33 18. 4- l 27. 1010‐33 (- 1)5 22. 53 53 33 X 22 23. 5‐3 5- 3 X X 8 PANDA THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE The calculator. The a calculator. use a NOT use exponents. Do NOT positive exponents. contains only answer contains your answer that your so that Simplify so EXERCISE EXERCISE 2: Simplify only positive 272. page on start chapter this for Answers you. for done been done have been first ttwo w o have you. Answers this chapter start page 1. =6x5 6x 5 3x 2 · 2x 3 = 1. 3x2-2x3 i 21. 21, 6,‐{1 6u 4 8112 '8uz 2. 2k‐44 ~4k2 : % · 4k2 = 2. 2k- 12 12. k 5x4 · 3x -‐22 3. 3” 5x -3x 14. 14. (2x 2)- 3 5. (23r2)’3 2 a (mnz)2 x22 X7. x -3 1 23. % 23x- 2 I l x mn 4 3x 15_ W3x4 15. (x-2)2 b-‐ 3 .• 3a6. -_ 3a 3a2b 3a ‐ 5b8 3n7 3117 7- 55 6n 3 7. 24. flm2n3 k- 2 k‐z 25. 25- pk-3 3 x1 xi? 16. 7 I xi x7 (a2b3)2 8. (azb3)2 26. m2 3 (7) c: n:r 27 27. ( 17. 17 x2. x2 x3. ‘r1 x4 x4 W4 9. ( xy4 ) x3y2 9,(”fl/2) ‘ 2)- 3 • 2x 3 18. (x (.r2)'3-2x3 3 (- x) 3 10.' -_(_-") (b- 2) -3. (b3)2 (b‘2)‐3 , (b3)2 )3 (m2n ("1 fl)‘ 22. ‐‑(mn 2)2 22. - 4u 2v 2u v 2 • ~4uzv 13. 21402- -3 - 3111 7m 3 •-‐3m‘3 4. 4. 7m3 10 a- 2)2 a- 1 •~a‘2)2 20. ((a‐1 (x2y - 1)3 11. 11. (x2y_1)3 3 )2 ) 2 •- (3111 19. (2m (2m)2 (3m3)2 2a 24 ) x y~z4 x2y3 4z-5 y -3 x x‘3y'42“5 ? off y ? terms o the value what is the then what 3x+2 = y, then EXAMPLE If3H2 value ooff 33x j r in terms EXAMPLE 1: If A )y+9 A)y B ) y-- 9 B)y ql C)% 3 D)% only difference the exponent the 2 in the that the notice that we notice Here we what x is. Here finding what trouble of finding Let’s exponent is the the only difference the trouble avoid the Let's avoid out: 2 the extract let's exponents, laws our using So want. we what between the given equation and what we want. 50 using o u r laws of exponents, let’s extract the out: and equation given the between 3X+2:3X.32=y = 3x . 32 = .1/ 3x+2 3xx=: 'i 3 9 Answer Answer ~(D) . a?7 value of a the value what is the ra +7 , what = 3‐“7, 3a+l = ff 3"+1 EXAMPLE 2: If EXAMPLEz- equal. be equal. therefore be muu sstt therefore the same. are the bases are the bases Here same. The The exponents exponents m that the Here we see that a + 1l ==-~ aa+ +7 a+ 2 2aa=: 6 au=@J =l 9 CHAPTER CHAPTER 1 EXPONENTS EXPONENTS & RADICALS RADICALS a 4a EXAMPLE 3: U 2a - b = 4, what is the value of b ?? EXAMPLE3zlf2a‐b=4,whatisthevalueof§5 2 2. Realize Realize that that 4 is just just 222. (22V 22" 4 2. ?:_2h_=F:2 :2 4" Za‐b Square Square roots roots are are just just fractional fractional exponents: exponents: I .Jx xi = x?l But what i ? The top means bottom means means to cube cube root root it: what about about xxi? The 2 on on top means to square square x. The The 3 on the bottom 3/x2 We this more Wecan can see this m o r e clearly clearly if we we break break it down down:: g l 2 2 I 3;-;, 2 (x (x2)? = {7x2 xx33 = )1 = v x2 The order -rooting doesn’t doe sn't matter order in which which we we do do the the squaring squaring and and the the cube cube‐rooting matter.. 2 x? = (xhz : (3/32 The result just the cube the outside. outside . That That way, we don't need need the the parentheses. parentheses. The end end result just looks looks prettier prettier with with the cube root root on on the we don’t EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 4: Which Which of the the following following is is equal equal to ~ Vac‐5 ? ? A) A)x B) .x5- x4 B)x5‐x4 CM; on? 1 The fourth root fractional exponent The fourth root equates equates to aa fractional exponent of 3', so so 4 4 x5=x Answer §). (C) . Answer 10 10 PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE THE root, factor square root, a square "surds"). To simplify called ”surds"). square roots simplifying square on simplifying you on also test you SAT will also The SAT roots (also called simplify a pairs : any pairs: out any and take out root and square root inside the square number inside the number the JT:\/2~2.2~z= \J /[I1]-[I}] - - ' 3 = 2 --32=\2·2v3 / § = 4= \4v3 /§ v'48 = ✓2-2·2 · 2 · 3 = [I}] . pair -. second pair out for the second another 2 out Then we take another [I}] . Then the first -. out for the a 22 out take a we take above, we example above, In the example looked have would route quicker a course, Of 4. get to root square the outside 2's two the multiply we multiply Finally, we t w o 2’s outside square root course, a quicker route would have looked this : like this: \/4‐ = t✓~/ _ - 3 =: 4\/§ 4v3 v'48 = example: another example: Here's another Here's M: \/--~2=2-3\/§:6\/§ pair: as a pair: root asa square root under the square back under put itit back and put outside and number outside the number take the backwards, take To go backwards, To N \/6-6- = V72 = x/fi 6v'2i =: ~ any triplets out any ifi6, take as W, cube root such a cube simplify a To simplify such as take out triplets:: W=x7-2=2¢/§ 0? where x > O? ¾, (x2 ) Q form of (12) equivalent form the following Which of the EXAMPLE 5: Which following is an anequivalent , where A)..jx AWE CW? x..fi B) Bm/E DN/E Solution 1: Solution 1: 3 s 1 (x2)“ zxz4 ZYZ zmz --x=x\/§ Answer Answer §)(B) . 3 . . 73 23 2 . exponent of 3 to the exponent of x in , each of the compare this (x2 ) 4 z= x 44 = Solution 2: Since (x‘)El Solution z x 2- ,, we we can can compare exponent 5 exponent each the 2,1 3 3 2 answer choices. choices. answer I ,Ix== xx2 Choice Choice A:A: J? 1 I 1 I- iI 5 3 ChoiceB: Choice 8: = xx21 x\/§=x‘-xz = x 1 3 x,/x = x1 • x 2 =x”Z Choice Choice C: W Choice Choice D: é/E : xxI1 -1/x= 2 = x‘1 1 I that the answer confirm that results confirm These answer is B. These results 11 & RADICALS CHAPTER 1 EXPONENTS & RADICALS EXERCISE 3: Simplify the radicals or solve for x. Do NOT use a calculator. Answers for this chapter start on page 272. page272. 1. \/1‐2 l. Ju /128 ' 10. v128 2. 2. fi)% 11 ll.Sv'2 = ./x 3. v'45 1/5 3. 12. 12 3,/x 4. \/1_8 /18 13 2v'2= v'4x 13. 5. 5 2/fl 2m 14. 144)6 6 3\/7_5 6. 3/75 15 7. «3‐2 7.J32 16. 16 4/3x 8. m v'200 17. 17 3v8 = x/2 9. 9. x/é v8 18. 18 x,/x = v'2l6 12 12 = v'45 = 2/3x = 2,/6 THE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA THE COLLEGE CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 272. A calculator should NOT be used should N O T be used on the following following questions. questions. If __ 1 ~ xc for all positive positive values what is \/x‐ = x‘ values of xx,, what V} 3 yX the value value of c ?? the I If aa- 1f = what is the = 3, 3, what the value value of a? a? A) A) - 9 1 B) 9 1 C) 3 D) D) 9 If 3x 3x = = 10, what is the lu e of 3xIf 10, what the va value 3"’33 ?? 10 A) ~ 3 A ) yy ++ 3 A) B) 39 B)) yy-‐ 3 B C) C ) 33- ‐ yy D) 3y 3y 10 10 C) 57 27 2xx IfIf 27 Y = 2 3, then then x must must equal equal 223, 10 10 27 27 D) fi 10 10, what what is the the value value of y2 y °? If y3/55 = 10, IfIf a are positive integers, which a and and b bare positive even even integers, which of the the following following is is greatest? greates t? A ) 440 0 A) B) 400 B) 400 A) A) 8) B) C) C) C) 1,000 1,000 D) 10,000 (- 2a)b (‐2a)" ( - 2a) 2b <‐2a)2" (2a) 11 an)” D) 2112" 2a 2/J D) ifii't, The expression expression Wx2y4, where where x > 00 and and y > 0, O,is is The equivalent which of the the following? following? equivalent to which A) A) 32 = 9? If x2 3/3, for what what value = yy9 ? x2 = = y3, value of 2 z does does xX32 PY x/Ty A A)) -‐ 1 B) B ) y ,fi y fi B) 0 1 C) x2 C) 1 D) x 2y D) 2 13 13 CHAPTER 1 EXPONENTS CHAPTER EXPONENTS & & RADICALS RADICALS If jxJx = xa, then If 2”3 2x+3 -‐ 2X= 2x = k(2x), what If what is the the value value of k k?? what is the value of a? 1 A) 2 A A)) 3 3 C) 7 B) 5 B) B) 4 0) 8 D) C) 1 C) 4 D) 0) 3 A calculator is allowed allowed on the following following questions. questions. lH 30, x > 1, lf xac • xhc = xx30,x lfx“‘oxh‘ 1 ,and a n daa+ +b = = 55,, wwhat h a t iiss 1 3 4 24 Jf(S 3) 4k: k = (53 (5! ))24,, what what is is the the value value of of k k?? the value value of c? the c? A) - 6 A) 3 2 B) 5 B) 3 C) 6 3 C) 4 0)) 110 D 0 0) 2 If 4 2n+ 3 . ? = 811+ 5, what what is 1s the the value value of of n 11 ? 2n Which of the the following Which following is equivalent equivalent to to x7? x -;; for for all b are all positive positive values values of of x, where where a and and bare positive integers? positive integers? A) 6 B) 7 C C)) 8 A) vbax2 lftix2 D 0)) 9 ½2n B) x7x2“ C) tJxa 12 C) (7x1142 D) 0) 5 w, 2"xb X Which of the Which ? the following following is equivalent equivalent to to ((‐2)3 ? 2) 3 A) A) -‐2-\3/Z 2-¼ B) B) 22· 3/1 </4 C) C) -‐4-€/i 4· '7'2 If x2y3 x 2y 3 = = 10 10 and and x3y2 x 3y 2 = If = 8, what what is the the value value of x5y5? x5y5 ? D) 3/2 0) 4. 4 · v'2 A 8 A)) 118 B 0 B)) 220 C C)) 4400 D 0)) 8800 14 14 Per cent Percent EXAMPLE the questions EXAMPLE 1: Jacob got got 50% of the correct on 30-question test test. questions correct on a a 30-question test and and 90% 90% on on a a 50 50 question question test. What What percent percent of all questions Jacob get correct? questions did did Jacob get correct? First, let's First, let’s find the total total number number of questions questions he he got got correct: correct : 50% 50%><30: X 30 = 1 2 xX 3300 =: 1155 9 90/ox507mx50‐45 90% X 50 = 1Q X 50 = 45 0 : Z : -. So 15+ z 60 u t of 50 = ; 80 So he he got 15 + 45 = 60 questions questions correct correct oout of a a total total of of 30 30 + + 50 80 questions: questions : 2‐0 ~~ = ~ = I 75% I. EXAMPLE 2: The price of by 20%, 20%, then decreased by by 40%, 40%, then by 25%. 25%. The The EXAMPLE 2: The price of a a dress dress is is increased increased by then decreased then increased increased by final price is what what percent percent of of the the original price? final price is original price? Here’s technique for dealing dealing with “series of of percent Let the Here's the technique with these these "series percent change” change" questions. questions . Let the original original price price be be p. p. When you multiply by 1.20 because it’s the original price plus 20°/o. When it’s decreased When ppisis increased increased by 20“/o, 20%, you multiply by 1.20 because it's the original price plus 20%. When it's decreased by is what's what’s left left after O u r final by 40%, you you multiply multiply by by .60 because because 60% 60% is after you you take take away away 40°/o. 40%. Our final price price is is then then p .90p p Xx1.20 1.20 X><.60 x X 1.25 1.25 := .90p The final price price is is I90"/o 90% Iof of the original original price. price. Example IMPORTANT percent concept by calculate prices Example 2 shows shows the MOST IMPORTANT percent concept by far far on on the the SAT. SAT. Never Never ever ever calcu late the the prices at each to get get the the end end result. each step. step. String String all the changes changes together together to result . It’s important to know know why why this works. Imagine Imagine again want to increase it it by by It's important this works. again that that the the original original price price is is p p and and we we want to increase 20"o. Normally,, we just take p and and add add 20% 20% of of it it on top: 20%. Normally we would would just take p on top : p + .20p p+ .20p But realize realize that that p + .20p .20p == pp(1+.20) :1.20p p+ ( l + .20) = l.20p 15 CHAPTER CHAPTER 2 PERCENT PERCENT And And now n o w we want want to decrease decrease this this new n e w price price by 40%: 1.20p -‐ (.40)( (.40)(l.20p) : (1.20p)( (l.20p)(ll -‐ .40) .40) := (1.20p)(.60) z (l.20 (1.20)(.60)p l.20p 1.20p ) = (1.20p)( .60) = )( .60)p which proves proves we we can can calculate calculate the the final final price price directly directly by by using N o w we re set set up up to tackle the the which using this this technique. technique. Now we're to tackle inevitable compound interest questions on the SAT. inevitable compound interest questions on the EXAMPLE 3: Jonas Jonas has has aa savings savings account account that that earns earns 33 percent percent interest annually. His His initial initial EXAMPt:.E interest compounded compounded annually. deposit was was $1-000. $1000. Which Which of of the the following following expressions expressions gives value of 10years? deposit gives the the value of the the account account after after 10 years? A) 100Q(l,30)l0 A)1000(1.30)1° 1000+30(10) B) 1000 + 30(10) C) 1000(1.03) 1000(1.03)(10) C) (10) 10 D) 1000(1.03) 1000(1.03)10 A 33 percent interest rate rate compounded compounded annually annually means means he he earns on the year. Keep Keep in A percent interest earns 33 percent percent on the account account once once a a year. mind that that this isn't just just 3% 3% on on the the original original amount amount of $1000. This 3%of at the time, mind this isn't This is 3% of whatever’s whatever's in the the account account at the time, including any any interest interest that that he's he's already already earned earned in in previous This is the the meaning meaning of of compound compound interest. interest. including previous years. years. This 80 ifif we're we’re in in year year 5, 5, he he would 3°/o on on the the original original $1000 and interest deposited deposited in years years 11 So would earn earn 3% and 3°/o 3% on on the the total total interest through through 4. 4. If we we try try to calculate calculate the the total after each each and and every every year, year, this this problem forever. Let's Let’s take what we we If total after problem would would take take forever. take what learned from Example 3 and here: learned from Example and apply apply it here: total:: 1000(1.03) 1000(1.03)‐ ‐ 1000(1.03) 1000(1.03)11 = Year 11 total Year 2 total 1.03) = 1000(1.03) Year2 total:: 1000(1.03)( 1000(1.03)(1.03)‐_ 1000003)22 Year 3 total: (1.03)( 1.03)( 1.03) = 1000(1.03) Year3 total: 1000 1000(1.03)(1..03)(103) 1000003)33 Year 4 total: 1.03)( 1.03)( 1.03) = 1000(1.03) 4 Year4 total: 1000(1.03)( 1000(1.03)(1.(o3) 103)(1.03)=1000(1.03)4 See the whatever the was last last year. the pattern? pattern? Each Each year year is an an increase increase of 3% 3°/o so so it's it’s just just 1.03 times times whatever the value value was year. Note Note ten times that 're not price of a a dress dress being that we we’re n o t doing doing any any calculations calculations out. out. Think Think of it as as the the price being increased increased by 3% 3°/o ten times.. §J . 10 , answer Therefore, the Year 10 Therefore, the 10total total is 1000(1.03) 1000(l.03)1°, answer ( D ) . Most the equation equation A Most of these these compound compound interest interest questions questions can can be be modeled modeled by the A= = P(l P(1+ r)t, r)‘, where where A A is the amount accumulated, accumulated, P is the initial amount, the total total amount the principal principal or the the initial amount, r .is is the the -interest interest rate, rate, and and t is the the number of times times interest interest is received. received. number EXAMPLE account that that earns earns 5 percent each year, EXAMPLE 4: Jay puts puts an an initial initial deposit deposit of $400 into into aa bank bank account percent interest interest each year, compounded annually. Which of the following equations gives the total dollar amount, A, in the account compounded annually. Which the following equations gives the total dollar amount, the account after years? after t years? A) A = 400(1.0St) 400(1.05t) A) B) A = = 400(0.0St) 4oo(o.051) C) C) A A = 400(0.0Sl 4oo(o.05)' 400(1.05) 1 D) A = = 400(1.05)' After and the the initiaJ amount P is 400. Plugging After t years, years, interest interest has has been been received received t times. times. The The rate rate r is 0.05 and initial amount Plugging §J . these into the these values values into the formula, formula, we we see see that that the the answer answer is ( D ) . 16 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA EXAMPLE less eggs eggs than they did did last year. If If they they laid laid 3,500 EXAMPLE 5: This year, year, the the chickens chickens on on aa farm farm laid laid 30% less than they last year. eggs eggs this year, year, how how many many did did they they lay lay ~t last year? year? This Year = (Last Year) : (.70) (.70)(Last 3,500 Last Year) 3,500 = : (.70)( (.70)(Last I5,0001 = Last Year Last Percent calculated as as follows: Percent change change (ak.a. (a.k.a. percent percent increase/decrease) increase/ decrease) is calculated follows: 1 value al _ new value -‐ old ch °/o ,ochange ange -= 01 n_______________ew vaollude “13: v ue x 100 oId v alue For and rises dollars , the the percent percent change For example, example, if if the the price price of aa dress dress starts starts out out at at 80 80 dollars dollars and rises to 90 dollars, change is: 90 9 0 ‐ 880 0 12.5% ;80 Xx 100 = 12.5% percent change change is positive, it’s aa percent percent increase. increase. Negative? Negative? Percent It’s important important to remember remember If percent positive, it's Percent decrease. decrease. It's that based on that percent percent change change is is always always based on the the original original value. value. EXAMPLE 6: In aparticular store, the the number number of TVs sold sold the the week Friday was was 685. The The number number EXAMPLE a particular store, week of Black Friday of TVs sold sold the the following following week week was was 500. TV TV sales sales the the week week following following Black Friday Friday were were what what percent percent less less of sales the the week week of of Black Black Friday Friday (rounded (rounded to to the the nearest nearest percent)? percent)? than TV sales than A)17% A) 17% B)27% B) 27% C) 37% C)37% D) 47% 0)47% W ~ ‐0.27 500 -‐ 685 685 ~ - 0 27 500 685 . We put the difference difference over over 685, NOT N O T 500. Answer Answer ~(B) -. put the We EXAMPLE 7: 7: In In aaparticular store, the the number number of of computers computers sold the week Black Friday Friday w.as was 470. 470. The The EXAMPLE particular store, sold the week of of Black number of computers sold the previous week was 320. Which of the following best approximates number of computers sold the previous week was 3ZO. Which of the following best approximates the the percent increase increase in computer sales from from the the previous previous week week to the week of Black Friday? Friday? percent computer sales the week A) 17°/o A)17% B) 27°/o 8)27% C) 37% C)37% D) 47°/o 0)47% 320 ~ O 470 -‐ 320 a: 0.47 47 320 · This time, time, the week week of of Black Friday Friday is n o t the the "original" ”original” basis for the percent change. Weput put the is not basis for the percent change. We the difference difference over the previous previous week's week’s number, number, 320. The answer answer is ~(D) -. over 17 17 PERCENT CHAPTER CHAPTER 2 PERCENT percent: involving percent: examples involving more examples A few more oi number of the number school decreased number of students EXAMPLE 8: The number EXAMPLE students at aa school decreased 20% from from 2010 to 2011. IfIf the 2010 in enrolled students of number the expresses the number students enrolled in the following which of the 2011 enrolled in 201 students enrolled students 1 was was k, which following expresses ? terms of kk ? in terms A) 0.75k A) B) 1.20k 1.20k C) 1.25k 1.25k D) D) 1.Sk 1.5k value . the new and not (from 2010) and value (from original value the original is based change is Percent change NOT 1.20k. Percent is NOT answer is The answer The based off of the n o t the n e w value. students in 2010, number of students the number be the Let x be .80x = : k .80x x= z 1.25k 1.25k Answer (@ more students were 25% more there were Therefore, there Therefore, students in 2010 than than in 2011. Answer (C) . those Red Among those are Red students are a school, at a graders at 10th graders Among 10th EXAMPLE 9: Among EXAMPLE school, 40% of the the students Red Sox fans. Among Red Sox fans both Red are both the school graders at the 10th graders What percent fans. What are also Celtics fans. Sox fans, fans, 20% are percent of the the 10th school are Red Sox fans and fans? and Celtics fans? it's 100. that it's suppose that let's suppose number of 10th the number know the don't know We don’t We 10th graders graders at at the the school school so so let’s = 40 = 40'3/o Red 40% of 100 = fans = Red Sox fans =8 40 = Celtics fans = : 20% of 40 Red Sox fans Celtics & Red The = I8% I then %~ = answer is then The answer 1 typically 100. total, typically the total, represent the number to represent up aa number questions is to make percent questions A ccommon o m m o n strategy strategy in percent make up 18 18 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA THE CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 276. A calculator is allowed allowed on the following following questions. questions. If x is 50% larger than 2, z, and and y is than If larger than is 20% larger larger than z, then then x xisis what what percent percent larger larger than than y y?? 2, A) 15% Reid purchase aa rug Reid wants wants to purchase rug that that has has aa price price of $150.00. He has ha s aa coupon reduce the coupon that that would would reduce the cost cost of the the rug rug by by k%. If If the the coupon coupon would would mg by $12.75, what reduce the cost reduce the cost of the the rug what is the the value value of k? k? B) 20% C) 25% D) 30% Veronica has has aa bank account that earns m% Veronica bank account that earns m% interest compounded compounded annually. annually. If she opened the interest she opened the account with with $200, the the expression expression $200(x)‘ $200 (x) 1 account represents the the amount amount in the the account represents account after after t years. Which Which of the the following gives x in terms terms years. following gives m?? of m A) 1 + + .01m .Olm In March, a city zoo attracted 32,000 visitors to its polar bear exhibit. In April, the number of visitors to the exhibit increased by 15%. How many visitors did the zoo attract to its polar bear exhibit in April? B) l1 + +m m C) 1 -‐ m D) D) 1 ++ 100m 100m A) A) 32,150 B) 32,480 C) 35,200 A charity organization collected 2,140 donations last month . With the help of 50 additional vo lunteer s, the organization collected 2,690 donations this month. To the nearest tenth of a percent, what was the percent increase in the number of donations the charity organization collected? D) 36,800 Miguel is following a recipe for marinara sauce that require s half a tablespoon of vinegar. If one cup is equivalent to 16 tablespoons, approximately what percent of a cup of vinegar is the amount required by the recipe? A) A) 20.40/o 20.4% B) 20.7% C) 25.4% A) 2.3% D) D) 25.7% B) 3.1% 3.10/o C) 9.4% D) 12.5% 12.5% 19 19 CHAPTER 2 PERCENT The number number of dishes served by a restaurant The dishes served restaurant during dinner dinner was was 17.5% greater than the the during greater than If the number of dishes dishes served served during during lunch. lunch. If number the restaurant served served 940 dishes dishes during during dinner, restaurant dinner, how how many more dishes did the restaurant serve many more dishes did the restaurant serve during dinner dinner than than during during lunch? during lunch? The discount price of a book is 20% less than the retail price. James manages to purchase the book at 30% off the discount price at a special book sale. What percent of the retail price did James pay? A) 42% 8) B) 48% 4896 C) 50% 5095 D) [)) 56% 5696 Each pistachios left Each day, day, Robert Robert eats eats 40% of the the pistachios in his his jar at that time . At the the second that time. the end end of the second day, 27 pistachios remain day, 27pistachios remain.. How How many many pistachios pistachios were in the were the jar at the the start start of the the first day? day? ln 2010, the the number number of houses built in Town in houses built Town A was 25 percent percent greater than the the number was greater than number of houses built in Town Town B. 8. If houses built If 70 houses houses were were built built in Town A during during 2010, how many were were built built in Town how many Town B? 8? Town A) A ) 775 5 8) 80 B) 80 C)) 885 C 5 D) D ) 995 5 Joanne bought a doll at a 10 percent discount off the original price of $105.82. However, she had to pay a sales tax of x% on the discounted price . If the total amount she paid for the doll was $100, what is the value of x? Over a a ttwo week span, span, John John ate 20 pounds of Over w o week ate 20pounds chicken and 15 15 pounds dogs.. Kyle chicken wings wings and pounds of hot hot dogs ate ate 20 percent percent more more chicken chicken wings wings and and 40 percent more more hot Considering only only hot dogs dogs.. Considering percent chicken dogs, Kyle ate ate chicken wings wings and and hot hot dogs, approximately weight, percent more more food, food, by weight, approximately x percent than John. What is x (rounded to the nearest (rounded the nearest than John. What percent)? percent)? A) 2 B) 8) 3 C) 4 D) 5 A ) 225 5 A) B) 8) 27 27 C)) 229 C 9 D 0 D)) 330 20 20 PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE ll) that bond that government bond Omar holds a government currently holds Omar currently year, the Each year, value of $900. Each market value a market has a has 20% be 20°/o expected to be bond is expected the bond value of the market value market If before. If year before. the year value the market value than its market higher than higher constant, a constant, pisis a where p + p), where expression 900(1 + the expression the the value of the market value expected market the expected represents the represents ? p value of ? what is the value years, what after 3 years, bond after bond Jane is playing a board game in which she must collect as many cards as possible. On her first tum, she loses 18 percent of her cards. On the second tum, she increases her card count by 36 percent. lf her final card count after these two turns is 11, which of the following represents her starting card cow1t in terms of n ? A) A) n 11 (1.18)(0.64) (l.18 )(0.64) (l.18 )(0.64)n B) 8) (1.18)(0.64)n C) n C) (1.36)(0.82) (0.82)( 1.36)11 D) (0.82)(1.36)n groceries in 2015. She on groceries dollars on spent xx dollars Sims spent than in groceries in 2016 than on groceries more on spent 34% more spent 34°/o groceries in more on groceries 145% more spent 145°/o she spent 2015, and and she following Which of the following 2017 than than in 2016. Which dollars, amount, in dollars, the amount, represents the expressions expressions represents Sims spent groceries in 2017? spent on groceries Due to deforestation , researchers expect the deer population to decline by 6 percent every year. If the current deer population is 12,000, what is the approximate expected population size 10 years from now? A) B) 8) C) C) D) A) 4800 B) 8) 6460 C) 7240 D) D) 7980 (2.45)(0.34x) (2.45)(0.34x) (1.45)(0.34x) (1.45)( 0.34x) (2.45)(1.34x) (2.45)( 1.34x) (1.45)(1.34x) (1.45) (1.34x) In 2016, County the collected the 8 collected County B and County County A and same amount of the amount ln 2017, the taxes . In amount of taxes. same amount taxes collected decreased by 25% County A decreased collected by County and 8 County B collected by County taxes collected amount of taxes the amount and the increased by 20%. If County A collected 60 Cow1ty collected increased million the was the what was taxes in 2017, what dollars of taxes million dollars amount taxes, in millions 8 County B dollars, County millions of dollars, amow1t of taxes, types of A small different types store sells 3 different clothing store small clothing accessories: and ties, and are ties, 60% are scarves , 60°/o are scarves, accessories: 20% are the accessories are the half of the belts. If half are belts. other 40 accessories the other ties are with scarves, many scarves scarves how many scarves, how replaced with are replaced will the store have? store have? collected collected in 2017? A 4 A)) 554 B) 78 8) 78 C 0 C)) 990 D 6 D)) 996 21 21 CHAPTER 2 M CHAPTER PERCENT PERCENT Daniel has Daniel has $1000 in in a checking account account and a checking and $3000 in a savings savings account. account. The checking checking account account earns earns him him 1 percent percent interest interest compounded annually compounded annually.. The savings savings account account earns him him 6 percent earns percent interest interest compounded compounded annually annually.. Assuming Assuming he he leaves leaves both both these these accounts alone, which accounts alone, of the the following which of following represents how represents much more how much more interest interest Daniel Daniel will will have have earned earned from the savings savings account account than than from from the checking checking account account after after 55 years? years? : * , A) 3, 3, 000(1.06 OOO(1.06)5 1,000(1.01)5 )5 ‐- 1, 000(1.01)5 B) 3,000 (1.06)( 5) -‐1,000(1.01)(5) B) 3,000(1.06)(5) 1,000(1.01)(5) 5 C) (3,000 (1.06) -‐ 3,000 C) (3,000(1.06)5 3,000)) -‐ (1,000(1.0 (1,000(1.01)5 1)5 -‑ 1, 000) 1,000) D) 000(1.06) (5) - 3,000 ) D) (3, (3,000(1.06)(5)‐3,000)‑ (1,000(1.0 (1,000(1.01)(5) 1)(5) -‐ 1,000) p ( 1 + 1~0)5 The expression expression above above gives of gives the population population of leopards leopards after after five years years during during which which an an initial initial population of P leopards leopard s grew grew by rr percent population each percent each year. Which of the following following expressions gives expressions gives the percent percent increase the increase in the leopard population leopard population over these five years? over years? A) A) (1(Hfi) + 1~)5 , . B) B) (1 + 1~)5 - 1 (1+fir) _:____!.=..:..-=- x 100 ‐1><100 (”m) ( 1 + 1~0)5 C)“ll‐fif‐llxloo )5- 1] x 100 C) [ ( 1 + l ~O D)(Ll-igafxloo D) ( 1 + ~)5x 100 1 22 Exponential vs. vs. Linear Linear Growth Growth The account earning The population population of ants ants doubling doubling every every month. month. A bank bank account earning 55 percent percent every every year year.. These These are are examples a quantity quantity grows examples of exponential exponential growth, growth, which which occurs occurs when when a grows periodically periodically by aa factor factor greater greater than than account , it's 1. 1. In In the the case case of the the ants, ants, this this factor factor is is 2. 2. In In the the case case of the the bank bank account, it’s 1.05. When When exponential exponential growth growth happens, happens, we we can can model model it as as an an equation equation that that looks looks like like y : ab, where y is is the the final quantity quantity after after t time time periods periods (e.g. (e.g. years), years), a is the quantity, and and bis b is aa growth growth factor factor the initial initial quantity, where greater than 1. Soif we started off with 100 ants, o u r model equation would be greater than 1. So if we started with ants, our model equation would be : 100(2) 100(2)'1 y= where tis t is the the number number of months months that that have have gone gone by. And And if if oour u r bank bank account account started started off with with $200, our o u r equation where equation would look like like would : 200(1.0Sf 200(1.05)' yy = where tis t is the the number number of years years that that have have passed passed.. You've You’ve seen already in the the percent chapter.. where seen this this already percent chapter Graphs of exponential exponential growth growth have have the the following following shape: shape: Graphs yll Notice how how the graph graph creeps creeps up up slowly slowly at at first but but then then shoots shoots up faster over over time. time. That's That’s exponential Notice up faster faster and and faster exponential growth. growth. 23 CHAPTER CHAPTER 3 EXPONENTIAL EXPONENTIAL VS. LINEAR LINEAR GROWTH GROWTH Exponential decay decay,, however, however, is the Imagine aa radioactive mass over over time. time. It Exponential the opposite. opposite. Imagine radioactive substance substance that that loses loses mass It loses aa lot lot of its its mass beginning and and then then loses loses it more more and astime loses mass in the beginning and more more slowly slowly as time goes goes by. Mass Mass It’s worth worth memorizing memorizing the the shapes shapes of these these graphs graphs of exponential exponential growth The SAT may may test you you It's growth and and decay. The explicitly explicitly on on them them.. The exponential growth: growth : equation for exponential exponential decay decay is the the same same as as the the equation equation for exponential The equation ab'1 y = ab The only only difference So an equation equation that that models exponential decay difference is that that the the growth growth factor, b, is less than than 1. Soan models exponential decay might might look look like like : 400(0.6 400(O.6)‘ y31= )1 where years from that the where y is the the mass, mass, in grams, grams, of aa radioactive radioactive substance substance t years from now. now. The The 400 indicates indicates that the substance substance currently has has aa mass 400 grams grams,, and and the the 0.6 0.6 indicates that at at the end the substance substance is left with with indicates that end of each each year, the currently mass of 400 mass it started started the year year with. ln other other words, words, it loses loses 40% of its mass each year. 60% of the mass with. 1n mass each Sofar, the the examples examples we've we've discussed discussed have been relatively relatively simple. simple. To model model more more complicated complicated cases of exponential So have been exponential growth and and decay, such as asa bank account account growing growing by 3% 3°/o every substance losing losing half half growth decay, such a bank every 2 years years or a a radioactive radioactive substance its mass every 9 months, need to use advanced exponential exponential equation: equation: mass every months, we'll we’ll need use aa slightly slightly more more advanced I yy=abi = abl where Note that t and and k where k is is the the time time required required for y to increase increase by one one factor factor of b. 17. Note It must must have have the same same units. So 50 if if t is in years, then than k should also also be in years. years. units. Let's go go over some examples so that that you you fully understand understand what Let's over some examples so what k means. means. EXAMPLE 1: EXAMPLE = 400(1.05) 400(1.05)§! M = The equation equation above models the the mass mass M, in nanograms, nanograms, of a years. Based Based on the equation, The above models a particle particle after after t years. on the equation, which of the following best best describes the mass mass of the the particle particle over which the following describes the over time? time? A) It increases increases by 5% 5% every every 4 months. months. A) increases by 5 nanograms nanograms every months. C) It increases every 4 months. increases by 5% 5°/o every B) It increases every 3 years. years. increases by 5 nanograms nanograms every years. D) It increases every 3 years. We have have an an exponential exponential equation with kk == 3 3 and and bb == 1.05, takes 3 years the mass mass of We equation with 1.05, which which means means it takes years for the the particle particle to increase increase by aa factor of 1.05. In other other words, words, the years. the particle's particle 's mass mass increases increases by 5% 5% every every 33 years. Answer ~(B) . Answer 24 24 PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE THE EXAMPLE2: EXAMPLEz‑ M = 400(0 400035)“ .6) 31 M equation, the equation, on the Based on years. Based after t years. nanograms, of aa particle mass M, in nanograms, the mass models the above models equation above The equation The particle after time? over time? particle over the particle mass of the describes the best describes following best the following which of the which the mass every 4 months. It decreases decreases by 60% every months. A) It months. every 4 months. decreases by 40% every C) ItIt decreases by 60% every 3 years. B) It decreases by 40%every 3 years. D) It decreases by 40% ’' as a reference, tt so how are k' form of k' not equation is n given equation exponent of the given the exponent that the reference, we see that ab1ias Using y = Using = abI o t in the form so how are arithmetic trick: have to use the value supposed to find the we supposed we value of k? k? We Wehave use an an arithmetic 3 400(0.6 /f( l / ) = 400(o.6)’/“/3’ 400(0.6/ 1 = M M == 400(0.6)3’ 1 1, 1 1 4 or 4 every 5 year, or decreases by 11 ‐- 0.6 = 40% every the particle's means the that k = we can Now N o w we can see that : 5, which which means particle’s mass mass decreases [ED. Answer (C) . months. months. Answer double able to organization is the organization If the volunteers. If 50 volunteers. has 50 currently has organization currently EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 3: A non-profit nOn-profit organization is able to double of number the odels m best equations following the of which months, 8 every volunteers of number the the number volunteers every months, which the following equations best models the number of now? from months t have will organization will have months from now? the organization v, the volunteers, 0, volunteers, I = 50(2)§ 50(2)-S A) v = l = 50(2)i B) vU= 50(2)i 50(2)81 V = 509)!“ D) U= 50(2) 1 V = 50(2)t C) v 1 1 number = 2. given information, the given on the Based on as a reference abk asa Again, reference.. Based information, a = = 50 50 and and b = 2. Since the the number use y := abl‘ we'll usey Again, we’ll equation the equation Therefore, the months, k = and t is in months, months, and every 8 months, growth factor every of volunteers z 8. Therefore, increases by the growth volunteers increases Answer ~(A) .~. Answer volunteers is v = 50(2) that number of volunteers 50(2) 5. models the number best models that best double organization is able the organization volunteers . H has 50 currently has EXAMPLE 50 volunteers. If the able to double organization currently non-profit organization EXAMPLE4: A non-profit the number models the equations best following equations the following which of the months, which the number of volunteers volunteers every best models number of every 8 months, the number now? years from will have volunteers, the organization have t years from now? organization will v, the volunteers, 0, t A) v = = 50(2)é 50(2)lJ B) t)v = 50(2) 7f = 50(2)%i ;i0(2) 81 = 50(2)8f v= D) 0 C) Vv = = 50(2) 500)?¥ this, the Because of this, months. Because instead of months. years instead except t is in years one in Example This question same as as the one Example 3, 3, except the question is the same convert to have we so units, same the have the same units, sowe have convert must and k m the correct answer is n o t the the same. correct equation, equation, t and u s t have same. To form the not answer 8 equation is then = % = gives k z 8 months = ~5 years. years. The equation then which gives years, which into years, months into 12 1(2/ 3 ) = 50(2)37' 50(2) ¥ u:= 50(2/ sour/(W3) V [ED. Answer Answer (C) . 25 CHAPTER EXPONENTIAL VS. LINEAR CHAPTER 3 EXPONENTIAL LINEAR GROWTH GROWTH Now let's compare compare exponential exponential growth growth and and decay decay with with linear linear growth As you know, Now let's growth and and decay. As you may may already already know, linear be modeled example, if Ann Ann has has aa piggybank linear growth growth can can be modeled by by aa line line with with aa positive positive slope. slope. For For example, piggybank with with 100 dollars already already in it, it, and and she she adds adds 5 dollars dollars every every month, month, the piggybank can can be be modeled modeled dollars the total total amount amount in the piggybank by by : St + 100 A = where the total number of months, (they-intercept) initial amount. where A is the total amount, amount, t is the number months, and and 100 (the y-intercept) is the initial amount. A Unlike exponential consistent. There There is no Unlike exponential growth, growth, linear linear growth growth is constant constant and and consistent. no slowing slowing down down or speeding speeding up . The the same up. The total total goes goes up by the same amount amount each each time time.. Now every month instead of adding The total total N o w imagine imagine that that Ann Ann takes takes 5 dollars dollars out o u t of her her piggybank piggybank every month instead adding to it. The balance decrease by a constant decay. The total amount amount A in balance would would decrease by a constant amount amount each each month, month, resulting resulting in linear linear decay. The total the piggybank piggybank could then be the could then be modeled modeled by z 100 -‐ lOt A = The The graph graph of such such an an equation equation is aa line line with with aa negative negative slope. slope. A Both exponential linear decay a negative negative association association between between ttwo things. As one exponential decay decay and and linear decay are are instances instances of a w o things. one thing thing decreases absences over over the the semester and final thing increases, increases, the other other thing decreases.. For example, example, the number number of absences semester and exam scores: exam Final Exam Exam Score Final • ••••• • • •• •• • • • Number of Absences Number Absences When the data points points are are close to forming forming aa smooth smooth line line or graph relationship, we we can can When the data graph that that shows shows the negative negative relationship, that there strong negative negative association association.. say that there is aa strong 26 THE COLLEGE THE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA Both exponential are instances between two t w o things. things. As As exponential growth growth and and linear linear growth growth are instances of a a positive positive association association between one thing increases, the other thing also increases. For example, the number of hours spent studying and final one thing increases, the other thing also increases . example, number hours spent studying and exam scores:: exam scores Final Exam Exam Score Final • • •• • • •• • • •• • Hours Hours Studied Studied The graph The shows a positive positive association association that that is quite graph above above shows quite strong. strong. 27 27 CHAPTER 3 EXPONENTIAL GROWTH CHAPTER EXPONENTIAL V5. VS. LINEAR LINEAR GROWTH CHAPTER start on CHAPTE R EXERCISE: EXERCISE : Answers Answers for this this chapter chapter start on page page 278. A calculator should NOT be use d on the followi ng questi ons. The employees at a new bookstore must stock a certain number of shelves so that the store is ready for its ready w o weeks. its opening opening in ttwo weeks. The The . employees rate employees stock stock shelves shelves at at a a constant constant rate throughout the throughout is the the number the two two weeks. weeks. If p(t) is number shelves left of shelves be stocked stocked after which of left to be after tt days, days, which the statements best best describes the the following following statements describes the function p function p?? The value The value of aa house the house decreased decreased by 8°/o 8% from from the previous year previous consecutive years. Which of year for n consecutive years. Which the following the value of following graphs graphs could could model model the the value the house house over over this this time time period? period? the A) A) The function A) The function p is an an increasing increasing exponential exponential fw1ction. function. B) The The function function p pisis a a decreasing decreasing exponential exponential hmction. function. C) The The function C linear function p is an an increasing increasing linear function . function. Time Time D The function is aa decreasing decreasing linear D) The function p is linear B) B) function. function . .-0 .-0 .-0 .-0 .-0 If the initial population of rats was 20 and grew to 25 after the first year, which of the following functions best models the population of rats P with respect to the number of years t if the population growth of rats is considered to be exponential? .-0 Time C) A) PP==5t 5t ++ 20 20 B) B) P = = 20(1.25)' 20(1.25)1 C) : 20(5)' C) P = 20(5) 1 D) = 5:2 + 20 D) P = 5t 2 + Time D) D) If the initial population of pandas was 100 and grew to 125 after the first year, which of the following functions best models the population of pandas P with respect to the number of years t if the population growth of pandas is considered to be linear? Time A 5t+ 00 A)) PP == 225t +1100 B) =100(1.25)' B) P = 100(1.25) 1 C) P = 100(1.2) 100(1.2)'1 D) P=20t2+5t+100 D) P = 20t 2 + 5t + 100 28 28 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA )I flf(t)t ) = :20(1+%)t 20 ( 1 + 100 15 N = 1, 000(0.97) 41' scientist uses equation above above to model model the the A scientist uses the the equation number of bacteria Ninin aa petri petri dish dish after after h number bacteria N hours. According According to the the model, model, the the number number of hours. bacteria is predicted predicted to decrease 3% every every kk bacteria decrease by 3°/o minutes. What What is the the value minutes. value of kk?? The models the The function function f above above models the temperature, temperature, in degrees degrees Celsius, Celsius, of a metal metal alloy alloy used used in an an experiment, experiment, where where t is the the number number of seconds seconds after the after the experiment experiment began began.. Which Which of the the following the best interpretation following is the interpretation of the the number 15 in this number this context? context? 1 1 A) A) 4 4 B) 4 A) The temperature, temperature, in degree degreess Celsius, Celsius, of the the metal beginning of the metal alloy alloy at at the the beginning the experiment experiment C)) 115 C 5 D) 240 B The increa increase the temperature, temperature, in degrees degrees B) The se in the Celsius, the metal Celsius, of the metal alloy alloy every every 100 100 seconds during during the the experiment experiment seconds C) The The percent which the the temperature, temperature, in percent by which degrees Celsius, metal alloy alloy degrees Celsius, of the metal decreased each second next decreased from from each second to the next during during the the experiment experiment cC = 40.002)“ 4(1.002) 21 The equation above can be used used to model model the The equation above can be the number cars, in millions millions,, registered number of cars, registered in aa certain years after According to the certain state state tt years after 2009. According the model, the number of cars registered the state state model, the number cars registered in the n%every every 6 months months.. is projected projected to increase increase by n% What is the the value value of nn ? ? What percent by which which the temperature, temperature, in D) The percent degrees metal alloy degrees Celsius, Celsius, of the metal alloy increased each second second to the the next next increased from each during experiment during the experiment A) 0.002 B) 0.04 C) 0.2 c u ) == 80(2) 80(2)é~ C(t) D) 2 how aa certain certain virus virus spreads, spreads, To examine examine how scientists introduced introduced the virus to cells in aa test test scientists the virus tube and found the number number of infected infected cells tube and found that that the in the the test tube tube grew exponentially over grew exponentially over time. time. The function The function C above above models models the the number number of infected infected cells in the the test test tube tube t days days after after the the virus on the virus was was introduced introduced.. Based Based on the function, function, which of the the following which following statements statements is true? true? The trees in aa forest forest has has been The population population of trees been decreasing years.. The decreasing by 6 percent percent every every 4 years population population at at the the beginning beginning of 2015 was was estimated 14,000. If If P represents represents the the estimated to be be 14,000. years after after 2015, which which of population of trees trees tt years population the following following equations equations gives the population population of the gives the trees trees over over time? A) The predicted predicted number number of infected infected cells in test tube the test tube doubled doubled every every 5 days. days. B) The predicted predicted number number of infected infected cells in the test tube tube grew grew by aa factor factor of 5 every every two two days. da ys. infected cells in C) The The predicted predicted number number of infected the test tube tube doubled doubled every every day. D) The predicted D predicted number number of infected infected cells in the test tube tube grew the grew by aa factor of 5 every every day. day. I A) P P = 14,000 14,000(0.06)t A) (0.06):J B) P = = 14,000 14,000 + + 0.94(4t) B) 0.94(4t) C) P = 14,000 (0.94) 41 C) P=14,000(0.94)4' I = 14,000 (0.94)4° D) P P= 14,000(0.94)é 29 29 CHAPTER 3 EXPONENTIAL VS. LINEAR GROWTH A calculator is allowed on the following questions. Jamie some money Jamie owes owes Tina some money and and decides decides to pay pay her back Tina receives receives 33 her back in the the following following way. way. Tma dollars dollars the the first first day, day, 66 dollars dollars the the second second day, day, 18 18 dollars day, and 54 dollars dollars the third third day, and 54 dollars the the fourth fourth day. Which Which of the the following describes the the day. following best best describes relationship relationship between between time time and and the the total total amount amount of money (cumulative) Tina from money (cumulative) Tma has has received received from Jamie over the the course course of these these four Jamie over four days? days? Which scatterplot the strongest Which scatterplot shows shows the strongest positive positive association association between between x and and y? y? A) y .,. ••• .:.. . •,, •••• . ,, .. ...... •• • •• • A) B) C) D) Increasing linear linear Increasing Decreasing linear linear Decreasing Exponential growth Exponential growth Exponential decay Exponentialdecay X B) y .. -•• .-··. ......,. ••• • • Albert has a large book collection . He decides to trade in two of his used books for one new book each month at a local bookstore. Which of the following best describes the relationship between time (in months) and the total number of books in Albert's collection? • ..,.. • • • •• •• • • A) B) C) D) X C) y ,- .,.,,,. ·" ~· .J: Increasing Increasing linear linear Decreasing Decreasing linear linear Exponential growth Exponential growth Exponential decay Exponential decay A scientist scientist counts counts 80 cells in aa petri petri dish dish and and finds into two two new n e w cells finds that that each each one one splits splits into cells every uses the = cr’ every hour. hour. He He uses the function function A( A ( t) = cr1 to calculate calculate the the total total number number of cells cells in the the petri petri dish hours. Which Which of the the following following dish after after t hours. assigns values to c and and r ?? assigns the the correct correct values X D) y A) c = = 40, = 2 40,rr = B) c = 80,r = 8) 80, r = 0.5 ,~ .... ,, J. C) cC = : 11.5 .5 = 80,r 80, r = D) cc = 80, = 2 80,rr = ·-"~'y. •• ti'• • • X 30 THE PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE ID,____ _____ .__....____,_ ..... The dollars, of price P, in dollars, the price shows the below shows table below The table a beginning of after the beginning days after cntde oil t days of crude barrel of a barrel an shortage. an oil shortage. Of the following scenarios, which one would result in linear growth of the square footage of a store? A) footage by square footage increases the square owner increases The owner A) The year. each year. % each 0.75 0.75% footage by square footage increases the square owner increases 8) The owner B) each year. 5% each 5% of the store by 5% the store expands the owner expands The owner C) The 5%of the each year. footage each original square original square footage year. between adding alternates between owner alternates The owner D) The adding 200 the square feet the and 300 square year and one year square feet one square year. next year. next Price, (dollars) Price, P (dollars) 0 50.00 15 60.51 30 73.22 45 88.77 11 11 the model the used to model m(2) " is used equation P = m(2)'/ the equation If the which of the and P, which between t and relationship between relationship ? and n ? values of m and the values be the could be following could following 11 = 54.38 and n m = 25 and A) m 86.12 25and n = B) m = 25andn =86.12 50 and n = 54.38 C) m = 50andn C) and n = = 50 and m = D) m = 86.12 equipment an equipment operation, an year of operation, its first year During its During line . product line. items in its carried 6,400 items supplier supplier carried its product carried the supplier next 66 years, each of the next For each years, the supplier carried number of items the number half the product line half in its product items it type of What type previous year. What the previous carried the had carried had the items the number of items the number model the best to model model is best model given any given line for any carried in its product supplier supplier carried product line operation? years of operation? year year in its first 7 years A) B) B) C) D) Number days, t Number of days, a stored in a gigabytes, stored data, in gigabytes, amount of data, The amount If 16 hours. If every 15 hours. database increases by 2% every database increases stored in the gigabytes the currently stored data is currently worth of data gigabytes worth functions g database, following functions the following which of the database, which will that will gigabytes, that gives data, in gigabytes, amount of data, the amount gives the now? be days from now? database t days the database stored in the be stored model An exponential growth model exponential growth An model decay model exponential decay An exponential A linear model growth model linear growth A linear model decay model linear decay 16(2)1s1 g(t) = 16(2)15' A) 80) A) I = 16(1.02)15 B) g(t) B) g<t>=16(1.02)f’-< 51 C) g(t)= 16(1.02)s C) g(t)=16(1.02)% V = 200(i V = 1,500t 81 D) g(t) = 16(1.02) '° D) g(t)=16(1.02)% ) An analyst wo the ttwo accurate the how accurate evaluating how analyst is evaluating An number models total number the total predicting the are in predicting above are models above of views, days after after receives t days video receives online video an online V, an views, V, are views are more views itit is released. many more How many released. How predicted the than by the model than linear model the linear predicted by the exponential video is the video after the days after model 4 days exponential model released? released? A) 1,400 B) 2,800 C) 3,200 D) 4,000 I 31 31 - ---- Rates Rates I’ve found rate problems problems to students just just “get" intuitively, others completely I've found rate to be be pretty pretty polarizing‐some polarizing-some students "get" them them intuitively, others get get completely Most of the rate problems be pretty straightforward, but aren’t, II highly highly lost. Most the rate problems on on the SAT will be pretty straightforward, but for the ones ones that that aren't, recommend using up the the solution solution ((if i f you’ve you should should recommend using conversion conversion factors to set up you've gone gone through through chemistry, chemistry, you know I ' m talking factors are approach a lot of these these problems, problems, know what what I'm talking about). about) . Conversion Conversion factors are a fool-proof fool-proof way way to approach but be slow-going solvers.. I’ll both the the straightforward, straightforward, intuitive intuitive but they can can be slow-going for stronger stronger problem problem solvers I'll be be covering covering both approaches approach throughout examples in this this chapter chapter.. approaches and and the the conversion conversion factor approach throughout the examples EXAMPLE 1: A bicycle bicycle manufacturer manufacturer can can produce produce 20 20 bicycles bicycles per per hour hour.. How H o w many many hours hours would would it it take take EXAMPLE the manufacturer to produce produce 320 320 bicycles? bicycles? the manufacturer Wedivide divide the the total + 20 20 = : [!§]hours hours.. Easy enough. enough . We total by the rate rate to get 320 ...,... EXAMPLE 2: 2: A rocket rocket has has 360 360 gallons fuel left left after after 2 hours hours of flight, flight, and and only only 100 100 gallons gallons after hours EXAMPLE gallons of fuel after 66 hours of filght. flight. It burns burns n71gallons gallons of fuel every hour hour of flight, flight, where where n is a constant. constant. What What is the value of n ?? fuel for every the value Here, we are are figuring figuring out o u t the the rate. rate. ln In 6 -‐ 2 =z 4 hours hours of flight, the rocket Here, we rocket burned burned 360 -‐ 100 =z 260 gallons gallons of 260 ILt:l Therefore, the the rocket rocket bums z ~ 5] gallons gallons of fuel every fuel. Therefore, bums a? = every hour. hour . 4 EXAMPLE 3: A box at the the supermarket can hold hold 66 oranges oranges each. Each orange 20 cents cents.. Given Given that that EXAMPLE box at supermarket can each. Each orange costs costs 20 the has a budget of $540 to stock oranges, how boxes will will the the supermarket supermarket be be able able to to the supermarket supermarket has a budget $540 to stock oranges, how many many boxes fill? If each dollar would would be be enough enough for 5 oranges. Five hundred forty dollars would then If each orange orange is 20 cents, cents , then then aa dollar oranges . Five hundred forty dollars would then be enough for 540 x 5 =z 2700 oranges, oranges, which which would would fill 2700 ...,... + 6= : j 450 Iboxes. be enough boxes. above were were quite straightforward and and didn didn’t out conversion factors, but but The examples examples above quite straightforward 't really really call for writing writing out conversion factors, what if if we wanted conversion factors factors for Example Example 3? 3? What what wanted to use use conversion What would’ve would 've the the solution solution looked looked like? IOOcents l g~ ange ox .centS" 1 1l bbox 5 4.de-Ha"fs 0 W xx 100.deHar ‐ 4450 0 boxes 540 x x ---= l1d o l i a r? X 20 2 .centS" 0 m X 66ganges 5 boxes ~ 32 THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA As help you go from from one one set set of to another As you you can can see, see, conversion conversion factors factors are are multipliers multipliers that that help you go of units units to another.. They're They’re 1 . . . . . . oran e usually as fractions, the question question (e.g. usually expressed expressed as fractions, and and they they represent represent either either information information provided prov1ded by the (e.g. orange) 20 cents , 100 cents) cents Wh .. .. f bl em, you ._ ((e.g. 100 1ve a pro d ar d unit or stan standard u n .i t conversmns ) .. When usmg c o n v e r s 1 o n factors solve problem, you must must set set conversions e.g. m dollar en using conversion actors to so 1 them and denominators. them up up in the the right right sequence sequence and and with with the the appropriate appropriate numerators numerators and denominators. Wags) The teach you they're used, even The rest rest of the the examples examples in this this chapter chapter are are done done with with conversion conversion factors factors to teach you how how they’re used, even though to solve the problems though you you may may be be able able to solve the problems "intuitively". “intuitively”. EXAMPLE travel 1 mile second-s. At Afthis many miles can the ear EXAMPLE 4: A car car can can travel mile in 1 minute minute and and 15 15seconds. this rate, rate, how how many miles can the car travel travel in 1 hour? hour? In most asking for. We convert that hour to most rate rate problems, problems, you'll you’ll start start with with what what the the question question is asking We need need to convert that 11 hour to aa distance distance that that the the car car travels travels.. The The car's car’s rate rate is 1 mile mile every every 75 seconds seconds.. 1 r x 6 0 m m 60seeonfis x 60 miles = : 11 mile mile = 60 60 x 60 miles I miles mil 1 hoof x 60 .mifl1:rtes x 60 _seetmcisx 148 r 1wear hoof 1.rnimrte 75 _seetmcis 75 es xlmimifixfiseeerfisz 75 The are canceling, are you're doing things The units units should should cancel cancel as as you you go go along. along. If the the units units are canceling, chances chances are you're doing things right. right. Notice up with. with . This This is another sign that we’ve we've Notice that that the the "miles" ”miles” unit unit at at the the end end is is the the unit u n i t we we wanted wanted to end end up is another sign that done done things things correctly. correctly. EXAMPLE 5: Tom Tom drives drives 30 30miles miles at at an an average average rate rate of 50 50 miles miles per per hour. hour. If If Leona Leona drives drives at EXAMPLE at an an average average rate same distance? distance? rate of 40 40 miles miles per per hour, hour, how how many many more more minutes minutes will w i l l it take take her her to travel travel the the same We have have to figure figure out o u t how how long takes Tom to to drive drive 30 miles:: We long it takes 30 miles hour 60 minutes minutes . 1 hour . 30 miles 36 minutes m11es>< x . x h = miles 1 hour 2 36 minutes 1es x our 50 m1 Leona will take take Leona will x 30 miles miles>< hour ~1 ho_ t x miles 4 0 m1 es 60 minutes 60 i°~inutes = 45 minutes 1 hour : 45 minutes our So, So, 45-‐ 36 =~ E minutes 36 = minutes 45 EXAMPLE 6: To prepare prepare for class, class, Mr. Mr. Chu Chu has has to print print a number of booklets booklets with with p pages pages per per booklet. booklet. If If EXAMPLE a number every 5 pages pages cost cost c0 cents cents to to print print and and he he spent spent aa total total of d dollars, dollars, how booklets did print every how many booklets did Mr. Chu Chu print p,c, and d ?? in terms of p, c, and cp A) A) 500d 500d 100d B) 100d 500d C) 500d B) cp C) cp ,.J _ d D) cp pages x 11booklet SOOd b booklets 55 ~ booklet I 500d kl X = -00 ets r s x lIda-Harxccents ppages cp .1xrue1r c.centS' p~ cp ,i---:::- d ~ctrS D) 35 Sd X 1OOcents‘ 100 .cetrtS' ..J-J.J...-::° X CT§] . Answer (C) . Answer 33 33 CHAPTER 4 RATES CHAPTER RATES CHAPTEREXERCISEAnswers : for this chapter star t on page 280. A calculator should O T be should N NOT be used used on on the the following questions. following questions. submarine descends As a submarine descends into into the the deep deep ocean, ocean, the pressure pressure itit m the u s t withstand increases. must withstand increases. At At an an altitude of ‐700 altitude - 700 meters, meters, the the pressure pressure is is 50 50 atrn atrn (atmosphe res), and (atmospheres), and at an an altitude altitude of of -‐900 900 meters, the the pressure meters, For every pressure is 70 atrn. atrn . For every 10 10 meters the meters the submarine submarine descends, descends, the the pressure pressure itit faces increases increases by n, where where n is is a a constant. constant. What What is the value va lue of n ? ? Tim's diet diet plan plan calls for 60 Tim’s 60 grams grams of of protein protein per per day. If Tim day. If were were to meet meet this this requirement requirement by by only eating eating a certain only certain protein protein bar bar that that contains contains 30 30 grams of protein, grams protein, how how many many protein protein bars bars would would he have have to buy he buy to last a a week? week? A) 0.1 B) 1 C) 2 D 0 D)) 110 An empty empty pool pool can can be hours if be filled in 5 hours if water water is is pumped in at 300 gallons pumped gallons an an hour. hour . How How many many hours would would it take take to fill the hours the pool pool if water water is is pumped in at 500 gallons pumped ga llon s an an hour? hour? An electronics electronics company company sells sells computer computer monitors monitors and releases a and releases e w model a nnew model every every year. year . With With each each new model, model, the the company company increases new increases the the screen screen size by a constant constan t amount. size amount. In ln 2005, the the screen screen size was was 15.5 inches. inches . In size was 1n2011, the screen screen size size was inches. Which Which of the 18.5 inches. the following following best best describes how describes how the the screen screen size size changed changed between between 2005 and and 2011? A) The The company company increases A) size by increases the the screen screen size by 0.5 inch inch every every year. year . The company company increases B) The size by 1 increases the the screen screen size inches every inches every year. year. company increases C) The company increases the the screen screen size size by by 22 inches inches every every year. year . The company D) The company increases increases the the screen screen size size by by 3 3 inches inches every every year. If a app les cost d dollars, which of the following expressions gives the cost of 20 apples, in dollars? 20a A) 303 d d B) B) y20d a a C) C) 207 20d 20 D) ad D>H 34 THE COLLEGE THE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA During During a a raceon race on a a circular circular race race track, track, aa racecar racecar Idina can type 90 words words in 2.5 minutes. ow Idina can type 90 minutes. H How many words type in 12 many words can can she she type 12 minutes? minutes? ‘ bums fuel fuel at at a a constant constant rate. bums rate. After After lap lap 4, the the racecar has tank. After After lap racecar has 22 gallons ga110ns left left in its its tank. lap 7, the racecar gallons left the racecar has has 18 gallons left in its its tank. tank. Assuming the racecar does not not refuel, refuel, after after Assuming the racecar does which lap will the racecar have have 6 gallons gallons left which lap will the racecar left in tank? its tank? A) Lap 13 Lap 13 B) Lap B) Lap 15 15 C) Lap Lap 16 16 C) _ D) L D Lap 19 19 ) ap salesman at aa tea company company makes makes a a $15 A salesman commission on on every every $100 worth worth of products products commission that he he sells. sells. If If a a jar of tea leaves leaves is $20, how how that many jars jars would would he he have have to to sell sell to to make many make $180 in commission? commission? _ By 1:00 PM, PM, a total total of 40 boxes had had been 40 boxes been unloaded from a delivery delivery truck. truck . By 3:30 PM, a unloaded from a PM, a total of 65 65 boxes boxes had had been been unloaded unloaded from from the the total same truck. truck. If If boxes boxes are are unloaded unloaded from from the same truck the truck constant rate, at a constant number of rate, what what is the the total total number boxes that that will have been been unloaded unloaded from boxes will have from the the truck by by 7:00 PM? truck PM? A train it train covers covers 32 32 kilometers kilometers in 14.5 minutes. minutes . If If it continues at the the same rate, which which of the continues to travel travel at same rate, the following closest to the distance distance it will travel travel following is is closest to the it will in 2 hours? hours? 54kilometers A) 54 kilometers A calculator is allowed following allowed on the following questions. questions. B) 265 kilometers kilometers C) 364 kilometers C) 364 kilometers D) 928 kilometers kilometers A rolling covers a feet in in 4 rolling ball ball covers a distance distance of 2400 feet minutes. speed, in minutes . What What is the the ball’s ball 's average average speed, inches er second? 12 inches inches per second? (12 inche s = = 1 foot foot) P ( ) I1 _ Peanut an industrial container at Peanut oil oil leaks leaks out out of of an industrial container at the If the the rate rate of 3 liters liters in 2 hours. hours. If the peanut peanut oil oil costs costs 8 dollars dollars per per liter, liter, how how many many dollars’ dollars' worth worth will will be be lost lost in 11 hours? hours? A) A) $60 B) B) $96 C) $118 $118 D) D) $132 35 CHAPTER CHAPTER 4 RATES RATES A recipe for soap calls for 1~ cups of lye for Henry 30 miles per hour hour and Henry drives drives 150 miles miles at at 30 miles per and then miles per per hour. then another another 200 miles miles at at 50 50 miles hour . What his average speed, in miles What was was his average speed, miles per per hour, hour, for the journey, to the the entire entire journey, the nearest nearest hundredth? hundredth? every 2 cup cup of castor castor oil. How H o w many lye every~ many cups cups of lye are needed batch of soap soap that cups of are needed for aa batch that uses uses 3 cups castor oil? castor 4 A) 38.89 B) 40.00 5 C) 42.33 A) 1 A) 15 B) 5 D) 43.58 9!4 C) C) 9g 5 1 D) D) 11~ 113 4 A ”slow” "slow" clock falls behind behind at at the the same same rate rate It is set set to the the correct correct time time at 4:00 every hour. It every A M . When When the AM. the clock shows shows 5:00 AM the the same same AM . When When the day, the correct time day, the correct time is 5:08 AM. the clock shows 10:30 AM AM that day, what what is the the correct correct shows that day, An 8 inch by 10 inch piece of cardboard costs $2.00. If the cost of a piece of cardboard is proportional to its area, what is the cost of a piece of cardboard that is 16 inches by 20 inches? time? time? A) 11:02 AM AM AM B) 11:18 AM AM C) 11:22 AM D) 12:18 PM D) A) $4.00 B) $8.00 C) $12.00 D) $16.00 Jared are tasked Jared and and Robert Robert are are accountants accountants who who are tasked with takes Jared Jared with reviewing reviewing financial financial reports. reports. It takes 15 hours, rate, to review 15 hours, working working at a constant constant rate, review a = 2 large bahar 400 kulack = 29 pikol 9 pikol report financial pages of financial report containing containing 240 pages statements. works at twice Jared Jared’s statements. If If Robert Robert works 's rate, rate, how many minutes minutes would would it take Robert to how many take Robert review pages of financial financial review a a report report containing containing 120 pages statements? statements? The formulas above represent represent the relationships The formulas above the relationships between some some units weight that were once once between unit s of weight that were used in Indonesia Indonesia.. A weight weight of 1,000 kulack used kulack is equivalent how many many large large bahar? (Round equivalent to how bahar? (Round your answer answer to the the nearest nearest whole whole number.) number.) your A) 225 B) 345 C) 450 D) 900 36 36 COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA A flask contains an acidic solution with a concentration of 7.1 x 1015 hydrogen ions per mi!Liliter. If 4.8 x 1023 hydrogen ions have a total mass of 0.8 grams, which of the following is closest to the concentration, in grams per liter, of the acidic solution? 5 A) 1.2 ><10_5 X 10A) 8 10B) 1.2 x ><1o‘8 -5 x 10 C) 1.5 ><10_5 8 D) 1.5 ><10_8 X 10D) Brett currently spends $160 each month on gas . His current car is able to travel 30 miles per gallon of gas. He decides to switch his current car for a new car that is able to travel 40 miles per gallon of gas. Assuming the price of gas stays the same, how much will he spend on gas each month with the new car? A) $100 B) 8) $120 $120 C) $130 D) D) $140 Margaret can buy 4 jars of honey for 9 dollars , and she can sell 3 jars of honey for 15 dollars. How many jars of honey would she have to buy and then sell to make a total profit of 132 dollars? 37 Ratio & Prop Ratio Proportion ortion Let’s parking lot lot is is 5:2 5:2 (5 Because ratios ratios can be written as fractions, fractions, Let's say that that the the ratio ratio of cars cars to trucks trucks in in aa parking (5 to to 2). 2). Because can be written as this a t i o is 15equrvalent to ~. 2 A A ratio r a t i o of of 5:2 5:2 is 15also a t i o of to the the this rratio equivalent to also equrvalent equivalent to to a a rratio of 10:4, 10:4, since since the the latter latter reduces reduces to former. former. In ratio of 5:2 means means that every 5 cars, And assuming Ln this this context, context, a ratio that for every cars, there there are are 22 trucks. trucks . And assuming that that there there are are only only cars and ratio also means that that there vehicles. By By the same cars and trucks trucks parked parked in the the lot, lot, the the ratio also means there are are 5 5 cars cars for for every every 77 vehicles. the same token, vehicles. token, there there are are 2 trucks trucks for every every 7 vehicles. EXAMPLE1: Minyoung EXAMPLE Minyoung bought bagels for event. The The ratio ratio of the number number of of bought croissants croissants and and bagels for a a breakfast breakfast event. of the croissants bought to the number of of bagels bagels she she bought bought was [f Minyoung Minyoung bought bought 72 bagels, how how croissants she she bought the number was 33 to to 4. 4. If 72 bagels, many croissants did she she buy? buy? many croissants did According to the Minyoung bought bought 3 croissants croissants for bought 72 According the given given ratio, ratio, Minyoung for every every 4 4 bagels. bagels. Since Since she she bought 72 bagels, bagels, she she must have bought bought must have 3 croissants croissants ~ . 72 bagels bagels = : ~ 54 croissants x 72 croissants bagels 4 bage 1s EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 2: Arfand Arfand is is following following a recipe for for a seasoning blend blend that black pepper, pepper, and and a recipe a seasoning that requires requires sea sea salt, salt, black paprika. paprika. According According to the the recipe, recipe, the the ratio ratio of of grams grams of of sea sea salt pepper should 1:2, and salt to to grams grams of of black black pepper should be be 1:2, and ratio of grams grams of black black pepper pepper to of paprika paprika should should be How many paprika should should the the ratio to grams grams of be 4:3. 4:3. How many grams grams of of paprika Arfand use to make make 108 grams seasoning blend? blend? Arfand use grams of of the the seasoning Since black black pepper both the ”common basis basis”" for for Since pepper is involved involved in both the given given ratios, ratios, we we can can use use itit to to establish establish aa "common comparison. First, comparison. black pepper pepper ratio ratio by get 2:4. Why multiply by 2? Because First, multiply multiply the the sea salt salt to black by 2 2 to to get 2:4. Why multiply by 2? Because now n o w the “ 4 " in the lines up with the ” 4 ” in in the the black black pepper pepper to the "4" the ratio ratio lines up with the "4" to paprika paprika ratio. ratio. Once Once they they are are lined lined up, up , we we can establish can that the between the three ingredients is 2:4:3 (sea salt to black pepper to paprika). establish that the ratio ratio between the three ingredients is 2:4:3 (sea salt to black pepper to paprika). According be used used for for every +4 + 33 = : 99 grams of the blend.. Therefore, Therefore, According to this this ratio, ratio , 3 grams grams of of paprika paprika should should be every 2 2+ 4+ grams of the blend 3 Arfand should should use use ~ 5 xx 108 = : 36 grams grams of paprika. Arfand of paprika. lliJ 38 38 COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA Proportion Proportion addition to ratios, the SAT will In addition ratios, the test you you on on proportions, o t in the that you you typically typically learn will also also test proportions, but but n not the way way that learn them in school school (direct (direct vs. vs. indirect indirect proportion). them will give and ask you how proportion). Instead, Instead, the the SAT will give you you aa relationship relationship and ask you how a change change in one one variable a variable affects another. another. Let's run through a a quick example . Imagine Let’s r u n through quick example. Imagine we we have have a a triangle. triangle. We We know know that that the the area area of of a a triangle triangle is is A = ébh Now Now let's let’s say say we we triple triple the the height. height. What What happens happens to the the area? area? Well, if we we triple triple the height, new height is 3h. The The new height, the new height is new area area is is then then 1 Anew = 517611) 2 3 1 (ibh) 2 314.0“) See what what happened? happened? The rearranged so so that that we e w area is three three times times the The terms terms were were rearranged we could could clearly clearly see the the nnew area is the area. We old area. We put put the ”3” old formula. "3" out out in front front of the the old formula. This technique This extremely important important because because it saves saves us on tough problems. We We could’ve technique is extremely us time time on tough proportion proportion problems. could've made made up up numbers numbers for the the base base and and the the height height and and calculated while that’s certame calculated everything everything out, out, and and while that's certainly a a strategy strategy you you should should have would’ve taken longer and silly have in your your toolbox, toolbox, it would've taken much much longer and left us us more more open open to to silly mistakes . mistakes. Let's do Let’s do a a few more more examples. examples. EXAMPLE The radius radius of a circle is increased increased by by 25°/o. By what EXAMPLE 3: The a circle 25%. By what percent percent does does the the area area of of the the circle circle increase? mcrease? Let the be AAM. the original original radius radius is is r, r, then e w radius radius is is 1.25r. the original original area area be old· If lf the then the the nnew l.25r . Am, = 7T(1.25r)2 z (l.25)2(7rr2) =1.5625(7rr2) = 1562514,” We can 56.25% I.. can see that that the area area increases increases by j 56.25% The idea idea is to get a number in front of the old old formula. formula. In turned out 1.5625. The number in front of In this this example, example, that that number number turned out to to be be 1.5625. Also note 1.25r was was wrapped in parentheses parentheses so Also note that that the the l.25r wrapped in so that that the the whole whole thing thing gets gets squared. squared. It It would’ve would've been been incorrect : rr(l.25 71'(1.25)r2 we wouldn't wouldn’t be e w radius. incorrect to have have Am” A ,ww = )r 2 because because we be squaring squaring the the nnew radius. EXAMPLE 4: The The length length of is mcreased increased by by 20%. width is is decreased EXAMPLE 4: of aarectangle rectangle is 20%. The The width decreased by by 20%. 20%. Which Which of of the the following accurately describes the change in the area of the rectangle? following accurately describes the change m the area of the rectangle? A) A) Increases Increases by 10% B) Decreases Decreases by 10% 10% C) Decreases Decreases by 4% 4% D) Stays Stays the the same same D) Originally, A= : lw. 120. Now, Originally, A Now, Anpzu A, ww Z (1.201)( (1201)(0.80u’) = 0.80w ) := §J . 0.96171) 0 .96/w = 0.96A01d 0.96A 0 1d The area Answer (C) . Most Most students students think (D). It's It’s not. The area has has decreased decreased by 4%. Answer think the the answer answer is is (D). not. 39 CHAPTER CHAPTER 5 RATIO RATIO & PROPORTION PROPORTION EXAMPLES: EXAMPLE 5: F_ = 9q1q2 94142 - ,2 7‘2 attraction between between two two particles particles can can be be determined determined by the formula above, The force of attraction the formula above, in which F is the force between q1 and and 472 q2are are the charges of the the two between them, them, rr is the the distance distance between between them, them, and and q, the charges two particles. particles. If resulting force of attraction the the distance distance between between ttwo w o charged charged particles particles is doubled, doubled, the the resulting attraction is what what fraction fraction of the original force? the original 1 Ali l 3); 1 C’s 1 D)1‐6 F 2 94qu z<1>2(9q1qz) _1 (9q1qz)=1p ""“’ (2r)2 2 r2 4 r2 4 0“ Answer how we do nnot the formula formula affect the the result. result. In ln getting Answer ~(B) . Notice Notice how o t let constants constants like like the "9" " 9 ” in the getting aa number number out front, students mixing that that number number up with that were out front, students often often make make the the mistake mistake of mixing with numbers numbers that were originally in the originally the formula. formula. EXAMPLE cube is tripled. each side side must been increased EXAMPLE 6: The The volume volume of aa cube tripled. The The length length of each must have have been increased by approximately approximately what what percent? percent? A)3% A) 3% B}12% B) 12°/o C)33% C) 33°/o 0)44% D) 44% Now volume of a a cube s3 where N o w we we have have to solve solve backwards backwards.. Keep Keep in mind mind that that the the volume cube is V = S3 where ss is the the length length of each can still apply apply the process as before: increase each side. side. Even Even though though this this problem problem is a little little different, different, we can the same same process as before: increase each side by some factor and rearrange the terms to extract a number . Only this time, we have to use x. each side some factor and rearrange the terms extract number. Only this time, have use 3 = (xs) (XS) Vnew Vm'w : Vm’u' 2X 3 3 _ 5 ‐X 3 Void 3 3 must be equal . That Notice That xx3 new Notice how how we we were were still still able able to extract extract something something out out in front, front, xx3. must be equal to 3 if if the the n ew volume triple the old volume volume is to be be triple the old volume:: 3 xx3z3 =3 x:\3/§z1.44 = ~ ~ 1.44 X Each have been Answer ~(D) .Each side side must must have been increased increased by by approximately approximately 44%. Answer 40 THE COLLEGE THE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 282. A calculator should NOT be used on the following questions . A calculator is allowed following allowed on the following questions. questions. The ratio and the the ratio ratio of a to b is 7:6, and ratio of b to c is 8:5. If what is the value of c ?? If a = 28, what the value P =- v2 = RF Electric Electric power voltage V and power P is related related to the the voltage and resistance R by the resistance the formula the voltage voltage formula above. above. If If the were halved, how would would the the electric electric power were halved, how power be be affected? affected? A) The electric electric power power would would be be 4 times times greater. greater . A) 8) The electric B) greater.. electric power power would would be be 2 times times greater C) The The electric electric power power would would be be halved. halved. D) The power would would be quarter of The electric electric power be aa quarter what it was. what was. The The ratio ratio 2}; can be What is 2~ : 1I;~ can be written written as as n n:: 2. 2. What the value value of 11 the n ?? Julie has a Julie has square fence that a square that encloses encloses her her garden. garden . She decides expand her her garden decides to expand garden by making making each 10percent After each side side of the the fence 10 percent longer. longer. After this will this expansion, expansion, the the area area of Julie’s Julie 's garden garden will have percent? have increased increased by what what percent? A) 20% A) 20°/o The the The price price of Product Product X Xisis 25% greater greater than than the price The price Product Z is 25% price of Product Product Y. Y.The price of Product less than the price product Y. What is the the ratio ratio than the price of product Y.What of the the price of Product X to the price of price Product the price Product Z? Z? Product B) 21% 8) 22% C) 22°/o D) 25% A A)) 3 : 2 B) 8) 4: 4:33 A right hass a base radius of rand r and aa right circular circular cone cone ha base radius height of 11. If the radius is decreased by 20 height 11 . If the radius decreased 20 percent the height 10 percent and and the height is increased increa sed by 10 percent, the following is the resulting percent , which which of the following is the resulting percent volume of the cone? percent change change in the the volume the cone? C C)) 5 : 2 D D)) 5 ::33 A) A) 10°/o 10% decrease decrease B) 8) 12% decrease decrease C) 18.4% 18.4% decrease decrease D) decrease D) 29.6% decrease 41 41 CHAPTER 5 RATIO & PROPORTION B 45° h A A s\/§ s b2 D D 40 5 45° I S s The The area area of the the trapezoid trapezoid above above can can be be found found In sides ln the the triangle triangle above, above, the the lengths lengths of of the the sides relate to one relate another as shown. If a n e w one another as shown. If a new triangle triangle is created such that that the the area area of of created by by decreasing decreasing ss such the nnew the e w triangle the original original area, triangle is 64 64 percent percent of of the area, s must 5 must have have been been decreased decreased by by what what percent? percent? using If lengths BC and and using the the formula formula ~%(b1 (bi + b2)h. b2)l1.If lengths BC AD are is doubled, are halved halved and and the the height height is doubled, how how would the would the area area of the the trapezoid trapezoid change? change? A) The 50 percent. The area area would would be be increased increa sed by by 50 percent. B) B) The The area area would would stay stay the the same. same. A) A) 8°/o 8% B) 20% C) The 25 percent. percent. The area area would would be be decreased decreased by by 25 D) The 50 percent. The area area would would be be decreased decreased by by 50 percent. C) 25% D) 30% V T ---------Questions 10-11 Questions 10-11 refer to the following to the following information. information. ---------- Calvin has has a a sphere Calvin sphere that is four that is four times times bigger bigger than Kevin has in terms The than the the one one Kevin has in terms of of volume. volume. The radius radius of Calvin’s Calvin's sphere sphere is how how many many times times greater in length greater length than than the the radius radius of Kevin’s Kevin's sphere (rounded (rounded to the sphere nearest hundredth)? the nearest hundredth)? L = 4nd2b The star each The total total amount amount of energy energy emitted emitted by by a a star each second luminosity L, related to second is is called called its its luminosity L, which which is is related to d, its 1), its its distance distance (meters) (meters) away away from from Earth, Earth, and and b, its brightness brighb1ess measured measured in in watts watts per per square square meter, meter, by by the the formula formula above. above. A) 1.44 B) 1.59 1.59 C) 1.67 D) 2.00 If one star is three times as far away from Earth as another, and twice as bright, its luminosity is how many time s greater than that of the other star? A A)) 8 B) 9 C 6 C)) 116 D 8 D)) 118 42 42 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA Astronomers see two equally bright stars, Star A and Star B, in the night sky, but the luminosity of Star A is one-ninth the luminosity of Star B. The distance of Star A from Earth is what fraction of the distance of Star B from Earth? If If the the ratio ratio of y y:: 2.4 is is equivalent equivalent to to 2.7 2.7 :: 3.6, what what the value is the value ofy of y?? 3 A); A) 2 4 B); B) 3 C) 7 C); 3 9 D); D) 5 1 Alfi A) 27 1 B) 9 1 C) 3 2 D) 3 Box A weighs 42 pounds and Box B weighs 30 30 weighs 42 pounds and B weighs pounds . The pounds. The ratio ratio of the A to the weights weights of of Box A to Box equal to the B is equal the ratio ratio of the the weights weights of of Box C C to to Box D. If weigh a of 180 If Box C and and Box D weigh a total total of pounds, what pounds, what is the the weight weight of Box C, C, in in pounds? pounds? A The student student body The after-school program program body at an an after-school consists only only of 6th consists 7th graders, and 8th 8th 6th graders, graders, 7th graders, and graders. The The ratio ratio of 6th graders. is 6th graders graders to 8th 8th graders graders is 17: 28. If a total total of 110 students 17: the students attend attend the program , n 11 of whom whom are program, graders, what are 7th 7th graders, what is aa possible value of n ? possible value 11? A 0 A)) 550 75 B) 75 C) 105 D) 130 bookstore ordered A bookstore 10 ordered an an initial initial shipment shipment of 10 paperback copies paperback hardcover copies of aa copies and and 4 hardcover copies of newly published published book. newly store m u s t order book. The The store must order aa second shipment second shipment with with the the same same ratio ratio of of paperback and and hardcover paperback hardcover copies copies as as the the initial initial shipment. If the shipment. the store 50 hardcover store orders orders 50 hardcover copies copies the book book for the of the the second second shipment, shipment, how how many many paperback copies paperback store order? copies should should the the store order? 43 43 Expressions Expressions 33m ~ k x2 + variables. Both x2 and variables. combinations of numbers expressions are Algebraic expressions are just just combinations numbers and + y and and m - k are are examples examples Algebraic 2 with deal with you to deal allow you that will allow techniques that fundamental techniques we'll cover of expressions. this chapter, chapter, we’ll cover some some fundamental expressions. In this and effectively. expressions quickly involving expressions questions quickly and effectively. questions involving Terms 1. Like Terms Combining Like 1. Combining they look like that look together that terms together putting terms avoid is putting the most terms, the When combining When combining like like terms, most important important mistake mistake to avoid like they combine a + ab to can you b3, nor make £73, b2 + b to make ' t. For example can can't. example,, you you cannot cannot combine combine b2+ n o r can you combine but can together but go together can go match. variables have the variables add or subtract make subtract,, the have to completely completely match. 2ab. To add make 21111. EXAMPLE 1: EXAMPLE 2 2 2 10b2 ) 5a2 b2 - 10172) ) -‐ (a 20132 -‐ 3a 3a2b2 4172) (a22 + + 5a2b2 b -‐ 4b 2(2a the expression equivalent to the following is equivalent the following Which expression above? above? Which of the 2 b2 -‐ 1st 18b 2 3a2 -‐ lla B) B) 3a2 11a2b2 A) -‐6a2b2 6a2 b2 2(2a2 2 (2a 2 2 2 -‐ b 3a12172 -7 31 2 2 41,2) <a2 ) -‐ (a 4b 2 b 2 + 2b 2 3a 2 -‐ lla C) 3,12 11a2b2 + 2172 2 2 b -‐ + + 5a 5a2b2 2 10b 10172)) IT§]. Answer (C) l. Answer 44 D) 5a2 + 2a2b2 + 21:2 2 2 10b 2 b + a 2 -‐ Sa 8b 2 -7 112 8b2 5a2b2 +1on2 4a 2 = : 4a2 6a 2 b2 -‐ 6112172 : 3112 3a 2 ‐= 2 2 + 2b22 11112172 b + 2b 11a THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA .. v0 2. Expansion Expansion and 2. and Factoring Factoring J EXAMPLE M L ] ;2 2: : ~ -. .r - 4)(2:c + + 3) 2(x -‐ 4){2x Which Which of the the following following is equivalent equivalent to the expression above? the expression above? A) ~ 2 -‐ lOx A)4x2 10x‐24 - 24 B)4x2+10x‐24 B) 4x2 + lOx - 24 C)4x2+10x+24 C) 4x2 + lOx + 24 D)8x2 0 x -‐ 224 4 D) 8x 2 ‐- 220x Some people people like to expand Some expand using using a method called FOIL (first, method called (first, outer, outer, inner, last). last). If If you you haven't haven't heard heard of it, that' it's the same that’ss totally totally fine. After all, all, it’s asdistributing same thing thing as distributing each each term. term. First, First, we we distribute distribute the ”2.” "2." 2(x -‐ 4)(2x + 3) 4)( 2x + 3) = = (2x ~- 8)(2x 8)( 2x + Notice that that itit applies applie s to just one of the Notice just one t w o factors factors.. Either Either one but N O T both. the two one is fine, but NOT both. (2x -‐ 8)( 2x + 3) = (2x 8)(2.r : 4x2 4x 2 + 6x ‐- 16x ‐- 24 = 4x 2 ‐: 4x2 10x -‐ 24 10x [ED. Answer (A) . Answer Now factoring and N o w when when it comes to factoring and expansion, expansion, there there are are several several key formulas formulas you you should should know: know: .• (a+b)2 (a + b)2 =a2+2ab+b2 = a2 + 2ab+ b2 0 (a‐b)2 =az‐2ab+b2 • (a - b) 2 = a2 - 2ab+ b2 0 (a+b)(a‐-b) • 112‐1)2 a2 - b2= (a + b)(a - b) Memorize Memorize these They show show up very often. these forwards forwards and and backwards. backwards. They up very often. EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 3: 3: Which Which of the is equivalent equivalent to the following following is to 414 4.x4‐- 9y2 9y2 ? ? A) (2x2 (2x2 + 9y)(2x2 -‐ y) A) + 9y)(2x2 B) (4x2 (4x2 + 3y) (x2 -‐ 3y) 8) syxxz (x 2 + 3y)(4x2 3y)(4x2 -- sy) 3y) C) (x2 D) (2x2 + 3mm2 3y)(2x2 -‐ 3y) D) (2x2 By) Part makes for a score is pattern Part of what what makes a top top SAT score pattern recognition. recognition . Once Once you've you 've done done enough enough practice, practice, you you should should 2 2 be able asa difference of t w o squares, a variation of the a2‐ b2 formula. The be able to recognize recognize the the question question above above as a difference of two squares, a variation of the a - b formu la. The SAT will rarely on those formulas in a straightforward way. Beon the lookout for variations that rarely test you you on those formulas in a straightfo rward Be on the lookout for variations that match match the pattern. pattern . With more more practice, practice, you’ll you 'll get better better and and better better at at noticing noticing them. them . Using the formu formula = (a + + b)(a -‐ b), we can By. Therefore, Therefore, Using la a4122 -‐ b2 b2 = can see that that a = = 2x2 2x 2 and and b = = 3y. 4x4 9y2 = : (2x (2x22 + 3y)(2x2 4x 4 -‐ 9y2 3y)(2x2 ‐- ay) 3y) ITelJ . Answer Answer (D) . 45 CHAPTER 6 EXPRESSIONS CHAPTER EXPRESSIONS EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 4: 4 -‐ 8x 2 2 16x4 8x2y2 + 3;4 16x y + y4 Which above? Which of the the following following is equivalent equivalent to to the the expression expression shown shown above? A) (41:2 + f ) ’ 4 B) (2x -‐ y) B) (2: y)4 2 C) C) (2x (2x + + y)2(2x y)2(2r -‐ y) y)2 D) (4x + y)2(x ‐ y)2 2 -‐ 2ab 2 (in reverse), Using the can see that that a = = 4x2 4x 2 and y2.Therefore, Therefore, Using the formula formula (a -‐ b)2 = = aa2 Zab + + bb2 reverse), we we can and b = = 3/2. 2 16x44 -‐ 8x 8x2y2 y4 := (4x2 yz)2 16x y2+ y4 (4x 2 -‐ y2 )2 2 formula to the This is not take it one step further further and and apply apply the a 2 -‐ bb2 n o t in the the answer answer choices choices.. We have have to take one step the a2 formula the expression inside the parentheses expression inside the parentheses.. 2 2 2 (4x (2x++yy) ( “ z-‐ y2 f f)2 : l=a [(2x x ++ wy)( a x2x‐-wy fi)] ==( u f a(2x x ‐- wy)2 2 Answer (C) . Answer [@] 3. Combining Fractions 3. Combining When When you're you’re adding adding simple simple fractions, fractions, 11 + 11 3 4 -3 + 4- the do this this so so that that we can get a common the first step step is to find the the least least common common multiple multiple of the the denominators denominators.. We Wedo we can get a common denominator. In aa lot cases, it's as it is here, here, 3 x 4 = denominator. lot of cases, it’s just just the the product product of the the denominators, denominators, as z 12. 4 1 5 + ‘ fi 3 7 fi ‐ fi Now 're adding denominator, the the idea idea is the the same. same . N o w when when we we’re adding fractions fractions with with expressions expressions in the the denominator, EXAMPLE5: EXAMPLES: 1 2 1 2 x+2 + x - 2 x+2+x‐2 Which equivalent to Which of the the following following is is equivalent to the the expression expression above? above? 3x -‐ 22 3x A) A ) (x+2)(x (x+2)(x' -‐ 22)) 3x + + 22 3x 1)” (x ( x+ 22)(x ) ( x-‐ 22)) B C) 3 3 C ) (x ( x+ 22)(x ) ( x-‐ 22)) 2 2 D ) ((xx++ 22)(x ) ( x-‐ 22)) D) The common denominator s: (x + 2)( multiply common denominator denominator is just just the product product of the the two t w o denominators: 2)(xx -‐ 2). So So now n o w we multiply 't have: have : the top and and bottom bottom of each each fraction fraction by the the factor the theyy don don’t -- 11 + x+ +2 22 _ 11 ix‐2 x- 2 22 .x+2_ x+2 2(x 2(x x -‐ 2 + 2 ( x++ 22)) _ ((x x ‐-22) ) ++2--,--0( x ++--'-22)) = -. -+ -. - - = ----+ -----'---= -'----'---,x -‐ 22 _ xx ++ 22 x -‐ 2 x -‐ Z2 x + 2 _ ( x(x++22)(x ) ( x -‐ 22)) ((xx++ 2)(x 2 ) ( x- ‐ 2) 2 ) _ ((xx++ 2)( 2 )x( x- ‐2)2 ) _ 3 x++ 2 3x + -- ‐ ( x(x++22)( ) ( xx -‐ 22)) [ill). Answer ( B ) . Answer 46 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA 4. 4. Flipping Flipping (Dividing) (Dividing) Fractions What's between+ What’s the the difference difference between 1 - 1 - ?? 2 2 3 3 and and - !2 The where the fraction line divided by 3. The divided by ~The difference difference is where the longer longer fraction line is. The The first is %divided The second second is 1 divided g. 3 They 're not They’re not the the same same.. 11 _ !1 -'-3 ; =_ !1 X !1=- !1 2· 2 3 6 3 ‐2'3‐2x3‐6 _i_ _L= 3 1 . 2 --=2 1 -'--= . 3 3 1 X-=2 3 2 3 The The shortcut shortcut is to flip the the fraction fraction that that is in the the denominator denominator.. So, a - g b- _ ac ‐ Fb C c If the occurs : If the fraction fraction is in the the numerator, numerator, then then the the following following occurs: a _ b 5_= _1 a c _ bc be EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 6: If If x > 1, 1, which which of the the following following is equivalent equivalent to ? ‐‐1‐xT1 ? 1 X x --‐ 1 + x + 1 2x22 2x __ A) (x - l)(x + 1) A)(x‐1)(x+1) B) 22 _______ B’(x‐1)(x+1) (x - l)(x + l) C) x(x‐1)(x+1) x(x - l)(x + 1) _______ 2 2 C) D __ )(x+1) D) ((xx-‐ ll)(x+l) 2 ) 2 First, combine fractions on the common denominator denominator (x -‐ 1)(x + First, combine the the two t w o fractions the bottom bottom with with the the common + 1). 11 1l X _ x +1 -x-- 1 + -x +-1 = -(x--- 1)-(x-+~1) X x -‐ 1l 2Xx 2 x--- 1-)-(x_+_l_) = -( x‐1+x+1“'u‐1nx+u + -(u‐1Mx+n ux--‐ 11-)-( x xx_+_ +l_n) Next, Next, substitute substitute this back back in and and flip it. +11)) x _ x (x ( x-- 1l ))(x ( x + 11)) _ ((xx -‐ 1l ))(x (x+ X ‐ ‐ 22xx ‐ _ _ ‐ ‐ 22x§ _ _ ‘ ‐ ‐ 22 _ ‑ ( x -‐ 11)(x ) ( x + 1l ) (x Answer ~(D) . Answer 47 CHAPTER 6 EXPRESSIONS CHAPTER EXPRESSIONS 5. Splitting Splitting fractions fractions 5. 30 EXAMPLE 7: Which EXAMPLE Which of the followingisequivalent to 306+ the following is equivalent to : C7 c? +c A) A S5) +c ? 6 10+c B) 10 +c B)‐2‐‐ 2 C ) 5 +c +c C)S We can split Wecan split the the fraction fraction into into two: two : ic D)5+g 0)5 + 30+c_?1)+£_5+£ 6 _ 6 6 _ 6 The answer is ~( D ) .- This The answer just the the reverse adding fractions. fractions. This is just reverse of adding Note that Note that while while you you can can split split up the the numerators fractions, you so with numerators of fractions, you cannot cannot do so with denominators. denominators . So, 3 3 x +y X _ 7g_ -i=-+x+y x 3 _ y 3 !J1 you cannot cannot break break up a fraction fraction like In fact, you like -x i -y any further.. any further x +y 48 COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 284. should N A calculator should O T be NOT be used used on the following questions. following questions. 4 + 8x Which of the Which the following following is equivalent equivalent to to 4 ~:x 12x forxX76 for /; O 0?? Which of the the following following is equivalent Which equivalent to 2y + 6x23] + 6ch2 6x 6xy 2 ? 1 ++ Bx 8x 3x 4 + 2x B) B) 3x 1 1 + 22xx C) 3x A) A) A) A) 6xy(x 6xy (x + y) B) 12xy(x + + y) 2 6x y2(y + x) C) 6x2y2(y 3y 3 D) 12x 12x3y3 D D)) 1l 0, then 2 !+ ~ is equivalent equivalent to which lIff a ,f; 76O,then + 2 which of the the a Which of the the following following is equivalent Which 3x44 -‐ 3 3 ?? equivalent to to 3x 4 following? following? A) 3(x 2 + 1)2 A)Mx2+1V 3 + 4a 4a 4a 4 ++33a a B) 4a B) 3(x2 1)22 3(x2 - 1) A) A) C) D) C) C) D) D) 3 ( x 3 -‐ 30: 1”(35+ ) (X + 1) 1) 3(x2 +1)(x+1)(x + l )(x + l )(x -‐ 1) 3(X 1) 7 4a 4 (x +1)2 +2(x +1)(y 1)+ ( y ++ 1) 1)22 + 1)2 + 2(x + l )(y + + 1) + (y a+4 Which of the Which the following following is equivalent equivalent to to the the expression shown expression shown above? above? A) (x ++ yy ++1)2 A) (x 1)2 Which of the following is equivalent to (x 2 + y) (y + z) ? A) x 2z + 1/ + 2)2 B) (x (x + +y + 2)2 C)) ( (x x ++yy)2 F ++22 + 1/Z D) (x + y)2 y )2 -‐ x -‐ y B) x 2y + x 2z + y 2 + yz C) x2y + y2 + x2z D) x2 + x 2 z + y2 + yz 49 CHAPTER 6 EXPRESSIONS EXPRESSIONS CHAPTER If yé0 yéy, If y I0 and and xx Iy, which which of the the following following is is 2 xy - x equivalent to xy ‐ x;2 ? equivalent ? A)‘i‘ A) The expression 8x 2 - ~y 2 can be written in the form where c is aapositive form 8(x -~ cy)(x cy)(x + + cy), where positive xxyy -" yy constant. What What is the constant. value of c ? the value _ 'f_ 1 A) A) 16 X B) 'f_ i X 1 B) 8 xX y 1 C) C) C) g- 4 xX y D) D) 7 D) which of the following If x > 1, which following is equivalent equivalent to 2 xx2(x (X 1 -----,----1 -=?7 x - 1 x +S --+-2 3 x‐1+x+5' C) D) D) 2) + +44 + 2)(x 2) ( X -‐ 2) Which of the the following following is equivalent Which equivalent to the the expression above? expression above? A) (x2 (x2 ‐- 2)2 2)2 A) B) B) (x2 (x 2 + + 2)2 2) 2 C) C) (x (x --1)2(x 1) 2 (x + 2)2 2) 2 D) D) (x (x +1)2(x + 1)2 (x -‐ 2)2 2) 2 A) 5): Sx + + 77 A) B) B) ~ 6 6 2x + 4 6 5x + 7 1 30x + 42 1 2+ X -- 1 2- X If x I76O, equivalent to to 0, which which of the following following is equivalent the given given expression? the expression? 2x -‐ 1 2x + 1 2x + 1 B) B) 2x -‐ 1 A) A) 4x22 -‐ 1 4x x2 x2 D D)) -‐ 1 C) 50 THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA _\ A calculatoris allowed on the following A calcu I‑ lator is allowed on the following quest ions. questions. I ‐ “ ): X 2 3x + 8x2 8x 2 ‐- 4x 3x33 + 7x2-11x - 7 712‐11x‐7 Which of of the following is the the sum Which the following sum of of the the two two polynomials above? above? polynomials ” X A) A) _L - x- 2 x‐2 rX B) 2(x B) -_ T {f - C) C) 10x 10x55 -‐ 7x -‐ 7 2 4 + 3x 3 D) D) 1Sx 15x4 + 3x3 -‐ 15x 15x2 -‐ 7 D) 3x D) 2(x - 2) 2(x ‐ 2) Whic h of ing is equivalent to Which of the the follow following is equivalent to the the expression above? above? expression A) -‐2a\/E 2afa A) B) afa B) a\/E C) ) 3a C 3 -a ‐2/a 2 fi D) D) 3a 3a+8\/E + BJa 9(2y) 2 2 + 2(6y) 26 22 7 If yyéo, y f=O,what what is is the the value If MW · B(3y)2 ?· value of H " Which of the the following Which following is is equivalent equivalent to to the the expression above above for x 752 =/=2 ? expression ? 3 + x 2 - 15x A) 3x 7 A) 3x3+x2‐1Sx‐7 3 B) 3x 1Sx2 -‐ lSx B) 3x3 + +15x2 15x -- 77 (5a + + 3Ja) WE) -‐ (2a + + sJa) s fi ) x --+~ --+2(2 X- x)a ‐ x- 2 xX C) 2(x - 2) 2(x ‐ 2) 3x 2) 2) Models ConstructingModels Constructing graphs . expressions, equations as expressions, quantities as real-life quantities represent real‐life you to represent require you questions require model questions Constructing model Constructing equations,, and and graphs. chapter is specifically focused but this chapter book, but chapter s in this book, other chapters can be type can Questions be found found in several several other Question s of this type Now exponential). Now quadratic , exponential). linear, quadratic, types (e.g. linear, pertain to any of the conventional 't pertain ones that don on on the ones don't conventional model model types be won 't be there won't quite simple, actually quite chapter's difficult. Most mean this chapter’s doe sn't mean that doesn’t Most of the questions questions are actually simple, and and there in the chapter leave the rest to you in and leave example s and two examples We'll just do two here . We’ll concept s here. any nnew e w concepts chapter exercise. i. . l schooll>µys th.e school grade - If each grade. students in each grade levels school, there a school, EXAMPLE 1: At a there are are a grade levels with with b students If the buys n 71 EXAMPLE s ckers thenumber gives the the following which of the equally among stickers bedistributed among the the students, students, which following gives number of stickers distributed equally stickers to be each receives? student receives? each student ab ab A) A) 7 n an B) B) an 7 b bn C) bn a rt D)~El? D) C) 7 ab divide student s. To find the number b) = The school has a (a) (b) : ab abstudents. number of stickers each each student student receives, we divide a total of (a)( ITe:IJ. ~: . Answer student s: ‐”‐. the number Answer (D) . number of students: number of stickers n by the number ab th drained tank.was until it was rate imtil was pumped pumped into into a tank at a constant constant rate was foll. full. The tank was then EXAMPLE 2: Water was amount of total ent-the rep could graphs at been filled. Which of the the following following could represent the total amount had been than it had rate than slower rate a slower at a water the tank time? versus time? tank versus water in the A) B) C) .... s ....2 0 s....fil § .... gt ~ s. §2 as at ~~ s“ ~ s; i” l ~~ 0~ Time Trme D) ..... 0 “6 ...Iii 0 l‐i 533 ~j s1 : Time Time Time Jhne Water be represented and to to the right (positive slope) . (positive slope). the right up and going up line going a line by a represented by should be tank should the tank into the pu~ped into be~ng pumped Water being Water slope).. That That leaves leaves (negative slope) right (negative the right to the and to down and going down line going by aa line represented by be represented should be dramed should bemg drained Water being us answers C and D. Since tank was drained at at aa slower slower rate is ~(D) answer is the answer filled, the was filled, than itit was rate than was drained the tank Since the and D. wi~ answers~ ~s with line o t as steep as as the going up up.. line going the line as steep 1snnot down is going down lme going 52 \ I i ~it 0~ Time Tlllle 5; the the THE COLLEGE THE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA CHAPTEREXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 285. should N NOT A calculator should O T be be used used on the following questions. following questions. An intemet charges internet service service provider provider charg es a a one one time time setup setup fee of $100 and and $50 each each month month for for service. service. If c customers customers join at the the same same time time and and are are on the of the the following following the service service for formm months, months, which which of A carpenter carpenter lays lays x bricks bricks per per hour hour for y hours hours and then and g bricks then lays lays ~ bricks per per hour hour for 2y more more expressions the total total amount, amount, in expressions represents represents the dollars, provider has charged these these dollars, the the provider has charged customers? customers? 2 hours. terms of x and hours. In terms and y, how how many many bricks bricks did did he lay in total? he total? A) 100C A) 100c + 50m A) A) 23:31 2xy B) 100c 100i: + 50cm 5 B) B) gxy xy C) 150cm C) 5xy Sxy D) 1 100m + 50cm 00m + 2 3 D) D) gx+3y 2x + 3y At aa math team competition, there are are m m schools math team competition, there schools with from each school. The The host host with n students students from each school. school wants order enough such school wan ts to order enough pizza pizza suc h that that there student. If there are there are are 2 slices for each student. are 8 slices in one which the following following gives one pizza, pizza, whic h of the gives the schooll must the number number of pizzas pizzas the the host host schoo must order? order? mn nm A) 8 mn B) A cheese vendo r current ly has 175 pounds of mozzarella avai lable for sale . If each pound of mozzarella sells for $8.75, which of the following functions gives the amount of mozzarella M, in pounds, still available for sale after d dollars worth has been sold? d M (d) = 175 - 8.75 B) B) M(d) M (d) =175‐8.75d = 175 - 8.75d A) T4 C) 8.75 C ) M(d) 7 5-‐ -8 ? C) M (d) = 1175 d D) =175(8.75)‐d D) M(d) M (d) = 175(8.75) - d m+2n m + 2n 8 8 D) D) 2mn A retail store has monthly fixed costs of $3,000 and monthly salary costs of $2,500 for each emp loyee . If the store hires x emp loyees for an entire year, which of the following equations represents the store's total cost c, in dollars, for the year? A) A) cc == 3,000+2,500x 3,000 + 2, 500x B) B) c c==12(3,000 12(3,000 + 2,500x) 2, 500x) C) cc = 12(3, 12(3,000) + 2,500x D) cc== 3,000 3,000 + 12(2,500x) 12(2,500x ) 53 CONSTRUCTING MODELS CHAPTER MODELS CHAPTER 7 CONSTRUCTING A calculator is allowed on the following questions. A manufacturing plant increases the temp erature of a chemical compo und by d degrees Celsius eve ry m minut es. If the compound has an initial temperature oft degrees Celsius, which of the following expressio ns gives its temperature after x minutes, in degrees Celsius? A) A) 8) 3) biking for 4 commu te by biking began a 5-mile cormnute Kaiba began rest area the rest at the stopped at area. He stopped rest area. a rest miles to a walked for the then walked and then for 15minutes 15 minutes and faster bikes faster If Kaiba bikes commu te. If remainder of the commute. remainder grap hs following graphs which of the following wa lks, which he walks, than he than commu te? his commute? represent his cou ld represent could m x++ t mx d m mdd++ t A) A) xX "U -0 QJ d C) t +C) t+‐d‑ mx dx D) Hi" D) t +m Q) o:i 2 E: 4 2 Ez w s.is 11 u C: - 6"' -‐ 0 D (I) 0-L---+---+----+-➔ 45 30 15 15 30 45 (minutes) Time (minutes) 8) B) bakers to make emp loys bakers cupcake store employs A cupcake make boxes and cupcakes x tains con box Each cupcakes. Each of cupcakes. contains cupcakes and cupcakes y produce to expected baker is expected each baker produce cupcakes expressions following expressions Which of the following each day. Which each needed for all boxes needed number of boxes gives all the the gives the number working for 4 bakers working produced by 3x bakers cupcakes cupcakes produced days? days? T: -0 QJ o:i Q) 2 5. ~ ,...._4 . E? 4 [r= 2_ 3 m- ~ 3 2 u E 2 a5 11 s2 QJ ·- C: - (I) 6"' '‐ D A) 12x2y 12x2y 3 3y B)7y 8) 4 C) 5 ~ ,...._4 F r:~ 33 . QJ · - 0 -"""'--+---+---- o 15 30 45 Time(minutes) Time (minu tes) C) C) 12x2 ‘U -0 QJ y 0.0 o:i 2 5 4 ~ ,...._4 «EA r= P g~ 33 D) 12y ·;: éé z211 s2 ~ C: ..::, U) -6"' 5 o 0 souvenir price of one At shop for tourists, one souvenir touri sts, the price At a shop purchased additional souvenir dollars . Each additional is a dollars. souvenir purchased Which percent. 40 percent. Which discounted by 40 after after the first is discounted C, cost C, total cost gives the total equations gives of the following following equations where souvenirs, where purcha sing n souvenirs, dollars , of purchasing in dollars, n> > 11?? 15 30 45 30 Time (minutes) (minutes) D) D) -0 QJ o:i > <1l ,...._ 5 4 r=~ 3 A) CC == aa + +(n‐1)(O.4a) (n - 1)(0.4a) B) 8) C = a + (n -‐ 1)(0.6a) QJ · - u E 2 ~ - 1 0 6"' C) C := a + n(0.6a) n(0.6a) D) = 0.6an D) C = 15 15 30 30 45 45 Time (minutes) (min ut es) 54 THE COLLEGE THE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA Mike starts starts driving Mike driving to to work work and and records records his his distance from from home, distance 10 minutes. home, in miles, miles, every every 10 minutes. His distance distance from His from home home increases increases slowly slowly at first first due to traffic, traffic, then due more quickly quickly as as then increases increases more traffic clears clears up. up. Which Which of of the the following following graphs graphs could illustrate illustrate Mike’s could Mike's distance distance from from home home during his during his drive? drive? At a video video game be game arcade, arcade, d dollars dollars can can be exchanged for p tokens. exchanged tokens. If If each each game game requires requires w w tokens to tokens gives the to play, play, which which of of the the following following gives the cost per cost per game, game, in dollars? dollars? w 2 A) A) dp dP A) A) 8) B) Q.I 2m 2m E 25,c- --r----.--r----,-----.-. 20 >--+--~_.,_---+-~------< § i 15 f---+---+----+- - ---.------i J:: :-::: m Q.I E 10 1--+-----+-~--±-__. m 0 .c u - § 0 id pw dw p F C) di” C) D) d_p dp D) w 5 (J') 10 20 30 40 50 60 Time (minutes) To prepare prepare for landing, landing, a a plane plane descends descends so so that that B) 3) altitude decreases its altitude decreases at a constant constant rate rate from from 24,500 feet to 17,900 feet in 12 12minutes. Which of of minutes. Which the following following equations the equations gives gives the the altitude altitude A, A, in in feet, of the plane its descent descent plane t minutes minutes after after its began, for0 began, s 12? 12? for O fi :S tt :S Q.I Q) E 0 o .c .: E E -A 0 ~ J:: = :-::: é a sE Q.I u - @ E ..... a 25 20 15 10 5 A) A =17,900 = 17,900 ‐- 550t B :17 , 9 0 0 + 550: B)) A = 17,900 550t 0 0 0 100 Q 0 210 0 3200 30 4 0405 50 0 660 0 (J') 24,500 C) A z= 24, 500 ‐- 550t D) A = 500 + + 550t = 24, 24,500 550t Time (minutes) (minutes) C) Q.I O.) E c0 25 20 0E... ..!!:! 15 ..... ·- 10 Q.I E 8 u -f: @ 5 ..... .<: .c A taxicab charges a dollars for the first mile traveled and b dollars for each additional mile. lf a a particular particular passenger passenger traveled traveled more more than than one one mile during mile during a a ride ride that that cost cost $24, which which of of the the following following represents represents the the distance, distance, in in miles, miles, the the passenger traveled passenger traveled during during the the ride? ride? (J') E (JJ ..<e ; 0 ,_[ I i5 0 100 D 0 210 0 3200 30 4 0405 50 0 6600 Time (minutes) Time (minutes) 24 - a - b A) 24‐ba‐b A) D) D) b Q.I B) 24‐ba+b 24 - a + b E 25 20 E0 ~ 15 J:: :-::: 10 Q.I E u ;a 5 ..... 8) 0 .c -· - I 1 'I --,- 24 + a - b C) 24+l:1‐b C) b 24 - a D) 24b‐a D) b (J') 0 b 00 10 10 20 20 30 00 30 40 40 50 50 60 60 Time (minutes) (minutes) 55 55 CHAPTER 7 CONSTRUCTING CHAPTER CONSTRUCTING MODELS MODELS Mark started working as an inspector for a large construction company on June 1, 2019. According to his contract, his annual salary will increase by $15,000 on the first day of June each year. Which of the following graphs could model Mark 's annual salary, in dollars, x years after June 1, 2019? To move move into into a new new studio studio space, space, the themm members members club agreed agreed to split of an an art art club split the first month’s month's rent of r dollars dollars equally rent equally among among themselves. themselves. If If k of the members share, which members fail to pay pay their their share, which of the following following represents represents the additional the additional amount, amount, in dollars, dollars, that that each members each of the remaining remaining members must pay pay to cover cover the first month must month’s rent? 's rent? rr 111-‐ k m kr B) B) m -‐ k m kr(m -‐ k) kr(m A) A) A) A) a E 73 E b sro N C) C) (V)I ) 111 111 kr D) D) m(m ‐- k) 76 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 5123456 B) B) 75 s T: E E‘ N 76 m a5 f: 5 1 1223344 55 66 C) E" s 3 E E’ 2 50° 76 3 E < 1 12 23 3 44 55 6 D) D) '----------+X 1 2 3 4 5 6 56 e • Manipulati)Jg Manipulating & Solving Equations On the SAT, SAT, there there is aa huge huge emphasis emphasis on on equations. equations. To get get these these types right, yott you must learn how how On types of questions questions right, must learn to isolate isolate the variables variables and and expressions expressions you you want. want. First, First, we'll we’ll cover cover several several useful techniques in dealing with useful techniquJs dealing with equations that that you you may may already already be be familiar familiar with. with. equations I 1. Don Don’t like terms 1. 't forget to combine like should be be ruthless ruthless in finding finding like like terms terms and and combining combining them. them. Doing Doing so so will simplify simplify things things and and allow allow you you You should figure out o u t the the next next step. step. I to figure EXAMPLE1:If2(a+b+2c+3d+1)= EXAMPLE 1: If 2(a + b + 2c + 3d +I) =3a+2b+4c+6d,findthevalueofa. 3a + 2b + 4c + 6d, find the value of a. same four four variables variables are are on both both sides sides of the the equation, equation, a, a,b,c should tell you you to distribute on the the The same b, c and and d. That That should distribute on side first and and then then combine combine like l i k e terms terms.. Sounds Sounds simple simple but but you you won won't how many many hudents students forget to 't believe believe how left side do this, especially especially in the the middle middle of aa more m o r e complex complex problem problem.. do 6 + 33dd + 11)) = 2 33aa + + 22bb + 44c c + 66d d 2((aa++ bb + 22c The b, b,c, and d variables variables cancel cancel quite quite nicely. The c, and 211+25+M+fid+223a +26+Arf+fad ~ + ~ + ¥ +M + 2 = ~ +~ +¥ + M : a IT]= \ \ \ “51 CHAPTER 8 MANIPULATING MANIPULATING & SOLVING SOLVING EQUATIONS EQUATIONS CHAPTER 2. Square Square equations equations correctly 2. When squaring squaring equations equations to remove remove aa square square root, root, the the most most important thing to remember you’re not not When important thing remember is that that you're squaring -y ou're squaring the entire squaring individual individual elements elements‐you’re squaring the entire side side.. EXAMP1,.'E2: EXAMPLEZ: ·"' vab = a- b \/a_b=a‐b If a,>. a >. 00 and and b > 0,'. O,tthe equation above is equivalent equivalent to to which which of the the following? following? U h;eequation above is A)ab=az~-b2 B)ab=az+b2 C)2ab=aZ‐b2 2ab = a 2 - b2 C) D)3ab=az~l-b2 D) 3ab = a2 + b2 ·TThe problem should h e square square root root in the the problem should scream scream to you you that that the the equation equation should should be be squared. squared. Most Most students students know know the square make: the square root root should should be be eliminated, eliminated, but but here's here’s the the common common mistake mistake they make: ab=aZ‐b2 ab = a2 - b2 They square When modifying equations, you square each each individual individual element. element. However, However,this this is WRONG. WRONG.When modifying equations, you must m u s t apply apply any any given given operation operation to the the entire entire SIDE, like like so: (M)2 b)2 (fa‐bf = = (a (a‐- b)2 If it helps, the operation. the same same holds holds true helps, wrap wrap each each side side in parentheses parentheses before before applying applying the operation. By the the way, way, the true for both sides all other other operations, operations, including including multiplication multiplication and and division division.. When When you you multiply multiply or divide divide both sides of an an equation, parentheses, but because of the equation, what what you're you’re actually actually doing doing is wrapping wrapping each each side side in parentheses, but because the distributive distributive property, it just multiplying or individual element the same property, just so so happens happens that thatmultiplying or dividing dividing each each individual element gets gets you you the same result. result. For For example, example, if we we had had the the equation equation zy x + 22 = and both sides doing is is and we we wanted wanted to to multiply multiply both sides by by 3, 3, what what we're we’re actually actually doing 3(x + 2) 2) = 3(y) 3(x which turns turns out out to be be the the same same as as which 3x ++ 66 =: 3y 3x 3y Anyway, back to the Anyway, back the problem: problem: 2 (M)2 = MW = (a (a -‐ b) 17)? ab:a2‐2ab+b2 ab = a 2 - 2ab + b2 2 2 3ab = : aa2 -+- b b2 3ab + answer is~is (D) . The answer Another the square square root root is isolated isolated on side. For For example, Another common c o m m o n mistake mistake is squaring squaring each each side side before before the on one one side. example, let's let’s say we we wanted wanted to find find the the solutions solutions to the the following following equation: equation: Vx+5+lzx We can't "1" from can’t square square each each side side right right away away to get get rid rid of the the square square root. root. We first have have to move move the the ”1” from the the left side to the theright side: side right side: x + 5=: xx ‐ 1l v'x+5 58 58 \~ ___ ____ _____ _ _ THE COLLEGE PANDA THE __ C _O_L_L_E_G_E_E _'AND __ :A _ And n now can square square both And o w we can both sides. sides . (Jx ( v x++5) 52f == ((xx ‐- U1)22 xx+5:x2‐2x+1 + 5 = x 2 - 2x + 1 00=x2‐3x‐4 = x 2 - 3x - 4 0 := ((x x ‐-44)(x ) ( x ++ 1l)) X x ==‐ -1 1,4 ,4 solutions are are ‐1 So, the solutions hold on! We’re square roots in the - 1 and and 4, but but hold We're actually actually not not done done yet. yet. When When there there are are s~uare roots in the original equation, equation, we original we have solutions by testing each of our values in the original equation. have to check check for false solutions by testing each of our values in the original equation. So when when x = -‐ 11,, the 50 the left hand hand side + 5+ + 11 = z 3 The values match, side is \/ J -‐11 + 3 and and the the right right hand hand side side is is ‐- 11.. The values don't don't match, so ‐1 - 1 is actually actually n so o t a solution. = 4, 4, the the left left hand is \/4 not solution. When When xx = hand side side is J4 ++ 55 ++ 11 := 44 and and the the right right hand hand side side is is 4. 4. case, the the values In this case, sides match so4 values from from both both sides match so 4 is is a a solution. solution. Why do false solutions Because squaring squaring both both sides solutions occur? occur? Because sides has has the the effect effect of of turning turning negative negative values values into into positive ones, ones, which positive which sometimes mismatch on both sides. If we plug x = ‐1 into \/ x + 5 = sometimes causes causes a mismatch both sides. If we plug x = - 1 into J x + 5 = xx ‐- 11 from from above, we above, side is One is we can can see see that that the the left hand hand side side is is 2 2 and and the the right right hand hand side is -‐ 22.. One is positive positive and and the the other other is is negative. Once negative. we square square both sides, however, this distinction is lost since both sides become 4. Once we both sides, however, this distinction is lost since both sides become 4. In summary, you’re dealing with square roots in square the the entire sides, which summary, when when you're dealing with square roots in an an equation, equation, square entire sides, "'lhich may may require require you you to move move something something from one side to the other, and solutions by plugging your from one side to the other, and check check for for false false solutions by plugging your results results into into the the original original equation. equation. I This lot to to watch watch oout u t for, but for most of This may may seem seem like like aa lot for, but for most of the the questions questions involving involving this this type type of o:fequation equation on on the the SAT, pitfalls by by plugging than solving solving SAT, you you can can avoid avoid all all the the potential potential pitfalls plugging in in the the answer answer choices choices (see (see tip tip #8) #8) rather ra~er than the equation equation algebraically. algebraically. 3. o o t equations 3. Square Square rroot equations correctly correctly Now, it comes both sides, forget the Now, when when it comes to to taking taking the the square square root root of of both sides, most most students students forget the plus plus or or minus minus( (±i )).. Always Always remember equation such such as asx2 z 25 25 has has two t w o solutions: solutions: remember that that an an equation x2 = f o z ¢ fi x = i 5 However, only applies taking the the square square root However, this this only applies when when you’re you're taking root to to solve solve an an equation. equation. By By definition, definition, square square roots \/§ = = 3, : -‐33 is is not n o t possible when roots always always refer refer to to the the positive positive root. root. So, So, v'9 3, NOT NOT 3&3. ± 3. And And fy'x = possi~le (except (except when working numbers, which which we'll we’ll look look at at in in a future chapter). The plus or minus is only necessary working with with non-real non-real numbers, a future chapter). The plus or minus ls only necessary when is used solve an solutions to the when_the the square square root root is used asa as a tool tool to to solve an equation. equation. That That way, way, we we get get all all the the possible possibl1 solutions to the equation. equation. EXAMPLE If (x + is the the sum sum of the two EXAMPLE3: 3: If + 3)2 3) 2 = = 121, 121, what what is of the two possible possible values values of of x x?? u+3fi=1m (x + 3) 2 = 121 tJ(xh ++53)22 = u1 = i±¢✓121 x ++ 33 =± = i 11 H xX = = -‐ 33±i 11 u Sox could s u m of w o possibilities Sox could be be either either 8 8 or or -‐ 14. 14. The The sum of those those ttwo possibilities is is j ‐6 - 6 I.. 59 CHAPTER MANIPULATTNG & & SOLVING SOLVING EQUATIONS EQUATIONS CHAPTER 88 MANIPULATING 4. Cross-multiply when set equal equal to 4. Cross-multiply when fractions fractions are are set to each each other other Whenever fraction is another fraction, fraction, Whenever a a fraction is equal equal to to another a _ E C 5 b_ d you can cross-multiply: ad ad = : be. you can cross-multiply: 4 10 10 5 3 . EXAMPLE4: If 5xx = ‘3‐', what is is the value of o f x ?? EXAMPLE4: If 4 10 s, _ 1_0 5X=3 5 _ 3 12x = 50 50 12x x_ é x=l _ 2: 6I 2 1 . EXAMPLE 5: If If ,/:--‐ 2 ‐ ‐ -‐ ‐= 0, !Sthe value of o f x ?? EXAMPLE _]___ = 0~what is xX -‐ 44 xx+ +2 2 1 2- 4 xx2‐ 4 -_ Xx + 22 = _O 0 2 _ 1 xx7-2 -‐ 4 _ Xx + +2 2) = z x2 22(x (x + 2) x2 -‐ 44 2x z x2 2x ++44= x2 -‐ 44 z x2 00 = x 2 -‐ 2x 2x -‐ 8 8 ) ( x + 22)) 0O=: ((xx -‐ 44)(x+ x X = 4, 4, -‐2 = 2 we plug these values values back back into into the the original equation, we'll we’ll see =4 is a solution but = ‐2 If we plug these original equation, see that that x = 4 is a solution but x = - 2 is is a a FALSE solution because because it causes causes division Therefore, the the answer answer is [±]. I. As we learned solutions can can solution division by 0. Therefore, learned before, before, false solutions occur an equation has square but they can also also occur are variab variables in the the denominator denominator occur when when an equation has square roots, roots, but they can occur when when there there are les in of aa fraction. Though you won’t see solutions very often on it’s aa good good practice always confirm confirm fraction. Though you won't see false solutions very often on the the SAT, it's practice to to always your these two t w o cases. cases. your results results in these 60 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA 5. Factoring should be in your toolbox toolbox should be Some variables that that are are tougher to isolate isolate.. For to do Some equations equations have have variables tougher to For a a lot lot of of these these equations, equations, you you will will have have to do some the variable you want. some shifting shifting around around to factor out out the variable you want. EXAMPLE6: EXAMPLEG: a a b = -=3a+c 3a +e Which the following Which of the following expressasainterms expresses a in terms ofbandc? of b and e ? bee b A) 1 - 3b A)1‐3b b bee B) 3b + 1 B)3b+1 1 -‐ 33bb C) 1 C) be be 3b+1 D) 3b +1 D) be be _ b =- 11 a- ‐3a+c 3a + e b ( 3 a+e)= + c ) : aa b(3a 3 a b++be= b c : aa 3ab b e z aa ‐-S3ab ab be= b c : aa(1 ( 1 ‐- 33b) b) be= bc be ‐a --= a 1 -‐ 33b} ; ‑ what we we did? See what did? We We expanded side. Then Then we we expanded everything everything out out and and put put every every term containing containing a a on on the the right right side. were able able to factor oout were u t a and answer is ~(A) -. and isolate isolate it. The answer EXAMPLE7: EXAMPLE 7: xx4+3x3+x+3=0 + 3x3 + x + 3 = 0 4 What is one one possible What possible real real value which the value of x x for which the equation equation above above is is true? true? 4 xx4+3x3+x+3zo + 3x3 + x + 3 = 0 x3(x+3)+(x+3)=0 x3 ( X + 3) + (X + 3) = 0 (x+3)(x3+1)=0 (x + 3)(x 3 + 1) = 0 x :=‐ -3 30orr -‐ 1 3 from the first two terms, further factoring was possible with the (x + 3) term. How Once we we factored Once factored out out x x3 two terms, further factoring was possible with the (x + 3) term . How would you would you know do this? Experience. know to do Experience . 61 61 CHAPTER 8 MANIPULATING CHAPTER MANIPULATTNG & SOLVING SOLVING EQUATIONS EQUATIONS 6. 6. Treat complicated complicated expressions expressions as as one one unit unit EXAMPLES: EXAMPLES: x x3+x2+x= -‐‐‐-‐-‐1-’-‘‑ MCI-FE) Which of gives m in terms of x? of the following following gives min x? (x4+x3+x2)R A) _(x4+x3+x2)\/;j§ B) _ x_312 C) ~(x3+x2+x)(x+-‐) A) m = ” ‘ m ‐(x+-( fixl) g ) ”‘M(x4+xa+xz)(x+;) ' " ‘ fi g x / x ‐ 1‐ x D) m = (. D ) m = (x3 (x3+x2+x) + x2 + x) x + l) (x+;) x Don't let the complicated expressions expressions as one unit Don’t let the big big and and complicated complicated expressions expressions freak freak you you out. out. Treat these these complicated as one unit or variable, like so: variable, like B A=~ A *me fi Multiply Multiply both both sides sides by by m. m. B mA =z -C‐ mA C Divide both sides sides by by A. Divide both m_1 _ AC Finally, plug plug the the original expressions back back in in.. Finally, original expressions 1 x x‐ ‑ xJx-.!. x nt = X 3 2 (x + x + x) ( x + Answer (D) . Answer~. 62 i) THE CKALEGE cpLLEGE PANDA PANDA EXAMPLE 9: EXAMPLE (x+1)2+5(x+1)‐24=0 (x + 1)2 + 5(x + 1) - 24 = 0 If xx > 0, what real value of of xis x is the theequafiOn above·ttrue? r u e"'""~ ? “1 If 0, for what real value 'E!quation above Treat (x + + 1) as as one one unit unit and and call it A. Treat (x+l)2+5(x+1)‐24:O (x + 1) 2 + S(x + 1) - 24 = 0 2 A2+5A‐24=0 A + SA - 24 = 0 ( A++ B)(A 8 ) ( A- ‐3) 3 )=: 00 (A ((xx+ + 11+ + B)(x 8 ) ( x++l 1- ‐ 3) 3 )=‐ O0 ( x + 99)(x ) ( x-‐ 22)) == 0 (x x == ‐-99oorr 2 Because the question question stipula stipulates that x > 0, 0, the the answer answer is is I]. I. Because the tes that Be comfortable comfortable solving solving for expressions, expressions, rather than any variable 7. Be any one one variable EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 10: If 3x 3x + + 9}; 9, wha whatt is is the value of x + + By? 9y = 9, the value 3y ? Get in the the habit habit of looking looking for what what you you want want before before you solve for anything to get get you solve anything specific. specific. Is Is there there any any way way to the answer the answer withou withoutt solving solving for x and and y? Yes! Dividing Dividing both sides of of the the given given equation equation by gives x + Yes! both sides by 33 gives + By: 3y = I. [I]. EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 11: If ~ 5= = 3, is the the value value of iY ?? 3, what what is 2X y 1 A) E 1 B) 5 z C) ~ C) 3 ~3 D) 5 2 D) Here, Here, we we have have no no choice choice but but to so solve the express expression. but we lve for the ion . We’re We're given given x over over y but we want want y over over x. We We can can flip the given equation get the given equation to get I/ 1 =- !,.._ 3 X ix Then we can divide both both sides obtain Then we can divide side s by by 22 to to ob tain the % we’re we're looking looking for: for: 63 63 ix= 21x 1. 1 1 = 8“ Answer Answer (A) . = 2 3 : ‐3~ [EI]. CHAPTER 8 MANIPULATING MANIPULATING & SOLVING CHAPTER SOLVING EQUATIONS EQUATIONS 8. In In some some cases, cases, you may need need to plug answer choices guess and and check check you may plug in the answer choices or guess When you When you can’t ”mathematical” way way to get get the the answer, answer, you you have w o options: options: 1) plug plug in the answer can't find a a "mathematical" have ttwo the answer choices or 2) guess choices Both are are valid valid strategies strategies that that you shouldn't be afraid to use. Not only does aa guess and and check. check. Both you shouldn't be afraid use. Not only does "brute force” ”brute often tum turn out out to be be quite quite efficient, efficient, but, but, for some some questions, questions, it is the the only only way way to get get the force" approach approach often the answer . answer. EXAMPLE EXAMPLEIZ: 12: v22~x=x‐2 What the set set of all solutions solutions to the the equation What is the equation above? above? A) {- 3, 13} A){‐3’13} B){3,6} B){‐3/6} C) {13} C){13} D) {6} D){6} We could could solve solve for x by We by squaring squaring both both sides, sides, but but plugging plugging in the the values values from choices is actually actually from the answer answer choices much quicker much quicker and and easier. easier. We We just just have have to see see which which of the the values ( ‐ 3 , 6, or 13) satisfy the equation. When values (- 3, satisfy the equation. When x= the left hand side = -‐ 33,, the left hand side is y'25 m = z 5 and and the right hand hand side z -‐ 55,, so so -‐33 is not in the the right side is -‐33 ‐- 2 = the solution solution set. set. When x =z 6, hand side /16 == 4 and When 6, the the left left hand side is m and the the right right hand hand side the solution side is 6 -‐ 2 == 4, so so 6 is in the solution set. set. At this point, point, we can answer is~ this can tell the the answer is m based on the the available available choices, u t let’s 13 just be sure. sure. based on choices, b but let's test test x = = 13 just to be When x = When z 13, the the left hand \/§ = : 3 and and the right hand 13‐- 2 = 11, so so 13 13is solution hand side side is ,/9 the right hand side side is 13 is not in the the solution set. set. EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 13: 2 (x3 -‐- 4) = 4x xx2(x3 If xxisis an an integer, integer, what what is is one one possible possible solution solution to to the the equation equation above? H above? Assuming we can't can’t use use a a calculator, calculator, there there is no no easy easy way way to solve hand, and and there there are are no no Assuming solve the the given given equation equation by hand, answer like this this calls calls for guess and check. check. Typically, Typically, you you want want to to start start with with answer choices choices to work work from. from. A situation situation like guess and small numbers like : -‐ l1,0, , O,1, small numbers like xx = 1, and and 2. Il won’t process here here since since it’s obvious what what you you need do. It It turns won't work work through through the the guess guess and and check check process it's obvious need to to do. turns out out the the answer l. answer is is [II. 64 THE COLLEGE THE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA EXERCISE1: Isolate the variable in bold . Answers for this chapter start on page 287. l. A= nr 2 A=7rr2 22. If If t = gax, ~ax, find find ax in terms terms of oft.t. 2. C ==22nr 7rr 23. If 3x + 6y = 7z, find x + 2y in terms of z. fig... +5 = 3. A = ~bh 24. If x wh 4.. V V :=I lwh 25 25.. If a; 2b, find 2x + 10 in terms of b. = a, find 4t in terms of a. ”dz‐fl1 =a,find4tintermsofa. V=7rr2h p-h p ‐Iz 2 2. . If p + h p ‑ · find 11 6 Ifp+h =z -33, fmdh 2 26.. .V:7rr2h : a¥2 ++ b§2 7.. c82 = I . terms o f r. 1 + 2r = -1 , find t m 27 . If -27. 1- t 2 If lltztrzéfindtintermsofr. 8..V=s3 V = s3 S227trh+27tr2 9.. S = 2mh + 2m 2 4x411 4x a -2 C 2 b =d If 29. If C ‘ab1 _ £ d 30. 1f2x(x 3 ‐ 30.1f2-‘(x3 lO. b _ d ll. 2.1/ terms xY = z, then then find find x z. 28. If x” : 2, xz?’ in terms of 2. x3 - X2 4 ), what is pin terms = p(x p(x55 -‐ x14), what p in terms of x? x? 1 -1) = m(x + 11)-: , whatismin 1) = m(x2 )‐ ‐,w h a t i s m in x x2 b _ d xz‐xl 2 terms of xx?? terms y ==m 12. y mxx + +bb "IZ‐y2_y1 2 ”M_x3= whatisnintermsofx? 31. lf Jx+2 l - x3 = 2..., l,whatisnintermsofx? 5x2 -‐ 3 nx x 5 n If a(b2 + what is a in terms terms of of 32. lfa(b2 + 22)) + c = = S(c 5(c + 1)3, l)3,what isain b and cc?? band m=y‐2_y1 xz‐x1 33. If If k(x2 k(x 2 + 4) + + 4) + ky = z 2 = “22 + 15. v02 = 11 + 2as a 16. xandy? x and y? X bE =_y2l b_y2 34. If ax + 3a + x andb? and b? t=27r\/Z = 2nJ!j 17. t 7x2 + +33 h . k . 7x2 f , what w at 1s terms of o is k m in terms 22 8 /p+q 18. A z=mm, ✓p+q I f XX == :X+1,findXintermsonandZ. 19. If : ~, find X in terms of Y and z. Y+Z 20. If If x(y + + 2) = y, find find yin y in terms terms of x. ~a = 1a 126 ++1] , find terms of “E‑ find a in terms ofbband and c. b 2c 21. If 65 65 + 3 = b, what is x in term s of a CHAPTER 8 MANIPULATING & SOLVING EQUATIONS CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 287. used on the NOT should N A calculator should O T be used questions. following following questions. If;= ~m, what is the value of m? 1 A) 6 A) 6 Ifa+b=‐2,then(a+b)3= If a + b = - 2, then ( a + b)3 = 2 B _ B) 3 A)) 4 A ) 3 5 C) 3 B) O 0 C)) -‐ 4 C 6 D)) -‐ 8 D D) 6 ? 4) 2 ? + 4)2 4)2 = (n + 11 is (n ‐- 4)2 va lue of n what value For what For IIff 3x 3 x++ 11 = = -‐8,whatisthevalueof(x+2)3? 8, what is the va lu e of (x + 2) 3 ? A A)) -‐ 1 B) l1 C) 8 D) 125 ! i, ac?? of b -‐ ac the value what is the value ofb If %x ~ x ~g == 1, what a ‐k 4+ 2 ‐= ‐3 " ,w here kk i= ¢ ‐- z2,, what w ha t i is 's k ' etterms rms kinm where If k 2 C o off xX?? A A)) -‐ 3 A) 12‐2x 12 - 2x A) B) 0 xX C) 2 B) 12+2x 12 + 2x B) the from the D) It cannot determined from be determined cannot be given. information given. information xX xX C) C) 12+2x 12 + 2x D 1 2 x- ‐ 2 D)) 12x 6x -‐ 7? value of 6x the value If 3 , what 7? what is the = -‐ 223, 3x -‐ 8 _‐_ If 3x A A)) -‐ 5 va lue of the value what is the and x < 0, what If 36 and = 36 3) 2 = If (x ‐- 3)2 x2?? x2 B 1 B)) -‐ 221 C C)) -‐ 3300 D 7 D)) ‐- 337 66 THE COLLEGE PANDA r- f=p<(1+ii)n‐1) 1) J = p ( (1 + lIff y > 0 and > Oand J of yy?? value of the value (g)3 what isis the , what = 31/5, (~)3 2 an value J future value the future gives the above gives The f of an formula above The formula the payment p, monthly payment the monthly on the based on annuity based annuity p, the months n. the number and the rate i, and interest rate interest number of months terms of J, pin gives following the Which of the following gives p in terms Which f, i, n?? and n and fiJi A) (1 + i)" - 1 M u+nn‐1 ((11++ i)i ) " ‐ 11 B ‐ fi ‐ B) ) Ji 11 - If fJ ‐- i C) 2\/x+4 2Jx + 4 3 . value the value 1s the what is and x > 0, what = = 6 and off X? o x? + i)" - 1 C) (1(1+i)"‐1 D fi + 1 ++ i i) ) "11 D)) Ji +11 ‐- ( (1 . n1 n value of -L ?? the value 1s the what is 2, what = 2, If fl- = 2m 211 Zn 2m A) 1 8 2 20‐fi=§fi+1o 20 - ✓x = 3 ✓x + 10 1 B) 4 equation the equation value of xx is the what value If x > 0, for what true? above true? above 1 C) - 2 D) 1 x 2 + Sx - 24 =0 0, < 0, above and equation above the equation solution of the If k is a solution If and k < ? lkl of |k| ? what value the value what is the the value + y2 + 16, what Jx2 +y2 IIff x +y what is the value of + y = «X2 xxy? ? l/ 67 CHAPTER 8 MANIPULATING & SOLVING EQUATIONS - 1 xx ++2 2 2X X - A calculator is allowed on the following questions. 2 _4 T What is the the solution the equation equation above? What solution set set to the above? y+2kx=kx2+5 y + 2kx = kx 2 + 5 A) A) {{‐ 10,0} 10,O} In the the equation equation above, above, k is a constant. constant. If If y := 23 what is the the va lue of k? when x = 3, what when value k? B) 10, -‐ 44}} B) {{‐10, C) C) {0,8} {0,8} A)) -‐ 6 A D)) {D { 44,8} ,8} B) 3 C) 6 D) 9 (92 -‐2(%) 15==o, what isthe 2(i) -‐ 15 0,whatisthe IIff xx > > 0and Oand (if value value of xx?? xX = _ x+12 6 X + 12 .' ,what 1s the value of -_ If -_ 6 =-42 ,whatis the value of x ?7 . ~ 6 X 1 A) 3 3 B) ) 2 B C) 3 C) D) ) 6 D 2 x - 4x +3 = 4 x- 1 What above? What is is the the solution solution to to the the equation equation above? d = a (~)24 Doctors use rule, shown above, to Doctors use Cowling's Cowling's rule, shown above, to determine right dosage dosage d, in milligrams, determine the the right milligrams, of medication for aa child child based on the the adult adult dosage dosage medication based on a,in child’s a, in milligrams, milligrams, and and the the chi ld 's age age c, c, in years. years . Ben is a who is in need need of a Ben a patient patient who a certain certain medication. uses Cowling’s medication . If a a doctor doctor uses Cowling's rule rule to prescribe prescribe Ben Ben a a dosage dosage that that is half half the the adult adult dosage, Ben's age, dosage , what what is Ben's age, in years? years? 2 4 : 8x 8x44 xx2(x4 (x -‐ 9) = A) 7 0, for what what real real value value of x is the the equation equation If x > 0, above true? true? above B) 9 C C)) 11 D 3 D)) 113 68 THE PANDA THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA 111 3‐1 ,______ V --------'Y --------- Qu estio ns 23-24 refer to the following Questions following 1 - A) B) C) D) the figure figure above, In the above, ttwo w o objects objects are are connected connected by aa string which is threaded threaded through string which Using its through a pulley. pulley. Using weight , object object 2 moves moves object object 1 along weight, along a flat surface. surface. The acceleration acceleration a of the the two two objects objects can The can be be determined by the the following determined formula following formula A) A) B)) B ---'~--'----= C)) C D) where m1 where object 1 and and m, and and m2 are are the the masses masses of object object 2, object 2, respectively, respectively, in kilograms, the kilograms, g is the acceleration due due to Earth's acceleration Earth's gravity gravity measured measured in . The acceleration acceleration would The would be be quadrupled quadrupled (multipled by (multipled by a a factor factor of 4). A --------- 2y) ‐- 3z lf 3(x ‐- Zy) 32 := 0, 0, which which of the the following following expresses x in terms terms of y and and z ?? expresses a _ m2g ng -‐ w11 ”mg 1g a= m + m z Ill]] + /112 m The acceleration acceleration would The would stay stay the the same. same . The acceleration acceleration would The would be be halved. halved . acceleration would The acceleration would be be doubled. doubled . --------- 2 -‐ 2 ,, and and 14 11 is a constant constant ISa ec2 sec 2y+32 2y + 3z 3 2 y+ +z 2y y ++22z2 6y+3z 6y + 3z . . known known as as the the coefficnent coefficient of ((xx ++ 1 ) ( x- ‐ 2) 2 ) == 77xx -‐ 118 8 l )(x friction. friction. what is If x is the the solution solution to the the equation equation above, above, what the value the 18? value of 7x 7x -‐ 18 ? Which of the following expresses fl in terms of the other variables? A) /I = A) y: a(m] a(m1 + mg) m2) "11ng2 m1m2g2 _ a(m] mz) a( m1 + + m2) B)) /In=‐ 8 "128 lg m2g -‐ m m1g ,,- C) 14Z 111 ng2g -‐¢:7(l:t; +1112) a( m1 + 111 2) C) -J If the the masses masses of If were of both both object 1 and and object object 2 were doubled, how how would the acceleration doubled, would the wo acceleration of the the ttwo objects be be affected? objects affected? informa tion . information. 1 ~......._ ___ Zfi 2./x :=xx ‐- 33 m1g Which represents all the Which of the the following following represents the possible of xx that satisfy the possible values values of that satisfy the equation equation above? above? a(m1 + m2) - m2R D 1)-z 4 1 1+122; ‐g ‐0m'“ g D) /1 111, A) 1 and and 9 B) 11 and and 4 C) 4 D) 9 69 CHAPTER 8 MANIPULATING & SOLVING EQUATIONS ------------= 2 4 x - 6x + 9 V ~ --------- Questions 31-32 refer Questions refer to the the following following 9 information. information. V v z= pP(l-r) a‐ Based on on the the equation equation above, Based the above, which which of the following could following could be be the value of x -‐ 33 ?? the value W1 The value The V of a value V a car car depreciates depreciates over overt t years years according to the the formula according formula above, above, where where P is the the original price original price and and r is is the the annual annual rate rate of of depreciation. depreciation. 2 A); A) 3 3 B); 8) 2 7 C); C) 3 9 D); D) 2 Which of the following expresses r in terms of V,P, and t? _I~ V A) r __ mr = 1 l - “F B) r _ = 1+ I Vp B)r‐1+\/‐P ~ Jx - = 10 = f,/x ‐- ✓-fl i m V C) r = ~ C)r‐V‐P - 1 1 1n the equation equation above, the value In the above, what what is the value of _P Jx - 10? VTTE? _ l/‘r w D D) )r =r lz--l ‐pT /6 A) x/E 8) ) h 2V2 B @ c >3./2 a fi C) D) v'14 \/1‐4 xy2+ X - y2- If a car depreciates to a value equal to half its original price after 5 years, then which of the following is closest to the car's annual rate of depreciation? 1=0 A)) 0.13 A o m lf the th e equation equation above above is true If values of true for all all real real values what must must the the value value of x be? y, what be? B o w 8) ) 0.15 C) ) 0.16 C om D D)) o0.22 70 More More Equation Equation Solving Solving Strategies Strategies 1n this chapter, In this chapter, we'll we’ll touch t w o equation equation solving solving strategies strategies that are necessary necessary for certain certain types questions touch on two that are types of questions involving equations. involving equations. 1. Matching Matching coefficients 1. coefficients 2 + 8x EXAMPLE 1: If If (x + + a) a)22 = z xx2 what is the the value EXAMPLE Bx + b, what value of b b?? It’s to see anything meaningful meaningful right right away away on on both both sides sides of the equation. Solet's let’s expand expand the the left side side first It's hard hard to see anything of the equation. So and that takes takes us and see ifif that us anywhere. anywhere. , ( x+ + aa))2 = : (x (x+ ) ( . \ '+ + nn)) = : x 22+ 2ax+n2 (x +aa)(x + 2ax + a2 So now n o w we we have have So 7 7 ’? + 22ax n . t+ + a2“ = z xx‘2 ++8Bx x+ x. r2‘ + + bb both sides sides to be be equal each other, other, the the coefficients coefficients of each u s t be them up. up. For both equal to each each term term m must be equal. equal. Let’s Let's match match them x 3 + g x + fi z x2+§x+g SO, So, 2a = B a2 = b Solving the the equations, equations, a11z and b = : ~E. Solving = 4 and 71 71 CHAPTER 9 MORE MORE EQUATION CHAPTER EQUATIONSOLVING SOLVING STRATEGIES STRATEGIES Another way Another this "ma ”matching coefficients" way that that the th e SAT tests this tchin g coefficient s" strategy strategy is is to to phrase phrase the th e question question in in the the context con text of infinitely infinitely many solutions equation (we' (we’ll solutions for aa single equation ll talk talk aboutinfinitely about infinitely many many solutions solution s for for a a system of of equations next chapter). single equation the equations in the the next chapter). A single equation has infinitely infinitely many many solutions solutions only only when when both both sides sides of of the equation are equivalent. equivalent. For equation instance, For instance, 3x ++ 66 = : 3x 3x 3x + +66 has infinitely has infinitely many many solutions solutions because because no no matter matter what what the = 11 is the value value of of x x is, the the equation equation is is always always true true (x (x = is a solution a solution,, x = 2 is aa solution, z 3 is a solution, ... . . . ) Notice Notice that down to O = O, which, solution, x = a solution, that the equation eq uation boils boils down to O = 0, which, again, is always always true. true. again, Equa tion s like 3x Equations 3x + because what what’s them in in the the first place? + 6 = 3x + 6 are are a a bit bit weird weird because 's the point point of of dealing dealing with with them first place? course 3x + Of course equal to 3x + + 6! But keep keep in in mind mind that that these o t meant meant to be solved; + 6 is equal these equations equa tions are are nnot to be solved; they’re they're meant to demonstrate the concept meant demonstrate the concept of infinitely many solutions. solutions. Let’s infinitely many Let's take take a a look at at how how this this concept concept might might appear appear in an an SAT question. question. EXAMPLE 2: EXAMPLE2: a(x2 - 2b) = 4x2 - 12 a(x2-2b) =4x2‐12 In the equation equation above, above, a and and b are constants. copstants. If the equation equation has infinitely infinitely many what is the many solutions, solutions, what value b? value of b? Just like le 1, we expand the left left side the coefficients coefficients so Just like in Examp Example expand the side and and match match the so that sides are equivalent. that both both sides equivalen t. Only equiva lent does infinitely many Only when when both both sides sides are are equivalent does the the equation equation have have infinitely many solutions. solutions. a(x 2 -‐ 2b) = 4x 2 ‐- 12 a(x2 : 4x2 12 ax ax22 -‐ 2ab 2ab = : 4x 4x22 -‐ 12 Comparing the the coefficients, coefficients, a = 4 and 2ab = -‐12. 12. Now Comparing and -‐2ab Now we we can can solve solve for b. -‐2ab 2ab == ‐‐12 12 2 -‐2(4)b 2(4) b = -‐ 112 b = - 12 = (TI] b=“_‐1§:‑ -8 EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 3: kx+3(5-2x) kx+3(5 - 2x) ==15 15 In the equation above, above, I: k is a constant. constant. If the the equation true for for all all values values of x, what the equation equation is true what is the value of k ? the value ? This question is just testing you on the This question just another another way way of testing you on the infinitely infinitely many many solutions so lutions concept. concept. kkxx + + 3(5 3 ( 5- ‐ 2x 2 x) )= : 115 5 kkxx+ +1 155-‐ 66xx = =1155 the right right side out the the x terms Since the side is just a constant constant of 15, we need need to cancel cancel out both terms on the the left left side side in order order for both sides be equivalent. easy to see that kk = does the the job. If If it helps, sides to be equivalent. It's It’s easy see that z ~ E] does side helps, you you can can think think of the the right right side as having a Ox term . The end result is th at no matter what what the value value of x is, is, 15 equa ls 15. Yes, I know as having a 0x term. The end result that no matter 15 equals know these these equations are are weird, weird, but but that’s that's how yo u get get infinitely equations how you many solutions. infinitely many soluti ons. 72 72 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PA THE NDA PANDA Now the opposite opposite of infinitely N o w the infinitely many solutionss is is no an equation hass no solutions, are many solution no solutions. solutions. When When an equatio n ha no solution s, there ther e are no values that satisfy satisfy it. To illustrate, no values of x that illustrate, the eq equation uation 3 x++ 6 ==33xx ++110 0 3x has no solution s because has no solutions because there there is no value that can can ever make 3x equal to to 3x 3x + 10. The The equation equation itself no va lue of x that ever make 3x + 6 equal itself is aa contradiction. contradiction. This is even even more more obvious obvious if we we subtrac subtractt 3x from both sides:: we’re with 6 z 10, which both sides we're left with 6= which is is fundamentally false. fundamentally N o w in the equation + 6 = 3x + + 10, notice notice that that the x terms side have the same same coefficient coefficient of of 3, 3, but but Now equation 33: 3x + terms on each side have the the constants cons tant s of 6 and and 10 are are different. the equation to have no solutions, the coefficients of the x terms different. For an equation have solutions, coefficients the x must be must be the same same on both both sides, sides, but b u t the constants constants must must be be different. different. EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 4: 3cx Box -‐ 4(x + +1) = 2(x ‐- 1) 1) = 1) equation above The equation above has has no no solutions, solutions, and and c is a constant. constant. What is the value value of c ‘? ? Expanding each each side, Expanding side, 3cx 3 c x- ‐ 4(x 4 ( x++ l1)) = 2(x 2 ( x-‐ 1) l) 3cx 3 c x- ‐4x 4 x- - 44 = 22 2xx-‐ 2 = 6x ‐- 2 3cx -‐ 4 = The constants need to get the the coefficien coefficients to match. Very simply, 3c =: 66 and and cc = : [f]. I. constan ts are are different, different, so so we just need ts of of xx to match. Very simp ly, 3c 2. Clearing Clearing denominators denominators 1 1 When you solve solve an + 5xx = : 10, aa likely likely first first step step is to get r i d of of the the fractions, fractions, which are harder When you an equation equation like 5xx + is to get rid which are harder 2 3 to work work with. with. How How do do we we do By multiplying multiplying both both sides sides by times do that? that? By by 6. 6. But But where where did did that that 6 6 come come from? from? 2 2 tim es 3. So Sothis is what you're actually doing when you multiply both sides by 6: this what you're actually doing when you multiply both sides by 6: 1 1 1 1 x · (2 · 3) + x · (2 · 3) = 10 • (2 . 3) 2éx-(2-3)+%x-(2~3)=lO-(2-3) 3 £x-(Z-3)+%x~(2-Z)le~(2-3) 1.x · ('/.· 3) + jx · (2 •,3)= 10 • (2 • 3) 3 x+ +2 z 6600 3x 2xx = We i d of the fractions fractions by clearing clearing the the denominators. denominators. Here’s the takeaway: takeaway: we same thing We got got rrid Here's the we can can do do the the same thing even even when are va variables denominators.. when there there are riables in the denominators 73 73 CHAPTER 9 MORE CHAPTER MORE EQUATION SOLVING STRATEGIES STRATEGIES EQUATION SOLVING EXAMPLES: EXAMPLES: ‐3 + ‐ ‐5 - == 2 -+-2 xX xx+2 +2 H a solution solution to the If x is is a 0, what what is the value the equation equation above above and and ix > 0, is the value of of x ? ? same way way we In the the same wemultiplied before,, we we can multiply multiplied by by 2 ·~3 before can multipl y by by x(x x(x + 2) 2) here. here. 3 xg-x(x+2)+x+2-x(x+2)=2-x(x+2) ·x(x + 2) + x +5 2 · x(x + 2) = 2 . x(x + 2) 3 5 g-x(x+2)+xj(z-le/+47=2X(X+2) .j(x + 2) + .x-rt •x..(x.-+-2f= 2x(x + 2) 1 3(x+2)+5x=2x2+4x 3(x + 2) + Sx = 2x 2 + 4x 3x+6+5x=2x2+4x 3x + 6 + Sx = 2x 2 + 4x 0 = 2x 2 - 4x - 6 0:2x2‐4x‐6 0 = x 2 - 2x - 3 Ozxz‐Zx‐B 0 :=( x(x‐ -3 3)(x ) ( x ++1l ) =.. GJ. x= l but because x > 0, z B3 oorr x = -‐1butbecausex O,x x= Here 's one one final example example that that showcases showcases both both of the the strategies Here’s strategies in this thi s chapter. chapter. EXAMPLE 6: EXAMPLEG: 3x + 55 _ -‐6x2+11x+5 3x 6x2 + llx + 5 axx+ (x+l)(ax+2) xx+1 +1+ a +2 = _ (x+1)(ax+2) equation above, above, 1:75‐g x f:. - ~ and the value In the the equation and a is aa constant. constant. What What is the value of a ?7 a A) ‐6 -6 B) -‐22 C) 2 D) 6 Let's clear clear the the denominators denominators by multiplying multipl ying both Let's both sides sides by (x + + l1)(ax )(ax + + 2): 3x 55 3x -‐6x2+11x+5 6x2 + llx + 5 x+1~~~(x+1)(ax+2)+ax+2(x+1)(ax+2)‐mm(x+l)(ax+2) --·(x+ l )(ax + 2)+-- (x+ l )(ax + 2)= ( l )( ) •(x + l )(ax + 2) x +l ax + 2 x + ax + 2 3x 5 3x 5 -‐6x2+11x+5 6x + ll x + 5 m -M ( a x ax + +22)) ++ ~ + 1 =) ~ M _ m . ·~ x ~ •.(,x-l-'11( •-(x(+ x l ).{ax-+-2T 2 3x(ax 3 x ( a x++ 22)) + 5S(x ( x ++ 1 1)) := -‐6x2 6x 2 + 11 llx x++ 5 2 3ax2+6x+5x+5z 3ax + 6x + Sx + 5 = ‐6x2+11x+5 - 6x 2 + 1lx + 5 [ill]. 2 terms, Comparing the the coefficients coefficients of the xx2 Comparing terms, 3a = -‐ 66.. Therefore, Therefore, a = = ‐- 22.. Answer Answer (B) . 74 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 293. A calculator should NOT be used on the following questions. 1 2 18x2 - 8 3 2 3 b) the equation equation above, above, a and are constants. constants . In the and b are ? Which the value Which of the following following could could be be the value of ab ab? 6x2 + ~x) 3x) = : M3 bx2 + ex cx (x ~x ax + bx 30(x3 + 30 = 2(ax + b)(ax - 2 A) 6 A) B) 9 In the re constants. the equation equation above, above, a, b, and and ccaare constants. If the equation true for aJI the equation is is true all values values of x, what what is the va lue of a + b + cc?.7 thevalueofa C)) 112 C 2 D)) 3366 D xx - ~2(33c-+‐8)‐22 4x (3x + 8) = 2 ( 2 - ~x) 1 -(‐1) How many many solutions are there there to the equation How solutions are the equation above? above? The equation equation has no solutions. solutions. A) The has no 2 B) The The equation equation has infini tely many many so lution s. B) has infinitely solutions. C) The The equation equation has has exactly exactly 11solution. solution. C) D) The has exactly solutions. The equation equation has exactly 2 solutions. ln the equation above, a and and b bare ts. If In the equation above, are constan constants. If the equation has solutions, the equation ha s infinitely infinitely many many so lutions, what what is the value ? the va lue of ~g-? 3 A) 4 3 ( 3-‐ 22x) x ) = 1122 -‐ 77xx 3xx + aa(3 4 B) - If the In the the equation equation above, above, a is a constant. constant. If the equation solutions, what equation has has no no solutions, what is the the value value of aa?? 3 C) 6 D ) 112 2 D) A A)) -‐ 2 B) 2 C C)) 4 D) 5 ax - b = 3(2x + l ) In the the equation equation above, above, a and b are constants constants.. If ln and bare the equation has no solution, which the the equation has no solution, which of the following be the values of aa and and bb ?? following could could be the values If (2): 5) = = 12x 12x22 + bx bx -‐ 15 (2x + 3)(ax -‐ 5) 15 for all all values value values of x, what what is the the va lue of b ?? A ) aa = z 22 aand n dbb= = ~- 3 A) B =2a n dbb= = 33 B)) aa= and C a n db b=: -‐ 3 C)) aa=: 6 and A) 6 D ) aa == 6 a n dbb== 3 D) and B) 8 C 0 C)) 110 D 2 D)) 112 75 CHAPTER 9 MORE EQUATION SOLVING STRATEGIES If (x + 3y) 2 = x 2 + 9y2 + 42, what is the value of x2y2? IIff n < Oand + 9 = (2x (2x+n)2, what is 0 and 4x24» 4x 2 + m mxx+ + n)2, what is the value o thevalue + n ?? off m + A) - 15 8)) ‐-‐ 9 B C)) -‐ 3 C D)) 112 D 2 1 If ~ + ~ = ~, what is x in terms of p and y ? If‐+1= l,whatisxintermsofpandy? p x yy P 6 x = xx ‐-33x(2n x ( 2 n-‐ 11)) 6x X In the the equation constant. If equation above, above, n is a constant. If the the equation has equation solutions, what what is has infinitely infinitely many many solutions, the value value of n ?? the A) 19‐3! p- y A) 3) fly 8) _EL p+y A) -A) ‐523 8) -B) ‐531 C) C) (C) D PY j l p- y D) _EL W D) y- p 4 3 5 D) D) - 3 (x3+kx2‐3)(x‐2)=x4+7x3‐18x2‐3x+6 (x 3 + kx 2 - 3) (x - 2) = x 4 + 7x 3 - 18x 2 - 3x + 6 In the constant. If It the the the equation equation above, above, k is a constant. equation values of x, what is the equation is true true for all values what is the value of k? k? value in ab + a a . If = g + 5 for all values of b, what If -ab2b- a = b+ all values what is 1s the the A A)) -‐ 99 value value of a a?? B) 8) 5 C) 7 D D)) 9 1 If 1,what thevalue x? If~i -‐ ‐y4‐ - - = 1, what is the value o off x? X X - 4 76 THE THE COLLEGE PANDA COLLEGE PANDA 5 ax - b xx ++33 ' xx -- 22 ‘ (x ( x + 33)(x ) ( x-‐ 22)) 2 The equation equation above The above is true true for for all all x > 2, 2, where where a and b bare constants. What and are constants. What is the the value value of a + + b ?? A) 7 B) 13 B) 13 C)) 119 C 9 D)) 221 D 1 4 + 2 _ 35 35 - 1 --+--=-x -‐ 1l xX + 1 1 _x2‐1 x2 If x > the solution > 1, 1, what what is the the equation solution to the equation above? above? The equation (2x - b) (7x + b) = 14x 2 - ex - 16 is tme for all values of x, where band care constants. If b > 0, what is the value of c ? A) - 20 8) 20 C) 28 D) 36 + --3!!.__ =3 n‐l+n+1= n- 1 11+ 1 _ 3_ If n > 0, for what If what value value of of n 11is is the the equation equation above true? above true? 77 Systems of Equ Systems Equations ations A system refers to more equations equations that that deal deal with with the same set set of of variables. variables. system of equations equations refers to 22 or or more the same + yy =z ‐77 -‐5.t sx + 2}; = z -‐ 112 2 -‐ 33xx -‐ 2y There are w o main main ways ways of solving solving systems of 22 equations: equations: substitution There are ttwo systems of substitution and and elimination. elimination. Substitution Substitution Substitution is all Substitution all about isolating one variable, or y, y, in in the way possible possible. about isolating one var iabl e, either either xx or the fastest fastest way Taking the example we can can see see that it’s easiest easiest to to isolate in the equation because because it it has has no Taking the example above, above, we that it's isolate y y in the first first equation no coefficient. Adding 5x to both both sides, sides, we we get get coefficient. Adding Sx : Sx 5x -‐ 7 y= We can can then then substitute substitute they the y in second equation equation with with Sx 5x -‐ 7 We in the the second 7 and and solve solve from from there. there. 7 )=: -~12 -‐ 33xx -‐ 2(5x 2(5x -‐ 7) 12 10x + + 14 1 4z -‐ 33xx -‐ lOx = ‐- 1122 3x = : -‐ 226 6 -‐ 113x z 2 x= Substituting xx =z 22 back intoy : Sx 5x -‐ 7,y : 5(2) 5(2) -7 77 = z 3. 3. Substituting back into y= 7, y = The z 2,}/ 3, which can be be denoted denoted as as (2,3). (2, 3). The solution solution is x = 2,y z= 3, which can 78 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA Elimination Elimination Elimination is is about about getting getting the the same same coefficients coefficients for for one one variable t w o equations you can can add Elimination variable across across the the two equations so so that that you add or subtract the the equations, equations, thereby thereby eliminating that variable. variable. or subtract eliminating that Using the the same same example, example, we we can can multiply multiply the the first first equation equation by so that that the y’s have have the coefficient (we Using by 2 2 so the y's the same same coefficient (we don’t worry worry about about the the sign sign because because we we can can add add or subtract subtract the equations). don't equations). 0x + +Z = -‐ 114 4 -‐ 110x 2yy = -‐ 33xx -‐ 2y 2 y:= -‐ 112 2 eliminate y, we we add add the equations. To eliminate the equations. 2y = = ‐- 114 4 -‐10x 10x + 2y -‐ 33xx -‐ 2 2yy = : -‐ 112 2 2 -‐ 226 6 -‐13x 13x = Now, we we can can see see that that x = = 2. This This result result can can be be used used in either either of the original equations to solve solve for y. We’ll Now, original equations We'll pick pick the the first equation. equation. + 22y y= : -‐ 114 4 -‐10(2) 10(2) + 2 y=-: ‐ 114 4 -‐ 2200++ 2y 2 =6 2yy = 6 yy = = 33 And we got substitution: x = 2, y z = 3. And finally, we we get get the the same same solution solution as aswe got using using substitution: : 2,y 3. When solving solving systems systems of equations, equations, you you can can use use either either method, one of them will typically be faster. If If When method, but but one them will typically be you see a variable variable with w i t h no no coefficient, coefficient, like like in -‐ 55xx + + y = z -‐77 above, substitution is likely likely the the best you above, substitution best route. route . If you see matching matching coefficients coefficients or you you see that that it's it’s easy easy to get matching coefficients, likely the best you get matching coefficients, elimination elimination is likely the best route.. The The example example above above was was simple simple enough enough for both both methods methods to work work well (though substitution was slightly route well (though substitution was slightly personal preference. preference. faster). faster). In these these cases, cases, it comes comes down down to your your personal No solutions solutions In the solutions when when both the equation equation are the previous previous chapter, chapter, we we saw saw that that aa single single equation equation has has no no solutions both sides sides of the are the the same except except for the the constants. constants. same similar fashion, fashion, aa system system of equations equations has has no no solutions solutions when the ttwo w o equations equations are are the the same except for their their In similar when the same except constants. For For example, example, the the system system constants. 3 x+ + 2y 2 y=z 5 3x 3 x++ 2y 2 y== -‐ 4 3x has no solutions solutions since since the the different different constants constants (5 (5 vs. vs -‐ 44)) result result in equations contradict each each other. has no equations that that contradict other . There There isn’t an an x and and aa y that that can can possibly possibly satisfy satisfy both both equations equations at the same time.. Note Note that the system system same time that the isn't 3 x+ +2 = 55 3x 2yy = 6 x++4y 4 y=: -‐ 8 6x also has has no no solution. solution. Why? Because the second equation equation can divided by 2 to get the the contradictory contradictory equation also Why? Because the second can be be divided equation we had had before. before. we 79 79 CHAPTER EQUATIONS CHAPTER 10 10 SYSTEMS SYSTEMS OF OFEQUATIONS EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 1: ‐ 1 i j= = 15 15 --‐ax ax-12y 41: + By = = -‐22 4x+3y If the system system 0f of equations equations above above has has no no solution, solution, what what is the the value value of a ? 11 ? We must get get the the coefficients coefficients to match match so so that that we we can can compare compare the w o equations. do that, we multiply the We must the ttwo equations. To do that, we multiply the second second equation equation by by -‐ 44:: -‐ aaxx -‐ 12y 123; = z 15 -‐16x 16x -‐ 12y 1211 = = 8 See how the -12's match now? then we we get get o our contradicting equations equations how the ‐12’s match now? Now N o w let's let's compare. compare. If aa = ~ then u r two t w o contradicting with with no no solution. solution. One One constant constant is 15 15 while while the the other other is 8. 8. Infinite Infinite solutions solutions In previous chapter, chapter, we we learned infinitely many when both both sides In the the previous learned that that aa single single equation equation has has infinitely many solutions solutionswhen sides of the the equation equation are are the the same. same. Similarly, both equations equations are are essentially essentially the the same: Similarly, aa system system of equations equations has has infinitely infinitely many many solutions solutions when when both same: 3 x+ + 2y 2 y=z 5 3x 3 x+ + 2y 2 y= = 55 3x (1, name just a few. Note that the the system (1, 1), 1), (3, (3, -‐ 22), ) , (5, (5, -‐ 55)) are are all all solutions solutions to to the the system system above, above, to name just a Note that system 6 x++ 4y 4 y=: 110 0 6x 3 x++2y 2 y=: 5 3x 5 also divided by by 2 to to get get the They're also has has infinitely infinitely many many solutions. solutions. The The first equation equation can can be be divided the second second equation. equation. They’re still still essentially essentially the the same same equation. equation. EXAMPLE 2: EXAMPLE2: Bx -‐ 5y 531 = = 8 3x 8 mx -‐ ny = 32 mx 32 In the system equations above, If the the system system has many solutions, what In,the system of equations above, m and and n are are constants. constants. If has infinitely infinitely many solutions, what isthevalueofm+n is the value of m + n?? Both the same there to be many solutions. solutions. We multiply the the first equation equation by Both equations equations need need to be be the same for there be infinitely infinitely many We multiply 4 to get hand sides get the the right right hand sides to match match:: 12x -‐ 20y = 32 12x mx -‐ ny 71}; mx = = 32 32 N o w we can can clearly clearly see see that that m m = 12 12 and and n = : 20. Therefore Therefore,, m + + n= : -. Now I32 I. 80 THE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA THE COLLEGE Word Word problems problems You will most u n into into a question asks you into aa system system of most definitely definitely rrun question that that asks you to to translate translate a a situation situation into of equations. equations. Here's Here's a a classic example: example: EXAMPLE order lunch lunch from aa restaurant. restaurant. Each EXAMPLE 3: A group group of 30 students students order Each student student gets gets either either a a burger burger or or asalad. thepriceofasaladis$6. Ifthegroupspentatotalof$162,how a salad. Thepriceofaburgeris$5and The price of a burger is $5 and the price of a salad is $6. If the group spent a total of $162, how many many students students ordered ordered burgers? burgers? Let x be the number burgers and can then then be the number of students students who who ordered ordered burgers and yy be be the the number number who who ordered ordered salads. salads . We We can make w o equations: make ttwo equations: 0 x + y z=330 5 62 5xx +66yy ==1162 Make Make sure sure you you completely completely understand understand how how these these equations equations were were made. made. This This type type of of question question is is guaranteed guaranteed to be be on the the test. test. We'll use We’ll system. Multiply Multiply the the first and subtract: use elimination elimination to solve solve this system. first equation equation by by 6 6 and subtract: 6x+6y 6x + 6y == 180 5x+6y : 162 5x + 6y = x=‑ X=~ 18 students got 18students got burgers. burgers. More complex complex systems systems You might might encounter bit more encounter systems systems of equations equations that that are are a a bit more complicated complicated than than the the standard standard ones ones you’ve you've seen seen above. these systems, and some equation manipulation w i l l typically do the trick. above. For these systems, substitution substitution and some equation manipulation will typically do the trick . EXAMPLE4: EXAMPLE 4: y + 3x = 0 y+3x x2 + 2y 2y22 = = 76 x2 If If (x,y) (x,y) is a solution to the y? a solution the system system of of equations equations above above and and y y > 0, 0, what what is is the the value value of of y? ln In the the first equation, we isolate isolate y to get get y = : -‐ 33x. x . Plugging Plugging this equation, we this into into the the second second equation, equation, 2 2(‐3x)2 xx2+ + 2(3x) 2 : 76 76 = 2 + 2(9x2) xx2 2(9x 2 ) = 76 76 xx2+1sz2 + 18x2 = 76 76 2 2 19x2=76 19x = 76 x2=4 x2 = 4 xX = : i± 2 IIff xx = 2, : ‐3(2) thenyy = = ‐- 33((-‐ 22)) := 6. > 0,y : ~ IE].2, theny then y = - 3(2) = = ‐- 66.. IIff xx = -‐ 22,, then 6. Becausey Because y > 0, y = 81 81 OF EQUATIONS SYSTEMS OFEQUATIONS 10 SYSTEMS CHAPTER 10 CHAPTER EXAMPLES: EXAMPLE 5: xy + 23; = 2 xy+2y=2 ) - 6= 0 (-1 )2++(x+2) (_1 x+2 ‐ 6 _ 0 (x+2) x+2 1 2 1 IYI?? value for |y| a possible what is a above, what equation above, the equation (x, y) is a solution If (x, If solution to the possible value substitution clever substitution be a clever might be there might that there hint that This is a hint both equations. + 2)'s the (x -+Notice the Notice 2)'s lying around around in both equations. This equation, the Isolating one. this as complicated as problem a somewhere, especially for a problem ascomplicated as this one. Isolating y in the first equation, especially somewhere, xy + 2y = 22 y(x + 2) 2) = z 22 _ 2 y _ x+2 1 1 y__ with z. equation with second equation the second substitute - - in the can substitute this form? want this would I want Why would y_ = here, 1 From here, From z -‐. - . Why form? So 50 I can 2 x+2 x+ 2 2 this as this such as manipulations such simplifying manipulations any simplifying out for any an eye must questions, you tougher questions, these tougher do these you do As you As you m u s t keep keep an eye out one. one. Substituting, we get Substituting, we 1 ‘ + (- 11 ) - 6 = 0 )2 _1 ((m) x+2 x + 2 +(x+z)‘6=° ’) )2+ G)- = o (f owe‐6:0 6 + Y-.- 6 = 0 y2 g+g~6zfl 4 2 f+@‐M=O + 2y - 24 = 0 y2 ((yy+ + 66)(y ) ( y- ‐ 4) 4 )== 0 Finally,y z ‐6 |y| can either /‑6 or 4 /. be either can be and IYI 4, and or 4, - 6 or Finally, y = even then, And even Practice. And use? Practice. can use? you can "trick" you substitution or ”trick” clever substitution there's a clever know whether you know will you How H o w will whether there’s then, a without a done without be done designed to be are designed questions are that SAT questions keep in mind Just keep sure. Just know for sure. always know won't always you won’t you mind that try and back step a take waJI, a hitting or circles in running you're like feel you if So steps. of number crazy crazy number steps. 50 you like you’re running circles hitting a wall, take a step back and error. and error. trial and with trial comfortable with be comfortable you must score, you perfect score, a perfect else. To get a something something else. must be ? a possible positive what is apossible = 10, and yz = 5, and = 5, 8, xz = = 8, If xy = EXAMPLE6: If EXAMPLE 10, what positive value value of xyz ? result right sides multiply the right and multiply sides, and the left sides, Multiply the equations. Multiply three equations. Multiply all three trick . Multiply Here 's the trick. Here’s sides.. The The result is 2y2z2 = = 8 -· 5 ~10 - 10 xchyzz2 xzyzzz = 400 x 2y2z2 = both sides. Square o o t both sides. Square rroot = ± v'400 x2y2z2 /W = HEW) = i±220 0 xyz = answer Since the value, the Notice how get the answer able to get were able we were how we / 20 /. Notice answer is -. the answer positive value, a positive asks for a question asks the question z. x, y, or 2. values of x,y, without knowing individual values the individual knowing the without 82 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA Graphs Graphs Leaming our understanding understanding of systems Learning aa bit bit about about equations equations and and their their graphs graphs will will inform inform our systems of equations equations.. The solutions solutions to a system system of equations equations are the intersection intersection points points of the graphs equations. Therefore, The graphs of the the equations. Therefore , the number points . number of solutions solutions to a system system of equations equations is equal equal to the number number of intersection intersection points. Take, for example, example, the system system of equations equations at at the the beginning beginning of this chapter: chapter: -‐5x 5x + yy == -‐77 -‐ 33xx -‐ 2}; 2y = -‐ 112 2 We can put put both both equations equations into into y = mx mx + ‐+- b bform form (we (we won't won’t show show that that here) here) and get the the following We can and graph graph them them to get following lines lines.. y (23) The one intersection point, so so there The solution solution to the system, system, (2,3), is the the intersection intersection point. point. There There is only one intersection point, there is only only one solution one solution.. What What about about graphs graphs of systems systems that that have have infinite infinite solutions solutions or no solutions? solutions? Graphing the the following equations contradict contradict each Graphing following system, system, which which has has no no solution solution because because its equations each other, other, y - 22xx=: 1 l z ‐- 3 y -‐ 22xx = weget we get y}/ What points . They're parallel. Makes What do you you notice notice about about the the lines? lines? They have have no intersection intersection points. They’re parallel. Makes sense, sense, right? right? 83 CHAPTER EQUATIONS CHAPTER 10 10 SYSTEMS SYSTEMS OF OFEQUATIONS And with infinite infinite solutions? And for a system system with solutions? 2 y-‐ 4x 4 x= z 22 2y y -‐ 22xx = 1 y It's just one it’s two t w o lines, lines, but but because because they’re overlap and It's just one line! Well, actually actually it's they're the the same same line, line, they they overlap and intersect intersect in in an Hence, an an infinite infinite number an infinite infinite number number of places. places. Hence, number of solutions. solution s. EXAMPLE 7: In the the xy‐plane, the lines lines y = 3x 3x -‐ 5 2x+ at the the point point (h,k). (h,k). What What is is EXAMPLE 7: xy-plane, the 5 and and y = = ‐-2x +1100 intersect intersect at the value ofk? of k ? thevalue As mentioned mentioned earlier, solutions to aa sys system equations are the graphs those ear lier, the the solutions tem of equations are the the intersection intersection points points of the grap hs of those eq uations, and equations, and vice vice versa. versa. So So to find the point(s) point(s) where where two graphs intersect, solve solve the system system consisting graphs intersect, consisting of this problem, their equations. equations. 1n In this problem, that that system system is : 3x y= 3x -‐ 5 : ‐2x y =2x++ 10 10 Substituting the the first equation Substituting equation into we get into the the second, second, we get 3 x-‐ 55 = x ++110 0 3x =‐-22x 5 x = 1 5 Sx = 15 x =3 When x =z 3, y = 3(3) -‐ 5 = 4. So So the w o lines lines intersect intersect at (3,4) When the ttwo (3,4 ) and and k =z I. [i]. 84 PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE THE EXAMPLES: EXAMPLES: y=xz‐5x+6 y = x 2 - 5x +6 yy=x+1 =x+1 intersection an intersection represents an y) represents (x, y) pair (x, ordered pair the ordered If the xy-plane. If the xy-plane. graphed in the above is graphed equations above system of equations The system The ? value of y ? possible value one possible what is one equations, what the ttwo graphs of the point point of the the graphs w o equations, equation Substituting the first equation system. Substituting solve the system. let's solve so let’s points, so intersection points, the intersection are the the system solutions to the The solutions The system are second, we get into the second, into xz‐Sx+6:x+1 x2 - 5x + 6 = x + 1 2 - 6x + 5 = 0 xx2‐6x+5:0 ( x-‐ 11)(x-5)= )(x-5)=0 (x x ==110orr 55 (1, 2) intersect at (1,2) equations intersect the ttwo graphs of the So the graphs When x = When = 1, 1,yy = l1 + +11 = : 2. When When x = : 5, 5,yy =: 5 + +11 = = 6. So w o equations [I]. and E. possible values which means (5,6 ), which and (5,6), and means the possible values of y are[}] are and EXAMPLE9: EXAMPLE9: y2=x+3 y2 = x+3 y ==| lxl xl yy does solutions does many solutions How above. H shown above. xy-plane are shown the xy-plane graphs in the and their equations and system of ttwo A system w o equations their graphs o w many the system system have? have? A) One A)One B)Two B) Two Three C) Three D)Four D) Four Answer ~-(B) . solution s. Answer are ttwo there are so there places so intersect in ttwo graphs intersect Simple. w o places w o solutions. Simple. The graphs 85 85 CHAPTE R 10 CHAPTER SYSTEMS OFEQUATIONS 10 SYSTEMS OF EQUATIONS CHAPTEREXERCISE:Answers for this chapter star t on page 296. _ A calculator should O T be the should N NOT be used used on the following questions. following questions . 2 + 5Syy = 2xx+ =2244 x+4y= x + 4y = 15 15 3 x-‐ 5 = ‐- 1111 3x Syy = lX e= ‐1 -B 3yy If above,, If (x, (x, y) y ) satisfies satisfies the the system system of equations equations above what what is the the value value of x + + y ?? A)) 7 A What What is the the solution so lu tion (x, (x,yy)) to to the the system sys tem of equations above? equations above? B) 8 C) 9 D)) 110 D 0 A)) ((-‐ s5,2 A ,2) B)) ((-‐ z2,1 B , 1) C) (1,0) (1,0) C) D) ((4, - 1) 4,‐1) D) _ _ 3 x++yy = = ‐- 22xx + 8 3x 0 -‐ 33xx + 2 2yy = --110 y+ : 2200 + 22xx = 6 y ==112 2 6xx-‐ 5Sy If (x, y) system of equations equations 1f y) is a a solution sol u tion to the system above, w hat is the above, what value the va lue of xy ?? A)) ‐- 116 A 6 Wh at is the the solution What solution (x, system (x,yy)) to the the sys tem of equations above? equations above? B)) -‐ 8 B A ) ((-‐ 77,6 ,6) A) C)) -‐ 4 C B) (‐6, B) (- 6, 7) D)) 44 D C) C) (6,7) (6, 7) D) D) (7,6) (7,6 ) x+ y z=aax + bb y z= ‐-bbxx 3x -‐ 4y = = 21 2] 3x The w o lines xy-plane The equations equations of ttwo lines in the the xy-p lane are are shown above, where a and b are constants. If the the shown above, where and bare cons tants. If ttwo w o lines value lines intersect intersec t at at (2,8), (2, 8), what what is the the va lue of aa?7 = 4x 14 4x -‐ 331 3y = 14 IfIf (x, (x, y) is a a solution solution to the the system system of equations equations above, above , what w hat is the the value value of y -‐ x ? ? A A)) 2 A 8 A)) ‐- 118 B) 4 B B)) -‐ 5 C C)) 6 C) 5 D) 8 D) 8 86 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA yy=x2+1 = x +1 z xx -‐ 1l y= 2 2xx-‐ 4 4yy= 8 2 z8 xX + + 22yy = 4 How many many solutions are there the How solutions (x,y (x,y)) are there to the system of equations above? system equations above? y A) Zero Zero A) One B) One C)) Tw Twoo C More than D) More than ttwo wo 2x -‐ 5}; Sy = a bx + lOy 10y = ‐8 - 8 A system equations and their graphs system of ttwo w o equations and their graphs in the man y the xy-plane xy-plane are are shown shown above above.. How H o w many solutions solutions does does the the system system have? have? ln the the system system of equations equations above, above, a and and b bare In are constants . If the system has infinitely many constants. If the system has infinitely many solutions, what what is the the value solutions, value of a ?? A) Zero Zero A) One B) One C) Twoo C ) Tw A ) -‐ 4 A) 4 D) Three Three 1 B) 3 4 C) 4 D 6 D)) 116 = y +2 2 -‐ 5Sxx = 2 ( 2 x- ‐1)1 )=: 3 -‐ 33yy 2{2x What What is the the solution solution (x, y) to the the system system of equations above? equations above? a x + 2y 2 y=z 5 ax+ 5 3 x-‐ 66yy ==2200 3x A ) ({-‐ 22,8 ,8) A) the system above, a a is a a constant. constant. In the system of equations equations above, the system system has one solution, solution, which the If the has one which of the following can can NOT be the the value value of aa ?? following N O T be B ) ( -‐ 11,, 33)) B) C ) ((1, 1 ,-‐ 77)) C) (3, - 17) D) (3,‐17) A A)) -‐ 1 3 B) 3 B) - E 4 C) 1 D D) ) 3 87 CHAPTER 10 EQUATIONS CHAPTER 10 SYSTEMS SYSTEMS OF OFEQUATIONS 3x = 15 3x -‐ 63) 6y = 15 = -8 4x‐‐y=‐8 3 1 4x - - y ‐-2x 2x + 4 4yy= = -‐ 1100 x ++116 6 y ==44x How solutions (x,y) are there H o w many many solutions (x,y) are there to the the system of equations equations above? above? system What the solution the system What is is the solution (x,y) (x,y) to to the system of equations above? equations above? A) Zero Zero A) A) A ) ((-‐ 22,8) 8) 8))( (- 1,12 1,12)) C)) , (1,20) ( 120) D)) ( (3,28) 3 , 28) 8) One B) One C)) Tw Twoo C More than than ttwo D) More wo mxx-‐ 66yy = = 1100 m 2xx-‐ n nyy = 2 z5 0 .0.5x 5 x ++114 4 y := x -‐ yy ==‐ -118 8 _ X ln the system system of equations equations above, above, m m and and n are are In the the system system has constants. If constants. If the has infinitely infinitely many. many According above, According to the the system system of equations equations above, what is the value of y ? what the value ? . . m so lutions, what what is the value m ?? solutions, 15the value of g 11 1 A) 12 fi A) 1 B)§ 8) 3 4 C) C) 5 3 D D) ) 3 1l 1 3x y ‘ -a6y l l ‐= 44 6 x-‐ aayy = =8 6x :\/E+3 y= vx + 3 ln equations above, [n the the system system of equations above, aa is aa constant. constant. If the the system the value system ha hass no no solution, solution, what what is the value of aa?? A) m_ fu - y =3 (x, y) is the the solution solution to the the system system of equations equations IfIf (x, above, the value value of y ?? above, what what is the 1 3 8) B) 1 C) 3 D) 6 88 PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE allowed on the following calculator is allowed A calculator following questions. questions. B 0 @ medium, small, medium, sells jelly in small, supermarket sells A local local supermarket much as weigh Sixteen small and large jars. jars. Sixteen small jars jars weigh as much and large Four small large jar. Four jars and medium jars as w o medium and one one large small as ttwo weight same weight the same have the medium jar have one medium jars and one jars and the small jars many small How many large jar. How as jars have have the one large as one large jar? one large weight weight of one A) 7 A) 7 B) 8 depending on points depending A game on rewards points darts rewards game of darts and regions, A and are ttwo There are which w o regions, hit. There region is hit. which region hitting darts, hitting throws 3 darts, above . James shown above. B,as James throws B, as shown total of a total twice, for a region B twice, and region once and region A once region hits but hits darts, but throws 33 darts, 18points. also throws Oleg also points. Oleg 18 regions once for a total of a total region B once and region twice and A twice regions A rewarded for are rewarded many points How many points. How 21 points. 21 points are once? hitting region B once? hitting region B) 8 9 C) 9 D) 10 10 are points are 30 questions, 5 points with 30questions, test with math test a math On On a points correct answer rewarded answer and and 2 points each correct rewarded for each answer . If James incorrect answer. each incorrect are James deducted for each are deducted points, scored 59 and scored questions and answered 59 points, the questions answered all the systems of following systems the following which of the solving solving which answers, correct answers, number of correct his number equations gives his equations gives the answers, incorrect of x, and incorrect answers, y, on on the number his number and his rectangular tables, rectangular A restaurant types of tables, two types has two restaurant has circular ones people and and circular seat 4 people each seat can each that can ones that people If 144 people tables people. It seat 8 people. each seat can each that can tables that restaurant, the restaurant, at the tables at aU 30 tables are enough to fill all are enough restaurant the restaurant does the tables does how rectangular tables many rectangular how many have? have? math test? math test? A) B) B) 59 xX + +y y = = 59 5x -‐ 2y Zy = = 30 30 5x x X + = 30 + y!f = A) 12 A) 12 5x = 59 59 2y = 5x + 2}; c) C) B) 16 16 B) C) C) D) D) x+ +y = = 30 2x Sy = 59 2x ‐- 53, D D)) xX++yy ==3300 5 x-‐ 22yy =: 559 9 5x 89 20 20 24 24 CHAPTER 10 SYSTEMS OF EQUATIONS In the 7x + +7 the xy-plane, xy-plane, the the graph graph of y = = x2 x 2 ‐- 7x 7 intersects the the graph intersects graph of y = : 2x the points 2x -‐ 1 at the points and (p,q). (p, q). What (1, 1) 1) and What is is the the value value of p p?? y _ xx22- ‐2 2x x==yy-‐ 1 1 x = y ‐- 111 1 A system system of ttwo equations is graphed graphed in the the w o equations xy-plane above. Which of the following is the xy-plane above. Which the following is the solution (x,y) the system? system? solution (x, y) to the If (x, (x, y) is a a solution solution to the the system system of equations If equations above, what what is one one possible possible value above, value of y ?? (0, - 6) A) (0,‐6) A) 8)) (B ( ‐ 33,,-‐ 33)) C) ( - ~, - 3) c> (4-3) D) (-3, -;) r» (+2) x2 _ x2 - 1 y2=_ -11_2 yz 12 xX -‐ 2y : 00 2y = lf the the ordered Y1) and satisfy If ordered pairs pairs (x1, (x1,y1) and (x2, yi) y2) satisfy the system system of equations equations above, above, what what are are the the the values of y1 and values and 1/2 y2 ? ? 1 and 2 1 1 B ‐ ‐ ‐ a and n d -- ‐ ‐ B) --- A) -- 1 2 \/12 v'12 ) 12 v'12 1 1 -- and and E C) C) ‐i 4 4 D) D) -- 1 6 1 and and1 6 90 ll Inequalities Inequalities Just had equations equations and and systems systems of of equations, equations, we we can and systems systems of of inequalities inequalities.. Just aswe as we had can have have inequalities inequalities and The you m u s t reverse reverse the the sign sign every time you multiply or or divide sides by The only only difference difference is that that you must every time you either either multiply divide both both sides by aa negative negative number. number. For For example, example, 2x + + 33 < 99 2x reverse the point? Well, we we would subtract by by 33 to to get get 2x and then by Do we we have have to reverse the sign sign at at any any point? would subtract 2x < 6 6 and then divide divide by 2 to get get x < 3. Yes, we we did did aa subtraction subtraction but but at at no no point point d i d we we multiply multiply or or divide by aa negative negative number. did divide by number. Therefore, the the sign stays the the same. same. Therefore, sign stays Let’s take Let's take another another example: example: 3x ++ 55 < 4x + 4 3x The first step step is to combine combine like like terms. terms. We Wesubtract both sides by 4x to get x’s on the left left hand We then then The subtract both sides by 4x to get the the x's on the hand side. side . We subtract subtract both both sides sides by 5 to get get the constants on the the right right hand the constants hand side: side : 3 x-‐ 4 3x 4xx << 4 -7 5 ‐ x << ‐- ’ 1l -x Notice Notice that that the the sign hasn’t changed changed yet. yet. Now, N o w, to get get rid rid of the negative in x, we multiply sign hasn't the negative in front front of of the the x, we need need to to multiply both sides by -‐ 1. 1. Doing so means we need to reverse the sign. both sides Doing so means need reverse the sign. x> > ll This concept concept is the so many many silly silly mistakes mistakes that that it’s important to reiterate it. working with with negative This the cause cause of so it's important to reiterate it. Just Just working negative numbers does NOT N O T mean m e a n you you need change the sign. Some negative numbers does need to change the sign. Some students students see see that that they’re they're dividing dividing aa negative number reverse the sign. Don't reverse the the sign sign when when you you multiply or divide divide number and and impulsively impulsively reverse the sign. Don't do do that. that. Only Only reverse multiply or both sides negative number. number. both sides by a a negative 91 91 CHAPTER 11 CHAPTER 11 INEQUALITIES INEQUALITIES EXAMPLE1: Which of the following EXAMPLE ofthe following integers solution to the inequality -3x ‐ 3 x -‐ 7 $ 5 -‐ 77xx -‐ 27 27? integer:s is a a solution the inequality ? A ) -‐ 6 A) B) B )-‐ 3 0)4 D )4 C )1 C)J -‐ 33xx -‐ 7 §s- ‐ 77x x ‐- 227 7 41'5‐20 4x s - 20 x S g ‐- S X 5 did we we multiply or divide divide by by aa negative negative number number so need to to reverse the sign. sign. We At no no point point did multiply or so there there was was no no need reverse the We divided divided a 0 , but did soby positive a negative negative number, number, -‐ 220, but we we did so by aa positi ve number, number, 4. §J . The only answer The only satisfies x3:S answer (A) . answer choice choice that that satisfies S -‐55 is -‐ 66,, answer EXAMPLE 2: If --77 $ 2x + $ 15, EXAMPLE 5 -‐-2x + 33 5 15, which the following following must be true? true? which of the must be A A)) 55$5 xx $$ 6 B ) -‐ 66_$<x_ $ x 5-‐ 5 B) C)‐6§x$5 D )-5‐ 5$5 xx $5 6 D) So how how do do we we solve So solve these these "two-inequalities-in-one" ”two‐inequalities-in-one” problems? problems? Well, we into two t w o inequalities inequalities we can can split split them them up up into that we can solve that we can solve separately: separately: -‐77 5 s ‐2x - 2x ++ 3 3 -‐2x 2x ++ 33 5 s 15 15 Solving the first inequality, Solving inequality, -‐77 3 $ ‐2x - 2x ++ 3 3 § ‐- 22xx -‐ 1100 s 5 ~2 xx S Solving Solving the second second inequality, inequality , 5 -‐ 22xx ++33§S 115 2 -‐ 22xx $§ 112 x 2 ‐- 66 X ~ Putting the two t w o results get -‐66 S xx S 5 5. 5. Answer Answer ~-(C) . Putting the result s together, together, we we get EXAMPLE 3: To follow follow his diet plan, James James must must limit limit his most 40 40 grams. grams. EXAMPLE diet plan, his daily daily sugar sugar consumption consumption to to at at most One has 5 grams sugar and and one fruit salad contains 7 grams sugar. If If James James ate ate only cookies One cookie cookie has grams of sugar one fruit salad contains grams of sugar. only cookies and fruit salads, following inequalities inequalities represents represents the possible number number of cookies c fruit and fruit salads, which which of the the following the possible of cookies c and and fruit salads ss that he could eat in one within his his diet’s sugar limit? limit? salads that he could eat one day day and and remain remain within diet's sugar 5 7 A)§+§<40 A) -+-< 40 C S 5 7 B)§+§§40 B) - + - ::;40 C S C ) Sc S c++ 7s 7 s< 4400 C) D 5 c+ +7 $ 4400 D)) Sc 7ss ::; The total a m o u n t of sugar he gets from cookies is Sc. 5c. The The total 75. The total amount of sugar he gets cookies is total amount amount of of sugar sugar he he gets gets from from fruit fruit salads salads is is 7s. 50 his total sugar intake for any given day is 5c + 75, and since it can’t be m o r e than 40 grams, Sc+ 75 S 40. So his total sugar intake any given day is Sc + 7s, and since it can't be more than 40 grams, Sc + 7s s 40. Answer Answer ~(D) . 92 PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE THE 1? - x -‐ 1? mean for y > ~x does it mean What does inequality look like? What an inequality does an what does standpoint, what graphing standpoint, a graphing From a From y X ---- represents all the points inequality y > -‐xx -‐ 1 represents above, the inequality region above, shaded region As shown points above above the line shown by the shaded look at below, just what's below, and what’s line and a line above a what's above track of what’s keeping track time keeping hard time a hard have a y= just look at the you have If you - x ‐- 1. If = ‐x region. The "above" region. the ”above" always in the y-axis is always part of the y‐axis two parts into two cuts the y-axis into y-axis. The line cuts parts.. The top part with intersection with show the intersection doesn't show graph doesn’t "below" region. always in the ”below" part of the y-axis is always bottom part bottom region. If the graph and "above" and the ”above” determine the graph to determine the graph through the vertical line through draw your always just draw the y-axis, you your oown w n vertical you can always regions. "below" regions. “below” itself do line itself the line points on the - x -‐ 1, the points and NOT y z= ‐x Because y > -‐xx -‐ 1 and dashed . Because line is dashed. that the line note that Also note line on points and solid, be would line the then 1, x 2:: y were inequality . If the equation the inequality. satisfy the not n o t satisfy equation were 2 ‐x ‐ then line would be solid, and points on the line inequality . the inequality. satisfy the would satisfy would y - X example, inequalities? For example, system of inequalities? a system about a what about But what y ::; 5 ‐x - x ++ 44 1 -x- 3 yY > - ~2 x ‐ 3 inequalities. In this both inequalities. satisfy both that satisfy points that with the points region with goal is to find the region comes to graphing, When it comes When graphing, the goal 1 . . can we can points, we this set of pomts, locate this = ~x y= above 31 but above below y = -‐xx + that are below points that want the points we want case, we + 4 but Ex ‐- 3. 3. To locate 1x- -x 1 . overlap . the rregions where the and see where and above = ‐x ++ 4 and below y z regions below shade the regions shade above y = Ex -‐ 3 and e g i o n s overlap. y X system. solutions to the system. that are solutions points that the points contains all the the left contains The overlapping on the region on overlapping region 93 93 CHAPTER 11 CHAPTER 11 INEQUALITIES INEQUALITIES Now N o w if system as asifif it were system of equations equations instead system of of inequalities, we would would if we we solved solved the system were a a system instead of a a system inequalities, we the intersection intersection point point of the get the the ttwo w o lines, case, happens be the solution solution with with the highest value value lines, which, which, in this case, happens to be the highest of x. As an find this this solution. Substituting the the first "equation" ”equation” into second, we get an exercise, exercise, let’s let's find solution. Substituting into the the second, we get 11 ‐ x ‐- 3 -‐ xx+ + 4 == -2x 2 :x‐6 -‐ 2 2xx++88=x4 -‐ 33xx = ‐- 114 .Xr 14 ‐ z ;::::: 44.66 .66 = z‐__3 3 - 14 this from from the the first equation). Therefore, (4.66, is the the solution solution At x x = 4.66, y = -‐4.66 4.66 + + 4 = -‐0.66 0.66 (we (we get get this equation). Therefore, (4.66, -‐O.66) 0.66) is with the the highest with There are no solutions in which x is 5, 6, or larger. highest value value of x. There are no solutions which larger. While finding finding the While the intersection example may may have (hahal), these these points intersection point point in this this example have seemed seemed a bit bit pointless pointless (haha!), points can can be very be very important important in the context context of a given given situation, situation, such such as maximize profit as finding finding the the right right price price to maximize profit or figuring right amount materials for a construction construction project. figuring out out the the right amount of materials project. EXAMPLE EXAMPLE4: 4: y II I lII IV The following following system system of inequalities inequalities is graphed graphed in the xy-plane above. 2::‐- 33xx + 1 y2 y 22::22xx -‐ 3 Which quadrants quadrants contain Which solutions to the the system? contain solutions A) Quadrants Quadrants I and and JI II Quadrants I and and IV B) Quadrants C) Quadrants Quadrants III I I I and C) and IV D) Quadrants I, II, I I , and D) Quadrants I, and IV IV First, graph equations, preferably your graphing graphing calculator. shade the the First, graph the the equations, preferably with with your calculator. Then Then shade the regions regions and and find the overlapping region. overlapping region . .1/ X 1 As you see, the overlapping region, which contains contains all region.. It has points in As you can see, the overlapping region, which all the the solutions, solutions, is is the the top top region It has points in quadrants I, II, I I , and quadrants and IV. Answer Answer ~.(D) . 94 THE PANDA THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA Ecologists have have determined determined that the number number of EXAMPLE 5: Ecologists that the of frogs frogs y y must must be be greater greater than than or or equal equal to to tluee three times ecosystem to in a forest. In In addition, times the number number of snakes snakes x for a a healthy healthy ecosystem to be be maintained maintained in a particular particular forest. addition, the number of the number frogs and number of of frogs and the the number of snakes snakes must must sum sum to atwleast at.least 400. PART Which of the systems of of inequalities inequalities expresses conditions for for a healthy ecosystem? ecosystem? PART1: l! Which the following following systems expresses these these conditions a healthy y 2~33xx y ‐- xx>400 >400 A) A) y 2~ 33xx y‐x2400 y 2~33xx y+12400 B) B) C) C) D) D) y ~ 3x 3,53: y+x5400 PART2: IfIf the the forest forest currently currently has PART has a healthy healthy ecosystem, ecosystem, what what is the the minimum number of frogs in minimum possible possible number frogs in the forest? the forest? Part 1 Solution: Solution: The number number of frogs, y, must must be be at at least least three three times the number number of snakes, snakes, x. x. So, 50, y 2". 2 3x. 3x. The The number of frogs frogs and and the number number of snakes snakes must soyy + number must sum sum to at least least 400, so + x 2". 2 400. Answer Answer ~-(C) . these types types of questions, the strategy the minimum minimum in the the graph graph of the Part 2 Solution: Solution: In ln these questions, the strategy is to look for the the inequalities. The minimum minimum (or maximum) maximum) will typically occur occur at at the intersection intersection point. point. To show show you you what what l1 inequalities. will typically mean, let's put the second inequality inequality in y = mx + mean, let’s first put the second = mx + b form. 33xx y 22". 00 y 22:‐ -x x++4 400 Now graph the the inequalities inequalities using using aa calculator Now we we can graph calculator.. y The graph graph confirms confirms that that y, y, the the number number of at a minimum minimum at the intersection point. After all, the the The of frogs, frogs, is is at intersection point. After all, overlapping region (the top region) represents solutions and and the the intersection intersection point point is at the the bottom bottom overlapping region (the top region) represents all all possible possible solutions of this region, region, representing representing the solution solution with minimum number number of frogs. of with the minimum We can find find the the coordinates of that that intersection solving a a system system of equations We can coordinates of intersection point point by solving equations based based on on the ttwo wo lines. lines. y= = 3x 3x = -‐xx + 400 y= Substituting the the first equation equation into into the second, second, Substituting = -‐xx + + 400 3x = : 400 4x = x = 100 X So, 100 100 is is the the x-coordinate. x-coordinate. The Theyy‐coordinate -coordinate must beyy := 3x 3x = Given these these values, values, the So, must then then be = 3(100) 3(100) = : 300. Given the I intersection point point is is at at (100,300 and the minimum possible possible number number of frogs is j 300 when has a intersection (100,300)) and the minimum when the forest has health y ecosystem. healthy ecosystem. 95 95 CHAPTER 11 CHAPTER 11 INEQUALITIES INEQUALIT'IES page 299. chapter start this chapter EXERCISE:Answers CHAPTER EXERCISE: Answers for this start on page following allowed on the following calculator is allowed A calculator questions. questions. y the to the solution to a solution following is a the following Which of the Which 14? 4x ‐- 14? 4 > 43: - x -‐ 4 inequality ‐x inequality ------.F------+ A)) -‐ 1 A X B) 2 C) 5 D) 8 Which of the following systems of inequalities could be the one graphed in the xy-plane above? A) y > 3 A )y>3 1 IfIf 3Zx‐4> ~x - 10, which of the following ~ x - 4 > Ex‐10,whichofthefollowing yy > > xx must be true? mustbetrue? B) y < 3 B) y < 3 A 4 A)) x <<224 B 4 B)) x >>224 y <x y<x C < 33 y< C)) y yy > > xx < ‐-224 C 4 C) ) x < D 4 > ‐-224 D)) x > D D)) yy >> 3 y< <x marbles in a jar. Jerry are m marbles there are that there estimates that Jerry estimates number of marbles Harry, marbles actual number knows the actual who knows Harry , who number, n, is in the actual number, the actual that the notes that the jar, notes estin1ate . Jerry's estimate. within (inclusive) of Jerry's marbles (inclusive) within 10 marbles represents Which inequalities represents following inequalities the following Which of the the the and the estimate and Jerry's estimate between Jerry’s relationship between the relationship the actual number of marbles in the jar? marbles number actual II ‐- 110 A)) 11 A n+ + 10 1 0'.S 5 mm '.S 5n 0 B m-‐ l10 O '.S S nn S'.S nm H+ - I10 O B)) m C n '.S Sm l 1011 On m S'.S C)) 11 m < n < 10m D) D) ‐-10_n_10m 10 < 96 R E THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA ‑ manufacturer produces A manufacturer produces chairs chairs for a a retail retail store store according to the according formula, M = 12P + 100, where the formula, M = 12P + where M is the P is the number number of units units produced produced and and P is the the retail price price of each retail units each chair. chair. The number number of units sold by the the retail sold store is given retail store given by = ‐- 33PP + 970, where N= where N is the the number number of of units units sold and and P is the retail sold What retail price pri ce of each each chair. chair. What are all the the values values of P for which are which the the number number of of units produced produced is greater units to the greater than than or or equal equal to the number of units number sold? unit s sold? ‘ yy f'--------1--------.i A) P P2 ~ 58 58 A) B) P P5 B) :S 58 58 X The The graph graph in the the xy-plane xy-plane above above could could represent represent which which of of the the following following systems systems of of inequalities? inequalities? C) P 55 P 2::::: 55 A) 3 A) y y 2::::: 3 :s D) P g :S55 y 5 ‐3 -3 B) y yS :S 33 B) y ::::: y z ‐- s3 If n is an an integer integer and and 3(n ‐- 2) > ‐4(n If - 4(n -‐ 9), 9), what what is the the least least possible possible value value of n n? ? C) 2 3 C) x X::::: 3 r < _3 X '.S- 3 D) x S :S 3 xX 22 -‐33 work, Harry To get to work, Harry must must travel travel 8 miles miles by bus bus and 16 miles by train train everyday. and 16miles everyday . The The bus bus travels travels an average average speed speed of x miles at an miles per per hour hour and and the the train travels travels at train speed of y miles miles per at an an average average speed per hour . If lf Harry’s Harry's daily hour. daily commute commute never never takes takes more more than 1 hour, hour, which which of the than the following following inequalities inequalities represents the the possible represents possible average average speeds speeds of the the bus bus and train train during during the and the commute? commute? 8 16 A)§+ES1 A) -+-:S l X y x 16 y 8 x y B) -+-:S B>E+§g1 l X y yy - +-‐< C) _ <1 C)8+16‐1 8 16 xX D 8 x + 16y 1 6 y:S § 11 D)) Bx+ 97 CHAPTER CHAPTER 11 11 INEQUALITIES INEQUALITIES An out to An ice ice cream cream distributor distributor contracts contractsout to two two different companies different companies to to manufacture manufacture cartons cartons of produce 80 cartons ice cream ice cream.. Company Company A can can produce 80 cartons each hour each hour and and Company Company B can can produce produce 140 cartons The distributor distributor needs fulfill cartons each each hour. hour. The needs to to fulfill an order order of over an over 1,100 1,100 cartons cartons in 10 10 hours hours of contract contract time. time. It contracts contracts out out x hours hours to remaining hours hours to Company Company A and and the the remaining inequalitie s Company Company B. Which Which of the the following following inequalities gives possible values gives all all possible values of xx in the the context context of this problem? problem? this 80 3 y2§x+2 Y -> -2 x + 2 5 y g::;‐-Z2xx -‐ S Which of the the following following graphs the xy-plane xy-plane Which graphs in the could represent represent the the system system of inequalities inequalities above? above? could A) A) 140 ~> 1100 >1,100 X + A) ‘x‐ + 10 10‐- Xx A) I 1, 100 B) 140x + + 80(10 -‐ x) > >1,100 140(10 -‐ x) > 1,100 C) 80x 80x + +140(10 1,100 B) B) 100 D) 80x + + 140(x 140(x -‐ 10) 10) > 1, 1,100 5 xx + y >>1l5 +aa C) C) y< <55xx + +bb inequalities above, above, a and and bare In the the system system of inequalities b are constants . If lf (1, (1,20 constants. 20)} is a solution solution to the the system, system, which the following could be which of the following could be the the value value of of b -‐ aa ? D) D) A) A) 6 B) 8 C ) 110 0 C) D ) 112 2 D) 98 THE COLLEGE THE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA no more more than than 30 Tina works works no 30 hours hours at at a a nail nail salon salon each week. week. She She can can do do a each a manicure manicure in 20 20 minutes minutes and a a pedicure pedicure in 30 and manicure 30 minutes. minutes . Each Each manicure earns her $25 and and each pedicure earns earns her earns her each pedicure her $40, and must earn and she she must earn at least least $900 to cover cover her her expenses. If expenses. week, she she does does enough enough If during during one one week, manicures m and manicures and pedicures pedicures p to cover cover her her expenses, of expenses, which which of the the following following systems systems of inequalities describes inequalities describes her her working working hours hours and and her her earnings? earnings? A) A) B) If - 9 . < - 2x + 4 < - , what 1s one possible 2 value of x - 2 ? + 2p ::; 5 30 3m + 25m + 40]; 40p 2 900 Joyce create a that Joyce wants wants to create a rectangular rectangular garden garden that has least 300 square has an an area area of at least square meters meters and and a a perimeter perimeter of at at least least 70 70 meters. meters . If the the length length of the and the is yy the garden garden is x meters meters long long and the width width is meters long, long, which meters of the following systems systems of which of the following of inequalities inequalities represents represents Joyce’s Joyce's requirements? requirements? 2m + + 3p S ::; 30 25m 25m +40p + 40p 2 900 C) C) 20 3 p flm -+-< 30 3 +2E< _30 3 225m+40p2900 25m + 40p 2 900 A) xy 2 70 x+ + y 2 300 300 D) D) _"1 E> Ill p 900 3-+-2_900 -+-> 3 2- B y 221 150 50 B)) x xy xX + y.1/22770 0 25m + 40p ::; 30 25m+40p§30 C y 223 300 00 C) ) x xy xX + y.1/22770 0 If k 5 3k+ which of of the the following following must ::; x 5 ::; 3k + 12, which must be true? be true? I. lII. l. III. 111. D y 223 300 00 D) ) x xy xX + + y.1/223355 x ‐- 12 12 5 ::; 3k k 2 -‐ 66 20 x -‐ k 2 IfIf a a < b, which which of of the the following following must must be be true? true? A) lonly I only B ) Il aand n d lIIl only B) only C) llII and C) I I only and IlII only D) I,I, 11, D) II, and and 111 III a2 < < b2 b2 I. a2 1], 2a < < 2b II. 2a I111. I ] . -‐ b < < -‐ a A) 11 II only only B n d lIIl only B)) lIaand only C) II and [ I and III] only only D I , and ll D)) II,, III, and IIII 99 12 Problems WordProblems Word to translate you to They require experience. They a frustrating problems is word problems solving word For students, solving is a frustrating experience. require you translate the the many students, For many show will chapter this in exercises the and math. The even do the can even before you question you can the math. The examples examples and the exercises chapter will show you you how how question before words translating words instinct for an instinct develop an to handle handle the the full range range of word word problems problems that that are are tested. tested. You will will develop for translating guide. best guide. the best Experience is the and finally variables, and right variables, the right setting the into math, finally solving solving for the answer. answer. Experience math, setting into of these the largest What is the EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 1: The The sum sum of three three consecutive consecutive integers integers is 72. What largest of these three three .integers? integers? things the things of the one of be one variable be a variable problems is to let a important technique most important The The most technique in solving solving word word problems be x. one smallest the let we so integers, three this problem, know. In this know. problem, we don't don’t know know any any of the the three integers, so let the smallest one be x. problem. the long as as long as x, as m a t t e r which which number number we set as as we're we’re consistent consistent throughout throughout the problem. matter don't you don’t you doesn't It It doesn’t smallest, then the smallest, So if xis x is the then our o u r consecutive consecutive integers integers are are So if x, x + + 1,x 1,x + + 2 x,x can make Because they Because they sum sum to 72, we we can make an an equation: equation: + ((xx ++ 11)) + ((xx + 22)) =: 7722 xx + 3 x+ + 33 z=772 2 3x 3 x= : 669 9 3x xX :=223 3 largest) . (the largest). and I25 be 23, 24, and then be three consecutive smallest, our the smallest, Because x is the o u r three consecutive integers integers must must then 25 I(the Because xis three integers Our integer? O largest integer? be the largest But what what would would the the solution solution have have looked looked like like if we we had had let let x be u r three integers would've would’ve been been 2,.\‘ -~ 1,x 1, x x -‐ 2,x been would've been A n d our o u r equation equation would’ve And (x - 2) + (x - 1) + x = 72 3 x-‐ -3 = ‐ 772 2 3x 3 ‐ 775 5 3xr = rX ‐=225 5 answer! the answer! already at the we're already scenario, we’re this scenario, A n d because was set set to be the largest of the the three three integers integers in this the largest because x was And 100 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA The lesson lesson here which unknown variable. Often times, that that here is that that you you should should think think about about which unknown you you want want to to set set as as the the variable. Often times, unknown be what is asking asking for. for. Other Other times, to unknown will will be what the question question is times, itit will will bean be an unknown unknown you you specifically specifically choose choose to make solve. And And sometimes, sometimes, as 1, itit doesn’t make the problem problem easier easier to set up and and solve. as was was the the case case in in Example Example 1, doesn 't matter matter which with the same answer which unknown unknown you you pick; you’ll you'll end end up up with the same answer with with the the same same amount amount of of effort. effort. EXAMPLE 2: 2: One One number number is is 3 firms another number. number. U If they EXAMPLE times another they sum sum to to 44, 44, what what is is the the larger larger of of the the two two numbers? numbers? In want to be the the smaller smaller of 1n this problem, problem, we we want to set xx to to be of the the two two numbers. numbers. That That way, way, the the two two numbers numbers can can be be expressed as expressed as xx and and 3x 3x If we we would have to to work we let xx be be the larger larger of of the the two, two, we would have work with with xX x.r an andd ‑3 3 and fractions and fractions are are yucky. Setting u r equation, Setting up oour equation, xX + 3x 3x = : 44 44 4x 4x = = 44 44 xX = = 11 Becareful‐we’re asks for for the Be careful - we're not not done done yet! The The question question asks the larger larger of of the the two, two, sowe so we have have to to multiply multiply x x by by 3 3 to to get I-.33 I. EXAMPLE What is number such that the square of is equal its reciprocal? reciprocal? EXAMPLE 3: What is a a number such that the square of the the number number is equal to to 2.7% 2.7% of of its Let the number number we’re we're looking looking for bex. be x. 1 2 x2 = .027 x1 X = X - X Multiply Multiply both both sides sides by by x x to to isolate isolate it. it. xx33 = = .027 Cube both sides. Cube root root both sides . x:‑ = []] X 101 PROBLEMS WORD PROBLEMS CHAPTER 12 WORD CHAPTER 12 old How Henry. H as Henry. old as as old twice as be twice will be Albert will than Henry. older than years older Albert is 7 years EXAMPLE4:-Albert EXAMPLE4: Henry. In 55 years, years, Albert o w old now? is Albert now? the earlier, assigning as we mentioned but aswe age, but Henry's age, be Henry’s assigned x to be We could've assigned age nnow. Albert's age be Albert’s Let x be o w. Wecould’ve mentioned earlier, assigning the might you of some point, this at Now route. faster the faster route. Now at this point, some you might typically the asking for is typically question is the question what the be what is asking variable variable to be add only add would only work, it would certainly work, would certainly that would While that variable to Henry's another variable assigning another be thinking of assigning Henry’s age. age. While be thinking more. calls for more. clearly calls question clearly the question stick to one solution. Try to stick the solution. more one variable variable unless unless the steps to the more steps old . be x -‐ 7 years must Henry m then Henry old nnow, years old Albert is x years If Albert If o w, then u s t be years old. old . years old. will be and Henry be x + will be Five o w, Albert Albert will + 5 and Henry will be x ‐- 2 years from nnow, years from Five years + ( x -‐ 22)) + 55 ==22(x x + 5 = 22xx -‐ 4 x X we first 10 the first for the yards per UO yards yards per 60 yards can run Jake can EXAMPLE5: Jake EXAMPLE5: mm60 per minute. minute. Amy Amy can can rrun u n 120 per minute minute for 10minutes minutes how after how time, same the same time, after at the running at start running they start thereafter. If they yards per 20 yards down to 20 slows down then slows but but then per minute minute thereafter. ? assuming t > 10 distance, assuming same distance, the same Amy have and Amy Jake and will minutes t w many minutes many i l l both both Jake have run r u n the 10 ? with Amy's distance rrun equate Jake's want to equate work with. variable t to work us aavariable gives us already gives problem already The problem The with. We Wewant Jake’s distance u n with Amy’s.. Jake’s distance: 60t Jake's distance: 20(t -‐ 10) distance: 120(10) Amy's Amy’s distance: 120(10) + + 20(t 10) 60t::120(10)4-20(t‐»10) = 120(10 ) + 20(t - 10) 60t 60t = : 11,200 , 2 o o+ + 20t 2 0 ; - 200 M = 11,000 bm) 40tn = tf =z 25fi the same they will minutes, they After I2sIminutes, After will have have rrun u n the same distance. distance. the scientists. shared among be shared must be equipment must research equipment company, research a pharmaceutical EXAMPLE6: At a EXAMPLE pharmaceutical company, among the scientists. for freezer for one and one freezer scientists, and 3 scientists, every 3 for every centrifuge for one centrifuge scientists, one every 4 scientists, microscope for every one micromope There is one scientists many scientists company, how equipment at this company, 52 pieces there is a total scientists. If there every 2 every 2scientists. total of 52 pieces of research research equipment how many are there? i, . X . i, , x is 5, and centrifuges IS number of centrifuges the number is 1, the U1enumber Then the number of scientists. the number Let x be be the scientists. Then number of microscopes microscopes IS and . x the IS ~ 5.. freezers is number of freezers the number X X x X + - = _ 552 2 -Z4 ++ -3 + 2 fractions, the fractions, both sides Multiply both Multiply sides by 12 12 to get get rrid i d of the 3 x+ 4 2 ~• 12 l2 4xx + 66xx z=552 3x 1 3 x=: 6624 24 13x x:‑ 102 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA EXAMPLE A group cost of renting a cabin cabin equally. equally. If each pays $130, EXAMPLE 7: 7:A group of friends friends wants wants to to split split the the cost renting a each friend friend pays they they will have $50 too too little. does it cost cost they will will have have $10 too too much. much. If each each friend friend pays pays $U0, $120, they will have little. How How much much does to rent rent the the -cabin? cabin? have two t w o unknowns problem.. We'll We’ll let let the number group be We have unknowns in this problem number of people people in the group be n and and the the cost of renting aa cabin cabin be be c. c. From From the the information information given, given, we we can come come up w o equations (make sure renting up with with ttwo equations (make sure you you see the the reasoning reasoning behind behind them): 13011 -‐ 10 = z cC 13011 + 50 = cC 120n + equation, 13011 130n represents represents the the total total amount amount the group 10 dollars dollars too much, In the first equation, group pays, pays, but but because because that’s that's 10 much, need to subtract subtract 10 10to arrive at the the cost cost of rent, rent, c. In the second second equation, total amount equation, 120n represents represents the total amount we need to arrive the group group pays, pays, but but this time time it's it’s 50 50 dollars dollars too little, little, so 50 to arrive at c. 6. Substituting from the so we we need need to add add 50 arrive at Substituting c from the into the second, the first equation equation into second, we we get get : 130n 130" -‐ 10 120n + 50 = -‐ 1lOn 0 n=: ‐ 660 0 = 6 n= So So there there are are 6 friends friends in the group. group. And And c:= C 13011‐10= 1 3 0· 6- 6- ‐ 10 1 0== 770 13011 - 10 = 130 renting the cabin cabin is is I-.770 1The cost of renting EXAMPLE 8: 8: Of the the 200 jellybeans jellybeans in in aa jar, 70% are are green rest are red. How How many many green jellybeans EXAMPLE green and and the the rest are red. green jellybeans must be be removed removed so so that 60% of of the the remaining remaining jellybeans jellybeans are green? must green? The answer answer is NOT N O T 20. You can't can’t just just take take 10% of the the green jellybeans away do that, green jellybeans away because because as as you you do that, the total total :a number jellybeans also also goes down. down. We We first find that that there jellybeans.. We x 200 = 140 green green jellybeans We need need to number of jellybeans there are are % x remove x of them so that that 60% of what's what’s left is green: green: remove them so jellybeans left _ 60“/¼ green jellybeans green ------= 6O°oo totaljellybeans total jellybeans left ‘ 140‐x_ 66 140 - X 200 - 110 2 0 0- ‐Xx _ 0 Cross multiplying, multiplying, : 6(200 -‐ x) 10(140 -‐ x) = 1,400 10x := l,1,200 1, 400 -‐ lOx 200 -‐ 6x 200 = = 4x = x _‐_ 50 X 50 green jellybeans jellybeans need need to to be be removed removed.. This This type type of with percentages is very very common IsoIgreen of word word problem problem with percentages is common in in chemistry and and is typically known as asa ”mixture" problem problem.. chemistry typically known a "mixture" 103 CHAPTER 12 WORD CHAPTER WORD PROBLEMS PROBLEMS Our next next example example is the Our area / perimeter word word problem. problem. the classic area/perimeter EXAMPLE 9: A rectangle EXAMPLE rectangle has that is is 3 rectangle is is has a a width width that 3 inches inches shorter shorter than than its its length. length. It If the the area area of of the the rectangle square inches, inches, what 108 square what is the the perimeter, perimeter, in inches, inches, of of the the rectangle? rectangle? Em I If we we let the If be I, then then the the width w is/ is I -‐ 3. Since Since aa rectangle’s the length the length length be/, width w rectangle 's area area is is equal equal to to the length times times the the width, width, we can up the we can set up the following following equation: equation : : 108 llw w= /(/ - 3) = 108 1(1‐ 12‐- 3131 ‐ 108 z= o 12 0 ( 1-‐ 112) 2 )(/( 1 ):o (/ + +9)9 = 0 Since the width is then /I -‐ 3 3 =z 12 12‐- 3 Finally, the the length length of a a rectangle rectangle has has to be be positive, positive, /I =: 12. The width is then 3 =z 9. 9. Finally, the perimeter 21+ 210 = : 2(12) + + 2(9) =: I-.42 1. perimeter is 2/ + 2w Never forget forget that Never that the perimeter perimeter of a many a rectangle rectangle is twice twice the the length length plus plus twice twice the the width. width . I’ve I've seen seen too many students students just just add add the the length length and and the width width without without thinking thinking it through. through . EXAMPLE 10: When EXAMPLE When Alex Alex and Barry work work separately separately from from each paint a and Barry each other, other, Alex Alex can can paint a house house in in 6 6 days, days, and Barry can paint a house Barry can house in 12 12days. Assuming Assuming that they each work at a constant rate, how many days that they each work at a constant days will w i l l it it take Alex and Barry to paint a house if if they they work together? take.Alex and Barry together? This is the the typical typical “work‐rate” "work-rate" problem This problem that involves two t w o individuals different rates. The general general that involves individuals who who work work at at different rates . The approach approach is to use use the r t , where where W W is is the the amount of work done, r is the overall rate at which the formula formula W = rt, amount of work done, r is the overall rate at which work being done, work is being done, and t is the time spent. The key thing to note is that the overall rate, r, can be found by and the time spent. The key thing note that overall rate, r, can be found by summing up summing up the the individual individual rates. rates. 11 Since Alex can days,, his his rate rate is 5 of a house 12 can paint paint a house house in 6 days house per per day. day. Since Barry Barry can can paint paint a a house house in in 12 1 days, his his rate per day. days, rate is ‐ of a a house house per 112 2 6 . . 1 _ 1 _ 2 1 _ 3 _ 1 Working + 12 =‐ 12 + 12 =‐ 12 = 4 of N o w we we can can use ‐ rt, rt, Working together, together, they can can pamt pamt 6 + of a a house house per per day. day. Now use W W= 6 12 12 12 12 4 where W = = 1 (i.e. (Le. 1 house) house) and z ~, 31, to find find the the time time it will will take paint one house.. where and r = take them them to to paint one house W= z rrtt 1 1l z= ‐- t 4 4 =: 1t Therefore, paint one one house. This answer makes sense sense because Therefore, it will take take Alex and and Barry Barry [±]days days to to paint house. Thjs answer makes because ifif Alex Alex can days by himself, then it should take less than 6 days if Barry is working can finish finish a a house house in 6 days himself, then it should take less than 6 days if Barry is workjng alongside alongside him. him. 104 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 301. A calculator should N O T be should NOT be used used on the following following questions. questions. A rectangular rectangular monitor monitor has has a a length length of x x inches inches and and a a width width that that is one‐third one-third of its length. length. If the the perimeter 48 inches, what is the the perimeter of the the monitor monitor is 48 inches, what va lue of x? value x? Which Which of the the following following represents represents the square square of the sum sum of x and the and y, y, decreased decreased by the the product product of and y y?? x and A) x2 A) x2+ +y2 y 2 -‐ xy xy 2y 2 -‐ xy B) xx2y2 Jr}; C) (x+y)2‐ (x + y) 2 - ((xH+yy)) C) D) (x + y)2 -‐ xy D) Susie salmon, weighing x Susie buys buys 2 pieces pieces of sa lmon, each each weighing pounds, pounds, and and 11 piece piece of trout, trout , weighing weighing y pounds, salmon pounds, where where x and and y are are integers. integers . The salmon cost $3.50 per per per pound pound and and the the trout trout cost cost $5 per pound. the fish was was $77, which pound . If the the total total cost cost of the which of the following be the value y? following could cou ld be the va lue of y? On a a 100 cm cm ruler, On are drawn drawn at at 10, X, and ruler, lines lines are and The distance lines at X and and 98 cm. The distance between between the the lines times the the distance distance between 98 cm is three three times between the lines is the value of X ?? lines at X and and 10 cm. What What the value A)) 4 A B) 5 C) 6 D) 7 If 5 is added to the square root of x, the result is 9. What is the va lue of x + 2? A 20% nickel alloy was was made nickel alloy made by by combining combining 22 grams nickel alloy with an grams of a a 35% nickel with 6 grams grams of an x% x % nickel nickel alloy. What What is the value value of xx ? ? A grocery store sells tomatoes in boxes of 4 or 10. If Melanie buys x boxes of 4 and y boxes of 10, where x 2: 1 and y 2: 1, for a total of 60 tomatoes , what is one possible value of x ? 105 PROBLEMS WORD PROBLEMS CHAPTER CHAPTER 12 WORD following allowed on the following A calculator is allowed questions. questions. At a Hong Kong learning center, i of the 1 tak e studen ts take th e students debate, 2 of the tak e debate, studen ts take students 6 ? If 8 + 5x is ’ twice ' x -‐ 5,, what h is ' the value off x ? 8 + 5x 15tw1ce x 5 w at 15the value 0 x - 6 A) ‐6 A .. , The science . The take scrence. students take the students ~1 of the and § writing, and writlng, is what is math, what take math, 33 studen ts take math. If 33students take math. rest take rest learning the at students of number total number students at the learning the total the 7 center? center. ) -3 B) ‘3 B) C) _§7 3 C) A 0 A)) 660 B) 66 B) 66 D) D) -‐22 C)) 7722 C _ D ) 7 D) 78 8 the what is the of n, what the same is the of 68 is 75% of IfIf 75°/o same as 85% of vvalue a l u eofdn? "? _ has 44 Jason has cards, and 20 footba ll cards, has 20football Ian has Ian and Jason 44 that such that trade such agree to trade They agree cards . They baseball cards. baseball card every card cards for every 2 baseball cards Ian 2baseball gives Ian Jason gives Jason trades suc h trades many such how many After how Jason. After Ian gives to Jason. Ian gives number of equa l number an equal have an each have and Jason Ian and will Jason each will Ian cards? cards? | | _ A ) 9 A) 9 B 0 B)) 110 C) 11 C) 11 games . their first 15 The o n exactly 15 games. exactly 4 of their won Pirates w The Pirates won and won games and remaining games They played N remaining then played They then the all the half of all exactly half won all o n exactly they w them. If they all of them. value of N ?? the value what is the played, what games they played, games they D) 12 D) 12 the number x, the the number times the from 3 times IfIf 3 is subtracted subtracted from added to when 8 is added result when the result What is the result result is 21. What half of x ? A) 1 | | _ B B) 5 ) 5 C) 8 12 D) 12 D) the same with the Alice start with same number number of Julie start and Julie Alice and pens her of 16 gives pens. After Alice gives 16of her pens to Julie, Julie, Alice After pens. Alice as pens Julie w o times many pens asAlice as many times as has ttwo then has Julie then the have at the Alice have did Alice pens did does. o w many many pens How does. H start? start? 106 PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE i i books on on aa the books and g of the Mark w n %and own Kevin o and Kevin Mark and than less than dollars less a tie is k dollars price of a the price store, the a store, At a costs shirt a If shirt. a of price the price a shirt. If a shirt costs $40 times the three times three value of k? the value what is the costs $30, what tie costs and a tie and k? the rest of the owns the Lori owns respectively . Lori shelf, respectively. shelf, the rest than books than Mark, more books Kevin oowns If Kevin books . If books. w n s 9 more Mark, own? Lori own? does Lori books does many books how many how has rectangle has a rectangle shape of a the shape board in the wooden board A wooden the area of the the area If the width. If its width. twice its that is twice a length that a length length, in feet, what square feet, board is 128 square board what is the the length, board? the board? feet, of the feet, grand its grand celebrate its coupons to celebrate out coupons gave out A bakery bakery gave either $1, $3, opening. Each coupon coupon was was worth worth either opening. Each out given out were given $1 coupons were many $1coupons as many Twice as or $5. Twice coupons $3 many as times 3 and 3 times as many $3 coupons coupons, and as$3 as $3 coupons, value of The total coupons. The as $5 coupons. given oout were u t as$5 total value were given out was coupons given all given out was $360. How H o w many many the coupons all the out? given out? were given coupons were $3 coupons $3 A)) 440 A 0 B) 45 45 C) 48 C) 48 D 4 D)) 554 has seas hells . Bob has collect seashells. all collect Carl all and Carl Alex, Alex, Bob, and three Alex ha as Carl. many seashells half seashells as Carl. Alex hass three as many half as If Alex and as Bob. If times and Bob seashells as many seashells as many times as seashells many seashells how many seashells, how have 60 seashells, together together have have? Carl have? does does Carl A water tank is connected to two pipes, Pipe A and Pipe B. It takes 4 hours to fill the tank when only Pipe A is in use, and it takes 6 hours to fill the tank when only Pipe Bis in use . If it takes 111 minutes to fill the tank when both Pipe A and Pipe Bare in use, what is the value of m ? A 5 A)) 115 B) 20 20 C 0 C)) 330 D D)) 4400 107 CHAPTER 12 WORD CHAPTER WORD PROBLEMS PROBLEMS Yoona runs steady rate yard per second.. runs at a steady rate of 1 yard per second Jessica runs Jessica gives runs 4 times times as as fast. IfIf Jessica gives Yoona head start start of 30 yards a head yards in a race, race, how how many many yards must must Jessica Jessica rrun yards u n to catch catch up to Yoona? Terry is hired hired to pave pave a a parking parking lot lot and and finishes finishes 1 3 of the hired to the parking parking lot lot before before Andy Andy is is hired to work work 3 alongside him. alongside him . They They each each work work at at a a constant constant rate , but but Terry works rate, works twice as as fast as as Andy Andy does. does. x 1 + i)1 ) 2 can be used to The equation equation 9 9 (i x = 2 can ( + 3 be used to 2 the total total number number of days find the days x it would would have have taken Terry to pave pave the taken lot by by the entire entire parking parking lot himself. Which Which of the the following himself. the best following is the best interpretation of the the number number 9 in the interpretation the equation? equation? A) The The number number of days days it would would have have taken taken Terry and and Andy Andy to pave pave the parking the entire entire parking they had had worked worked together together from from the lot ifif they the start. start. number of days days it will will take take Terry and B) The number and Andy to pave pave the the remainder remainder of the the parking Andy parking working together. together . lot working The number number of days days it would would take take Andy Andy to C) The pave the the remainder remainder of the the parking parking lot pave lot if if he he were working working alone. alone . were The number number of days days it would would take take Terry D) The Terry to pave the the remainder remainder of the the parking parking lot he pave lot ifif he were working working alone. were alone. Nicky owns a house that has a patio in the shape of a square . She decides to renovate the patio by increasing its length by 4 feet and decreasing its width by 5 feet. If the area of the renovated patio is 90 square feet, what was the original area of the patio, in square feet? 108 13 Minim Minimum Maximum um & Maxim um Word Word Proble Problems ms Minimum Minimum and and maximum word problems problems require require aa bit bit of maximum word of logic and and an an understanding understanding of of rates rates and and inequalities inequalities (chap (chapters and 11). One One of the most most common common issues students have is that they’re unsure of whether round ters 4 and issues studen ts have is that they 're unsure of whether to to round up or down. down. The examples examples in this chapter will address this issue and illustrate the strategies you’ll need to this chapter address issue and illustrate strategies you' ll need to solve solve these types types of problems. problems. EXAMPLE 1: Corinne graphic designer designer who who earns logo she designs.. What What is is the the EXAMPLE Corinne is aa graphic earns $275 for for every every logo she designs minimum number number of logos logos she would would have have to design design to earn least $4,000 minimum earn at at least $4,000 ? To earn Corinne would would have have to design design at least least 4, To T earn at least least $4,000, $4,000, Corinne \~ 0 _ x 14.5 14.3 logos. logos. That's That’s 14 14 logos logos and and half half aa :::::: logo. But becau because it’s implied implied that that a fraction of a logo logo cannot up to to se it's cannot be be designed designed and and sold, sold, we have have to round round up ii logos. OI) logos. When When a whole whole number is implied, implied, the the minimum m i n i m u m generally that we we round up. number answer answer is generally requires requires that round up. EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 2: A pallet pallet truck truck can can move move up up to 3 tons single trip. be used used to to move move tons in a single trip. If If the the truck truck is is to to be 320-pound 320-pound pallets, pallets, what what is the the maximum maximum number number of whole pallets the truck can can move move in in aa single single trip? trip? whole pallets the truck (1 ton pounds) ton = 2,000 pounds) A) 6 A)6 B) 18 C) 19 D) 106 6, 000 6,000 : 18.75 pallets. pallets. However, However, = 320 the question question specifically specifically states states whole whole pallets, pallets, so sowe have to E pallets pallets.. If rounded up, up, the we have to round round down down to to DI] If we we rounded the weight would weight would be be above above what what the truck truck can handle. handle. Since 3 tons is equivalent equivalent to 3 x 2, 000 =: 6,000 pounds, pounds, the truck can move move 2,000 When number answer generally requires When a whole w h o l e number a n s w e r is implied, implied, the maximum maximum generally requires that we we round round down. down. 109 MAXIMUM WORD MINIMUM & MAXIMUM CHAPTER 13 MINIMUM CHAPTER WORD PROBLEMS PROBLEMS what yogurt, what greek yogurt, of greek 6 cups and 6 flour and of flour cups of 8 cups flatbread can tray of flatbread one tray EXAMPLE 3: H If one can be be made made from from 8 cups of and 100 of flour cups of from 150 made from be made can be that can flatbread that whole trays number of whole maximum number the maximum is is‘the trays of flatbread 150 cups flour and 100 cups cups yogurt? gteEtkyogurt? of greek other, used up be used will be yogu rt) will greek yogurt) resources (either the resources questions , one In these one of the (either flour flour or greek up before before the the other, types of questions, these types In these approach to way best the Therefore, produced. be can that amount the limit resource will and that will limit the amount that can be produced. Therefore, the best way to approach these that resource and resource separately. each resource consider each questions is to consider questions separately. 10 the consider the only consider we only If we made . If be made. can be flatbread can tra ys of flatbread l~O = 18.75 trays requirement, % the flour consider the only consider we only IfIf we flour requirement, 100 be produced can be that can amount that the amount Since the made . Since be made. can be flatbread can trays of flatbread l~O ~ requirement, ‐6‐ yogurt requirement, greek yogurt greek 2 16.7 trays produced limiting a limiting is a yogurt is greek yogurt the greek flour, the the flour, produced from can be that can amount that the amount than the less than from greek yogurt yogurt is less beproduced from the the greek from the the result, a As . flatbread of trays of flatbread. As a result, the limited to 16.7 trays flour, so use up enough of it to use isn't enough factor. up the the flour, so we're we’re limited There isn’t factor . There when finding round down we round that we Remember that made is [!I]. be made can be that can trays that number of trays whole number maximum -. Remember down when finding the the maximum whole maximum. maximum. EXAMPLE 4: EXAMPLE4: = 18tw 18tw + + 1,050 1,050 C= producing of producing dollars, of in dollars, C, in total cost the total calculate the equation above uses the appliance manufacturer An appliance manufacturer uses the equation above to calculate cost C, more than no more spend no can spend manufacturer can the manufacturer that ea-ch toasters that shipment of t toasters a shipment a each weigh weigh w to pounds. pounds. If If the than $21,000 $21,(X)0 the what is pounds, what 6 pounds, be 6 will toaster w each toaster and the toasters, and shipment of toasters, producing producing the the next next shipment the weight weight of each i l l be is the shipment? next the for produced be can that toasters of number maximum maximum number toasters that can be produced the next shipment? up an setting up question by this question solve this Let's solve Let’s by setting an inequality: inequality: c ~ 5 21,000 21,000 C 21,000 ::S:21,000 18110 + + 1,050 1,050 5 lBtw 18t(6) ::S: 5 19,950 19,950 18t(6) 10815 19,950 ::S:19,950 108t 184.72 ::S:184.72 t5 produced be produced number that maximum number the maximum numbers , the whole numbers, produced in whole are produced toasters are that toasters implied that it's implied Since it’s Since that can can be I184 1. for the shipment is -. next shipment the next 110 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA EXAMPLE deck of48cards of 48 cards consists EXAMPLE 5: 5: A Adeck consists of ofonlynedcards Ifthenumberofredcards only red cards andblackcards. and black cards. If the number of red cards is less than twice twice the the number less than number of black what is the in the black cards, cards, what the minimum minimum possible possible number number of of black black cards cards in the deck? deck? Let r be be the the number Let number of red red cards cards and and b be the number variables, we can set be the number of black black cards. cards. Using Using these these variables, we can set up up a a system that consists consists of an system that an equation and an an inequality. equation and inequality. r+b= : 448 8 b r <<22b Since the the question Since question is asking asking about about the black cards, cards, our o u r goal get rrid i d of the black goal should should be be to to get of rr so so that that we we end end up up with with an an inequality inequality in terms terms of bonly. so, we we isolate isolate rr in in the o w we 48‐- bb b only. To do do so, the equation equation to to get get rr = 48‐ 48 - b. b. N Now we substitute substitute 48 for r in the inequality : the inequality: 48 4 8-‐ bb <<22b b 4 b 488 < 33b l166 < b Based on on this this resulting resulting inequality, inequality, the Based minimum possible possible number black cards the minimum number of of black cards is-. is [ill. EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 6: An art art teacher teacher needs needs to buy buy aa total of 36paintbrushes Each paintbrush total of 36 paintbrushes for a a painting painting class. class. Each paintbrush must an acrylic acrylic brush, brush, which must be be either either an which costs brush, which costs $3. If no no more more than than costs $5, or a watercolor watercolor brush, which costs $150 can can be spent on the be spent on the paintbrushes, paintbrushes, what what is the minimum number watercolor brushes brushes the the art art teacher the minimum number of of watercolor teacher can buy? can buy? be the the number number of acrylic Let a be acrylic brushes brushes.. Now Now we we can can set set up up aa brushes and and w be be the the number number of watercolor watercolor brushes system of an equation and system an equation inequality just aswe did in Example 5. and an an inequality just as we did in Example 5. a+w 6 a+ w ==336 5 a+ + 33w w §:S1150 50 5a Our goal get the Our goal is to to get the inequality inequality in terms w only, so let’s a in in the equation to to get get a z 36 36‐- w. w. Now Now terms of w only, so let's first isolate isolate a the equation a= we can substitute we can substitute for a a in the the inequality: inequality : 5(36 -‐ w) w) + + 3w $ 1150 50 5(36 3w :S 180 -‐ 510 5w + 310 3w 5150 :S 150 180 ‐- 2w 5 :S 150 ‐2w 5 ‐30 - 2w :S - 30 w 215 w ~ 15 Based on on this this resulting resulting inequality, Based m i n i m u m number can be bought is-. inequality, the the minimum number of watercolor watercolor brushes brushes that that can be bought is lli]. 111 111 CHAPTER 13 MINIMUM CI-LAPTER MINIMUM & & MAXIMUM MAXIMUM WORD WORD PROBLEMS PROBLEMS EXAMPLE 7: Shahar baseball cards Two rare rare Shahar collects baseball cards that that are are sold sold in in regular regular packs packs and and premium premium packs. packs. Two cards can be found inevery cardscanbefound regularpackand threerarecardscanbeformd ineverypremium pack. in every regular pack and three rare cards can be found in every premium pack. If If Shahar wants Shahar wants to add 30 rare cards his collection add at least least 30 rare cards to to his collection by by buying buying no no more more than than 12 12 packs packs of of baseball baseball cards, what cards, what is the premium packs packs he the least least number number of of premium he could could buy? buy? Again, let’s let's set up Again, up a a system system with with r as as the the number number of of regular regular packs packs and and pas pas the the number number of of premium premium packs. packs . r+ + pp §:S1122 2 0 2rr + 3 3pp 2 ~ 330 Since we we have have a a system system of ttwo inequalities, we can’t w o inequalities,we can't just just do do what what we we did did in in Examples Examples 5 5 and and 6. 6. Instead, Instead, we we need need on the following following trick: inequalities inequalities can be to rely on same direction. be added added together together if if their their signs signs point point in in the the same direction. Note that that inequalities inequalities should should never never be be subtracted Note subtracted from from one one another; another; only only think think in in terms terms of of addition. addition. Soto So to get get signs to point in the the same same direction, direction, we can multiply the first inequality the signs ‐ 2 . This will switch inequality by by - 2. This will switch the the sign sign and get get the the coefficients coefficients of r to match and match up. up . -‐ 22rr -‐ 22p p2 ~ ~24 - 24 2r+3p 2r + 3p 2~ 30 30 Now we we can can add add the inequalities Now inequalities together together to to get p ~> 6 p 6 Based on this result, result, the minimum minimum possible Based value of p is [E]. possible value of pis [ill. Another valid valid way way to approach approach this problem problem is guess Another guess and and check. check . For example, example, we we can start start with with p p = =0 0 and and Given those those values, values, is 2r + least 30? If not, rr = z 12. Given + 3p at least with p z 1 and r = 11, and not, repeat repeat the process process with p = 1 and r = 11, and etc. etc. Soon enough, enough, you’ll you'll arrive arrive at p = Guess and and check turns Soon z 6. Guess turns oout u t to be be quite quite efficient in in many many cases, cases, so so don’t don't give up up on on it too early. 112 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 304. A calculator is allowed allowed on the following following questions. questions. shop held held a a weekend weekend sale the goal A gift shop sale with with the goal of selling at at least least $8,000 worth greeting cards cards selling worth of greeting and gift boxes . Each greeting card was sold sold for and gift boxes. Each greeting card was more and each each gift box was was sold $5, and gift box sold for $7. If no more than 400 gift gift boxes were sold the sale due than boxes were sold during during the sale due limited inventory, inventory, what the minimum to limited what is is the minimum number of greeting greeting cards cards the could have have number the shop shop could sold to meet meet its goal? sold its goal? Katherine classroom calculators each Katherine has has 28 28classroom calculators that that each require aa set require set of 4 4 batteries. batteries. If If her her school school supplies supplies her with batteries in packs what is the her with batteries packs of 6, what the least least number of packs to provide provide every number packs needed needed to every classroom with aa complete classroom calculator calculator with complete set set of batteries? batteries? A) 1,040 B) 1,160 C) 1,280 D) 1,400 restock supplies, supplies, a a nail salon purchases To restock nail salon purchases toolkits that that each 80 nail and 150 toolkits each include include 80 nail files and the nail nail salon restock at nail buffers. buffers. If the nail salon needs needs to restock at least 1,800 nail at least nail least nail files files and and at least 4,000 nail buffers, what what is the toolkits buffers, the minimum minimum number number of toolkits the salon salon can can purchase? purchase? the Martha Martha is is working working on on aa design design project project that that requires requires 16 16ounces ounces of glue. glue. The The glue glue gun gun she she is is using comes preloaded with a glue stick that using comes preloaded with a glue stick that provides 2.5 ounces ounces of glue. provides glue. The The only only additional additional glue sticks purchase are glue sticks Martha Martha can c a n purchase are ones ones that that each each provide provide 1.75 ounces ounces of glue glue.. Assuming Assuming that that the the glue glue sticks sticks can can only only be be purchased purchased in whole whole numbers, minimum number numbers, what what is the the minimum number of glue glue sticks Martha Martha must must purchase purchase for for her her project? project? sticks A ) 6 A) B) B)7 C)8 C) D D)) 9 One equivalent to approximately approximately 33.8 One liter liter is equivalent ounces. can each ounces. Mark Mark has has plastic plastic cups cups that that can each hold hold 12 liquid.. At most, 12 ounces ounces of liquid most, how how many many of these these plastic Cups cups could could aa ttwo liter bottle bottle of soda plastic w o liter soda fill? A)5 A) B B)) 6 C) ) 7 C D D) ) 8 113 CHAPTER 13 MINIMUM & MAXIMUM WORD PROBLEMS During a a weekolong week-long fishing fishing trip, trip, Ashleigh During Ashleigh caught nine less than than three three times the number nine less times the number of caught Naomi caught. caught. If they 45 fish fish Naomi they caught caught at at least least 45 combined, what the minimum minimum number number of fish fish combined, what is the that Naomi could have have caught? caught? that Naomi could In one hour, Jason can install at least 6 windows but no more than 8 windows. Which of the following a possible following could could be bea possible amount amount of time, time, in hours, that windows in hours, that Jason Jason takes takes to to install install 100 windows home? a home? A) 12 A) 12 B) 16 B) 16 C) 17 C) 17 D) 18 18 IN 1 fluid fluid ounce ounce = = 29.6 milliliters milliliters I’ ' ' F V filled with with black white pebbles, pebbles, A jar is filled black pebbles, pebbles, white and jade pebbles. The pebbles is and jade pebbles. The number number of jade jade pebbles greater than than half half the the number number of black greater black pebbles, pebbles, and the the number number of white white pebbles pebbles is less less than than and twice the number number of black black pebbles. pebbles . If there are are twice the If there 32 jade the jar, what what is the 32 jade pebbles pebbles in the the maximum maximum number of white white pebbles pebbles that that could could be jar? number be in the the jar? 1 cup cup = = 16 fluid fluid ounces ounces A chemistry teacher is planning chemistry teacher planning to to nm r u n aa class class experiment each student experiment in which which each student must must measure measure out a graduated out 100 100 milliliters milliliters of vinegar vinegar in a graduated cylinder. class is using 66 cups cylinder. The The class is ljmited limited to to using cups of vinegar. Given Given the the information above, what vinegar. information above, what is the maximum who will the maximum number number of students students who will be be able participate in this experiment? able to participate this experiment? Giovanni Giovanni works works as as aa waiter waiter at at an an Italian Italian restaurant. For every table that he restaurant. For every table that he serves, serves, he he earns the bill. earns a 15% 15% tip tip on on the bill. During During lunch, lunch, he he served tables and table had served 12 tables and each each table had an an average average bill of during dinner bill of $25. If each each table table during dinner will will have have an bill of $45, what least number an average average bill what is the the least number Giovanni must must serve during dinner of tables tables Giovanni serve during dinner to earn least $180 for the the day? earn at at least day? A) 3 A) B 6 B)) 116 C 8 C)) 118 D ) 2200 D) 114 s THE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA THE COLLEGE part of aa marketing marketing campaign, As part campaign, aa restaurant restaurant is offering 4 4 free free tacos tacos for every every burrito burrito a a customer customer offering buys. If If the the restaurant restaurant would the buys. would normally normally sell sell the tacos for $2.60 each, what is is the the minimum minimum tacos each, what number of burritos burritos aa customer customer would would have have to number to buy to receive receive at at least least $140 worth buy worth of tacos tacos for free? A pharmacy produces a a certain pharmacy produces certain medication medication in aa daytime daytime variety variety and and aa nighttime nighttime variety variety.. A bottle bottle of the the daytime daytime variety variety contains contains 2 ow1ces ounces of the the active ounces of flavored active ingredient ingredient and and 66 ounces flavored syrup syrup.. A bottle bottle of the the nighttime nighttime variety variety contains contains 33 ounces active ingredient ingredient and ounces of the the active and 55 ounces ounces of flavored syrup. flavored syrup. The The pharmacy pharmacy currently currently has has no no more than 385 ounces the active more than ounces of the active ingredient ingredient and and no no more more than than 850 ounces ounces of flavored flavored syrup syrup available at least 65 bottles the daytime available.. If at least 65 bottles of the daytime variety filled, what variety must must be be filled, what is the the maximum maximum number of bottles of the nighttime number bottles the nighttime variety variety that that can filled? can be be filled? A) A ) 778 8 B) 85 C) 92 C) 92 decorating two-tier two-tier and and three-tier Ava is decorating three-tier wedding cakes. It takes her 20 minutes to wedding cakes. takes her 20 minutes to decorate each each two-tier two-tier wedding cake and and 35 decorate wedding cake 35 minutes to decorate decorate each each three-tier minutes three‐tier wedding wedding cake . If decorate at least cake, If Ava needs needs to decorate least 14 wedding cakes cakes today, today, and she can no wedding and she can spend spend no more than than 6 hours doing so, so, what the more hours doing what is the maximum three-tier wedding wedding cakes cakes maximum number number of three-tier she can decorate today? today? she can decorate D) 106 A banquet banquet hall hall has has aa maximum maximum seating seating capacity capacity of 168 people particular event, people.. For For aaparticular event, the the banquet banquet manager manager must m u s t use use an an arrangement arrangement of short short tables and that there there is and long long tables tables to ensure ensure that tables enough that capacity. capacity. Each enough seating seating to meet meet that Each short short table seats table seats 4 4 people people and and each each long long table table seats seats 8 8 people . lf no more than 32 tables can be placed people. If no more than 32 tables can be placed inside the banquet banquet hall, maximum inside the hall, what what is the the maximum number tables that be used? number of short short tables that can can be used? A A)) 4 B)5 B) C C) ) 6 D D) ) 8 A ) 110 0 A) B) B) 14 14 C) 18 C) 18 D D)) 2222 115 CHAPTER 13 MINIMUM & MAXIMUM WORD PROBLEMS Lianne wants to make a seasoning that consists of 75% sea salt and 25% black pepper . If sea salt costs $2 per pound and black pepper costs $8 per pound, and Lianne can spend no more than $210 on these ingredients, what is the maximum number of pounds of seasoning that she wiU be able to make? C 10On 0/ = 100n % _n+w n+w 0 The formula determine the formula above above can can be be used used to determine the volume percent volume concentration C of an ethanol percent concentration an ethanol solution ethanol and w solution containing containing 11 n ounces ounces of ethanol and w ounces wants to use ounces of water. water . A chemist chemist wants use the the formula formula to create create an an ethanol ethanol solution solution with with aa volume percent volume than percent concentration concentration of no more more than 16%. If will mix 10 10 ounces ethanol If the chemist chemist will ounces of ethanol and x cups and water to create cups of water create the the desired desired solution, solution, what the minimum minimum possible value of what is the possible value assuming that x, assuming that x is aa whole whole number? number? (1 cup = 8 ounces) cup = ounces) A)) 442 A 2 B) 50 50 B) C)) 556 C 6 D)) 6600 D its products small, A toy company company ships ships its products in small, medium , and large boxes . Last month, the the medium, and large boxes. Last month, company shipped a total total of 250 boxes, company shipped a boxes, of which which 70 were were medium medium boxes. boxes. The The number number of large 70 large boxes shipped shipped was was more more than than the the sum sum of the boxes the number of small small boxes boxes shipped shjpped and and the the number number number medium boxes boxes srupped. What is the of medium shipped. What the greatest greatest possible number number of small boxes the company possible small boxes the company shipped last shipped last month? month? t . i 116 Lines functions . as linear referred to as often referred they are Lines are just functions functions in the f(x) = : mx + + b, which which is why why they are often linear functions. form of J(x) the form are just Lines present they because first Lines covering we're covering lines We'll cover whole in aa future future chapter; chapter; we’re because they present some some a whole as a functions as cover functions that they frequently that so frequently concepts so these concepts tests these The SAT tests functions . The concepts don’t apply they deserve deserve their their other functions. apply to other that don't concepts that o w n chapter. chapter. Let's Let’s dive dive in! own Given w o points and (x2,Y2 (Md/2)) on aa line, line, (x1,yi) and points (x1,_1/1) any ttwo Given any , rise 2 -~ y1 1/2 rise · -- “ll‐1 Slope o f line ope of SI Line =: -4 =z -y rrun un .\' 3 XJ X2 -~ x1 The rise line is. The more the m slope, the the slope, The measure of the the steepness steepness of aa Line-the line‐the bigger bigger the o r e steep steep the line rise is the the a measure slope is a The slope of slope A coordinates. x the between distance the rrun and the coordinates and they.'1 coordinates distance between the u n is the the distance between the coordinates. slope 2 means means distance between to the lleft. every 1 uunit down the line goes goes 2 uunits n i t s up up for every u n i t to to the the right, right, or 2 uunits nits d o w n for every n i t to e f t , A slope slope of -‐ ~5 every 11 unit the left. to the units to every 3 units up for every units up or 2 units right, or down for every means the the Line line goes goes 2 units units down every 3 units units to to the right, left. means the graph as in the go up always go slope always Lines up and and to the the right right as graph above. above. positive slope with positive Lines with yV rise run the right and to the down and Lines right:: go down slope go negative slope with negative Lines with y 117 CHAPTER CHAPTER 14 14 LINES LINES EXAMPL£1~ EXAMPLE1: y (a.b) The line line shown the xy-plane passes through through the the origin and point point (a, b), where where a > b. Which shown in the xy-plane above above passes origin and (a,b), Which of the following could bethe the slope slope of the the line? line? thelollowing could be 1 A) -A)‐-% 2 B);~4 B) C ) 11 C) D); D)~ 2 rise ·_ 1 b h at tthe h esslope lope 1s .. positive. .. .. Th Iope, -rise .. tthat .. F First, notice lS posnhve. The ru_', 1s 15aalso 1rst, notice esslope, so equal equa I to E' -b . runI] a y Since a > b, b, ~g is always less than than 1. 1. For For example, example, if if aa =z 5 and be ~2 The The only choice Since always less and b = 3, 3, the the slope slope would would be only choice 5 a [NJ. that’s both both po positive less than than 11 is is answer answer (B) . that's sitive and and less EXAMPLE 2: 2: Line Line m m passes passes through points (k, 7) and and (3,1: 4). If If the the slope line m m is 3, what what is the EXAMPLE through points (3, k -‐ 4). slope of line the value of k? k? value ( k- 4) S l o =p ---e(k z3 ‐-43k)-‐T7 == 33 Slope 1 == 33(3 ( 3 -‐ kk)) k -‐ 111 2 99 ‐- 33kk k - 1111 = 4 k= : 2200 4k k:‑ 118 118 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 3: 3:If line has has a and passes passes through through the the point ) , which If a a line a slope slope of of~g and point (1, (1, ‐- 22), which of of the the following following points points also also lies lies on on the line? the line? A) ((-2, A) 4 , --5) 5) B)(-‐2,‐1) B) (-2,-1) cue‐11) C) (4, -1) D) (4, (4,10) D) 10) i 1 A slope to the right, or or 11 down down for slope of 5 means means 11up up for every every 33 to the right, for every every 3 3 to to the the left. left. If If we we go3 go 3 to to the the left, left, the the point point [I§J. we get we If we we go go3 to the the right, right, the the point we get get to the line line is is ((4, answer (C) . get to to on on the the line line is is ( -‐ 22,, -‐3). 3). If 3 to point we to on on the 4, -~1), 1), answer In this we got the answer answer pretty quickly, but but if we we hadn’t, would have continued moving moving right or this case, case, we got to the pretty quickly, hadn't, we we would have continued right or left left until until we we fotmd found an answer choice choice that that matched matched.. On On the an answer the SAT, it shouldn't shouldn't ever ever take take too too long long to to arrive arrive at at the the answer for aa question answer question like like this this.. In addition slope , you addition to slope, you also know what what x and and y intercepts The x-intercept x-intercept is the graph graph also need need to know intercepts are. are. The is where where the crosses the the x-axis. Likewise, crosses Likewise, they-intercept the y-intercept is where where the the graph y‐axis.. graph crosses crosses the the y-axis Let's say say we we have Let’s have the the line line 2x + By 2x 3y = 12 12 = the x-intercept, To find the x‐intercept, set equal to 0. set y equal 2x + + 3(0) 3(O) = = 12 2x : 12 2x = 12 x = : 6 The The x-intercept x-intercept is 6. To find the the y-intercept, y-intercept, set equal to 0. 0. set xx equal 2(0) + 3y = 12 = 12 3]; 3y := 12 12 y =z 4 The y‐intercept is 4. They-intercept + EXAMPLE the line line ax ax + 3y = 15, where aa is a EXAMPLE 4: 4: If the 15, where x‐intercept that is twice twice the value of a constant, constant, has has an an x-intercept that is the value of the y-intercept, what the y-intercept, what is is the the value value of aa ?? First, set x = First, set = 0Oto find the y-intercept: to find they-intercept: a ( 0 )++3y 3 y=: 115 5 a(O) 3 5 3yy = 115 yy = =5 They-intercept The y-intercept is 5, 5, which x-intercept must 0, which means means the the x-intercept must be be 5 5x x2 2= = 10. 10. Plugging Plugging in in x x z = 10, 10, y y= = 0, a(10) + +3(0) : 15 a(lO) 3(0) = 15 10a = 15 a =~ 119 CHAPTER 14 CHAPTER 14 LINES LINES All be expressed All lines lines can can be expressed in slope-intercept slope-intercept form: y = mx mx + + bb where m the slope they-intercept. the line the slope y-intercept is where m is is the slope and and b is the y‐intercept. So So for for the line y = = 2x 2x ‐- 3, 3, the slope is 2 and and the the y‐intercept -‐ 33:: y While expressed in slope-intercept it'll take take some work to there . If you’re you're While all all lines lines can can be be expressed slope‐intercept form, form, sometimes sometimes it’ll some work to get get there. given y easy easy to get get the the equation the line. line . But But what given aa slope slope and and aa y-intercept, y-intercept, then then of course course it's it’s reall really equation of the what if we're a y-intercept? y-intercept? Then it'll be more convenient convenient to use use we’re handed handed aa slope slope and and aa point point instead instead of aa slope slope and and a Then it’ll be more point-slope form: point-slope form: m(x yy ~- yY1 i =m ( x-‐ xxi) i) where point. For For example, let's say want to find the the equation equation of aa line line that has aa slope slope where (x1,y (x1,y1) the given given point. example, let’s say we we want that has 1 ) is the point (1, -‐ 22). the line line is then then of 3 and and passes passes through through the the point ) . The The equation equation of the yy -‐ ( (-‐ 22)) = - 11)) = 33(x (x~ Once it’s in point-slope form, we we can can then then expand expand and and shift shift things around to get form if if we we Once it's point -slope form, things around get to slope-intercept slope-intercept form need to. need ( x-‐ 1) l) y -‐ ((-‐ 22)) = = 33(x = 33xx -‐ 3 y +2 = y= =33xx ~- 55 EXAMPLE 5: EXAMPLES: y ........ ............ 'J ,_ , ......... ,_ ,_ ,.,. -14. - SI ......... 2 - 1P "' i-.... I" -X ' Which of the following could could be be the the equation of the the line line shown in the the xy-plane above? Which the following equation of shown in xy-plane above? A ) y == ‐- Z2x+3 x+3 A)y 1 B)y=%x+3 B)y = -2 x + 3 1 C)y=‐%x+3 C)y =--x+ 3 2 D ) y= = 2x 2 x-‐ 33 D)y To get get the the equation of the the line : mx mx + + b, we we need need to to find the y-intercept b, The line To equation of line y = the slope slope m m and and the they-intercept b. The line crosses crosses the y‐axis at 3,so b : 3. The line goes downward from left to right, down 1 for every 2 to the right, so the y-axis at 3, sob = 3. The line goes downward from left right, down every to the right , so the the slope slope 1 m is -‐ ~. 5. Therefore, Therefore, the the equation equation of the the line line is y = z -‐ ;%x+ x + 3. Answer Answer ~-(C) . 120 THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA EXAMPLE and (3, 13). 1;3),What is the y‐intercept y~interceptof Imel? EXAMPLE6: 6: A line line l1passes through through the points points (( - 22,3) ,3) and line I ? yz‐y1 = 1 Slope = 133-‐ ‐ 33 =: 2 5 = 1 Y2- Y1 = oPe X2 x 2-‐ xX11 33 ‐- ( -‐ 22)) 2 Using -slope form, Using point point-slope form, our o u r line line is y -‐ 13 13 = 2(x -‐ 3) Note that we 3). The result result will will ttum Note that we could've could’ve used used the other other point point (( ‐ 22,,3). u r n out out to be be the the same. same. y -‐ 13 13 =: 2(x 2(x -‐ 3) 3) y= =22xx ‐- 66++113 3 y= : 22x x+ 7 + After can easily easily see that -intercept is [z]. After putting putting the equation equation into into slope-intercept slope‐intercept form, form, we we can that they the y-intercept .. There There are are aa few more more things things you you need need to know know about about lines. lines. Two lines lines are parallel parallel if they they have have the same same slope. slope. y Two lines In other other words, one slope Two lines are are perpendicular perpendicular if if the the product product of of their their slopes slopes is is -‐ 11.. In words, ifif one slope is is the the negative negative 1 ). reciprocal reciprocal of the the other other (e.g. (e.g. 22 and and -‐ E). 2 y 121 CHAPTER CHAPTER 14 14 LINES LINES EXAMPLE a slope slope of ~g and through the point (4, (4, 3). line n is perpendicular EXAMPLE 7: Line Line m m has has a and passes passes through the point 3). If line 1:is perpendicular to line line m and passes following could could be equation of linen? m and passes through through the the same same point point (4,3), (4,3), which which of the the following be the the equation line n ? A)y=‐§x+9 = -- 32 x + 9 A)y 3 = - -x - 3 B)y=‐§x‐‐3 2 B)y 3 3 2 D)y =- -x + 9 D)y=‐%x+9 C)y =- -x + 6 C)y=‐?2‐x+6 2 3 Because perpendicular to line ~- Using Because it's it's perpendicular line m, m, linen line Hmust must have have aa slope slope of -~‐5' Using point-slope point-slope form, form, 3 (x - 4) y‐3z‐g(x‐4) 2 y - 3 =- 3 yz‐gx+6+3 2x + 6 + 3 y =- 3 yy=‐%x+9 =- x+ 9 2 We answer is ~-( D ) . Weget get the equation equation into into slope-intercept slope-intercept form form to see see that that the the answer Finally, you'U need lines . The the vertical that Finally,you’ll need to know know the equations equations of horizontal horizontal and and vertical vertical lines. The equation equation of the vertical line line that passes through (3, 0) is x = 3. passes through (3,0) 3. y x=3 X +-+--+---+---+--+--+--+--f-1-+ equation of the the horizontal horizontal line line that passes through through (0,3 (0, 3)) is y = : 3. 3. The equation that passes yll y=3 +-+--+---+---+--+---+--+---t---,1--+ 122 X THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 307. A calculator calculator should should N O T be be used on the the NOT used on following questions. following questions. ln the In (‐3,5) and and (6,8) (6, 8) lie lie on on the xy-plane, xy-plane, points points (-3,5) line points is also on line 1. I. Which Which of of the following following points is also on lline i n e ]I?? What What is the equation equation of of the line parallel to the the line parallel to the y~axis right of y-axis? y-axis and and 3 3 units units to the the right of the the y-axis? A) (0,6) (0, 6) A) B) (3,8) C) (9,10) C) (9, 10) D) (12,11 ) D) (12,11) A)) Xx= A = -‐ 3 B) B ) x=3 x=3 C)) yy = C = ‐- 3 D D)) yy== 3 y y (5, n) (-1, 1) • +----, 0+-----. • X Note: Note: Figure Figure not n o t drawn to scale. scale. drawn to - In the the figure figure above, above, the the slope slope of of the the line line through through The graph of LineI is shown in the xy-p lan e above. Which of the following is an equation of a line that is parallel to line I ? the t w o plotted value the two plotted points points is is~%- What What is is the the value o off n n?? A) 9 2 A)y=‐§x+2 A) y =-- x + 2 3 B) 4 C) 3 2 B)y=§x+10 B) y = x + 10 3 7 D) 3 3 3 C)yzgx‐4 C) y = - x - 4 2 D =3 D)) yy = 3xx-~ 11 xy-plane, line has has an anx-intercept of -‐22 In the xy-p lane, a a line x-intercept of and a and slope of of the the a y-intercept y-intercept of -‐ 44.. What What is is the the slope line? line? A A)) -‐ 2 B) ~§11 B) -6 2 1 C) C) -5 2 D) 2 123 CHAPTER 14 LINES y y X +---+-----+---<>----+----- -3 -2 - 1 O 1 2 3 xy-coordinate system system above can be be Line I/ in the xy-coordinate above can represented by the b. Which represented the equation equation y = mx mx + b. Which of the the following following must must be be true? true? the xy‐plane xy-plane above, In the the graph graph of the the linear linear above, the function f is perpendicular perpendicular to the graph of the the function J the graph linear (not shown). shown). If If the graphs of linear function function g (not the graphs offf and g intersect the point and intersect at the point A) mb A) mb > >0 B) B) mb mb < 00 (1, 2), what what is the the (1,~), C) mb = 0 mb = value of gg(‐1) value (- 1) ? ? D) mb : 1 mb = The line y = -‐ 22xx -‐ 22 is perpendicular perpendicular to line/. line I. If If these two lines have the same y-intercept, which of the following could be the equation of line / ? A A)) yy=z ‐- Z 2xx-‐ z2 B 2 x- ‐ 2 B) ) yy== 2x A calculator is allowed allowed on the following following questions. questions. 1 C) C) .v yz‐ix‐Z =-- 2 x - 2 1 D)y=%x‐2 D) y = - x - 2 2 y m The slope slope of line line/ I is ~%and and its its y‐intercept y-intercept is 3. What What is the equation equation of the the line line perpendicular perpendicular to line (1,5) line I that that goes goes through through (1, 5) ?? A = ‐ 22xx + 3 A)) yy =B = ‐ 2x h+ B) ) yy =+7 What m in the figure What is the slope slope of the the line line m the figure above? above? A) A) - 2 1 11 11 C) C) y y:_§x+7 = - 2x + 2 1 B B) ) ‐ ‑ 1 9 D) D) yy‐§x+§ = 2x + 2 2 1 C) C) 4 1 D) 2 124 THE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA THE COLLEGE 2 A line line with with aa slope passes through slope of g passes through the the In the xy-plane, the line with equation 1 . ax ‐ 531 := 8, where constant, passes where a 15a is a constant, passes 3 -1y points (1, 4) and points (1,4) and (x, (x, 10). 10). What What is the the value value of x? x? A) A) 4 through point (2,6). What is the through the the point (2, 6). What the x-coordinate of the x-coordinate the x-intercept x-intercept of the the line? line? B) 6 C) C) 8 D) D ) 1100 D Day ay Monday Monday Thursday Thursday ”‑ Friday Friday Saturday Saturday Average speed, speed , 5 s (miles per per hour) hour) Number of Number calories burned, burned , c 7.2 616 6.8 584 7.9 672 8.5 720 a y = bx + c d +cC y = ‐- xX + y e The lines in the The equations equations of two two perpendicular perpendicular lines the xy-plane are shown above, and e a, b, c, d, and e xy-plane are shown above, where where a,b,c,d, On certain certain days week, Elaine an days of the the week, Elaine runs r u n s for an hour on treadmill. For each day that that she she ran ran in each day hour on aa treadmill. the week, the the table shows the the average the last last week, table above above shows average speeds at which speed sat which she she ran, ran, in miles miles per per hour, hour, and and the number number of calories she burned burned during during the the the calories c she run.. If relationship between between cc ands and s can can be be run If the the relationship modeled function, which the modeled by aa linear linear function, which of the following functions best best models models the the following functions relationship? relationship? a following must be true? following must be true? d A) - < - 1 A)‘1<‐1 e 8 d B)_1<fl<0 L’ e B) - 1 < - < 0 A) c(s) c(s) = z305+400 A) 30s + 400 d C)0<§<1 C) 0 <-< l e B ) c(s) c(s) = 660s 0 $ + 2210 10 B) d D)5>1 D) - > 1 8 e C) c(s) = 2805+40 C) c(s) 80s + 40 D ) c(s) = 2 990s 0 5-‐ 330 0 D) If m m and and b are are real real numbers and m m > 0 and and b > 0, 0, If numbers and then the line whose equation is y = mx + b then the line whose equation = mx + cannot contain the following cannot contain which which of the following points? points? A) (0,1) A) (0, 1) B) B) C C)) D) D) . are If O 0< 2 are constants. constants. If b < 1, which which of the the (1,1) (1,1) ((-‐ 11,1) ,1) (O,‐1) (0, - 1) 125 15 Linear Interpreting Interpreting Linear Models Models chapter previous chapter the previous extension of the direct extension are a direct On the SAT, you you will w i l l encounter encounter linear linear model model questions questions that that are the SAT, context, world real a within models these models within a real world context, the numbers about lines. You’ll interpret the the meaning meaning of the numbers in these have to interpret You'll have about lines. and y-intercept slope and applying your understanding y‐intercept to do do so. understanding of slope applying your equation the equation esmn~ted by the be estimated can be EXAMPLE 1: The value value V, V, in dollars, dollars, of aa home home from 2006 to 2015 can EXAMPLE 2006. since V= 000 ‐- 5, 000T, where Tis T is the number number of years years OOOT,where 240,000 = 240, the meaning best describes PART following best describes the meaning of the the number number 240,000 in the the equation? equation? Which of the following PART 1: Whichof A) The value value of the home home in 2006 home in 2015 value of the home B) The value home from C) value of the the home from 2006 to 2015 average value The average C} The increase in the the value value of the the home home from 2006 to 2015 D) The increase equation? the equation? number 5,000 in the describes the following best best describes the meaning meaning of the number PART 2: Which of the following A) B) C) D) The number number of homes homes sold each year year sold each the value The yearly yearly decrease value of the home home decrease in the and in 2015 The difference between the value of the the home home in 2006 and the value difference between value of the the home home per per square square foot the value decrease in the yearly decrease The yearly -intercept b will Theyy-intercept form. The equation in y = will Part 1 Solution: i l l give give you you an an equation : mx mx + + b form. will que stions w these questions Many of these Solution: Many and it describe 240,000 they-intercept case, the 0. In this case, when x = typically an initial initial value, value, the value value when : O.In y-intercept is 240,000 and describess designate an typically designate Answer ~-(A) . course, is 2006. Answer which, of course, after 2006, the value of the home when when T = : 0, zero years after 2006, which, zero years the home the value designate s The slope + b. The mx + form y := mx Part 2 Solution: dealing with w i t h an an equation equation of the the form slope m m always always designates we're dealing Again, we’re Solution: Again, the means the which 000, 5, is slope the slope case, the each increase a rate, increase in x. In this case, ‐ 5 , 000, which means decrease in y for each increase or decrease the increase rate, the Answer ~(B) -. value of the decreases by 5,000 for each each year year that goes by. Answer that goes home decreases the home value 126 THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA It’s important important that you don don’t get tricked into choosing choosing a looks right right but ultimately doesn't fit the the It's that you ' t get tricked into a rate rate that that looks but ultimatel y doesn't context set set by the variables xx and and y (in ( i n this this case, case, T and and V). Answer Answer ((A) A ) is wrong wrong because we’re n o t dealing dealing because we're not context the variables with the number of homes homes sold; sold; we're we’re dealing dealing with with the value of a Answer (D) is wrong the with the number the value a home. home. Answer wrong because because the numbers in the the equation equation aren aren’t on aa per-square-foot per-square‐foot basis. basis. Always variables you're you’re working numbers 't on Always be be aware aware of the the variables working with. with. EXAMPLE 2: 2- The The maximum maximum height height of aa plant plant h, in inches, inches, can by the EXAMPLE can bedetermined be determined by the equation equation h = grow the the plant. plant . where where x .is is the the amount amount of fertilizer, fertilizer, in grams, grams, used used to to grow x: 4 6 “5+ 6,, PART 1: According According to to the the equation, one more more gram gram of fertilizer fertilizer would would increase increase the the maximum maximum height height of a PART equation, one a plant plant by how how many many inches? inches? PART exactly one one inch, how many PART 2: To raise raise the the maximum maximum height height of aa plant plant by by exactly inch, how many more more grams grams of fertilizer fertilizer should the plant? should be be used used in growing growing the plant? Part 1 Solution: Solution: This question question is essentially the change change in hh for every unit increase increase in x. This This is essentially asking asking for the every 11 unit . . 4 . even clearer, clearer, we can put the the the slope. slope. From From the equation, equation, we can can see see that that the the slope slope is IS ~, 5’ or I-.0.8 I. To make make this even can put the t ~x + + 2. Note Note that dealing with equation into into y = equation : mx mx + + bb form form by by splitting splitting up up the the fraction: fraction: hh = : Ex that when when we're we’re dealing with changes in x and they-intercept irrelevant because a constant constant that’s that's always changes and y, the y‐intercept b is irrelevant because it's it’s a always there. there. Part 2 Solution: change in x for every every l1 unit unit increase the reverse Solution: Because Because this this question question is is asking asking for the the change increase in h, the reverse of Part Part 1, we need need to rearrange rearrange the equation equation so so that that we we have have x in terms terms of h. 4x+6 =2hh s5 4x + 6 4 x+ + 66 ==5Shh 4x 4 x= =5 4x Shh-‐ 6 S 3 sz-lh‐§ = -h- 4 2 X Now that x increases N o w we can can see see that increases by ~, Z, or [ill when the slope slope of oour when h increases increases by 1. The The answer answer is just just the u r new new equation. the reciprocal reciprocal of the the slope the original original equation. equation. The equation. A shortcut shortcut for this this type type of question question is to take take the slope of the The 4 . S recrproca ' proca 1 l of 4 5 is 5. reci 1s 4. 5 4 EXAMPLEB: EXAMPLE 3: 5 -‐ 66m m T == 665 A can the soda, Fahrenheit, can can be can of soda soda is put put into into aa freezer. freezer. The The temperature temperature T of the soda, in degrees degrees Fahrenheit, be found found by by using equation above, the can can has the freezer. using the the equation above, where where m is is the the number number of minutes minutes the has been been in the freezer. What What is the the decrease the temperature every 5 minutes can is left decrease in the temperature of the the soda, soda, in degrees degrees Fahrenheit, Fahrenheit, for every minutes the the can left in the the freezer? freezer? The slope represents the every 1 minute the can can is left in the the freezer. So slope of -‐66 represents the change change in the the temperature temperature for every minute the So S x 6 = I30 Idegrees degrees Fahrenheit. Fahrenheit. for every every 5 minutes, minutes, the the temperature temperature of the the soda soda decrease decreasess by 5 127 CHAPTER CHAPTER 15 15 INTERPRETING INTERPRETLNG LINEAR LINEAR MODELS MODELS CHAPTER page 309. CHAPTER EXERCISE: EXERCISE: Answers Answers for this this chapter chapter start start on on page A calculator should NOT be used on the following questions. A membership website offers offers video video tutorials on membership website tutorials on The large aquarium aquarium The water water level level h, in feet, feet, in aa large h = 100 3d, where can be modeled by can be modeled by h z 100 T 3d' where d d is is the the number of days that have passed since the number of days that have passed since the aquarium last refilled a q u a r i u m was was last refilled.. Based Based on on the the model, model, how level change each day? how does does the the water water level change each day? i A) Decreases by A) Decreases by 3 3 feet feet feet B) Increases by 3 B) Increases by 3 feet A) every one one additional additional video, video, the A) For For every the site site gains e w members. 500 nnew members . gains 500 B) The available videos available The site site initially initially made made 200 videos members . to members. C) Decreases Decreases by 100 feet D) Increase Increasess by 100 feet feet ‘ programming. The number of members, members, m, programming. The number m, subscribed to the the site can be be estimated the subscribed site can estimated by the m = 500 + 200n, 200n, where the number equation m equation where nn is the number videos available available on on the the site. site . Based on the the of videos Based on equation, which which of the the following following statements equation, statements is true? true? ' ' The bread b remaining The number number of loaves loaves of bread remaining in aa bakery each be estimated bakery each day day can can be estimated by the the the number number equation equation b = 200 -‐ 18h, 18h, where where h is the have passed pass ed since of hours hours that that have since the the store's store’s opening the value in opening.. What What is is the the meaning meaning of the value 18 18in this this equation? equation? C) The The site site was was able get 500 members able to get members without any any available available videos without videos.. D) The site gains 500 new members for every D) T h eadditional S i ’ e g a mvideos S m Wavailable membe’sm’eve’y additional available on the the site. 200 videos on site. s= 10 -‐ 2h 5 = 10 211 recipe suggests with A recipe suggests sweetening sweetening honey honey tea with sugar. The The equation equation above above can be used used to sugar. can be to determine the the amount amount of sugar in teaspoon s, determine sugar s, 5,in teaspoons, Ii that should be added added to a a tea beverage that should be beverage with with h teaspoons Of of honey. honey. What What is the meaning of the the 22 teaspoons is the meaning of in the equation? in the equation? A) The bread in 18 The bakery bakery sells all all its its loaves loaves of bread 18 hours. hour s. B) The bakery bakery sells 18 loave loavess of of bread bread each each B) The sells 18 hour. hour. A) every teaspoon teaspoon of of honey honey in in the the A) For For every beverage, two more teaspoons teaspoons of of sugar sugar beverage, two more should be added . ShOUId be added. B) For every teaspoon teaspoon of of honey honey in in the the B) For every beverage, two fewer teaspoons teaspoons of sugar beverage, two fewer sugar should be be added. should added. loave s of bread bread C) The The bakery bakery sells sells aa total total of 18 18 loaves each day each day.. D) There There are are 18 18 loave loavess of bread bread left left in the the bakery at the end bakery at the end of each each day day.. C) For For every every two honey in the the two teaspoons teaspoons of honey beverage, more teaspoon beverage, one one more teaspoon of sugar sugar should should be be added. added. For every every ttwo honey in the the D) For w o teaspoons teaspoons of honey beverage, one fewer sugar beverage, one fewer teaspoon teaspoon of sugar should added. should be be added. 128 THE PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE h ==1100 0 0 -~ 44tt The monthly salary of a salesperson at a used car dealership is determined by the expression 1,000 + 2, 0OOxc, where x is the salesperson's commission rate and c is the number of cars sold by the salesperson. Which of the following statements is the best interpretation of the number 2,000 in the context of this problem? the model the used to model be used can be above can equation above The equation The at held at milk held gallon of milk a gallon until a hours h until number of hours number sour. goes sour. Celsius, goes degrees Celsius, oft,t, in degrees temperature of a temperature a following is the following which of the model, which the model, on the Based on Based the number the of interpretation best interpretation the best the the number 4 in the equation? equation? car at used car a used price of a average price The average A) The at the the B) C) D) gallon of make a gallon will make °C will increase of 11°C A) An increase faster. sour 4 hours go sour milk go milk hours faster. dealership dealership at salesperson at a salesperson salary of a monthly salary base monthly The The base dealership the dealership the eamed commission earned monthly commission average monthly The The average dealership the at salesperson each salesperson the dealership by each sold by the cars sold number of cars average number The The average the month each month dealership each dealership gallons of make 4 gallons will make °C will increase of 1 B) An increase 1°C faster . hour faster. sour 1 hour milk go sour milk gallon of make a gallon will make increase of 4°C will C) An increase faster. hour faster. sour 1 hour go sour milk go milk gallon of make a gallon will make 4° C will increase of 4°C D) An increase faster. hours faster. sour 4 hours go sour milk go milk p = 2, OO0s+ 15, 000 p=2,0005+15,000 an auction at an was sold lamp was antique lamp An antique sold at auction.. The The the during the dollars, during lamp, in dollars, the lamp, price p of the price equation the equation by the modeled by be modeled can be auction can auction seconds number of seconds the number where t is the lOt, where p = 900 ‐- 10t, what model, the to According auction. the in left left the auction. According to the model, what equation? the equation? the 900 in the meaning of the the meaning is the above to equation above the equation uses the government uses state government A state town a town population p for a average population the average estimate the estimate best following best the following Which of the schools. Which withs 5 schools. with the number 2,000 in the the number meaning of the the meaning describes describes the equafion? equation? lamp the lamp price of the auction price starting auction The starting A) The A) lamp the of price auction final The B) B) The final auction price the lamp per lamp per the lamp price of the the price increa se in the The increase C) C) The second second lamp, in the lamp, auction off the took to auction time it took The time D) The seconds seconds students at number of students average number The average A) The at each each a ttown school in a school own each schools in each number of schools average number The average B) The ttown own town 's a town’s increase in a estimated increase The estimated C) The C) additional each for population population each additional school school a town population of a estimated population The estimated D) The D) town schools without any without any schools y= 1.30x‐ - 1.50 = l.30x above to equation above the equation uses the teller uses bank teller A bank where y is the euros, where into euros, dollars into U.S. dollars exchange US exchange the dollar amount. U.S. dollar the US. and x is the amount and euro amount euro amount. interpretation best interpretation the best following is the the following Which of the Which equation? the equation? the 1.50 in the of the the do the euros to do charges 1.50 euros bank charges The bank A) The A exchange. currency exchange. currency the do the dollars to do U.S. charges 1.50 U bank charges The bank B) The S . dollars B) exchange. currency exchange. currency euros. worth 1.50 euros. dollar is worth U.S. dollar One US. C) One C) dollars. worth 1.50 U.S. euro is One euro D) One is worth U S . dollars. D) 129 CHAPTER 15 INTERPRETING INTERPRETING LINEAR MODELS CHAPTER 15 LINEAR MODELS calculator is allowed allowed on on the following following A calculator questions. questions. Which of the following is the best interpretation of the y-intercep t in the contex t of this problem? A) The price of each cake 2x + 9 t_2x+9 t=-- B) The cost of making each cake _ 55 C) The daily costs of running a bakery The equation above models the the time time t, in The equation above models seconds, it takes takes to load load aa web web page with x seconds, page with images. Based Based on on the model, by how how man many images. the model, y seconds does each each image the load load time seconds does image increase increase the time of a web page? ofawebpage? D) The daily cost of making the cakes that weren't ab le to be sold _ What mean that solution to the the What does does it mean that (5, O)is 0) is aa solution equation equation of the the line? line? A) The needs to sell 55 cakes to The bakery bakery needs cakes per per day day to cover cover its daily daily expenses. expenses . B) Each must be be sold sold for at Each cake cake must at least least 5 dollars dollars to cover t, cover the the cost cost of making making iit. C) cake. C) It It costs costs 55 dollars dollars to to make make each each cake. D) Each day, the Each day, the bakery bakery gives gives the the first 5 cakes cakes away for free. away ---------T---------7 Questions 11-13 Questions 11'13 refer refer to to the the following following information. information. Daily Profit Profit (y) Daily --------- 600 -1----,----,-1 ------ 500 400 - L - 300 -l- ---r----"'-------"'-1 200 +- -,----,-----100 +- --,----,------,-- ;-;,"'--~- ----;;;, ~· ~~-- 1---4----+--+--+~~+--+----t---;,-100 -200 -300 . -400 A --------- Cakes 7- - 8--- 9-- (x) T = 56 + Sh To w a r m up room, Patrick the warm up his his room, Patrick turns turns on on the heater. his room, room, in heater . The The temperature temperature T of his degrees Fahrenheit,, can modeled by the the degrees Fahrenheit can be be modeled equation equation above, above, where where h is the the number number of hours hour s since since the the heater heater started started running. running . Based Based on on the the model, what is the model, what the temperature temperature increase, increase, in degrees Fahrenheit, 30 minutes degrees Fahrenhei t, for every every 30 minutes the the heater on? heater is turned turned on? -500 -600 -700 · The relationship between the the daily daily profit The relationship between profit y, in dollars,, of aa bakery bakery and and the the number number of cakes cakes sold sold dollars by the bakery is graphed graphed in the the xy-plane xy-plane above above.. the bakery What does the slope slope of the line represent represent?? What doe s the the line The price price of each cake A) The each cake The profit from each cake sold sold B) The profit generated generated from each cake C) The The dail daily profit generated from all the C) y profit generated from the cakes that that were were sold sold cakes D) The The number number of cakes cakes that that need need to be be sold sold to make aa daily dollars make daily profit profit of 100 dollars 130 130 THE COLLEGE PANDA 2 4 2yy-‐ xX ==114 add like to add would like but would frog but pet frog a pet Alice owns a Alice owns veterinarian local veterinarian The local tank . The same tank. the same turtles to the turtles the total determine the above to determine equation above uses total the equation uses the be that should gallons, that watery,y, in gallons, amount should be amount of water alongside thrive alongside turtles to thrive tank for x turtles the tank held held in the the which of the equation, which the equation, on the Based on frog. Based Alice’s Alice's frog. true? be true? following must must be following support water can gallon of water 1, can support additional gallon One additional I. One turtles . more turtles. ttwo w o more requires two turtle requires additional turtle One additional III. I , One t w o more more water. gallons gallons of water. half an additional requires an turtle requires more turtle One more III. One additional half water. a gallon of water. a gallon A) B) C) C) D) only ll only II IIII I I only only I and only and II only only and III I and I I I only C = 1.5 + 2.5x equation above the equation uses the post office uses local post A local above to a dollars, of mailing cost C, in dollars, the cost determine mailing a determine the increase of 10 pounds . An increase weighing x pounds. shipment weighing shipment 10 equivalent to mailing cost the mailing dollars in the dollars cost is equivalent to an an weight of the weight pounds in the many pounds how many increase of how increase the shipment? the shipment? A) z2 B) 2.5 C) 4 D) 0) 5 131 131 Functions Functions function is aa machine machine that that takes takes an an input, input, transforms transforms it, u t an functions are are A function it, and and spits spits oout an output. output. In math, math, functions denoted x ) , with with x being being the input. So 50 for the the function function denoted by Jf ((x), the input. f(.\') : x2 +1 every squared and and then o n e to get get the the output. It's important important to understand understand that every input input is squared then added added to one output. It's that x is aa completely label‐it’s just aa placeholder placeholder for the the input. input. In fact, II can put in in whatever whatever II want w a n t as completely arbitrary arbitrary label - it's just can put as the the input, including input, including values values with with x in them: them: ff<2x> (2x) = : (2x)2 (2.102 + +11 Jf(a):a2'+1 (a) = a 2 + 1 b+ : (b (17+ 1)2+1 Jf ((b +11)) = + 1)2+ 1 fW(*) ) = r (*)2+ ( * ) ‘ * 1l f(Panda)) = : (Panda (Panda)2 +11 /(Panda )2 + 2 Wrap the Notice the Notice the careful careful use use of parentheses parentheses.. In the the first equation, equation, for example, n o t the the same same as 2x2. example, (2.1')2 (2x)2 is not as 2x . Wrap the input parentheses and and you'll you’ll never never go go wrong wrong.. input in parentheses EXAMPLE 1: If I f J(x) f(x) = : (11+ 1)‘, then then what what is the value value off(0) (1) + + f/(2) ( 2 ) + f/(3)? (3) ? EXAMPLE (x + l)X, of J(O) + ff(l) Just plug the inputs. Just plug in the inputs . fJ((O) 0 )++ Jf ((1) l ) f+f J( 2 3) = z(0+1)“+(1+1)1+(2+1)2+(3+1)3 (2)) ++fJ( (3) (0 + 1)0 + (1 + 1) 1 + (2 + 1)2 + (3 + 1)3 :1“+2‘+32+4~‘ = 1°+ i + i + 43 : 11f+22¢+99++664 4 = z fi_. f f =~ 132 132 COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA EXAMPLE EXAMPLE2: 4 4 f(x) 2 -1 0x+25 f(x) = xx2‐10x+25 For what the function function f above aboveundefined? For what value value of x is the undefined? Because we we can't can’t divide divide by 0, O,a function is is undefined undefined when the Because a function when the denominator denominator is zero. zero. Setting Setting th e denominator denominator zero, to zero, 10x + xx22 -‐ lOx + 25 z= 0 (x ‐- 5)2 5)2z= 0o x X =z [fil The when x = 5. 5. The function function f is undefined undefined when This wou would be aa good time to talk about domain domain and and range range:: This ld be good time talk about Domain: The The set set of of all all possible input values values (x) lead to •0 Domain: possible input (x) to to a a function function (values (values that that don’t don 't lead to an an invalid invalid operation operation or an undefined output) output).. an undefined 0 Range: The all possible output values (y) (y) from • Range: The set of all possible ou tput values from a function. function . In Example 2, x z= 5 leads However, all other other val values give real real number outputs. Examp le 2, leads to Jf (x) (x) being being undefined. w1defined. However, ues of x give number outputs. Therefore, numbers except except 5. 5. To To verify, we can take aa look at the the grap graph Therefore, the the domain domain of offf is all real real numbers verify, we can take look at h of off:f: y 5 0 5 As the graph graph has has no no y-va y-value when x = = 5. 5. In In fact, fact, x = = 5 is is like like an an invisible invisible line graph As you you can can see, see, the lue when line that that the the graph approaches approaches but but never never crosses crosses.. We We call these these lines vertical asymptotes. summarize, the has one one lines vertical asymptotes . To summarize, the function function f has verticall asymptote with equation equation x = = 5. 5. vertica asymptote with You might've might’ve also also noticed noticed that that the the graph graph never never goes goes below below the x‐axis. approaches x-ax is. It’s It's another ano ther line line that that the the graph graph approaches but never crosses crosses.. The x-axis, in this is aa horizontal horizontal asymptote. has one o n e horizontal horizontal but never The x-axis, this case, case, is asymptote . The The function function f has asymptote with asymptote with equation equation y = 0. Because are no on the graph that that have have a y‐value of O Oor of f is is all positive positive Because there there are no points point s on the graph a y-value or below, below, the range range of real Put mathematically, f (x) > 0. 0. By thiss makes sense. Because Because of of the the square square in in the the real numbers. numbers. Put mathematically, f(x) By the the way, way, thi makes sense. denominator (x) = = xm2 denominator of of ff(x) _ l~x + 25 = fi, (x you always positive output output for any va value in the the ~ 5 ) 2 , you alwa ys get get a a positive for any lue of of xx in domain. domain . Let’s the domain domain,, start start with with all all real and then the values values of xx for for which Let's summarize. summarize. To find the real numbers numbers and then exclude exclude the which the function function is invalid invalid or undefined. For examp example, 2 0 take the the the undefined . For le, the the domain domain of y := fl.jx is is xx ~ 0 because because we we can't can't take square negative numbers numbers.. square root root of negative To find the graph the on your your calculator calculator and u t the possible values values of of y, y, taking taking note note of of the range, range , graph the function function on and figure figure o out the possible any asymptotes. any horizontal horizontal asymptotes. 133 CHAPTER 16 CHAPTER 16 FUNCTIONS FUNCTIONS EXAMPLE 3:I f f ( x -‐ 1) 1) = and g(x) == xx + 3,what is the value (2))? off(g(2)) ? EXAMPLE3:If/(x = 6x 6xandg(x) + 3,whatisthevalueof/(g Whenever you of other other functions), functions), start Whenever you see composite composite functions functions (functions (functions of star t from from the the inside inside and and work work your your way way out. out. First, First, g( 2) = 2 + 3 = 5 Now we have have to (5). Now we to figure figure out out the the value value of of f/(5). Well, we into J(x f ( x -‐ 1) 1) == 6x 6x to to get getf(5) = 6(6) = I-.36 I. we can can plug plug in in x x := 6 6 into f (5) = 6(6) = EXAMPLE byf(x) EXAMPLE 4: 4: Functions Functions/ f and and g g are are defined defined by f(x) the value value of k ?7 i· = xx+1 = §.1ff(g(f(k))) = 10, what is is = + 1 and and g(x) g(x) = If f(g(f(k))) = 10, what Again, our way way out: out: Again, we we start start from from the the inside inside and and work work our f ((k) k )=: k + 11 = k+1 g(k+1):k%1 2 g(k + 1) 1c;1) = k ;1+ 1 Finally, Finally, k+l -I%1+1210 2- + 1 = 10 k+1 = k%1:9 9 2 8 kk + 1l 2=118 = [ill k=E k As we've returns an and output output pairs allow we 've mentioned, mentioned, a function function takes takes an an input input and and returns an output. output. Well, Well, these these input input and pairs allow us function asa set of points in the xy‐plane, with the input as x and the output asy. In us to graph graph any any function as a set of points in the xy-plane, with the input as x and the output as y. 1n fact, fact, 2 y = xx2+ the same 1. Both and yy are are the + 11is is the same asf as f (x) = x2+ x2 + 1. Both ff(x) (x) and the same same thing‐they’re thing-they're used used to to denote denote the the output. output. The reason we use with the The only only reason use y is that that it’s it's consistent consistent with the y‐axis y-axis being being the the y‐axis. y-axis. Anytime (x) is used of it it as as the (x) > > 0, Anytime ff(x) used in a graphing graphing question, question, think think of they.y. 50 So ifif a a question question states states that that fJ(x) 0, all allyy values graph is is always above the x-axis. It’s extremely important that you learn to think values are are positive positive and and the graph always above the x-axis. It's extremely important that you learn to think of points inputss and and outputs points on on a a graph graph as as the the input outputs of of a a function. function . 134 THE PANDA THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA EXAMPLES: EXAMPLE 5: y ; I/\ \ J - 1- 'O I I -· \ \ I \ X \ \ I \ The f (x) is is shown shown in in the xy-plane above. above‘ For what value value of (x) at The graph graph of of J(x) the xy-plane For what of x xisis fJ(x) at its its maximum? maximum? Again, (x) as as they the y.. So So we’re graph with with the Again, when when it it comes comes to to graphs, graphs, think think of offf (x) we're looking looking for for the the point point on on the the graph the highest y‐value, the ”peak”" of That point point is x-value is .. highest y-value, the "peak of the the graph. graph. That is (5, (5, 4), 4), and and so so the the x-value is I}]. EXAMPLE the function function with with equation = ax a):22 + point (1, 2), what what is EXAMPLE6: If the equation yy = + 33 crosses crosses the the point (1,2), is the the value value of of a a?? Remember - a point Remember‐a is just an output, output, an an xx and y. Because 2) is is a on the the graph point is just an an input input and and an and a a y. Because (1, (1, 2) a point point on graph of of the the function, function, we we can can plug plug in 1 for x and and 22 for y. 2 2 =:a(1)2 a(1 )2++3 3 2 = aa + 3 a z j 2+ EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 7: If the function y = = xx2 + 2x -‐ 4 contains the point and m m> what is is the value the function contains the point (m,2m) (m, 2m) and > 0, 0, what the value of m? ofm? It's important important n not get intimidated It's o t to get by all the variables. variables. The gives us us aa point point on on the graph, so so let's let's intimidated by all the The question question gives the graph, plug plug it it in. in . : x2 yy = x2 + +2x 2x -‐ 4 4 2m = m2 + 2m 2m-‐ 44 2m m2 + 00 = m2 m 2 -‐ 4 4 From here From we can can see that :l:2. The question question states states that : l.@]. here we that m = ± 2. The that m > 0, 0, so so m m= The zeros, zeros, roots, and x-intercepts The function are are all for the the same thing‐the values x-inter~epts of aa function all just just different different terms terms for same thing - the values of x that that make make ff(x) (x) = = 00 (or y = = 0). O). Graphically, Graphically, they values of crosses they refer refer to to the the values of x x where where the the function function crosses the x-axis. the 135 FUNCTIONS 16 FUNCTIONS CHAPTER 16 CHAPTER EXAMPLES: EXAMPLE8: y ~ I I I , -- I I I I I ' . "" .." .,_:. I I '\ -- '\ I I '\ ' X ' I I I I " ...../ I I The graph off (x) = x3 - 2x2- Sx + 6 is shown in the xy-plane above. does the zeros does distinct zeros PART 1: How How many many distinct the function function ff have? have? value the value be the could be following could the following which of the solution, which that J(x) such that constant such If k is a constant PART 2: If f (x) = = k has has 1 solution, of kk?? -3 A) ‐3 A) B) 1 C) 5 0)99 D) has so ff has times, so three times, x-axis three the x-axis crosses the graph crosses The graph Solution : The Part 1 Solution: Part and 3. are -‐ 22,, 1, and zeros are these zeros that these see that see can we can the graph, distinct zeros ffidistinct zeros.. From From the graph, we Read explanation. Read the explanation. during the lost during you feel lost panic ifif you so don't involved, so quite involved, question is quite This question So lution: This Part 2 Solution: don’t panic sense make to able be you'll promise I . confusing were that bits the to back go then go back the bits that were confusing. promise you'll be able make sense of and then through and the way all the all way through everything. everything. always we always input, we the input, matter the function. No matter just a function. realize that this question, To truly understand question, first realize that a constant constant is just understand this does What does say k = -‐ 33.. What let's say So let’s y = k or g(x) = k. So can write we can question, we this question, output. In this same output. the same get the get write it as asy at -‐ 33!! line at horizontal line like? A horizontal y z= ‐3 look like? - 3 look y intersection points the intersection referring to the merely referring it's merely = k, it’s so lutions to fJ (x) = the solutions asks for the question asks a question Now points of f (x) when a Now when (x) J other, each other, f(x) = equal to each functions equal sets ttwo question sets a question general , if a k. In general, line y = horizontal line and = k. w o functions = g(x), and and the horizontal and the intersection points the intersection only at the it's only all, it’s After all, points. After intersection points. the intersection referring to the it's referring solutions, it’s the solutions, about the asks points you about asks you constant a constant be a happens to be just happens g(x) just case, g(x) particular case, this particular functions. In this both functions. that same for both the same value of y is the the value that the function, : k. g(x ) = function , g(x) there above, there shown above, as shown - 3 as So ifif k = points. 50 intersection points. the number The equivalent to the number of intersection : ‐3 solutions is equivalent number of solutions The number the are the themselves are solutions themselves The solutions points. The must intersection points. the 3 intersection represented by the as represented solutions to fJ (x) = -‐ 33,, as be 3 solutions must be and 2.6. 2.2, 1.6, and be -‐2.2, them to be x-values estimate them can estimate points . We can those points. x-values of those 136 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA Getting back we have choose a Getting back to the the original original problem, problem, we have to to choose ak k such such that that there there is is only only one one solution. solution. Now Now we’re we're thinking backwards. thinking Instead of being constant, we have to to choose choose it. it. Where might we place place aa backwards. Instead being given given the the constant, we have Where might we horizontal there’s only only one intersection point? o t at we just just showed how horizontal line line so so that that there's one intersection point? Certainly Certainly nnot at ‐3 - 3 because because we showed how that would would result that result in 3 solutions. solutions . Well, looking looking back one just below -‐ 44.. Horizontal Horizontal lines at these back at at the the graph, graph, we we could could place place one just above above 88 or or just just below lines at these values w i t h fJ (x) just just once. Looking at is the values would would intersect intersect with once. Looking at the the answer answer choices, choices, 9 9 is the only only one one that that meets meets our our condition. Answer Answer ~(D) .condition. Let’s take a revisit part part 1. 1. In In part 1, we we found number of intersection points between fJ (x) and Let' stake a moment moment to revisit part 1, found the the number of intersection points between (x) and But realize realize that that the just the the horizontal horizontal line y = 0. In counting the number of intersection the the x-axis. x-axis . But the x-axis is is just line y = 0. In counting the number of intersection points = 0, really doing doing is is finding the number number of points between between f (x) and and the the horizontal horizontal line line yy = 0, what what you you were were really finding the of solutions 0. solutions to f (x) = = If you you didn’t in this this example the first first time through didn't grasp grasp everything everything in example the time through, through, it’s it's ok. ok. Take Take your your time time and and go go through it again, making sure throw quite questions at at again, making sure you you fully fully understand understand each each of of the the concepts. concepts . The The SAT SAT will will throw quite aa few few questions you as well well as as the the solutions solutions to (x) = = g(x). you related related to the the zeros zeros of of functions functions as to fJ (x) g(x) . Hopefully by by now, you’re starting to see constants ashorizontal lines. 5, that means Hopefully now , you're starting to see constants as horizontal lines. 50 So for for instance, instance, if if fJ (x) (x) > > 5, that means the is above z 5. in this i l l help help you you on on a the entire entire graph graph of offf is above the the horizontal horizontal line line y = 5. Thinking Thinking of of constants constants in this way way w will a lot of SAT graph lot graph questions. question s. 3 + 2x2 EXAMPLE 9: Which of following could could be be the the graph EXAMPLE 9: Which of the the following graph of of y y = xx3+ 2x 2 + + xx ++ 11?? B) m A) ~ C) q #‘x $3: %x yy y y D) yy x Although Although the the given function looks complicated and you might given function looks complicated and you might be be tempted tempted to to graph graph itit on on your your calculator, calculator, this this is the find a be on on the graph and eliminate eliminate the easiest easiest question que stion ever! ever! A Alll l you you have have to to do do is is find a point point that’s that's certain certain to to be the graph and the So what’s an easy easy point and test? test? the graphs graphs that that don’t don 't have have that that point. point. So what 's an point to to find find and Plug to get = 1. 1. N o w which which graphs graphs contain contain the Plug in x x z = 00 to get y = Now the coordinate coordinate (0, (0, 1)? 1)? Only Only graph graph ~-. - By are particularly particularly good good for to use By the the way, way, numbers numbers like like 00 and and 11 are for finding finding ”easy” "easy" points points to use for for this this strategy. strategy. 137 CHAPTER 16 CHAPTER 16 FUNCTIONS FUNCTIONS Function Transform Function Transformations ations Function transformations Function transformations are are changes changes we we can make make to to the the equation equation of of a a function function to to ”transform” "transform" its its graph graph in in specific ways. The transformations you might encounter on the SAT are reflection across the x-axis, ways . transformations you might encounter on the SAT are reflection across the x-axis, vertical verticaJ shift, horizontal shift, and We’ll cover first three shift, horizontal shift, and absolute absolute value, value. We'll cover the the first three here here and and discuss discuss absolute absolute value value transformations transformations in the absolute absolute value value chapter. chapter. Let's start Let’s with the (x) = z x2 + 2x, start with the example example function function fJ(x) x2 + 2x, whose whose graph graph looks looks like like y graph of fJ(x) To reflect the graph (x) across down),, multiply ( x ) by by -‐ 11.. The The resulting across the x-axis x-ax is (flip (flip itit upside upside down) multiply ff(x) resulting equation, equation, 2 - 2x, produces y = f(x) = x the reflected 312 ~f (x) z ‐x2 ‐ produces reflected graph. graph. yy = = -‐ f(x) fl fl y ·. I To shift shift the graph up, add To graph of fJ(x) ( x ) up, add a constant ( x ) . For example, ( x ) ++ 22 =z x2 + 2x constant to ff(x). example, y 2= fJ(x) x2 + 2x + + 22 produces produces aa graph that that is 2 units graph (x). units above above the graph graph of of ff(x). shift the graph graph of fJ(x) down, subtract To shift (x) down, (x). For (x) -‐ 2 + 2x subtract a constant constant from ff(x). For example, example, yy = = fJ(x) 2 z= x2 x2 + 2x -‐ 2 2 produce s a a graph produces graph of f ( x). graph that that is 2 units units below below the the graph of J(x). yy = = f(x fl n) ++22 y = f(x) - 2 y y 138 COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA To shift x ) to the the left by a [1units, units, substitute substitute x + + a in = fJ((xx + + 1) 1) = = shift the the graph graph of fJ((x in for for x. x. For For example, example, yy = 1)22 + 2(x + 1) 1) produces produces a graph that that is unit to left of the graph of f(x). (x + 1) a graph is 11 unit to the the left of the graph of J (x). To shift x ) to the substitute x -‐ a shift the the graph graph o offff ((x) the right right by a11units, units, substitute a in in for x. x . For For example, example, yy = = fJ((xx -‐ 1) =z + 2(x -‐ 1) 1) produces is 11 uunit n i t to off(x). (x -‐ 11)2 )2 + produces a a graph graph that that is to the the right right of of the the graph graph of J (x). y = f (x + l ) y = J (x - y 1) y Here's Here’s a trick that use to make make sense that I like to use sense of horizontal horizontal shifts: shifts : For horizontal For horizontal shifts, shifts, find find out out what what value value of of xx makes makes the equal to the substituted substituted expression expression equal to 0. 0. This This value value will will tell tell you horizontal shift shift is. is. For For instance, instance, when when we we have f (x ‐ 1), what value of x makes 1 you what what the the horizontal have J(x - 1), what value of x makes x x -‐ 1 equalto 0?x = 1. Sof(x ‐ 1)is1 unit tothe rightoff(x). What aboutf(x+4)? Well,x = ‐4makesx+4 equal to 0? x = 1. So J(x - 1) is 1 unit to the right off (x ). What about J(x + 4)? Well, x = - 4 makes x + 4 equal to equal to 0. Since value is negative, graph is is shifted left. And And what what about f(3x -‐ 2)? Since the the value negative, the the graph shifted 4 units units to to the the left. about /(3x 2)? What's5 the the horizontal horizontal shift What’ relation to to f(x)? f (x)? A value value of x = = ~ 2 makes equal to the horizontal horizontal shift in relation makes 3x -‐ 22 equal to 0,so 0, so the 2 shift is is ~3 units units to right. shift to the the right. Note that horizontal horizontal and Note that referred to astranslations. the graph of a and vertical vertical shifts shifts are are commonly commonly referred as translations. And And the graph of a transformed transformed hmction is often function often called called an an image image of the graph of the the original original function. the graph function . EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 10: In the the function function g units to to the the left left the xy‐plane, xy-plane, the the graph graph of the g is the the graph graph of of f/ translated translated 55 units and 33 units units downward. downward. If and the function (x) = (x -‐ 3) 3)22 + + 1, 1, which which of of the the following lithe function f is is defined defined by fJ(x) following defines defines g(x)? g(x)? A)g(x) A)g(x)=(x‐8)2‐2 = (x - 8)2 - 2 B)g(x)=(x+2)2‐2 B)g(x) = (x + 2)2 - 2 C)g(x)=(x‐8)2+4 C)g(x) = (x - 8)2 + 4 D)g(x)=(x+2)2+4 D)g(x) = (x+2) 2 +4 A translation units downward downward means translation of 5 units units to the the left and and 3 units means that that g( J (x + 5) -‐33 3 0x )) = =f(-Y+5) : ( (x ( x + 55)) -‐ 33)) 22+ + 11-_ 33 == (x+2)2~2 = (x + 2) 2 - 2 Answer Answer ~(B) . To summarize, summarize, for a function f (x),, To function J(x) o (x)) results in a x-axis • -‐ Jf (x results in a reflection reflection across across the the x-axis 0 x) + + a results units; Jf(.r) of a a units units • fJ((x results in in an an upward upward shift shift of a units; (x) ‐- 11 a results results in in a a downward downward shift shift of 0 + a) results shift of a units horizontal shift shift of a units • f (x + results in a horizontal horizontal shift units to to the the left; left; f (x ‐- (1) a) results results in in a a horizontal of a w1its to to the right the right 139 CHAPTER CHAPTER 16 16 FUNCTIONS FUNCTIONS CHAPTEREXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 311. A calculator should NOT be used on the following questions. y X y 0 20 1 21 3 29 The table table above above displays displays severa The severall points points on on the the graph of the the function function fin graph f in the the xy-plane. xy-plane. Which Which of the following could could bef be J(x)? the following (x) ? A) f (x)) = 20x A) J(x B) fJ(x (x)) z= xx ++20 8) 20 C) fj (x) (X) = = xX -‐ 20 20 C) 2 D) D) f(x) J(x )==x2 x ++20 20 The graph graph of the the function function f is shown the The shown in the xy-plane above. If J(a) = f(3), which xy-plane above. If f (a) f (3), which of the the following could could be be the following the value value of of aa ?? A)) -‐ 4 A 8) ) -‐ 3 B C)) -‐ 2 C D) 1 y J(x) y In the portion of the xy-plane shown above, for how many values of x does J(x ) = g(x)? A) None B) One The function f is graphed in the xy-plane above . For how many values of x does J(x) = 3? C) Two D) Three A) Two 8) Three C) Four D) Five 140 THE COLLEG COLLEGE THE E PANDA PANDA For which of the following functions is it true that J(-3) ==f(3) J(3)?? thatf(‐3) IfIf fJ(x) (x) = values = x2, x 2 , for for which which of of the the following following va lues of of c isf is ((c) c) < cc?? A) f J(x) M m ==-X2; 1 A) 1 A)E 2 x3 B 8) ) 1 8) J(x) = B)fu%=§ 3 3 C) ~ C)z 2 C) C) f(x) J(x) =3x2+1 = 3x 2 + 1 D) f(x) 0) f(x) = xx + + 22 D) ) 2 D the graph graph of the IfIf the the function has x-intercepts function fJ has x-intercepts at at -‐33 and and 2, and 12, which which of of the and ay-intercept a y-intercept at at 12, the following could following could define define f ? ? The hmction f is defined by J(x) = 3x + 2 and the function function g is defined the by g(x) defined by g(x) = f(2x) -‐ 1. = J(2x) l. What is the What the value value of of g( 10) lO) ? ? A) fJ(x) (x + 3)2(x -‐ 2) A) ( x )‐=‐ (x (+3)2<x z) B)) f ((x)X =) ((xH+ + 33)(x B X ‐ )-( 2) 2)22 C)) fJ(x) + 2) C ( X ) = (x ( X-‐ 3)2(x 3)2 (X+2) D) ) fJ ((x) = = ‐(x( X- 3)(x D 3)(X + + 2) 2)22 If J(x) = 16 +x x 2 J(x) = x 2 + 1 2 is the the value value for all x 7é0, -:fa0, what what is g(x)=x 2 - 1 g(X)=x2‐1 off (- 4)? The functions The defined above. above. What What is is functions f and and g are are defined the the value value off(g(2)) of f(g(2))? ? A) - 8 8) -4 C) 4 A) 3 D) 8 B) 5 C 0 C)) 110 D 7 D)) 117 X 0 1 2 J(x) -2 3 18 In the the xy-plane, xy-plane, which which of of the the following following translati translations on s of of the the graph graph of of y y = 2x2 2x 2 ‐- 2 2 results results in in 2 the the graph graph ofy of y = = 2x2 2x + + 44?? Several values Several are given given in in the the values of the the function function fJ are table above. above . If table (x) = ax2 are If fJ(x) ax2 + + bb where where a a and and b bare constants, what constants, value of (3) ?? what is the the value offf (3) A) A) 8) B) C) D) A 3 A)) 223 B) B) 39 39 C) C) 43 43 D 6 D)) 556 141 141 A translation translation 2 2 units units downward downward A translation translation 6 6 units units upward upward A translation translation 2 units units to to the the left left A translation translation 6 6 units units to to the the right right CHAPTER 16 FUNCTIONS in the the xy-plane, xy-plane, the the graph graph of the the function function f [n reaches its its maximum maximum value value at the the point point (3,f (3) (3) ). reaches The function function g is defined The defined by g(x) g(x) = = ff(x (x) + + 7. 7. At which of the the following following points points in the the xy-plane xy-plane which its maximum maximum value? does the the graph graph of g reach does reach its value? y A 7) A) (10,f(10) (10, f (10) + 7) B) (f (3), f (3) ++ 7) B) (f(3),f(3) C) (3,f(10)) (3,f( lO)) C) D) (3,](3) (3,f(3) ++ 7) D) The graph AB graph of the the function function f and and line line segment segment E are shown above . For how many are shown in the the xy-plane xy-plane above. For how many between -‐33 and values of x between values and 3 does does J(x) f(x) = = c? c? 2 fJ(x) (x) = ✓xx ‐ 2 The function function f is defined defined above above for all x 2: The 2 2. 2. Which of the the following following is is equal equal to to Which f(18) -‐ f f(1 f(18) ( 11l ))?? A) A) B) B) C) C) D) D) X f(x) f<x> -4 3 5 - 2 0 2 3 4 f (3) f(3) ff(5) (5) f(6 f(6)) ff(7) (7) The function f is defined by J(x ) = (x - 3)2, and the function g is defined by g(x) = x2 + 4x + 4. The graph of g in the xy-plane is the graph off shifted k tmits to the left. What is the value of k ? 2 16 4 8 The table above gives some values for the function f. If g(x) = 2f(x), what is the value of kif g(k) = 8? A) 2 B) 3 C) 4 D) 8 142 142 THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA A calculator is allowed on the following questions. Ifg(c) If g(c) := 5, 5, what what is is the the value value of of f(c) J(c)?? A A)) -‐ 22 B) 3 _ xx + +1 l y= x ‐ x ‐ 11 C) 5 D) 6 Which Which of the the following following points points in in the the xy-plane xy-plane is is NOT NOT on on the the graph graph of y y?? A 1 A) (- 2, 3) 8) (- 1, 0) 1 . C) (0, - 1) l f J(x) f ( x ) = -‐ 33xx + 55 and and éfla) 10, what what 1s i sthe If J(a ) = 10, the D) (1,2 ) va lue of a a?? value 2 A)) -‐ 8 A B)) -‐ 5 B C) 5 Let the by g(x) g(x) = : @. the function function g be be defined defined by ffx. g(a) = = 6, what what is th thee value value of a ?? If D)) 8 D A) 3 B) 8) 6 C) 9 X D) D) 12 12 V --------~------- Questions following Questions 20-21 20-21 refer to to the following 0 1 2 3 information. information. 4 X - 2 - 1 0 1 2 3 f(x) 3 5 - 2 3 6 7 J(x) -4 -8 3 6 g(x) 5 7 2 4 6 4 7 5 2 -3 Several Several values values of the the function function f are are given given in the the table above. If the function g is defined table above . If the function defined by g(x) value ofg(3) g(x) = = f(2x J(2x ‐- 1), 1), what what is is the the value of g(3)?? 5 7 1 A) 2 A) The 3 are are defined the six values values The functions functions f and and g defined for the of x shown shown in the the table table above. above . B) 8) 6 C) 5 D) 7 D) What is the value of J(g( - 1)) ? A) - 2 B) 3 C) 5 D) 6 143 CHAPTER 16 FUNCTIONS CHAPTER 16 FUNCTIONS IIff f(x) f ( x ) is aa linear f(2) :::; S /(3), f(3) linear function function such such that that /(2) f(4) f(6) = 10, which which of /(4) 2 ~ f(5), /(5), and and /(6) of the the following following must must be be true? true? f(x) :=44xx -‐ 3 J(x) g(x) = 33x+5 x+5 g(x) The functions The defined above. Which functions f and and g are are defined above. Which the following of the is equal following is equal to to f (8) (8) ? ? A) ) f/(3) A ( 3 ) < f(O) f ® ) <<f/(4) @) B) f(O) = 0 B) f(0 >= C) ) fl C m >>110 0 f(O) D) D ) ff(O) ( 0 )= ‐‐ 10 10 A) g(l) B) g(3) C) g(5) D) g(B) y y -- Y = g(x) - 1 +-----::Q +----------1----+ X 1 ' . •--~ I ! • ····- I .. The graph of the function g is shown in the xy-plane above, and the function f (not shown) is defined by f (x) = x3 . If g is defined by g(x) (x + a) + b, where are constants, g(x) := fJ(x +a)+ where a and and b bare constants, what what is the the value value of a a+ + bb?? The graph graph of f(x) The f (x) is shown shown in the the xy-plane xy-plane above. If g(x) = (x + 3)(x ‐ 1), for above. If g(x) = + 3)(x - l ), which which of the the following ( x ) > g(x) following values values of x is is ff(x) g(x)?? A A)) ‐- 3 A A)) ‐- 5 B)) -‐ 2 B B B)) -‐ 1 C) 1 C) 1 D) 2 D)) 5 D In the xy-plane, the graph of the function g is the image of the graph of the function f after a translation of 11;~ units translation right. Which units to the the right. Which of the the following g(x) ? following defines defines g(x) ? A) ) g(x) A g u )==J(3x f 6 r-‐ 2) E B)) gg(x) f(3x + 2) B ( x ) = fGX+fl C)) gg(x) 3) C ( x )= = ff(2x o ‐- w D) g(x) = f(2x 3) D ) g u ) = f o ++% 144 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA w” y y A 2 The the function is shown The graph graph of the function y = = 9 -‐ xx2 shown in AB ?? the xy-plane the length the xy-plane above above.. What What is the length of E The function f(x) = x3 + 1 is graphed in the xy-plane above. If the function g is defined by g(x) = x + k, where k is a constant, and J(x) = g(x) has 3 solutions, which of the following could be the value of k? A) 3v'2 A) 3\/§ B ) 3v'10 3m B) C) 9 D ) 9v'10 9m D) A)) -‐ 1 A B) 0 C) 1 D) 2 y [n the -+- 12, 12, where where 1n the xy-plane, xy-plane, the the function function y = ax ax + constant, passes through the the point point ((‐a,a). - a, a) . a is a constant, passes through If a > value of a ?? > 0, what what is the the value The function f is graphed in the xy-plane above. If the function g is defined by g(x) = f(x) + 4, what is the x-intercept of g(x)? A) - 3 B) - 1 C) 3 D) 4 145 17 Quadratics Quadratics Just as lines were one group of functions that that have o w n properties, quadratics are are another. another. A A quadratic quadratic Just as lines were one group of functions have their their own properties, quadratics is a function in the is a function the form form f(x) = r - ax axz2 + bx b x+ J(x) +c in which which the highest power power of x is is 2. 2. The The graph graph of of aa quadratic quadratic is the highest is a a parabola. parabola . To review we’ll walk walk through through aa few examples various properties properties you you need need to to review quadratics, quadratics, we'll examples to to demonstrate demonstrate the the various know . know. QUADRATIC 1: QUADRATIC 2 -- 44x f(x) = xx2 x ‐- 21 f(x) 21 The Roots The Roots The The roots roots refer refer to the the values values of x that make Jf ((x) x) = : 0. They're They’re also x‐intercepts and and so solutions. We’ll that make also called called x-intercepts lutions . We'll mainly use the mainly use the term term "root" “ r o o t ” in this this chapter, the other other term termss are just as Don’t forget that that they they all all chapter, but but the are just as common. common. Don 't forget mean the the same mean thing.. Here Here,, we we can just factor find the roots: same thing can just factor to to find the roots: 2 - 4x :00 xx2~4x‐21 - 21 = ( . r-‐ 77)(x ) ( . r+ + 3) 3 ) =2 0 (x x X : 7, = 7, -~33 The roots roots are are 7 and The this means means the the quadratic quadratic crosses the x-axis x-axis at at xx =z 77 and and x.r =: -A3. and -43. 3. Graphically, Graphically, this crosses the 3. The Sum Sum and Product of the Roots Roots = We already found We already found the so their u m is just just 77 + ( -‐ 33)) z 4 their product product is is just just 77 xx -‐33 = z -‐ 221. 1 . This This the roots, roots, so their ssum 4 and and their was really easy, so was really easy, about these these values? values? Because Because sometimes sometimes you'll you’ll have have to find the the sum s u m or or the the so why why do we care care about product the roots roots without without knowing knowing the the roots roots themselves. themselves. H o w do we do that? product of the How do we do that? . . . b Given quadratic of the form y = : ax axz2 + + bx + c, the the sum s u m of of the of the the roots roots Given a a quadratic the form the roots roots IS is equal equal to to -‐ ~E and and the the product product of a , c . equal c. is 1s equa 1to -E. a 146 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA our example, example, a = In our : l,Lbb = : -‐ 44,, c = -‐21.So, 21. So, Sumz‐é=‐‐:4 = - -- 4 = 4 a 1 l b Sum = - - C Product Product = -E = --‐ ‐-_21fl = ‐- 2211 1 l a See how were able these values values without without knowing knowing the roots that that we we how we were able to determine determine these the roots roots themselves? themselves? The The roots found found earlier earlier just just confirm confirm our our values. values. The Vertex The The vertex The vertex is the the midpoint midpoint of a a parabola. parabola . y vertex vertex The x‐coordinate The vertex is always always the midpoint of the ttwo w o roots, roots, which found by averaging them. x-coordinate of the the vertex the midpoint which can can be be found by averaging them. Because roots are are 7 7and the vertex vertex is at x = z Because the the roots and -‐ 33,, the 7+ + (-( ‐ 33)) z 2. When When x = : 2,f(x) (2)22 -‐ 4(2) 5. = 2, J (x) := (2) 4(2) ‐- 21 21 := ‐- 225. 2 Therefore, the Therefore, vertex is at (2, -‐25). Note that that the maximum or m i n i m u m of a quadratic always at at the vertex. the vertex 25). Note the maximum minimum quadratic is is always the vertex. ln this this case, in minimum of ‐25. case, it’s it's a minimum - 25. Form Vertex Form Just asslope-intercept as slope-intercept form Just b)is of representing form is is one one way way of of representing representing form (y = mx+ mx + b) is one one way way of representing a a line, line, vertex vertex form a quadratic quadratic function a function.. We've We’ve already t w o different different ways ways quadratics can be be represented, namely standard already seen seen two quadratics can represented, namely standard form (1; (y = form : ax2 form (y = : (x -‐ a a)(x looks likey = a(x a(x -‐ h)2 + k. ax2 + + bx bx++ c) and and factored factored form )(x -‐ b)). Vertex form form looks like y = h)2 + To get get a a quadratic quadratic function function into into vertex vertex form form,, we we have have to to do do something something called called completing completing the the square. square. Let’s Let's walk walk through through it step-by‐step: step -by-step: yy z= x2 x2 -‐ 4x 4x -‐ 21 21 the middle See the The -‐ 44.. That That’s the key. key. The The first step is to divide divide it by 2 Then write the middle term? term? The 's the step is it by 2 to to get get -‐ 22.. Then write the following: following : y = (x ‐- 2)2 2) 2 ‐- 21 where we put See where ? The The first part o w the take that that -‐22 and square it. We get get put the the ‐- 22? part is done. done . N Now the second second step step is to take and square it. We 4. yy:= (x‐2)2‐21‐4 (x - 2)2 - 21 - 4 See where where we Wesubtracted at the end. The The vertex we put put the the 4? 4? We subtracted it at the end. vertex form form is is then then y z= (x -‐ 2)2 -‐ 25 To recap, recap, divide middle coefficient to get get the the number divide the middle coefficient by by 22 to number inside inside the the parentheses. parentheses. Subtract Subtract the the square square of of that at the the end. that number number at end . 147 CHAPTER 17 QUADRATICS CHAPTER 17 QUADRATICS Completing the the square square takes Completing takes some and practice, practice, so so if if you some time time and you didn't didn 't catch catch all of of this, this, first first prove prove to to yourself yourself that it is indeed that the same same quadratic the result. result. Then indeed the quadratic by by expanding expanding the Then repeat repeat the the process process of of completing completing the the square square yourself. If you’ve yourself. slightly different different way, way, feel free to many m o r e examples in this this you've been been taught taught a a slightly to use use it. We’ll We'll do do many more examples in chapter. chapter. N o w why vertex form? look at at the the numbers! It’s called vertex form reason. The The Now why do do we we care care about about vertex form? Well, look numbers! It's called vertex form for for aa reason. vertex (2, -‐25) vertex be found found just just by looking at the the numbers numbers in found the the vertex, 25) can can be looking at in the the equation. equation. But we we already already found vertex, you say! Yes, that’s true, but had to find the the roots roots to to do do so finding the o t always you that 's true, but we had so earlier, earlier, and and finding the roots roots is is nnot always so so easy. Vertex form vertex without knowing the quadratic. It’s also very much form allows allows us us to to find the the vertex without knowing the roots roots of of a a quadratic. It's also very much tested on the tested the SAT! SAT! One o t e ‐ o n e of o f the the most common mistakes students make = ((xx -‐ 2) 2)22 -‐ 2 and think One final n note-one most common mistakes students make iiss ttoo look look a att y = 255 and think the the vertex is at (‐ 2, 2, -25) ‐ 2 5 ) instead instead of of (2, (2 -‐ 225). 5 ) One One pattern pattern of of thinking avoid this What vertex is at (thinking II use use to to avoid this mistake mistake is is to to ask, ask, What value of x would would make expression inside parentheses eq11al equal to zero? 0. value make the the expression inside the parentheses zero? Well, x: x =2 2 would would make make xx ‐- 2 2 equal equal to to 0. Therefore, vertex is at xx‐ = ‐ 2. T h i sis thinking you get the the solutions solutions from from the Therefore,the the vertex This is the the same same type type of of thinking you would would use use to to get the factored factored form form y‐‐ y = (x ‐- a)(x a)(x -‐ b). b). The Discriminant The Discriminant If then the As we l l explain explain later, the If a a quadratic quadratic is in the the form form ax2 ax2 + bx + c, c, then the discriminant discriminant is is equal equal to to b2‐ b2 - 4ac. 4ac. As we '’ ll later, the discriminant' Before we we explain its significance, significance, let’ the discriminant IisSa a component component of of the the quadratic quadratic formula formula. Before explain its let'ss calculate calculate the discriminant for oour discriminant u r first example, example, 2 f(x) f(x) = xx2‐4x‐21 - 4x - 21 Discriminant Discriminant = = b2‐ 4ac = : ((‐4)2 : 100 b2 - 4ac - 4 )2 -‐ 4(1)(‐21) 4(1) ( - 21) = Now, what does the the discriminant di scriminant mean? Now, what does value of the doess not n o t matter. mean? Well, the the value the discriminant discriminant doe matter. What What matters matters is is sign of the the discriminant‐whether discriminant -w hether it's the sign it’s positive, positive, negative, negative, or zero. care that zero. In In other other words, words, we we don’t don't care that it’s it's 100, we we just just care care that that it's it’s positive positive.. Letting be short short for discriminant, discriminant, Letting D be W h e nDD = z O0,, When y W h e nDD > 00,, When y W h e nDD < O When 0,, y -----0-+----there are are ttwo there w o real t w o solutions). solutions) real roots roots ((two tthere h e r eis one one real real root. root. X there no real real roots. roots. there are are no The The Quadratic Quadratic Formula Formula we've seen, As we’ve seen, the important aspect aspect of a the roots roots are are the the most most important a quadratic. quadratic . Once Once you you have have the the roots, roots, things things like like ve rtex form form and vertex and the discriminant are are n o t as ashelpful. or work the discriminant not helpful. Unfortunately, Unfortunately, the roots roots aren’t aren't always always easy easy to to find find or work with. That’s That's when when vertex with. u m / product of the can get get us to the the answer vertex form, form, the the discriminant, discriminant, and and the the ssum/product the roots roots can us to answer faster. But if if we we m u s t find the there is always always one one surefire surefire way way to o ‐ t h e quadratic must the roots, roots , there to do do sso-the quadratic formula. formula. _ ‐b:|:\/b2‐4ac - b± Jb 2 - 4ac x= _T 2a forax2+bx+c:0. for ax2 + bx + c = 0. 148 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA For the purpose quadratic formula purpose of learning, learning, let’s let's apply apply the the quadratic formula to to our our example, example, f(x) = x 22‐- 44xx ‐- 2211 J(x) According to the According the formula, are formula, the the roots roots //ssolutions olutions are _4 m _= 44 x± 1100 _= ?or _ x_ = -‐(‐4)i,/(‐4)?‐4(1)(‐21) (- 4) ± J( - 4)2 - 4(1)( - 21) = 4 ± i/100 x ‐ T ‐ 2(1)T ‐ ‐ ‐ 27 0 2 r ‐ 33 These values that that we factoring.. These are are the the same same values we got got through through factoring Notice 4116, is is tucked tucked under under the o w does does this Notice that that the the discriminant, discriminant, 172 b2 -~ 4ac, the square square root root in in the the quadratic quadratic formula. formula. H How this help us know about the discriminant? help us understand understand what what we we know about the discriminant? takes effect effect and and we we end w o different Well, when when b2‐ b2 - 4ac > 0, 0, the the"“ :±l :"" takes end up up with with ttwo different roots. roots. When When 172 b2 ‐- 4ac 4ac = = 0, 0, the the ”" ±i "” does does not n o t have we’re essentially essentially adding of which which give give us us the same have an an effect effect since since we're adding and and subtracting subtracting 0, 0, both both of the same root.. When square root root of gives us us root When [72 b2 ‐- 4116 4ac < O, 0, we’re we're taking taking the the square of a a negative negative number, number, which which is is undefined undefined and and gives no real no real roots (we’ll talk number in in aa later roots (we'll talk about about imaginary imaginary number later chapter). chapter). Hopefully, you understand understand where meanings come come Hopefully, the the quadratic quadratic formula formula helps helps you where the the discriminant discriminant and and its its various various meanings from. Understanding from. will help you remember remember the Understanding this this connection connection will help you the concepts. concepts. Now that Now we’ve taken you on tour through that we've taken you on aa thorough thorough tour through the the properties properties of of quadratics, quadratics, we’ll we'll go go through through a a few few more examples more pace. examples to illustrate illustrate some some important important variations, variations, but but we’ll we'll do do so so at at a a much much faster faster pace. QUADRATIC 2: QUADRATIC 2: ff(x) (x) = : -x ‐x22 ++ 66xx‐- 1100 The Roots Roots This quadratic n d in fact, fact, if if we we look look at the discriminant, quadratic cannot cannot be be factored. factored. A And at the discriminant, ac = : (6) (6)22 -- 44(-1)( ( ‐ 1 ) ( ‐-110) 0 ) := ‐-44 b1922 -‐ 44ac it's negative, negative, which it’s are no no real real roots roots or solutions. solutions. The The graph the quadratic which means means there there are graph of of the quadratic makes makes this this even even more more clear: y 2 term When the coefficient coefficient of the When x2 negative, the the parabola shape of U.” the x term is negative, parabola is is in in the the shape of an an upside-down upside-down ”"U." 149 CHAPTER 17 CHAPTER 17 QUADRATICS QUADRATICS The The Sum Sum and and Product Product of the Roots Roots x ) = -‐x2 10 Jf ((x x 2 +66xx -‐ 10 b 6 Sum = - - = - - = 6 a -‐11 a C - 10 Product P r o d u c=t : -5 = z -_‐10 :=110 0 a -‐11 Sum= ‐9 = ‐i =6 what!? We already already determined determined that that there there were were no no roots roots.. How H o w can sum and and aa product Wait, what!? can there there be be a a sum product of roots roots that don’t exist? exist? Well, the the quadratic quadratic doesn't doesn’t have have any any real roots, have ima imaginary roots. The values roots, but but it does does have ginary roots. The values that don't above are are the the sum sum and and product product of these these imaginary imaginary roots roots.. We'll We’ll cover numbers in a above cover imaginary imaginary numbers a later later chapter. chapter. Vertex Form Because the roots roots are are imaginary, imaginary, we we can't can't use use their their midpoint midpoint to find these cases, cases, we we must must get get the the Because find the the vertex. vertex . In these quadratic quadratic in vertex vertex form. form. We'll We’ll have have to complete complete the the square square.. yyz‐x2+6x‐10 = - x 2 + 6x - 10 First, multiply multiply everything everything by negative negative 11 to get get the the negative negative out out of the Having the the negative negative there makes First, the x2 x 2 term. term . Having there makes later . things needlessly complicated ll multiply back by -‐11 later. things needlessly complicated.. We' We’ll multiply everything everything back -‐y:x2‐6x+10 y = x 2 - 6x + 10 get 9. Remember put the the -‐33 inside the Divide term by 2 to get -‐33 and Divide the the middle middle term and square square this this result result to get Remember that that we put inside the parentheses pieces in place, place, parentheses with with x and and subtract subtract the 99 at at the the end. end. Putting Putting these these pieces = (x‐3)2+10‐9 -‐ y =( x - 3) 2 + 10 - 9 = (xx -‐ 3) 3)22 + +11 -‐yy =( N o w multiply everything by by -‐11 again, again, Now multiply everything : -‐ ((xx -‐ 3) 3)22 -‐ 1 y= Now the vertex the graph graph is an upside-down ”U,” "U," -‐11 is the the Now it's it’s easy easy to see that that the vertex is at at (3, (3, -‐ 11)).. And And because because the an upside-down maximum value of Jf(x). (x). maximum value QUADRATIC QUADRATIC 3: 3: 2 f ( x ) = 2x 2x2+5x‐3 f(x) + 5x - 3 The Roots Roots The Wecan can factor this quadratic to get get We this quadratic 2x22 + + 5x -‐ 3 = = 0 2x ((2x 2x -‐ 1l ) ( Xx + 33)) = O 0 x X z 0.5, -‐33 = The roots roots are are 0.5 and you don't don’t know know how how we we factored factored this, teaching factoring the The and -‐ 33.. If you this, unfortunately unfortunately teaching factoring from from the ground up is not n o t within the scope scope of this this book. book. Don't Don’t be be afraid afraid to look look up factoring lessons lessons and and drills ground up within the up factoring drills online online and in your your textbooks. textbooks. It's It’s an an essential essential skill skill to have have.. Just Just know o u t there there involves involves a and know that that every every method method out a little little trial and error. And if you’re ever stuck, the quadratic formula is always an option. trial and error. And you're ever stuck , the quadratic formula always an option . 150 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA THE The The Sum Sum and and Product Product of the the Roots Roots 5 b Sum = -‐B = -‐§ = : -‐2.5 Sum 2.5 a a 2 2 C -3 Product = E = _‐3 = -‐ l1.5 .5 Product 22 a a= The The Vertex Averaging the the two t w o roots roots to find find the x-coordinate of the the vertex, Averaging the x-coordinate vertex, 0 5+ + (( ‐ 33)) =_ -‐2.5 0.5 2.5 =_ _ 25 _ 2 22 2 _ 1.25 1. Plugging Plugging this this into into f(x) f (x) to find find they-coordinate, the y-coordinate, 2(‐1.25)2 : ff(‐1.25) (- 1.25) = 2( - 1.25)2 + 5(‐1.25) 5( - 1.25) -‐ 3 3 = -‐6.125 6.125 The vertex vertex is at at (( ‐ l 1.25, . 2 5 , -‐6.125). Because the the quadratic quadratic opens shape of aa "U," ” U , ” the the minimum The 6.125). Because opens upward upward in the the shape minimum value is -‐6.l25. 6.125. value of J(x) f ( x ) is Vertex Form : 2x 2x22 + + 5x -‐ 3 y= 2 First, square, always make sure sure the the coefficient coefficient of xx2 First, divide divide everything everything by 2. Before Before completing completing the the square, always make is l. We'll We'll multiply multiply the the 22 back back later later.. y 5 3 2 2=X + 2X- 2 25 Divide result to get get~!. We put put the the~2 inside the parentheses with Divide the the middle middle term term by 2 to get~ get 2 and and square square this this result 1‐6. We inside the parentheses with 25 16 x and and subtract subtract the the 3‐2 at at the the end. end. -"‐<+?)2 E‘ x 4 2 16 z_ !!.. = (x+ §Y_9 ~)2 - 4916 22‘(x+4 4 16 Multiplying by 2, Multiplying I/ (x+ ~) 2 - 49 ‐2(x+§)2‐9 4 8 =2 ·3“ +125)2 yi, = 2(x + 1.25) 2 -‐ 6.125 This consistent with This is consistent with the the vertex vertex found found above above.. The Discriminant The Discriminant For let's calculate will confirm the fact that this For the the sake sake of completeness, completeness, let's calculate the the discriminant. discriminant. Hopefully, Hopefully, it will confirm the that this quadratic has two t w o distinct distinct real real roots roots.. quadratic has _ 2x22+ ‐ 2x + 5x 5x -_ 3 y= 3 2 - 4ac := (5) Discriminant = : b62‐ (5)22 -~ 4(2)(‐3) Discriminant 4(2)(-3) = 49 The that this this quadratic quadratic has has ttwo roots. The discriminant discriminant is positive, positive, which which confirms confirms the the fact that w o real real roots. 151 151 CHAPTER CHAPTER 17 QUADRATICS QUADRATTCS QUADRATIC QUADRATIC 4: f(x) 4x2 - 12x + 9 f(x) ==4x2-12x+9 The The Roots Roots We ld factor let's use the quadratic Wecou could factor this, but but let's use the quadratic formula formula instead. instead. b ± Jb 2 - 4ac _ -‐(‐12):t\/(‐12)2‐4(4)(9) x _ -‐bi\/b2‐4ac 1 2±1 \/6 (- 12) ± J( - 12)2 - 4(4)(9 ) _ 12 J6 _ 3-3 x =-----_ 2a 2a ' 2(4) _ 8 ‘:'z2 As one root, root,~As you you can can see, see, the discriminant discriminant is 0 and and the quadratic quadratic has has just one 2 2 The Sum Sum and Product Product of the Roots Roots - 12 b Sum = -‐~- = -‐‐ z 3 Sum = a 4 C 9 a 4 Product Product = - = - If we we only have aa sum and a a product are they they different different only have have one one root, root, how how is it that that we we can can have sum and product of two t w o roots? roots? Why Why are from found? from the the one root root we found? Here's a quadratic one root, really has has ttwo that are are the same. same. Here’s the thing. thing. While we we may may say a quadratic has just just one root, it really w o roots roots that 2 term, is expected to have two roots. When they're the same, we just refer to After After all, all, aa quadratic, quadratic, with an an xx2 term, expected have t w o roots. When they’re the same, we just refer to them them as as one one.. 9 So add them, and if we we multiply multiply them, them , we Soour o u r "two" ” t w o " roots roots are are ~3 and and ~. g. If we we add them, we we do do indeed indeed get 3, 3, and we do do get ~. Z. The Vertex The When aa quadratic root, the vertex is the same as the because aa When quadratic has has just just one one root, the x-coordinate x‐coordinate of the the vertex same as the root. root. That's That’s because quadratic quadratic is tangent tangent to the x-axis when when it has has one one root. root. y 0 Q 2 3 They-coordinate course, 0. Therefore, ( ~, O). 0). The minimum minimum value The y-coordinate is, of course, Therefore, the the vertex vertex is at at (5, value off of f (x) (x) is 0. 0. 152 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA Vertex Form = 4x 4x22 -‐ 12x + +9 y= 2 First, divide square, always always make make sure the coefficient coefficient of xx2 is 1. We'll First, divide everything everything by 4. 4. Before Before completing completing the the square, sure the We’ll multiply the back later. multiply the 44 back later. y1 : 22 _ 9 -4 = Xx - 3x+4 3X + -2 4 . . . 4 3 9 2 4 Divide the result to get get ~. We put the -‐%~ inside the parentheses parentheses D1v1de the middle middle term term by by 22 to get get -‐ ~5 and and square square this this result 1. We put the inside the 2 with with x and and subtract subtract the the ~g at at the the end. end. The The constants constants cancel cancel out. out. Multiplying by by 4, 4, Multiplying This consistent with found above. This is consistent with the the vertex vertex found above. Wow! We much everything to know about quadratics Wejust just covered covered pretty pretty much everything you you need need to know about quadratics.. Unfortunately, Unfortunately, we're we’re not not quite done as there you should should be exposed to. quite done yet yet as there are are aa few tough tough question question variations variations that that you be exposed EXAMPLE the xy-plane, y = x2 x 2 ‐- Sx EXAMPLE 1: In the xy-plane, the the parabola parabola with w i t h equation equation 31= 5x + + 6 intersects intersects the the line line y = = 3x -‐ 10 b). What the value at at point point (a, (a,b). What is is the value of b? b? This the systems systems of equations equations chapter, chapter, but reviewing it This is aa question question type type that that we we already already covered covered in the but we're we’re reviewing again here next few examples. examples. The concept is whenever again here because because it will will help help you you understand understand the the next The core core concept is that that whenever you have to find intersection point(s) solve the the system system consisting their equations. equations. The you have find the the intersection point(s) of two t w o graphs, graphs, solve consisting of their The solutions we have have solutions to the the system system are are the the intersection intersection points. points. Here, Here, we yy = x2 x 2 -‐ 5x Sx + +66 y = 3x 3x -‐ 10 10 Substituting into the Substituting the the second second equation equation into the first, first, 3x‐10zx2‐5x+6 3x - 10 = x 2 - Sx + 6 00 == x¥2 -‐ & Bx+ +m 16 : ((x x ‐- 44)F2 00 = x=4 x=4 To find find they, equations: y = 3(4) the y, we we plug plug x =z 44 into into either either of the the original original equations: 3(4) -‐ 10 10 =z 2. 2. Therefore, Therefore, the the point point of intersection is at at (4, (4, 2) and and b = = [I]. I. intersection 153 CHAPTER QUADRATICS 17 QUADRAncs CHAPTER 17 EXAMPLE 2: How man ' the gra h of = _ _ 2 . ‑ EXAMPLE2: How manyy times does the the 10 in the y = 10in line 31= the line intersect the 3 mm 6x + 3 y _ - xx2 + 6x p Ofy a calculator.) cannot use acalculator.) xy-plane?(You cannotuse xy-plane? graph We’re dealing with the intersection of two graphs again. Sowhat do we do?"> We:re deal~g with the intersection of two gra hs a ain. So wh of consisting Of the system solve the We solwg we do . We at do th fj ti~ . g the eguat10ns. their the" equations, Substih1ting Substituting the the second second eq equation system C°"5i5ti"8 get we get rst, we into e first ua on into 1 0=: -‐x2+6.r+3 x + 6x + 3 10 2 + 6x 6x‐- 7 7 x2 + = -‐x2 00z Now and finish this to intersection point(s) just like previous the previous in the did in we did like we point(s) just the intersection find the to find solving this finish solving ~,ead and go ahead couldgo we could Now we example, but there’s a faster way. For the purposes of this question, we don ’t care where the intersection points points intersection where care 't don we question, this of purposes the example, but theres a faster way. For are. We just want to know how many there are. there many how know want just We are. that. the discriminant Sound discriminant to do do that. use the can use We can familiar? We Sound familiar? 2 4(: (6) (6)22 ‐- 4 ( ‐ 11)() ( ‐ 77)) := 8 Discriminant: b2‐ - 4ac = Discriminant = b there are 2 above . If there up above. we set up equation we are 2 solutions there are The discriminant which means solutions to the equation means there positive, which discriminant is positive, bother finding didn't bother points . To summarize, there must solutions must be be [I} intersection intersection points. summarize, we didn’t finding above, there equation above, the equation solutions to the might've points intersection the and care, we all for 100 = x and 2 = been x could've been the two and and the intersection points might’ve values of x. They could’ve two values the used the we used and we them, and of them, were ttwo there were that there mattered was doesn't matter. ). It doesn’t been and (100,6 (100,6). matter. What What mattered was that w o of (2,5 ) and been (2,5) And point. intersection one be only would that. If the discriminant discriminant determine that. discriminant were were 0, there there would be one intersection point. And ifif discriminant to determine . points intersection points. no intersection be no would be there would than 0, there were less than discriminant were the discriminant points intersection points the intersection where the out where and figure out back and understand this question you understand Make sure Make sure you question.. Feel free to go go back so was so discriminant was the discriminant why the That 's why formula . That’s need the fun . You'll not fun. It's not (Hint: It's are (Hint: actually are actually You’ll need the quadratic quadratic formula. helpful). helpful). EXAMPLES: EXAMPLE3: y -‐ kk = = 0O = x2-3x + 1 yy=x2‐3x+l system the system does the k does of It the following of the For which constant. For a constant. is a k is above, k equations above, system of equations the system Jn the in which of following values values of solutions? equations have of equations have no no real real solutions? A) ‐22 A)- B) -‐11 C)O D) 1 equation , second equation, the second into the equation and we get y = First, we First, z k from the first equation and substitute substitute this this into kk = x2 +1l 3x + x 2 -‐ 3x O=z x22-‐ 33xx + ((11-‐ kk)) O The real solution no real have no should have above should equation above the equation then the solution, then real solution, no real has no equations has system of equations If If the system solution.. The than 0. be less than discriminant should discriminant should be 4k 4k = 4(1)(1 -‐ k) = 9 ‐- 4 + 3)2 -‐4(1)(1 b2 -‐ 44ac Discriminant = 172 Discriminant: a c = ((‐3)2 +4k z 55 + +4k answer 2, answer Only -~2, negative. Only being negative. 4k being + 4k 5+ in 5 which one to see choices to each of the test each Now N o w we test the answer answer choices see which one results results in discriminant. negative discriminant. a negative produces a ~ produces back Go back SAT. Go the SAT. on the see on might see you might questions you toughest questions the toughest far showcase so far done so 've done examples we The examples we've showcase some some of of the them . understand them. make sure and make and sure you you understand 154 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA EXAMPLE n) = ‐100n2 - 10Qn2 + 000n to model model the population EXAMPLE 4: A biologist biologist uses uses the the function function p( p(n) + 1, 1,000n population of seagµlls seagulls equivalent forms of p(n) p(n) displays on aa beach beach in year number number n, where where 1 ~ 5 n ::; S 10. Which of the the following equivalent displays which the population reaches that the the maximum maximum population population of seagulls seagulls and and the the number number of the year in which population reaches that maximum maximum as as constants constants or coefficients? ‘ A) 4n(25n -‐ 250) A) p(n) = -‐4n(25n B) 10(10n2 -‐ 100n) B) p(n) p(n) = -‐10(10n2 10011) C) p(n) = -‐100(n lOO(n-‐ 5)2 + 2,500 C) D) lOO(n- 7) 4,900 D) p(n) = -‐100(n 7)22 + +4,900 Anytime maximum or minimum output (i.e. (i.e. Anytime you you see see a quadratics quadratics question question that deals deals with with the maximum minimum of a function function output the y-value), either figure out the vertex or look for vertex form. After all, the the maximum y-value), either figure look After all, the vertex vertex is where where the maximum or minimum minimum occurs occurs.. In fact, fact, the the answer answer is is either either (C) (C) or (D) because those are are the only only ones vertex form form.. because those ones in vertex Furthermore, with that (D) does does not the original original equation Furthermore, with a little little calculation, calculation, it's it's easy easy to see that n o t expand expand to be be the equation,, so so the the answer answer is (C). However, learning purpo ses (and questions), I'll this question question in ttwo However, for learning purposes (and for the the tougher tougher questions), I’ll show show you you how how to do do this wo different ways ways.. We We can can find the the vertex vertex using using the the average average of the roots roots and vertex form form.. different and then then reverse reverse engineer engineer vertex Or we transform the the equation we can can transform equation into into vertex vertex form form directly. directly. Solution and factor, Solution 1: To find the roots, roots, we we set set the the equation equation equal equal to O 0 and 0 -400,12 100n 2 + 1,000n 1,000n = 0 -‐100n(n lO0n(n -‐ 10) = z 0 : 0,10 n= 0, 10 The roots vertex is 5. Now roots are are O 0 and and 10, which which means means the the x-coordinate x-coordinate of the vertex Now we we can can plug plug 5 into into p(n) to find find the y-coordinate.. they-coordinate : -‐100(5)2 +1,000(5) : 2,500 2,500 p(5) = 100(5) 2 + 1, 000(5) = So 2500). Now So the the vertex vertex is at (5, (5,2500). N o w remember remember what what vertex vertex form form looks looks like: y = : a(x -‐ h) h)22 + + k. Given Given our o u r values, values, we have have = a(n -‐ 5) 5)22 + + 2,500 p(n) = 2,500 We now another point point to work work with easy to see that n o w need need to find what what a is. To do that, that, we we need need another with.. Well, it's it’s easy that p(n) passes ). Plugging passes through through the the point point (0,0 (0, O). Plugging that that in, in, 0= z a(O a(0 -‐ 5)2 + + 2,500 2,500 o 2 25a 2511 + + 2,500 0= 2,500 2,500 -‐25a 25a = 2,500 a == -‐100 100 [@[J . Finally, p(n) = -‐100(n 5)22 + 2, 2,500. Answer (C) . Finally, lO0(n - 5) 500. Answer 155 QUADRATICS 17 QUADRATICS CHAPTER CHAPTER 17 divide First, divide directly . First, form directly. vertex form the square involves completing method involves second method This second Solution completing the square to get the vertex Solution 2: This l. coefficient of 1n122 is 1. the coefficient ensure the - 100 to ensure everything by ‐100 everything p(n)) = 1,00011 + 1,00011 - 100n2 + = ‐100n2 p(n POI) _ 2 - lOn p(n) = ‐‐_100 ‐n n2_ lOn - 100 lOn. be -‐10n. would be term would "middle" term end, the ”middle" what to do next? you remember Do you remember what next? If If we wrote wrote the the constant constant 0 at the end, and the with n and parenthe ses with the parentheses inside the belong s inside - 5 belongs that to get and square get -‐55 and the ‐- 110 Divide the Divide 0 by 2 to get square that get 25. The The ‐5 end . the end. at the subtracted at 25 gets subtracted 25 p01) _ (n 25 (n -‐ 5)2 p(n) = W _ 5)2 ‐- 25 - 100 - 100. back by ‐100. everything back multiply everything can multiply we can Now N o w we 2,500 + 2,500 p(n) = ‐100(n 5)22 + - l00 (n -‐ 5) . [@IJ that the again, we prove And again, And prove that the answer answer is (C) . 156 THE COLLEGE PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE Review: Review: + c,c, ax2 + bx form, y = the form, Given = ax2 bx+ quadratic of the Given aaquadratic ways: following ways: the following be found The roots, also also called called solutions solutions and and x-intercepts, x‐intercepts, can can be found in the The roots, 0 Factoring • Factoring 0 on the the calculator calculator (look for the the x-intercepts) x‐intercepts) (look for Graph on • Graph o The quadratic formula x = quadratic formula • The m -‐ bb± ✓bi2 - 4ac 2a 211 = - -ab Sum of the the Roots Roots = ‐5 Sum C Product of the Roots = = -2 the Roots Product a 2 - 4ac ThediscriminantD =b b2‐4ac The discriminant D = solutions. 0 When D > > 0, w o real real solutions. are ttwo there are 0, there • When one real When D = 0, there is one real solution. solution. 0, there •0 When solutions. real solutions. 0 are no no real there are 0, there When D < 0, • When the vertex, vertex, find the To find get to get quadratic to the quadratic that value Then plug 0 average of the the roots roots to get get the the x-coordinate. x-coordinate. Then plug that value into into the the average Take the • Take the y-coordinate. y-coordinate. the square . the quadratic Put the quadratic in vertex vertex form form by by completing completing the square. •0 Put 2 is positive 1 by dividing everything by a. coefficient of xx2 Ensure the the coefficient positive 1by dividing everything by 1. Ensure C b 2 y =x2+ x+ +x -a = X + -E a a b b2 b that result Square that 2a. Square get 2. term bx to getZa middle term the middle 2. Divide Divide the the coefficient coefficient of the result to to get g e4a1,22 t 2‐ .. PPutu 2a 2a t ‐ 2. ! 2 end. the end. subtract £72 at the with x and inside parentheses with and subtract the parentheses inside the z_(.+£)2+£_i +:. - ~ (x+ _!:_)2 a 4a 2a a ¥_= a_ 211 by a. 3. everythingby Multiply everything 3. Multiply 2 b 2 a 4:122 2 b2 c ‐ ‐b ‑ = a ( x +-b ) + c-yy=a(x+‐‐2) 4a 2a actual with actual quadratics with on quadratics variables. Practice the variables. with the 4. IIt's t ’s unnecessary unnecessary to memorize memorize these these steps steps with Practice on k. + )2 h a(x = y like: looks form vertex numbers. However, do do remember remember what what vertex form looks like: y : a(x‐- h)2 + k. numbers. However, a quadratic, find minimum or the minimum asked for the you're asked Whenever or the the maximum maximum of aquadratic, find the the vertex. vertex. Whenever you're 157 QUADRATICS CHAPTER 17 QUADRATICS CHAPTER 17 CHAPTER EXERCISE: Answers for this chapter start on page 314. the used on the be used NOT should N calculator should A calculator O T be following questions. following questions. 3x2+10x=8 3x 2 + lOx = 8 equation the equation solutions to the If w o solutions the ttwo are the and b are If a and ? b2 ? value of If2 the value above what is the > b, what and a > above and the between the the distance what is the xy-plane, what the xy-plane, In the distance between parabola the parabola x-intercepts of the ttwo w o x-intercepts yy = x2 10?? 3x ‐- 10 x2 ‐- 3x 4 A) 9 2 B) 3 A) 3 B) 5 C) 4 C) 16 D) 16 D) C) 7 D)) 110 D 0 fJ(x) (x) = =m[(x‐m)2‐l] m [(x - m) 2 - 1] to x 2 + 4x + 2 = 0 ? solutions tox2+4x+2=0? the solutions What are the Whatare positive a positive m is a above, m defined above, hmction ff defined the function In the A i fi = z- 2‐ ±Z vf2 A) ) x x B n/i B)) x x= 2z±e2v12 C) ) Xx=C = ‐ 22 i±22y12 \/§ D = ‐- 44 i±Z2,/2 \/§ D)) xx= xy-plane is a the xy-plane offf in the graph of The graph constant. The constant. following statements the following parabola. statements Whkh of the parabola . Which true? parabola is true? the parabola about the about ( m, ‐- 11). at (m, occurs at minimum occurs A) [Its t s minimum ). - m). at (m, ‐m). occurs at minimum occurs Its minimum B) Its B) 1). (nz, ‐- 1). at (m, occurs at C) maximum occurs Its maximum C) Its m). (m, -‐ m at (m, occurs at maximum occurs Its maximum D) Its D) ). = 0, what is the value 7a + 3 =O,whatisthevalue 2a 2 ‐- 7a+3 lIff a < 1 and 2a2 l and o a?? off a yy = ‐- 33 2 yzx2+cx y = x + ex constant. a constant. c is a above, 0is equations above, system of equations In the system ln the the does the values of c does following values the following For which of the For which real exactly ttwo have exactly equations have system w o real system of equations solutions? solutions? solutions of the solutions the ssum What u m of the What is the 2 =4x+5? (2x‐3)2 (2x - 3) = 4x + 5? A A)) -‐ 4 B) 1 C) 2 D) 3 158 THE PANDA THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA A calculator is allowed on the following questions. m 2 ‐- 100m -‐ 120,000 P= = m2 120,000 The The monthly monthly profit profit of a mattress mattress company company can can be modeled modeled by the equation equation above, above, where Pisis be by the where P the profit, profit, in dollars, dollars, and and m is the number of the the number mattresses sold. the minimum minimum number number mattresses sold. What What is the of mattresses sell in a given mattresses the the company company must must sell a given month so that it does not lose money during that month so that does not lose money during that month? month? At which the following following points does the which of the points does the line line the parabola parabola with with equation equation y = z 4 intersect intersect the y = (x + 2)2 2)2 -‐ 55 in the xy-plane? the xy-plane? A) 1,4 ) and A) ((‐1,4) and (( ‐ 55,, 4 ) B) 5,4 ) B) (1,4 (1,4)) and and ((‐5,4) C) (1,4 ) and 4) C) (1,4) and (5, (5,4) D) 11, 4) and D) ((‐11,4) and (7,4 (7,4)) y E(x) = 50x 50x22 ‐- 8003: + 10,000 10,000 E(x) = B00x + The function function above above models the relationship relationship The models the between the the total total monthly expenses E, in dollars, dollars, between monthly expenses its restaurant and and the the number tables x in its of a restaurant number of tables dining area, area, where where O::; What does does the the dining O5 x::; x 5 25. What number 10,000 represent the function? function? number represent in the (3, -8) maximum number tables that A) The The maximum number of tables that can can fit in the the dining dining area area Which of the following equation s represents the parabola shown in the xy-plane above? A) y = (x - 3)2 - 8) y =(x+ C) y = 2(x - average monthly expenses, in dollars, dollars, B) The The average monthly expenses, for each table in the dining room room each table the dining C) The dollars,, The total total monthly monthly expenses, expenses, in dollars when there there are tables in the dining when are zero zero tables the dining 8 3)2+ 8 area area 3)2 - 8 D) The The total total monthly monthl y expenses, expenses , in dollars, dollars, when the the number number of tables tables in the the dining dining when area maximized area is maximized D) y= 2(x+ 3)2- 8 2 For value oft of t does the equation equation vv = St St -‐ tt2 does the For what what value result in the maximum value value of v ? result the maximum f (x) = - x 2 + 6x + 20 The defined above above.. Which the The function function f is defined Which of the following forms of f (x) displays the (x ) displays the following equivalent equivalent forms maximum value of f as maximum value as a a constant constant or coefficient? coefficient? A ( x )=: ‐-(( xx‐-3 3)2 ) 2 ++ 11 A)) ff (x) 11 2 B ) f ( x ) : ‐ ( x ‐ 3 ) 2 + 2 9 B) f (x) = -(x - 3) + 29 C) f(x)=‐(x+3)2+11 C) f(x) = - (x + 3)2 + 11 D) D) ff(x):‐(x+3)2+z9 (x)=-(x+ 3)2+ 29 159 CHAPTER 17 QUADRATICS CHAPTER 17 QUADRATICS yy = = ‐- 33 g(x) = - 3x 2 + 18x The gives the the data The function function 3 g above above gives data transfer transfer speed, second, over network speed, in megabytes megabytes per per second, over a a network connection connection x minutes minutes after after a file transfer transfer was was initiated. g(x) in the xy-plane initiated. The The graph graph of y = = g(x) the xy-plane has c. Which Which of of the has x-intercepts x-intercepts at at x = 0 0 and and x = c. the following is the following the value value the best best interpretation interpretation of the y=ax2+4x‐4 y = ax2 + 4x - 4 In the system of equations constant. the system equations above, above, a a is aa constant. For which of the the following For which does the following values values of a a does the system of equations equations have system have exactly exactly one one real real solution? solution? cC _7 ?. of 2 A)) -‐ 4 A 2 B)) -‐ 2 B A) The The initial initial data data transfer transfer speed speed over over the the network connection connection network C) 2 D)) 4 D B) B) The speed over over the the The maximum maximum data data transfer transfer speed network connection connection network C) The data transfer The time time at which which the the data transfer speed speed over the the network network connection over connection was was at its highest highest f ( x ) = x 2‐ 24x +180 time at which D) The The time which the the file transfer transfer completed completed For a a manufacturer For x‐ray machines machines,, the manufacturer of x-ray the cost per unit, in thousands per unit, thousands of dollars, can be dollars , can be modeled modeled the function function f above, above, where by the where x is the the weekly weekly number of units units produced. produced. How number How many many units units should the the manufacturer manufacturer produce produce each should week to each week minimize the the cost minimize cost per per unit? unit? y = a(x - 3)(x - k) the quadratic In the are quadratic equation equation above, above, a a and and k are constants. If constants. graph of the If the the graph the equation equation in the the xy-plane is a xy-plane (5, -‐32), a parabola parabola with with vertex vertex (5, 32), what what is the the value value of a ? ? A) 2 B) 5 C) 6 D) 8 f(x) = : -‐4x2 x J(x) 4x 2 + 2 22x The function The function ff above above gives gives the the data data transfer transfer speed, in megabytes per per second, speed, megabytes second, over over a a network network connection x minutes connection transfer was was minutes after after a a file transfer initiated. graph of y = J(x) f(x) in the xy-plane initiated . The The graph the xy-plane has x-intercepts at = 0 and = b. Which has x-intercepts at x = and x = Which of of the the following is the following the best best interpretation interpretation of b b?? In the line y = = 2x + + b intersects the xy-plane, xy-plane , the the line intersects the the parabola at the point (3,k). If parabola y = = x2 x 2 + bx + 5 5 at the point (3, k). If b b is a constant, is the constant, what what the value value of k ? A) 0 A) The the The initial initial data data transfer transfer speed speed over over the network connection network connection speed over over the the B) The The maximum maximum data data transfer transfer speed network network connection connection C) The The time time at at which which the the data data transfer transfer speed speed over a s at its its over the the network network connection connection w was highest highest The time at which D) The time at which the the file transfer transfer completed completed B) 1 C) 2 D) 3 160 18 e • Division Synthetic Division Synthetic way you same way the same another in the involves dividing Synthetic dividing one one polynomial polynomial by another you divided divided numbers numbers in in 3rd 3rd division involves Synthetic division grade. . grade xx 2 2++ 3x 3 x 7 22 1 8 R 2 3 5 6 3156 R R ‐- 1] + 2x2 5x + 1 xv1|Fx3+2x2~5x+1 x - 1 Ix 3 several shortcuts towards several you towards direct you then direct way first, but "mathematical" way I'll teach l’ll teach you you the long long “mathematical” but then shortcuts that that will will get get questions way. These long way. without using on the SAT without you through through almost almost any any synthetic synthetic division division question question on using the long These questions you do, they'll rarely show up, up, and and if they do, they’ll show show up up only only once once.. rarely show synthetic division. to synthetic applies to same logic applies can see how by 33 so Let’s retrace steps of dividing dividing 56 56by so you you can how the same division. retrace the steps Let's to get and a 1 x 3 = on top once . We put First, we see that that 3 goes into into 5 once. put aa 1“1on top and z 3 below below the 5. We then then subtract subtract to get 22 First, and down. bring the 6 dOWn. and bring l 6 3156 3 26 26 below the 24 below into 26? 8 times does 3 go into times does many times N o w how how many times.. So we put put an 8 up top and and a 3 x 8 = z 24 the 26. 26. Now Subtracting, Subtracting, we get 2. l 8 3156 3 2 6 2 4 - 2- eighteen into 2. Therefore does nnot and 3 does At this point, point, there there are are no more m o r e digit digitss to bring bring down down and o t go into Therefore,, 3 goes iinto n t o 56 56 eighteen At form: following the in written be can result This two times w i t h a remainder of t w o . result can be written following remainder with times 56 = 18~ 3 3 divisor . and 3 is the divisor. quotient, 2 is the remainder where 18 18is the quotient, remainder,, and is the where 161 CHAPTER 18 18 SYNTHETIC SYNTHETIC DIVISION CHAPTER DIVISION The process The essentially the the same. same. To show you you how synthetic division division works, process of dividing dividing a a polynomial polynomial is essentially To show how synthetic works, let’s let's 3 + 2x divide divide xx3+ 2x22 -‐ Sx 5x + ll by by x -‐ l.1. 3? xx22 times. 3. We H o w many many times We How times does does x -‐ 1 l go into into xx3? times. Why? Why? Because Because xx xx x2 x2 = = x3. x3. The The goal goal is is to to match match xx3. 3- x 2 . This don’t i n " step. step. Now, Now, (x 1) xx x2 x2. what we we put don ' t care care about about the the -‐11 during during this this ”fitting "fitting in" (x ‐- 1) x2 = xx3‐ This is is what put below below dividend. the dividend. xx22 3 xx -‐ l1x j x3 ++ 22xx2 2- ‐ 5Sxx ++ 11 xx33 ‐ x x2 2 Finally, we subtract like we Finally, we subtract do in basic number division. division. Notice Notice that subtract each we do basic number that we we must must subtract each element, element, sothe so the -~x2 x2 2 2 becomes x , yielding becomes + +x2, yielding 3x2. Unlike in long long division division with dividend 3x . Unlike with numbers, numbers, all the remaining remaining terms terms from the the dividend should be be brought brought down down for each should each step step in synthetic synthetic division. division. x2 x2 xx33 xX -‐ l11 ++ 22xx22- ‐ 5Sxx ++ 11 x3 x 3 ‐ x x2 2 3 x2 2- ‐ Sx 5 x++ 11 3x 2 ? 3x Next step. step. H How many times time s. Remember Next o w many times does does x -‐ 1 go into into 3x 3x2? 3x times. o u r goal Remember our goal at each each step step is to get the same same exponent exponent and and the the same same coefficient the term with the highest the coefficient as as the term with +3x up and highest power. power . We put put the the +3x up top top and 3x x (x -‐ 1) = 3x2 3x 2 -‐ 3x 3x on on the the bottom. bottom . 3x x2 x 2++ 33xx + 22xx2 2- ‐ 5 + 11 Sx x + xx -‐ 1 l jxx33 + xx33 -‐ x x2 2 3 x2 2 ‐ Sx 5 x++ 11 3x 3 x2 2 ‐ 33xx 3x And just like last last time, subtract each each term, term, nnot And time, we subtract o t just just the 1. the first. We then then bring bring down down the the 1. x2 x 2 ++ 33xx x ‐ 111 xx33 ++ 22xx2 2- ‐ 5 + 11 Sx x + x3 x 3 ‐ xx2 2 3 x2 2- ‐ Sx 5 x++ 11 3x 2 - 3x 3x2‐3x 3x -‐ 22xx + + 1 1 X - 162 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA We’re How many many times does xx -‐ l1 go go into 1? -‐22 times times.. So up top and We're almost almost done. done. How times does into -‐ 22xx + + 1? So a a ‐2 - 2 goes goes up top and 1) = = -‐ 22xx + 2 goes the bottom. bottom. -‐22 x (x -‐ 1) goes on on the x2 x 2+ + 3x 3 x ‐ 22 x33 ++ 22xx2 2 ‐ 5 5xx ++ 1 xx -‐ 1 l lx 1 ‘% xr :1 ‐ x2 x2 2 2 ‐ 5x 3xx 3 5 x++ 11 3x 2 3x2‐3x 3x ‐ 22xx ++ 1 1 ‐ 22xx ++ 2 Subtracting, we Subtracting, we get get ‐1 - 1 at at the the end. end . x2 X - + 3x 3 1 1x + 2x 2 x3 3 : 3 ‐ xx2 2 2 5x + 1 2 2 ‐5x 3x x 3 5 x+ + 11 3x 2 3x2‐3x 3x ‐ 22xx ++ 1 ‐ 22xx ++ 2 -‐11 . . 56 2 . . 56 know we're we’re done With a constant. constant. And 185, m1xed fraction, fraction, We know done when when we end end up with And Just just as as we can can express express ‐3‐ as as 18~, aa mixed 3 we we can can express express x33++22xx 22_- 5x 5 x+ + 1 as x2+3x‐2‐ 2 11 as X + 3x - 2 - -x -‐ 1l x -‐ 1l Notice where Notice each component component is placed. placed. The The quotient u t in remainder, -‐ 11,, is is the the where each quotient is written written oout in front. front. The The remainder, numerator of the numerator fraction and the divisor, x ‐ 1, is the denominator. These placements are exactly the same as the fraction and the divisor, - l, is the denominator. These placements are exactly the same as long division in long Get used used to to seeing seeing synthetic results in in this division with with actual actual numbers. numbers . Get synthetic division division results this format. format. Here’s another that’s the the same. same. The The result result of of our o u r long long division numbers Here's another thing thing that's division with with numbers 1 8 R 2 3 5 6 3156 means 56 = 18 + 2. means that that 56 = 3 x 18 The same meaning applies our synthetic synthetic division The same meaning applies to to our division result. result . x3+2x2‐5x+1=(x‐1)(x2+3x‐2)‐1 x 3 + 2x 2 - 5x + 1 = (x - l ) (x 2 + 3x - 2) - 1 Dividend = = Quotient Quotient x Divisor Remainder Dividend Divisor + Remainder Hopefully you've you've been to grasp synthetic division o r e intuitively Hopefully been able able to grasp synthetic division m more intuitively through through the the comparison comparison with with regular regular long the parts each other other in in the where long division. division. A Alll l the parts relate relate to each the same same way. way. Let's Let's dive dive into into some some more more examples examples where we show you we can can show you some some shortcuts. shortcuts. 163 CHAPTER CHAPTER 18 18 SYNTHETIC SYNTHETIC DIVISION DIVISION 6 5 EXAMPLE expression (2:25 x - is equivalent the following? following? EXAMPLE 1: The The expression equivalent to which which of the x+ 2 17 A’6“m x+2 A)6 -~ B)6+ 7 _2_ B)6+x+2 x+2 6 -‐ 5 C) 6-5 07 5 0)6 - - 9’6‘52 2 Using division, Using synthetic synthetic division, 6 x X + 22 I6x 6x + ‐ 5 6x + + 12 6x ‐ 17 17 The quotient quotient is 6 and and the the remainder remainder is -‐ l17. 7 . We We can can write write this this result xl‐ZZ'-An Answer The result as6 as 6 -‐ ~ swer~-(A) . x +2 ~ Now question without division? N o w how how would would we we approach approach this this question without using using synthetic synthetic division? 6xx-‐ 5 6(2) 77 . 6 6 ( 2 )- ‐ 5 We up.. Let's say x == 22.. ' IThen w e ccan a nplug p1u g in l n numbers n u mb ers that t hat we w e make m ak eup Let ’ssayx ' he n --x + 2 = ---2 + 2 = ‐-4 . x+2 2+ 2 4 7 n o w look look for an an answer answer choice choice that that gives gives 2 when when x = z 2. We can rule out right away away since We now can rule out (C) and and (D) right since they they 4 i· don't give give 2. Plugging Plugging x = z 2 into into answer answer (A) gives gives don't _17_617 x+2 _ 4 2417 4 4 7 4 This making up numbers and testing each each answer This confirms confirms that that the the answer answer is indeed indeed (A) (A).. This This strategy strategy of making up numbers and testing answer choice be much choice can can be much faster faster than than synthetic synthetic division. division. 7 EXAMPLE 2: When 3x 2 + 4 is divided by x - 1, the result is A + -. What is A in terms of x ? EXAMPLBthensz+4isdividedbyx‐1,theresultisA+;‐_7:‐1.WhatisAintermsofx? x- 1 A)3x A ) 3 x-‐ 4 B)3x-3 B)3x‐3 C)3x C ) 3 x++ 3 D)3x+4 D)3x+4 Using synthetic synthetic division, division, Using 3x + 3 x X 3x22 + 4 -‐ 1 I3x 3x22 -‐ 3x 3x 3x + 4 3x ‐ 3 7 If you followed along, clunky when when we subtracted subtracted the the -‐ 33xx and and brought brought you followed along, you you should've should’ve noticed noticed it got got aa little little clunky the 4 down. That’s because because the the dividend, dividend, 3x 3x22 + + 4, 4, has has no no x term. process is the the down. That's term. Still, the the process the same: same: subtract subtract and and bring the remaining terms terms down. down. bring the remaining 164 THE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA THE COLLEGE L1. 2 4 : 3x + + 7 The quotient quotient is 3x 3x + + 3 and the remainder 7. The The result result can as 33x +14 Now x + The and the remainder is 7. can be be expressed expressed as = 3x + 3 + _ __ Now x ‐- 1 x -‑ 1 it’s easy easy to see see that that A = = 3x 3x + + 3, 3, answer answer ~-(C) . it's Again, we we could've could’ve done done thi thiss question question by by making making up up numbers. lf x = 2, then Again, = 2, then numbers. If 2 3x22 + +44 _ 3(2) 3(2)2+4 3x +4 16 - xx---‐ 1 1- = - 2 2---‐ 1 1- = 216 If we we didn't didn’t know know the the answer answer was was (C), (C), we we would would test test each answer choice with xx = 22 until 16, but since If each answer choice with until we we got got 16, but since we do do know, know, we'll we’ll test (C) first for confirmation. confirmation. Letting Letting A = = 3x 3x + + 3, we test (C) 3, 7 7 3X+3+m ‐3(2)+3+m ~ ‐99++77=: 116 6 + 3 + -= 3(2) + 3 + -= x- 1 2- 1 3x Answer Answer confirmed. confirmed. 2 4 1 EXAMPLE 3: If the expression Sx - ~ + is written in the form Sx + 6 + __!!_, where B is a constant, EXAMPLEB:Hfl\eexpressim-5’:2‐Jt_‐__4ii‐liswritteniritheform5x+6+‐B-,whereBisaconstant, xx-‐ 2 x- 2 what is the value off B ? whatisthe value o Based division. Based on on where where it is, is, B represents represents the the remainder remainder of the the division. 5x 5 x+ + x -‐ X 6 2 I5x 5x2‐ 4x 4x 2 +1 + 1 2 5x2‐10x 5x lOx 6 6x x ++ 1 6x ‐ 12 13 13 13 r:;---:;-i Wecan can write write the the result result of this this division division as as5x x _ 2,, from from which = L.llJ. -. We Sx + 6 + -which B = 2 xThis last last example example is perfect perfect for demonstrating demonstrating aa shortcut shortcut called remainder theorem, get This called the remainder theorem, which which allows allows us us to get the remainder without without going going through through synthetic synthetic division. division. the remainder In Example Example 3, 3, we we divided divided Sx 5x22 -‐ 4x 4x + + 11by 2. Whenever Whenever a divided by by a which is is 1n by xx -‐ 2. a polynomial polynomial is divided a monomial, monomial, which just something something in the the form form of ax ax + b, b, the remainder can can be be found the va value the remainder found by by plugging plugging in to the the polynomial polynomial the lue just that makes makes the the monomial monomial equal equal to to 0. The The process process sounds m o r e complicated than it is, so let’s of xx that sounds more complicated than is, so let's show show how how it’s done done.. it's What makes 0? x = z 2. What makes x -‐ 2 equal equal to O? Plug xx = 22 into the polynomial polynomial 5x 5x22 -‐ 4x 4x + 1. 1. Plug into the 5(2)22 -‐ 4(2) + +11 = 13 13 5(2) A n d that's that’s the the remainder remainder we we obtained obtained in Example Example 3. And 165 DIVISION SYNTHETIC DIVISION 18 SYNTHETIC CHAPTER 18 CHAPTER l? + 1? divided by x + - 2x 2 + when ‐23(2 remainder when the remainder What is the What + 5x is divided polynomial, the polynomial, into the Plugging that zero? x = -‐ 11.. Plugging to zero? equal to makes x + what makes Well, what + l1equal that into 7 ‐2(‐1)2+5(‐1) - 2(- 1) 2 + 5(- 1) = -‐7 the remainder - 7 is the Boom. ‐7 Boom. remainder.. l? divided by 2x 4x 4 + when 4x4 remainder when What + 3x 3x22 -‐ 4 is divided 2x -‐ 1? the remainder What is the 1 zero? x = equal to zero? makes 2x -‐ 1 equal What makes What z 2'. 2 polynomial, the polynomial, into the Plugging that into Plugging that 2 - 4 = 41+ 43- 4 = - 3 (21) + 3 (1) 4 4 2 remainder. the remainder. Boom . -‐33 is the Boom. .· 2x2‐5x+1. .· m .· alent form 2x + 1 + -x-R R . ·. th e equiv 2x2x- _Sx + 1 IS· wntten uv"' 11.•PLE If th e expression __- , what is the EXAMPLEdzlftheexpreesmn‐‐;‐:§‐‐1swnttenmtheeqmvalentform2x+l+m,whatrsfire 3 3 J;,.IUUT-1, A ,,.: . value of R? valueofR? plug in can plug we can theorem, we remainder theorem, the remainder Using the by x -‐ 3. Using R represents after dividing dividing 2x 2x22 -‐ 5x + 11by remainder after the remainder represents the 2 remainder. the get the remainder. x = 3 into + 1 to get 2x -‐ 5x + into 2x2 2(3)2‐5(3)+1=18‐15+1=. 2(3) 2 - 5(3) + 1 = 18 - 15 + 1 = [±J division . synthetic division. No need for synthetic No need Plugging in 2, 2. Plugging x 2 ‐- 3x + 2 by x ‐- 2. divide x2 we divide that we theorem . Let's remainder theorem. the remainder about the thing about One Let’s say say that 2, we we last thing One last see remainder is the remainder that the see that (2)22 -‐ 33(2) +2 =0 2z (2) + (2) factor we factor indeed, if we factor of 18. And a factor like 3 is a x 2 -‐ 3x + 2, just remainder is 0, x ‐- 2 is a factor of x2 the remainder Since just like And indeed, Since the 2 ‐ 3x + 2, x2 2, + 3x x 1) 2)( x ‐- 1) (x -‐ 2)(X (x that x -‐ 2 is in fact a factor. we see see that connected? math is connected? everything in math how everything Don’t love how just love you just Don't you 1? x 3 + 1? factor of x3 1 a factor + 1a example, is x + easier . For example, much easier. become much Some o w become questions nnow Some questions 3+ factor of xx3 Therefore, x + 1 is a factor = 0. Therefore, - 1) 3 + 1 = remainder is ((‐1)3 that the remainder Well, plugging 1. plugging in -‐ 11,, we find that were we were If we like x + 1. monomials like dividing by monomials works when only works theorem only remainder theorem the remainder that the note that Do note when we're we’re dividing 1. If division . synthetic division. use synthetic have to use would have we would x2 + 2, we dividing like x2 something like by something + 11by x3 + dividing x3 166 PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE THE EXAMPLES: EXAMPLE 5: +5Sxx++ 2 kx2 + 3x 3 ‐- kx2 f(x) = 3x3 f(x) = k?? what is the 2, what by x ‐- 2, divisible by constant. If ff(x) a constant. is a above, kit is defined above, polynomial f(x) the polynomialf In ·the (x) defined (x) is divisible the value value of k 12 A) 12 B)9 B) 9 C)66 C) 0)33 D) a words, x ‐- 2 is a other words, 2. In other divided by x ‐- 2. when ff(x) O when remainder is 0 the remainder then the 2, then If f (x) is divisible (x) is divided divisible by x -‐ 2, If f(x) zero) equal to zero) makes x ‐- 2 equal that makes va lue that (the value plug 2 (the we plug that when remainder theorem factor r ) The theorem tells us us that when we The remainder factor of f ((x). get 0. into (x), should get we should ), we into fJ(x f/ ((2) 2 ) = 00 3(2)33 3(2) ‐k(2)2+5(2) 0 + 2 := o k(2) 2 + 5(2) +2 2 4- ‐ 4 1 0++22=: 0 4kk++ 10 24 - 36 -‐ 4k = 36 =0 ‐- 44kk := ‐- 336 6 k= 9 Answer Answer ~(B) . EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 6: X p(x) -3 1 - 1 0 0 5 2 -3 4 4 the following Which of the values of x. Which some values p(x) for some polynomial p(x) value of polynomial the value gives the above gives table above The table The following must must be be p(x)?? a factor of p(x) A ) x ++ l1 A)x B)x B ) x- ‐ 1 C)x C ) x-‐ 4 D)x D ) x ‐- ‐ 5 Answer p(x). Answer factor of p(x). a factor be a must be = 0, x ++ 1 must p((-‐ 1) make s this theorem makes remainder theorem The remainder The this question question easy. easy. Because Because p l) = is NOT answer is Be careful-the answer NOT x -‐‐ 1. 1. ~-(A) . Becareful‐the 167 CHAPTER CHAPTER 18 18 SYNTHETIC SYNTHETIC DNISION DIVISION CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 317. A calculator should be used used on the should NOT N O T be the following following questions. questions. X The expression x4_x x 2 is equa The expression equall to which which of the the x- 2 following? following? 3 6 0 A) A ) -‐ 2 8 B) ---+ x- 2 1 2 3 -4 -3 -3 -2 4 4 g(x) The function g is is defined defined by by a a polynomial. polynomial. The The The function g(x). table above above shows shows some va lu es of x and some values and g(x). table What is the the remainder remainder when when g(x) g(x) is divided divided by What by xX + 33?? 8 4 ) x -‐ 2 + - 2x 2x D) 44 ‐‐ C) --+ C ‐‐ A)) -‐ 2 A B) 1 C) 2 2 . . th . 6x + 5x + 2 . IIff the expression M x + 1s th e expression is wntten written m in thee 22x + 11 __ ' ' D) 6 7 1 Q, what is Q in terms of x ? form _2 xl_+ 1 + form +Q,whatisQ1ntermsofx. 2x + 1 A) A ) 33x x -- 1 2z3 - kxz2 + 5xz + 2x - 2 223‐kxzz+5xz+2x‐2 B) 3x + 1 C) C) 6x2+3x+1 6x 2 + 3x + 1 In the the polynomial polynomial above, is aa constant. constan t. If 2 z -‐ 11 above, kk is is a a factor factor of the the polynomial polynomial above, what is the is above, what is the D) D) 6x2+5x+1 6x 2 + 5x + 1 value value of kk?? The written as The expression expression 4x 4x22 + 55 can can be be written as A(2x 1) + R, where A is an expression A(2x ‐ R, where A anexpression in terms terms of x and lu e of R and R R is aa constant. constant. What What is the the va value R ?? What is the th e remainder remainder when x 2 + 2x 2x + 1 is What when x2 is divided divided by by xx ++44 ?? 168 THE PAN DA THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA A calculato calculatorr is allowed allowed on the following following question s. questions. 3 + x2 If p(x) = xx3 divisible p(x) = x2 ‐- 5x + 3, 3, then then p(x) p(x) is is divisible by which which of the the following? following? by I. xX -‐ 2 When Bx -‐ 4 is by 3x -‐ 2, When 3x 3x22 -‐ 8x is divided divided by 2, the the result can be be expressed A -‐ result can expressed as asA II. x ‐- l1 II. IIII. I]. x + + 33 x ~ . What What is A £133 A 2 3 A) A ) xx-‐ 4 and II only A) I and 11only and 11] III only only B) I and C) [I II and and IIII only C) l l only B)) xx-‐ 2 B D) I, I, II, II, and and III D) III in terms of x ? intermsofx? C) C ) xx ++ 2 D) D ) xx ++ 4 the polynomial polynomia l p(x) p(x) is is divisible divisible by by x ‐- 2, If the 2, p(x)?? the following could be be p(x) which of the which following could The The expression expression 2x 2x22 -‐ 4x 4x -‐ 33 can can be be written written as as A (x + where Bis constant. What What is A A(x + l1)) + + B, where B is a constant. in terms terms of x ? = - x 2 + 5x - 14 B) p(x) = x 2 - 6x - 2 B) p(x)=x2~6x‐2 C) p(x) = 2x 2 + x - 8 C) p(x)=zx2+x‐8 D) p(x)= 3x2 - 2x - 8 D) p(x)=3x2‐2x‐-8 A) p(x)) A) 2x A) 2x + +6 B) 2x 2x + 2 C) C ) 22xx -‐ 2 D) D ) 22xx -‐ 66 If x ‐- 1 and and x + are both both factors factors of the the If + 1 are 2 4 3 po lynomial ax bx -‐ 3x and a and and bare polynomial ax4 + bx3 3x2 + 5x 5x and b are constants, what what is the the value value of a ?7 constants, The can be The expression expression xx22 + 4x 4x -‐ 9 can be written written as as (ax+ b, and and care (ax + b)(x b)(x -‐ 2) + + c, where where a, a,b, c are constants. What constants. What is the the value value of a + + b+ + c? A ) -‐ 3 A) B) 1 C) 3 A ) -‐ 2 A) D D)) 5 B) 3 C) 7 D D)) 1100 For a For a polynomial polynomial p(x), p(x), p (5) of the (D= 0.0. Which Which of the following following must must be be a a factor factor of p(x) p(x)?? A) 3x ‐- 1 l (2) = 0. For a a polynomial polynomial p(x) For p(x),, pp(2) 0. Which Which of of the the folJowing must be true following m u s t be true about about p(x) p(x) ?? B + 1l B)) 3 3xx + A) 2x is a a factor factor of p(x). p(x). C) x - 3 p(x). B) 2x -‐ 2 is aa factor factor of p(x). D) x + 3 C) x -‐ 2 is a a factor factor of p(x). p(x). + 2 is aa factor factor of p(x). p(x). D) x + 169 19 Numbers ComplexNumbers Complex 2 = imaginary the imaginary invented the mathematicians invented until mathematicians What value of x satisfies : -v1? There were w e r e no no values values until 1? There satisfies xx2 What value can power other from there, and from They defined ;=1. They represents \/‐1. number defined i2 i2 to equal equal -‐ 11,, and there, any any other power of i can which represents number i, which be derived. be derived. ;2 1 “ =: -7 1] ;3 =4-‐1i 1K ;4 14= z 11 1'5 L i ;6 1"= :- fl1 ;7 {7 =z -‐1i ;B i” = z 11 powers of i. For higher powers simplify higher i4 = that i4 the fact that repeat in cycles The cycles of 4. 4. You can can use use the : 1l to simplify For results repeat The results example, example, 1-511: (ml: X 1'2 ; 1 x i 2 : _] subtract, add, subtract, We add, complex number. a complex called a like 3 + When used in an an expression expression like + 2i, the the expression expression is called number. We When i is used expressions. algebraic would we like much numbers complex divide complex numbers much like we would algebraic expressions. and divide multiply, multiply , and equivalent to (3 the following EXAMPLE 1: If i = J=I, \/ ‐ 1 , which which of the following is is equivalent (3 + + Si) ‐- (2 (2 -‐- 3i) 3i) ?? EXAMPLE A)9i A)9i B )11+ +2 2ii B) C C)) 1 + 8Bii D) D ) 55 ++ 8Bii Just expand and combine terms . like terms. combine like expand and Just ( 3+ + Si) 5 1 )- ‐ (2 ( 2 -‐ 33ii ) = 2 .3 + + 5Sii -- 2 + 3 : 11 ++8Bii 3i i = (3 Answer Answer ~(C ) . 170 THE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA THE COLLEGE A, EXAMPLE 2: Given Given thati that i = what is the product (4 + ii))(5 EXAMPLEZ: = \/‐1,whatisthe product (4+ ( 5- ‐ 2i) ? A) 18 - 3i A)18‐-3i B) 22 - 3i B)22‐-3i C) C ) 18 1 8+ + 33ii -. D) D ) 22 2 2+ + 3i 3i Expanding, Expanding, ((4+i)(5‐2i):20‐8i+5i‐2i2=20‐3i+2=22‐3i 4 + i) (5 - 2i) = 20 - Bi + 5i - 2i2 = 20 - 3i + 2 = 22 - 3i Answer ~( B ) . Answer . . . 22 + 3 i 1 +i EXAMPLE the following is equal to ~i ?? EXAMPLE 3: Which Winch of the followmgisequal to 1+ +1. 1 1. A)§‐§l 1.. 1 1 B) B)§+'il -+- 1 2 2 5 1. (Di‐El 55 1. 1. D) D)§+El -+ -t 2 2 When you're with aa fraction containing i in the denominator, multiply multiply both and the the bottom When you’re faced with fraction containing the denominator, both the top top and bottom of the conjugate, conjugate, you conjugate of 1 + i the the fraction fraction by the the conjugate conjugate of the the denominator denominator.. What What is the you ask? Well, the the conjugate simply reverse reverse the sign between. is 1 -‐ i. The conjugate conjugate of 5 -‐ 4i is 5 + 4i. 41". To get get the the conjugate, conjugate, simply sign in between. In this top and this example, example, we multiply multiply the top and the the bottom bottom by the the conjugate conjugate 1 -~ i. 2 + i - 3i2 5 +i 5 +1 i. (2+3i).(1‐i)_2‐2i+3i‐3i2_2+i‐3i2_5+i 1 (2 + 3i) (1 - i) _ 2 - 2i + 3i - 3i2 (1 11-‐ i + i ‐- i ;2 ( 1+ + ii)) . (1 ( 1-‐ ii)) 2 _ 11‐12 - i2 = - 22- = 2 + 2 The The whole whole point point of this process process is to eliminate eliminate i from the denominator denominator.. The absence absence of i in the the denominator denominator is aa good were done answer is ~(D) -. good indicator indicator that that things things were done correctly. The The answer 171 CHAPTER 19 CHAPTER 19 COMPLEX COMPLEX NUMBERS NUMBERS CHAPTER EXERCISE: Answers for this chapter star t on page 319. A calculator calculator should should NOT N O T be used on on the the be used following questions. following questions . ((66++2i)( fl fl 22+ + Si) 5) If + bi, bi, If the the expression expression above above is is equivalent equivalent to to aa + where a and b are constants, what is the value where and bare consta nt s, what is the va lue of aa?? For z \/‐_1, of the following is For ii = ;=T , which whic h of the following is equivalent Si)?? equivalent to (5 -‐ 3i) 3i) -‐ (( -‐ 22 + + Si) A)) 33 -‐ 8 Bii A A) 2 B) 3 + + 2i B) 12 12 B) C) C) 7 -‐ Bi 81' C)) 2222 C D) + 2i 2i D) 77 + D)) 3344 D Which Which of the following is equall to the following is equa to Given that that i = \/‐_1, Given of the the following following is is ;=T, which which of equal to ii(i ( i + 1) 1) ?? 3(i0++2) 3 m-‐ 2(5 2 w- - 4i) 4 0?u(Note: w m ei =i =H¢ f fl) A) i -‐ 2 A) 16 16 -‐ Si B) i -‐ 1 B) -~44 + 7i C) i + + 1l C) -‐ 44 ++ 11i Hi D) D) 0 D) 16 16 ++ 11i 11i For i = = \/R‐ l ,, which For is which of the the following following is equivalent + 2) ‐ i ( i ‐ 1) ? equ iva lent to 3i(i 3i(i + 2) - i(i - 1) ? fi+3fl+2 i4 + 3;2 + 2 Which of the the following Which following is equal equa l to the the expression expression above? (Note above? (Note:: i = H \/‐_1)) A A) ) ‐- 4 ++ 7ifi A) i A) B B) ) -‐ 22 ++ 7ifi B B)) -‐ 1 C C)) -‐ 4 ++ 5ia D & D)) ‐- 2 ++ Si C) ) 0 C D) 1 For i = \/ R‐ 1 , which which of of the the following following is is equal equal to to ,-93 ? ? 193 22+m+43+5fi+6fl + 3i + 4i + 5{'- + 6i 2 4 A A)) -‐ 1 If the the expression expression above If above is equivalent to aa + + bi, bi, equiva lent to where a and where value of and b are are constants, constants, what what is is the the value of a+ +bb?? ((Note N o t ei i= = \/‐_1) H ) B B) ) 1 C)) -‐ ii C D D)) i A)) 2 A B) 6 C 0 C)) 110 D)) 112 D 2 172 THE COLLEG COLLEGE THE E PANDA PANDA Which of the following complex numbers is is Which the following complex numbers equivalent (3 ‐ i )2? (Note: i = \/-‐‐1) equivalent to to (3 - i)2? (Note: i J=T) A) A) Which of the following is equal to -1 -- 3i. ?? 3+ 1 (Note: i = (Note: = \/‐‐1) R ) 88 -‐ 61" 6i B) 8) 88 + 61' 6i A A)) -‐ i ,- C) 10 10 -‐ 6i C) 6i B) 8) i + C)‐§i C) - ~i + D) 0) 10 10 + 61’ 6i 0) ‐‐§i ~ - ~i D) 4 4 (-i)2 - i)4 (‐i)2 -‐ ((‐i)4 number system, system, what what is is the In the the complex complex number the value (Note: = \/‐_1) value of the the expression expression above? above? (Note: ii = J=T) Which the following Which of of the following complex complex numbers numbers is is 2 equivalent to 3‐1; equivalent : ‘/_1) - ~ ?? (Note: (Note: ii = J=T) A)) -‐ 2 A B) 8) 0 2+ 1 C) 1 3 4, - - l 2‐31“ 5 5 4, 8) 1 - - I 5 5 4. C) - - - l 3 3 4, 0) 1 - - / 3 A) A) D) 2 0) - B)1‐§i C)g‐gi (5 (5 -‐ 2i)( 2i)(4 31') 4 -‐ 3i) D)l‐§i Which of the the following following is is equal equal to to the the expression Which expression above? above? (Note: (Note: ii = = \/‐_1) R ) _I__________ __, A 4 -‐ 7 A)) 114 7ii B) 14 -‐ 23i 8) 14 23i C) + 7i C) 26 26 4 + i + 2 ‐1 - i 1 ‐1 - i+ l + +1i D) 26 0) 26 ‐- 231" 23i Which to the Which of the the following following is is equal equal to the expression expression above? = \/‐‐1) above? (Note: (Note: ii = J=T) A) -‐22 -‐ i B) 2 + i 8) 1 11 1 Which of the following is equal to -:i‐2+i_4' +~ +~ ? I (Note: i I I C) 4 + i = J=T) D) 0) 4 ‐- i A) - i 8) C) 0 0) 1 173 20 Absolute Value Absolute The absolute absolute value value of x, denoted denoted by lxl, |x|, is the the distance distance xis x is from from 0. O. In other other words, words, absolute absolute value value makes makes The everything everything positive. positive. If it's it’s positive, positive, it stays stays positive. positive. If it's it’s negative, negative, it becomes becomes positive. positive. EXAMPLE 1: How H o w many many integer integer values values of x satisfy satisfy lxl |x| << 44?? EXAMPLE Think the negative Think of the the possible possible numbers numbers that that work work and and don't don’t forget forget the negative possibilities. possibilities. Every Every integer integer between between -‐33 and and 33 works, works, aa total total of [zJ 7 integer integer values values.. We absolute value equation like can be We could've could’ve also also solved solved this this problem problem algebraically. algebraically. Any Any absolute value equation like the the one one above above can be written as written as < Xx < < 4 -‐44 < and since since x is an an integer, integer, and - 3 :S:X '.S3 EXAMPLE.2: 2: How H o w many many integer integer values values of x satisfy satisfy Ix ix + + 11!I < 5? 5? EXAMPLE Here So Here we we go through through the the same same process. process. The The largest largest possible possible integer integer for xx is 3 and and the the smallest smallest is -‐ 55.. So S xx :S: S 3, 3, aa total total of []9 possibilities. possibilities. -‐55 :S: Solving algebraically, algebraically, Solving + l1 < -‐55 < Xx + <5 Subtracting 1, 1, Subtracting < 4 -‐66 < Xx < § Xx :S: § 3 -7 55 :S: EXAMPLE 3: 3: For For which which of of the the following following values values of xis x is l2x |2x -‐ SI 5| < 0? O? EXAMPLE A) 0 A)O B) 2.5 B)2.5 C) 5 C)5 There is no no such such value value of x. D) There question.. The The absolute absolute value value of something something can can never n e v e r be be negative. negative. There There is no no solution, solution, answer answer I (D) Trick question (D) I·. 174 THE COLLEGE THE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA EXAMPLE 4: A manufacturer manufacturer of cookies cookies tests tests the the weight packages to to ensure ensure consistency EXAMPLE weight of its its cookie cookie packages consistency the product. product. An acceptable package of cookies cookies must must weigh weigh between 18 ounces in the acceptable package between 16 16 ounces ounces and and 18 ounces as as it is the the weight cookie package, which of the comes out of production. comes out production. If w tois weight of an an acceptable acceptable cookie package, then then which the following following inequalities ? inequalities correctly correctly expresses expresses all all possible possible values values of w w? A ) Jw-171 [ w ‐ 1 7 |>> 1 A) 1 B )Jw| w ‐ 116J 6 |<< 22 B) C )Jw+ | w +17J 1 7> [ >1l C) D )Jw-1 | w ‐ l 71 7 |<< 11 D) In these types of of absolute absolute value value word word problems, problems, start start with of the the desired 17in this case, 1n these types with the the midpoint midpoint of desired interval, interval , 17 in this case, and subtract subtract it from from w: Jw |w -‐ 171. 17|. Think Think of this this as as the the ”distance,” away from midpoint of the "distance," or ”error,” "error," away from the the midpoint the and interval. We We don don’t this "error" ”error" to to be be greater greater than than 1 since then be be outside outside the interval. So So would then the desired desired interval. interval. 't want want this since w would ouranswer our answer is §} |w‐ 17| < lw - 171 1. 1. We Remember that that the end result result should should be w < 18. We can can confirm confirm this this answer answer by by solving solving the the inequality. inequality. Remember the end be 16 16 < w Let's Let’s see see if if our o u r answer answer gives gives us us that that result result when when we we isolate isolate w. |w‐l7|<1 lw - 111 < 1 -‐ 1l < w w ~- 1177 << 1 Adding Adding 17, 16 << w w < 18 16 We We have have confirmed confirmed that that ~ is the the correct correct answer. answer. This is the the graph graph of y = x: This y N o w this this is the graph of y = Now the graph |x|: !xi: y See how the graph an y function function makes makes all the the negative how the graph changed? changed? Taking Taking the the absolute absolute value value of any negative y-values y‐values become become reflected across across the the x-axis). x-axis). All the the positive y-values positive positive y-values y‐values (points (points in the the quadrants quadrants III I I I and and IV are are reflected positive y-values stay they are. that you you should able to recognize. recognize . stay where where they are. This This V-shape V-shape is the the classic classic absolute absolute value value graph graph that should be be able 175 CHAPTER CHAPTER 20 ABSOLUTE ABSOLUTE VALUE VALUE table of values transformation . If then compare compare fJ (x) A table values is another another way way to see this this absolute absolute value value transformation. If fJ (x) = 2x, then with | f ( x ) | with IJ (x)J. -3 -6 6 X J (x) IJ (x)I - 2 - 1 0 1 2 -4 - 2 0 2 4 4 2 0 2 4 3 6 6 The negative the positive positive values positive . negative values values of Jf (x) become become positive positive and and the values of Jf (x) stay stay positive. EXAMPLE of y = j2x 1j ? EXAMPLE 5: Which Which of the following following could be be the graph graph ofy IZX ‐- 1|? B) B) A) A) C) C) yy yy yy D) D) y31 x The absolute value the absolute absolute value value of something something can can never The entire entire function function is enclosed enclosed in an an absolute value and and since since the never be be negative, than or equal words, the graph must on or above above the negative, y must must always always be be greater greater than equal to 0. 0. In other other words, graph m u s t lie on the x-axis. That eliminates (A) without the absolute absolute value. the answer, answer, we That eliminates (A) and and (8). (B). In fact, (A) (A) is the the graph graph of 2x -‐ 1 without value. To get get the we the x-axis so take all the take the points points with with negative negative y-values y-values in the the graph graph of (A) (A) and and reflect them them across across the so that that they're they’re [19]. positive. The graph graph we we end end up up with with is (C) . positive. One great mentioning here obtaining points points that that One great tactic that's that’s worth worth mentioning here is narrowing narrowing down down the the answer answer choices choices by obtaining 2(0) -‐ 11|I = point (0,1) (0, 1) must then be be on are are easy easy to calculate. calculate. For For example, example, ifif we let let xx =z 0, then then y =: 1|2(O) = 1. The The point must then the graph, that (0.5, 0 ) must must also on the graph . This the graph, eliminating eliminating (A) (A) and and (B). Letting Letting y = z 0, 0, we we now n o w find that (0.5,0) also be be on the graph. This eliminates should only only have eliminates (D) (D) because because (D) (D) has has two t w o x-intercepts x‐intercepts wherea whereass the the graph graph should have one one.. 176 THE COLLEGE THE PANDA COLLEGE PANDA CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 320. A calculator should should N O T be used NOT used on the following following questions. questions. yy llff fJ(x) (x) = = -‐2x2 2x 2 -‐ 3 3xx+ + 11, ,what what iissthe the value value o off 1 /(1) 1? |f(1)|? x A) 3 B) 4 C) 5 D) 6 Which Which of of the the following following could could be be the the equation equation of of the xy-plane above? the function function graphed graphed in in the the xy-plane above? A) ) yy = x l -‐ 2 A = -l‐ M B) y = lx 2 B ) y = hl h- 4 q y = lx l + C ) y = h H 42 D) ) yy=: Ix D M - ‐ 21 fl If x is aa positive what is is If 1|2 2 -‐ x] x i > 5 and and xis positive integer, integer, what the minimum minimum possible the possible value value of of x x? ? If |x 10, which Ix ‐- 3] 3 1 > 10, which of of the the following following could could be be the the value value of |xl lx l ? ? A A) ) 2 m4 B) 4 Which of the Which is equal the following following expressions expressions is equa l to to ‐5 - 5 for for some some value value of x ?? A A)) B B)) C q) D D)) C) ) 6 C D D)) 8 | x-‐ 661 | + 22 Ix | x- ‐ 221-| ‐ 6 Ix 6 | x++ 2 + 66 Ix 21| + A calculator is allowed on the following questions . [ x++61 6 |-‐ 2 Ix 2 H o w many different integer integer values How many different values of of x satisfy satisfy |x+ 6I< 3? Ix + 61< 3? 177 VALUE ABSOLUTE VALUE CHAPTER 20 ABSOLUTE CHAPTER If In - 21 = 10, what is the sum of the two possible values of n ? y A) 4 B) 6 C) 12 D) 20 the the function graph of the function f is shown shown in the The graph be following could the following Which of the above. Which xy-plane above. xy-plane could be ? I IJ(x) ? function y := |f(x)| the the function graph of the the graph A) A) which of the then which where x < 10, then 101= If |x = b, where Ix ‐- 10| equivalent to bb -‐ x ?? following is equivalent following y A)) ‐- 110 A 0 10 B) 10 2b - 10 C) 217‐10 C) 100-‐ 22b D)) 1 D b B) y hot dogs that its hot ensure that must ensure dog factory must hot dog A hot dogs length . inches in length. 6~ inches and 62 inches and 6~ inches between 6}; are are between this factory, hot dog length of a hot the length lfIf h is the dog from this inequalities following inequalities the following which of the then which then ? h7 values of h accepted values expresses the accepted correctly expresses correctly C) y A) lh- 6~I< ~ B) \h- 6~\< 1 C) \h- 61\< i D) 11,- 611> i D) y 178 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA In - 21< 5 bakery standardizes A bakery standardizes muffins muffins to weigh weigh 1 between 11Z between [f m weight of ~3 and and 21 2 ! ounces. ounces. If m is the the weight How many many integers How inequality integers n satisfy satisfy the the inequality above? above? 4 4 a muffin muffin from a this bakery, following from this bakery, which which of the the following inequalities m ?? inequalities expresses expresses the the possible possible values values of m A) Six B) Seven Seven 3 1 A) A) m‐11‘<Z lm-1~ 1<~ Eight C) Eight D)) N Nine D ine 1 B) Im- 21<B)|m‐2|<1 4 1 C)|m‐2|<1 C) Im- 21<22 tape must Rolls of tape certain length. length. must be be made made to a certain They must must contain contain enough tape to cover cover enough tape between 400 feet and between and 410 feet. If If/I is the the length length of a roll roll of tape tape that a that meets meets this requirement, requirement, which which of the the following following inequalities inequalities expresses expresses the the possible values ? possible values of I ? D) |I -‐ 400| 10 A) I/ 4001< 10 B) I/ |I -‐ 405| B) 4051> 5 C) II U+ + 405| 4051 < 5 D) H I/ -‐ 4051 4051< <5 HIlllllllllllllilllllllll If l4x |4x -‐ 4| |5y + +10] = 15, what what is 41= 8 and and l5y 101= is the smallest possible possible value smallest value of xy ?? A) A ) ‐- 220 0 B)) -‐ 115 B 5 C)) -‐ 5 C D D)) -‐ 1 If lal la} < 1, 1,then which of the then which the following following must must be be true? true? 1 I. - > 1 L1>1 a 2 ll . a¥ 1 IL <1 III .Laa>> -‐ 1l H A) B B)) C) D)) D [ I ] only III only n d 11 11only 1l aand only II and I I only and III1 II,, JI, I I , and and IIII II 179 3 1 lm-}~1<1 21 Ang Angles les Exterior Angle Angle Theorem Theorem An exterior is extended. the triangle triangle below, below, xx°0 designates designates an an exterior angle angle is is formed formed when when any any side side of of a a triangle triangle is extended . In ln the exterior angle. exterior angle. s u m of the two t w o angles angles in furthest from In this An exterior exterior angle angle is always always equal equal to the the sum of the in the the triangle triangle furthest from it. it. In this case, case, xI z= aa ++ b EXAMPLE 1: D A 100° C 3x°0 3x E E B What is the value of the figure figure above? What the value of x in the above? A C E must be 80°. o w there are aa lot lot of of ways ways to to do do this, is the LD DC£ must be 80°. N Now there are this, but but using using the the exterior exterior angle angle theorem theorem is the fastest: fastest: 80 ++ Xx =: 3x 80 3X 80 =: 2x 80 r=E 180 THE PANDA THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA Parallel Lines Parallel 711 When the following following are are true: true: When two two lines lines are parallel, parallel, the 0 angles are (e.g. £1 = 44) • Vertical angles are equal equal (e.g. L'.l = L 4) 0 : £5 = 46) • Alternate Alternate interior interior angles angles are equal equal (e.g. (e.g. 44 L4 = L S and and 43 L3 = L 6) 0 41l = : L 45) • Corresponding Corresponding angles angles are are equal equal (e.g. (e.g. L S) 0 supplementary (e.g. 180°) • Same Same side side interior interior angles angles are are supplementary (e.g. 43 L3 + + 45 LS := 180°) No need memorize these just need need to know w o parallel need to memorize these terms. terms . You just know that that when when ttwo parallel lines lines are are cut cut by by another another line, line, there are are two there t w o sets sets of equal equal angles: angles: L 1 = L'.'. 4 = LS = LB L2 = L'.'. 3 = L6 = L7 EXAMPLE 2: EXAMPLE2: C A G F E In the figure above‐If above, AC || Inthefigure ACE= =40°,whatisthevalueofx? II"CfiandE‐F' GD and BF HE. II CE. IfACAE If LCAE = = 70° 70° and and [LACE 400, what is the value of x? Here fastest way: L Here is the fastest [ A C E = .LABF AABF = : 40° because because they are corresponding lines ACE corresponding angles angles (A‐C (AC cuts cuts parallel parallel lines BF and and fiCE). W ) . Since angle an exterior exterior angle angle to 6A AABF B F,, x = z 70 + + 40 = = I‑ 110° 1angle x is an 181 CHAPTER ANGLES CHAPTER 21 ANGLES Polyg ons Polygons Triangle Triangle 180° 180° Quadrilateral Quadrila tera 1 Pentagon Pentagon 00 □ 360° 540° Hexagon Hexagon 720° angles by 180° interior angles sum of the interior increases the sum As you additional side side increases 180°.. each additional above, each polygons above, the polygons from the can see from you can angles is interior angles the interior For any u m of the polygon, the ssum any polygon, sides number of sides 180(n -‐ 2) 2) where where n is the number lBO(n 1080° . = 180 x 6 := 1080°. 180(8 ‐- 2) = angles is 180(8 interior angles sum of the the sum sides, the has 8 sides, 50 the interior which has octagon, which an octagon, So for an regular . If are regular. above are shown above polygons shown equal. The polygons are equal. sides and which all sides one in which A regular and angles angles are polygon is one regular polygon . 135° = -;-8 1080° of measure a have would angle interior each regular, were octagon our our octagon were regular, each interior angle would have a measure + 8 : 135°. drawing triangles by drawing several triangles into several up into split up be split polygon can be that any from the fact that formula comes lBO(n ‐- 2) formula The 180(n comes from any polygon others . the others. vertex to the any oone from any lines from n e vertex Count for sides. Count number of sides. than the number results from that results triangles that number of triangles The number from this process process is always always ttwo w o less than - 2), (n ‐~ 180° be must polygon a within angles the contains 180°, triangle contains each triangle Because each yourself! Because yourself! 180°, the the sum s u m of angles within a polygon m u s t be 180°(n sides. where number of sides. where n is the number EXAMPLE3: EXAMPLE3; ? value of x '? above. What is the value figure above. extended as pentagon are extended Two sides as shown shown in the figure sides of a regular pentagon be 540° -;-5 angle must interior angle each interior So each 540° . So 5 -‐ 2) = pentagon is 180( a pentagon degrees in a number of degrees total number The total 180(5 2 540°. m u s t be + 5 = 108° 108°.. 72°. = 108 180 be must be formed by the triangle formed the triangle within the The angles the intersecting intersecting Jines lines must ‐ 108 = 72°. angles within 108° 108° So,x=180‐72‐72:-. So, x = IBO - 72 - 72 = j 36° 1182 THE COLLEGE PANDA CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 322. should N NOT A calculator should O T be be used used on the following questions. questions. following c.....----~-----------1 kO Note: Figure Figure n not Note: o t drawn scale.. drawn to scale In m are parallel. 1n the the figure figure above, above, lines lines I and and m are parallel. Whatisthevalueofa+b+c+d? What is the value of a + b + c + d ? 1n the the figure figure above, In above, 1” = 50 50 and = 140. What i= and k = What is the value the value of j? j ? A)) 660 A 0 A) 270 B) B) 70 70 B) 360 C) 80 80 C) C) 720 D)) 9900 D cannot be D) It cannot be determined determined from from the the information given. information given. Note: Figure not drawn to scale. Note Figure not Note:: Figure scale.. not drawn drawn to scale 1n the In = 40, what the figure figure above, above , ifif x = what is the the value value ln the the figure In figure above above,, what what is the the value value of y ?? of yy?? A)) 330 A 0 A ) 440 0 A) B)) 4400 B B) 50 B) C)) 550 C 0 C) 80 C) 80 D D)) 7700 D)) 9900 D 183 183 CHAPTER 21 CHAPTER 21 ANGLES ANGLES A calculator is allowed following allowed on the following questions. questions. In the figure above, lines I and m are parallel. What is x in terms of a and b ? Note: Figure Figure n not drawn to scale. scale. Note: o t drawn A) a + +b In the the figure figure above, above , what what is the the value va lue of x + In + yy?? A 125 A)) 125 B) B) a -‐ b C C)) b -‐ a D 1 8 0- ‐aa-‐ b D)) 180 B B)) 180 180 C) 235 D) 280 r» 280 _ 70° 11° 30° 17° Note: Figure drawn to Note: Figure not not drawn to scale scale.. In the figure above, what is the the figure above, what the value value of a + + b ?? A ) 880 0 A) B) 100 C) 110 C) D) 120 Note : Figure Figure nnot m o t drawn drawn to scale scale.. In the the figure figure above, ln above, what what is the the value value of zz ?? A 5 A)) 335 B) 45 45 C) C) 55 55 D 0 D)) 880 184 THE COLLEGE THE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA (x + 40)° x° the figure In the figure above, above, what what is is the the value value of of x x? ? A) 60 60 A) 70 B) 70 C) 75 75 C) In In the the figure figure above, above, a a rectangle rectangle and and a a quadrilateral overlap. quadrilateral u m of overlap . What What is is the the ssum of the the degree measures degree measures of the the shaded shaded angles? ang les? D) D) 80 80 I_ A) A) 360 360 B) 540 C) 720 D) 900 I -'1 Ar ', ~• 4 ~ " :.·•. ~ • • \ ., regular hexagon hexagon is shown A regular figure above above.. shown in in the the figure What is the What the value value of x ? ? A) 15 A) 15 Note: Figure Figure n m o t drawn drawn to scale scale.. not B) 20 20 C) 25 C) 25 the figure figure above, above, what In the value of y? y? what is the the value A) A) 100 B) 130 D) 30 C) 140 D) 150 185 "'v,) CHAPTER 21 ANGLES Note: Figure Figure not not drawn drawn to scale. Note: scale . the figure figure above, above, lines lines I and and m In the m are are parallel. parallel. Which of the the following following m Which u s t be must be true? true? Note: Figure not drawn to scale. I, = 3b 3b I. a = In the the figure figure above, above , lines lines I, m, m, and and n are are parallel. parallel. II . a + c 11. + b= = b+ + C What is the the value What value of a + + b ?? 45 III. bb == 45 A) A) IIllonly I I only 8) Il and and [I II only only B) C) II ll and and 111 lil only only C) D)) I, D 1 ,[II, L aand n d III 111 Note: Figure not drawn to scale . the figure figure above, above, what what is the In the value of xx + + yy?? the value A 0 A)) 110 B ) 220 0 8) C 0 C)) 330 D 0 D)) 550 186 22 Triangles Triangles & Equilateral Triangles Isosceles Isosceles 8.EquilateralTriangles equal. those sides opposite those The angles length. The equal length. An isosceles isosceles triangle has ttwo w o sides sides of equal angles opposite sides are are equal. that has one that triangle is one B Because AB = : AC, AC, L.C 4C = : AB. L.B. Because angles angles, the imply equal sides imply equal sides Because equal length. Because same length. the same triangle, all sides equilateral triangle, an equilateral In an sides have have the equal angles, the angles 60°. are are all 60“. degree measure the degree What is the measure of 50°. What has a measure one of the isosceles triangle, an isosceles EXAMPLE 1: In an triangle, one the angles angles has measure triangle? the triangle? the greatest possible angle angle in the greatest possible of the are ttwo There are angles. There equal angles. also ttwo triangle has isosceles triangle An isosceles has nnot o t only only ttwo w o equal equal sides sides but but also w o equal w o possibilities possibilities for the triangle, or the a 50-50--80 making a could be angle could an i t h an an angle angle of 50°. 503. Another Another angle be 50°, 50C, making 50‐50‐80 triangle, with triangle w isosceles triangle an isosceles 80° Iis the possibilities, j 800 these two Given these triangle . Given other w o angles making aa 50-6.5-<>5 50‐65‐65 triangle. t w o possibilities, the greatest greatest equal, making be equal, could be angles could other ttwo possible triangle. the triangle. angle in the possible angle 187 TRIANGLES CHAPTER 22 TRIANGLES CHAPTER w a s C A B B , is the value of j + k + l + m + n + o ? · lS eq ·.. teral. What maxe‘i‘fggm‘meghemieucmequflatem. Whatisthevalueofj+k+l+m+n+o? ,ih1~} i;:~ I degree total degree triangles has these triangles Each of one. Each the equilateral triangles within Solution are 3 smaller smaller triangles within the equilateral one. of these has aa total There are Soluti on 1: There we what get to ACB L out total of 180° x 33 = 540°. We combined total measure We need need to subtract subtract out L A CBto get what we want. want. 180°, for aacombined measure of 180°, is 60°. So ACB equilateral, L Because triangle ABC ABC is equilateral, [ A C Bis 80 540° -‐ 60° 60° = I-.480° Because triangle I. line, they straight line, a straight form a and II form k and Because k both j and is equilateral, on 2: Because Solution Because .0-A AA BC BCis equilateral, both and o0 are are 60°. Because they add add Soluti all oour 180°. Adding up to add up also add and n also m and up to 180°. Because up Because m also form form aa straight straight line, line, they they also to 180°. Adding up up all u r values, values, we we get : I-.480° 1get 60° + 180° + 180° + 60° = Triangles Right Triangles angle). right angle), the right opposite the (the side made up triangles are Right are made up of two t w o legs legs and and the the hypotenuse hypotenuse (the side opposite Right triangles C a b the legs of the lengths of the lengths bare and b a and where a c2 , where b2 = C2, theorem: a£122 + b2= obeys the Every triangle obeys the pythagorean pythagorean theorem: are the legs and and right triangle Every right hypotenuse. c is the the hypotenuse. length of the the length 188 THE COLLEGE THE PANDA COLLEGE PANDA EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 3: The rectangle above has a length 20. is twice twice as as long long as as the height, The rectangle above has a diagonal diagonal of of length 20. If If the the base ba se of of the the rectangle rectangle is the height, what the height? height? what is the The w o right be xx and be 2x. 2x. Using Using the The diagonal diagonal of of any any rectangle rectangle forms forms ttwo right triangles. triangles . Let Let the the height height be and the the base base be the pythagorean theorem, pythagorean theorem , x2+ (2x)22 = 202 x2 + (2x) 202 2 xx2+4x2=400 + 4x 2 = 400 2 5x2=400 5x = 400 2 xx2=80 = 80 M If you take the the SAT enough If you take enough times, what you’ll find is that repeatedly. For times, what you'll find that certain certain right right triangles triangles come come up up repeatedly. For example, the 3-4-5 3‐4‐5 triangle: example, the triangle: 4 A set of three three whole whole numbers numbers that triple.. Though Though not not that satisfy satisfy the the pythagorean pythagorean theorem theore m is is called called a a pythagorean pythagorean triple necessary, it’ll it' ll save save you you quite necessary, and improve improve your you learn recognize the common quite a a bit bit of time time and your accuracy accuracy ifif you learn to to recognize the common triples that show show up: triple s that up: 3, 4, 5 3,4,5 6, 8, 10 6,8,10 5,12, 13 5, 12,13 7, 24, 25 7,24,25 8, 15, 17 8,15, Note that that the the 6‐8‐10 Note just aa multiple of the 6-8-10 triangle triangle is just multiple of the 3‐4‐5 3-4-5 triangle. triangle . 189 CHAPTER 22 TRIANGLES CHAPTER TRIANGLES Special Right Special Right Triangles Triangles will have have to memorize You will w o special right triangle 45°‐45°‐90°: memorize ttwo special right triangle relationships. relationships. The first is is the 45°-45 °-90 ° : 45° X 45° X The best that it's it's isosceles-the isosceles‐the ttwo w o legs best way way to think think about about this this triangle triangle is that legs are are equal. equal. We We let let their their lengths lengths be be x. x. The hypotenuse, which is always always the biggest biggest side side in in aa right right triangle, u t to hypotenuse, which triangle, turns turns oout to be be fl /2 times times x. x. We can can prove We relationship using theorem, where prove this relationship using the the pythagorean pythagorean theorem, where h 11is is the the hypotenuse. hypotenuse . x2 + x2 = 112 x2+x2 zh2 2 2x2=h2 2x = 112 x/27:\/h‘2 v'2li = ~ xx/Ezh xV2= 11 l show show you proofs not 1 you these these proofs n o t because because they will be be tested tested on on the problem-solving the SAT, SAT,but but because because they they illustrate illustrate problem-solving concepts that that you have to use use on on certain certain SAT questions. questions. concepts you may may have The second second is the 30°‐60°‐90°: the 30° -60 ° -90 °: 60° X Xfi Because 30° is the Because smallest angle, from it is the shortest. side be be x. x. The hypotenuse, hypotenuse, the smallest angle, the side side opposite opposite from shortest. Let that that side the turns out to be be ,/3 \/§ times times x. x. the largest largest side, side, turns turns out out to be be twice x, and and the side side opposite opposite 60° 60° turns out to One students make make is to think think that that because 600 must One common common mistake mistake students because 60° is is twice twice 30°, 30°, the the side side opposite opposite 60° must be be twice as the the side side opposite opposite 30°. That That relationship relationship is is N O T true. You cannot extrapolate the ratio twice as as big big as NOT true . You cannot extrapolate the ratio of of the the sides the angles. angles. Yes, side opposite opposite 60° 30°, but but it it isn't isn’t sides from the the ratio ratio of the Yes, the the side 60° is is bigger bigger than than the side side opposite opposite 30°, twice as twice as long. long. 190 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA We can prove the relationship by using equilateral triangle. triangle . Let could use We can prove the 30-60-90 30‐60‐90 relationship using an an equilateral Let each each side side be be 2x 2x (we (we could use xx but why 2x makes things but you'll you’ll see see why 2x makes things easier easier in aa bit) bit):: B A 2x 2x C Drawing aa line down the middle from from B B to A_C creates ttwo w o 30--60-90 30‐60‐90 triangles. Because an triangle Drawing line down the middle AC creates triangles. Because an equilateral equilateral triangle 2x was was used avoids any fractions. is symme trical , AD symmetrical, AD is half half of 2x, or just just xx.. That's That’s why why 2x u s e d- ‐ it i t avoids any fractions. B D X A To find BO, pythagorean theorem: BD, we we use use the the pythagorean theorem: AD22 + B0 3022 = A82 AD AB 2 2 BD22 xx2 + 80 = (2x)2 (2x)2 31322 = : (2x)2 -‐ x2 80 x2 3022 80 2 : 4x2 = 4x 2 -‐ xx2 3022 80 = 3x2 3x 2 M 2: = ~ @ ✓ao BD = = X\/§ BO xV3 Triangle the 30--6090 relation ship . Triangle ABO ABD is proof proof of the 30‐60‐90 relationship. 1 9] 191 C CHAPTER 22 TRIANGLES CHAPTER TRIANGLES Wu 4: A B C WintistheareaofAACBshownabwe? the area of ..6.ACBshown above? Wbatis A)-y2. AN? '8)2-/2 ism/i C) 4 04 D) 8 · D18 leg). each leg). than each greater than times greater v'2Z times is \/‐ hypotenuse 1s (the hypotenuse triangle relationship, 45--45-90 triangle the 45‐45‐90 Using the USing relationShiPr AC AC = = BC BC‐= 7~ (the ‐ )(x/i‐ ) 22 (_> 22 22 (1/5 1 4 4 ) ( 4 1 16 4 ) = . then The area z _1 ( 16) = z 4. v'2 then ‐1 ( v'2 1s area is Answer Answer ~(C) . EXAMPLE5: EXAMPLES: A 10 I D = C B = ratio of AC to CB ? the ratio What is the AB = 30° apd A8 LB = 30°,and above, AD the £igur-e hi, In the figure above, AD = DC, DC, 48 = 10 10... What V2 1/5 «5 2 “W7 ”7th 0m ”5 triangle 30-60-90 triangle is a 30‐60‐90 6 ADB triangle . A 45-45-90 triangle. only isosceles not only is not 6 ADC DC, A Because A D C15 isosceles but but also also a 45‐45‐90 A D BISa ADD ‐=‐ DC, Because A Using 5v'3. DBB‐=‐ 5\/§. and D hypotenuse, 5, and half the hypotenuse, is half AD 15 relationship, AD 30-60-90 relationship, the 30‐60‐90 Using the with 3Using hypotenuse of 10. Using a hypotenuse with a DCC= DBB- ‐ D CBB‐=‐ D and C 5, and =‐ 5, DCc _ 5v'2, D ACC= relationship, A the ‐‐ 5\/§, ‐ ‐ 5y'3 5f3‐- 5. 5 45--45-90 relationship, the 45-45‐90 AC A_c_ = 5y'2 5\/§ CBB 5v'3 C s fi ‐- s5 Answer Answer ~(A) . 192 _ = y'2 W2 fiv'J-‐ 1i THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA Similar Similar Triangles Triangles When ttwo triangles have have the the same their sides sides are When w o triangles same angle angle measures measures,, their are proportional: proportional : B A C the figure figure above, above, 6 DBE and 6 AABC In the ADBE and A B C both both have have right parallel to A‐C, right angles angles and and share share AB. L.B. Because Because W DE is parallel AC, [L.BED B E D is equal equal in measure measure to ABCA. Therefore, 6 ADBE B C have sets of angles angles and and are are L.BCA. Therefore, DBE and and A 6 AABC have congruent congruent sets similar to each each other. other words, just a AABC. has the the same same shape shape but but not not similar other. In other word s, 6ADBE DBE is just a smaller smalJer version version of 6 ABC. It has the same same size. size. If we draw draw the the ttwo triangles separately the If we w o triangles separately and the sides sides some some arbitrary arbitrary lengths, lengths, we we can can see see and give give the this more this more clearly. clearl y. B B 4 8 D A 5 10 6 6 3 E C Notice that ”ma‐tches up”" with with E, with E. math Notice that m AB "ma tches up BD, AE_matches AC matches up with with W, DE, and and Ematches BC matches up up with BE. Using Using math terms, say that corresponds BD, AC correspo corresponds and BC corresponds with BE. term s, we say that AB correspo nds with BO, nds with DE, DE, and corresponds BE. For illustrative illustrative purposes, we made the sides sides of the the big as long the sides sides of the the smaller smaller one. one. But purposes, we made the big triangle triangle twice twice as long as as the regardless what the thing to remember is is that that the the cor corresponding sides of of regardless of what the actual actual numbers numbers are, are, the the important important thing to remember responding sides similar ratios of of their their lengths lengths are are equivalent. In oour u r example, example, similar triangles triangle s are are proportional, proportional, so so the the ratios equivalent. In Q _ E _ E _ BD_DE_BE_ Forming these types types of of equations is your your goal goal in in every triangles. Forming these equations is every SAT question question dealing dealing with with similar similar triangles. 193 CHAPTER 22 TRIANGLES CHAPTER TRIANGLES EXAMPLE6: EXAMPLEG: B A C drawn to scale. Note: Figure Figure not not drawn Note: DB = AD = 99,, DB lnAABCabove,fiE‐isparalleltoza = 33,, aand n d DE DE= 22.. .ti.ABC above, DE is parallel to AC, AD In 1: What is the length of AC1 PART Pmnwmetheimgmofzc? ? area of l:i.BAC? the areaofABAC PART 2: What. the ratiooftheareaofABDE-Ito ratio of the ai:ea of ABD E to the rakrziwhamthe 1 1 .1 1 ! B) A)! Al‘s. 3 ) ; C); Dlfi 16 D) 9 C) • 4 3 similar see similar they see whenever they make whenever students make that students mistake that common mistake 6. A common NOT 6. answer is NOT Part 1 Solution: Solution: The The answer many course, Of not. do they when other each certain segments that certain assume that triangles is to assume triangles segments correspond correspond with with each other when they do not. Of course, many assume to easy it's case, particular case, it's easy to assume that this particular In this make . In easy to make. mistake is easy this mistake that this so that designed so are designed questions are questions that ratios the ratios at the look at to look have to We have incorrect. We be incorrect. would be times DE, be 3 times must be BO, AC must because because AD is 3 times times BD, DE, but but this this would triangle). any triangle). of any side of a side not a is not AD is that A‐D (Note that portions of those triangles, not the triangles, sidesof the between the sides between not portions those sides sides (Note parallel, are parallel, AC are DE and Because D‐E ratios . Because correct ratios. up the correct we set up and make beginning and the beginning from the let's start So let’s So start from make sure sure we and KC the Equating similar. are .6.BAC and .6.BDE , Therefore L.BCA. to equal is equal to L.BAC L.BDE ABDE is equal ABAC and and L.BED [ B E D equal ABCA. Therefore, ABDE and A B A C are similar. Equating the corresponding sides, relevant corresponding the relevant ratios sides, ratios of the DE BD _ DE BO E X _AC R BA 2 33 __2 = R 35 +? 9) _ AC 2 3 fi12 == AC E Cross multiplying , Cross multiplying, 3AC = = 24 24 3AC AC:‑ AC =~ triangles . with working w when working take when there are warning, there word of warning, a word As a are valid valid shortcuts shortcuts that that some some students students take i t h similar similar triangles. DE:AC. to equal not is 80:0A is not equal to DEzAC. II that BD:DA though we BE:EC, even equal to BEzEC, 80:0A is equal example, BDzDA For example, For even though we just just showed showed that misused . Just easily misused. are easily they are because they shortcuts altogether types of shortcuts these types you avoid that you recommend that recommend avoid these altogether because Just focus focus triangles similar triangles handle any to handle able to be able you'll be and you'll right ratios up the right on setting setting up ratios between between corresponding corresponding sides sides and any similar on throw at might throw question at you. you. question the SAT might of ratio of the ratio of the the square equal to the areas is equal their areas the ratio are similar, triangles are When ttwo Solution: When w o triangles similar, the ratio of their square of Part 2 Solution: 2 2 Answer :4 = the areas, ratio of the the ratio Squaring that their The ratio ratio of the the sides sides is 1:4. Squaring that ratio, ratio, we get the areas, 1 12:42 : 1:16. 1:16. Answer sides. The their sides. o t drawn scale. drawn to scale. figure is nnot the figure that the Note that /-.(D) /. Note 194 ..- .·· THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA In it was was easy the triangle triangle similarity similarity and sides corresponded corresponded with with each each 1n this this example, example, it easy to to see see the and determine determine which which sides other. similar triangles and their sides are are more more difficult difficult to spot and keep other. In 1n tougher tougher questions, questions, similar triangles and their corresponding corresponding sides to spot and keep track o t always track of. The The ratios ratios are are n not always obvious. obvious . For these labeling equivalent with tick marks. Sides Sides opposite from For these tougher tougher questions, questions , II recommend recommend labeling equivalent angles angles with tick marks. opposite from angles with the the same same number number of of tick tick marks marks will w i l l correspond correspond with each other. an example angles with with each other. Here’s Here 's an example to to illustrate: illustrate: EXAMPLE 7: EXAMPLE G Lh F K H hithefigtmeabove,whatisthelengthofffi? In the figureabove, what is the length of KH ? At first glance, glance, this n o t look like aa similar similar triangles triangles question. of the the outside outside At this does does not look like question. But But ifif we we label label the the angles angles of triangle FGH, something something interesting tick mark mark and and L [HH with t w o tick tick triangle FGH, interesting happens. happens. Let’s Let's first label label [F L F with with one one tick with two marks. marks. /n A F G G G m& ‐> K K H F K H N o w whenever w o angles are equal w o angles another, the the third third angles angles must must Now whenever ttwo angles of one one triangle triangle are equal in measure measure to ttwo angles of another, also be equal. Because outside FGH and on the the left both have right angles and share also be equal. Because outside triangle triangle FGH and triangle triangle FGK FGK on both have right angles and share L F, AFGK L FGK must AF, m u s t have (two tick marks). Likewise, outside F G H and triangle have the the same same measure measure as as LAH H (two marks). Likewise, outside triangle triangle FGH and triangle GKH on the the right GKH right angles and share share AH, so L.KGH ZKGH must have the the same same measure measure as AF (one (one right both both have have right angles and L.H, so must have as L.F tick mark). mark). The result is that The result that the the outside triangle, the the triangle triangle on on the the triangle on the right all all have have the the same same outside triangle, the left, left, and and the triangle on the right angle angle measures measures.. They're They’re all all similar similar to one one another! another! Since 6. AFFGK GK is aa 3-4-5 3‐4‐5 triangle with FK FK = = 4, 4, we we can can n o w set similar triangles triangles Since triangle with now set up up an an equation equation of of ratios ratios using using similar AF GKon the left and A K H on on the the right the length 6. FGK on the left and 6.G GKH right to find the length of m. KH. KH (opposite (opposite I-tick KH l-tick angle side triangle) l-tick angle angle in left side side triangle) angle in right right side triangle) __ GK (opposite (opposite I-tick triangle) GK (opposite (opposite 2-tick angle GK angle in right side triangle) FK (opposite 2-tick angle in left side triangle) right side triangle) (opposite angle side triangle) EA 3 33 ‘4 4 4 ( K H )=: 9 4(KH) KH KH =rn 195 CHAPTER CHAPTER 22 22 TRIANGLES TRIANGLES Parallel Parallel Lines Lines and Proportionality Proportionality Lines three or proportional parts. Lines that that cut cut through through three or more more parallel parallel lines lines are are separated separated into into proportional parts. a b n m To illustrate, transversals that through three three parallel parallel lines. lines. Therefore, illustrate, lines lines m 771 and and n it above above are are transversals that cut cut through Therefore, the the three three parallel lines divide parallel lines divide lines lines m m and and nn proportionally: proportionally: a ‘ 1 5C bbd d This concept don 't need need to know know the the underlying underlying proof. proof . concept can can be be easily proved proved using using similar similar triangles triangles,, but but you you don’t problems Just rule . It's shown up on past exams, usually Just memorize memorize the the rule. It’s not n o t tested tested very very often often but but it has has shown past exams, usually in problems involving involving aa trapezoid. trapezoid. EXAMPLE8: · EXt\MPLE 8: A •~•=-t ~ llt~ ► if;, '~ ,. ....... J~ ""trr ,..,. .-,/' :t,n.;'11,• ~~ ~. - ... ~ l " • > B \ I P ,,.;-.. ... ,. D I Q C lnflrefigumabave,fi,P§,and‐D'Careparakl. PointPliesonEandpointhiesonFC. lfB Q = 44,, In the figure above, AB, PQ, and DC are parallel. Point P lies on AD and point Q lies on BC. If BQ QC=2,andAD=7.5,whatisthelengthofAP? -QC = 2, and AD = 7.5, whatis the length of AP? Because E and W cut through through three three parallel parallel lines, lines, they they are are divided proportionally. Because AD and BC cut divided proportionally. £_@-L2 PD_QC_2_ can see, since since BQ is twice twice QC, AP is twice twice PD (a ratio ratio of 2 to 1). A 2:1 ratio ratio means means that that AP is -2‐3‐1‐ : ~g - = As we can 2+1 3 2 the length length of AD AD.. AD AD is then then ~5 x 7.5 = : [fil. I. If you you prefer prefer to do length PD be x. the do things things algebraically, algebraically, then then let length PD be ‐ 2 Then length length AP AP is 2x, and and since since AP AP and and PD PD sum sum to AD A D , 2x 2x + x == 7.5. This equation z 2.5 and we get Then equation gives gives x = and we AP = : 2x = = 2(2.5) 2(2.5) = : @J I. . AP 196 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA Radians radian is simply simply another another unit used to measure measure angles. have feet meters, pounds and A radian unit used angles. Just Just as as we we have feet and and meters, pounds and kilograms, we we have degrees and radians. kilograms, have degrees and radians. 7Tradians radians = 180° 180° Tr If you've you’ve never never used used radians radians before, before, don don't be put put off it’s just just aa number. number. We We could’ve If ' t be off by by the the 7T. Tr. After After all, all, it's could've written written 3.14 radians radians :::::; z 180° 180C instead, but but everything typically expressed expressed in terms terms of 7r working with with radians radians.. Furthermore, Furthermore, Tr when when we're we're working instead, everything is typically is only only an anapproximation. given the conversion factor factor above, above, how radians? 3.14 is approximation. So, given the conversion how would would we we convert convert 45° to to radians? 7Tradians __ .:: 71 d" 450 45° xx Tr radians 180° 4 radians ra ians 1800 - Z Notice that that the degree units units (represented (represented by the the little little circles) cancel u t just just as they should should in any conversion Notice the degree cancel oout as they any conversion 3 problem.. Now N o w how how would would we convert convert 7” degrees? Flip Flip the the conversion ; to degrees? problem conversion factor. 3rr d.1ans x ---= -3‐H ra radians & 1800 : 2700 0° 2 Tr radians 7Tradians You might be wondering wondering why why we we even even need need radians radians.. Why n o t just just stick this another another difference might be not stick with with degrees? degrees? Is this difference between rest of the and meters? meters? Nope the chapter chapter on on between the the U.S. U S . and and the the rest the world, world, like like it is with with feet and Nope.. As we'll we’ll see see in the circles, some calculations are much easier are expressed expressed in radians circles, some calculations are much easier when when angles angles are radians.. EXAMPLE9: EXAMPLE 9: y m In the above, line origin and and has a a slope slope of y/j. the xy-plane xy-plane above, line m m passes passes through through the the origin Vi. IfIf point point A A lies lies on on line line m m and point point B lies lies on on the x-axis as as shown, what is the the measure, measure, in radians, angle AOB? AOB ? and the x-axis shown, what radians, of angle A).:: A); 71: 6 B)? n B) n: 5 C).:: D).:: C); D)? 4 3 7T 7T 197 CHAPTER 22 CHAPTER TRLANGLES TRIANGLES We can can draw from A to the We draw aa line line down down from the x-axis x-axis to to make make aa right the slope slope is v'3, V3, the ratio of the right triangle. triangle . Because Because the the ratio the height of this height base is always to 11 (rise (rise over over run). this triangle triangle to its base always \/5 v'3to run). y m This right right triangle triangle should should look triangle. Angle the fi, v'3,so This look familiar familiar to you. you. lt's It’s the the 30-60-90 30‐60‐90 triangle. Angle AOB A 0 3 is opposite opposite the so its its measure is measure is 60°. Converting Converting that that to radians, radians, 7T 60 x 180° 2 3 Answer Answer ~(D) . 198 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 324. V. calculator should should N NOT A calculator O T be on the be used used on following following questions. questions. X The lengths length s of the the sides sides of a The are x, a right right triangle triangle are 2, and and x + 5. 5. Which Which of the x -‐ 2, the following following equations could could be used to find x ?? equations be used A) +X - 2 = X +5 + (x + 5)2 = (x - 2)2 + (x - 2)2 = (x + 5)2 (x - 2) 2 + (x + 5)2 = x2 X square of side side length length 6 A square the figure 6 is shown shown in the figure above. What the value above. What is the value of x ?? B) x2 C) x2 D) 6 A) WE A) 3v'2 B) 6 C) WE C) 6v'2 D) 6v'3 6\/.’§ B B I C A D Note: Note: Figure n o t drawn drawn to scale. Figure not ln BDC above, the length In .6 ABDC above, what what is the length of W DC?? C A) 3 the figure figure above, above, E In the || CB. What is the AB II CD. What the length length of AB AB?? B) 5 C) 5\/§ C) 5v'3 D) 8 199 CHAPTER 22 TRIANGLES CHAPTER TRIANGLES Two angles same measure. measure. angles of a a triangle triangle have have the same IfIf two 15and the two sides sides have have lengths lengths 15 and 20, what what is is the greatest possible greatest value of the of the possible value the perimeter perimeter of the triangle? triangle? Note: drawn to scale.. Note: Figure Figure not not drawn to scale In the the figure figure above, above, the the base base of of a a cone cone has has a a radius sliced horizontally so radius of 6. The The cone cone is is sliced horizontally so that the top that piece is a smaller cone with a height top piece smaller cone with height of 1 and and a base base radius radius of 2. What What is the the height height of of . the bottom the bottom piece? piece? N N ~ 5 M 5 8 A) 1 B) 2 C) 3 O 0 D) 4 What area of isosceles What is the area M NO isosceles triangle triangle MNO above? above? A B H 10 C Note : Figure not drawn to scale . the figure In the figure above, above, E AB is parallel parallel to to flGH and and 57 OF is parallel ‐C". If = 1, 1,EH = 3,EC 2 2, 2, and parallel to 'BBC. If DE DE = EH = 3, EG = and HC = 10, what what is is the length OfAD of AD?? HC 2 10’ the length the figure figure above, In the anequilateral on above , an equilateral triangle triangle sits on top of a a square. top If the an area of 4, square. If the square square has has an area what is the what the area area of the the equilateral equilateral triangle? triangle? A)) \ v'3 A /§ \/§ B) )v'3 B T 2 3 OZ C) 4 D D) ) 1 200 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA THE A calculator is allowed allowed on the following following questions questions.. cC DE How radians are H o w many many radians are in 225° ?? A) 37T 37r - D...,______ T4 7rr 77r B) - ?6 5rr Sn C) - A 74 0) E B ABC above, L CDE = and AA L A = 90° In 6 AA B C above, ACDE = 90° and 90°.. AB : 9and DE = 6, 6,whatis AB = 9 and AC AC = 12. If DE what is the the length of CE length CE?? 337r rr - 72 A)) 6 A B) 8 C) 9 0)) 110 D 0 A ~ B 9 C E F w W Triangle ABC ABC above similar to to triangle triangle DEF. DEF. Triangle above is similar What is the perimeter of triangle DEF ? What the perimeter triang le DEF? A ) 220 0 A) zZ 20 20 B) 26.8 C C)) 3300 12 12 D) 36.2 0) ________________ X J 15 15 yY Two above are are Two poles poles represented represented by by W XW and and W YZ above 15 feet 20 feet 15 feet apart. apart. One One is 20 feet tall tall and and the the other other is 12 feet rope joins joins the 12 feet tall. tall. A rope the top top of one one pole pole to the the top of the other. What is the length of the rope? top the other . What the leng th the rope? ABC,, E shortest side side.. In isosceles isosceles triangle triangle ABC BC is the the shortest If the degree measure of LA is a multiple of 10, the degree measure L A is a multiple 10, what is the the sma smallest possible measure measure of L [BB ?? what llest possible A) 75° A 2 A)) 112 B) B) 70° B) B) 17 17 C) 65° C) C) 18 18 D) 60° 0) D) 0) 19 19 201 201 CHAPTER 22 TRIANGLES CHAPTER 22 TRIANGLES y A( - 2,4) 24 35 What is the What the perimeter perimeter of the the trapezoid trapezoid above? above? A) 100 A) B) 108 C) 112 D) 116 B(- 2, - 3) C(5, - 3) Points A, B, and C form a triangle in the xy-plane shown above. What is the measure, in radians, of angle BAC? A);6 7[ A) B)? B) 4 C)? C) 3 8 7[ 7[ X D); D) 2 7[ What is the the value triangle above? What value of x in the the triangle above? y A z D parallel lines lines are Two parallel are shown shown in the xy-plane the xy-plane above. If If AB AB := 15 and point point B has has coordinates coordinates above. 15 and n ), what what is the the value (m, n), value of n? n? ln the the figure figure above, above, ABC ABCDD is aa square In square of side side length 3. AW = length 3. If AW : AZ AZ = CX = CY : 1, 1 , what w h a t is is CY = the perimeter rectangle WXYZ the perimeter of rectangle WXYZ? ? A A)) -‐ 66 A s fi A) ) 3v2 B) B) 4\/§ 4v2 C e fi C) ) 6v2 B B)) -‐ 8 C)) -‐ 9 C D 2 D)) -‐ 112 D) 8 202 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA B A B D C In the figure above, circle O is inscribed in the square ABCD. If BO = 2, what is the area of the circle? In the figure above, equilateral triangle A BC is inscribed in circle D. What is the measure, in radians , of angle ADB? A) A) 7T A) 4 7T 27T 27r ?3 37T 37r 8) B) - 8) 2 C) 7T D) T4 37T 2 47T 471 C) C) “5‑ 5 57T Sn D) D) 76 y D A X 2 In the the figure figure above, [n above, the the value value of % where ~~ is k, where . C constant. Which Which of the the following following ratios k is a constant. ratios has has 1 a a value value of ik?? 45° B What the length length of DB the figure figure above? What is the DB in the above? A) 2v'3 M5 3 3 8) B) 2./6 216 C) C) 4./6 sfi 3 3 z Z 3 YZ A) A) flxz 8) B) W xw C) C) W XY xy XY yz YZ YW YW D) D) XW xw \/5 D) v'3 203 CHAPTER 22 TRIANGLES CHAPTER TRIANGLES y B B(2,8 ) E F +---+--------'~--x 0 A D C 0 (8,0 ) In the xy-plane above, points A and C lie on OB and BO, respectively . If AC is parallel to the x-axis and has a length of 3, what is the length of Equilateral triangle triangle DEF DEF is inscribed inscribed in __ Equilateral equilateral triangle triangle ABC ABC such that E equilateral such that 1 AC. ED 1AC. What is the the ratio ratio of the the area area of ADEF 6. 0EF to the the area area What ABC?? of ABC BC? A)) 11 ::4 A 4 B)) 1 ::33 B 1:2 C) 1 :2 0)) 5 ::88 D v B C A D A A‘ B the figure figure above, above, equilateral equilateral triangle triangle AED In the AED is the figure figure above, above, a a semicircle semicircle sits sits on on top top of a In the a square of side side 6. Point Point A is at the the3p top of the the square semicircle . What What is the the length length of AB? semicircle. AB ? contained within within square square ABCD the contained ABC D.. What What is the degree measure measure of [LBBEC? degree BC? A) B) C) D) 60° 100° 100° 120° 120° 150° A) A) 3\/§ 3 v15 B) 7 C) 9 D 3m D)) 3v'IO 204 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA In AABC, ZABC = 120° 120°.. 6 ABC, AB AB = BC BC := 6and 6 and L ABC = What is the the area area of AABC 6 ABC?? What A A N5 A)) 2v'3 B) B) 4\/§ 4v'3 C) 6v'3 C ) s fi D) W3 D) 9v'3 3 0 O 4 E C In the square DBCE DBCE has has aa side side the figure figure above, above, square length 4, what is the length AD ? length of 3. If OE OE = 4, what the length of of AD? y 3! e x ( v'3, -‐ 11)) N3, A In the xy-plane above, above, angle formed by the xy-plane angle 9 0 is is formed by the the x-axis and and the the line shown.. What line segment seg ment shown What is the measure, in radians, measure, radians, of angle angle 0 ? ? ?3 B) B) T4 -‘ 4 4 F 571 57T A) A) B 12 12 77r 77T 97r 9n C) C) ?5 1171 lln D) D) T6 D C Square ABC D above Square ABCD above has aa side side length length of 12. If If BF : 4, 4, what what is is the length of BE? BF = the length of BE? A A)) 3 B)) 2,/2 B zfz C) C) 3\/§ 3,/2 D) ) 4,/2 D Ni 205 CHAPTER TRIANGLES CHAPTER22 22 TRIANGLES A R E D B Q 15 15 T In the above, RT RT = = 17 17 and the figure figure above, and g QS is perpendicular perpendicular to RT. RT . What What is the the length length of B7" ST to C the nearest nearest tenth the tenth of a unit? unit? In the the figure figure above, = 12, AC = 13, and and above, AB = DE = 3. What is the DE What is the length length of AE AE?? A) 12.6 A) B) 12.8 C) 13.2 D) 13.4 B C X D 2 B~---------JE 4 A X A F C Note: Figure Figure nnot Note: o t drawn drawn to scale. scale. Note: Figure Figure nnot Note: o t drawn drawn to scale. the figure figure above, above, 51? In the DE is parallel parallel to K. AC. The The perimeter 12but no perimeter of triangle triangle BDE BOE is is at at least least 12 but no more p, of triangle triangle ABC ~ore _than than 16. If If the the perimeter, perimeter, p, is one possible value of p ?? 1san an integer, mteger, what what is one possible value In the above, points lie on A_C the figure figure above, points B amuz" and E lie AC and OF, respectively and fi, respectively,, such that BEis to such that BE is parallel parallel to 5. What is the x? CD . What the value value of x? A) Jé ,/6 A) B ) z fi B) 2./2 C) 2\/§ 2)3 C) D) 3 206 23 Circles Circles Should Know: Circle ~acts Facts Yoµ You Should Know: Area of a a circle: rrr2 Area m2 Circumference Circumference of a 2m a circle: 2nr Arc,,Length: Arc Length: ~ % ·x 2m 2,rr ! Area of a3 Sector: Sector: % x nr 7tr22 ,Ar.ea OR OR Or if 09 is in in radians radians Or OR érze if 60is is in radians radians ½r20 Central angles have have the same measure measure as a r t s that they ”carve out.” <;'.fil\tra.Langles the same as the the arcs-that they "carve out." A ‘ B Many Many students students confuse length with with arc measure. The length is is the the actual actual distance one would would travel travel oonfuse arc length arc measure. The arc arc length distance one along the circle from from A to B. Arc measure is the number of degrees one turns through from A to B. You alotrg the Ate measure the number degrees one turns through from A to B. You can think of it as asa rotation along along the the circle circle from from A to B. A A full full rotation rotation is is 360°. 360°. can think a rotation Inscribed angles angles are are half half the the measure measure of the arcs that that they Inscribed the arcs they ”carve "carve out." out." 60° I .. . 207 CHAPTER 23 CIRCLES CHAPTER CIRCLES .Oways 90°. extension of the the previous angle · inscribed • . · P) Angles in aa sewi~ semicircle arei are always 90°. This is is just just an an extension previous fact. An angle inscribed in aa semicircle carves out half ~,circle, a circle, or 180°, 180°,which which means means the angle itself itself is half half that, that, or 90° 90°.. "circle~a,tves the angle @ . is Aradiusdrawntoalinetangenttothecimleisperpendicular to that line: ./ .;, E}"eirele perpendicular to that line: ® ‘x Gen.etal eq:uation1)£a .circlemthe__ xy-plane: Germlequationofacircleinthexy-plane: (x‐h)2+(y‐k)2=r2 ',.'. y31 '," II where~{h, (h,k) radius. wh~ fllsisthecenterofthecimleandrisits -the center.of the-circleand r is i~ ;radius. EXAMPLE1: ~ i' ~/' ... ~.\, + ... ,. ln above, the outer s radius as the the inner cltcle' s. What the ratio In ,the the .fi~ figure above, outer citcle' circle’s radius is twice twice as as long long as inner circle’s. What is the ratio of the the areaoftheshadedregiontotheareaoftheunshaded region? of the unshaded region? ~a o~ the $haded region-to the area A); B)1 B)l C)2 C)2 D)3 0)3 208 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA THE the radius radius of of the inner inner circle circle be Then the the radius radius of the is 2r. Let the be r. Then the outer outer circle is Area of inner inner circle: n:r m22 Area Area of outer outer circle: n:(2r 7T(2r)2 )2 Area of shaded region: 7r(2r)2 7rr22 = : 4n:r 47'tr22 -‐ n:r m22 = : 3n:r2 37rr2 Area shaded region: n:(2r) 2 -‐ n:r Shaded 3n:r2 Shaded 37tr2 3 -U -n-sh _a _d_ e_ d = _n:_r_ Unshaded : 7rr22 = ‑ The answer answer is J ((D) The D) J.. EXAMFLE2: mm 2; C B 2 Whatistheareaofmeshadedregioninfltefigureabove? What is the areaof the shaded region in the figureabove? Aug‐Vi wig‐Ni 0125‐2 m g - fi get the the shaded shaded area, area, we we must must subtract subtract the the area area of the the triangle To get triangle from the the area of the the sector. 45° 45° n:r _ sector.. -360° 7Tr2 = ‐Area of sector· . '360 ° 1 7f _ 7r(2 _ -N 2 -81 n( 22z) = 2 8 triangle: Draw Draw the the height height from from point point A to base 45‐45‐90 triangle. triangle. Because also Area of triangle: base CB. This makes makes a3 45-15-90 Because AC AC is also radius,, its its length length is 2. 2. Using the 45-15-90 45‐45-90 triangle triangle relationship, relationship, the aa radius Using the the height height is then then % ~ = fl. ,/2.. 1 1 1 : ébh Area = (2)( v'2)= = 2bh == 2(2)(fi) x6 v'2 i- shaded region : g ‐ flV2 Area of shaded region = The answer answer is ~-(D) . The 209 CHAPTER 23 CIRCLES CHAPTER CIRCLES EXAMPLE 3: EXAMPLE3: A 120° 0 B Adielewithadiame’wrof’misshowninfitefigureabova IfziAOB =-120°,whatisthelengthofminor mXE“? , , $2955 0 ·'1107: 011. ,, 3 t. 120° 1200 (2m ) = w(2flr) ‐ 360° 1 1071’ ~(2n x 5) = 110n §(27T x5)‐‑ 3 3 I The The answer answer is ~(C) .- “W134: C In ,the the ngure figureabove, A C E is is inscribed inscribed in in 0ircle circle O:_ 0. What What is the ln .,above, [LACB the measure measure of of angle angle ACB ? ? A) 15° 15° B) 30°· 30° C) 45° C)45° D) 60°° D)60 The measure arc AB XE is the as the central angle angle LAAOB, AC B is The measure of minor minor arc the same same as the measure measure of central AOB, 90°. Inscribed Inscribed angle angle ACB §j. half half of that, that, 45°. Answer Answer (C) . 210 PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE THE BXAMPLH5: EXAMPLE5: fi‐a+f+@=m x2- 4x + y 2 + 2y = 31 the ·eirde? eentet of the'circle? the center the ,coordihates · of the are thecoordinatesof What are gh'ren.above. · is ~ the,~ 'i:ltd e&:1, ::of ·.aniflemfm ~uati:on .:i".i "f ' Theeqnafiom the“ xy‘plane is given above. What - 2,-‐ 11)) A}( A )(‐2: ij))((-42,1) 8 :1) - 1,2) C)()(412) C 0)(2, D )(2, ‐- 11)) square the square complete the have to complete we have r 2 , we = r2, k) 2 = + (y ‐- k)2 h)2+ form (x ‐- h)2 the standard circle in the the circle To get equation of the standard form the equation get the review should review you should square, you the square, complete the how to complete know how don't know the y's. and once x 's and the x’s once for the twice, once twice, once for the y’s. If If you you don’t with x, Starting with do it. Starting how to do contains many which contains the many examples examples of how chapter, which quadratics chapter, the quadratics 2 ((xx-‐ n ++e2y y ==3311 4 + fy2 -‐ 4 2)2 Then Theny,y, u‐2P‐4+@+1F‐1=m ( X - 2 )2- 4 + (y + 1)2- 1 = 31 (x‐n2+@+1V=36 - 2)2 + (y + 1) 2 = 36 (x Answer ~(D) .radius is 6. Answer the radius and the center is at (2, ‐- 11)) and can see we can standard form, the standard From the From form, we see that that the the center 211 CHAYTER 23 CHAPTER 23 CIRCLES CIRCLES CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 330. A calculator is allowed allowed on the following following questions. questions. A B pP The circle circle above above has has area area 367t 36rr and The and is divided divided into into congruent regions. regions . What What is the the perimeter 8 congruent perimeter of one of these these regions? regions? one D C A) A) 6+1.57r 6 + l.Srr B) 6+27T B) 6 + 2n In the figure above, above, the the square [n the figure square ABCD ABC D is inscribed in a circle . If the the circle is r, inscribed a circle. If the radius radius of the r, what is the the length length of arc APD APO in terms terms of r? what r? A) 12 + l.Srr C) 12+1.57r D) 12+27r D) 12 + 2rr nr 4 rr; B B)) - ‐ Which of the the following following is is an an equation a circle circle Which equation of a the xy-plane center ( -‐ 22,, O) 0) and an area in the xy‐plane with with center and an area 49rr?7 of 4971 C) nr C) D) D) nr 2 4 A) ) ((xx- ‐2) 22+) y 2 = 7 A B) +y2=7 B) (x+2)2 (x + 2) 2 + y2 = 7 C) (x C) ( -‐2)2 +y2=49 2)2+ y2 = 49 D) +y2=49 D) (x+2)2 (x + 2)2 + y2= 49 the figure figure above, above, three three congruent congruent circles circles are are In the tangent to each each other other and and have have centers tangent centers that that lie on on the diameter diameter of a larger larger circle. the area the circle. If [f the area of each each of these these small circles is 97t, 9n, what what is the the area small circles area of the the large large circle? A) A) 3671 36n B) 497r 49n C) 64n 647t D) 8171 81rr 212 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA B B Note: Note: Figure Figure not not drawn drawn to scale. scale. In is ln the the figure figure above, above, equilateral equilateral triangle triangle ABC A BC is inscribed D. If If the the area area of of circ/lxe D is inscribed in circle circle D. circle Dis 36m the length minor arc 36n, what what is the length of minor arc AB AB ?? In the CB is inscribed the figure figure above, above, [L AACB inscribed in aa - circle. The The length length of minor circle. minor arc AB is what arc AB what fraction of the the circumference fraction the circle? circle? circumference of the A) 27r 2n A); 1 B) a); 4 C);61 C) 1 A) 3 B) 37r 3n B) 47T C) 47r D) D) 67r 6n mg 1 D) 12 C In the C has radius of of 6. If the figure figure above, above, circle circle C has aa radius 6. If the the shaded shaded sector 1071, what what is the the the area area of the sector is 10n, measure, AC B ? measure, in radians, radians, of angle angle ACB? A) A) In the above, AC is a circle the figure figure above, a diameter diameter of the the circle and the and AB is 1. 1. If the radius of the length length of AB the radius of the the circle is 1, what circle degrees, of what is the the measure, measure, in degrees, LBAC L BAC?? 27r 27T ?5 471 47T 79 57r 57T C) 79 Sn 57T D) D) T8 B) B) 213 CHAPTER 23 CIRCLES CHAPTER CIRCLES A C B 1n the the figure figure above, above, a circle has In center C and and has center radius 5. If measure of central radius If the measure central angle angle AC ACBB is 7T 7T 4 2 The base base of a right right circular circular cylinder The cylinder shown shown above has a radius of 4. above has radius 5. What 4. The The height height is 5. What is surface area area of the the cylinder? cylinder? the surface between g and and g radians, radians, what what is one one possible between possible A) 4 40rr A) 0” 60rr B) 607r integer value value of the length integer length of minor XE ? minor arc arc AB? 72rr C) 7271 D) 81rr D) 8171' H _...;..._--------~------1 figure above, above, circle P and In the figure and circle U each each have radius of 3 and and are are tangent have a radius tangent to each each other. other. .6.P HU equilateral, what ifIf API-I U is equilateral, area of the what is the area shaded region? shaded region? 1n the figure In figure above, above, four four circles, each each with with radius radius are tangent tangent to each each other. other. What What is the 4, are the area area of the shaded shaded region? the region? A)) 16 A 1 6-- 44rr 7r B ) 6 4 ‐ 4 7 B) 64 - 4rr1 C 7r C)) 6 644 -‐ 88rr A) lOrr A) 1 0 " B)) 1271 12rr B D) D) 64 64‐167r - 16rr D) 1 15rr D) 5” C)) 1471 14rr C 214 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA (x + 2)2 + (y + 4)2 =4 The equation equation of a a circle circle in the the xy-plane xy-plane is given The given above . Which Which of the the following must be be true? above. following must true? I. The the circle ). The center center of the circle is at (2,4 (2,4). II. tangent to the the x-axis. I I , The The circle circle is tangent x-axis. III. The circle circle is tangent tangent to the the y-axis I I I , The y‐axis.. A) I]II only only A) B) III only I I I only and II only 11only C) I and D)) II,, III, D I , and and 111 Ill AA Note Note:: Figure Figure not n o t drawn drawn to scale. scale. If If the the area area of the the shaded shaded region region in the the figure figure 24rr and above is the radius of circle O above 247r and the radius circle 0 is 6, 6, what what is the the value value of x ? A) A ) 115 5 B) B) 30 C) 45 C) 45 D)) 6600 D A AA D B In the the figure figure above, above, circle circle A is tangent tangent to circle circle B 3 at the circles at point point D. If If the circles each each have have aa radius radius of 4 and AC is tangent and A‐C tangent to circle circle B at at point point C, what what is the triangle A BC ?7 the area area of triangle ABC A) 8 B ) 8y'2 s fi B) est/5 C) 8v'3 D ) 116 6 D) 215 24 ometry Trigonometry Trigon “ need to know: you need functions you illustrate the three triangle to illustrate We'll use right triangle three trigonometric trigonometric functions know: 5-12-13 right a 5‐12‐13 use a 13 5 5~ u sinxzmzi 5 opposite . = sm x = -~--hypotenuse 13 13 hypotenuse 12 12 c o s x z n g opposite = -5 tanxzopPOSltezi tan X = ----'---''--12 adjacent · 12 adjacent = cosx = -~-hypotenuse hypotenuse 13 adjacent 12 they ' re just were just ordinary as ifif they were functions as trigonometric functions It’s important ordinary numbers. numbers. After After all, they’re these trigonometric important to see these It's . . . . . 1 similar. angle are Similar. 30° angle a 300 with a triangles With right triangles ratios. always equal equal to 5.. Why? Because Because all right example, sin 30° is always ratios . For example, 2 The ratios ratios of the sides sides stay the same. same. 2 1 . \f3 v'3 I 4 2 v'3 2\/§ tan x differently and tan treat sin x, cos x, and because they treat Many students over-complicate differently than than regular regular trigonometry because over-complicate trigonometry Many students following: the like mistakes make sometimes students , numbers. Perhaps Perhaps because because of the notation notation, students sometimes make mistakes following: numbers. . sin 2x : ssm i n2 --= X treat them and treat 2x and and 2x sin and The above n o t possible possible because because sin 2x o n e "entity." "entity.” You cannot them separate sin cannot separate 2x is one above is not independently just like you you can't can’t separate x ) into into f and and x. separate Jfl (x) independently 216 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA The definitions definitions of sine, The cosine, and and tangent tangent are are best memorized through through the c t m y m SOH-CAH-TOA, sine, cosine, best memorized the aacronym SOH-CAH-T OA, S for over hypotenuse), S for sine (opposite over hypotenuse),C for cosm' e (adyacenft over and T t (opposite C for cosine_(adjacent ovet hypotenuse), hypotenuse),and T for for tangen. tangent(opposite ov~r w e t adjacent) ' t).. momite Aside you should should also also memorize identity: Aside from from the the definitions, definitions, you memorize the the following following very very important important identity: sinx = cos(90° cos{90° - x) sinx Themeverseisalsotrue. The reverse is also true. cosx=sin(90°‐x) cos x = sin(90 ° - x) Expressed in radians, Expressedin radians, sinxzcos(‐72£‐-x) sinx = cos ( - x) 1 . (1f ) . cosx=sin(g‐x) COS X = SlI\ Z - X and and . Now, the trig functions depends Now, the sign sign of each each of the trig functions depends on the the quadrant quadrant in which which the the angle angle terminates. terminates. y I II -----0 -+------ m X IV • Sine, Sine, cosine, cosine, and o tangent are all positive positive in in the the first quadrant. and tangent are all quadrant. 0 Only sine sine is is positive podfive in in the the second second quadrant. quadrant. • Only 0 tangent is is positive the third third quadrant. • Only Only tangent positive in in the quadrant. • Only Only cosine cosine is 0 is positive positive in the the fourth fourth quadrant. quadrant. These are are best through the Students Take Calculus). Calculus). All are Those best memorized memorized through the acronym acronym ASTC ASTC (All Students A l l the the functions functions am positive quadrant, only only sine the second, second, and positivein in the the first first quadrant, sine is is positive positive in the so on. and so on. 217 CHAPTER24 CHAPTER 24 TRIGONOMETRY TRIGONOMETRY ' 'I;Q. find the tb:e~,µ~e a qijg p;mdion :without a'oalculator, a ·ca1culator, . Tofin'd value of ofa’ttig Extraction'for-an foran angle angle without J)et ~tiiune w:hatth~cSignof the .results'he.tild be (positive ornegative). or negative). ' >1.: la.mewhat&iesigxioffiiemlt shouldbe . .2( referen~~gle (the drawing aa straight straight line X'-axis). If the Z Fin,d.the Find flievzefiexenoemgle (the acute angle you you get get by drawing line to the the x‐axis). If the angle ·is 225°, for example, th reference angle is 225° -‐ 180° =45°: = 45°.: angleis225°,f01'example,tchenel‘erenceanglei5225o ·, '+ l • .. "'-. ' ,,. ·"' .. ,· • ... ,\1,.'' ',· .. J-1•' ' ... t l • '' , : t ., ,t ~--.i..~• /' y ~ "' : . . l~ , l 'I ,1 ••~ 1 :. } ~ • ,c,- .. 2250 •/ ,1,,,t :t;,1 Don’t tQemorize memorize any formulas £bi; for finding the the reference reference angle. draw aa line line to -the the x-axis x-axis and Dontt arty formulas angle. Inst Just draw and fig:u:.re if out yow:se:lf! figmeitoutyomselfl 3. Use Useyourworm‐Mspecialfighttinglestogetthetfigvaluefortherefemceangle. 3. your 45-45--90.or 30-60-,90.special right ttiangles to get the trig value for the refe:r;enceangle. l'he SAT won't to calculate trig values for angles that aren't in thesespecial these special right TheSAT won't as~ ask you you tocalculate trigvalues for angles that aren'tin right triangles triangles ~ess ryou' re able t-0 use your calculator,. unless-ymflmabletouseymcalculator. 4. Makesumyourresnlthasthecomectsignfimstepme. M:akE}sw:e your result has t:l,;le c;o,rect sign from step one. 4. Let's do Let’s do aa couple couple simple simple examples examples.. l. 1. What What is the the value value of sin sin 330°? fourth quadrant quadrant and and sine sine is negative negative in the quadrant, the the result should be be Since 330° is in the fourth the fourth fourth quadrant, result should the reference help of a a diagram: diagram: negative negative.. Now N o w let' let’ss find find the reference angle angle with w i t h the the help y 330° The reference angle is 360° - 330° = 30°. Using the 30-60-90 1 v'3 . 300 opp 1 = = hyp 2 Stn I-~/. Since the result result should should be be negative, negative, sin sin 330° = ‐12 . 218 218 triangle , THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA 2. What the value What is the value of cos 135°7 135°? Since the second second quadrant quadrant and and cosine cosine is negative second quadrant, Since 135° is in the negative in the the second quadrant, the the result result should should be be negative . Next, negative. Next, we we find find the the reference reference angle angle:: y 135° reference angle angle is 180° 180° -‐ 135° = 45°. Using Using the the 45-4545‐45‐90 The reference 90 triangle, triangle, 1 1 cos 45° = = - 1- = v'2 adj hyp ,/2 2 1-1;1.- Since the the result result should should be be negative, negative, cos 135° = : ‐ ‐‐ 3. What What is the value value of tan tan 210°7 210°? Since 210° is in the positive in the the third third quadrant, quadrant, the the result result should the third third quadrant quadrant and and tangent tangent is positive should be be positive . Next, positive. Next, we we find find the reference reference angle angle:: y 210° The reference the 30--60 - 90 triangle triangle shown shown earlier, earlier, reference angle angle is 210° -‐ 180° = 30°. Using Using the 30‐60‐90 \/§ 0 11 )3 t a n 3=0 -° = =‐ -= ‑ tan30 \/5 )3 J; \/3 result should should be be positive, tan 210° = = I ‐3‐ 1.Since the result positive, tan 219 3 3 CHAPTER 24 TRIGONOMETRY CHAPTER TRIGONOMETRY • j• Finall~ Myywshmldnmoflzeflxefofloufingvahzesformmdw: you should memorize the following values for 0° and 90°: ' ~ sin0°=0 sin0 ° =0 cosO°=1 cos0 ° = 1 tan0°=0 tan.O° = 0 sin90°=lV sin90 °= 1 ~-, cos90°=0 cos90° = O = m190°=undefined tan 90° undefined Expmsshagwmmdians, fag,ressing 90° in radians , (i) =_1 cos (i) = 0 sin t¥t (;) = undefined 220 220 • t l "'i .,•.¢ ,,..., 1 .,.t •• - ;, ,I I, THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA CHAPTER EXERCISE: Answers for this chapter start on page 332. calculator should A calculator O T be should N NOT be used used on the the following questions. following questions. In right is 90° right triangle triangle ABC, ABC, the the measure measure of AC L'.C is and If cosA 2, what and AB AB = = 30. If cos A := ~, what is is the the length length of of If If cos 40° = a, what what is sin 50° in terms terms of a a?? AC?? AC A) a 1 B) - a E C) 9 900-‐ a D a fi D) ) a../2 Iftanx m , wha w h att is i s sin s i nxx iinn tterms e r m sof o fm m? 1f tan x = = m, In a a right right triangle, triangle, one such one angle angle measures measures x° x 0 such 0 that tan tan x° x := 0.75. What that the value What is the value of cos xx°0 ?? 1 A A) * ) x/m2+1 Jm + 1 2 B B) ) 1 ; C C) rn m ‐ _ m ‐ J1 - m2 \/1‐m2 ) Vm2+l Jm2 + 1 D D) ) x/l‐m2 J1 - m2 sin 0 + cos(90 cos (90 -‐ 0) sinG 6) + cosbl sin(90 6) cos 0 + sin (90 -‐ 0) For any For any angle angle 9, 0, which which of the the following following is equivalent to the the expression equivalent expression above? above? B A) 0 B) 22sin sin 6 0 C) 2 cos 0 2cos e 5 D) 2(sin + cos 9) 2(sin 0 + 0) A C Given that Given : 5 and right that AB = and tan tan B = ;g in the the right triangle above, triangle what is the the value value of above, what sin + cos B sin B + B?? 221 TRIGONOMETRY CHAPTER CHAPTER 24 TRIGONOMETRY following allowed on the following A calculator is allowed questions. questions. - 12) (Sm ‐cos32 sin(5m 12) cos32 = sin are in measures are angle measures In the the angle above, the equation above, the equation what is the m < 90°, what degrees. the value value If 0° < m degrees. If m?? of m B 3 I A C C the BC in the length of BCin the length what is the If x 0 = 0.25, what sin x° If sin above? triangle above? triangle y A( - 3, 5) N B B A CM C M C(12, - 3) lane the xy-p shown in the Right xy-plane ABC is shown triangle ABC Right triangle va lue of cos C ? above. the value What is the above . What 0 A A)) similar triangle ABC right triangle In the ABC is similar above, right figure above, the figure In and C B, and A, B, vertices A, with vertices to right N O , with MNO, triangle M right triangle 0, and 0, corresponding vertices M, N, and corresponding to vertices value of the value what is the B = 2.4, what tan 8 If tan respectively. respectively . If cos N ? cosN? B) 8 _8 17 17 i8 15 13 C) E 15 D)1‐7 222 THE PANDA THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA B A Note: Note: Figure o t drawn scale. Figure n not drawn to scale. : In the the figure figure above, abo:7e, cos(90° cos(90 ° -‐ x°) x0 ) = 8 it; is . What What is 17 C In cos x° : ~g. In right right triangle triangle ABC ABC above, above, cos x0 = If the value value of If BC := NE, 2 /k, what what is the of k k?7 the value value of cos xx°0 ?? the A) A) 6 E8 15 15 17 17 B) E B) 15 C) 8 8fi C) 17 15 D) 15 D) fi 17 B In a a right right triangle, triangle, the the sine the two sine of one one of of the two J;. acute angles angles is ?. acute What other What is the the sine sine of the the other acute acute angle? angle? 1 A) A) 5 2 B) A C Note: o t drawn Note: Figure Figure n not drawn to to scale. scale. j3 2 In the the figure figure above, above, ABC and and DBE DBE are are right right triangles. 10and triangles . If If DE = = 10 and the the tangent tangent of of angle angle BAC is 1.25, what of segment what is the the length length of segment BE BE ?? 1 C) C) /3 D) D) ,Ii 2 223 CHAPTER 24 CHAPTER 24 TRIGONOMETRY TRIGONOMETRY the figure figure above, above, AC In the AC is a a diameter diameter of the the AC := 1, 1, which circle. If AC gives which of the the following following gives the area area of triangle triangle ABC the ABC in terms terms of 0 0?? 0 A) 5 A) 2 tan0 m m) B) ) ‐ 2 B 2 2sin0 C) ZsinG D) D) sin0cos0 sin9c056 2 Given that that sin sin 9 0 ‐- cos 0 = Given = 0, where where 9 0 is the the radian measure measure of an angle, radian of the angle, which which the following could following could be be true? true? 7T rr I,0<9<'§ I.O < 0< 2 rr II. g << e0 << 7r 11. rr 2 377 3rr Ill. H rr < 9 0< ‑ III. 22 A) A) [only I only B) B) II II only only C) C) I and I I only and IIII only D)) I, and III D I , II, I I , and III 224 25 Data Reading Reading Data easiest are typically these are Fortunately, these charts . Fortunately, and charts. The SAT your ability ability to read read graphs graphs and typically the easiest loves to test your SAT loves the with arithmetic simple on you test just them of Most math. much too involve never they questions much math. Most them just you simple arithmetic with the because they never involve questions because graph. Practice a graph. extra having to interpret interpret a Practice away! away! step of having extra step 225 CHAPTER 25 READING DATA CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 334. following allowed on the following A calculator is allowed questions. questions . Voter Turnout Turnout in Elections Congressional Presidential Elections and Presidential Congressional and 80 75 70 E. .... Cl) 70 ..... ~ 0 65 > 65 cii 60 .....60 0 ..... 55 55 ..... 0 .....50 c:: Cl) 45 45 m.‘ __ ~ Cl) 40 0... 40 35 30 Commute Times 90 c, .. -" 75 1/) ~ E 60 _g <II E 45 ~ B• ~ ::, 30 E E D• (3 15 15 30 45 60 75 Commute Time to Work Commute Ttme 75 _ l ' _ -+. _ Congressional Election 1 ........ Election | Presidential Election + Presidential I "'... 90 plotted the commute For commute days, Alex plotted work days, four work For four work in time from work commute time the commute and the time time to work and was days was which of the four days above. For which the grid above. the grid work the and from work the commute time to and total commute the total greatest? greatest? ---,,.~ - -- --- ...__ --- -~~ I ~ ~ ~ ~ Year 8 N ;:: ~ ~ ~ ~ ~ turnout for voter turnout the voter The graph shows the above shows graph above election or aa congressional election a congressional each year a each year which ttwo held. In which was held. election was presidential wo presidential election turnout voter turnout difference in voter year was the difference period was year period and the between election and congressional election the congressional between the smallest? presidential election the smallest? presidential election A A)) A B) B A) A} 1996 to 1998 C C)) C B) 2000 to 2002 D D D)) D C) 2004 to 2006 D) 2008 to 2010 226 PANDA THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA Cream Sales Sales Ice Cream !_§ 1.75 ,,...._ 1.70 ... <J) ''f 400 f--"--- -------t 350 -----------, _§ 300 .... 250 ~ -+- -----, ---1'----200 f------·5.. ---- -------< --+---·o 150 ----~ -+-----, - ----p,.. 100 ---50 ro ‑ ..!!l 1.65 ' 0 ..... 1.60 -0 0 1.55 ' .9 1.50 <J) C ], 1.45 1.40 .s:! (ll (f) 1.35 ~ <J) o=------------a n s - u » --=..., ~ ogf~u o m ~ > 5 ~ §a § 3 §............. 5 i 3<(f)ozo a5°8 -~<~ ...... @ j :a o..~§:i Month Month N"J x" )x " ,3 q? '\9'\9 Ky Average Precipitation in Kathmandu Y’Q \\>Oc monthly the monthly shows the above shows The line graph above line graph According year . According last year. Kathmandu last precipitation precipitation in Kathmandu September precipitation in September total precipitation the total graph, the to the graph, precipitation in total precipitation the total percentage of the what percentage was was what June? June? Q\\0\'?f’§C} cream above, ice cream graph above, line graph the line According to the According and in 2014 both in 2013 and highest both were highest sales sales were period? three month during which during which three month period? A) 40% 8) 50% B) March A) January January to March June to June April to B) April B) C) July to September September C) 60% D) 75% December October to December D) October 227 CHAPTE R 25 READING READING DATA CHAPTER DATA Population in Population in 2010 Birth Rate Rate Birth -40 1-E1--.;::--c------~ -+- South Korea Japan San San Diego Diego Chicago Chicago ...... ~ 1! 20 1--------- ---- ~H co 10 10 2006 1 Population (millions) 2006 Researchers above to compare Researchers created created the the graph graph above compare their population estimates with the actual their population estimates with actual populations of different different cities in 2010. For which populations which the cities did did the researcher s underestimate underestimate of the the researchers the population? population? the 2008 2010 Year 2012 2014 Based on on the graph, graph, which which of the the following following best best describes the general trend in birth birth rates rates in describes general trend South Korea Korea and and Japan South Japan from from 2006 to 2014? Each year, birth rates rates decreased A) Each year, birth decreased in both both South Korea and South Korea and Japan Japan.. Each year, both B) Each year, birth birth rates increased increased in both South Korea and Japan . South and Japan. birth rates rates increased increased in South South C) Each year, birth but decreased decreased in Japan. Japan . Korea but Each year, birth birth rates rates decreased South D) Each decreased in South but increased Korea but Japan.. increased in Japan I. San San Diego Diego 1, II. Chicago Chicago 11, Ill 111.. Los Angeles Angeles A) B) C) D) D) ~"-c- t:: Angeles Los Angeles I only and 11 onl y lI and 11only lI and III only II and 111 only I, and IIII l, II, 11, and II 228 228 PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE I 30 28 U) ~ g 26 24 .It u ;:l 22 ~ ..... 20 >-0 .... ..c: 18 t)0 16 ~ 14 12 • - ,_ :: 6 5 10 20 ; • : • I • 30 40 50 Age (years) lL 1• • 60 70 0 ! ! : I ~ I\ \ I/ ·- I/ ~ \ \ I / 1! 2 ' i.. ~ 3 4 5 Hours since 9:00 A.M. the created the researchers created study, researchers certain study, a certain In a the the ages above to summarize scatterplot scatterplot above Summarize the ages of the hours of sleep the number and the participants and participants number of hours sleep following the following Which of the night. Whichof each night. required each they required age, in years, the age, the closest is the closest to the years, of the the least amount required the least who required participant who participant amount of night? each night? sleep each sleep up picks up Musa picks day, Musa each day, A.M. Starting at 9:00 A Starting M . each trailer until his locations until various locations packages at packages at various his trailer then maximum capacity. its maximum reaches its truck reaches truck capacity. He He then that up picked he that packages that he picked up that the packages all the delivers delivers all his of weight the shows the weight his above shows The graph day . The day. graph above during the points during different points at different truck at truck the day. day. What What is hold, in can hold, truck can Musa's truck weight Musa's maximum weight the maximum the tons? A) A ) 335 5 B) 40 A 4 A)) 114 55 C) 55 C) B) 16 8) 16 D D)) 6600 C 4 C)) 224 D D)) 3300 229 CHAPTER 25 READING READING DATA CHAPTER DATA Annual Salt Production in the U.S. Video Game Video Game Console Console Sales in 2015 ui' § ..... 40 u .E ui' 250 "O QJ @ E CJ) g "O @ 2 CJ) ;:l 0 2 20 20 "d 200 150 L ] i:: 0 ·.uc 10 ;:l "d 0 M p... 0 2009 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 2015 Year A B) 2012 to 2013 B) C) 2013 to 2014 A) A) A D) 2014 to 2015 D) B) B C) D D D) E ui' E ~ 400 ro .s 300 0 CJ) CJ) ro 200 E QJ 00 <13 M QJ ~ Cow Wolf Goat Cat Cat D E The graph graph above the number number of units sold The above shows shows the units sold in 2015 for five different different video game consoles. video game consoles. The prices of consoles consoles A, B,C, B, C, D, and The prices are $100, and E are and $300, respectively. respectively. Which Which $150, $200, $250, and of the five consoles consoles generated generated the the most most total total revenue? revenue? A) 2009 to 2010 ...... C Console Based on the the graph graph above, above , for which which of the Based the following ttwo consecutive years years was was the the percent percent following w o consecutive increase in U.S. annual salt production the the same increase U S . annual salt production same as the the percent percent decrease decrease from from 2010 to 2011? as ro M ..0 B Pig Animal According to the above, the According the graph graph above, the average mass average mass of a wolf's wolf's brain brain is what what fraction fraction of the the average average mass of aa pig’s pig's brain mass brain?? 230 IBE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA 20 ,....,_ ... Ill State Health Care Spending State Health Care Spending in 2013 -e-CompanyX -+-- Company Y ~ 0 -0 ..... 0 le 0 ~ 15 ~ 15 I "C 0 ~ ~ I..... e ll.. Hospital Care I --Prescription Drug I 0 :5 10 ..;:: _- 10 e 00 .s -g 5 5 Q) ~ 2 3 0 4 AL Quarter Quarter AK AZ AR State The graph shows the the profit profit of Company Company X The graph above above shows and Company Y in each each quarter and Company quarter of last last year. year. In which which quarter quarter was was Company Company X's X’s profit profit twice twice Company Company Y's? Y’s? The graph graph above shows the health care spending The above shows the health care spending four different different states, of four states, Alabama Alabama (AL), (AL), AK (Alaska), (Arizona), and and AR (Arkansas) (Alaska), AZ (Arizona), (Arkansas) in the graph, had the 2013. Based Based on on the graph, which which state state had the highest combined and prescription highest combined hospital hospital care care and prescription drug spending in 2013? drug spending A) 1 B) 2 A) Alabama Alabama C) 3 B) Alaska Alaska D) 4 C) Arizona C) Arizona D) Arkansas Arkansas 231 CHAPTER DATA CHAPTER 25 READING READING DATA ... ~ ~ 190 ·c ... 10 ;:l Q) 0 :r: ... Q) "O ..._,_ "' E 8 0.. -0 ... Q) Q) 6 j"' ], 4 ~ ~ "' i:: < > Q) .!!? <O u .....l Q) 2 "' 0 u ;:l 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 180 -170 160 150 J 140 130 120 110 0 Time (hours) ' i\ \ J l/ G 7 ,_ -- I \ I i [\ ' 1 2 .. 3 4 5 6 7 ~ ._ .. ~ 8 9 Time (Hours after 8:00 A.M.) Jeremy Jeremy works works at aa call call center. center. The The graph graph above above shows average number shows the the average number of calls he he answered answered per hour per hour during during his his 7-hour 7-hour work work shift. shift. What What is is the total total number answered during the number of calls he he answered during his his shift? shift? the day day of a medical Greg ate ate On the medical evaluation, evaluation, Greg breakfast at 8:00 A.M. and and lunch at 12:00 PM. P.M. breakfast lunch at During each each meal doctors recorded During meal,, doctors recorded his his glucose glucose levels in the the graph graph above above until until they they were able to levels were able calculate the the glucose glucose recovery the time time it took took calculate recovery time, the the body's body 's glucose glucose level level to return return to its initial for the its initial value at at the the start start of the the meal. meal. According According to the the value graph, by how how many many hours hours was Greg's glucose glucose graph, w a s Greg's recover y time time after after lunch greater than than his recovery lunch greater his glucose recovery time after breakfast? glucose recovery time after breakfast? A) 1.5 B) 2 C) 3 D) 5.5 232 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA THE Car X § 55 V =;;; 50 45 40 ~ 35 ] 30 '; 25 I\. ~ 20 bO i ~ ? t:: ~ l? 15 10 5 , I/ 7 7 -........_ ~ 7 I / 17 ' ' ! 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 Speed (miles per hour) mileage for Car The above shows shows the the gas gas mileage Car graph above The graph how graph, the on Based . X at different speeds. Based on the graph, how speeds at different Car X drive Car many gallons of gas gas are are needed X needed to drive many gallons per miles 30 of speed for 5 hours hours at a constant miles per constant speed hour? hour? 233 26 Probability Probability Generally speaking, speaking, probability probability can can be be defined defined as as Generally number of target target outcomes outcomes number number of total total possible possible outcomes number outcomes Nearly all probability probability questions questions on on the the SAT will will involve involve tables 80 for the purposes of the Nearly tables of data. data. So the purposes the SAT, probability can can more m o r e narrowly narrowly be be defined defined as as probability ‐-‑ number in target target group number group number in group group under under consideration number consideration EXAMPLE 1: EXAMPLE Beef Oricken First Class Coach 18 27 62 138 The a first class The table table above above summarizes summarizes the the meat meat preferences preferences of passengers passengers on aa particular particular flight. flight. If If a passenger passenger is is chosen chosen .at at random random from from this this flight, flight, what what is is the the probability probability that that the the passenger passenger chosen chosen prefers prefers hoofl · beef? 9 A)~ POE 40 2 B) ~ B)§ 5 3 C) C)§~ 5 D)~ D)§2 3 number of first class passengers passengers is 18 18 + 27 = : 45. This This is the the group under consideration. consideration. The The number number of The number group under class passengers passengers who who prefer prefer beef beef is 18. This This is the the target target group. group. first class number in target target group group number number in group group under under consideration consideration number Answer (B) . Answerefm. 234 234 18 2 18 45 = T 5 45 ‐-‐‑ THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA EXAMPLE manager of a large assembly line uses the table below to keep track of the number of m m . 2:- The Themanagerofalargeassemblylineusesthetablebelowtokeeptrackoffliemmmerof vehicles are produced during different the clay. day. vehicles that that are produced during different shifts shifts in the Cars First,shift • Second shift Third shift “m “Total 173 182 165 520 m Trucks - 126 143 109 378 . .:' Total 299 325 274 898 m If a vehicle is closestto probability is selected at random at the end of the day, which of the following following is closest to the probability that the vehicle will be either a car produced during the first shift or a truckproduced duringthethird during the third thatthevehiclewillbeeitheracarproduceddufingthefirstshiftoratruckproduced shift? A) 0.193 A)0.193~ •B) B) 0.314 0.314 C) 0.352 (30352 D) 0.421 In this all the the vehicles, vehicles, aa total total of 898 at at the the end the day. day. this question, question, the the group group under under consideration consideration includes includes all end of the The and trucks trucks produced during the the third The target target group group includes includes cars cars produced produced during during the the first first shift shift and produced during third shift, shift, aa total total of 173 + + 109 = = 282 vehicles vehicles.. number in target target group group number = 282 ~ 314 . . . ‐ x 00.314 number 898 · number in m group group under under consideration con51deration Answer (B) . Answer~. 235 235 CHAPTER CHAPTER 26 PROBABILITY PROBABILITY ‑ CHAPTER EXERCISE: EXERCISE: Answers Answers for this this chapter start on page chapter start page 336. A calculator is allowed allowed on the following following questions. questions. Speeding Truck T ruck Car m Total 68 83 151 Violation Violation Type Stop sign Parking 17 39 51 26 90 43 ‐ ‐ Total 124 160 ‑ 284 A district driving violations violations by type vehicle in above.. According According district police police department department records records driving type and and vehicle in the the table table above to the which of the the following is closest closest to to the the proportion violations committed committed by the record, record, which following is proportion of of stop stop sign sign violations by truck truck drivers? drivers? A) 0.137 B) 0.315 C) 0.433 D) 0.567 ----‑ Color Color Red Red Blue Percent 20% 33% Black 10% White White Silver 14% car manufacturer produces cars cars in red, red, blue, blue, black, A car manufacturer produces black, white, white, and table above above shows shows and silver. silver . The The incomplete incomplete table the percentage the percentage of cars cars it produces each color. If from the chosen at at random random,, what what is produces in each If a car car from the manufacturer manufacturer is chosen the probability probability that that the the silver? the car’s car 's color color is red red or or silver? A) 23% B) 33% C) 37% D) 43% 236 PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE THE -------------------T------------------information. following information. Questions 3-4 refer to the following Questions different experience in five different year of experience one year least one with at least California with workers in California number of workers the number shows the below shows table below The table The occupations. construction-related occupations. construction-related ‐‐ ‐ - - -‐ ‐- ‐ ‐ | ‑| Experience Years of Experience Painter 1 2 3 4 5+ Total 22,491 26,973 29,086 33,861 37,061 149,472 ‐Roofer - 23,908 -27,634 30,932 - 34,146 ‐ 39,718- 156,338 | 169,240 42,680 36,902 32,784 ‐Welder - 27,062 -29,812 | 183,885 45,376 40,083 36,670 33,119 28,637 Plumber ‐ - 28,806 - 34,867 ‐ 37,418 - 43,922 - 169,409 | 24,396 Carpenter ‐ ‐ | s2s,344 11 2os,757 1 1s2,410 1 164,339 1 146,344 1 126,494 1 I‐Total ‐ |1 the to the closest to is closest following is the following which of the random, which at random, California is chosen plumber in California a plumber table, ifif a the table, on the Based on Based chosen at experience? of years four least at has plumber the that probability probability that the plumber has at least four years experience? A) 0.10 B) 0.22 C) 0.25 D) 0.46 which the table, in the included in those included from those random from at random chosen at experience is chosen years of experience four years least four at least with at worker with a worker IfIf a table, which plumber? a plumber? person is a the person that the probability that the probability to the closest to is closest following is the following of the A) 0.10 B) 0.22 C) 0.25 D) 0.46 _ ‐ ‐ _ _ _ ‐ 237 _ A _ ‐ ‐ ‑ ‐-‑ CHAPTER PROBABILITY CHAPTER 26 PROBABILITY Won Lost Total Underdog Underdog 10 35 45 Favorite Total 25 5 40 30 75 ‐ - - 35 m The table categorized by whether the considered the was considered team was whether the team team, categorized baseball team, a baseball of a results of shows the results above shows table above favorite games in the games fraction of the What fraction (expected to lose). What underdog (expected game or the underdog in the game win) in to win) (expected to favorite (expected team win? which the team did the underdog did considered the underdog was considered team was which the team 2 A} - 5 2 B) 7 2 C) 9 2 D) 15 ‐ W e e Week k 11 Week2 W een 40 mMattresses m 61 ‐ Box springs ‐ Total ‐ - 35 47 82 ‐ “ 101 ‐ Week3e Week4 W e k Total s ‑ 68 88 - 55 m 77 ‑ 198 ‑ m 348 bedding weeks at a bedding four weeks over four sold over units sold mattress units and mattress number of box spring the number summarizes the A store spring and manager summarizes store manager sold? units sold? spring units fraction of all box spring what fraction accounted for what and 3 accounted above . Weeks 2 and table above. incomplete table store store in the incomplete 2 A A) ) 15‐ 4 B B) ) 15‐ 2 C) 5 4 D) D) 5 238 PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE THE Gold Silver Bronze Total USA 46 29 29 104 China 38 27 23 88 Russia 24 26 32 82 Great Britain 29 17 19 65 Germany 11 19 14 44 Total 148 118 117 383 Country m Olympics . If an Summer Olympics. London Summer the 2012 London at the awarded at medal s awarded distribution of medals the distribution shows the above shows table above The table The an the gives the which country table, which the table, countries in the the countries one of the from one random from at random chosen at be chosen medalist is to be Olympic medalist Olympic country gives Bronze medalist? a Bronze selecting a probability of selecting highest probability highest medalist? USA A) USA Russia B) Russia Britain Great Britain C) Great Germany D) Germany Species Fish Species Number of Fish Number Cartilaginous Cartilaginous Bony Bony 400 300 800 1,200 Philippines Philippines New Caledonia Caledonia New produced by were produced above were table above the table in the data in The data bony . The or bony. cartilaginous or either cartilaginous as either categorized as be categorized can be AU A l l fish can by species fish species each that Assuming Caledonia. New and Philippines the in species fish the studying biologists biologists studying the fish species in the Philippines and N e w Caledonia. Assuming that each fish how Philippines is the Philippines in the fish in a cartilaginous fish catching acartilaginous of catching probability of the probability being caught, the chance of beingcaught, equal chance an equal has an has is how Caledonia? New one in N catching one probability of catching the probability than the greater than much greater much e w Caledonia? A) A) 2 15 1 B) 4 3 C) 10 1 D) 3 239 CHAPTER CHAPTER 26 26 PROBABILITY PROBABILITY fires ‐ u g h m g -Lightning-caused c a u s e d fi m s Human-caused fires East East Africa Africa South South Africa Africa 65 65 Total ‑ 30 30 ‑ Total 135 220 The incomplete table wildfires that that occurred occurred in ttwo regions of Africa Africa in The incomplete table above above summarizes summarizes the the number number of wildfires w o regions 2014 by cause. cause. Based what fraction fraction of all human-caused? Based on the the table, table, what all wildfires wildfires in East East Africa Africa in 2014 were were human-caused? 11 A ) 24‑ A) ~~ B ) ‑ B) ~! C ) ‑ C) 11 D ) 15‑ D) Not defective Total Assembly Assembly Line L i n eA A m_ 300 5,700 Assembly B m_ 500 Assembly Line LineB 3,500 6,000 4,000 800 9,200 10,000 Defective Total A manufacturer The results results of each each assembly line's quality quality manufacturer uses uses two t w o assembly assembly lines lines to produce produce refrigerators. refrigerators. The assembly line’s control are shown in the table above. If a refrigerator from the manufacturer turns out to be defective, control are shown the table above. a refrigerator from the manufacturer turns o u t be defective, what what is the probability that the refrigerator was produced Line A? A? the probability that the refrigerator was produced by by Assembly Assembly Line A) 5% 5°/o A) B) 37.5% C) 60% D) D) 62.5°/o 62.5% 240 THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA ‐ Type of Residence ‑ _ Family members _ _ _ 1 2 3 4 or more ‐Total ‐ Apartment ‐‐ - - 10 20 8 8 - 46 Duplex 22 Single residence 3 35 12 ‐‐ ‐ Total 13 45 12 28 18 30 46 138 -n 8 4 n 46 _ m ‑‑ ‑ ‑ The table table above above summarizes summarizes the distribution of living a The the distribution living situations situations for residences residences in a a neighborhood. neighborhood. If a duplex in the neighborhood is to be be inspected inspected at at random, what is the probability that the residence duplex random, what the probability that the residence is the neighborhood occupied occupied by no no more more than than 22 family family members? members? 2 A) 23 B) 3) 6 23 17 C) C) 69 17 D )23‑ D) Number of soil soil samples samples Number Percent of samples samples Percent with Chemical with Chemical A Area 1 450 8% 8% Area 2 550 6% The who collected collected soil areas to The data data in the the table table above above were were produced produced by by ecologists ecologists who soil samples samples from from two t w o areas on the table, what determine whether they were were contaminated with Chemical A. Based determine whether they contaminated w i t h Chemical Based on the table, what proportion proportion of the the soil samples samples were were contaminated contaminated with with Chemical Chemical A? soil A) 0.067 B) 0.069 C) 0.070 D) 0.072 241 CHAPTER 26 26 PROBABILITY CHAPTER PROBABILITY Test negative Has v. virus Has .. Does nnot Does o t have virus have virus ‐_ Total 30 550 580 Test positive Total Total 370 50 420 400 600 1,000 1,000 ‐_ m m The that is is designed when patients patients are are The table table above above shows shows the the results results of of a a test test that designed to to give give a a positive positive indicator indicator when infected indicator when when they o t infected. to the the results, infected with with a certain certain virus virus and and a negative negative indicator they are are nnot infected. According According to results, what is the probability what probability that that the test gives gives the incorrect incorrect indicator? indicator? A) A) 5°/o 5% B) 8% B) 8°/o C) 10% D) 12% D) Drug Sugar Pill Cured Cured Not Not cured cured 90 25 incomplete table The incomplete study in gave patients experiencing back back table above above shows shows the the results results of aa study in which which doctors doctors gave patients experiencing pain either pain either aa drug as many many patients drug than from drug or a a sugar sugar pill. pill. Three Three times times as patients were were cured cured from from the the drug than from the the sugar pill. For every sugar by the the sugar sugar pill, pill, 5 patients were n o t cured by the According every 2 patients patients cured cured by 5 patients were not cured by the sugar sugar pill. pill. According the results, results, if a to the person will w i l l be be cured cured of of back a patient patient is given given a sugar sugar pill, what what is the the probability probability that that the the person back pain? pain? 1 A)?I A) 4 2 B); B) 7 C) 3 C)13‐0 10 2 D); D) 5 242 242 ‐‐‑ THE PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE -Juniors Seniors seniors Total Gym equipment Gym equipment 240 ‐ Computers " 300 160 460 Total m 540 computers . equipment or computers. gym equipment surplus on nnew budget surplus a budget whether to spend deciding whether school is deciding principal of aa school The principal spend a e w gym senior a senior If a students . If senior class students. and senior junior and among junior preferences among summarizes the preferences above summarizes incomplete table above The incomplete How ~- H equipment is 33. gym equipment prefers gym student prefers the student that the probability that the probability random, the at random, chosen at school is chosen from the school ow school? the school? are at the seniors are many seniors many 243 243 27 Statistics II Statistics list of numbers: Consider numbers: this list Consider this 5,6,2,2,2,7 5,6, 2, 2, 2, 7 average : the average: list is the the list The mean The m e a n of the 5+ 6 + 2 + 2+ 2+ 7 ‐ _ 6 _ 4 is 3. 3, 4, 5} is of {1, order. For the list middle when the middle number in the the number median is the The median The when the list is in order. For example, example, the the median median of {1, 2, 2,3,4,5} 3. looks like which looks list, which our For For o u r particular particular list, like 2,2,2,5,6,7 2,2, 2, 5, 6, 7 even an even there's an because there’s That's because median . That’s when there is no no single single middle middle number number we we can can consider consider the the median. ordered, there when ordered, numbers, middle two the of average the When that's the list numbers in the number of numbers number list.. When that’s the the case, case, the the median median is the average the t w o middle numbers, 2 and and 5: +5 22 T‐+ 5 _ '357 3.5 2 -l..::'.::::J looking for we're looking the median? determine the were 100 numbers list were the list Now numbers long? long? How How would would we we determine median? Well, if we’re for what if the Now what which designates take half sense to take number, it would the would make make sense half of 100 to get get 50, which designates the the 50th 50th number. number. But is is middle number, the middle it's the numbers. Maybe number of numbers. even number there's an since there’s Probably nnot the median? number the 50th number the 50th the median? Probably o t since an even Maybe it’s the average average large lists, with large See, with numbers? See, 50th numbers? and 50th 49th and the average numbers . Or is it the and 51st the 50th of the 50th and Slst numbers. average of the the 49th lists, it's it’s hard hard to tell. odd or even there's an odd whether there’s median: regardless the median: getting the technique for getting Here’s regardless of whether even number number of numbers, numbers, Here's my technique have Since we up" to 51. Since "go up” and “go divide by 2 to get numbers, we So for a list up." So always "go we always ”go up.” list of 100 numbers, we divide get 50 and we have For a list of 101 numbers. For 51st numbers. and 5lst average the the average the median numbers, 50 whole numbers, ttwo w o whole 50 and and 51, the median is the the 50th 50th and 101 numbers, numbers, 51st the Slst median is the the median number, 51, the whole number, one whole have one only have and "go get 50.5 and we divide ”go up" up” to 51. Since Since we we only divide by 2 to get we number. number . numbers (the out on a list of 3 numbers test it out works . Just but it works. weird but technique is weird this technique Yes, this Just for reassurance, reassurance, let's let's test (the median median numbers). 3rd and 2nd the of average the is median (the numbers 4 of list a and number) 2nd the is obviously numbers (the median the average the 2nd and 3rd numbers). obviously the 2nd number) and a list number the 2nd that the confirms that which confirms up" to 2, which "go up” then ”go take half numbers, we list of 3 numbers, For a list we take half of 3 to get get 1.5, and and then 2nd number For numbers whole The 3. to " up "go then and 2, get to 4 of half take we numbers, 4 of list median. For For a numbers, take half get and then "go up” The whole numbers 2 the median. is the median. the is numbers 3rd and 2nd the of average the average the 2nd and 3rd numbers the median. and that the confirm that and 3 confirm particular list, our particular the most up the The most often. often. In our list, it's it’s [I]. .. shows up that shows number that the number mode is the The mode 244 THE PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE number : smallest number: the smallest and the the list and biggest number between the difference between the difference range is the The The range the biggest number in the 7‐2:‑ 7 - 2 =~ how much words, how numbers is. In spread oout measure of how a measure deviation is a standard deviation The standard The how spread u t a list of numbers In other other words, much the the closer to the are closer numbers are more numbers when more lower when deviation is lower standard deviation mean. The standard the mean. from the "deviate" from numbers ”deviate” numbers the mean. mean. example, oour For example, mean. For the mean. from the away from out away spread out are spread numbers are The The standard standard deviation deviation is higher higher when when more more numbers ur list 2, 2, 2, 5, 6, 7 following list the following deviation than standard deviation higher standard have a higher would have would than the 5,5,5,5,6,7 5, 5, 5, 5, 6, 7 deviation the standard that the turns oout mean. It turns the mean. tightly clustered more tightly second list is more the second because clustered around around the u t that standard deviation because the we got these how we Don't worry second list is 0.83. Don’t the second deviation of the standard deviation the standard and the list is 2.28 and of oour u r list worry about about how these compare one know how Just know SAT. Just the SAT. on the deviation on the standard calculate the to calculate asked to never be values‐you’ll be asked standard deviation how to to compare one values-you'll never did. we just another's as with another's deviation with list's standard list’s standard deviation aswe just did. EXAMPLE1: EUMPLB 1: . . .' Sports Playing Sports Spent Playing Daily Hours Hours Spent Daily i 1---130 tl) o ... fz 20 --10 -0 I• 1 2 Hours 3 '-·. 'L at aa students at summarizes the above summarizes The histogµun histogram above the daily daily number number of hours hours spent playing playing sports sports for 80 students school. school. 80 students? sports for the 80students? spent playing daily number the mean PART 1: What What is is the mean daily number of hours hours spent playing sports PART students? sports forthe'80 playing sports spent playing daily number the median PART 2: What median daily number of hours hours spent for the 80students? What is the number of the number that by the divide that Then divide student. Then every student. number of hours total number up the total Sum up hours for every Solution: Sum Part 1 Solution: students.. students Total hours (0x5)+(1x35)+(2x15)+(3><25) _ 140 = _ I1.75 I x 5) + (1 x 35) + (2 x 15) + (3 x 25) = = (0 Total hours 80 80 students ‐ Number _ Number of students histogram (the histogram middle (the the middle are the ttwo students are 41st students and 4lst the 40th students, the 80 students, group of 80 Part 2 Solution: Solution: In a group 40th and w o in the hours playing spend 0 hours students spend have to). The first 5 students don't have their hours already students by their hours so so we don’t playing the students orders the already orders 40th student so the 40th student, so includes the 40th group includes sports next 35 students students spend spend 1 hour. hour. This group 40th student, student each day. The next sports each 41st the so student, 41st the includes group Now hours. 2 spends 1 hour. The next 15 students spend hours. N o w this group includes the 4lst student, so the 4lst spend students 15 next spends hour. student spends 2 hours. Taking the average, average, Taking hours. student spends student _ 1 + 2 _ l1ci Daily spent by 40th 40th student student + Daily Daily hours l s t student spent by 441st hours spent hours spent Daily hours -~ 2 2 -= 2 2 245 CHAPTER STATISTICS I CHAPTER 27 STATISTICS "EXAMPL'E2: EXAMPLEZ: / O O O O ~- •1 ., . ':~f·•.,1 ·, ,: 11-1 I ,,' ~ '••J, :/ I +'! 0 0 0 O o o o o 0o 5 4 5 2 33 4 11 2 Flights'I‘akeninaYear Taken ih a Year Flig,hts 6 O \ I .! O“ Q 0 0 Q o I\ , •6 ·.• I• I ., • , student students. If taken in a year by 19 college students. The dot plot above the number of flights flights taken If the the student number-of sumtnarizes the above summarizes dot P,lot describes the correctly describes following correctly the following which of the datfl, which took 6 Bights flights in in a is remov-ed removed from from the data, year is a year who -took changes to the statistical measures of the data? data? chc:Utges . · d~as~s ·· I.I Tue The tneatt mean1decreases. -\ t /"' decreases. n. I I . The median median decreases. d~creas~ ~ Therartge III. The range decreases. 1-¥'.J. . : , >''1 114 i~ I' ~ ,,.m. 1,»leme y B)Iandllon1y B.)I and.ll.ol'.d .r •~ • qr.andIDQnly C)IandIIIon1y , ll,andW D)I D)I,II,andIlI I ,I where outside where is far outside that is point that data point extreme data an extreme an outlier, year is flights in a year took 6 flights who took The is called called an outlier, an student who The student up . It (mean) average the brings the average (mean) up. data, itit brings rest of the data, than the this outlier Because this data lies. most of the lies. Because outlier is greater greater than the rest the data most maximum (6). the maximum (0) and mi:nimwn (0) the minimum since there range since the range increases the also increases also there is a larger larger gap gap between between the and the The median, decreases. The the range and the decreases and mean decreases the mean outlier is removed, this outlier When this When removed, the range decreases. median, however, however, is unaffected unaffected.. is and the students, and 19 students, are 19 there are outlier is removed, the outlier Before the calculate it. Before let's calculate this, let’s confirm this, To confirm removed, there the median median is and students, 18 are there removed, is outlier the After flight. one took who took one flight. After the outlier removed, there are 18 students, and student, who the 10th represented represented by the 10th student, does median of 1 does the median So the flight. 50 one flight. whom took one and 10th the represented by the the 9th 9th and 10th students, students, both both of whom median is represented the median median. Answer but the mean typically affect the outliers typically n o t change. n d in fact, outliers mean b u t not n o t the the median. A n s w e r [@] (C) . And change. A not w.eighing 230 panda, weighing Anqther panda, pounds. Another 200· pounds. ts 200 a group avetage weight EXAMPLE 3: 3: The average weight of a group of p'illt~~ pandas is ~PLE matty pandas How .. poun.ds H o w many group to 205 pounds. entire ..group average wej,ght grqup., :rais-mg oins:the pounds,jjoins the group, raising the the average weight of the the entire pandas pQ~ds were group? . , Qti~a.l \~oup'? fl),eoriginal ht the wei;e·in with less to do w have less questions have These questions averages . These problem that a word you will while, you Once will get a word problem that involves involves averages. ith Once in a while, cover to decided chapter, we decided this chapter, averages in this with algebra, more and m statistics and o r e to do with algebra, but but because because we cover cover averages cover statistics as well. here as problems here these well. word problems types of word these types always find the totals. You can always sums or totals. think in terms of sums questions on the SAT, think average questions When i t h average with dealing w When dealing average with s u m by multiplying multiplying the average with the number number of subjects. subjects. sum When 200x . When then 200x. group is then original group the original weight of the total weight be x. Let the pandas in the the original original group group be r. The The total number of pandas the number ). 1 + weight is 205(x + 1). total weight the total and the + 1 and number of pandas another the group, group, the the number pandas is x + panda joins the another panda pounds , Since panda weighs weighs 230 pounds, that panda Since that 200x + 230 = : 205(x + 11)) 200x + + 230 = 205x ‐l‐ + 205 = -‐ 225 5 -‐ 55xx = : 5 S x= group . There original group. the original panda s in the were [fil pandas There were 246 246 COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA THE EXAMPLE4: .,, ,· Neighborhood B Neighborhood A r,._• ... j......30 ! cl 20 t l ~ I "' 10 0 '0‘123456 1 2 3 4 5 6 awned of cars owned Number Numberofcars Nw;nber Number of cam cars owned owned and B, neighborhoods, A that residents charts above The bar bar charts above summarize summarize the the number number of cars that residents from ttwo w o neighborhoods, A and B, by wned o cars of m1mbei the of deviation standard the correctlycompares the following own. Which of the following correctly compares the standard deviation the number of cars ownedb own. Which • · neighborhoods? the neighborhoods? tesidents residents in each of the . larger. is A eighborhood A is larger. ca:rsowned deviation of the standard deviation fhe standard A) The the number number of cars owned by residents residents in in Neighborhood is larger. Neighborhood in residents by oWhed cars of number the o.fi deviation' of B) The The standard standard deviation number cars owned residents Neighborhood"BBis larger. B) and ·residents .in owned by residents deviation of the number standard deviation C) The standard number of cars owned in Neighborhood Neighborhood A A and same. is the same. Neighborhood B Bis . Neighborhood determined from cannot be relationship cannot be determined from the information information given. given. D) The relationship which, mean, which, the mean, out from much more are much Neighborhood B are data for Neighborhood the data Most Most of the are at at the the ends ends and and are more spread spread out from the A, Neighborhood for The data cars. The be 3 cars. estimate to be can estimate symmetrical, we bar graph because the graph is symmetrical, we can data Neighborhood A, on on the the the bar because for deviation standard the , is. Therefore mean the m where the are more other hand, other hand, are more clustered clustered towards towards the the low low end, end, where e a n is. Therefore, the standard deviation for larger. Answer Neighborhood Answer ~-(B) . B is larger. Neighborhood Bis Boxplots Boxplots are just and dotplots, histograms and SAT. Like histograms the SAT. on the shows up question shows boxplot question then , aa boxplot and then, Every Every nnow o w and up on dotplots, boxplots boxplots are just one: construct to need you that metrics statistical 5 are There . data numerical visualizing of another another way way visualizing numerical data. There are 5 statistical metrics that you need to construct one: the the maximum . the maximum. and the the first quartile minimum, m i n i m u m , the quartile,, the the median, median, the the third third quartile, quartile, and weights of 30 tortoises: the weights that summarizes example of a boxplot Here’s boxplot that summarizes the tortoises: an example 's an Here Ql Q1 Min Min t ‐ ‐ ( r + ‐+‐‐ 10 10 20 20 30 30 Q3 Q3 Median Median : : q l + ‐ Max ‐ + 50 40 40 50 60 Weight (in pounds) pounds) Weight i 1 70 70 l 80 line segment the line and the quartiles, respectively, third quartiles, and third The left and and right right sides sides of the "box" ”box” represent represent the the first and respectively, and segment The the to the box to the left and drawn from are drawn median. Line segments the median. inside the indicates the segments are from the and right right sides sides of of the the box box indicates the box inside whiskers. called whiskers. These segments minimum and and the maximum.. These segments are are sometimes sometimes called the maximum minimum quartile pounds, the tortoises is 15 pounds, the 30 tortoises among the From the the boxplot, boxplot, we can can see see that that the the minimum minimum weight weight among the first quartile From pounds 70 is maximum the and pounds, and the maximum is 70 pounds.. 60 pounds, the third pounds, the 40 pounds, median is 40 is 30 30 pounds, third quartile quartile is is 60 the median pounds, the is 247 CHAPTER 27 STATISTICS CHAPTER STATISTICS I N o w before we get let’s go go over over what what the and third Now before we get too too far ahead ahead of of ourselves, ourselves, let's the first first quartile quartile and third quartile quartile mean. mean. The first quartile, also known known as as the the lower lower quartile quartile or or 25th 25th percentile, The first quartile, also percentile, is is the the value value for for which which 25% 25% of of the the data data is is less than. If your score on an exam is equal to the first quartile, then you scored better than 25% of the people less than. If your score on an exam is equal to the first quartile, then you scored better than 25% of the people who who took took the exam. exam . The known as upper quartile quartile or or 75th 75th percentile, value for which 75% data is is The third third quartile, quartile, also also known as the the upper percentile, is is the the value for which 75% of of the the data less If your your score score on on an equal to to the the third quartile, then you scored better than 75% of the people less than. than. If an exam exam is is equal third quartile, then you scored better than 75% of the people who took took the who the exam exam.. To calculate calculate the these steps steps:: the quartiles, quartiles, follow these 1. Make Make sure sure the the data data set set is ordered. ordered . 2. Find Find where where the the median median is. 3. Use Use the median median to split data set into two t w o halves halves.. Do nnot o t include 50 when when split the the data set into include the the median median in in either either half. half . So the data data set contains 7 numbers, the set contains numbers, the halves are are the the first 3 numbers and the last last 3 numbers since the two two halves numbers and numbers since the the 4th element 4th be excluded. excluded. When the data set contains 8 numbers, the the two two element is the the median median and and needs needs to be When data contains 8 numbers, halves are are the halves the first 4 numbers numbers and last 4 numbers. numbers. The median ”excluded” since since it's it's the and the last median is already already "excluded" the average of the average the 4th 4th and numbers. and 5th 5th numbers. The first quartile 4. The quartile is the median of the lower half half of the is the the median median of of the upper the median the lower the data. data . The third third quartile quartile is the upper half the data. data. half of the Note that that there there are are actually Note actually several mathematicians use use to calculate quartiles, and the resulting several ways ways mathematicians calculate the the quartiles, and the resulting values values can differ differ depending depending on on the can the method. method. Fortunately, Fortunately, this this isn't isn’t something need to worry something you you need worry about. about. For For the the purposes of the the SAT,just the method purposes just use use the method described described above above and and you’ll you'll be be fine. illustrate, let’s let's do an example. example. Let's Let's construct To illustrate, do an from the following prices for 15 15 different different construct a boxplot boxplot from following set of prices textbooks: textbooks: {24,28,30,30,30,72,75,82,88,90 { 24,28, 30, 30, 30, 72, 75, 82, 88, 90, 100,100, 100, 100, 130} ,100,100,100,100,130} o The m i n i m u m iiss 24. • The minimum o 15+ 2 = 7.5 ‐> number: 82. • The The median median is the the 15 -:-2 -+ 8th 8th number: • Because Because the median median is the 8th number, 0 number, we can can use use itit to split into ttwo w o halves: split the data data set into halves: the the first 7 numbers and the numbers and the last last 7 numbers. numbers. We do not not include include the the median half.. median in either either half • The first quartile quartile is the the median median of the 0 the first 77 numbers, + 2 z= 3.5 ‐> numbers, so so it’s it's the 7 7-:-+ 4th 4th number: number: 30. • The The third third quartile o numbers, so so it’s +2= = 3.5 -+ ‐> 4th 4th number number from from the the quartile is the the median median of the the last last 7 numbers, it's the 77 -:-2 median or the the 8 + median + 4 = 12th 12th number number in the the overall overall set: 100. maximum is is 130. •o The maximum Using these these values, values, we can Using can n o w construct boxplot: now construct the the boxplot: H _ _ _ J _ l ‐ H t ‐ t ‐ i ‐ t ‐ H ‐ t ‐ t ‐ t ‐ t ‐ f ‐ t ‐ F ‐ ‘ l 200 3300 440 2 0 550 0 660 0 70 0 11110 0 1 2120 0 1 130 3 0 1140 40 70 8 0809 0901 0100 Price Price 248 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 338. A calculator is allowed allowed on the following following questions. questions. The average height students in one The average height of 14 14students one class class is is 63 63 inches inches.. The The average average height height of 21 21 students students in another classes are another clas classs is 68. If If the the two t w o classes are combined , what the average inches, combined, what is is the average height, height, in inches, of the the students students in the the combined combined class? class? ..... 0 .... QJ "E 2 :l z A) 64.5 B)) 665 5 0 C)) 666 6 J, "'-~ ~ D)) 666.5 6.5 ~ ~ {' ?:,~ lo' ...... ~ ...,_lo' 'I,~ "v'd" Books read The histogram histogram above above shows The shows the the number number of books read last last year 20 editors a publishing publishing books read year by by 20 editors at at a company. Which Which of the the following following could be the the company. could be median number number of books books read read by the 20 editors? median the 20 editors? Kristie taken five tests Kristie has has taken tests in science science class class.. The The average of all test scores average all five of Kristie's Kristie’s test scores is 94. The The average average of her her last last three three test test scores scores is 92. What s? What is the the average average of her her first first ttwo w o test test score scores? A)) 110 A 0 B)) 1122 B A ) 995 5 A) C 6 C)) 116 B) 96 B) D ) 223 3 D) C) C ) 9977 D ) 9988 D) Final Exam Exam Scores Scores Final (out (out of 100 points) point s) A food food company company hires hires an an independent independent research research agency agency to determine determine its its product's product’s shelf shelf life, life, the the length length of time time it may may be be stored stored before before it expires. expires. Using random sample units of the Using aa random sample of 40 40 units the product, the the research product, research agency agency finds finds that that the the product's s. Which product’s shelf shelf life life has has aa range range of 33 day days. Which of the st be the following following mu must be true true about about the the units units in the sample? sample? the l~ ‐ i : l : l ‐ ‐ l t ‐ 70 t ‐ 75 ‐ ‐ + 80 ‐ t ‐ 85 ‐ l ‐ 90 ‐ ‐ l 95 ‐ ‐ l 100 The box box plot plot above above summarizes summarize s the the final final exam exam The scores studentss in a math class. Based on on scores of 26 26 student a math class . Based the following best the box box plot, plot, which which of the the following best estimates the the number the estimates number of points points by which which the median score of the students exceeds exceeds the median score the 26 26 students the lowest individual individual score? lowest score? A) All All the the units units expired expired within within 33 days days.. B) The unit unit with with the the longest longest shelf shelf life life took took 33 B) The days unit with the days longer longer to expire expire than than the the unit with the shortest shelf shelf life life.. shortest A) 3 The mean mean shelf shelf life life of the the units units is 3 more more C) The than the the median. median. than B) 5 C C)) 8 The median shelf life units is 3 more more D) The median shelf life of the the units than the mean. than the mean. D ) 11 D) 11 249 CHAPTER STATISTICS I CHAPTER 27 STATISTICS Locks are are sections sections of canals canals in which which the the water water level to raise level can can be be mechanically mechanically changed changed to raise and and lower shows the number lower boats. boats. The The table table below below shows the number of locks locks for 10 canals canals in France. France . Miss World World Titleholders Miss Titleholders ••• •• • ••• ••• ••• ••• •• ••• • 0 0 0 0 0 O O 0 0 O 0 0 0 O O 0 0 Name I # Locks I Q 0 0 0 O O 0 Aisne 27 18 18 19 19 22 20 21 21 22 20 Age (years) Age (years) 23 23 24 24 Alsace 25 Rhone 5 Centre 30 Garonne Lalinde 23 The dotplot dotplot above above shows the distribution distribution of ages The shows the ages 24 winners winners of the the Miss Miss World World beauty beauty pageant pageant for 24 at the the time time they they were were crowned. crowned. Based at Based on on the the data, which which of the the following following is to the data, is closest closest to the average (arithmetic age of the the winning winning average (arithmetic mean) mean) age Miss World pageant pageant contestant? contestant? Miss World A)) 119 A 9 Midi 27 32 Oise 27 Vosges 93 29 Sambre B) 20 20 B) Removing which which of the the following following ttwo canals Removing w o canals from the the data data would would result result in the the greatest from greatest decrease in the the standard decrease standard deviation deviation of the the number of locks locks in each number each canal? canal? C)) 2211 C D)) 2222 D Temperature (°F) Frequency 60 3 61 4 63 4 67 10 70 7 Aisne and and Lalinde Lalinde A) Aisne 8) Alsace Alsace and and Garonne Garonne B) C) Centre Centre and and M Midi idi Rhone and D) Rhone and Vosges shoe store store surveyed surveyed a a random random sample A shoe sample of 50 50 customers to better better estimate estimate which which shoe shoe sizes customers sizes should be be kept kept in stock. stock. The The store store found found that that the the should median shoe shoe size size of the the customers customers in the the sample sample median inches. Which Which of the the following following statements statements is 10 inches. must be must true? true? The above gives the distribution The table table above gives the distribution of low low temperatures for a a city over over 28 28 days. days . What the temperatures What is the median low temperature, temperature, in degrees degrees Fahrenheit Fahrenheit median low (°F), of the the city for these these 28 28 days? days? (°F), The sum sum of all the the shoe shoe sizes the sample sample A) The sizes in the inches . is 500 inches. average of the smallest shoe size and and B) The average the smallest shoe size the largest largest shoe the sample sample is 10 the shoe size size in the 10 inches. inches. C) The The difference difference between between the the smallest smallest shoe shoe C size and and the the largest largest shoe shoe size size in the the sample size sample inches. is 10 10inches. D) At At least least half half of the the customers customers in the the sample sample D have shoe sizes greater greater than than or equal equal to 10 have shoe sizes 10 inches. inches. 250 __ The The tables tables below below give give the the distribution distribution of travel travel times times between between ttwo w o towns towns for Bus Bus A and and Bus Bus B 40 days . over over the the same same 40days. Bus Bus A Travel Travel time time (minutes) (minutes) _‑ 44 45 47 48 THE PANDA THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA 10 ~~---_-_-_-_-_-_-__-_-_-__:;--- ---~ 9 -Company A 1---------i 8 _ i::::::::::J Company B ,_______ A28 _. 7 “5 7 an Frequency 6 5 -g ... 5 10 10 .o 0 Q) 5 4 53 1 zZ 2 15 10 2 1 0 45 Bus B Travel Travel time time (minutes) (minutes) Frequency 25 5 30 35 40 5 47 48 46 Weight Weight (in (in pounds) pounds) 49 The bar bar chart above shows the distribution The chart above shows the distribution of weights (to (to the the nearest pound) for for 19 kayaks weights nearest pound) kayaks made and 19 kayaks kayaks made made by made by by Company Company A and by Company B. B. Which of the the following Company Which of following correctly correctly compares the median median weight the kayaks compares the weight of the kayaks made made by each each company? company? 10 15 10 Which Which of the the following following statements statements is true true about about the the data data shown shown for these these 40 days? days? A) The the kayaks The median median weight weight of the kayaks made made by by Company A is smaller. smaller. Company A) The The standard standard deviation deviation of travel travel times times for for Bus Bus A is smaller. smaller. B) The The median median weight weight of the the kayaks kayaks made made by by Company B is smaller. smaller. Company B) The standard standard deviation deviation of travel travel times times for for B) The Bus Bis B is smaller smaller.. median weight kayaks is C) The The median weight of the the kayaks is the the same companies . same for both both companies. C) C) The The standard standard deviation deviation of travel travel times times is the the same same for Bus Bus A A and and Bus Bus B. D) D) The relationship cannot be determined from the information given. D) travel times The standard standard deviation deviation of travel times for D) The Bus and Bus Bus A and Bus B cannot cannot be be compared compared with with the provided . the data data provided. Quiz Score 1 87 2 75 3 90 4 83 5 98 6 87 7 91 The above shows shows the the scores scores for Jay's first The table table above for Jay’s first seven quizzes . Which the following following are are seven math math quizzes. Which of of the true about his his scores? true about scores? 1, The The mode mode is greater greater than than the the median. I. median . n. The greater than than the the mean. mean . II. The median median is greater III. The range is greater than 20. The range greater than A) B) C) D) 251 llII only only IIII I I only only II and and III III JI I, H, II 11,and and IIII STATISTICS I CHAPTER 27 STATISTICS CHAPTER 5 Vl A -School SchoolB Q) >. ~ Vl Vl ro Q) 0 g. ~ 1-L. 3 .... Q) 2 .0 1 z 6 2 :l 0 6 5 8 7 Integers Integers 1 0 910 1 The frequency the frequency shows the above shows graph above The graph generated randomly generated list of randomly distribution distribution of aa list the Which of the integers and 10. Which between 5 and integers between range following the mean the range and the mean and gives the correctly gives following correctly of the integers? list of integers? the list A) B) C) D) 4 u ...... 3 1---------- 2 4 3 5 shown films of Number The number of films the number shows the above shows chart above bar chart The bar shown classes year for 19 classes past year the past over the class over shown in class in School Which of School B. Which 15 classes in School and 15classes School A and and the mean and the mean compares the correctly compares following correctly the following class for each class shown in each median number of films shown median number schools? the ttwo the w o schools? Mean =4 Range = = 7.6, Range Mean = Range 7.6, = Mean : Mean Range := 5 median number and median A) The e a n and number of films mean The m both greater are both class are each class shown greater in shown in each School A. School A. Mean = 8.2, Range Range == 4 Mean = Range = Mean : 5 Mean = 8.2, Range number of films median number and median mean and The mean B) The shown greater in both greater are both class are each class shown in each School School B. each C) The shown in each films shown number of films mean number The mean median the median class School A, but but the greater in School class is greater is the schools. both schools. same in both the same Meals Calories in Meals Calories 500 500 520 550 550 550 550 600 600 900 mean number D) The number of films shown shown in each each The mean the median but the School B, but greater in School class median class is greater schools. both schools. same in both the same is the calories in number of calories the number lists the above lists The table above The table 900-calorie a 900-calorie If a meals. If last 10 's last each Mary's 10 meals. each of Mary the values added to the today is added had today she had meal values that she meal that statistical following statistical the following listed, which of the listed, which measures w i l l n_o_t change? not change? data will the data measures of the 1, Median I. Median Mode Mode III. Range Range 1], II. A A)) B B)) C) C) D D)) lIaand n d 11 only II only [I aand n d 111 only III only only and IIII 11and II I I only and IIII II,, II, I I , and II 252 THE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA THE COLLEGE •• •• ••• ••• ••• • ‐‑ • 2 1 222 2 23 23 2 2 5 26 26 2 2 8 29 2 9 30 30 21 244 25 277 28 Gas mileage mileage (miles (miles per per gallon) gallon) Gas The dotplot dotplot above above gives gives the the gas gas mileage (in The mileage (in miles per per gallon) gallon) of 15 15different cars. If the the dot dot miles different cars. representing the the car car with with the greatest gas gas representing the greatest mileage is removed from the dotplot, dot-plot, what what will will mileage removed from happen to the the mean, mean, median, median, and and standard standard happen deviation deviation of the the new n e w data data set? Number of lectures lectures Number of professors professors 12 15 21 25 28 32 40 15 12 6 20 17 15 5 “‑ The summarizess the distribution of The table table above above summarize the distribution the number of lectures the number lectures each each of the the 90 90 professors professors at last year. year. Which Which of the at acollege a college gave gave last the following box plots data following box plots correctly correctly represents represents the the data shown in the the table? shown table? A) Only Only the the mean mean will will decrease decrease.. B) Only and standard Only the the mean mean and standard deviation deviation will will decrease decrease.. A) A) H'-_---'-_ the mean and median C) Only Only the mean and median will will decrease decrease.. D) The mean, median, and standard standard deviation The mean, median, and deviation will decrease will decrease.. _:------1 l ‐ ‐ 0 ‐ ‐ f ‐ 0 ‐ f ‐ + ‐ ‐ f ‐ l * l ‐ ‐ l 0 1 15 5 20 2 02 3 5 40 4 04 5 0 5 1 10 25 5 3 30 0 35 45 5 50 Number lectures Number of lectures B) B) l ‐ E I Z l ‐ l Snowfall Snowfall (in ( i n inches) inches) mmmmmm 45 48 49 55 57 60 60 57 61 50 57 52 54 58 65 59 i i ‐ f ‐ O ‐ l ‐ l ‐ M ‐ l ‐ l 5 1 10 0 1 15 5 20 2 0 25 2 5 30 3 03 4 04 5 0 35 5 40 45 5 50 Number lectures Number of lectures mmnmmm m m m m 61 ‐ 90 C) The table above The table above lists lists the the amounts amounts of snowfall, snowfall, to the nearest inch, experienced by 18 the nearest inch, experienced 18 different different cities the past past year cities in the year.. The The outlier measurement measurement of 90 the mean, 90 inches inches is an an error error.. Of the mean, median, median, and range and range of the the values values listed, listed, which which will will change change the most the most if if the the 90-inch 90-inch measurement measurement is replaced replaced by the correct measurement measurement of 20 inches? the correct inches? F E D ‐ i H t ‐ t ‐ t ‐ t ‐ t ‐ t ‐ t ‐ + ‐ + ‐ ~ I 5 1 10 0 1 15 5 2 20 0 2 25 5 3 30 0 3 35 5 440 0 445 5 550 0 Number of lectures lectures Number D) D) A) Mean Mean Median B) Median r 5 Range C) Range None of them them will will change. change. D) None 253 o H + o +‐ i‐ r +‐ o ‐4 10 15 15 20 25 25 30 30 35 35 40 45 50 50 40 45 10 Number lectures Number of lectures e • Statisti Statistics II cs II The goal goal of statistics statistics is to be be able able to make make predictions predictions and information.. and estimations estimations based based on on limited limited time time and and information might want the mean mean weight of all all female female raccoons raccoons in in the United For example, example , aa statistician statistician might want to estimate estimate the weight of the United States. to survey survey the the entire raccoon population population.. In In fact, fact, by by the States . The problem problem is that that it’s it's impossible impossible to entire female raccoon the time be accomplished, accomplished, not n o t only only would would the the data data be u t of would be e w females in time that that could could be be oout of date date but but there there would be nnew female s in the population. population. Instead, Instead, aa statistician statistician takes random sample sample of female make an an estimation of the takes aa random female raccoons raccoons to to make estimation of what the actual actual mean mean might might be be.. In other words, the the sample sample mean the population population mean mean.. what the other words, mean is is used used to to estimate estimate the Using a sample to predict predict something o m m o n theme theme in in stati statistics and in in SAT SAT Using a sample something about about the entire entire population population is is aa ccommon stics and question s. questions. EXAMPLE EXAMPLE 1: A pet pet food store store chose chose 1,000 customers customers at _random random and many pets pets and asked asked each each customer customer how how many he he or she she has. has. The results results are shown in the the table table below. are shown I f t • Number of pets Number of customers 1 600 200 100 100 2 3 4ormore There are There are a total total of 18,000customers customers in the the store's store’s database. database. Based Based on the the survey what is the the expected survey data, data, what expected total number number of customers customers who who own o w n 2 pets? pets? total Using sample data, total number number who who o w n 2 pets be Using the the sample data, we can can estimate estimate the the total own pets to be 200 _ ~ 18, 000 X x ] ,()()Q = ~ 3, 600 18,000 1,000 _ 254 THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA w a s Oxygtm Uptakeversus -Hea.rt Racte ..,.. l.;-v , I I • ~ 1..... ;~•v""' • t.,..V • . i.., :..,,. ..... . i....• l..--'-' • • !..- •• ..:,.),- . ~~I~~: 090 ,. I •~,.: '. 1' ' " • ' ~ M 120 100 110 130 Heart rate (beatsperi‘rdnute) (beats per :i;ninute) Heartrate .. . sca~tot heart-rate ;t.6diffeten; W W above W shows W the Wrelatiqosltjp W M bet;ween M W M and; O oxyg~ W uupt~eM at '.a E Mpoiµts W during< ~outil;t~. fineotbest fit is a1s6showi;i. d m x yI~: kyte'S' ' s eex,ercise xmmu fi n e .The minnofbestfltisalsoshown. , ·· ; · at a."be.,rrr!lfeof11Pbeats PARTl: _ d on the ,line of best-nt, -;what.isKyle's predicted o~gen ~e M 1 : Medonthelumetbestfitwhathyle’spredmdoxygmuptdteataheertrateofllobeats permin,ute? perndnute? by PAR'l' 2: ''what lS the oxygen1,1ptake,in lliers per Jll.UlUte,ofthemeasurementiepresentedbythedaw of the me-asurementreP.~~ted the data M12: Whatistheoxygenuptake, mittetsperminute, ,oinf is farthest,fromthe line of best fit? pomtfimtisfarfiiestfiomthelineofbestfit? : tnat . ; .,, Part Solution: Using that at at a heart rate of 110 beats beats per per minute (along the the Part 1 Solution: Using the the line line of best best fit, we we can can see see that heart rate minute (along x-axis), the oxygen x-axis), the oxygen uptake uptake is ~ liters liters per per minute minute.. Using a prediction dangerous, especially especially when Using the the line line of best best fit to to make make a prediction can can be be dangerous, when we are are making making aa prediction prediction outside outside the the scope scope of oour u r data oxygen uptake uptake at heart rate rate •0 we data set (predicting (predicting the the oxygen at aa heart le-you'd probably dead). of 250 beats beats per per minute, minute, for for examp example‐you’d probably be be dead). there are are outliers outliers that may hea heavily influence the the line Part 2). •0 there that may vily influence line of best best fit (see (see Part •o the curve rather than aa linear one . In this this case, case, a a the data data is is better better modeled modeled by by aa quadratic quadratic or or exponential exponential curve rather than linear one. linear like compound compound interest linear at linear model model looks looks to be be the the right right one, one, but but something something like interest may may look look linear at first even even though it's it’s exponential exponential growth growth.. though Part 22 Solution: data point point farthest farthest away from the best fit is at at Solution: From From the the scatterplot, scatterplot, we we can can see see that that the the data away from the line line of best I I liters per minute . 118 along uptake of 2.s liters along the the x-axis. x-axis. The The point point represents represents an an oxygen oxygen uptake per minute. Note point is likely an hea vily influence the line our Note that that this this data data point an outlier, outlier, which which can can heavily influence the line of best best fit and and throw throw off o ur predictions . Outliers if they they represent represent specia cases or exceptions. exceptions. predictions. Outliers should should be be removed removed from from the the data data if speciall cases Not the line line of best best fit, but but you ' ll also also be be asked interpret N o t only only will will you you be be asked asked to make make predictions predictions using using the you’ll asked to to interpret its We'll use example in the the next next one one to show these concepts its slope slope and and y-intercept. y-intercept. We’ll use the data data from from this this example show you you how how these concepts are tested. are tested . 255 CHAPTER CHAPTER 28 STATISTICS STATISTICS II II EXAMPLE 3: Exam 3: Oxygen Uptake versus Heart Rate • _.Al ' I--' I--'' , ~ ! .. • 'I' ' ~ \ ,- 90 J~ II. ........ , : I • • ~.,.. • I;' .... '. . I,, ... ' .,,,i'...-;• . ·/ ' ~I--' .,...i.-- I' - ~ II 110 120 100 110 Heart rate rate(beats per minute) H~ (beats per minute) 130 The saatterplot above shows the relationship between heart rate and oxygen uptake at Themmwowdwwsflerdafimhipbetweenheanfitemdoxygenuptake 16dil‘ferentpoints at 16 different points dllring Kyle's exerciseroutine. The vdminglfiyle‘sexemisemtine. Thelineothestfitisalsoshown. line ofhest fit is al.so shown. PART'l:Which, of th following is the best-interpretation of the slope .of the line of best fit in the context “M1:Winchofthefollowmgisthebestintapretahonotflieslopeoffllehneofbestfitinthecontext ofthispmblem? of this problell\'? A) ‘I'hepredrctedmcreasemele’soxygenuptake inlitersperminute, foreveryonebeatperminute The predicted increase in Kyle's oxygen uptake, in liters per minute, for every one beat per min~te in his heart,:rate ' increase incrmeinhishemme B) The predicted B) The predicted increase increase'in in Kyle's Kyle's heart heart rate, rate, in beats beats per per minute, for every liter per per minute minute minute, for every one one liter jnctease oxygen uptake increasem in his his oxygen uptake ‘ C) Kyle's Kyle'spredicted oxygen uptake uptake in per minute minute at heart rate rate of beats per minute predicted oxygen in liters lifers per at a a heart of 0 Obeats per minute predicted heart heart rate rate in in beats beats per per minute minute at at an an oxygen uptake of liters per D) Kyle’s Kyle's predicted oxygen uptake of 0 Oliters per minute minute PART Which of the following is the the best best interpretation interpretation of y-intercept of of the the line line of fit in in the the PART 2: Which the following of the they-intercept of best best fit commit of this problem? context-of this problem? A) The predicted increase in Kyle’s oxygen uptake, uptake, in in liters liters per minute, for every one beat beat per minute minute A) The predicted increase in Kyle's oxygen minute, for every one increase his heart increase in his rate heart rate B) the 13) The _pre,djcted.increase predictedi n c r e a s e in in Kyle's Kyle’s heart heart rate, rate, in in beats beats per per minute, liter per per minute minute minute, for every every one pne liter increase :m,his increasein his oxygen oxygen uptake ptake C) Kyle's predicted predicted oxygen uptake in in liters liters per per minute minute at heart rate beats per minute C) Kyle's oxygen uptake at a a heart rate of 0 0 beats per minute Kyle’s predicted predicted heart rate in in beats beats per per minute minute at at an an oxygen minute D) Kyle's heart rate oxygen uptake uptake of of 0 0 liters liters per per minute Part 1 Solution: Solution: As we we learned model questions the interpretation chapter, the slope is is the the learned in the the linear linear model questions in the interpretation chapter, the slope increase uptake) for each increase in x (heart rate). The only difference n o w is that it’s a predicted increase in y31(oxygen (oxygen uptake) each increase (heart rate) . only difference now that it's predicted [0] increase. increase . The The answer answer is (A) . Part 2 Solution: Solution: They The y‐intercept the value value of y (oxygen (oxygen uptake) uptake) when answer is -intercept is the when xx (the (the heart heart beat) beat) is is 0. 0. The The answer is -. Note that value would would have have no significance in in real real life since heart rate rate of of 0. [@. Note that this value no significance since you you would would be be dead dead at at a a heart 0. This again again illustrates illustrates the danger danger of predicting values outside outside the scope sample data. This predicting values scope of of the the sample data . 256 VGNVcI 5 1 9 3 7 7 0 2 ) EIHl THE COLLEGE PANDA j $ . W ° W W W 3 ° W, W V “ W W F m e ' m m q u w w m 'j WWPWW°PSWMWPWMWWmWwSaWW 1° “13mm teams a U; 1111931 513111 new 111M 9111va M0110; 311310 ammmvw‘mmwunmmwde I\; “ a n e w us fimumdv wastes 5111109118109 (v A) 30 randomly selected apartments in Malden :,,_ , ” - _s1133m139mw10119111s1u31111179d9p313313$&11u0p119109 (a B) 30 randomly selected, apartments in allofMassa,cltusetts · m p m m fl m m d e m p s x n n o p m o g ( 3 I 11519331111 u m : 911: 1 ° } W 11 surve yed°~ “ W VW ‘ S M W W P W M ‘ M W m e m p m w m m s m w e d e l EXAMPl.E4: M~d~~ a town; th~stateoi.M~chuse~ . A'rea;t\i stateagefifjandbnµy apartm~ts for .s~e m¥a:tden ~d foung that the a~f~ gepri ~eof ~j cl! ~~~ t .wa_s f 150A~<1Q J A:,;i ~ fhe:r real estate age.ttt mtends to replicate th_r sttrVey and ~ att~.mpt-to ~et ~ spiall~ marg:tn ofl~r ,,..._ , of the following samples will most .likely result in a sinallet margin of error for the mean pnce o. apartment in Malden, Ma$sachuse.tts? C) 80 randomly selected aparbnents in Malden D) 80 randomly selected apartments in <lll.o{Massachusetts ' • • ....~ , '·"'j,,.;.; , ., I\ , ..:!, , .... . ., \ '.,.-t·l';I',' •• , , , .., \•. :.-· .,~ _:,:-;~i.,11,-a:,: , · 1,· < ,1 ""'' mmmwwnemwmmmdvapsfinmpwos (a IT9J .The margin of error refers to the room for error we give to an estimate. For example, we (3) S113MS119 3111 could say the mean price of an apartment in Malden is $150,000 with a margin of error of $10,000 . This implies that the true mean price of all apartments in Malden is likely between $140,000 and $160,000 . This interval is called a confidence interval (see Example 6). '(9 31du19xg1 33s) 19A131u1 aauapguoa 9 p31193 p u 9 919p 1 n 0 319111339 3 1 0 u 1 3111 ‘A3A1ns 3M s1u3u1119d9 3 1 0 m 3111 “ a s u a s u o u 1 u 1 0 3 $1$1111 3215 31du195 138191 9 am p1n0115 3M 'A1pu0335 ‘s1u3u1119d9 u 3 p 1 9 w 10 3311d 38913119 3111 pay 01 51 113111M 'A3A1ns 31111011131111 191118110 3111 111011 s69115 0519 1nq 919p 3111 01 A1111q9119A 3 1 0 u 1 saanp011u1 A1u01011 s1133n1139ssew 10 119 u1011 s1u3111119d9 8111133135 0313191111 111 s1113u1119d9 111011 133135 A1u01s111 p1n0115 3M ’17 31du19x3 111 1011310 u1819111 13119u1s 9 138 01 To get a smaller margin of error in Example 4, we should first only select from apartments in Malden. Selecting apartments from all of Massachusetts not only introduces more variability to the data but also strays from the original intent of the survey, which is to find the average price of Malden apartments . Secondly, we should use a larger sample size. This is common sense. The more apartments we survey, the more accurate our data and our estimations are and the lower our margin of error is. 's11011310 11181910 1 n 0 13M013111 p u 9 319 su0119u111s3 1 n 0 3101391 0M1 uo spu3d3p 1u3u1113dx3 u9 u1011 319u111s3 A119 1011011310 u18191u 3111 ‘1391 u1 1n fact, the margin of error for any estimate from an experiment depends on two factors: 321g 31du195 0 • Sample size (u01191A3p p19pu91s Aq p31n593u1 u3110) 919p 3111 111 A1111q9119A 0 • Variability in the data (often measured by standard deviation) 919p 1311198 01 8111u1nsu03-3u111 p u 9 £11503 001 5,11 asneaag gsaz1s 31d1119s 38n11 asn sA9M19 s13113193s31 1,u0p A11M 03 ~3z1s 31d1u9s 3111 1011u03 1193 3M 1nq ’(s1 11mo p931ds M011) 919p 3111 10 uo1191A3p p19pu91s 3111 1011u03 1,u93 A119a1d1<1 3M 1 0 11 3 10 111819u1 3111 13M01 3111 ’s1 919p 3111 31q9119A $531 3111 p u 9 321g 31d1119$ 3111 138191 3111 The larger the sample size and the less variable the data is, the lower the margin of error. We typically can't control the standard deviation of the data (how spread out it is), but we can control the sample size. So why don't researchers always use huge sample sizes? Because it's too costly and time-consuming to gather data from everyone and everywhere . '31311~1A13A3 pue 3qu13113 111011 amtuswmflm m a m a a i m s - m a p mm 112 9843091109 mama as am EXAMPtE5: :Researchers conducted/ an experimentio determine whether ex-e:rcise:im_pl'oves , stuc(ent exam scores. 'Fhey.z:a,:1domly 'S.elected.2()(1 .sfildents who exercise atrleastonce.'a week..ano 200 students ,t'he. students' acacleinicpetform~-ees ~lor a .year 1 who do .not exercise at1east once-a week. Af:tertraciking the researchers found tnat-the students ·who exercise at1east'Ohee a week pedo.rfned s1gnifitant1y better on .fh:e,same exams thari the students who do not. l3ased.on the design.and.resrilts-..ofth-e stud.y, which of Sim-90751?“ M a n - 0 1 m m m a m sumpms ooz 933338 51mm 69111 mm ma m W W w v w r m m m m m w m pane; n e w a m 11335 9 1 0 1 W 31111313339 W M W W qaameammqseqw 3310131131011011 011m 101991114913831: m u m p m - fl m p a u no 13353810101) 01m warms 3111 1mm m e m e s an m guo1snpu03 3191.1d01dd9 119 $1811111101101 3111 the following is an appropriate conclusion? - 031003 11191133de01 £13311] $1>133M 9 33110 1593119 8111s1313x3 (v A) Exercising at least once a week is lik~y toimprove exam scores.. B) Exercising three times a week improves exam-scores more .than exen:isingjustonceaw.eek. C) Any student who starts exercising at least once a week will improve his or her exam scores, 1 D) There is a positive association between exercise and student exam scores. ·1.· 3133111933110 1911!811181313113 119111310111amass 1119713 9 3 d e 1133,“ 9 3311111 331111811181313xg ‘ s a m a s unaxa 131110 $11131101111111 111m 1133119 33110 man 19 811131313113 sums qu (g 1113pn1s Auv (3 w o o s 1119x3 1113pn1s pun 351313x3 1133M1aq uogeposse amped 9 $13.13111 (0 /r 31 1013918111A113p1m 3111 1mm 1131 1lu93 3M ‘p3u8153p 9 9 M 1113111113dx3 3111 A9M 3111 01 3 n q '13p1911 Apn1s u131113>19u1011m s1u319d 8111pu9u13p 310111 311911 £3111 10 31111d1as1p 310111 311911 1sn13s1313x3 011m s1u3pn1s sd9q1ad 'sa103s u 1 9 x 3 111 1u3u13A01du11 119 1111M 1131171305517 1sn1s,11 3 3 1 0 3 5 u 1 9 x 3 u1 1u31113Ao1d1111 u9 sasnvp 351313x3 19111 11931u 1,us30p 53103s 1 u 9 x 3 13113q 108 351313x3 011M s1113pn1s u0119130ss9 10 3 5 9 3 31ss913 9 1111111 S193p 11011s3nb $1111 asn933q 1sn[ 'u0119sn93 ' S A (u0119131103 1331193 0s19) This question deals with a classic case of association (also called correlation) vs. causation . Just because students who exercise got better exam scores doesn't mean that exercise causes an improvement in exam scores. It's just associatedwith an improvement in exam scores. Perhaps students who exercise just have more discipline or they have more demanding parents who make them study harder. Due to the way the experiment was designed, we can't tell what the underlying factor is. ‘1u3u1113dx3 3111 111 p3>139111,us9M 191118u111131110$ ’s13119111351313113 10 buanb3113111 19111$311du110s19 1 n q u0119sn93 S311du11 A1u0 10u 113sn933q 8uo1M 51(g) JaMSUV 'u0119sn93 sa11du1111 asn933q 8u01M 51( v ) 1 3 M S U 9 ‘3101313111 Therefore, answer (A) is wrong because it implies causation. Answer (8) is wrong because it not only implies causation but also implies that the frequency of exercise matters, something that wasn't tracked in the experiment. 1.92 ,I s119A131u1 $1111 ‘000’091$ p u 9 000'017[$ u33M13q A13>111 S1u 3 p 1 9 w 111 s1u3u1119d9 119 10 3311d 1193111 3n11 3111 19111 5311du11 51111 0001113; 10 1011310 u1819u19 1111M 000119104; 51u 3 p 1 9 w 1111113111119d9 me10 3311d u93111 3111 A95 p1n03 \ ] 10113 101 111001 311101 s13131 1011310 u1819u1 3111 ' I ~•,· , , .,, ,,. 3M ’31du19x3 10:1 ‘319u11153 119 01 31118 am The answer is ) 257 CHAPTER 28 CHAPTER 28 STATISTICS STATISTICS IT [1 Answer wrong because outcome. Even DID improve exam Answer (C) (C) is wrong because it suggests suggests aa completely completely certain certain outcome. Even if exercise D I D improve exam scores, improve their scores. There There might might be students for scores, not n o t every every single single student student who who starts starts exercising exercising will will improve be students whom their scores worse. worse . Any conclusion drawn from sample a generalization and whom exercising exercising makes makes their conclusion drawn sample data data is a generalization and should a truth truth for every should not n o t be be regarded regarded as asa every individual individual.. answer is ~-(D) . There There is a positive positive association association between between exercise and and student student exam The answer exam scores. One of the things the researchers did correctly correctly was was to take take random random samples each group. word is One the things researchers did samples from each group. The key word random.. If [f the samples samples weren't weren’t random, random, we we wouldn't wouldn’t even even have have been conclude that there is is aa positive random been able able to conclude that there positive association between between exercise and and exam exam scores. Why? Let's Let’s say the researchers picked 30 students from the association researchers picked students from the tennis team for the the exercise group group and and 30 students students who who just just play video games day for the non-exercise non-exercise tennis team play video games all day group.. Definitely Definitely not n o t random random.. Now, Now, did did the the exercise group group do better on their exams because they group do better on their exams because they exercise or because play tennis? tennis? Or was was it the the video video games games that that made made the non-exercise worse? because they play non-exercise group group perform perform worse? selection wasn't wasn’t random, random, we we can't can’t tell how how each each factor influences result.. When the selection Because the selection influences the result When the selection is random, all the the factors factors except except the the one we're we’re testing testing are are "averaged “averaged out.” random, out." N o w what what if the the researchers researchers wanted wanted to see whether whether exercise does causee an an improvement does indeed indeed caus improvement in exam exam scores. Now What should should they have have done done differently? differently? The answer answer is random assignment. Instead of randomly selecting 200 assignment. Instead randomly selecting What students from from one group that that already already exercises regularly regularly and and 200 students another group group that that does not, students one group students from another does not, they should step would would be be to randomly assign each each student should have have just randomly randomly selected selected 400 students students.. The The next next step randomly assign student to exercise or not. least once a week week and everyone in the not. Everyone Everyone in the exercise group group is forced to exercise at least and everyone the group performs performs better better on the exams, then then we can non-exercise non‐exercise group group is not n o t allowed allowed to exercise. If If the the exercise group the exams, can conclude conducting this type of experiment experiment conclude that that exercise causes causes an an improvement improvement in exam exam scores. Of course, course, conducting this type can be be such such a monumental monumental task. task . be extremely extremely difficult, which which is why proving proving causation causation can be The following following list summarizes different experimental experimental designs designs involving summarizes the the conclusions conclusions you you can can draw draw from different involving two exam scores). two variables variables (e.g. (e.g. exercise and and exam 1. Subjects not not selected selected at random random & Subjects not n o t randomly randomly assigned 1. assigned • Results 0 Results cannot cannot be be generalized generalized to the population population.. Cause and and effect cannot cannot be be proven. proven. •0 Cause Example: Researchers Researchers want want to see whether whether medication medication X is effective in treating •o Example: treating the flu. People People with the flu from Town A receive People with with the flu from Town B receive a placebo with the receive medication medication X. People receive a placebo (sugar pill). More More people people in the the medication medication X group group experience symptoms. The (sugar experience a reduction reduction in flu symptoms. generalization a reduction reduction in flu symptoms generalization that that medication medication X is associated associated with with a symptoms cannot cannot be be made made since it was only tested in Town A and Town B (sample was not randomly selected from the general was tested Town and (sample was not randomly selected the general population). There There may may be be something something special special about B. No cause and effect population). about Town A and and Town 8. cause and relationship be established established because because the the medication medication was not n o t randomly assigned. Perhaps Perhaps Town relationship can be randomly assigned. experienced aa less severe severe flu epidemic. epidemic. A experienced not selected selected at random random & & Subjects randomly randomly assigned assigned 2. Subjects not Results cannot cannot be be generalized generalized to to the population. population. •0 Results I Cause and and effect can can be proven. •0 Cause be proven. Example: Researchers Researchers want want to to see whether whether medication medication X X is is effective in treating flu. People People •0 Example: effective in treating the the flu. with the the flu flu from from Town A A and and Town To w n B B are are randomly randomly assigned medication X placebo with assigned to to either either medication X or or aa placebo (sugar pill). pill). More More people people in in the the medication medication X group group experience in flu symptoms. symptoms. The (sugar experience aa reduction reduction in generalization that that medication medication X X is is effective effective for for everyone be made made since since it it was was only tested generalization everyone cannot cannot be only tested in Town A A and and Town Town B B (sample (sample was was n o t randomly randomly selected selected from general population). population). Perhaps in Town not from the the general Perhaps only one pa~cular particular strain strain of of the the flu_ flu exi~ts exists in in Town Town A A and and Town Town B.A effect relationship relationship B. A cause cause and and effect only one can be established because the medication was randomly assigned. For the people in Town A and and can be established because the medication was randomly assigned. For the people in Town A Town B, B, we we can can c_ conclude that medication medication X X causes causes a symptoms.. Note that this this is T~w~ onc_lude that a reduction reduction in in flu flu symptoms Note that is still just a generalization‐as with any other medication, medication X does not guarantee you will s~ J~St a generalization-as with any other medication, medication X does not guarantee you will definitely get get better, better, even even if if you you live live in in Town Town A A or or Town B. Town B. definitely 258 I' I THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA Subjects selected selected at random random & & Subjects Subjects not not randomly randomly assigned assigned 3. Subjects a Results can can be be generalized generalized to to the the population. population. • Results Cause and and effect cannot cannot be be proven. proven. •0 Cause Example:: Researchers Researchers want w a n t to see see whether whether medication People •0 Example medication X X is effective effective in treating treating the the flu. People with the flu from the general population are randomly selected. They are given the choice with the flu from the general population are randomly selected . They are given the choice of of aa n e w medication (medication X) or a traditional medication (really a sugar pill). More people in the new medication (medication X) a traditional medication (really sugar pill). More people the medication X group experience a reduction in flu symptoms. We can generalize that people who group experience a reduction symptoms . We can generalize that people who medication choose to receive receive medication medication X fare fare better better than However, no cause and than those those who who don’t. don't. However, no cause and effect choose relationship can can be be established established because because the the medication o t randomly don’t know relationship medication was was nnot randomly assigned. assigned . We We don't know whether the the reduction reduction in symptoms symptoms is due due to the medication or a between those whether the medication a difference difference between those who who volunteered and and those those who who didn't. didn’t. volunteered 4. Subjects Subjects selected selected at random random & Subjects randomly randomly assigned assigned 4. & Subjects Results can can be be generalized generalized to the the population. population. •0 Results and effect can can be be proven proven.. •0 Cause Cause and Example: Researchers Researchers want w a n t to see see whether whether medication treating the People •0 Example: medication X is effective effective in treating the flu. People with the flu from from the the general general population population are are randomly randomly selected selected.. Using or tails), with Using aa coin coin toss toss (heads (heads or researchers randomly randomly assign each person person to either (sugar pill). pill). More More researchers assign each either medication medication X or a a placebo placebo (sugar people reduction in flu symptom s. We conclude that people in the the medication medication X group group experience experience aa reduction symptoms. We can can conclude that conclusion can the entire medication medication X X causes causes aa reduction reduction in flu symptoms symptoms.. This conclusion can be be generalized generalized to the entire population with the population of people people with the flu. EXAMPLE are testing pH levels in a forest that is being hallned by acid rain. They EXAMPLE 6: 6:Environmentalists Environmentalistsaretestingpfl levelsinaforestthatisbeinghamedbyacid rain. They year and and found thatthe analy.z.ed from 40 rainfalls in the analyzed water water samples samples from 40rainfallsin the past past year found that the mean.pH mean pH of the-water the water samples samples has a 95% confidence appropriate has a confidence interval interval of 3.2 to 3.8. Which Which of the the following following ~onclusions conclusions is :the the most most appropriate based based on on the the confiaence confidence interval? interval? A) 95% of all the forest have a a pH between 3.2 and all the forest rainfalls rainfalls in in the the past past year year have pH between and 3.8. B) 95% of all a pH ~d 3.8. all the the forest forest rainfalls rainfalls in the the past past decade decade have have a pH between between 3.2 and C) !tis plausible that the true mean pH of all the forest rainfalls in the past is between 3.2 and 3.8. C) It is plausible that the true mean pH all the forest rainfalls the past year yearisbetween 3.2 and D) is plausible that the true mean pH of all the forest rainfalls in the past decade is between 3.2 and D) It ltisplausiblethatthetmemeaan ofallthefomstrainfallsinthepastdecadeisbetweenB.2and 3.8. If don't know 't worry. worry . You’ll You'll never and the If you you don’t know what what aa confidence confidence interval interval is, don don't never need need to calculate calculate one one and the SAT makes these questions very easy. All a confidence interval does is tell you where the true mean (or some makes these questions very A l l a confidence interval does you where the true mean (or some other other statistical between 3.2 and and 3.8). Even Even though the SAT only statistical measure) measure) for the the population population is likely likely to be be (e.g. between though the only brings 99% (any confidence intervals. higher brings up 95% 95°/o confidence confidence intervals, intervals, there there are are 97% and and 99°/o (any percentage) percentage) confidence intervals. The The higher the the interval. interval. 50 So in the the example example above, above, we can be the confidence, confidence, the more more likely likely the the true true mean mean falls within within the can be quite rainfalls in the between 3.2 and quite confident confident that that the the true true mean mean pH of all the the forest forest rainfalls the past past year year is between and 3.8. Answer Answer ~(C) -. The conclusions about about the the samples The answer answer is not n o t (D) because because we we cannot cannot draw draw conclusions the past past decade decade when when all the samples w e r e gathered gathered from from the the past year. were past year. A confidence rainfalls themselves. themselves. You cannot cannot say one confidence interval interval does does NOT N O T say say anything anything about about the the rainfalls say that that any any one rainfall has aa 95% and 3.8, and and you you cannot that 95% of all rainfall has 95"/o chance chance of having having aa pH between between 3.2 and cannot say say that all the the forest forest rainfalls remember that confidence interval interval applies applies rainfalls in the the past past year year had had a pH between between 3.2 and and 3.8. Always Always remember that a confidence only the mean, an individual individual data group of data only to the mean, which which is a statistical statistical measurement, measurement, NOT NOT an data point point or a group data points. points. Secondly, there is a a 95% chance chance it contains true mean. mean. Even Secondly, aa 95% confidence confidence interval interval does does not n o t imply imply that that there contains the the true Even though confidence you cannot cannot say say that that the has a a 95% though confidence intervals intervals are are computed computed for the the mean, mean, you the interval interval of 3.2 to 3.8 has chance containing the m e a n pH pH.. chance of containing the true true mean 259 II STATISTICS II CHAYTER 28 STATISTICS CHAPTER and again and repeated again were repeated experiment were If the experiment confident in something? be 95% confident statistics to be mean in statistics does itit mean So what does Sowhat something? If contains that interval confidence a us give would experiments those of 95% samples, water 40 with each again, again, each with 40 water samples, those experiments would us a confidence interval that contains experiment. one experiment. result of just one the result example is the given in the example interval given confidence interval words, the confidence other words, mean. In other true mean. the true interval. Keep different confidence a different produce a would produce samples) would 40 samples) (another 40 experiment (another same experiment Another rrun Another u n of the same confidence interval. Keep pertains to all the 95% pertains So the mean. 50 true mean. contain the true will contain them will and 95% of them intervals and confidence intervals these confidence getting these on getting interval confidence interval one confidence any one that any chance that NOT the chance experiments, NOT repeated experiments, generated by repeated intervals generated confidence intervals the confidence that aware that be aware but be calculated, but are calculated, intervals are confidence intervals how confidence about how worry about don't worry mean . Again, true mean. contains the true contains Again, don’t statistics. how "confidence" this is how ”confidence” is defined defined in statistics. 260 260 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA CHAPTER EXERCISE:Answers for this chapter start on page 340. A calculator calculator is allowed allowed on the following following questions. questions. "' § ·.c ro Violations in Various Towns Traffic Light Light Violations Various Towns 0 ·;;: 100 ..... Tu 90 Male Shoe Size versus Age 13 I :..::i u ::E 80 12 (ll ,,,, 11 70 ..... 0 .t: ..,,,-v / V / ►- •- @ s I 6 40 ::i2 30 <lJ .....,v- 8 7 C: >-, ,,,,.v ! <lJ s: / I <lJ bO i (ll .... 10 10 11 11 12 12 13 13 14 14 15 15 16 16 17 17 18 18 19 19 20 20 Age Age (years) (years) 20 20 30 30 <lJ ~ ---- _i..--_ ---,--- 50 ;:I / ......... 60 •.---- - : - - 40 600 70 800 9 900 1 100 4 0 50 50 6 70 8 00 Number of traffic lights Number lights The scatterplot above shows shows the the number The scatterplot above number of lights in 15 and the the average weekly traffic lights 15 towns towns and average weekly number number of traffic light light violations violations that that occur occur in each town. town . The line of best fit is also also shown. each The line best fit shown. the line best fit, which which of the the Based on the line of best following weekly following is the the predicted predicted average average weekly number of traffic light light violations a town number violations in a town with with 75 traffic lights? 75 lights? The scatterplot shows the the relationship scatterplot above above shows relationship between between age, age, in years, years, and and shoe shoe size size for 24 24 male maless between and 20 between 10 10and 20 years years old. old. The The line line of best best fit data, how is also also shown. shown. Based Based on the the data, how many many 19 19 year year old old males males had had aa shoe shoe size size greater greater than than the the one predicted predicted by one by the the line line of best best fit? A ) 1 A) B B)) 2 A 0 A)) 440 C)3 C) B) 50 50 D ) 44 D) C 5 C)) 555 D D)) 6600 In a survey s, xatpercent percent said survey of 400 senior seniors, said that that they physics. One they plan plan on on majoring majoring in physics. One university university has this data has used used this data to estimate estimate the the number number of physics major s it expects physics majors expects for its its entering entering class class of 3,300 students the university students.. If If the university expects expects 66 66 physics physics majors, majors, what what is the the value value of x ?? 261 CHAPTER 28 STATISTICS II A university wants to determine university wants determinethe dietary dietary preferences of the freshman class. preferences the students students in its its freshman Which of the the following survey methods methods is is most most Which following survey likely provide the most valid results? likely to provide the most valid results? Consumer Behavior Behavior during Consumer during Store Store Sales 'vJ 60 .E:! 55 l ! 50 - 45 40 ..... 35 ~ 30 .::l 0.. 25 0.. 0 ...c: 20 15 ~ 10 A) Selecting Selecting aa random random sample sample of 600 students students from the university from the university I .§ B) Selecting Selecting aa random random sample sample of 300 students students from from the the university's university’s freshman freshman class class C) Selecting Selecting aa random random sample sample of 600 students students the university’s university's freshman freshman class from the class D) Selecting Selecting aa random random sample sample of 600 students students from one one of the the university's university’s freshman freshman dining dining halls halls = ~ tJ) ~ Q) ~ - _,,.. _, 1...---" ~ ----- 1...---" i.,...---' ~ 5 0 0 0 55 110 0 115 5 220 0 225 5 330 0 335 5 440 0 445 5 550 0 (%} Store Discount Store Discount (%) Shopping time time refers the time time a a customer Shopping refers to the customer spends in one store. The scatterplot shows spends one store. The scatterplot above above shows the average average shopping shopping time, time, in minutes, the minutes, of customers at 26 different stores stores offering offering various various customers discounts. The The line line of best also shown discounts. best fit is also shown.. Which of the following following is the interpretation Which the best best interpretation meaning of the the y-intercept the line line of of the meaning y-intercept of the best fit? best Two candidates candidates are are running running for governor governor of aa state. that out a random state. A recent recent poll poll reports reports that out of a random sample sample of 250 voters, voters, 110 support support Candidate Candidate A and 140 support Candidate B. An estimated and support Candidate estimated 500,000 state expected to vote state residents residents are are expected vote on election election day. According According to the the poll, poll, Candidate Candidate B is expected expected to receive receive how how many more votes many more votes than Candidate Candidate A? than A) The predicted predicted average average shopping time, in shopping time, minutes, of customers store offering offering no minutes, customers at a store discount discount A) 60,000 shopping time, B) The predicted predicted average average shopping time, in minutes, of customers customers at a store offering a minutes, store offering discount 50% discount B) 130,000 C) 220,000 D) 280,000 C) The predicted increase the average C) The predicted increase in the average shopping time, in minutes, each one shopping time, minutes, for each one percent the store store discount discount percent increase increase in the D) The predicted number of predicted average average number customers at a store offering no discount customers store offering discount 262 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA Advertising for 16 Companies ,....._ ~ '"§' 500 ~ 450 ~ 400 ~ 350 "d ~ 300 r.r, ;::l 250 0 ..c: .... 200 :.§. 150 100 50 • ,. ...... I -- ./"' ~ ./"' • ----- ,. ./"' ,,,,--- .g 180 t---t---+---t--t-- ""' 0 160 r.r, -- ·- ' j - --+--+--.-- · --; t---t---+---t--t--+---+--+--f---, 140 ......_ ........................... -.= ,. .1 120 r---+--t---+---+-_-+-- -f- - --= b.--i==_... :.§_100 1---..- -+ r---l - = -+-''ll->-+--+---+- . -+----l 80 f------<q..... -t---J- l---l--l---l--1----l r.r, Qi 60 l--+--+----+-+---+-.....j.......--4--+-~ ~ Cf) Qi 40 t---+--+--+--+---+--+--l-+- ~ u _____ _*__.a... {www $ 20 -1• ·+-------t---+.............-+---+---+----t 7 ·s ,,,,--- .,,,,---,. __.,,,,,,.. :.---- •- .......- 200 ~~-~--~----~-~~ ~ 200 -- ro Movie Length versus Box Office Sales • • • - . 0 0 1 0 20 2 0 30 3 0 4400 550 0 60 6 0 70 7 0 80 8 0 90 90100 0 10 100 Advertising Expenses Expenses (in (in thousands dollars) Advertising thousands of dollars) The scatterplot scatterplot above above shows shows the the relationship relationship between revenue between revenue and and advertising advertising expenses expenses for 16 companies . The line 16companies. shown. line of best best fit fit is also also shown. Which of the the following following is the the best best interpretation Which interpretation meaning of the slope of the the line of the the meaning the slope line of best best fit? >< 0 c:o .,_ _ , • . . . . . . . . ~ _ o ~~--+--~---~~-~-~~ 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 140 150 Movie Movie Length Length (minutes) (minutes) The scatterplot 15 scatterplot above above plots plots the the lengths lengths of 15 movies against movies sales. The The line line of against their their box box office sales. best fit is best is also also shown. shown. Which the following following is is Which of the the best the best interpretation interpretation of the the meaning meaning of the the slope slope of the line line of best best fit? expected increase increase in revenue A) The expected revenue for every every one dollar dollar increase one increase in advertising advertising expenses expenses B) The expected expected increase increase in revenue revenue for every every one one thousand increase in advertising advertising thousand dollar dollar increase A) The expected expected decrease box office sales decrease in box sales per increase in movie movie length per minute minute increase length expected increase increase in box B) The The expected box office sales sales per per minute increase minute increase in movie movie length length C) The expected C sales expected decrease decrease in box box office sales per movie length length per 10‐minute 10-minute increase increase in movie D) The The expected expected increase increase in box box office sales sales per per 10-minute 10‐minute increase increase in movie movie length length expenses expenses C) C) The The expected expected increase increase in advertising advertising expenses for every expenses thousand dollar every one one thousand dollar increase increase in revenue revenue D) The The expected expected revenue company that that revenue of a a company D has no advertising has no advertising expenses expenses 263 CHAPTER 28 STATISTICS CHAPTER STATTSTTCS II II Mistakes Made Made in Incentive-based Mistakes Incentive-based Task 60 60 (I) "O (ll E 50 ··- <fl (I) 40 (ll ..... <fl 30 ...... 0 .... 20 (I) ,,, 440 • ~ ........... ~ - - ~ ~ I/ 420 <fl (I) "'-. ·e 400 ~ 380 cc u 0 ~ • § 10 z '- -~, •/ ~ ..... 360 ~ 340 - 1 320 0 ‘- 0 100 !/• ·c .0 0 Fat and Calories of Ice Cream ,, l 200 300 400 Prize ((in Prize i n dollars) dollars) 500 300 600 a psychological psychological study, In a study, researchers researchers asked asked participants each complete participants to each complete aa difficult difficult task task for / V I 15 20 20 25 30 30 (grams) Total fat (grams) 35 The The scatterplot above shows shows the content and scatterplot above the fat content and calorie counts counts of 8 different calorie different cups cups of ice cream. cream . Based on the line Based line of best best fit to the the data data shown, shown, what is the the expected what expected increase in the number of increase in the number of calories for each calories of fat in a cup each additional additional gram gram in a cup of ice cream? cream? a cash cash prize, prize, the the amount amount of which a varied from from which varied participant to participant. participant participant. The The results results of the the study, as as well well as as the the line line of best study, best fit, are are shown in shown in the scatterplot above. Which the scatterplot above. Which of the following is the following the best best interpretation interpretation of the the the meaning meaning of the the y-intercept of the y-intercept line of best the line best fit? A) 5 B) 8 The expected expected decrease A) The number of of decrease in the the number C) 20 20 D ) 4 0 D) 40 mistakes made mistakes made per the per dollar dollar increase increase in the cash cash prize prize B) The The expected expected increase increase in the the number number of of mistakes made mistakes made per per dollar dollar increase increase in the the cash cash prize prize C) The C expected dollar cash The expected dollar amount amount of of the the cash prize required prize required for a a person person to complete complete the the task task with with 0 mistakes mistakes The expected expected number D) The number of mistakes mistakes aa person person makes in completing makes completing the the task task when when no no cash cash prize prize is offered offered A record record of driving driving Violations violations by type type and and vehicle is shown below. vehicle shown below. ‐ m ” Truck Car Total Speeding speeding 68 83 151 Violation Violation Type Stop Sign Parking stop Sign 17 39 51 26 90 43 m m - Total 124 124 160 If violation If the data data is used used to estimate estimate driving driving violation information information about about 2,000 total total violations violations in in a a certain the following best certain state, state, which which of of the following is is the the best estimate of the number estimate number of speeding speeding violations violations committed committed by cars in the state? state? A) A) 479 B) 585 C) 1063 D) 1099 264 u 284 THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA Nitrogen Fertilizer and Oats ,,...._80 ~ ~ • ~ 60 en ~ 50 ..c: en 40 ::i 6 ~ 30 0 0 20 "Cl ~ ro ...... L// v ~ v- / ~ V I ... 80 QJ • ·r--, 0... .l!l ro QJ 60 ~ r-------- en ...... 0 .... 40 QJ • r--.._ ..0 - ~~ 10 >= Food Courts in Various Malls 100 en I 70 .... ~::i 0 0 , 0 200 200 300 400 100 300 400 500 Amount Amount of nitrogen nitrogen applied applied (pounds (pounds per per acre) acre) ~ ro ... QJ ~ ,i ! r--- 20 -0 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Number restaurants Number of restaurants The scatterplot above above shows shows the distribution of The scatterplot the distribution seats for the different mall food seats the restaurants restaurants in 7 different mall food courts. The line of best best fit is also also shown. courts. The line shown. According data , what what is total number According to the the data, is the the total number at the the food court represented the data data of seats seats at food court represented by by the point that is farthest farthest from the line point that from the line of best best fit? The The scatterplot scatterplot above above shows shows the the amount amount of nitrogen oat fields nitrogen fertilizer fertilizer applied applied to to 8 oat fields and and their best fit is their yields yields.. The The line line of best is also also shown shown.. Which the following is closest Which of the following is closest to to the the amount amount of nitrogen per acre, nitrogen applied, applied, in pounds pounds per acre, to the the oat oat field field whose whose yield yield is is best best predicted predicted by by the the line line of best best fit? A) 200 B) B) C) C) A) A) 200 B) 350 C) 400 C) 400 240 240 320 320 D) 560 D) D) 450 Researchers an experiment Researchers must must conduct conduct an experiment to see see whether a an new vaccine is effective effective in relieving relieving whether e w vaccine certain have selected random certain allergies. allergies . They They have selected a a random sample 100 allergy Some of the sample of 100 allergy patients. patients. Some the patients are are assigned assigned to the new vaccine while while patients to the n e w vaccine the rest rest are are assigned assigned to to the the traditional treatment. the traditional treatment. Which of the following methods Which the following methods of assigning assigning each patient’s patient's treatment likely to lead lead to each treatment is is most most likely to a reliable reliable conclusion conclusion about about the the effectiveness a effectiveness of the e w vaccine? the n new vaccine? assigned to the new A) Females Females are are assigned the n e w vaccine. vaccine. Those who more than than one one allergy allergy are B) Those who have have more are assigned n e w vaccine. assigned to the the new vaccine . C) The divide themselves evenly into into The patients patients divide themselves evenly ttwo w o groups. groups. A coin coin is tossed tossed to decide decide which group receives receives the e w vaccine. which group the nnew vaccine. D patient is assigned assigned aa random random number. D) Each Each patient number. Those with even number are assigned assigned to Those with an an even number are the e w vaccine. vaccine. the n new 265 CHAPTER 28 CHAPTER 28 STATISTICS II STATISTICS II The blue-spotted salamander's salamander’s tail tail The length length of a a blue-spotted can its age. A biologist biologist can be be used used to estimate estimate its age. A selects random selects 80blue-spotted 80 blue-spotted salamanders salamanders at at random and and finds finds that that the the average average length length of their their tails tails has has a a 95°/o 95% confidence confidence interval interval of 5 to 6 inches. inches. Which Which of the the following following conclusions conclusions is the the most most appropriate based appropriate based on on the the confidence confidence interval? interval? basketball manufacturer selects a A basketball manufacturer selects a random random sample of its sample ensure aa its basketballs basketballs each each week week to ensure consistent air consistent within them air pressure pressure within them is maintained. ln maintained. In Week 1, 1, the sample had had aa mean mean the sample air pressure pressure of 8.2 psi air (pounds per per square square inch) psi (pounds inch) and a a margin margin of error 0.1 psi. and error of 0.1 psi. ln In Week 2, the 2, the sample sample had mean air pressure pressure of 7.7 psi had aa mean psi and and a a margin of error margin error of 0.3 psi. psi . Based Based on on these these results, results, which of the the following reasonable which following is aa reasonable conclusion? conclusion? A) 95°/o salamanders have have aa 95% of all all blue-spotted blue-spotted salamanders tail that between 5 and and 6 inches inches in length length.. that is between all salamanders have aa tail B) 95% of all salamanders have that is tail that between 5 and between length. and 6 inches inches in length. The true C) The true average the tails average length length of the tails of all all blue-spotted salamanders salamanders is likely between blue-spotted is likely between Most of the the basketballs basketballs produced produced in Week 11 A) Most had an an air air pressure pressure under under 8.2 psi, had psi, whereas whereas most of the most the basketballs basketballs produced produced in Week 2 had an air had an air pressure pressure under under 7.7 psi. psi. B) The pressure of all the basketballs basketballs The mean mean air air pressure all the produced in Week 11 was was 0.5 psi produced psi more more than than ·tthe mean air pressure of all the basketballs h e mean air pressure all the basketballs produced produced in Week 2. 2. number of basketballs basketballs in the the Week 1 C) The The number sample was more more than the number number of sample was than the basketballs in the the Week 2 sample. sample. basketballs that the the mean mean air D) It is very very likely likely that air pressure pressure the basketballs produced in Week 11 of all all the basketballs produced was less less than was than the all the mean mean air air pressure pressure of all the basketballs produced the basketballs 2. produced in Week 2. and 6 inches. 5 and inches. The true true average average length length of the the tails tails of all D) The all salamanders salamanders is likely likely between between 5 and and 6 inches . inches. An economist economist conducted conducted research determine research to determine whether there there is a a relationship relationship between between the whether the price price food and and population population density. of food density. He He collected collected data from from a a random random sample data S . cities sample of 100 U U.S. cities and and found significant significant evidence found food evidence that that the the price price of food lower in places places with is lower population with a a high high population density. Which Which of the density. the following conclusions is following conclusions best by these these results? results? best supported supported by A student student is assigned assigned to conduct conduct a a survey survey to determine the the mean number of servings determine mean number servings of vegetables eaten eaten by aa certain vegetables group of people certain group people each day has not yet decided each day.. The The student student has n o t yet decided which which group group of people people will will be be the focus of this this survey. survey. the focus Selecting Selecting aa random random sample sample from from which the which of the following groups would would m o s t likely likely give following groups most give the the smallest error? smallest margin margin of error? ln US. U.S. cities, cities, there A) in there is a positive association association a positive between the between the price price of food food and and population population density. density . U.S. cities, cities, there B) In US. there is aa negative negative association association between the the price between price of food food and and population population density. density. C) In U S . cities, U.S. cities, aa decrease decrease in the the price price of food food is caused an increase increase in in the caused by by an the population population density. density. U.S. D) In U S . cities, cities, an an increase increase in the the population population density price density is caused caused by a decrease decrease in the the price of food. food. the same A) Residents Residents of the same city Customers of a certain certain restaurant B) Customers restaurant Viewers of the the same same television television show C) Viewers show Students who are following D) Students who are the same same daily daily following the diet diet plan plan 266 266 29 Volume Volume The volume volume of all all regular regular solids solids can can be be found found using using the the following following formula: formula: The Volume = Area of base x height 3 (the 2 and That’s why why the the volume volume of aa cube cube is V = : s53 (the area area of the base is s52 and the the height height is s) s) the base That's sS The volume volume of aa rectangular rectangular box/prism box / prism is is V V= : lwh Izuh (the (the area area of the base is lw Iw and and the height is h) h) The the base the height h w I 2 h (the And the base and the the height h) A n d the the volume volume of aa cylinder cylinder is V V= : m rrrzlz (the area area of the base is is m 7rr22 and height is is 11) h Even though though the the SAT gives gives you you these these formulas formulas at at the the beginning beginning of each each math math section, section, they they should should be be memorized, memorized, Even addition to to the the volume volume of aa cone cone in addition V : ‐3 rrrzlI 267 CHAPTER VOLUME CHAPTER 29 VOLUME and the and the volume volume of a a sphere sphere 4 3 V= : -§nr3 V rrr 3 But what what if we we have What’s the volume of have a a hollowed-out hollowed-out cylinder? cylinder? What's the volume of that? that? h I ' we look Well, ifif we look at base, it's it’s just just a ring. at the the base, a ring. A area of the The area the outer minus the inner circle. the ring ring is the outer circle minus the inner 7tR2 ‐ 7tr2 = 7r(R2 ‐ r2) To get by the the height. get the the volume, vo lume, we we multiply multiply this this area area by height. v = : rr(R 7r(R22 -‐ r2)h V r 2 )h addition to finding finding an an object’s object's volume, In addition volume, you'll you'll also also need need to know know how how to find its density. Sometimes you' you’ll density. Sometimes ll the density be given given the density formula and sometimes sometimes you you won't, won’t, so so it’s it. formula and it's important important to memorize memorize DeI\S;l e ·ty i = ns ty =Mass‐ ‐ Volume Volume Denser objects are heavier Denser size. heavier relative relative to their their size. 268 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA CHAPTER EXERCISE: Answers for this chapter start on page 342. calculator is allowed allowed on the following following A calculator questions. questions. What is the the vo volume cube with area What lume of a a cube with surface surface area 24a 2 ? 24a2 A) 4a2 4a2 A) 8a2 B) 8a2 ,, , , , ,, , C) 8a3 8a3 C) I I 3 D) D) 16a 16113 5cm I water tank tank with with a radius of 4 A cylindrical cylindrical water a base base radius 4 feet and a a height can be filled in 33 hours feet and height of 6 feet can be filled hours.. At that that rate, rate, how will it take take to fill a how many many hours hours will cylindrical water a base cylindrical water tank tank with with a base radius radius of 6 feet and and a a height height of 8 8 feet? feet? 4cm In the the figure figure above, above, aa cylindrical cylindrical block block of of wood wood is sliced sliced into into two two pieces pieces as as shown shown by by the the dashed dashed curve. curve. What What is the the volume volume of the the top top piece piece in A) 4.5 cubic cubic centimeters? centimeters? B) 6 A) lOrr 107i C) 7.5 B) 15rr 157r D) 9 2071 C) 207T D) 407r 40n A clay brick shape of aa right brick in the the shape right rectangular rectangular prism has length of 6 inches, inches, a width prism has aa length width that that is 25% greater than its length, and a height greater than its length, and a height that that is 2 inches shorter shorter than its length. length. The The brick brick has has aa inches than its mass of 5.85 kilograms. kilograms. What What is is the the density, density, in mass grams per per cubic inch, of the the brick? brick? grams cubic inch, James James wants wants to to cover cover aa rectangular rectangular box box with with wrapping has aa square wrapping paper paper.. The The box box has square base base with with an an area area of 25 square square inches. inches. The The volume volume of the the box box is 100 cubic cubic inches. inches. How H o w many many square square inches paper will inches of wrapping wrapping paper will James James need need to to exactly cover all faces of the box, including exactly cover all faces the box, including the the top top and and the the bottom? bottom? A) 120 B) 130 C) 150 D) 160 269 CHAPTER CHAPTER 29 VOLUME VOLUME A cube side length length of 5 inches cube with with a a side inches is painted painted black black on all all six faces. faces. The The entire entire cube cube is then then cut cut into smaller smaller cubes cubes with with sides sides of 1 inch. inch. How into How many any black black paint many small small cubes cubes do do n_ot not have have any paint them? on them? A) A ) 227 7 B)) 3 311 B C)) 336 C 6 D)) 4488 D finds a a box box with an open open top. top. Each Each side Yuna finds with an side is 8 inches long. long . If she this box with identical identical 2 inches she fills this box with cubes, how many of these these in by 2 in by 2 in cubes, how many cubes will will be be touching touching the the box? box? cubes A container container in the the shape shape of a right right circular circular cylinder shown above is just large enough cylinder shown above is just large enough to to fit exactly 33 tennis exactly tennis balls balls each each with with aa radius radius of 22 inches emptied o out inches.. If If the the container container were were emptied u t and and filled top with be the filled to to the the top with water, water, what what would would be the volume volume of water, water, in cubic cubic inches inches,, held held by the the container? container? A)) 440 A 0 B) 48 48 B) C)) 552 C 2 D)) 556 D 6 A) A) 16n 1671 B) 24n 247r IN C) 32n 327: D) D) 48n 487r A 3 x 4 x><5Ssolidblockismadeupofl solid block is made up of 1 xx11 x1 x1 A3><4 unit cubes. cubes. The unit The outside outside surface surface of the the block block is painted black. How How many cubes have have painted black. many unit u n i t cubes exactly exactly one one face painted painted black? black? A ) 116 6 A) An aquarium aquarium has inch has an an 80 80 inch inch by 25 25 inch rectangular rectangular base base and and aa height height of 30 30 inches inches.. The The aquarium is filled with aquarium with water water to to aa depth depth of 20 20 inches block with inches.. If If aa solid solid block with a volume volume of 5,000 in in33 aquarium, by is completely completely submerged submerged in the the aquarium, by how does the water level how many many inches inches does the water level rise? rise? B 8 B)) 118 C 0 C)) 220 D 2 D)) 222 right circular circular cone cone has has aa volume 6rra 4 cubic cubic A right volume of 67ra4 centimeters, where positive constant. constant. If the centimeters, where a is a positive If the 2 which of height of the the cone cone is 2a height 2112 centimeters, centimeters, which the following following gives give s the the radius, radius, in centimeters, centimeter s, of the the base base of the the cone ? the cone in terms terms of a ? A) A) tat/3 a./3 B) B) 311 3a C) C) 3a2 3a 2 D) D) 270 941 9a THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA 3 10 15 cm 8 crate that that is 10 inches long, long, 8 inches wide, and and A crate 10inches inches wide, 3 inches inches high high is shown above. The and the the shown above. The floor floor and four walls walls are are all one one inch inch thick. thick. H How many four o w many one-inch cubical cubical blocks can fit inside inside the the crate? crate? one-inch blocks can A food produces packages food manufacturer manufacturer produces packages of frozen cones. Each frozen ice ice cream cream cones. Each ice ice cream cream cone cone consists that is filled consists of aa right right circular circular cone cone that filled with with ice hemisphere is formed the ice cream cream until until aahemisphere formed above above the cone cone as as shown shown in the the figure figure above. above. The The right right circular has aa base radius of 9 cm circular cone cone has base radius cm and and aa slant height of 15 cm . What is the volume slant height 15cm. What is the volume of ice ice cream, cream, in cubic cubic centimeters, centimeters, the the manufacturer manufacturer uses uses for each each ice cream cream cone? cone? A)) 884 A 4 B) 96 B) C) 120 D) 144 A) A) 729n 7297r B) 810n 8107r C) 8917: 891 rr 96071 D) 960n A right right circular circular cylinder cylinder has has aa base base radius radius rr that that is 22 inches inches longer longer than than its its height. height. Which Which of the the following expressions expressions gives gives the the volume, volume, in cubic cubic following inches, of the inches, the cylinder cylinder in terms terms of rr ?? 5 A) 271'r33 A) 2nr 6 Note: Figure o t drawn to scale scale.. Note: Figure n not drawn to 7rr3 + 2n 2m2 B) n r3 + r2 The concrete staircase shown shown above The concrete staircase above is built built from from a long and a rectangular rectangular base base that that is 55 meters meters long and 6 6 meters have equal equal meters wide. wide . The The three three steps steps have dimensions one has rise of 0.2 meters. meters. dimensions and and each each one has a a rise If is 130 kilograms kilograms per per lf the the density density of concrete concrete is cubic mass of the concrete cubic meter, meter, what what is the the mass the concrete staircase mass divided staircase in kilograms? kilograms? (Density (Density is mass divided by volume) volume) by r 3 -‐ 2n r2 C) nm3 27rr2 D) 2n 27rr3 + nm2 D) r3 + r2 A) 1,420 B) 1,560 C) 1,820 D) 2,040 271 271 30 the Answers to.the Answers to Exercmes Exercises l: Exponents & Radicals Chapter Chapter 1:Exponents Radicals EXERCISE EXERCISE1: 1. 1 36 11. -~36 9 20. 9 2. -711 12. 64 1l 21. 9 21. 9 3. 1 72 13. -7‐72 4. -A11 14. 108 5. 11 648 15. -7648 1 23. ‑ 23 · 125 125 6. -211 16. 11 24. 49 24- 49 7. 7. -‐1 1 1 17 17.. !6g 25_ * 25. 49 11 18. 4 7 18. 4 26. 1,000 26 - 27 8. 727 9. -727 27 10. 27 27 10. 22. 125 1 49 1 1 27 27 · 1,000 1,000 19. 1 272 THE THE COLLEGE PANDA COLLEGE PAN DA EXE EXERCISE RCISE 2: 2: 1 6x 6x55 1. 88 2. k2 ‐ 2. k2 3. 15x 15x22 4. -‐ 2211 4 10 x33 10. x 19 36m8 19. 36m8 1 ~1 20. ”6 20. 6 x6 X 11. y‐3 11. 3 y 6 a 21. 3112 1,12 b12 3u 2 12. T 4 22 m4 13. -‐8u3v3 13. 8113 v 3 22.' -n n 21. 1114 11 5. 7 5. 8x 6 8x 9b55 6. -‐&a3 113 14 15 23.1’2 14. x 5 23. x 2 15. 3x 3x88 15. 24‘ L 1 24. -mn2 -2 16. Xx 25. k 25. k mn 7 7. n4 1 14 . 22 8. 8 crib6 a4b6 y22 17. xx99 17. 6 m6 26. ‑m9 "9 22 18. 3‐3 X x n 27 5 7 9 27.. x5yy7zZ9 9. 2 y_2 9. X x EXE EXERCISE 3: RCISE 3: 1· Ni l.1. 2/3 7. 4\/'2 Ni 7. 2. 4/6 4\/6 2. 8, 10\/' 1o\/§ 8. 2 3. 3v'S 3\/5 3. 9. 2\/'2 zfi 9. 4.3f2 4. 3\/'2 10. 8\/'2 sfi 10. 5 . 6/3 6\/§ 5. 11 .xx = = 5500 11. 6.15\/§ 6. 15/3 12. Xx = =5 12. 5 13. x = 2 13. X = 2 14. x = 8 14. X = 8 15- x = 21 15. X = 21 x= 5 11 X = 2 17x26 16. 16. 17. X = 6 18. x : 6 18. X = 6 I I I I \ I •' j 273 CHAPTER ANSWERS TO THE CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS THE EXERCISES EXERCISES CHAPTER EXERCISE: EXERCISE: 10. ‑ avoid any any trickiness, trickiness, it’s it's best 7. [fil E To avoid best to plug plug in numbers . Leta Let a = through numbers. = 2 and and b = 2. Going Going through each choice, choice, each l. a =3 A) (- 4) 2 = 16 A) (‐4)2 16 1 7 fl : 3 B) (‐4)4 (- 4)4 = 256 B) C) 16 C) (2-2)2 (2 · 2)2 = 16 D = 22-·1166 = D)) 2-24 2 · 24 = =3322 11=3\/E = 3y'a w; ~ = y'a the largest. largest. (B) is the -91‐a =a 1 8. [Q] of the the first equation, equation, Cube both both sides [__D_] Cube sides (x2)3 = (y3)3 2-I x6 P = 233 2x 2.1/ 2x‐y=23 2x-y = 23 = y9 6 9 , Now can be be replaced replaced by xx6, N ow y y9 can X32=y9 x3z =y9 x3z=x6 x3z = x6 x ‐ yy =: 3 xx = yy + x= +3 3 2=: 6 3z z= 2 : 2 3. [Q] [E] Raise Raise each each side side to to the the 4th 4th power: power: 9 .‑ 9. 0 5 = 10 yy5 = 10 (y5)4 = 104 104 (y5)4 = Ir' f! ti Vn/Esz-xé v x = y x • x ==\/x_%=(x%)"l’ y x = (x 2 ) 2 ==xx y20 3/20 = 10,000 1 2 X \f 31 3 4 3 4. Therefore, Therefore , a = 3 4 0 10. 4G-::i, v x- y ·=(x 2 4 ! y )4=x 2· 1 4.! ! 1 r= 4y 4= x "y =y v x In ' xbc = x30 xac+bc ___ x30 m+m=w ac + be= 30 (a + b)c= b)c : 30 5c : 30 Sc= 30 cc== 6 6 [g .‑ 6. 274 I I PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA 1HE COLLEGE 11.@] 22(2n+3) = = 23(n+5) 22(2n+3} 2(2n + 3 (n + 5) + 33) )=: 3(n 4n + 66 = : 3n 15 +15 3n + 4n + n=9 12. 0( - 2); = n = v'l- 2 . - 2 . - 2 1- - 2 . - 2 = - 2 . 1 - 2 . - 2 = 13. - 2-¼ [£] 2x+ 3 - (2x) (23 ) - 2x(23 - = k(2x) 2x = k (2x) 1) = k (2x) 2x 2x (7) = k(2x) 7= k 14. exponents. the exponents. Multiply the [filMultiply (53)4k = (5§)24 (5! )24 (53)4k= = 5s 512k = Since can equate equate same, we can the same, are the bases are the bases Since the 8 2 the exponents: 12k = = 8 and and so so k = = % = = g.. the exponents: 12 3 15. 15. and power and 2a power the 2a raised to the means raised 2a means The 211 [filThe the root. bth root. the bth means the bottom means the bottom on the b on the b 16. [Q] @ Multiply Multiply both The left left together . The equations together. both equations 16. 5 hand The right side hand side right hand x y5. The gives x5y5. side gives hand side gives gives 80. 275 CHAPTER ANSWERS TO TO THE THE EXERCISES EXERCISES CHAPTER 30 30 ANSWERS Chapter 2: Percent Percent CHAPTER CHAPTEREXERCISE: EXERCISE: f"o""i:l12.75 ‐0.085 _ 8.5 A, 1. ~ 501‐‐ 150 = 0.085 = 8.5% 2. : 2. @32,m0(1.15) @]3 2,000 (1.15) = 9. for 9. [D] ~ Let xx be be the the sales sales tax (as (as a a decimal decimal for now). at the now). We'll We'll convert convert it to a percent percent at the end. end. 36,800 36,800 105.82(.90)(1+ = 100 105.82 (.90)( 1 + x) = ..O‐5 31% []J ~:6‐0.03125~ = 0.03125 ~ 3.1 % 3. 4.. l1 +x= +x= .Letz =1.50(100) [I] Let z = 100. Then Then x x = 1.50(100) = 150 _ and is and y = 1.20(100) := 120. x is 150 - 120 150‐120 120 120 30 30 0 = % ‘ fi120‘ =z25M 0 Each year, Veronica keeps whatever she she Each year, Veronica keeps whatever has in her her account account plus the interest that has plus the interest on on that amount. Because amount. we can Because m misis a a percentage, percentage, we can convert it to to a a decimal decimal by convert 100, by dividing dividing it by by 100, giving = 11 + + 0.0lm. 0.01m. giving us us 0.01m. 0.0lm . Therefore, Therefore, x = x X z 0.05 = 5% = xX = 800 Therefore, Therefore, 940 -‐ 800 = 140 more more dishes dishes were were served during served during dinner. dinner . 11. 11. 2,690 -‐ 2, 2,690 140 2,140 2,140 x 1100% 0 0 / o~z 25.7% X 21140 8. = (105.82)( .90) -‐1 l _ (105.32)(.90) 1.175x = 940 l.175x El new value value -‐ old old va value fol new lue x 100% _2 O 6-~ Id I x 100 1/oold value o va ue 7. 100 X 10. I140 ILet xx be number of dishes served be the the number of dishes served during lunch. lunch . Then during Then larger than larger than y. 5. 100 100 (105.82) (.90) (105.82)(.90) A := ((1.25) 1 2 5( B) A 7 0 (1.25) (1.25)(B) 70: = ( B) 6= 8 56 []2JLet the original price of the book be $100. Then James James bought Then bought the the book book at at 100(1‐- 0.20)(1 0.30) = 100(0.80)(0.70) 100(1 0.20) (1 -‐ 0.30) = 100(0.80) (0.70) = = 5 $56, which is ; = 56% of the original price . 1 0 12. = 24 of chicken chicken [I] Kyle Kyle ate ate 20(1.20) = 24 pounds pounds of wings = 21 hot dogs dogs.. wings and and 15(1.40) 15(1.40) = 21 pounds pounds of of hot That 's a That’s = 45 pounds of food. a total total of 24 24 + 21 21 = 45 pounds food. John : 35pounds food.. The The John had had 20+ 20 + 15 15 = 35 pounds of of food percent from John John to Kyle Kyle is percent increase increase from 0 Let x be be the of pistachios at the the the number number of pistachios at start. each day, what’s left start. At the the end end of each day, what's left is 1 -‐ 0.40 = 0.60 of the the day’s day's starting starting amount. amount . Over w o days, Over ttwo days, 45 45 -‐35 35 35 z. .29 29 = 2 9°/o 35 ~ 29% x(0.60)(0.60) : 27 27 x(0.60) (0.60) = 0.36x : 27 0.36x = x X ~ 13. = = 75 75 Let her count be bex. loss of of [I] Let her starting starting card card count x. A A loss 18 (0.82)x. From 18 percent percent reduces reduces her her total total to to (0.82)x. From there, gets the there, an an increase increase of 36 percent percent gets the total total to (1.36)(0.82)x. (1.36)( 0.82)x. Now, Now, (1.36)(0.82)x (1.36) (0.82)x = n n x=~--x : (1.36) (1.36)(0.82) (0.82) 276 THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA 14. [Ij 12,000 (0.94) 10 m ~ 6,460. 6,460 . 12,000(0.94)10 19. after 55 years will be 3,000(1.06)5, but the the after years will be 3, 000 (1.06 ) 5, but interest 3,000(1.06)5 000.. interest earned earned will will be be 3,000 (1.06) 5 -‐ 3, 3,000 The total amount in the the checking The total amount checking account account after 55 years years will will be be 1, after 1,000(1.01)5, 000(1.01 ) 5 , but but the the interest 1,000(1.01)5 1,000.. interest earned earned will will be be 1, 000 (1.01 ) 5 -‐ 1,000 With deposit and With a a larger larger initial initial deposit and a a higher higher interest savings account interest rate, rate, it's it's obvious obvious the the savings account will difference will have have eamed earned more more interest. interest. The The difference in earned will be (3,000(1.06)5 earned interest interest will be (3, 000 (1.06) 5 -‑ 3,000) (1,000(1.01)5 1,000). 3,000 ) -‐ (1,000 (1.01) 5 -‐ 1,000 ). 15. I100 ISince Since scarves scarves and and ties make make up 80% of the accessories, accessories, the the 40 belts belts must the m u s t account account for 20%. Letting Letting the the total total number 20°/o. number of accessories accessories be x, x, be 20°/o of = 40 20% of Xx = 1 -5x:40 x = 40 5 xX :=2 200 00 There are 200 accessories accessories in the There are store. the store. Hopefully you’re able get this Hopefully you're able to get this without without having make an an equation, having to make equation, but but there's there’s no no harm harm in aa little little algebra! algebra! Now N o w we we can can 20. P(1 +- r)5 - P lOO and ~g x 200 = = 120 ties. the 120 120 ties ties and ties . Half Half of the p (60 ties) replaced with scarves, so so the the store store ties) are are replaced with scarves, will w i l l end + 60 = = 100 scarves. scarves. end up with with 40 + I 16. 1.728 After years, the the market market value After 3 years, value of the the bond bond is 9000.2)3 = 900(1.728) 900(1.728) == 900 900(1+ 0.728). 900(1.2) 3 = (1 + 0.728). Therefore, Therefore, p = z .728 [g To get get the the final final value value after after aa percent percent increase, you have to multiply the initial initial increase, you have multiply the value the percentage (as aa decimal). value by 1 plus plus the percentage (as decimal) . So in 2016, Sims Sims must spent l.34x 1.34x must have have spent dollars on dollars must have on groceries. grocerie s . In 2017, she she must have spent (1 + +1.45)(1.34x) : (2.45)(1.34x) spent l.45 )( 1.34x) = (2.45)( 1.34x) dollars dollars on groceries. groceries . 18. [g The The percent percent change change is the the new n e w minus minus the the old old times times 100. Notice Notice that P’s old over over the the old that the the P's cancel out. cancel out. determine there are z 40 40 scarves scarves determine that that there are ~%x x 200 = 17. amount in the the savings savings account account [g The The total total amount |__D_] Let x x be be the the amount amount of taxes, taxes, in millions millions [Q] of dollars, dollars, collected collected by County County A in 2016. Since the the taxes taxes decreased from 2016 to Since decreased by 25% from 2017, (1 -‐ 0.25)x = : 60 60 0.75x = 60 60 xX = = 80 80 Because Bcollected the same same amount amount Because County County B collected the as County County A in 2016, County County B also also collected collected as 80million dollars of taxes taxes in 2016. In In 2017, 80 million dollars County collected 20% more more than so County B collected than in 2016, so County B must have collected 80(1.20) : 96 96 County must have collected 80 (1.20) = million dollars in 2017. million dollars 277 X 100 = CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS TO lliE EXERCISES Chapter 3: Exponential vs. Linear Growth CHAPTER EXERCISE: 1 1.. 0 home value of the home exponential decay. The value a case of exponential The situation question is a the question presented in the situation presented time . over time. increments over smaller increments and smaller smaller and then by smaller beginning and the beginning decreases o r e significantly and then significantly in the more decreases m decay. exponential models that graph a shows A answer Only Only answer shows a graph that models exponential decreases be stocked shelves left to be number of shelves rate, the number a constant shelves at a constant rate, stocked decreases employees stock shelves the employees [Q] Since the 2.. lg function . linear function. decreasing linear Therefore, the function time. Therefore, over time. rate over constant rate at a constant function p is a decreasing 25 20 = ; be 252‐020 turns out which turns increase, which percent increase, calculate the percent need to calculate we need growth, we out to be exponential growth, 3.. []] With exponential 20(1.25 ) 1, modeled by P := 20(1.25)', be modeled can be growth can the exponential and the growth factor is 1.25, and 0.25. Therefore, exponential growth Therefore, the growth population. initial population. where 20is is the initial where 20 4.. increase is 125 -‐ constant increase [I] The constant initial (the initial y-intercept (the and the y-intercept 25 and slope is 25 100 = : 25. Therefore, Therefore, the slope population) is 100. population) alloy's metal alloy’s 20 is the metal equation, where definition of f is in the form form of an an exponential exponential equation, where 20 given definition [QJThe given 5.. @ second. each second. increased each which itit increased percent by which 15 is the percent experiment and the experiment beginning of the at the beginning temperature at temperature and 15is 1 greater = + 1% growth factor, 1 + because the growth second because each second increased each temperature increased We know know the temperature z 1.15, 1.15, is greater /! 15 = 0.85. have to be 1 -‐ % = would have factor would growth factor the growth correct, the answer C to be than 1. For answer than be correct, 100 6.. 0 f doubled infected cells doubled number of infected predicted number the predicted exponent, the growth factor is 2 and Since the growth and ~5 is the the exponent, so oonn . And so 80(2) 2 := 320. And C(lO ) = days , C(10) 10 days, (2) 1 =: 160. After days, C(5) =: 80 after 5 days, So after days . So 5 days. every 5 every 80(2)1 After 10 = 80(2)2 7.. II] 8.. increases by 1.002 -‐ 11 = registered increases number of cars registered the number equation is 1.002, the the equation growth factor in the II] Since the growth : the 97% of the 1, 000 (0.97 )/r/( l / 4 ), 97°/o 000 (0.97)4h = 1,000(0.97)"/“/4), as N = express asN can express we can which we model, which the model, on the Based on Based : 1, 1,000(0.97)4" 1 1 . minutes . every ~3 x 60 = decrease every 3% decrease a 3% That's a hour. That’s ~ hour. every 5 after every remain after bacteria = 15 15 minutes. bacteria remain 1 months). Therefore, every %year 0.002 = : 0.2% every year (6 months). Therefore, n = z 0.2 2 reference. The a reference. as a equation y = 1abk use the equation decay, we exponential decay, a case of exponential have a we have [QJSince we 9.. [E we can use 11115 as years . 4 years. every 4 0.94 = 0.06 1 of factor a factor exponentially by a decays exponentially at 14,000 and starts at trees starts population of trees population and decays 1‐ every 0.94,k 14000,b := 0.94,k Therefore, a = 14000,b Therefore, t 14,000 (0.94)4 = 14,000(0.94)i the equation and the 4, and z= 4, equation is P P= straight line. a straight forming a closest to forming the closest Scatterplot C is the II] Scatterplot received she has amount she total amount Because the total received: 3, 9, 27, 81. Because has received: she has amount she total amount Keep track of the total 11. II] Keep has received 10. growth . exponential growth. relationship is exponential each day, the relationship triples triples each decay linear decay relationship is linear decrease, the relationship constant decrease, a constant this is a Because this book . Because a book. loses a Albert loses month, Albert Each month, 12. []] Each (decreasing linear). linear) . (decreasing 13.. = 80. c= count is 80 so initial count hour so every hour doubles every count doubles [QJThe cell count [El so the growth growth factor, r,r, is 2. The initial so 6 278 THE PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE 14. constant. footage is a constant. original square the original square footage percent of the Five percent CgFive make it would make which would change, which doesn't change, It doesn't linear growth.. linear growth exponential decay. one of exponential model is one year, the model cut in half gets cut items gets number of items 15. []] Since the number half every every year, equation is the exponential 6, 000. The first equation 500 (4) := 6,000. 1, 500(4) V = 1, model: V linear model: the linear equation is the second equation 16. [[] The The second exponential 4 2,800. = 3,200 6,000 difference The 3,200. = ) (2 model: V : 200(24) = 3,200. The difference is 6,000 ~ 3, 200 = 2,800. 200 = : model 17. m start), m at the start), = 0 (i.e. at when t = 50 when equation . Since P = 50 an exponential exponential growth growth equation. equation is an given equation CgThe given the So we equation) . 50 into the equation). 50 into and P = plugging in t = confirm this by plugging can confirm m u s t equal = 0 and = 50 we know know the (you can 50 (you equal 50 must which each of the two Now choice D. N choice C or choice answer o w we have have to check each t w o answer answer choices choices to see which either choice answer is either equation the equation that the quickly see that we'll quickly calculator, we’ll a calculator, use a we use If we table. If the table. values in the the values approximates the better approximates one one better = 86.12. with nn = equation with the equation than the better than 30, 45 better = 15,30,45 given values models the given = 54.38 models with values of P for t = with n = information, From the given reference. From as a reference. abt as equation y := abf exponential equation standard exponential the standard use the Let's use 18. [QJ @ Let's given information, equation exponential equation growth factor). Since the standard (the growth and bb := 1.02 (the amount) and initial amount) (the initial 16 (the a = a = 16 standard exponential 15 5 ~ gives k = which gives days, which into days, hours into 15 hours convert 15 requires tt and and k to be be in the same same units, units, we we have have to convert = fl~~ := 5 requires 1 . W/(SIB) = 16(1.02) (t ) = 16(1.02) we get together, we everything together, Putting everything days . Putting days. get g g(t) 16(1.O2)'/‘5/8) 160.02)? 279 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES Chapter 4: Rates CHAPTEREXERCISE: 1. [I!]For protein intake intake of 7 x 60 60 = grams. For one one week, week, Trm's Tim’s diet diet plan plan would would require require aa protein = 420 grams. Since each each Since 7 30 30 = 14 protein buy 420 + protein bar bar provides provides 30 30 grams grams of protein, protein, he he would would need need to buy 14protein protein bars bars.. 2. 0 3. [I] The pressure 4. WThe pool has a capacity Over 6 years, the screen size increased by a total of 18.5 - 15.5 = 3 inches. That's 3 7 6 each each year. year. = 0.5 inches increases by 70 - 50 = 20 atm while the submarine descends - 900 - (- 700) meters. per meter, per 10 meters. meters. That's That’s 20 7+ 200 = = 0.1 atm atrn per meter, or 1 I atm a i m per meters. = - 200 of 5 x 300 = 1,500 gallons. At an increased rate of 500 gallons per hour, it would would only only take take 1, 1,500 7+ 500 = : 3 hours hours to to fill the the pool. pool. 5. []] dollars 20 2051i"'"f''"" a,,nDkrt, p p l e Xs dd‐ollars ,,nDkrt, a ~, 6. "" d II z?-20d dollars = 0 ars a [f]The racecar burned 22 - 18 = 4 gallons of fuel in 7 - 4 will will have have to consume consume 18 18‐- 66 = z 12 12more more gallons. gallons. That's That’s = 3 laps. To get to 6 gallons left, the racecar lapss 43 3 laps 12gallon§x ‐ 9 9 more more laps 12 _galk,nsx _galk,ns= laps 4 which is Lap Lap 7 + +9= = 16. which 7. I100 IIt took 2.5 hours for 65 - 40 = 25 boxes to be unloaded. There are 3.5 hours from 3:30PM to 7:00PM. 25 boxes . hours, 3.5.het:rrs 3 . 5 h o u r § x M .het:rrs = : 35 35 more more boxes boxes will will be unloaded. That’s total of 65 65 + + 35 35 = 100 In 3.5 hours, be unloaded. That's a a total 2.5mm 25 boxes. boxes. Average speed speed is just just total total distance distance over over total total time. The total was 2400 x 12 12 = : 8. I120 IAverage time. The total distance, distance, in inches, inches, was 28,800.. The The total seconds, was w a s 4 x 60 = : 240. 28,800 second. 28,800 total time, time, in seconds, 28,800 7+ 240 z= 120 inches inches per per second. 432 I 9. 1432 . 90 90 words words = l m e u t é § xx fi ‐ 432 . 12.mi:m:rtes 432 words words 2 .5 .mi:m:rtes :_w- --~ m l ~m,SJOn 180 100 ~ 1 jar xX ‐OO‐‐‐1’rl 60 jars l :_ s- --~ m xX _2O10_ _m) amr ==60jars 15 ..!c! .l-l...l-'H'tTJll:,SJOn 2 ;n nr~ ~ ......s 11. [[] 6 0.mim:rtes m m ? 32 32 kilometers kilometers ., 60 ~ 265 kilometers 22m 265 kilometers .het:rrs xX f l.lwtrf xX _ .mi:fttrtes ~ 14 5 m ‐ s 1n7 3 liters 8 dollars 11 hours hours x 3hliters x xm I' : 132 dollars dollars 12..@ ~ 11 = 1 liter 1ter 2 hours ours 280 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA 3 @3cu s r o i l xX 13. [Qj 3~ 14. -é cups cups of lye lye 2 ‐ 2 ‐= 2 = 11.25 11.25 cups lye cups of of lye 2 gw 5~ An 88 inch inch by 10 inch inch piece piece of of cardboard cardboard has has an 10 = z 80 inches.. A A 16 16inch inch by by 20 20 inch inch [I]An by 10 an area area of of 8 8 x 10 80 square square inches piece of cardboard cardboard has has an an area area of 16 16 x 20 20 = = 320 square piece square inches. inches. £ ~ o. nx 320 l1ci 15. ~ -1,000kulacl€x 15. 1,000.hmrct< x 16. 17. 2 dollars ‐2d‐°"a.rS‐‐ =8dollars ~= 0 W 8 dollars 80 8 29 ¢k6f ' 29 2 large bahar fl .kalaci< xx M _Fiko[ ~ 16 large bahar 400 400144th 9M z16largebahar 9 0 The first first 150 miles miles took took 150 -;-30 + 30 == 55 hours hours.. The next 200 miles took 200-;200 + 50 : 44 hours hours.. His His average The The next miles took 50 = average speed, total total distance distance over time, was was (150 + + 200) / (5 + + 4) m miles per speed, over total total time, ~ 38.89 miles per hour. hour . The clock clock falls behind behind by 8 minutes minutes every every hour. hour. There are 6.5 hours hours between between 4:00 AM and 10:30 AM A M, CgThe There are and 10:30 so the the clock clock falls behind behind by 8 x 6.5 = : 52 52 minutes. minutes. The The correct then 52 52 minutes minutes past past 10:30 10:30 A M, so correct time time is then AM, which which is 11:22 AM AM.. 18. 0 2240 Jared’s rate rate is E~ = = 16 16 pages pages per per hour hour.. Robert's Robert’s rate then be be 16 16 x 2 = = 32 32 pages pages per Jared's rate must must then per hour. hour . It 1 would take Robert % hours to review review the report. That’s = 225 minutes minutes.. would take Robert ~; = 3.75 hours the 120-page 120-page report. That's 3.75 x 60 60 = 15 h 7.1 x 10 1015 ’ ns 'A77.1 ~ 19 19.. ~ A 20. 1 JHL lm lf 0.8 grams grams 0.8 4.8 X 1023 ~ X x4.8><1023hy,dmgerr‘iofi§x X 1000m‘lf ~ _ grams 1000.mt" z 1.2x ‑ 1L 2 10-51‘3‐ra‐’ms 0 5 - L1L ~ 1. X l L What makes makes this this question question aa little little tricky tricky is is that that we we don't distance Brett [I] What don't know know the the distance Brett travels travels each each month month the number gallons he he uses uses each each month month.. But let’s say he needs or the number of gallons But we need need to start start somewhere, somewhere, so so let's say he needs 2 gallons of gas gas each each month (you can can make make up up any any number want).. That means he 60 gallons month (you number you you want) That means he travels travels 30 30 x 2 = 60 miles each month dollars (ridiculous, (ridiculous, I1 know) miles each month and and each each gallon gallon costs costs 160 -;-2 + 2 = = 80 dollars know).. Now N o w if he he switches switches the new n e w car, he'll he’ll only only need need 60 -;-40 + 40 = = 1.5 gallons gallons of gas miles divided divided to the gas each each month month (distance (distance of 60 miles by the 40 miles miles per per gallon). gallon). Because the price price of gas stays the i l l cost cost him him the 40 Because the gas stays the same, same, that that amount amount of gas gas w will 80 = z 120 dollars dollars each each month. month. The The answer answer ends what number number we we make make up up ends up up being being 120 no no matter matter what 1.5 x 80 month. for the the number number of gallons gallons of gas gas Brett Brett uses uses each each month. . 160 Here's pnce per per gallon gallon of gas, gas, then Brett currently currently uses uses -7 Here’s an an alternative alternative solution solution.. If we we let let x be be the the price then Brett X 160 ((30) 4,800 gallons means that that he he drives 30 ) = 4’ --800 miles m iles each eac h gallons of gas gas each each month month.. Using Using that that amount amount of gas gas means drives -152‐0 X X 12 44, 800 120 month. he will gas each each month that distance. distance. month. With With the the new n e w car, he w i l l need need ' BOO-;‐Z‐ 40 40 = 70 gallons gallons of gas month to drive drive that x X X 120 Since each each gallon gallon of gas gas costs costs x atdollars, he will will need : 120 dollars Since dollars, he need to spend spend -% x x = dollars on on gas gas each each month. month . X Each jar of honey costs 9 -;-4 +4= = 2.25 dollars dollars.. She 15+ dollars. That's That’s a 21. I48 j Each honey costs She can can sell sell each each jar for 15 -;-33 = 5 dollars. a profit profit : 2.75 dollars dollars per per jar. To make make aa profit profit of 132 dollars, would have have to sell sell 132 -;-2.75 + 2.75 = = 48 48 of 5 -‐ 2.25 = dollars, she she would jars. jars . 281 281 ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS CHAPTER Chapter 5: Ratio & Proportion EXERCISE: CHAPTER EXERCISE: 6.@ 6. @J value of b is 1. ~ Since a z= 28, the value g then value of c is then ; x 28 = 24. The value 5 5x24‐15. BX24 = 15. 2. 1 = Vnew = Vm’w essentially just are essentially ratios are that ratios Remember that [lJRemember 2 nr h 3mzh Vold = void 2 1 3 2 7r(0.80r)2(1.10h) 0.80r) (1.10h) n( (~m 2h) = 0.704V = (0.80)2(l.10) 0.704v0m (0.80)2(1.10) (értrzh) 0 1d equivalent to ratio is equivalent given ratio So the given fractions. 50 fractions. zl+1l‐_+ = -4 XX -3 =‐ §3-2‐=33:. 22 119392 9 2- ...!... } - = - ...!... 4·2 2 _4 4· 4 decreases by volume of the cone decreases The volume 1 ‐- 0.704 := 0.296 = 29.6%. Therefore, n = Therefore, = 3. 7. [[] the Y. Then Product Y. price of Product be the price @J Let y be 3. [El Then the price of the price and the Xisis l.25y Product X price of Product price 1.25y and ratio of the ratio Simplifying the 0.75y. Simplifying Product Z is 0.75y. Product we get prices, we their prices, their Anld = 1 §(bl + b2)h l Anmu : E = 1.25 = 5 : 3 = 5 X 4 _ 5 _ 5 :33 l.25y 1-25.v_@_§-§_§xe_§_5 33 ‐ 33 ‑ 4 4 ‐4 0.75 4 ' 4 0.75y 0.75y‘0.75‘4 (Ebl + 1 l 2172) (2h) 1 1 = (§)(2> [5071+ w] 1 = 5071+ bzlh = Aold 4.@] 4. @ 2 vv2 Pold R Paid== F P P 1 . b1 and Notice u t from and from In factored oout was factored how %was Notice how 2 51) - 0o225P o.25v 2 _ - 0.25v2 (o.sv )2 _ -_ (0.SV)2 new -‐ R ‐- R -‐ -· b. stays the same. same. area stays b2. The area old and Kevin's sphere, radius of Kevin’s be the radius 8. [[] Let r be sphere, and Calvin's radius of Calvin’s be the factor the radius let x be greater by. sphere sphere is greater what fourth of what drops to a fourth power drops The electric power it was. was. 2, where where ss is square is A = area of aa square 5. [[] The area = s52, the length each side. side. length of each .The VKc’vin : A m , = (1.105)2 : 1.21s 1.2152 (1.10)2s2 = (l.10 s) 2 = (1.10)2s2 A new= 4 57" 2 4 = l.21A old = 1.2mm, Vca lvin greater . 21% greater. area is 21°/o new area The new = 43n(xr) 3 = x 3 ( 37Tr3 ) = X 3 V Krvin =4 X = v'4~ 1.59 x3 282 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA 9. 9. @ E The The area area of the the original original triangle triangle is is 11 _ 11 22 -§(5)(5) (s)(s) = _ -s 2 225 Amy An ew 1 13. 14. 1 1 ( XS )2 = Xx2 2((552) 1 2) xZAOM 2 §(xs)2 =2 2s = X Aold ~M l~ :a~erback ar cover 4 hardcover paperback copies paperback copies [QJ @ )!_ = 2.7 1__EZ 2.4 _ 3.6 2.7 ( ) 2.7 y = 3.6 2.4 xx2=0.64 = 0.64 2 = x = . 8.80 0 X s5 must decreased by must have have been been decreased 11 -‐ .80 = 0.20 = 20%. 15. 99 = 1.8 = 5 II] The The ratio the weight weight of Box A to ratio of the to the the weight of Box B reduces 7: 5. Since weight reduces to 7:5. Since the the weights of Boxes Boxes C C and follow the the same weights and D follow same E] 10. [Q] 7 7 ratio, Box C must ‐ fi; of Ofthe the ratio, must weigh weigh m: = 2 7 5 total total weight weight.: Therefore, Therefore, Box C weighs weighs Lotherslar : 47rd2b Lstar (2b) Lstar = Z 4rr(3d)2 47T(3d)2(2b) 7 2 = (3)2(2)(4rrd b) (3)2(2)(47Td2b) % x 180 = 105 pounds. pounds. 12 = otherstar : lBL 18Lother star 11. x 50 hardcover = 50hardcover = 125 II] Let Let x be be the the fraction fraction that that Star Star A's A’s distance distance is of Star Star B's. B’s. 1 LstarA Lsmm = = 5 LstarB LSmrB 9 2 47r(xd)2b = : ~(4rrd %(47rd2b) 4n(xd)2b b) 2 2 : i(4rrd game») xx2(47td2b) (4rrd2 b) = b) X x 2 z _ 11 =- 9 1 xx =-1 “ 33 The given given ratio ratio means means that that there there are are 12. I20 or 65 IThe 17 eighth graders 17 sixth sixth graders graders and and 28 28eighth graders for every batch batch of 17 17+ 28 = = 45 45 sixth sixth and and eighth eighth + 28 every This means means that the total total number number of graders. This graders. that the sixth and and eighth graders must must be bea multiple sixth eighth graders a multiple the case case that that this this total total is is 45, 45, the the of 45. In the remaining 110 -‐ 45 45 = 65 65 students students must must be be remaining seventh graders graders.. In the the case case that that this this total total is is seventh 45 x 22 = 90, the the remaining remaining 110 -‐ 90 90 = 20 20 45 students must m u s t be be seventh seventh graders. graders. Therefore, Therefore, students the possible possible values values of nn are are 20 20 and and 65. Notice Notice the that we we don’t have to to consider multiples of 45 45 that don't have consider multiples higher than since those those multiples multiples would would higher than 90 90 since exceed the the total total number number of students. students. exceed 283 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES Chapter6: Expressions CHAPTER EXERCISE: 0 We factor factor out out 6xy 6xy from from both both terms terms to get get 6xy(x 6xy(x + + y). y). IDl . . 1l 3 4 3a 4 + 3a 2. The least 2. ~ .The least common common denominator denominator 1s is 4a. So, -‐ + + -g = -i + + - = -4 + 3a a 4 4a 4a 4a 1. 1. 3_a 3.. 2 2 2 Expanding, (x (x22 + y)(y y)(y + z) = xxzy [fil Expanding, y + xx22 z + yy2 + yz 4.. [g Divide Divide the the top top and and bottom bottom by 4 to get get 11 +21: way to get same answer the . Another Another way get the the same answer is to split split the 3x ;}x. fractions fractions and and reduce. reduce. 5..@3x4 @]3x 4 -‐ 33 = 3(x 1)(x 2 -‐ 1) l)(x ‐- 1) 3(x44 -‐ 1) 1) = 3(x 3(x22 + +1)(x2 1) = : 3(x 3(x22 + l)(x 1)(x + +1)(x .The 6.. [IjThe expression b2 pattern, + 1. expression follows follows the the (a+ (a + b) b)22 = a1122 + 2ab Zab + b2 pattern, where where a = x + 1 1 and and b = y + 1. Therefore, Therefore, the expression is equivalent + 2)2. the expression equivalent to ((x ((x + 1) + (y + 1))2 = = (x + y + 7 'Elxy‐x [Q]xy - x2Z= Jx (yW - x) ‐= X - x (L x -M y) = _x ~ · xy-y x y ‐ y22 _ yy(x ( x -y) ‐y) y(x-y) y(x‐y) yy + 5 _ 33(x ( x ‐- 11)) ++22(x ( x ++55)) rr7 . . . . x-1 1 x x+S 8.. L.::JAdding Adding the the two t w o fractions fractions in the the denommator, denominator, -x g - + + - 3- = 6 2 6 3 _5x+7 = -5x 66+- 7 . 6 ‘ result fl'1p1 't: Sx ‐. ~ Now, this it: Now, 11 over over thls result means means we we can can flip 5x + 7. 7 2+ 1 2 + -x 2x + 11 2x -x + -x _ 9 · CE] --f = 2x f= ' 1 -2_x_1 2- - x X 10. x X x X 2x + 11 2x -x- x x 2x _ 2x 2x + +1 x 2x + +1 2x 1 = -xx 2x 1 = 2x 1 2x‐1 x 2x‐1 2x‐1 x X 2 [g First term s. Then First factor out o u t an an 8 from from both both terms. Then use use the formula formula aa2‐ b2 = (a -‐ b)(a b)(a + b2 + b). 1 1 1 Bx2 - 1y 2 = 8 ( x 2 - 1 y 2) = 8 ( x - 1 y ) ( x 4 8x2 “ 2 53/2 2 802 ‘ E312) 16 1 1y ) :8("‘1M”+ 411> Therefore, c = Therefore, 1 4. 2 (x 2 - 4) + = x 4 - 4x 2 + 4. Now we can apply the formula 2 11. ~ First, (x + 2)(x First, expand: expand: xx2(x 2)(x -‐ 2) + 4 = z xx2(x2 ‐ 4 z x4 ‐ 41x2 N o w we can apply the formula 2 - 2) 2 . 2 2 aa -‐2ab+l72 2ab + b = (a - b)2, where a = xx2and b= 2, to get x 4 -‐4x2 4x 2 + (a‐b)2,wherea andb =2,togetx4 +44 = (x (x2‐2)2. 12. 2 ) + (- 4x [fil Combining terms, we Combining like like terms, we get get 3x 3x33 + (8x (8x22 + 7x 7x2) + (‐4x ‐ 13. .Combining like terms, terms, Sa 5a-‐ 2a 2a= 3aand and 3y'a 3\/_ -‐ 5/a 5\/E = = -‐2\/E. [g Combining like = 3a 2/a . 137 w 11x) 11x) ‐- 7 = 3x 3x33 + 15x 15x22 -‐ 15x -‐ 7. 7. _1+ 9(2y)2 + 2(6y) 2 __ 36y2 ny 2 _ 1 1_§ _ 3 +2(6y)2 36y2 + +72y2 1 14· 3 9(2y)2 2 2 8(3y) 72y -‐ -‐ 2 + 2 8(3y)2 72y2 _ 2 15. II] To get get aa common c o m m o n denominator denominator of 2(x 2(x -‐ 2) for both fractions, we both fractions, we first factor factor oout u t aa negative negative from the the second bottom of the fraction by 2: second fraction fraction and and then then we multiply multiply the the top top and and bottom the first fraction x + x = Xx + x : x _ x = 2x _ xX = xX X X X X X 2X -m x ---2 + -22(_(22 ___ x _) = x ---2 + ---2-( x---2-) = x ---2 2 (x -2) = 2 ( _ x ___ 2 _) 2 (x -_ 2 ) = 2 ( . ,...... x--‐x) x ‐ 2 ‐2(x‐2) x ‐ 2 2(x‐2) 2 ( x ‐ 2 ) 2 ( x ‐ 2 ) 2 ( x ‐ 22~) ) 284 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA Chapter 7: Constructing Models CHAPTER EXERCISE: 1. 1. 0 In the the 2y the first first y hours, hours, the the carpenter carpenter lays lays (x)(y) (x)(y) = = xy bricks. bricks. In the 2}; hours hours thereafter, thereafter, he he lays lays (g) (Zy) == xy xy bricks. bricks. Altogether, Altogether, that's that’s xy + xy = = 2xy bricks. ( ~) (2y) bricks. 2.. For d dollars dollars worth worth of mozzarella mozzarella to have have been been sold, 861‐75 pounds must have been sold. sold. That That leaves leaves [I] For sold, _!!__ pounds must have been 8.75 d pounds still still available available for sale. sale. 175 -‐ ‐ _~ pounds 88.75 5 The store's store’s monthly monthly total total cost is is 3,000 3,000 + 2, an entire entire year, year, we we multiply multiply by by 12 12 months: months: 3.. @ The 2, 500x. For an c= =12(3,000 + 2,500x 2,500x). C 12(3,000 + ). 4.. @ The each customer. customer. The cost for all all the the customers The setup setup fees amount amount to 100c, 100C, $100 for each The monthly monthly cost customers amounts months, the add up to 50c amounts to 50c, 50C, $50 for each each customer customer.. Over Over m months, the monthly monthly charges charges add 50C x m, or 50cm. The charge is therefore The total total charge therefore 100c 100C + + 50cm. 50cm. 5.. @ For 2mn. Since there there are each pizza, For mn mn students, students, the total total number number of slices slices must must be be 2mn. are 8 8 slices in each pizza, the the 2mn mn . school school must m u s t order order -T - = T pizzas pizzas.. 8 6.. 4 . d . . [Q] !!_degrees degrees per minute. So after [ElThe compound's compound’s temperature temperature increases i n c r e a s e s by 5 per m i n u t e . 50 after x minutes, nunutes, the the temperature temperature m d dx Th final . .· th dx ._ b y -Ex, d dx dx . increases x, or -.a. e final temperature temperature 1s en tt + i n c r e a s e s by The 15 then + -E' m m m 7.. [Q] Over 44 days, days, they a total IE The The bakers bakers make make 3xy cupcakes cupcakes each each day. day. Over they will w i l l make make a total of 44 x 3xy = z 12xy cupcakes. the total total number divided by the number of cupcakes. The The number number of boxes boxes needed needed is the number of cupcakes cupcakes divided the number 12 = 12y. xy = cupcakes cupcakes that that can can fit fit in each each box: box: icy X 8.. @ The reduced So the the first souvenir souvenir costs and the the reduced price price of each each souvenir souvenir after after the the first is 0.6a. So costs a dollars dollars and remaining n l souvenirs each cost 0.6a dollars. Therefore, the total cost is a + (n l)(0.6a ). remaining ‐ 1 souvenirs each cost 0.611 dollars. Therefore, the total ‐ 1)(0.6a). 9.. [fJDuring should go up and and be relatively steep During the the biking biking portion portion of the the commute, commute, the the graph graph should goup berelatively steep since since Kaiba Kaiba minutes , covers the walks . When the rest area for 15 covers the initial initial 4 miles miles at at a faster faster pace pace than than he he walks. When Kaiba Kaiba stops stops at at the rest area 15minutes, the graph ld be distance during time. After the rest the graph shou should be flat since since he he does does not n o t cover cover any any distance during this this time. After Kaiba Kaiba leaves leaves the rest area, incline since he covers commute at area, the graph graph should should go go up up and and be be at at aa gradual gradual incline since he covers the the last last mile mile of his his commute at aa walking criteria. walking pace. pace. Only Only the the graph graph in answer answer C fulfills all of the above above criteria. 10.. [Q] his commute, commute, we're that goes [E]Since Mike's Mike's distance distance from from home home increases increases during during his we're looking looking for a graph graph that goes up and slowly at first and and then quickly later, later, and to the the right. right. Since his his distance distance from from home home increases increases slowly then more more quickly we're slope (more (more steep). steep). Only we’re also also looking looking for the graph graph to to go go from from aa low low slope slope (less steep) steep) to aa high high slope Only the the graph in answer answer D meets meets these these conditions. conditions. graph 11.. d [f] Since the cost per per game dollars . Since p tokens tokens can can be be used used to play play E_ 5 games, games, the game is _!!.__p= = dw dollars. -E w w 285 £1710 p CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES rr7 24,500 24, 500 -‐ 17,900 17,900 6, 6,600 plane descends The plane = 16200 := 550 descends at a rate rate of T = 550 feet feet per per minute. minute . Since Since the the plane plane 12 12 started its descent started A = = descent at an an altitude altitude of of 24,500 feet, feet, its its altitude altitude after after tt minutes minutes can can be be represented represented by by A 24,500 24, 500 ‐- 550t. 12. ~ 13. [fil The passenger spent The passenger spent 24 24 ‐- 14. [Q]Mark’s Mark's annual salary does does not [El annual salary l s t , when not change change during during the the year year except except for for June June 1st, when itit ”jumps” "jumps " by by $15,000. $15,000. a a dollars dollars on on additional additional miles miles after after the the first, first, which which means means the the passenger passenger 24 -‐ aa 24 traveled - b- additional traveled additional miles Adding the miles after after the the first. first. Adding the first first mile mile then then gives gives us us the the total total distance distance b traveled : traveled: 24 2 4-‐ a + 1 _ 24 2 4-‐ aa +é_ b 244-‐ a + bb 2 b‑ - b b -+ l =b -+ b = b _ b b Therefore, the correct correct graph graph should Therefore, jump at at the of each should be be flat throughout throughout each each year year except except for for aa jump the end end of each year year we are (since we are starting starting from June June 1st, l s t , the the end each year refers the next June lst). Only the end of each refers to to the next June 1st). Only the graph graph in in answer D fits this description. answer description . 15. @ [Q]Initially, members are are each each responsible Initially, the members responsible for paying paying 5 .!_ dollars. dollars . But ifif k k members members fail fail to to pay, pay, then then m r m k members remain and each one one becomes m ‐ k members remain and each becomes responsible responsible for _!__ k dollars. This amount dollars. This amount is is greater greater than than m -‐ k the original original amount amount by the mr mr r- ‐ m r r _ mr _ rr(m ( m-‐ kk ) _ m kr dollars mrr + kkrr _ (( m-‐ kk)) dollars m(m mm m -‐ k ‐- E = ‐ m ( m-‐ kk)) m ( m-‐ kk)) ‐ m _ m m (m mm (( m-‐ kk)) = m . .. . rr Here is an an alternative alternative solution. solution . Since each each member member is initially initiall y responsnble Here dollars, the club loses responsible for -a dollars, club loses m out on L !_ (k) dollars dollars when wh en the the k members members fail fail to pay. To make o u t on make up this lost lost amount, amount, each each of of the the remaining remaining m m ‐- k members members must must pay m pay an an additional additional r - (k ) kr kr m z _n m ll .!!1__ = _i - =: ---dollars m -‐ k m -‐ k m (m m m m ( m-‐ kk)) d o ars 286 286 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA Chapter 8: Manipulating & Solving Equations EXERCISE EXERCISE1: 1. rr = = 1. 2. r 19. 19. ± ~ fl7r X X _ CE7T = _ 271 2 _ YY + +Z Z X ( Y++Z)Z =) : X X ++ ll X(Y X Y++XZ X Z- ‐XX=: 1 XY 2A 2A 3. b = z h ‑ 3. b h X ( Y++ZZ-‐ 11)) == 1 X(Y V = lh 4. w 5. hI = z -‑ 5. I 1 x-111 : ‐ Y+Z‐1 X V ~ 2 m2 ?Tr 6. rr =± z j: 6. 20. 20. ~ 17th = ±i J c2e2 -‐ sz W s= W 7. 7. bb : 8. _ xX++ 1l = x(y + 2) = y xy + 2x = y 2x = y - xy 2x = y(l - x) a1122 _ 27rr2 9. _ S 9. h h= S - 2m2 27rr 2rrr bc be 10. aa = ‐ ti 7 10. be 21. First, First, cross‐multiply. cross-multiply. 11. d = = -E 11. a m:= 12. m 2ac=ab+b 2ae = ab + b 2 a c- ‐ ab a b=z b 2ae a ( 2 -c ‐b)b )=: b a(2e y- b “ll‐b -x x 13. 3/2 : m(x2 -‐ x1) + + Y1 y1 = = mx2 mxz -‐ mx, m x 1+ + yY1 1 y2 = _ mx2 - y2 + y, 14.. X1 x 1- : " y z +3“ 14 m ‐ m e 15. a = 15. 18. p ‐ b 2c‐ b v2 u2 02 -‐ 142 25 25 I~I 3t 22. ±/f;bx 22. 47r2L 4n 2 L 23. Divide Divide both both sides sides by 33 to to get get xx + + 2}; = g 23. 2y = 16. y = _ :i: 16. 17. z 17. g g= a‐ a- 7 [i] 72 t‐2 t2 A2 A2 7t2r2 = 22 7T r 24. Multiply Multiply both both sides sides by get 2x 2x + 10 10= by 2 to to get = j 4b - q 2t = %, a25. Since 2t a 1 , we we can can multiply multiply both both sides sides M by2toget4t= @ by 2 to get 4t = 287 I CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES 26. Cross Cross multiply. multiply. 31. n 3(p - h) = 2(p + h) 3(p‐h>=2(p+h) 1 = x 3 h ==22p p ++22h h 3pp-‐ 33h p= = 5Shh Jx + 1 ( Sx2 - 3- 3) 32. a = 5(c+ l) 3-c b2 + 2 5-‑ t=~ P_ 33. Cross multiply. 27. Cross multiply . 2 k(x2 + + 44)) + kkyy = 2 ( 1++2r) 2 r= ) =11- ‐ tt 2(1 2 + 4r 4 r== 11- ‐ tt , = 1-1- 4, x 2+ 7x24‐3 7x 2 3 2 7x2 + 3 2 + 4 + y) = k(x2+4+y)=7x k(x +3 2 2 k_ 7x2+3 k= 7x +3 2 _ 2(x2+4+y) 2(x + 4 + y) 1 28. Square both sides to get (xY)2 = x 2Y = [{] 34. 29. p: p= (x3 - x2)(x5 - .x4) 2 30. m = a 3 a++xx++33 = =b axx++ 3a a ( x++3) 3 )++ (x ( x++ 3) 3 )= = bb a(x ((x+ x + 33)(a ) ( a+ 1l )= ) =b x(X3-- 1)+- 12 X x2 x +1 b x + 3 = -a ++ l1 x n-31 b : x =I b l ‐3 a+ 288 288 THE PANDA THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA CHAPTER EXERCISE: EXERCISE: CHAPTER 1.@] 7. 7. (a + b)3 2. = (- 2) = - 8 [El The The answer obvious just just by @] answer should should be be obvious Cross multiply to get 12 12= + 2x. Then, Cross multiply to get = kx + Then, 12 12 -‐ 2x 2x k: x 8. 8. E ~ Note Note that that lookingat Testing n gives us us:: looking at it. Testing n=0 0 gives 2 0 k=--- 3 (- 6)2 = (‐6)2 = 36 36 2 (0 ( 0- ‐ 4) 4)2 = ((00++ 4) 4)2 which when xx = -‐ 33.. Then Then which happens happens when 2 9. xx2= = ((‐3)2 - 3)2 = 9. (- 4)2 = (4)2 <‐4)2 : (4)2 9 9.0. ‑ 16 == 16 r- We could could also and solve We also expand expand and solve like like so: 50: _ p(( 1(1++i ) " ‐ 11) J= f‘ ( i ) fJi 1= ( ( 1 + 1i)" ) "-‐ 11)) =pp((l Ji fi _ (1 + i)" m i l- 1‐ =Pp (n 4)(nn -‐ 44)) = (n +4)(n (n -‐ 4)( (n + 4)( n + 44)) n2‐8n+16=n2+8n+16 n2 - 8n + 16 = n 2 + 8n + 16 6 n=: 0 -‐ 116n n= =O 0 3.‑ 10. 3. []] 271? 2m ' = aacc b= 11. If : ac, then If bb = then b -‐ ac ac must must equal equal 0. @If " _ - · -=E' 2 l · -=- m m _2 2 Z4 _ 8 8 .x2 5x -‐ 24 be factored factored as as [fil x 2 + 5x 24 = = 00 can can be (x + The two t w o possible possible + 8)(x 8)( x ‐- 3) = 0. The solutions are are then then -‐88 and Since k < 0, solutions and 3. Since k= = -‐ 88aand n d lkl |k| = = 88.. 4 3 , then 3x = : -‐15. 4.. [Q]u 3 3xx -‐ 8 z = -‐ 223, then 3x 15. Multiplying both 0 and and Multiplying both sides sides by by 2,6x 2, 6x = -‐ 330 6x ‐ 7 z ‐37. 6x = - 37. m ·w 12 Cross multiply. multiply. Cross -4 = -38 m Gf = %2 9 12 = 72m y3 : J_1 1 8 32 8 2 8 yy 2==32‑ 1 6 -= m 6.0 3x n n l which means -1 = = -1.. Then, which means Then, m m 4 n l n l 1 1 ac 0 Multiply both sides by get % 4, Multiply both sides by 22 to to get m = 4, . 2 := 1l ~ 5. 5. 0 +1= - y=ti =1 8 3x =-9 X =-3 (x+2)3 : (‐3+2)3 z -‐11 (x + 2) 3 = (- 3 + 2) 3 := (‐1)3 (- 1)3 = 289 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS CHAPTER THE EXERCISES ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES 13.‑ 13.1771 17. I30 ITo make make this this problem problem easier easier to to work work 2\/x 2y'x+4 3 i. with, let A = Then, with, let = 2. Then, 4=6 =6 2 \ / x++ 4 = 118 8 2Jx (if - 2(i) - 15 = 0 (g>2_2<g>_15=0 V + 44 =z 99 Jxx + xX + 44 ==881 1 xX ==777 7 A2‐2A‐15=0 A2 - 2A - 15 = 0 ( A -‐ 55)(A ) ( A++ 3) 3 )== 0 (A 0 A= = 5, -‐33 xX xX .. .. So = -‐ 33.. Solvmg Solvmg these So 8 := 5 or E = these equations equations 14. (E] 14.‑ 6 2 20‐fi=§fi+10 20 - ..rx = Fx+10 3 18. [zJThere w o ways There are are ttwo ways to approach approach this this problem. The problem. The faster faster way way is to factor factor the the 5 102§fi 10= 3../x 3 numerator numerator first. first. e fi 6 =zv'x 3 = Xx 366= 2 xx2_ - 4x+3z4 4x + 3 = 4 x -‐ 1l (x‐3)jJ//1‘)':4 3 )__(,x.----lj =4 Square both both sides sides of the 15. 11] Square the equation. equation. (X - M .x--T 2 x -‐ 3 = : 4 + y)2 = (Jx2 + (x +y)2 = («33 +y2 y2 +16) + 16)2 x= =7 x2+2xy+y2 x2 + 2xy + y2=x2+y2+16 = x 2 + y2+ 16 2xy 2xy = 16 xy = = 88 xy 16. 6 gives x = 30 gives 8 . Since the 30 and and x = -‐ 118. the question question specifies that specifies that x x > 0, the answer answer is 30. The second second way The r i d of the the fraction way is to get get rid fraction by multiplying multiplying both first by both sides 1 and and sides by x x -‐ 1 then then factor factor later. later. 2 - 4x + 3 _ xx2‐4x+3 =4 x -‐ 1 4 x2‐4x+3:4(x‐1) x2 - 4x + 3 = 4 (x - 1) [g Cross both sides. sides. Cross multiply multiply and and expand expand both 4(2x‐ 1 )z ) ( x-‐ 22)) 4(2x - 1) = ((xx ++ 22)(x 8 : xx22 -‐ 44 Bxx- ‐ 44= 0=x2‐8x 0 = x 2 - Bx 0 0= = xx((xx -‐ 88)) x2‐4x+3=4x‐4 x 2 - 4x + 3 = 4x - 4 x2-8x+7=0 x 2 - Bx + 7 = 0 (( Xx -‐ 77))((Xx- ‐ 1 =0 1)) = xX ==00,8 ,8 xX ==77,1 ,1 Neither are false solutions, Neither are set solutions, so so the the solution solution set is is {0,8}. Now, Now, x = solution since since it causes = 1 is a false solution causes division by 0. Therefore, division = 7. Therefore, the the solution solution is x = 290 THE COLLEGE PANDA COLLEGE PANDA calculator question, no calculator a no this is a Because this 19. [}] Because question, can strategy. You can valid strategy. a valid check is a and check guess and guess following: the following: do the also do also 23. II] m2g ‘- µm1g = "128 a= l e g m1+ "12 + m2 m1 x20:4 9) = 8x 8x44 x2 (x4 ‐- 9) a(m1+ ymlg m2g ‐- µm1g = ng a(m1 + m2) = = ‐- yµm1g m2g = a(m1 + m2) ‐- "128 a("11+ m1g x - 9x - 8x = x6‐9x2‐8x4 :00 2 - 8x -‐ 9) = x 2 (x 4 ‐8x2 x2(x4 z 00 6 2 4 ng a(m1 + m2) m2g ‐- a(m1+ m1g m lg x2(x2‐9)(x2+1)=0 x2 (x 2 - 9)(x 2 + 1) = 0 x2(x‐+‐3)(x 0 1) = 0 3)(x 2 + l) x 2 (x + 3)(x ‐- 3)(x2 24. the out, the cancel out, 2's cancel the 2’s Because the [JJBecause same. the same. stays the acceleration stays acceleration equation the equation be 3 for the must be 0, x must Because Because x > 0, true. be true. above to be above _ 2 n g ‐ y(2m1)g = 207123 ‐ umig) 2m1+2m2 20711 + 7712) y values. x and J/ given 20. II] 20‘ C Plug Plug iinn tthe h e 81 ‘venxand values. anew ‑ :=” oaold ld kx 2 + 5 y + 2kx = kx2 23+ = k(3) k(3)22 + 5 2(k) (3) = 23 + 2(k)(3) 2 + 6k 6 k== 99kk+ 5 233+ 25. ‐- 33kk = ‐- 118 8 k =: 6 21. E_x+12 X + 12 X 26. 42 Then side. Then hand side. left hand the left expand the First, expand First, [}QJ combine factor . and factor. terms and like terms combine like 4 2 x=: 66xx ++7722 42x 3 6 x = 7722 36x x= : 2 x6 []J 3(x 3 ( x-‐ 22y) y ) -‐ 33z2 = : 00 3 y --3 2 3z == 0 3xx -‐ 66y 3x 6y+32 + 3z 3x =: 6y xX = = 2y 2y+z +z multiply . Cross multiply. II] Cross 6 = fl ((xx+ + ll ))((xx-‐ 22)) = 77xx -‐ 118 8 2 - x - 2 = 7x - 18 xxz‐x‐2=7x‐18 6 x2‐8x+16:0 x 2 - Bx+ 16 = 0 2 (x‐4)2=0 (x - 4)2 = 0 N o w , =‐ ‐ ‐ == 3. 3 Now, 22.‑ 22. II] Therefore, and Therefore, x = 4 and 7x ‐ 18= 7(4) ‐ 18= 18 = 10. 7x - 18 = c+1 d = a( c~ l) d=“< 24) a C+ l) =a(c~ i§=“(z_4> 1 cC + 11 5 2 : 247 1 2=: cC + + 11 12 l11l = z cC 291 291 CHAPTER CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES EXERCISES IRJ 27. El We can can either answer choices either plug plug in the the answer choices or solve solve algebraically. algebraically. Plugging Plugging in the the answer answer choices choices is more more efficient efficient here, here, but but since since that’s that's self‐explanatory, solve algebraically. algebraically. self-explanatory, let’s let's solve First, both sides. First, square square both sides. is false. A.. For choice B, B, false. We can can eliminate eliminate A For choice 2,/2 = Js, so the value 2\/2 = \/§, so ifif that's that's the value of Jx \/x -‐ 10, then have to equal we plug then x would would have equal 18. If we plug 18 into into the the equation, equation, the the left hand hand side x = 18 side is \/18 10= the right right hand side is is J 18 -‐ 10 = 2\/2 2 ,/2 and and the hand side m‐ /18 - fz=3\f2‐ ,/2 = 3 ,/2 - « ,/25=: 2NE. ,/2 . Sinceboth Since both sides be the the answer. sides match, match, choice choice B must must be answer . (2/x)2 = (x - 3)2 (2\/§)2:(x‐3)2 4x=x2‐6x+9 4x = x 2 - 6x + 9 30. IT] O=x2‐10x+9 0 = x 2 - l0 x + 9 = ((xx ‐- 1l ))(x( x -‐ 99)) 0= xy2+x‐y2‐1=0 xy 2 + X - y2 - 1 = 0 (y2+ 1) - (y2 + 1) = 0 X(y2+1)‐(y2+1)=0 (y2+ 1) (X - 1) = 0 (y2+1)(x‐1):0 X = x = 11,9 ,9 X Since 1 is a a false solution, the the only Since false solution, only value value of x that satisfies satisfies the the equation that equation is 9. Since y2 Since + 11is always positive, equal y2+ is always positive , x must must equal 1. 28. 28.[Il 31. 4 4 _ = xx 22- ‐ 6 6xx++99 _ 44 (x - 3) 2 (Y‐3)2 9 [I] Divide both sides Divide both sides by P and and take take the the tth tth root of both root both sides. sides. V = P((11- ‐ r) : P r)’1 = =99 ~p = (1 -‐r)1 r) 1 g=(x‐3)2 ; = (x - 3) 2 fig: ± '9= / (x- ~= 1- r (x‐3)2 3) 2 ,IV r = l - Vp i§=x‐3 3 2 ±- = x - 3 32. 29. I]] We can can use use the the answer answer choices choices to [I] From the the previous From question, we we know know previous question, _ tthat h a rt r=‐ 11‐- backsolve or we can backsolve can solve solve the the equation equation algebraically. We'll first solve solve it algebraically algebraically. algebraically by squaring squaring both both sides. sides. ,IV i/V zP =‐_12.. $.BecauseVishalfP, V p· Because Vis- half P, p 2 Thus,r:1‐{‘/gz0.l3 = 1 - if"{:=:::: 0.13 Thus , r (✓x - 10 ) 2 = (vx - 12)2 (x/x‐10>2=(f‐\/§)2 (Jx)2 /x)(n /h5 ) + ( /2 fi f -‐ 2( aw x / )2 if x‐ 10= :x -x‐zx/fln x - 10 2../h + 2 xx -‐ 10 1 0= : -‐12=‐2\/fl 12 = - 2./ix 6 = ...fix, 6=\/2_x 3 6=: 22xx 36 1 8== Xx 18 Let's we wanted wanted to test Let’s say we answer test the the answer choices instead . H How choices instead. o w would that? For would we do that? For choice ../6is the the value choice A, if if \/5 \/xx -‐ 10, 10, then then x value of J would have have to equal equal 16. If we we plug z 16 16 would plug x = into the equation, equation, we we get into the get 44 = = 4 -‐ \/2, ,/2, which which 292 292 V 1 THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA Chapter 9: More Equation Strategies Equation Solving Solving Strategies CHAPTER EXERCISE: EXERCISE: 1. I55 I30 30 ((x3 + 1. x3 + + ~§x> ~éxz x2 + x) haven’t assumed that haven't assumed that a and and b are are positive positive here. here . But of the the answer answer choices, choices, only only 6 is aa possible = 3 and and bb = = 22 or possible value value of ab ab (when (when a = when z -‐33 and = -‐ 22). ). when a = and b = = 30x 30x33 + + 5x 5x22 + + 20x. = 20x. Therefore,aa = 30, 30,bb = 5, and z 20. Therefore, and c = + bb ++cc = : 555. 5. a+ 2.. [Qj E] For For an to have an equation equation to have infinitely infinitely many many solutions, sides must must be solutions, both both sides be equivalent. equivalent. 5. 0 Expand both sides of the equation. 3 2 1 -- x - 4 = 4 -2 Comparing sides, ~a ga = ~g Comparing the the terms terms on on both both sides, and 3 = = 9b. Solving Solving these these equations, equations, we we get get and 1 a 4 a= = 4 and Therefore, b 5 = I= 12. and b = 5.. Therefore, 3 ‐ Ex‐ 4‐ ‐ 2x 3 Let’s rearrange the right side that the the terms terms Let's rearrange the right side so so that line left side. side. line up with with the the left 3.. [Qj [E For For an no solutions, solutions, the an equation equation to have have no the coefficients coefficients of the u s t be be the same the x terms terms m must the same on either side but m u s t be be either side but the the constants constants must different. If we different. we expand expand the the right right side, side, we we get get 1 1 -‐ ‐xx -‐ 4 =-: ‐ ‐xx+4 4 2 2 + Now it’s Now easy to see see that that the the it's easy the coefficients coefficients of the x terms terms are same but the constants constants are are are the the same but the different the equation different ( -‐ 4 vs. 4). Therefore, Therefore, the equation a axx-‐ b = = 66xx + 3 Therefore, aa = = 6 and and b f= 742 ‐ 33.. Only Only answer answer Therefore, choice D satisfies satisfies these these conditions. conditions. Choice choice Choice C would result in infinitely many solutions solutions would result infinitely many since both both sides would be beequivalent. since sides would equivalent. has solutions. has no no solutions. 6. 0 = (p (F7 + + q)(P Q)- We 4.. Remember,P2 Remember, p2 -‐ £72 q2 = q)(p -‐ q). We can take can apply apply this this factorization factorization here here once once we we take out aa 2: 18x22 -‐ 8 = 2(9x2 = 2(3x ++ 2)(3x 2)(3x -‐ 2), 2), 18x 2(9x 2 -‐ 4) = which equals 2(ax 2(ax + b)(ax b)(ax -‐ b). b). Comparing Comparing which equals the coefficients, coefficients, a = 3 and and b = : 2. Therefore, Therefore, the ab = : (3) (3)(2) : 6. Note that this factorization (2) = Note that this factorization method assumes assumes that the constants are method that the constants are positive, but that's that’s okay okay since all the the answer answer positive, but since all choices It’s possible that aa = z -‐33 choices are are positive. positive. It's possible that and b = : 2 or a = = 3 and and and b = -‐ 22,, for instance, instance, but but these these are are cases cases that that you you generally generally don't don't need need to worry worry about about for this this factorization. factorization . [QjFor an equation to have no solutions, the coefficients terms must m u s t be be the same coefficients of the the x terms the same on either side but but the constants must must be either side the constants different. First, First, let's let’s expand left side. side. different. expand the the left 3 x+ +3 a x= = 1122-‐ 77xx 3x 3aa-‐ 22ax 3 a-‐ 22ax a x = 112 2 -‐ 1lOx 0x 3a Comparing Comparing the the coefficients coefficients of the the x terms, terms, a= 0 , a = 5. Note Note that is N O T equal -‐ 22a = -‐ 110, that a is NOT equal to 4 since o t for the since the the goal goal is n not the constants constants to be the same.. the same 7. [II Expand the right side. (2x + 3)(ax =12x2 15 3)(ax -‐ 5) = 12x2 + bx -‐ 15 If you this factorization factorization and and you didn’t didn't use use this instead expanded expanded the the right right side, side, you you instead would’ve gotten gotten would've 18x2 ‐ 8 = 2a2x2 ‐ 1 2 1 x 2 xX--‐ 5X x -‐ 44 = ‐ 44 -‐' 5xx 2ax2 10x -‐ 15 = 12x2 2ax 2 + 3ax -‐ lOx 12x2 + bx bx -‐ 15 2ax2 0 ) x -‐ 15 1 5= b x‐- 15 15 2ax 2 + (311 (3a -‐ 1lO)x = 1212 12x2 + bx Comparing 12 and Comparing both both sides, sides, 2a 2a = 12 and b= which yields and = 3a 3a ‐- 10, which yields a =z 6 and b = 33aa -‐ 1100 =: 33(6) ( 6 )-‐ 1100=: 88.. 2172 Comparing the either side, side, Comparing the coefficients coefficients on either 18 = 2a2 18 2a2 and and 8 = 2b2. 2b2 . Solving Solving these these equations equations gives $33 and = ± :l:2. you can can see, see, we we gives a a := ± and b = 2. As As you 293 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS CHAPTER ANSWERS TO THE THE EXERCISES EXERCISES 8. j 49 IExpand Expand the side: the left side: 13. E] @JMultiply Multiply both both sides sides by by xyp. xyp. x2+6xy+9y2=x2+9y2+42 x2 + 6xy + 9y 2 = x2 + 9y 2 + 42 _1 + 1_ : _1 -+-=xx /xl+6xy+9f=xz+9 + 6xy + JI = / + JI +42 + 42 w+w=w x2y2 x2y2= = 49 yp = : X __1E_ p yy -‐ p 9. [fil For an 9. an equation equation to to have have infinitely infinitely many many solutions, both both sides sides must solutions, must beequivalent. be equivalent. First, let’s let's expand First, expand the right side the right side of the the equation: equation: 14. LE] @]Expand Expand the the left side side of the the equation. equation. (x3 + kx2 - 3) (x - 2) (x3+kx2‐3)(x‐2) 6xx =: xx-‐ 66nx 6 nx+ +33xx 6x 6x = 4x -‐ 6nx 6nx = x 4 + kx3 - 3x - 2x3 - 2kx2 + 6 =x4+kx3‐3x‐2x3‐2kx2+6 = x 4 + (k - 2)x 3 - 2kx 2 - 3x + 6 =x4+(k‐2)x3‐2kx2‐3x+6 2x == -‐6nx 2x 6nx Comparing this this to x4 Comparing 18x22 ‐- 3x x 4 + 7x3 7x3 -‐ 18x 3x + + 6, we can see that k - 2 = 77and and ‐- 22kk = wecanseethatk‐ = -‐ 118. 8 . lInn both cases, cases, k = both : 9. Now when we compare compare the N o w when the coefficients coefficients on both sides, we get 2 = both sides, = -‐ 66n, n , which which gives gives 1 2 n:_‐6= n =- 6 =-3·3. [j 15. ~ Multiply Multiply both both sides sides by by (x + + 3)(x 3)(x ‐- 2). We We get Multiply both both sides sides by Multiply by b. b. 5(x 5 ( x-- 22)) ‐- 22(x ( x + 33)) = aaxx -‐ b 5 2 x- ‐ 66 = z aaxx -‐ b 5xx-‐ 1 100- ‐ 2x 3x -‐ 16 ax -‐ b 3x 16 = ax a b abb++aa = aa++5Sb a b = 5 b ab Sb a=5 S 11. [IjMultiply Multiply both sides by by x(x x(x -‐ both sides Comparing the the coefficients coefficients on Comparing on either either side, side, a := 3andb = 16. Therefore, Therefore, 3 and b = a + b ==33++116 6 ==119. 9. a+b 4). 4). ((xx-‐ 4 x ( xx -‐ 44)) 4)) -‐ xx ==x( lNotice ( x -‐ INotice that that x22‐- 11==( x(x++1 l))(x 1 16. j ; -‐44 z=x2 x ‐- 4x 4x 2 o (x -‐ 2) 2)22 0= = (x 4 ( x++ l1)+2(x) + 2 ( x ‐ 1) 1 )=: 335 5 4(x 4 5 4xx++ 44 ++ 2 2xx-‐ 22 ==335 6 5 6xx++ 22 z=335 6 6xx = 3333 We can can see that that x = 2. 0 1 1))o onn right hand hand side. side. It’s the right It's then then easy easy to see see that that we should should multiply we sides by multiply both both sides by ((xx + l ))(x ( x -‐ l1). ). 0 z x2 0= x 2 -‐ 4x 4x + + 44 12. p p YP + xp = xy - xxpp yypp = xxyy ~ yp = x(y y p = X ( l / -~ pp)) 6xy = 42 6xy = xy xy = 77 10. yy Expanding side, Expanding the right right side, 4x2+mx+9 z4x2+4nx+n2 4x2 + mx + 9 = 4x2 + 4nx + n2 xV2 = _ 22 11 Comparing Comparing both both sides, we see see that sides, we that = 4n = 1n122 and and m m = 4n 9 9: Therefore, n = -‐33 and and m = Therefore, = 4(‐3) 2 4( -3) = -‐ 112 m +n = : ‐ -1 12 2 ++((‐- 33)) = ‐- 115 5 m+ 294 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA 17. [[) Expand hand side. Expand the the left left hand side. (2x -‐ b)( 7x + 14x 2 -‐ ex b)(7x + b) = =14x2 cx -‐ 16 16 2 -‐ ex 14x b2 = 14x22 + + 2bx Zinc -‐ 7bx - b2 = 14x 143:2 cx -‐ 16 b2 = 14x 14x 14x22 -‐ Sbx 5bx -‐ b2 14x22 -‐ ex cx -‐ 16 Comparing both can see Comparing both sides, sides, we we can see that that b = =4 (b cannot 0). cannot be be -‐44 because because b > O). 2 Sb 5b = 5(4) = = 20. ec = 18. @] Multiply both by (n -‐ 1l))(( n + lMultiply both sides sides by(n + 1). 1). 3(n 2n (n -‐ 1) (11+ l )( n -‐ 1) 3(n + + 1) 1) + +2n(n 1) = 33(n +1)(n 1) 3n + 3 + 2n 2 - 2n = 3(112 - 1) 3n+3+2n2‐2n =3(n2‐1) 2 2n2+n+3=3n2‐3 2n + n + 3 = 3n 2 - 3 2 00 = - ‐11 = nn2 n- ‐66 00 := ((n +22)) n ‐- 33)( )(n+ n = 33 oorr -‐ 22.. BBecause e c a u s ne n>>0, 0 ,nn== 33.. 295 295 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS CHAPTER ANSWERS TO TO THE THE EXERCISES EXERCISES Chapter 10: Systemsof Chapter Systems of Equations Equations CHAPTER EXERCISE: CHAPTER 1. [fil Substituting 1. Substituting the the the second second equation equation into into the ; 6. 6. first, first, w o lines [I] IfIf the the ttwo lines intersect intersect at at the the point point (2, (2, 8), 8), then solution to system. then (2,8) (2,8 ) is a a solution to the the system. Plugging the Plugging the point point into into the the equation equation of of the the second line, second line, we can can solve solve for for b, b, 3 (1 - 3y) - 5y =- ‐ 111 3(1~3y)‐5y= 1 3 -‐ 99yy -‐ 5Syy = z ‐- 111 1 3 -‐ 114y 3 4 y== ‐- 1111 yy = z ‘- bbx" 8 == ‐b(2) - b(2) 8 ‐- 4 = =b ‐- 114y 4 y == ‐- 1144 l yy = =1 Plugging the Plugging the point point into into the the equation equation of of the the Finally Finally,, x = z 11 -‐ 3(1) = = -‐ 22.. line, first line, [QJFrom 2. E] From the the first equation, = 20 equation, 31 y= 20 -‐ 2x. 2x. Plugging this Plugging this into into the the second second equation, equation, ax + +b b yy = : ax 8 = a(2) a (2) -‐ 4 6xx -‐ 55(20 6 ( 2 0-‐ 22x) x ) = 112 2 1 2=: 22a“ 12 6 6 =: aa 6xx -‐ 1100 lOx 6 0 0+ +1 0 x=: 112 2 16x : 112 16x = x = z 7 7. The two graphs do not intersect at all, so there are there are no no solutions. solutions. We already know Wealready know the at this this the answer answer is is (D) (D) at point , but point, z 20 ‐ 2(7) = 6. but just just in case, case, y = 20 - 2(7) = 6. 3. 0 8. [1]From From the the first first equation, equation , we we can can isolate isolate yy to to get y = -‐ 5Sxx ‐- 2. Substituting get Substituting this this into into the the second equation, second equation , [1]Add Add the w o equations the ttwo equations to to get get 7x -‐ 7y 7x 7y = 35. Dividing both sides sides by by 7, Dividing both 7, 5. We can x ‐- y == 5.We can multiply multiply both both sides sides by by ~1 - 1 to get y x = 5. togety‐x=‐5. 2(2x = 33 -‐ 3(‐5x 2(2x -‐ 1) 1) = 3(- Sx -‐ 2) 2) 4 3 3+ + 15 x ++66 4xx-‐ 22 := 15x 4. ~ The The fastest fastest way way to do do this to this problem problem is is to subtract the the second subtract second equation equation from from the the first, first, which yields x + +y = z 9. 9. which yields 4x ‐- 2 := 15x + +9 11x -‐ 1ll1 = = ll x _1 z x - 1=X [I] In the the first equation, we can m o v e 3x 3x to to equation , we can move Finally, _5( _1) _ 2 = 3. Finally,yy z = - 5( - 1) - 2 = 3. 5. the right right hand the : ‐- 5Sxx + + 8. 8. hand side side to to get get y = Substituting this Substituting into the the second second equation, equation, this into 2((-‐ 55xx + + 8) 8) = ”- 33xx + +2 = z -‐ 33xx ‐- 10x lOx + + 16 16 = : -~13x 13x = x Z x= 9_ 9. [1]Divide Divide the the first first equation equation by by 2 2 to to get get x ‐- 2y := 4. We can’t can't get get the the coefficients coefficients to to match match ((-‐ 2 vs. vs . 2 2 for for the the y’s). y's). Therefore, Therefore, the the system solution.. In system has has one one solution In fact, fact, we we can can even even solve w o equations solve this this system system by by adding adding the the ttwo equations to get y= = O. get 2x = 8, 8, x = 4, 4, which which makes makes y 0. -‘ 110 0 ‐- 110 0 6 -‐ 226 2 2 10. Then, y = ‐5(2) Then,y - 5 (2) + 8 z = ‐- 22.. Finally, Finally, xy = (2)( 2) = 4. xy = <2>(‐2) ‐ 4 . the [I] To get get the the same same coefficients, coefficients, multiply multiply the first equation 10y = equation by ‐2 - 2 to get get ‐- 44xx + + lOy = -‐2a. 2a. Now N o w we a = ‐- 88,, a we can can see see that that ‐- 22a a= = 4. 4. 296 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA 11. 0 the 17. E] ~ Plugging Plugging the the first first equation equation into into the second, second, Multiply equation by Multiply the the first first equation by -3 ‐3 to to get get -‐3ax 3ax -‐ 6y = 15. The = -‐15. The constant constant a cannot cannot be be -‐ 1. equation 's 1. Otherwise, Otherwise, the the second second equation’s coefficients equal to the coefficients would would then then be be equal the first equation's coefficients, equation’s coefficients, resulting resulting in aa system system v'4x m ‐ -( fi(v1x ++ 3 3)) == 33 z fi -‐ fiVX ‐ -33== 33 2/x /x fi ==6 6 x z=336 6 X with with no no solution solution.. 12. @ First, First, multiply multiply the the fust first equation equation by by 33 to to get rid of the fraction: 12x y = 24. Next, get rid the fraction: ‐ = ‐24. Next, substitute substitute the the second second equation equation into into the the fust, first, Therefore, \/3_6 + +3= : 9. Therefore, y = v'36 12x -‐ (4x (4x + 16) 16) = = -‐ 224 4 18. 12x 1 2 x- ‐4x 4 x- ‐ 16 1 6=: -‐ 224 4 medium, and and large large jars, respectively. Based Based medium, jars, respectively. on the information, we can create on the information, we can create the the following following ttwo w o equations equations:: Bx 8 x = -‐ 8 x X == -‐ 1 Finally,y 4(‐1) + 116 6= = 12. y = 4(1) + Finally, 13. 16s=2m+1 = 2m + I 16s 4 s +m m = 1I 4s+ [IQ]We Wecan can isolate isolate x in the the second second equation equation to to Substituting this get get x = = y -‐ 18. Substituting this into into the the first first equation, equation, the weight weight of the the large terms of To get get the large jar jar in terms the weight of the small jar, we need get rid the weight the small we need to to get rid the weight weight of the the medium of m, m, the medium jar jar.. We Wecould could certainly use elimination, but here, we'll certainly use elimination, but here, we’ll use use substitution. Isolating the second substitution. Isolating m m in the second into equation, m equation, m = I -‐ 4s. Substituting Substituting this this into the first first equation, equation, we we get the get y3]= = O.S (y - 18) + 0.5(y‐18) + 114 4 . 5 y-‐ 99 ++114 4 yy ==00.Sy O.5y=5 0.Sy =5 0 y ==110 14. 16s=2(1~4s)+l 16s = 2(/ - 4s) + / Cf]To match coefficients, multiply match the the coefficients, multiply the the 16S=21‐SS+1 16s = 21- 8s + I equation by by 18 18to get 6x 6x -‐ 3y = : 72. We We first equation to get can then can then see see that that aa = = 33 if if the the system system is to have have no solution solution.. no 24s=3l 24s = 31 8 8s5=: 1I E’ Divide Divide the the fust first equation equation by by 3 to to get get 15. [Q] 2y = 5. Divide Divide the the second second equation equation by by -‐22 x -‐ 2y to get get x -‐ 2y 2y = : 5. They're They're the the same, same, so so there there are are an an infinite infinite number number of solutions solutions.. 16. Eight small jars jars are needed to match Eight smaJl are needed match the the weight large jar. weight of one one large E] Since were 30 30 questions, questions, James James must Since there there were must 19. [Q] have z 30. The The points points have had had 30 answers, answers, x + y = he 5x. The The he earned earned from from correct correct answers answers total total 5x. points he lost lost from answers total points he from incorrect incorrect answers total 2y. Therefore, 5x 5x -‐ 2y 231 = 59. Therefore, For aa system system to to have have infinitely infinitely many many Cf]For solutions, solutions, the the equations equations must must essentially essentially be be the same. same. Looking Looking at the the constants, constants, we can can the make them them match match by by multiplying multiplying the the second second make equation by 2. The The equations equations then then look look like like equation this:: this Leta and points you you get get be the the number number points 20. @] Leta and b be for hitting hitting regions A and and B,respectively. regions A B, respectively. From information, we form the the From the the information, we can can form following t w o equations: following two equations : mx -‐ 6y 6y =: 10 mx 10 4x -‐ 2ny = 10 10 4x + 22bb = 118 8 a+ 2 a + b = 2 2a + b 211 N o w it's it’s easy easy to to see see that that m m= z 4 and and 2n Zn = : 6, 6, Now . m_ 4 n =‐ 3. 3. Finally, Finally, ;: n [II Lets, Lets, m, and I be be the the weights ll, m, and weights of sma small, ‐ ;.5. = To solve solve for b, b,multiply first equation equation by by 22 multiply the the first and subtract to get get 3b = 15, 15, b = 5. 5. and subtract 3b = 297 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES 21. [Q]Let r and c be the number of rectangular tables tables and and circular circular tables, tables, respectively, respectively, at at the the restaurant. Based on on the restaurant. Based the information, information, we we can can make make the the following following two t w o equations: equations: 24. II] To find the point(s) where two graphs intersect, solve the the system system consisting their intersect, solve consisting of their equations . In this this problem, problem, that that system system is equations. y=x2‐7x+7 y = x 2 - 7x + 7 : 22xx -‐ 1 y= 4r+ + 88cc ==1144 44 4r rr + +cC ==3300 Substituting the first equation equation into the Substituting the into the second, we get second, get To solve solve for r, multiply multiply the the second second equation equation by 8 and and subtract subtract to get get -‐ 44rr = : -‐ 996, 6 , r = 24. 2 - 7x + 7 = 2x - 1 xx2‐7x+7=2x‐1 22. ~ The The solution solution to the the system system is is the the intersection point of the two lines. intersection point the t w o lines. Each Each 2 - 9x + 8 = 0 xx2~9x+8:0 (x( x ‐ 1l )(x) ( x ‐ 8)= 8 ) = 00 horizontal horizontal step step along along the the grid grid represents represents ~2 of xl e= o1 or r 8 aa unit, and each unit, and each vertical vertical step step along along the the grid grid represents represents 1 unit. unit. So, So, the the intersection intersection point point is 3 at( - ~, - 3). So the the x-coordinates x-coordinates of the the points So points of intersection are and 8. Since intersection are 1 and Since the the question question must be already gave (1, 1), p must already gave us us the the point point (1,1), be “(74> 23. equal to 8. equal [Q]From the second equation, x = 2y. Plugging the first equation, Plugging this this into into the equation, we we get get I 25. 9 or 16 j First, both sides sides of the First, add add 11 to both the second equation to second equation to get get y =: x + 11. Then Then substitu te this this in for y in the the first equation: substitute equation: 2 _ 2= : _1_ (2y)2 (231) _ y2 y 12 12 2 _ 2 == -1_ 4y2 4y - y2 y 12 12 1_ ‐ _1 3y22 = 3 y ' i-12z x 2 - 2x = x + 11 - 1 x2‐2x:x+11‐1 2 - 3x - 10 = 0 xx2‐3x-1ozo ((xx ++ 2 ) ( x- ‐ 5) 5 )= =0 2)(x =-‐ 22or5 x= 0r5 1 y2=l = 36 2 y When +1111 = 99.. W When W h e nxx== -‐ 22,,yy == -‐ 22 + h e nxx == 55,, The so lutions to the the system y := 5 + 11 = 16. The solutions system are then then (‐2,9) (- 2, 9) and and (5,16). (5, 16). Therefore, the are Therefore, the possible values possible values of y are are 9 9 and and 16. 1 yy = ‐ i±-g 6 1 Therefore, Therefore, the the values values of y1 and and y2 y; are are -‐2 and and 6 1 6. 6 298 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA Chapter11: Chapter 11: Inequalities Inequalities CHAPTE R EXERCISE : 1.‑ -‐ xx ‐- 44>>44x x ‐- 114 4 ‐- 55xx > ‐-110 0 x< <2 the answer Of the answer choices, choices, only only -‐11 is is aa solution. solution. 2. El Multiply to get r i d of fractions.. 2. [QJ Multiply both both sides sides by by 44 to get rid of the the fractions 1 3 -Zx‐4>§x‐10 x - 4 > - x - 10 4 2 3xx-‐ 1166 > 22xx -‐ 4400 3 xX >> ‐-224 4 3. 3. The shaded shaded region below the the horizontal : 3, above [g The region falls below horizontal line line 31 y= 3, soy soy < 3. 3. The The shaded shaded region region also also stays stays above y= soy = x, X, SO y > x. X. 4. Let’s say say Jerry's Jerry's estimate, estimate, m, m, is 100 marbles. marbles. [fil Let's 5. 5. [I] Setting Setting up up the the inequality, inequality, If the the actual actual number of marb marbles is within within 10 If number of les is 10 of of that that estimate, estimate, then then the the actual number must m u s t be be at at least least 90 m ‐- 10 5 n S actual number 90 and and at at most most 110. Using Using variables, variables, m 10 ::; 11 ::; + 10. m+ lO. M 2N N M ?. 12P + +100 12P 100 2 ?. ‐- 33PP -++ 970 970 15P 2 15P ?. 870 P ?. 2 58 58 6. [zJ 3 ( n-‐ 22)) > -‐ 44(11 ( n -‐ 99)) 3(11 3 n-‐ 66 >>‐ -44n n ++336 6 3n 7 2 7nn > 442 n>6 Since n11is Since is an integer, the least possible value of of 11 n is 7. an integer, the least possib le value is 7. 7. The shaded shaded region region is is below below the the horizontal horizontal line line y3;= ‐ 3 . Therefore, Therefore, [fil The = 33 but but above above the the horizontal horizontal line line y = = -3. y2 ?. ‐3 - 3and and y 5 ::;3. 3. 8. 8. 16 hours. Since spends on the bus bus is 2 hours he spends spends on the train train is is % [I] The The time time Harry Harry spends on the is ~ hours and and the the time time he on the hours. Since y X 16 8 16 the the total total number number of hours hours is never never greater greater than than 1, z 1. - + + y- S::;1. X 299 299 y CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES 9. 10. [I] U the the distributor distributor contracts If u t to Company u t to for contracts oout Company A A for for xx hours, hours, then then it it contracts contracts oout to Company Company B B for 10 ‐- x hours. 10 Company A then produces 80x cartons and Company B produces 140(10 ‐ x) cartons. hours. Company then produces cartons and Company B produces 140(10 - x ) cartons. Setting up Setting up the the inequality, inequality, 80x + +140(10 1,100 140(10 ‐- x) > 1,100 [El [QJPlug Plug in x = = l,1, y z= 20 to get 15+ > a. 20 into into the the first first inequality inequality to get 20 20 > > 15 + a, a, 55 > a. Do Do the the same same for for the the second second inequality 15 < b. is less 15. The between inequality to get get 20 20 < 55 + b, b, 15 b. 50, So, a a is less than than 5 5 and and b bisis greater greater than than 15. The difference difference between the wo m u s t be m o r e than = 10. 10. Among 12 is is the only one greater than the ttwo must be more than 15 ‐- 5 = Among the the answer answer choices, choices, 12 the only one that that is is greater than 10. 11. E, [QJThe line = ~x 2x + +2 line going going from from the the bottom-left bottom-left to to the the top-right top -right must must be beyy = 2 and and the the line line going going from from the the top-left to the the bottom-right top-left = -‐ 22xx + + 55 (based bottom-right must must be beyy = (based on on the the slopes slopes and and y‐intercepts). y-intercepts). Answer Answer (D) (D) correctly shades shades in the correctly the region : ~2xx + + 22 and and below region above above y = below yy = ‐- 22xx + + 5. 5. 12. [I] One One manicure manicure takes takes 1/3 hour. One One pedicure she 1 /3 of an an hour. pedicure takes takes 11//22 an an hour. hour . The The total total number number of of hours hours she 1 1 spends doing doing manicures spends must be be less 30, so so ~m 3m + + 5pp ~ 5 30. manicures and and pedicures pedicures must less than than or or equal equal to to 30, 30. She She earns earns the manicures manicures and 25m for the pedicures. Altogether, Altogether, 25m and 40p for the the pedicures. 25m + + 40}: 40p 2 2: 900. 900. 13. |E [Q]From From the given -+- 12. Subtracting Subtracting 12 12 5 which given inequality, inequality, x 5 ~ 3k 3k + 12 from from both both sides sides gives gives x x ‐- 12 ~ 3k, 3k, which confirms that that I is always confirms always true. true. From the the given given inequality, inequality, 3k + 12 From 2 k, which means 2k 2 2, k u s t also 12 2: which means 2: -‐ 112, k2 2: ‐- 66,, so so 11 II m must also be be true. true. From the the given given inequality, inequality, k 5 From I“ must ~ x. Subtracting Subtracting k from from both both sides sides gives gives 0 OS ~ x x -‐ k. k. Therefore, Therefore, III must also also be true be true.. First, 14.13~ < x < ?~ ILet’s Let's solve solve these these separately. separately. First, 2 20 ‐30 < -‐ 22xx ++ 4 -3 0 < -‐ 66xx + 1 -‐ 220 122 ‐- 332 2 << -‐ 66xx 16 3 -L" > >xx Now N o w for the the second second part, part, 9 -‐2x 2x + 44 << -‐ ‐ 2 -‐ 44xx + 88 < -‐ 9 7 -‐ 44xx < -‐ 117 >_ x >- x4 17 4 17 16 9 1 17 16 9 10 Putting the the ttwo Putting w o results together, I < x < 3. . Therefore, Therefore, Z < xx -‐ 2 results together, 2 < 30.. 4 4 3 3 15. El [QJIf the the area area is at at least least 300, then 2 300. The The perimeter + 2y, 2y, so then xy xy 2: perimeter of of the the rectangular rectangular garden garden is is 2x 2x + so 2x + 2 70, which + 2y 2y 2: which reduces reduces to x + + y ~2 35. 35. 16. ~ I is nnot always true true because o t always values. Take a = 2 because of negative negative values. a z = ‐5 - 5 and and b b = 2 for for example. example. a a < < b, b, but but a > b2. b2 . II is is definitely definitely true. a I I is It’s the true. It’s It's the the equivalent equivalent of of multiplying multiplying both both sides sides by by 2. 2. IIII is also also true. true. It's the equivalent of multiplying equivalent which necessitates necessitates a multiplying both both sides sides by -‐ 11,, which a sign sign change. change . 300 PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE THE Word Problems Chapter 12: Word Chapter Problems CHAPTER EXERCISE: CHAPTER EXERCISE: y and y of salmon pounds of 2x pounds bought 2x Susie bought [Q]Susie 6. E] 6. salmon and then cost is total cost The total pounds of pounds of trout. trout. The is then the sum 1. [Q] E] The The square square of the sum of x and and y is and y is product of x and The product (x + y)2. The is xy. xy. The The the difference asks for the question question asks difference:: (x + + y) y)22 -‐ xy 77 Sy= (3.50)(2x) = 77 (3.50)(2x) + 5y 213 h ++ Sy w =z 77 w 7x X ==33(X 988-‐ X 9 ( X ‐- 110) 0) 98 _ X = 3X _ 30 98 - X = 3X - 30 plug can plug we can integers, we be integers, must be and y must Since x and Since above to equation above the equation into the choice into answer choice each to each answer value for x. When an integer get an we get see ifif we see integer value When which is ~ 8.14, which example, x z 4, for example, = 4, y= is not n o t an an When 7. When be 7. out to be turns out answer turns integer. The answer integer. The 6. y == 7,x 7,x =: 6. 4X = -‐ 128 -~4X X = 32 32 X = contains alloy contains nickel alloy The 35% nickel 7. ~ The nickel of nickel. 0.7 grams 2(0.35) = = 0.7 grams of nickel. The The x% x°/o nickel vx + 5s = 9 J; nickel. 6 = 0.06x grams ~ ·-6 contains £6 alloy contains alloy grams of nickel. 1 0 flvx = : 4 X x = z 16 16 2= xX + +2 Z 18 18 can the information, 4. 1 s or 10 )Based Based on on the information, we we can Now 4x + equation 4x the equation form the form + lOy = : 60. N o w it's it's Since x and check. Since and check. guess and just just aa matter matter of guess and find we find Jong before be long y are are integers integers,, it won't won’t be before we example, that works. something that something works. For For example, possible solution. one possible = 5, 5,yy = = 4 is one solution. x= 5. 5. formed alloys formed these alloys combined, these When combined, When nickel alloy, a 20% nickel 2+ +6= = 8 grams grams of a alloy, which which nickel. of grams 1.6 = 8(0.20) contain must must contain 8(0.20) = 1.6 grams of nickel. get we get equation, we an equation, up an Setting up Setting ‘ 0.7 + 0.06x = 1.6 0-7 ‘l' 0-06" Z 1-6 0.9 0.06x = 0.06x : 0.9 6x = 2 90 90 xX = Z 15 15 monitor is the monitor width of the The width G!J The is ~x. 331. Since Since the the 8. 8' length the length twice the is twice a rectangle perimeter of a perimeter rectangle is width , the Width, twice the plus plus tw1ce 0 + 5x : 2(x 5) 2(x -_ 5) Sx = 88 + 88 +sx + 5 x=: 22xx ‐- 110 0 i 1 2x+2<§x> + 2 ( X) = 4488 2x 3x = = -‐18 18 3x X 2 2x+gxz48 2x + x = 48 33 x = 48 §x=48 ~x 3 xzw-§=w = 48 · -38 = 18 X 301 301 zw- 6 = CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS CHAPTER ANSWERS TO THE THE EXERCISES 9. I60 IConverting 9. fractions in in Converting 75% and and 85% to fractions the equation the equation below, below, 14. [E equation to figure u t x, [QJMaking Making an an equation figure oout 3xx-‐ 3 z 3 =2211 3 ~(68) = 17 17 n 20 17 17 51=‐ -20 En 51 n 4 3 x= = 224 4 3x x= =8 2 _ 8+1(8)‐12 20) _ 51(fi 51 (~~) ‐ =n n the price 15. I90 IThree Three times times the price of a shirt shirt is 120. Since a tie, which costs 30, is k less less than that, k which costs than that, must 30 = 90. As As an must be be 120 ‐- 30 an equation, equation, 60 = zn 60 10. 10, [z] tie = : 3(shirt) 3(shirt) -‐ kk 4 + NN _1 1 4+ 3 0=: 33(40) ( 4 0 )-‐ k 30 15+ N _ 2 15 + N 3 0= : 1120 2 0-‐ k 30 Cross multiplying, Cross multiplying, k == 990 0 2 ( 4++N) N )== 1 N 2(4 155++ N 8+ 2 N 2NN = 1155++ N N = 77 Let the board be Then its 16. ~ Let the width width of the the board be w. Then length rectangle is its length is 2w. 2w. Since Since the the area area of a a rectangle length times times its width, length width, 11. I48 IThey start start with with the the same same number number x. Once Once gives 16to 16 to Julie, Alice gives with xx -‐ 16 16 Julie, Alice is left with and Julie and Julie then has x + 16. then has (2w)(w) =: 128 (2w)(w) 2 2w2=128 2w = 128 w2=64 w2 = 64 xX ++ 116 6 = 22(x ( x ‐- 116) 6) w=\/6_4=8 W = v64 = 8 xX ++116 6= =22xx ~- 3322 -‐ x == ‐-4488 12. Finally, 2w = = 2(8) = : 16. Finally, the the length length is 2w z=448 8 x X 17. Cf]Let xx be be the the number number of seashells seashells that that Carl Carl 1 has. Bob then has. seashells and has then has has éxx seashells and Alex has math is Cf]The The fraction fraction of students students who who take take math 1 1 11 11 11 11_Z - - -‐ 5_ ‐ -fl.Letxbethetotal - - -5 = . Let x be the tota 1 4 6 8 24 2 Since Alex and ~gxx seashells. seashells. Since and Bob together together number of students. number students. have have 60 seashells, seashells, 11 1l X ‐=33 33 fix 24 1 3 -ixx + + 5x - x ‐=60 60 2 2 z 72 = 72 2x = : 60 2x 60 x X X 13. [Q]Let x be 13. [E Each trade, trade, be the the number number of trades. trades . Each [ a n has Jason has has aa Ian has a a net net gain gain of 1 card card while while Jason n e t loss of 1 card. card. net Carl Carl has has 30 seashells. seashells. 2 = 44 4 4-‐ xX 200++Xx = 2 4 2xx =: 224 x X ==112 2 302 = = 30 30 PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE Mark books. Mark number of books. total number the total be the Let x be 18. J 45 Let J ;x ~x Kevin has and Kevin then has éx books books.. books and has ix books then has so Mark, so than Mark, more than owns 9 more Kevin Kevin owns 1 3 I 21. 40 Jessica runs at a rate of 4 yards per takes for Jessica to time it takes the time second. be the second . Let t be equation an equation make an can make We can overtake overtake Yoona. We and distance Yoona's distance and being Yoona’s with side being the left side with the distance. the right side being Jessica’s distance. being Jessica's right side J 1 4 = 99 - x ‐x -'‐ Ex -3x 3 =44tt 300++ tt = 3 300= 33tt 1 100=s tt by 12, sides by both sides Multiplying Multiplying both 4 : 108 4xx‐- 33xx = catch up to ItIt takes seconds for Jessica to catch takes 10 seconds = 40 runs 4(10) = time, Jessica runs that time, Yoona. In that yards. yards. xX ==1108 08 Mark own books is 108. Mark number of books total number The total ownss 22. 121 ILet the side length of the original patio a length patio has renovated patio Then the renovated s. Then be s. be has a length of an up Setting 5. s + 4 and a width of s s+4andawidthofs‐5. Settingupan patio, renovated patio, the renovated area of the the area equation for the equation we get owns Kevin owns and Kevin i~ x 108 = = 27books 27 books and J . 1 must then Lon must books. Lori x 108 = %x z 36 36 books. then own own 3 books . 108 ‐- 27 ‐- 36 = z 45 books. out given out $5 coupons given number of $5coupons the number [Q]Let 19. [E Let the given $3 coupons given number of $3coupons the number be ixt . Then be Then the and the out is 3x, and out the number number of $1 coupons coupons out is 2(3x) = given out given : 6x. 5)) = 990 ((ss++ 4)(s 4 ) ( s- ‐ 5 0 52‐5‐20=90 s2 - s - 20 = 90 52‐5‐110=0 s2 - s - 110 = 0 ( s-‐ 11 ) ( s++ 10) 1 0 )== 0 ll )(s (s 5(x) + = 360 + 3(3x) ++ 1(6x) = 5x+9x = 360 6x = + 6x 5x + 9x + positive a positive be a must be s must length 5 side length the side Since the original the original means the which means number, number, ss = 11, which 2 sq ft. (11) 2 = = (11)2 was s52= patio was area = 121 sq area of the patio 20x = = 360 x= = 18 18 X then out is then given out coupons given The number The number of $3 coupons 3x = 3(18) = 54. can fill itself can Pipe A by itself 20. j 144 J Pipe 23. rate overall rate the overall done, r is the work done, amount of work the amount the time the is t and done, and being done, work is being at the time which work at which the parking finish the spent. If Terry can can finish parking lot lot in xat spent. Andy can then Andy himself, then days can finish it in 2x days by himself, paves that Terry paves means that This means himself . This days days by himself. ~ of the the tank tank 41-1 1 the of the fill Z,of can fill itself can Pipe B by and Pipe hour , and each hour, each by itself 6 can used together, When used each hour tank each tank hour.. When together, they they can . 1 1 _ 55 fill ‐ 1‐2 of the tank each hour hour.. Now Now tank each + 8~ = fill 7}+ 12 Wisis 1 where W formula W = the formula we = rrt, t , where use the can use we can 5 hour, to find t. per hour, tank per the tank and r = tank and tank : $5 of the 12 i Andy and Andy day and %of each day parking lot each the parking ~ of the X day . the parking _.:!_ paves of the parking lot lot each each day. paves 51; 2x 1 1 X 2X - of the + 7x pave -%+ Working they pave together, they Working together, 5 1 ‐ t 12t 1 == 12 12 12 rater r.. overall rate the overall day . This is the each day. parking parking lot each the The remaining fraction fraction of the the remaining ~ is the number 2 The number g 5 ‐= tt takes Therefore, Therefore, itit takes [II This problem follows the format of a where W is problem, where word problem, = rtrt word standard standard W = This is paved . This be paved. yet to be has yet that has parking parking lot that given bet.t. And must number 9 m the number W. 50 u s t be A n d given So the the be the must what and r, t m u s t be Wand have for W we have what we and Andy take Terry and number Andy to days it will take number of days parking lot the parking remainder of the pave pave the remainder working together . working together. 2 12 pipes to hours for both hours both pipes 5 result to this result Converting this tank. Converting fill the tank. fill the 2 minutes, get m = = 132 ~ x 60 =: 144. minutes, we get 303 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS CHAPTER ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES EXERCISES Chapter13: Chapter Minimum& Maximum MaximumWord Problems Problems 13:Minimum CHAPTEREXERCISE: CHAPTER EXERCISE: 1. Katherine w i l l need (m Katherine will need a total total of 6. [[] Working would Working at the the slowest slowest pace, pace, Jason Jason would take 100 + -;-6 take 6m at the :::::16.67 16.67 hours. hours. Working Working at fastest take 100 100 -;-8 +8= : 12.5 fastest pace, pace, he he would would take hours. answer choice choice between those hours. The The only only answer between those numbers is 16. ttwo w o numbers 28 28 x 4 = z 112 batteries. that there are 6 6 batteries. Given Given that there are batteries in aa pack, batteries she will need pack, she need 18.67 packs. 112 -;-6 + 6 x:::::18.67 that packs. Since it’s it's implied implied that packs only only come packs come in whole whole numbers, numbers, she she round up to 19 packs she needs needs to round packs to ensure ensure she has enough batteries has enough batteries.. 2. 3. 7. [I] Martha needs 16 Martha needs 16‐- 2.5 = 13.5 more more . 13.5 ounces ounces of glue, glue, which which amounts z 7.7 7.7 amounts to g 1. ::::: 75 glue sticks. Since glue glue sticks sticks can glue sticks. can only only be be purchased whole amounts, purchased in whole Martha must must amounts, Martha purchase a a minimum minimum of 8 glue purchase glue sticks. sticks. 6 r11D-<t- 16..ow=teeS" 1 6 m 29612115 29.6.mt:' 1 student student X --X --119.115 9Jf1' xlgunce’ 1 _o.i.mce100 .mt:' IOOmE X ---- 6>-r_ |- x a :::::28.4 students students Since it wouldn't wouldn’t make make sense sense to have have four -tenths of aa student, four-tenths that can can be student, the the most most that be accommodated is 28 accommodated 28 students. students. 0 To get get the the minimum minimum number number of greeting greeting cards the shop could have cards the shop could sold, we assume have sold, assume that the shop sold sold as as many many gift boxes that the shop as boxes as possible (400 gift boxes). possible boxes). Since each each gift box was sold sold for $7, the store was store sold sold 400 x $7 $2,800 $7 = = $2, 800 worth worth of gift boxes boxes in this scenario, which scenario, least which means means the the store store sold sold at least $8,000 $8, 000 -‐ $2, 800 = = $5, 200 worth $2,800 $5,200 worth of greeting greeting cards . Since each cards. each greeting greeting card card was was sold sold for store could could have $5, the store have sold sold a minimum minimum of $5,200-;- $5 = 1,040 greeting cards to meet its goal. goal. 8. @] Giovanni made 0.15 (25)( 12) = $45 during lunch. lunch. If he during tables during during he serves serves x tables dinner, he he will make dinner, make an additional 0.15(45)x an additional 0.15 (45)x dollars. Since the dollars. should be be the total total for the the day day should least $180, $180, at least 45 + 0.15(45)x 2 180 45 + 0.15(45 )x 2:: 0.15(45)x 2135 0.15 (45 )x ~ 135 x X 1,800 the salon salon needs needs at least 1,550 = : 22.5 ➔ ‐> 23 least ~ toolkits. To get get the required required number toolkits. number of nail nail buffers, the buffers, the salon salon needs needs at at least least 4,000 4 , OOO::::: 27 toolkits. toolkits . Based m 26.7 ➔ ‐‐> 27 Based on these these 150 numbers, a minimum numbers, minimum of 27 27 toolkits toolkits must must be be purchased the salon purchased for the salon to receive the receive both both the required number of nail files and the required number of nail number nail buffers. buffers. 0 Two liters is equivalent to 2 x 33.8 = 67.6 ounces, which will fill 67.6 -;- 12 :::::5.63 plastic cups. cups can be cups. Soat So at most, most , 5 plastic plastic cups can be completely completely filled. 304 135 ~ o.15(45) 0.15 (45) x ~2 X 4. I27 J To get required number get the the required number of nail nail files, 5. [m 0 20 TI-IE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA 9. [!!] Leta Let a be be the the number number of fish fish Ashleigh Ashleigh caught caught and and nn be be the the number number of fish Naomi Naomi caught. Using these caught. Using these variables, variables, we can can set set up up aa system system of an an equation equation and and an an inequality: inequality: 11. []] Because Because we're trying to maximize the we’re trying maximize the number of nighttime assume that that nighttime bottles, bottles, we we assume number 65 daytime bottles bottles were 65 only 65daytime only were filled. filled. The 65 daytime bottles 65 x 2 = 130 ounces daytime bottles used used up up 65 130 ounces the active active ingredient ingredient and and 65 of the 65 x 66 = 390 ounces of flavored flavored syrup, syrup, leaving leaving ounces the active active 385 -‐ 130 130 = = 255 ounces ounces of the ounces of ingredient and ingredient and 850 -‐ 390 = 460 460 ounces flavored syrup ounces of flavored syrup.. The The remaining remaining ounces 255 . ingredient . d'1ent are active mgre are enough enoug hf for or ¥ = active : 85 85 a = 33nn-‐ 9 45 aa + n z2:45 The The equation equation allows allows us us to substitute substitute for for a in the the inequality: inequality: 3 aa+r1245 + n 2:45 (3n - 9) + n 2: 45 (3n‐9)‐+‐n245 4n254 2: 54 4n n213.5 n 2: 13.5 nighttime bottles, bottles, and the remaining ounces nighttime and the remaining ounces 460 flavored syrup enough for g of flavored syrup are are enough 5 = 92 = 92 nighttime bottles. bottles. Based Based on nighttime on these these numbers numbers,, we're limited remaining amount amount of we're limited by the the remaining active ingredient, ingredient, so so the the maximum maximum number number of active nighttime bottles nighttime bottles that that can can be be filled is is 85. Since Since it's it’s implied implied that that fish are are caught caught in whole whole numbers, numbers, the the minimum minimum possible possible value value of n is 14. 14. 12. [Q] Let's set set up a a system as the the El Let’s system withs with s as as the the number number of number of short tables and and I as number short tables long tables. tables. long 10. I125 IIf If we we let let b be be the the number number of black black pebbles, pebbles, w w be be the the number number of white white pebbles, pebbles, and and j be be the the number number of jade jade pebbles, pebbles, then then 4 S++ 8/ 8 l ==1168 68 4s j > ~ g and and w < 2b. Since j = 32, 32, the the first s + Il §::;3322 inequality inequality becomes becomes 32 32 > ~, g, which which simplifies simplifies Divide both sides sides of the the equation equation by 4 to get Divide both get to 64 so the 64 > b, b,so the maximum maximum possible possible value value of bb is 63. Using Using b = 63, the the second second inequality inequality becomes becomes w w < 2(63), which which simplifies simplifies to w < < 126. Based Based on this this result, result, the the maximum maximum possible possible value value of w w is 125. 125. Now N o w you you might might be be wondering why we wondering why we used used the the maximum maximum in the second possible possible value value of bbin second inequality. inequality. Since Since w w is less less than than 2b, maximizing maximizing w w means means that we have to maximize that we have maximize b first. 21:= 42. 42. Isolating Isolating I then 21 -‐ ~. 2. s5+ + 21 then gives gives /1= = 21 Substituting this result into into the inequality, we we Substituting this result the inequality, get get s s + 21 - -2 < 32 - :. < 11 2 - s::; 22 Based on this result, the maximum number of Based on this result, the maximum number short used is 22. short tables tables that that can can be be used get at least $140 worth worth of tacos, tacos, a 13. [!!] To To get least $140 customer would have have to receive customer would receive at least least 140 53.8 ➔ ‐> 54 tacos tacos (we (we round round up since since ~m 53.8 ~-!~ m it’s implied tacos are are given given in whole it's implied that that tacos whole numbers only). To receive 54 tacos, numbers only). receive at at least least 54 tacos, the would have have to buy buy at least the customer customer would least 54 = 13.5 ➔ ‐> 14 14burritos (again, we round up up = burritos (again, we round 4 since implied that are sold sold in since it’s it's implied that burritos burritos are whole numbers). Therefore, Therefore, 14 the 14 is the whole numbers). minimum.. minimum 54‐4 305 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES 14. [I] Let a be the number the numbers 16. I54 ILet s, m, and and Il represent represent the numbers of of two-tier cakes and be the number b be number of three-tier cakes Ava three-tier cakes decorates . Using decorates. Using these variables, we we can can set set these variables, up the the following following system up system of inequalities: inequalities: small, medium, medium, and small, boxes shipped, and large large boxes shipped, respectively. Based respectively. Based on on the the information information given, given, 50 ss + m m + II==2 250 2 0 a+ +3 5 b~ § 3360 60 20a 35b s+m lI > >s+ a+b214 a + b 2'.14 Since m = = 70, the the system system becomes becomes Note converted 6 hours 360 Note that that we converted hours to 360 minutes to set set up minutes inequality.. The up the the first inequality The first inequality 4a+ 7b 5 inequality then then simplifies simplifies to 4a + 7b ~ 72. To solve this solve this system, system, we have get the the signs signs have to get pointing in the pointing the same same direction so that we can direction so that we can add the add Remember that the inequalities. inequalities. Remember that inequalities can inequalities can be be added added only only if if their their signs signs point in the the same same direction point (do not not subtract subtract direction (do inequalities; think inequalities; only in terms terms of adding adding think only them) . Soif So if we we multiply multiply the them). the second second inequality by -‐ 44,, we inequality up with the we end end up with the following system system (note following (note the the sign sign change): change) : 80 ss + II ==1 180 0 Il >> ss ++770 IsolatingI Isolating l in the the equation equation gives gives Il = = 180 ‐- 5. s. Substituting this Substituting inequality, we we get get this into into the the inequality, 1 8 0- ‐ss > ss ++7700 180 110>25 110 > 2s 5 >s 555 > Since Since s5is implied to bea whole number, number, the the is implied to be a whole greatest possible greatest possible value value of s5 based on this based on this result is 54. result 4a+7b 4a + 7b S ~ 72 72 -‐ 44aa -‐ 44b bS 6 ~ -‐ 556 17. Adding the Adding 16, the inequalities, inequalities, we we get get 3b 3b 5 ~ 16, which simplifies which 5 5.33. Since Since it's simplifies to b ~ it's implied implied that that Ava decorates whole decorates cakes cakes in whole numbers, numbers, the the maximum maximum possible possible value value of b is 5. This question could’ve also been solved solved question could've also been through guess through guess and and check. check. [zJBased Based on on the the given 11= 10 given information, information, n = 10 and w = and = Bx 8x (8 ounces ounces of water water in each each of the the cups) . To use use these x cups). these values, we first set set up values, we the following the inequality: following inequality: CS ~ 16% 16% 100n < 100n < 116 6 nn + w - 15. [RJ E] For For 11 pound seasoning, Lianne Lianne will will pound of seasoning, need 0.75 pounds need salt and pounds pounds of sea salt and 0.25 pounds black pepper. of black The sea salt pepper. The salt will will cost cost 0.75 x $2 the black pepper $2 = $1.50 and and the black pepper will will cost 0.25 x $8 Altogether, that' that’ss $8 = $2. Altogether, $1.50 + + $2 = = $3.50 for each each pound pound of seasoning . Since Lianne seasoning. can spend more Lianne can spend no more than $210, she than she is limited limited to making making . $210 : 60 Therefore, $ = 60 pounds pounds of seasoning. seasoning . Therefore, 350 ssfso 60 maximum. 60 is the the maximum. 100(10) 10 < 16 100 10 + 8x s- 16 i 8.3 1000 ~ S 16 16(10 8x) 1000 (10 + Bx) 1000 ~ S 160 160 + + 128x 128x 1000 840 S ~ 128x 6.56 5 ~ x X Since the question Since question indicates indicates that that x is aa whole whole number, number, the the minimum minimum possible possible value value of of xx based to note note based on on this this result result is 7. It’s It's important important to that we were thatwe sides by by were able able to to multiply multiply both both sides 10+ sign 10 + 8x Bx without without worrying worrying about about a sign change because 10 10+ 8x is guaranteed be change because + Bx guaranteed to to be positive (x must positive must be be positive positive in the the context context of the problem). problem) . the 306 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA Chapter 14: 14: Lines CHAPTER EXERCISE EXERCISE:: 1. 1. [filA vertical line that vertical line that intersects intersects the the x-axis at 5. 3 has has an an equation equation of xx = z 3. 2.‑ 2. [f] of line/ goes up three units for every ttwo every w o units its units to the the right, right , which which means means its slope is ~. 2 A parallel line must must have have the slope parallel line the same same slope. Only slope. Only answer answer choice choice (C) (C) gives gives an an equation slope. equation of a a line line with with the the same same slope. - y1 z}1 yz‐y1 Y2 xX2z -‐ xX)1 n l 7 1- ‐ 1 3 1 1) =3 n -‐ 1l --= 1 - 5 -(ng 6. B From the graph, we can see that J goes up to the up 11 unit unit for every every 2 units units to the right, right, 6 =3 6 3 1 which which means means its slope slope is ~.. Since g is E n -‐ 11 = 2 perpendicular to J, f, the the slope slope of gg must must be perpendicular be -‐22 (the negative reciprocal). g passes (the negative reciprocal). Since g passes n=3 3. 3. [f] The graph through point (1, we can through the the point ( 1, 2), ~), we can use use 0 Draw the x-intercept to Draw aa line line from the x-intercept of -‐22 to the y‐intercept y-intercept of -‐ 44.. point-slope equation of point -slope form to find the equation of g: yy ‐- yy1 1 ==" m(x 1 ( x-‐ xxi) i) 5 y‐§‐‐2(x‐1) y --=2(x - 1) yll 2 5 2x+2+2 yy == _- 2x+ 2 + -_ 2 9 y‐‐2x+§ y = - 2x + 2 . ‐4 Finally,g (- 1) = - 2(- 1) + 229 = 2 + 4~2l = l 6! 2· A quicker been to work quicker way would've would've been work you can see, it goes units down down for every every As you can see, goes 4 units 4 2 units to the right. The slope slope is is _74 units to right. The ~ = -‐ 22.. backwards backwards from from the the point point (1, ( 1, g), ~), knowing knowing that the slope slope is -‐ 22.. So Soon graph of g, 11 that the on the the graph of g, unit brings us us to unit to the left brings . . 8 ‐ 5 ‐_ 9 ‐_ 4.-Theslopeof1mells 4. 0 The slope of line / is 6‐‐(‐_3) ( ) = ~ = !3.. 9 6- - 3 3 (0,2. = (0,4%>, ( 0, ~ + + 2) 2) = (0,41), and and 11 more more unit unit to to the the Using Using point-slope point‐slope form, form, left brings brings usto +2) = ((‐1,6%). us to ((‐1,4% - 1,41 + 2) = - 1,6D. = m(x x1)) yy -‐ yY1 l =m ( x - 11 1 yy‐8‐§(x~6) - 8 = (x - 6) Therefore, g( g(‐1) Therefore, - 1) = 6.5. 3 7. []] 1 yy = éxx + +66 3 u = fl2 -=0 =i 2_ = _ 1l xz‐xl 0 -‐ 4 5 -‐ 44 2 answer choice choice by At this this point, point, we we test each each answer plugging x-coordinate and and verifying verifying plugging in the x-coordinate the y‐coordinate. Only answer (A) ( A ) works. they-coordinate. Only answer works. 8. 307 [filFrom the graph, slope mis positive and y-intercept mb < 0. y-intercept b is negative. negative . Therefore, Therefore, mb 0. CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES @The = -‐ 22xx -‐ 2 9. [Q] The line line y = 2 has has a a slope slope of of -‐22 and a a y‐intercept and u s t have have a y-intercept of -‐ 22.. Line Line Il m must a slope reciprocal of of -‐ 22,, slope that that is the the negative negative reciprocal 1 which which is 2'. Since Since they they have have the the same same from from the the table. table . Answer Answer A A works works for for Monday Monday (c(7.2) = = 30(7.2) + 400 = = 616) but o t for any 30(7.2) + but n not for any of the days. Answer B works for the other other days. Answer works for Saturday Saturday (c(8.5) (c(8.5) := 60(8.5) 60(8.5) -++ 210 210 = = 720) 720) but but n o t for any not any of the the other other days. days. Answer Answer D does does not value of c for not give give the the correct correct value for any any of the the given given values values of 5. s. Only Only answer answer C C gives gives the the correct value correct value of c for each each of the the given given values values s. These These types of 5. types of questions questions require require you you to be thorough. thorough . Don’t be just test and Don't just test one one case case and choose the choose the first thing thing that that ”works.” "works." You have have evaluate all all the the answer to evaluate answer choices. choices. 2 y-intercept, of line must be be y-intercept, the the equation equation of line Il must yyzix‐Z. = 1 x - 2. 2 10. []] The line we're looking for must have a 1 slope that that is slope is the the negative negative reciprocal reciprocal of of %, , 2 which is ‐- 22.. which 13. [E [Q] A line line with with a a positive ot positive y‐intercept y-intercept will will nnot cross the the y-axis y-axis at at a negative negative point. cross point. Therefore, Therefore , when x is 0, y cannot cannot be when negative, which which be negative, makes (E) makes answer. (E) the the answer. y = ‐2x +b - 2x+b Plugging Plugging in the the point (1,5), point (1,5 ), ~ 5 =: ‐2(1)+ - 2(1) + bb 1.6 or 2 IFirst, First, plug the point 14. 1l.6 plug the point (2,6) (2, 6) into into the the 7=b equation of the the line line so so that that we equation we can can solve solve for a: a: Now that that we we have have b, the Now + 7. the line line is y = -‐ 22xx + 7. 1 a(2) a(2)‐§(6)=8 - (6) = 8 3 @ 11. [Q] 2 a- ‐ 22 =z 8 2a 10 -4 _2 2 10‐4 = 3x ‐- l 1 _ 3 2 0 2aa =110 a=5 6 _z 2 6 x -1 ‐ l ‐ 33 X So the the equation equation of the So the line line is 5x -‐ Cross multiplying, Cross multiplying, which which gives gives x = g ~ == 1.6. 2 x-‐ 22 ==118 8 2x 2 0 2xx = 220 12. 8. 8. The x-intercept x-intercept always The y-coordinate of of always has has aa y-coordinate 0, so if we we plug 0,soif we get get 5x = 8, plug in Ofor y, we 5x = 8, 2 ( x-‐ 11)) = 118 8 2(x x X 1 all z 3y = 15. ==110 0 [1JOne One easy easy way way to approach approach this this problem problem is is make up up numbers to make numbers for a and and b. b. Let Let a = 1 and b = 2 so and that ~g = ;%.. Since so that Since the the second second line line [SJWe can can use t w o days days use the the values values from from any any two find the the line line that best models to find that best Let’s models the the data. data. Let's use the the values values from from Monday use Monday and and Thursday Thursday to 616 -‐ 584 . calculate the the slope: slope: ---calculate = 80. At this this = 7.2 -‐ 6.8 point, we can tell point, we can tell the the answer answer is probably probably going to be be choice choice C, but going find the but let’s let's find the y-intercept just y-intercept just to be be sure. sure. Currently, we have have Currently, we 80s + c= z 805 -+- b. Plugging = 7.2 and = 616 Plugging in inss = and c c= from Monday, Monday, we from : 80(7.2) ‐+‐ b, we get get 616 = 80(7.2) + which gives gives 1)z which b = 616 ‐- 80(7.2) 80(7.2) = 40. Therefore, c(s) c(s) = 80s 805 + + 40. Therefore, d perpendicular to the is perpendicular the first, first, C;= - = -‐ 22,, which which e satisfies the the condition satisfies condition in answer answer choice choice (A). An alternative alternative solution solution is to test test each each of the the answer choices choices by answer in the the values values by plugging plugging in 308 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA Chapter15:Interpreting LinearModels CHAPTEREXERCISE: 1. [I] means the decreases by 33 feet each each day. E The The slope slope is -‐ 33,, which which means the water water level level decreases E The value value 18 18refers refers to the the slope slope of -‐ 18, which which means loaves remaining 18 means the number number of loaves remaining decreases decreases by 18 2. []] each bakery sells loaves each each hour. hour . each hour. hour. This implies implies that that the the bakery sells 18 18loaves 3. [g They -intercept of 500 means that when n = 0 (when there were no videos on the site), there were 500 members. members. 4. @ The number 2 refers to the slope of - 2, which means two fewer teaspoons of sugar should be added (C) and which for every Don 't be fooled by answers answers (C) every teaspoon teaspoon of honey honey already already in the the beverage. beverage. Don’t be fooled and (D), which (hands, slope is always always the change in y for each "reverse" ”reverse” the x and and they the y (I: and s, in this this case). case). The slope the change each unit unit increase increase in x, not n o t the other other way way around. around. 5. [I] The salesperson earns a commission, but on what? The amount of money he or she brings in. To get that average price that,, we we must m u s t multiply multiply the the number number of cars cars sold sold by by the average price of of each each car. Since xx and and c6 already already represent cars sold, respectively, the represent the commission commission rate rate and and the the number number of cars sold, respectively, the number number 2,000 must must represent represent the the average average price price of each each car. 6. [) The number 2,000 refers to the slope, which means a town 's estimated population increases by 2,000 for each each additional additional school school in the the town town.. 7. [I] 8. [fil When t = 9. [I] The number 4 refers to the slope of - 4, which means an increase of 1° C decreases the number of words, the the milk hours faster. hours hours until until aa gallon gallon of milk milk goes goes sour sour by 4. In other other words, milk goes goes sour sour 4 hours 0, ther e is no time left in the auction. The auction has finished. Therefore, the 900 is the auction price price of the the lamp. lamp. final auction Because it's the slope, the 1.30 can be thought of as the exchange rate, converting U.S. dollars into euros. But after after the conversion, 1.50 is subtracted subtracted away, which means means you you get get 1.50 euros you euros. away, which euros less than than you the conversion, should have have.. Therefore, Therefore, the best interpretation interpretation of the y-intercept is a e u r o fee the the bank bank charges charges should the best the 1.50 y-intercept a 1.50 euro to do the conversion. conversion. . . ~ 22 99 see the answer answer more more clearly, clearly, we we can can put the equation equation mto mtoy = = mx mx+ form: tt == 5xx + 5 . The The slope slope 10. L:.!JTo see put the + bb form: . To 5 5 2 is ~, 5, or 0.4, which which means means the the load load time time increases increases by 0.4 seconds each image image on the the web web page. page. seconds for each The slope slope is is the the change change in y (daily (daily profit) profit) for each (cakes sold). 11. @ The each unit unit change change in xx (cakes sold). Notice that the y-intercept negative. It is when no no cakes Therefore, is the the bakery’s bakery 's profit profit when cakes are are sold. sold. Therefore, 12. [) Notice that they -intercept is negative. anything that that varies varies with with the the number number of cakes cakes sold sold is incorrect. example, answer answer (D) is wrong anything incorrect. For example, wrong because because the cost of the cakes cakes that that didn didn't depends on on how many It’s n o t aa fixed number number ' t sell depends how man y the the bakery bakery did did sell. It's not like they the y-intercept The best best interpretation interpretation of the the cost of running running the the bakery bakery (rent (rent,, like -intercept is. The theyy‐intercept -intercept is the labor, machinery,, etc.), which which is likely likely aa fixed number number.. labor, machinery 13. The solution solution (5,0) (5,0) means means that that the the bakery's bakery's daily zero when when 5 cakes are are sold. sold. [J) The daily profit profit is zero Therefore,, Therefore selling five cakes cakes is enough enough to break break-even with daily selling -even with daily expenses. expenses. slope of the equation equation is 5, which which means means the temperature goes up by 5 degrees degrees every every hour hour.. So 50 the temperature goes up 14. I2.s j The slope every half half hour minutes), the the temperature goes up = 2.5 degrees. every hour (30 minutes), temperature goes up by 0.5 x 5 = degrees. 309 309 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES . . . 1 1x mx 1 15. [E [[I Putting Putting the the equation equation m t o y = mx + + b form, form, y = 5x + one more more turtle into + 7. The The slope slope of % means means that that one turtle requires additional half requires an an additional half aa gallon gallon of water water.. So SoIll 11] is true. true . Getting x in terms terms of y, x = 2y Getting The "slope” water can can support support ttwo wo 2y ‐- 14. The "slope " of 2 2 means means that that 11 more more gallon gallon of of water more turtles. turtles. SoI more So I is true. true. 16. CgBecause Because this this question question is asking asking for the the change change in "x" ” x ” per y ” (the reverse of slope), we per change change in ”"y" (the reverse of slope), we need need the equation equation to get x in terms to rearrange rearrange the C. terms of C. C = 1.5 + + 2.53: 2.Sx Dividing each Dividing each element element in the the equation by 2.5, equation by : 0.6 + x 0.4C = = 0.4C -‐ 0.6 x = The slope slope here here is 0.4, which means the The which means the weight weight of aa shipment shipment increases increases by 0.4 pounds pounds per per dollar dollar increase increase in the the mailing a 10 increase in the mailing cost is equivalent equivalent to a mailing cost. cost. So 50 a 10 dollar dollar increase the mailing a weight weight increase increase of 10 pounds. 10 x 0.4 = : 4 pounds. 310 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA Chapter Chapter 16: 16: Functions CHAPTER EXERCISE: CHAPTER EXERCISE: l.1. [Q] FE] Check Check each each answer answer choice choice to see see whether whether 10. J (O) == 20,J f(0) 20,f(1) and /f(3) The only only (l ) = 21, and (3) == 29. The function that that satisfies satisfies all three function three is (D). (D). 2. [Q]J @f(x) t w o graphs graphs (x) := g(x) g (x) when when the two intersect. They intersect intersect. intersect at 3 points, so there points, so there must be be 3 values must values of x where x ) = g(x). where Jf ((x) conditions . conditions. 11. lg(2) [I)g( 2) =: 22 22 -‐ 11= = 3. 113.So, So, 2+1= ff(g(2)) (g(2)) = J (3) = 3 = f(3) = 32+1 2 110. 0. (3) = -‐ 22.. N 3. @ Jf(3) o w where ? Now where else else is ffatat -‐ 22? When x = When z ‐- 33.. Soa be -‐ 33.. So a must must be 4. 12. ~ B The The difference difference between 2x22 -‐ 2 and between 2x and 2x + + 4 is a constant In other constant of 6. 1n other words, 6 needs to be needs = 2x 2x22 -‐ 2 to get be added added on to y = 2 y= 2x + : 2x2 + 4. entails a translation translation 6 units units 4. That That entails upward. upward. [I] Draw Draw aa horizontal at y = 3. 3. This line horizontal line at line intersects intersects J[ ((x) x ) four times, there are four times, so there are four solutions (four values values of x for which solutions (four which J (x ) = f(X) = 33). )‑ 5. @ The x‐intercepts x-intercepts of ‐3 - 3 and and 2 mean mean that that fJ((x x ) must and (x -‐ 2). 2). must have have factors of (x + 3) and That A y-intercept y‐intercept of That eliminates eliminates (C) and and (D). A when we plug = 0, 12 means means that that when plug in x = x) = answer (B) meets Jf ((x) = 12. Only Only answer meets all these these [g Plug Plug in -‐33 and and 3 into into each each of the answer answer 13. whether you choices to see whether you get get the same the same value. you're smart smart about about it, realize value. If If you’re it, you'll you’ll realize 2 , which always that answer answer (C) has has an an xx2, that always gives gives a positive positive value a value.. Testing Testing (C) (C) out, out, 3(‐3)2 +11 = 28 and Jf ((-‐ 33)) = 3(3)2 + 28 and 2 = 3(3) 3(3)2 + +11 = = 28. The answer indeed ff(3) (3) = answer is indeed [I) Draw Draw a a horizontal z c, horizontal line line at at y = C, passing passing through (0, c). This horizontal horizontal line through line intersects intersects with f three times. That with three times. That means means there there are are 3 values values of x for which x) = = c. which Jf ((x) 14. 14.@ (C). (C)- g(k) = 8 8 g( k) = 6. @] First, g(10) = 6.-First,g(10) = f(20) o w, f (20) -‐ l.1.N Now, f(20) Finally, f (20) = 3(20) + 2 = 62. Finally, g(10) = 62 62‐- 11 = 61. _ 22 iol 16 + (- 4) 32 7. ‐ 44))=: 16‐2%4)i : 3‐1 2 7. .~ f (J (2(- 4) = - 8 = 8. Lookingat only when when Looking at the chart, chart, fJ (x) z = 44 only x= =3.3. So Sokk = 3. -4 4.. 15. [I] We plug plug in values values to solve solve for a and and b. lg] g(x) constant of 7 to [Q]Since g( x) just adds adds a constant every the maximum every value value of f(x), J (x), the maximum of g(x) must occur occur at the same must x-value as same x-value as the maximum maximum of f(x), J (x), namely namely x = 3. So, the maximum reached at the point point maximum of g(x) is reached at the (3,g(3)), since g(x) : Jf(x) 7, this this (3,g (3)), and and since g (x ) = (x) + 7, point is is (3,f(3) (3,/ (3) + point + 7). Plugging in (0, (O, -‐ 22), ) , -‐22 = : a(0)2 + b = : b. So, Plugging b = -‐ 22.. Plugging Plugging in (1,3), (1, 3), a(1)2+ 3 = “(1)2 +b 3= z a -‐ 2 = a 5= 16. .0 f ( J1(18) 8 ) =: \/18 = v'16 \/1‐ = z 4. 4. ✓18 ‐- 2 = = /f(11) (11) = So a = 55 and Soa x) = : 5x 5x22 -‐ 2. Finally, Finally, and Jf ((x) \/11‐ /If=2 = \/§ 3. = J9 == 3. = 4 -‐ 3 = Testingeach ff(18) (18) ‐- ff(11) (11) = = 1. Testing each [J((3) 3 ) == 5(3)2 ‐ 22 == 43. 5(3)2 - 9. 0 2f(k) =8 2f (k) = 8 flJ (k) k) = Z 44 J answer also answer choice, choice, f (3) is the only one one that that also equals 1. equals l. Plug in the and check. check. Plug the answer answer choices choices and 1 1 2 1 . . 1 f(§) _ (5) ‐ z,whlchlslessthan 2' J (1)= (1) = ~,which is less than 1 2 The answer (A). answer is (A). 311 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS TO IBE EXERCISES 17. ~ factor g, I If If we we factor 3, we we get get 2 + 4x + 4 = (x + 2) 2 . Since g(x) is g(x) = x g(x )= x + 4 x + 4 ‐_ (x+2)2. Sinceg(x) is f (x)) shifted shifted k units units to the the left, 25. [[I each of the the answer answer choices When E Test each choices.. When x == -‐ 33,, Jf (x) = -‐22 according according to its graph , its graph, g(x) = ((-‐ 3 ++3)(‐‐3 3)( - 3 -‐ 1) 0.Inthis and g(x) 1) = 0. In this case , greater than than g(x). g(x ). When case, f ((x x ) is not n o t greater When and x == -‐ 22,, Jf ((x) x) ~ z 1.5 and g(x) =: ((-‐ 2 + 3 3)( this case, g(x) ) (-‐ 2 -‐ 1) 1) = z -‐ 33.. Ilnn this case, fJ((x) x ) >> g(x) so so we have have oour u r answer answer.. g(x) +kk)) g ( x )== J(x f(x+ (x+2)2=(x+k‐3)2 (x + 2)2 = (x + k - 3)2 + 22 =: xx + x+ + k -‐ 3 2= = k -‐ 3 5=k 26. the value value of x that that makes makes the the substituted the substituted equal to O. 0. This value tells tells you you expression equal expression This value what the horizontal horizontal shift For choice what the shift is. For choice A, Alternatively, this Alternatively, we we could've could’ve solved solved this and g(x) que stion by comparing question comparing J(x) flat) and g(x) to to 2 . The y= offfJ((x) - 3) 3 : xx2. The graph graph o x ) == (x ( x~ 3)22 is i s3 2, and units units to the the right right of y = : xx2, and the the graph graph of 2. g( x) = (x + the left g(x) + 2) 2)22 is is 2 unHs units to to the left of y = xx2. Therefore, the left left of J( x ). Therefore, g(x) g(x) is 5 unit unitss to the f (x) 2 = 5 makes makes 3x -‐ 2 equal equal to 0, so so the x= the 3 horizontal units to the right. For For horizontal shift shift is ~g units the right. 2 2 that value the shift shift is g choice B, that choice value is -‐ g,, so so the 3 the expres sion 2x -‐ 33 equal the shift the expression equal to 0, so so the shift is 3 ~5 units units to the the right. This is the answer . For right. This the answer. For [Qj @ g( g(aa) = 6 choice D, the the shift shift is ~3 units units to the the left. left. choice v13a =6 36 3a = 36 27. [Q] The key are "linear ": f is [E The key words words are ”linear function function": is a what straight line can a straight straight line. line. So So for what straight line can both f(4) 2 /f(5) be true? both f(2) / (2) 5 '.Sf[(3) (3) and and J( 4) 2: (5) be true? Only Take aa minute Only a a horizontal horizontal straight straight line. line . Take minute to think since f is a flat think that that through. through . Now, Now , since a flat line 10, then all values values of are 10, 10, line and and f/ (6) (6) = 10, then all offf are no matter value of x is. Therefore, no matter what what the the value Therefore, f mO)) = : 110. a f( 12 a = 12 E] Using the tabl table, g(‐1) : 2. Then, Then, 20. [Q] Using the e, g( - 1) = /( 2) == 66. f (2) 21 21. 3 units left. For For choice units to the the left. choice C, x = ~3 makes makes 18. [Q] 2) cannot E) (1, (1,2) cannot be be on on the the graph graph of y since since an an x-value of 1 would result in division by 0. x-value would result division 0. 19. [g For For horizontal horizontal shifts, the trick trick is to find shifts, the is to find []Ju g(c) = 5, then then c = since 1 is the the only only 1 since input that gives an an output 5. Then, Then, input that gives output of 5. f(c) f(C) == fJ( (l1 )) == 33.‑ 28. Remember that 8JRemember that you you can can use use your your calculator for graphing graphing.. The The graph graph of calculator for x ) = xx33 is ”centered" (0,0). Jf ((x) "centered" at at (0,0 ). The The graph graph of g(x) is ”centered” at (3, (3, -‐2). Comparing g(x) is "centered" at 2). Comparing these see that that g(x) g(x) these points points of reference, reference, we we can can see is shifted shifted 3 units to the and 22 units units units to the right right and downward downward from from [(x). J(x) . Therefore, Therefore, g(x) : J(x f ( x -‐ 3) -‐ 2, 2,which = -‐33 g(x) = which means means a = From the the second second equation, = 20. So, So, 22.. []] From equation , f (a) = f(a) a+ + 55 J( a) = -‐ 33a 20 == -‐3a 20 3a + 5 3a == -‐15 3a 15 a =z -‐ 5 and um a + +b The ssum bisis then then and b = -‐ 22.. The = -‐ 55.. -‐ 33 + + ((-‐ 22)) = .f-)g( : 3=) /( 2(3) 2 ( : 3- )1) ‐ 1=) /( f(5)=2.Weget 23. 8]g( (3) 5) = 2. We get from the the table. table. f (5) =‐2 2 from f@)f(8) = 4(8) -‐ 33= Testing each each 24. [Q] J (8) = = 29. Testing answer choice choice to see see which which one one yields yields 29, we answer that g(8) 3(8) = 3(8) + 5 = 29. see that see 312 PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE THE 9. they-intercept When x = 29. @ When = 0, y = = 9, 9, so so the y-intercept is 9. 3. is x-intercept the x-intercept so the 0, x = 3, so When y = O,x When 31. slope of with aa slope line with a line function g(x) is a The function [g The draw g(x) If you a y-intercept and a l1 and y-intercept of k. If you draw g(x) with with the from k for possibilities different the the different possibilities from the an there's an that there’s see that you'll see choices, you’ll answer answer choices, when only when with J(x) points with intersection f (x) only intersection of 3 points below . shown below. as shown k = 1 as y A y and 3 and base of 3 a base with a triangle with right triangle a right AAOB 6 AOB is a theorem a pythagorean theorem,, the pythagorean Using the height of 9. Using a height A W2 0Bfi2z=AAB +o A0d2 + ¢ A §2 + 3§2 == AB 92 + s =zABfi2 90 3 ¢ E =: AAB B 3v'10 30. 32. ( - a, a), Plugging in (‐a,a), [I]Plugging a= (‐a + l12 2 a)) + = aa(- where J units up f from where up from graph of g is 4 units The graph [g The a: - a 2 + 12 a = ‐a2+12 a2+a‐12=0 a2 + a - 12 = 0 and the x and slope off the slope is, because the of f is -‐ 22,, the but because is, but y intercepts will not increase by by the the same same not increase intercepts of g will So a ratio amount. increase in a ratio of 2:1. 50 They'll increase amount. They’ll the 4, the up by 4, shifted up when the gets shifted -in tercept gets theyy-intercept when x-intercept gets the right right by by 2. The The shifted to the gets shifted x-intercept n e w x-intercept x-intencept is therefore therefore 1I + 2 = 3. new solve for Another actually solve this is to actually do this way to do Another way form, -intercept form, the slope-intercept Using slope x-in tercept. Using the x-intercept. we get f(x) = ‐ 2 x + 2.Adding 4 to get the the get to 4 Adding 2. 2x J(x) get we equation of g, g(x) ‐ 2 x + 6. Setting Setting 6. + 2x = g(x) equation the g(x) = 00 and and solving solving for x to get get the g(x) x-intercept, get x = z 3. we get x-intercept, we ((a+ a + 44)(a ) ( a-~ 3 3)) == 0 a= ,3 = ‐-44,3 S i n c ea a>>0, 0 ,aa= = 33.. Since 313 ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS CHAPTER EXERCISES Quadratics 17:Quadratics Chapter17: Chapter CHAPTER EXERCISE: CHAPTER 1. x-intercepts. the x-intercepts. [g We factor factor to find the 6. vertex. Since m is occurs at its vertex. always occurs always a upwards in a opens upwards positive, parabola opens the parabola positive, the with dealing we're means which shape, ”"U" U ” shape, which means we're dealing with Since vertex . Since its vertex. at its minimum at the parabola 's minimum the parabola's expanding vertex form form of a vertex us a gives us expanding f gives f(x) 1]= ( x-‐ m)2 ‐- mm,, m(x =m m [(x - m)2 - 1] J (x) = m[(x‐m)2‐ the Therefore, the vertex is at (m, ‐- m). Therefore, the vertex the m). occurs at (m, ‐- m parabola’s ). minimum occurs parabola 's minimum 3x - 10 = (x - 5) (x + 2 ) y= y=x2‐3x‐10=(x‐5)(x+2) x2 - distance The distance and ‐- 22.. The are 5 and x-intercepts are The x-intercepts The them is 5 ‐- ((-‐ 22)) = between them between = 7. formula, quadratic formula, 2. [}] Using Using the the quadratic X = ✓ (4 ) 2 - 4(1)( 2) -‐ 44 fl±: ./(4)?‐4(1)(2) 2 (1) 2(1) _ = _ v'8 -‐ 44±i \/§ the into the equation into the first equation 7. Substituting the 7. [}] Substituting second, second, 22 _‐4:t2\/§ _#- 4 ± 2v12 ‐3 ex +cx x2 + - 3==x2 2 :=-‐ 22i ± \ / ..fi §. 2 0 + at + 33 x +ex+ 0 = x2 will have equations will The have ttwo wo system of equations The system two has above equation above has t w o the equation solutions if the solutions if have ttwo above to have equation above the equation For the solutions. For solutions. wo be must be 4ae, must b2 - 4ac, discriminant, b2‐ the discriminant, solutions, the solutions, positive. positive. 3 .‑ 3. []] 2a2‐7a+3:0 2a2 - 7a + 3 = 0 ((2a 2 a- ‐l1)(a )(a 0 - ‐3)3 )=: 0 c2‐ 0 e2 - 4(1)(3) > o remember this , remember factoring this, trouble factoring had trouble you had If you quadratic the quadratic use the always use can always you can that you that c2 0 12 > o e2 -‐ 12 1 . 0.5. = g,, or 0.5. 1, a = < 1,a Smee a < formula. formula. Since 2 > 12 > 12 cC2 2 4. 4. Expanding everything, [iJExpandingeverything, choices, only answer choices, the answer each of the Testing only Testing each than 12 bigger than value bigger gives a value (A), ‐- 44,, gives answer (A), answer when squared. when squared. (2x‐3)2 +5 (2x - 3)2 = 44xx + 4x2‐12x+9=4x+5 4x2 - 12x + 9 = 4x + 5 4x2-16x+4:o 4x 2 - 16x + 4 = 0 treat the points , treat intersection points, the intersection 8. @ To find the equations. system of equations. as a system equations asa ttwo w o equations second , the second, into the equation into the first equation Substituting the Substituting - 16 b . . b - - 4- = = ‐T is - z solutions IS_E the solutions sum of the The : 4. The sum 4:(x+2)2‐5 4 = (x + 2) 2 - 5 = (x + 2) 2 99=(x+2)2 a 5. 5. parabola a parabola maximum of a minimum or maximum The minimum []JThe get side to get left side the left the 8 to the Move the lg!Move i±S3 = x + 2 xX :=‐ -5 5,, 1 the either use can either we can Now, l0x -‐ 8 = 0. N + 10x 3x + o w, we use the this case, formula or factor quadratic formula quadratic factor.. In this case, we'll we’ll =0 factoring: (x + with go w i t h factoring: + 4)(3x ‐- 2) = points intersection points the intersection y-coordinates of the The y‐coordinates The the ttwo so the equation), so the first equation), (from the be 4 (from must be must wo (1, 4). and (1,4). (- 5, 4) and are (‐5,4) intersection are points of intersection points b, b must be ~ . Since a > b,bmustbe orr xx == §.Smcea S o ,xx== -‐ 44 o So, = 16. ( - 4) 2 = = (‐4)2 b2 = and 172 ‐4 - 4 and 314 PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE THE 9. the (3, -‐ 88), vertex is at (3, the vertex Because the [g Because ) , the 14. the Because the (C). Because (A) or (C). either (A) must be either answer must answer use can use we can (1,0 ), we through (1,0), passes through parabola passes parabola potential our test oout to test point to that point that ut o u r ttwo w o potential (C), we = x in plug we When answers. answers. When plug = l1 into into (C), (C). answer is (C). the answer that the 0, confirming that get y = 0,confirming get 0 the into the equation into Substitute the first equation Substitute the second, second, - 3 = ax2 + 4x - 4 ‐3=ax2+4x‐4 0=ax2+4x‐1 0 = ax2 + 4x - 1 the solution, the real solution, one real have one For the system to have the system real one only have should above equation equation above should have only one real discriminant, the discriminant, words, the other words, solution . In other solution. equal 0. must equal b2 - 4ac, must b2‐ t(S -‐ t), t2 = v = St equation 0 the equation 10. ) 2.5 ) From From the 5t -‐ t2 : t(5 Oand are 0 the t-intercepts that the can see we can we see that t-intercepts are and 5. 5. occurs at the maximum occurs the maximum Because the Because the vertex, vertex, average of the the average t-coordinate is the whose t-coordinate whose the two two maximum the in results 2.5 = t t-intercepts, t-intercepts, t = results the maximum graphing by graphing this by confirm this can confirm v. You can value of 1). value calculator . your calculator. on your the equation on the equation 2 0 4 (a)( - 1) = (4) (4)2 -‐4(a)(‐1) =0 1 6++ 4a 4 a== 00 16 4 6 4aa== ‐- 116 I number of minimum number the minimum 11. ) 400 To find the that it so that must company m the company mattresses the mattresses u s t sell sell so money, set lose money, doesn't lose doesn’t set P = = 0. a= = ‐- 4 15. m2 120,000 = = 0o m2 -‐ 100m -‐ 120,000 Since value of J minimum value the minimum results f (x). Since results in the opens that parabola a offf is aparabola that opens the graph of the graph offf minimum of the minimum shape, the a ”"U" upwards U ” shape, upwards in a located at which is located the vertex, occurs vertex, which occurs at the xx =_-_baE=_- _- (24it) = 12. 12. Therefore, Therefore, the the 2 1 2 2a 2(l) units each produce 12 should produce manufacturer 12 units each manufacturer should unit. per unit. cost per the cost minimize the week week to minimize (m -‐400)(m + 300) = 00 400)( m +300) m= = ‐300,400 - 300,400 number of the number sense for the make sense doesn't make Since it doesn’t Since negative , m = sold to be negative, mattresses : 400. If If mattresses sold above equation above the equation factoring the trouble factoring had trouble you had you and calculator and your calculator on your tough), graphing (it's tough), (it’s graphing on good both good are both quadratic formula the formula are the quadratic alternatives.. alternatives 12. that value of x that the value looking for the We're looking [ill We're 02] are x-intercepts, x-intercepts , bare and x = b 0 and Since xx = O 16. El Since and Oat f (x), the at x = 0 and speed, is 0 transfer speed, data transfer the data transfer x= : b. First, would the data transfer the data why would First, why transfer is the file transfer O? Well, the at x = Oat be 0 speed : 0? speed be just starting so no megabytes have been just starting so no megabytes have been the number 10,000 The number 10,000 is they-intercept, the y-intercept, the [g The number the number total when x, the expenses when monthly expenses total monthly expenses of tables, is 0. We can assume these expenses these assume can tables, etc. salaries, etc. worker salaries, equipment, worker rent, equipment, be rent, to be the speed transferred yet. Now why would would the speed Now why transferred yet. the file that the n S W e r iis s that best aanswer The best = bb?? The transfer no are no there are so there completed, so just completed, has just transfer has transfer - just to transfer‐just more left to data left megabytes of data more megabytes at stops at when it stops Owhen like be 0 would be speed would car's speed like a car's likely most likely Therefore, b most trip. Therefore, a trip. end of a the end the represents which the transfer the file transfer time at which the time represents the completed. completed. b a t xx = bee 0Oat square. First First the square. complete the need to complete We need 13. [[] We divide by -‐ 1, everything by divide everything y = x2 - 6x - 20 -‐y=x2‐6x‐20 term by 2 to the middle divide the Now N o w divide middle term to get get -‐33 the -‐33 put and square that result to get 9. We put the get result that and square subtract the and subtract with x and parentheses with the parentheses inside the inside the 9 at end. the end. at the 17. and 0 and g(x) and x = =O parabola and x) is aa parabola Since g( [g Since x= = ~g is the the x-intercepts, x = its x-intercepts, are its = c are = (x‐3)2‐20‐9 (X - 3)2- 20 - 9 -‐ y = parabola’s along line along the line symmetry, the axis of symmetry, parabola's axis vertex the vertex case, the this case, vertex lies. In this the vertex which the which the since the occurs, since is where maximum occurs, the maximum where the parabola an downwards in an opens downwards parabola opens back everything back N o w simplify multiply everything and multiply simplify and Now by 1. by -‐1. y: ‐(x‐3)2+29 upside-down U ” shape. %is the is the Therefore, ~ shape . Therefore, upside-down “"U" time which the a s at a was speed w transfer speed data transfer the data time at which maximum maximum.. 315 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES 18. [Q]One of the x-intercepts is 3. Since the the at the must lie at 5, must vertex, 5, the vertex, x-coordinate of the x-coordinate other the other x-intercepts, the the ttwo midpoint of the midpoint w o x-intercepts, us giving us 7, giving Therefore , k = 7, x-intercept is 7. Therefore, x-intercept the plug in the now can n We can 3)( x -‐ 7). We = a(x -‐ 3)(x y= o w plug solve for a. point to solve as a point vertex as vertex ‐- 332 2 = a(5 -‐ 3)( 3)(55 -‐ 7) a(2)( - 2) ‐- 332 2 = a(2)(‐2) ‐- 332 2 := ‐- 44a a a a == 8B 19. both into both (3, k) into point (3, the point Substituting the [I] Substituting equations, equations, k :=22(3) ( 3 ) +b k=(3)2+3b+5 k = (3)2 + 3b + 5 Substituting the equations. Substituting system of equations. This is a system This the second, the second, into the equation into first equation 2 ( 3+ ) +bb=: (3)2+3b+5 (3)2 + 3b + 5 2(3) 6+ + b := 9 + + 3b 3b + 5 +bb 2=33b 6+ b ++114 4 : 22b b -‐ ‐88= : ‐- 4 b= equation, first equation, the first From the From k = 6+ + bb == 66 -‐ 4 = 2 316 THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA Chapter 18: Synthetic Chapter Synthetic Division Division CHAPTER CHAPTER EXERCISE: EXERCISE: [g 1. l. 5. [TIzz ‐- 11is only ifif the 5. is aa factor factor only the polynomial polynomial yields O yields 0 when when z2 = = 1 (the (the remainder remainder theorem). theorem). Therefore, can set set up up an an equation. equation. Therefore, we we can 4 2 I4x x ‐ 2 4x 4x 4 x -‐ 8 8 2(1)3‐kx(1)2+5x(1)+2x‐2=0 2(1) 3 - kx (1) 2 + 5x (l ) + 2x - 2 = 0 2 ‐kx+5x+2x‐2=O 2 - kx + 5x + 2x - 2 = 0 X - l 8 3 + 7x 7 x:= 0 -‐ kkxx + 0 From can see see that that k = From here, here, we we can 2 7. 7' This This result result can can be be expressed expressed as as4 + _‐xfB_2 4+ x- 2 z- ‘ 7'‑ 7. []] 3x 3 x ++ 1 2 x++11I6x 6 2x 2+ +5x 5 x++ 22 2x 6x 2 6x 6. [2J By the the remainder 6. E By remainder theorem, the remainder theorem , the remainder 2 is(‐4)2+2(‐4)+1=16‐8+l=9. is (- 4) + 2(- 4) + 1 = 16 - 8 + 1 = 9. ‘ xX + + 33xx ‐ - 3X2 _ 21 3x 2 - 2x 2x + 11 ‐ 6x ‐ 4 6x 11 This This result result can c a n be be expressed as expressed as . 1 3x + 1 1 + -m, Wthh Q Q= = 3x 3x + + 1. 1. , from from which 2x + l -‐ , expression by 2x -‐ 1l and expression and write write the the result result in in the form of the form of Dividend : Quotient Divisor + Remainder. Dividend = Quotient xx Divisor + Remainder. 2x + + 11 2x 2 -l-5 2 X- ‐ 11j 4x 4X 2x + !iD ‘ , 2x . ' _ _ . _ 8. to divide diVide the the 8. El This This question question 15 is asking asking you you to expression by xx + + 11 and and write the result in the expression by write the result in the form form of Dividend : Quotient + Remainder Remainder.. Dividend = Quotient x><Divisor Divisor + 6 6 Therefore, Therefore, 4x 4x22 + +5= = (2x + +1)(2x 1) + + 66.. 1) (2x -‐ 1) R2 = 66.. 2x - 6 xx ++ 11j 2x 2 2x 2- ‐4x 4 x- ‐ 33 2 2x2 + 2x 2x 2x + 2x + 2x + 55 2x 2x -_ 11 4. 4. 6x + 4 6x + 4 ‐ 8 8 2 x ‐ 6 r 4x‐‘2x - 4 This This result result can can be be expressed expressed as as 8 .. 2 -‐ 3x x _ , from from which xx -‐ 2 Whmh A A= _ xx -_ 2. 2' 3 _ 2' 2 @] [E] This This question question is asking you to to divide divide the the asking you 2 4x 2 2 3x‐23x2 x -‐4 4 3x - 2 j 3x 2 ‐ 8Bx 2x 2x + + 2 3. 3. 2 1 . -‐ 6x ‐ 3 3 -‐ 6x ‐ 6x 6 6 3 3 Therefore, 2x Therefore, 2x22 -‐ 44xx -‐ 3 = (2x -‐ 6)(x 6)(x + + 11)) + + 3. 3. [I] Using Using the theorem, the the the remainder remainder theorem, remainder remainder when g(x) is divided divided by x + + 33 is is when g(x) equal equal tog to g ((-‐ 33)) = = 2. 2. 317 317 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES 9. ~ This question is asking you to divide the expression by x ‐- 22 and expression in the and write write the the result result in the form of form Dividend = = Quotient Quotient >< Dividend Remainder, x Divisor Divisor + Remainder, where ax + b where is the is the the bis the quotient quotient and and c c is remainder remainder.. 14. be be a factor factor of p(x) ifif p + 6 + 2 xX -‐ 221xx 2 + 4x 4 x- - 99 x X + xx22 -‐ 22x x 6x x - ‐ 9 6 6xx -‐ 112 6 2 3 Therefore, x2 + 4x - 9 = (x Therefore,x2+4x‐9= ( x ++ 66)() (xx-‐ 22)) + + 33.. Finally, a= F i n a l l y, a =1,l ,bb== 6, 6 ,cc= =3 a n daa++bb++ cc ==110. 0. 3,,and 10. ~ Using Using the the remainder remainder theorem, theorem, p(2) = =0 means that that x -‐ 2 is a a factor factor of p(x). means 11. ~ Use the remainder remainder theorem theorem to test Use the test each each option for a a remainder remainder of 0. option 23 + 22 - 5(2) + 3 = p(2) = =23+22‐5(2)+3 = 55.. 13 + 12 - 5(1) + 3 = 0. p(1) = : 13+12‐5(1)+3=0. p(- 3) = (‐3)3 (- 3)3 + (- 3)2 -‐ 5(-3) 5(- 3) + p(‐3) + (‐3)2 + 3 =z o. 0. Therefore, divisible by x -‐ 1 and Therefore, p(x) is divisible and x + 3. 12. [ill ItIf p(x) is divisible divisible by x -‐ [E] 2, then then p(2) must equal equal 0 (the (the remainder remainder theorem). must theorem). Testing each each answer answer choice, choice, only Testing only choice choice (D) results in 0 when results : 2. when x = 13. ~ Using Using the the remainder remainder theorem, theorem, we we can can set set up a a system up system of equations equations.. When When the the polynomial is divided divided by by x ‐- 1or polynomial 1,the 1 or x + 1, the remainder is 0, which remainder which means means that that if we we let let denote the the polynomial, polynomial, p(1) = 00 and p(x) denote and p(- 1)== 00. p(‐1) a(1)4 + b(1) 3 - 3(1)2 + 5(1) a(1)4+b(1)3‐3(1)2+5(1) =o =0 { a(‐1)4 a(- 1)4 + b(- 1)3 -‐ 3(‐1)2 + 5(5(‐1) =o + b(‐1)3 3(- 1)2 + 1) = 0 a+ + b ‐- 3 + + 5 [I] From From the the remainder remainder theorem, theorem, 3x -‐ = 0 = { a ‐- b ‐- 3 ‐- 5 z= 0 Adding the the equations equations together, Adding together, 2 a- ‐ 66=: 0 2a a= 3 318 (g) (1)= 0.0. 11 must must THE PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE Chapter19:Complex Numbers CHAPTER EXERCISE: .I(5‐3i)‐(‐2+5i)=5‐3i+2‐5i=7‐8i = 5 - 3i + 2 - Si = 7 - Bi i (ii(i++11)) == ii22++i =i :-‐1l + ii 2. I[[j 1. [g (5 - 3i) - (- 2 + Si) .Ii4+3i2+2=1‐3+2:0 + 3i + 2 = 1 - 3 + 2 = 0 5 ( ‐i)i )++ 6(1) 6 ( 1 =) :44-‐ 22ii 0 2 + 3i + 4i + 5i + 6i = 22 ++33ii ++44(-( ‐ 11))++ 5(4...2+3i+4i2+5i3+6i4 2 3. [g i4 2 3 4 S n daa++bb= : 22.. Sooaa=: 44,, bb == ‐-22,, aand 0 (6 + 2i)( 2 + Si) = 12 + 30i + 4i + 10i2 = 12 + 34i + 10(- 1) = 2 + 34i 5.. (6+21)(2+5i)=12+30i+4i+10i2=12+34i+10(‐1)=2+34i =22.. Therefore,a Therefore, a 2 lli i Bii = : 33ii ++66 ‐- 110 0+8 = -‐ 44 ++11 [g 3(i + 2) - 2(5 - 4i) = 6..@3(i+2)‐2(5‐4i) [[l 3i(i + 2) - i(i - 1) = 3i2 + 6i - i2 + i = -‐ 3 ++ 66ii-‐ ((-‐ 11))++ ii = ‐- 22++77ii 7..I3i(i+2)‐i(i‐1)=3i2+6i‐i2+i= (1)23. i = i @]i93 = (i4)23. i = (1)23-i=i 8..Ei93=(i4)23-i: 0 (3 - i) 2 = 32 - 6i + ;2 = 9 - 6i - 1 = 8 - 6i .-(3‐i)2=32‐6i+i2=9‐6i‐1=8‐6i 9. 10. i2 - i4 = 0 Deal with the exponents first: (- i)2 - (- i)4 = 1'2‐i4 1Z'Dealwiththeexponentsfirst:(‐i)2‐(‐i)4 = ‐- 11. (5 - 2i)( 4 - 3i) = 20 - 15i - Bi+ 6i2 = 20 - 23i - 6 = 14 - 23i [[j E(5‐2i)(4‐3i)zzo‐151‐81+6i2:20‐231‐6=14‐23i 1 -‐ 11=: -‐22 1 1 1 1 = ! - 1+1 = ! + ..!_ !1 + ..!_ .'Z|7+i‐2+i‐4_7‐1+1_7 G\l i i i4 i2 ~ i 12 12. ~ = ‐i- i = 1L= getygz I byy i ttoo get~·~ Now bottom b and bottom top and both top multiply both Now multiply I .(1-3i)(3‐1’)_3‐i‐9i‐1~3i2 I _ ‐ -1lOi 3_ 3 -‐ 1lOi 3 - lOi + 3 0 i-‐ 3 0 i -2_ ‐- 1/. !Al (1 - 3i) (3 - i) _ 3 - i - 9i + 3;2 _ 3‐101'+3i2 - -- ---,----,-- ----=--- 2 - -----=· -13 L.:2J-2 10 9- i 9 - 3i + 3i - i (3 - i) . ((33+ + ii)) (3‐i)_9‐3i+3i‐i2: 9-12 “ 9 9‐ -( ‐(-11)) 10 _ 14 . ‐ 3i2 _ _ ‐ _ 2 2 .(2‐i).(2‐i)_22‐2i‐2i+i2_4‐4i+i2_4‐4i‐1_3~4i (2 - i) ' (2 - i) = 2 - 2i - 2i + i2 = 4 - 4i + i = 4 - 4i - 1 = 3 - 4i = 0 2 2 + 22i i-‐ i 2 _ ((22++ ii)) ((22- ‐ i) i ) _ 44 ‐- 22ii + 4- i 4‐12 1) ) " ‘ 44‐- ( (‐- 1 5 5 !i ~ -_ 2 § “5 5 5 5 IThe i)(1 + i). i). denominator is (1 -‐ i)(1 common denominator 15.. [[] The common 4ii++ i 22) )++(2 ((44++ ii)( ) (11++ ii)) (2 ( 2-‐ ii)( ) (11-‐ ii)) _ (4 ( 4++ii ++ 4 ( 2- ‐ 2i 2 i-‐ ii++i 2i2 )) _ 44 + Si 5 i- ‐ 1l ++ 2 -‐ 33ii -‐ 1 _ 44 ++ 22ii 2 2== 11++ ii -‐ ii ‐- i i2 ((1l ‐- i )i)(1 ( 1 + ii)+( ) (ll ‐- i i)(1 ) ( 1++i)i )=‐ ‘ 1 -(‐ ( ‐ 11)) ' 2 : 22 ++ ii = 319 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS ANSWERS TO TO THE THE EXERCISES EXERCISES CHAPTER 30 Chapter Chapter20: Absolute Value Value CHAPTER CHAPTEREXERCISE: EXERCISE: 1.‑ 1. []] 1|f(1)| / (l ) I = 1- 2(1) 2 - 3 (1) + 11 = l- 4 1 = 4 =l‐2(1)2‐3(1)+1|:|_4|=4 2. The best to solve question is is trial and error error.. If = 1, 1, which which is is not not 2. ~ The best way way to solve this this question trial and If x x := 3, 3, for for example, example, 1|2 2 -‐ 33|J = greater than result indicates that we we should should try try larger we continue continue to o u r way greater than 5. This This result indicates that larger numbers. numbers . If If we to work work our way up, arrive at at the minimum possible possible value value xx = = 8, which results results in in J2 |2 -‐ BJ 8| = : 6. 6. up, we we would would arrive the minimum 8, which 3. can equal equal -‐55 (when []J Only Only the the expression expression in answer answer (B) can (when x = 11 or Because the absolute value value of = or 3). Because the absolute of anything is always greater than or equal to O, the other answer choices can never reach ‐ 5 . anything is always greater than or equal to 0, the other answer choices can never reach - 5. Recall that that the graph of y = Jx [x]l is aa V-shape V‐shape centered centered at The graph graph pictured pictured is 4. []] Recall the graph at the the origin. origin. The is also also V‐shaped but but converges converges at at y = = -‐ 22,, which which means means it has has shifted w o units V-shaped shifted ttwo units down. down. Therefore, Therefore, the the equation equation of the the graph : lx le l -‐ 2. Note Note that |x -‐ 21 2| shifts shifts the w o units units to the O T ttwo w o units units graph is y = that y = Ix the graph graph ttwo the right, right , N NOT down down.. 5. 5. [ill IE Test each choices, making making sure sure to include negative possibilities. possibilities. For For example, the each of the the answer answer choices, include the the negative example , the answer is not answer n o t (A) because z 2 or -‐ 2, 2, Ix [x -‐ 33]J is n o t greater than 10. However, However, Ix [x -‐ 33]1is greater greater because when when x = not greater than than 10 when x = than 10 when : -~8. 8. 6. @]Smart Smart trial trial and and error error is the the fastest fastest way way to find find the the bounds The lower lower bound for xxisis -‐88 and and the bounds for x. The bound for the upper upper bound bound is -‐ 44.. There There are are 5 integers integers between between -‐44 and do this and -‐88 (inclusive). (inclusive). If we wanted wanted to do this problem problem more more mathematically, mathematically, we we could could set set up up the the following following equation: equation: < -‐3 3 < + < x -+- 6 X 6< 3 Subtracting 6, Subtracting 6, < Xx << -‐ 3 -‐ 99 < Since Since xx is an an integer, integer, -‐ 88 S ~ Xx ~g -‐ 4 7. [ill El In the the graph graph of 1|f/ (x)I, (x)|, all all points with negative negative y-values the x-axis) x‐axis) are across the the points with y-values (below (below the are flipped flipped across x-axis. All points points with positive y-values with positive y-values stay stay the the same same.. Graph shows this correctly.. Graph (D) (D) is the the one one that that shows this correctly 8. 8. positive, [J] If nn is positive, : 110 0 n -‐ 22 = n = 1 2 n = 12 IIff n iiss negative, negative, n -~ 22=-: ‐ 110 0 n 11 == -‐ 8 The The sum s u m of these these ttwo w o possible values of 11 n is 12 12+ = 4. possible values + ( -‐ 88)) = 320 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA 9. II] Make Make up up a Let’s say say x = = 3. 3. Then Then b = = 13 |3 ‐a number number for x. Let's 10] 7, and = 4. ur 101 = = 7, and b b -‐ x = = 77 -‐ 33 = 4. Using Using o our numbers, we’re numbers, looking for an answer choice choice that that gives b = 7. The only one that does so is (C). we're looking an answer gives 4 when when b = 7. The only one that does so is (C). do this To do this question mathematically, we we have have to always negative. question mathematically, to realize realize that that when when x < 10, 10, x -‐ 10 10 is is always negative . Therefore, Therefore, x -‐ 10 10 == -‐bb x z= 10 lO ‐- b Using substitution, Using substitution, b -‐ x becomes b) = becomes b -‐ (10 -‐ b) = 2b 2b ‐- 10. 10. . . 3. II] The The midpoint 6!41 and midpomt of 61 62 is 15the the average: average: (6; //22 = = 6; The midpoint midpoint is %away from the and 6~ (6!4 ++ 62) 6~) 6!. The is ! away from the 4 4 2 4 boundaries the accepted boundaries of the accepted range length of a m u s t be be within within ! %of range for the the length a hot hot dog. dog. So So whatever whatever h h is, is, it must of the the 4 midpoint: midpoint: 1 _ _ 162‘< } [Q] 11. El Smart Smart trial trial and and error error is the way to find find the lower bound is -‐22 and the fastest fastest way the bounds bounds for n. The The lower bound for for n is and the the upper bound bound is 6. 6. There There are are 9 integers integers between upper between -‐22 and and 6 (inclusive). (inclusive). If If we we wanted wanted to do do this this problem problem more we could more mathematically, mathematically, we set up up the the following equation: could set following equation: ‐5 < n ‐- 2 < 5 -5 Adding Adding 2, -‐33 < < n << 7 Since n Since 71is an an integer, integer, -~22 g :S n 5:S 6 12. E] [Q]The The midpoint midpoint of 400 and and 410 is is the the average: average: ((400 + 410) 410) /2 /2= z 405. The The midpoint midpoint is 400 + is 55 away away from from the the boundaries the accepted boundaries of the accepted range range for the the length length of a m u s t be be within a roll roll of tape. tape. So So whatever whatever Il is, is, it must within 5 of the midpoint: the midpoint: ll|l ‐- 405| 405 1 < 5 5 13. @ There There are are ttwo w o possible possible values values of x, x, 33 and and -‐ 11.. There w o possible of y, 11 and get There are are ttwo possible values values of and -‐ 55.. We We get the smallest possible possible value the smallest value of xy when when x = = 33 and and y = z -‐ 55,, in which which case = -‐ 115. 5. case xy = 14. II] If |a| 1, then laI << 1, then by definition, definition, ‐1 - 1 < a < l1 This means that III true . Because This means that I I I is true. Because a must m u s t be be aa fraction, fraction, a2 1,so also true. true. However, o t always a 2 < 1, so II is also However, I is n not always 1 true when a is negative, true because because when 5 is is not n o t greater greater than negati ve, ! than 1. 1. a .. .. 3 1 .. 3 1 . . i 1 1o7 The m1dpomt 1 away 15. ~ 1 3 and and 25 2 1 1s The midpomt of 11 is the the average: average: ( 1113 + + 21 = 2. The midpomt is 15Z away from from the the 2 1) //22 = The midpoint 4 4 4 4 4 i 1 boundaries of the the accepted range for the boundaries accepted range the weight weight of a is, it must a muffin. muffin . So So whatever whatever m m is, must be be within within 1 of of the the midpoint: midpoint: 1 Im lm-_ 221 | << _-4 4 321 CHAPTER CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS ANSWERS TO THE THE EXERCISES EXERCISES Chapter21: Chapter 21: Angles CHAPTER EXERCISE: CHAPTER EXERCISE: @] 1. E] Using Using the exterior exterior angle angle theorem, theorem, Because alternate alternate interior are 5. [}] Because interior angles angles are equal, the missing equal, one one of the missing angles angles of the the lower lower triangle is also also a: triangle a: + jj kk = ii + 1 4 0=: 50 5 0++j j 140 9 0==jj 90 2. triangle is 2. [}] The missing missing angle angle in the the left triangle is 180° 180° -‐ 60° -‐ 50° = 70° 70°.. This angle angle is an an exterior the right exterior angle angle to the the triangle triangle on the right.. So, using using the the exterior exterior angle angle theorem theorem,, 7 0== y ++440 0 70 3 0=: y 30 an exterior exterior angle angle to the Since x is an the lower lower triangle, triangle, 3. []] equal to sum of the .a a + b + + c + d is isequal to the thesum ofthe angles as shown angles of the the quadrilateral, quadrilateral, as shown below below.. x = aa + x= + bb angle at the triangle 6. []] The angle at the the top top of the triangle is 180 70 -‐ 30 we look at the larger 180 -‐ 70 30 = = 80. 80. If we look at the larger angle gives triangle, taking away triangle, taking away the the top top angle gives a + b. = 180 180 -‐ +b= a+ a 7. 80 = 100 100 form a circle, which which means [f] The angles angles form means they sum 360°. °. they sum to 360 xX + =360°‐45°‐80° =235° +y = 360 ° - 45 ° - 80° = 235° Because angles of a a quadrilateral Because the angles quadrilateral sum sum to to 360, the answer answer is 360. 360, 4 0. ‑ 8. 4. Filling out the bottom the [fJ Filling out the bottom triangle, triangle, the missing angle is 180° missing angle 180° -‐ 60° -‐ 40° = 80°, which the angle across from from it in the the which means means the angle across upper triangle is also 80°. Finally, Finally, upper triangle also 80°. x+ x ++yy))==1 180 80 +yy ++( (x 4 0 + y + ( 4 0 + y ) = 1 80 40 + + (40 y) = 180 2y+80=180 + 80 = 180 2y 2yz100 = 100 2y X 2 2180° 5 ° -‐ 880° 0 ° == 55° z= 180° -‐ 445° O y z=S50 The ttwo w o angles angles form form aa line, line, which which means 9. [fil The means they sum sum to 180° 180°.. ((xx + 4400))+ + xX ==1180 80 2 x+ 4400 z=1180 80 2x 2x= 40 2x =1140 xX ==7700 322 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA 10. 15. -Angleais I260 IAngle a is equal equal to 60 = 120. to180 -‐ 60 Angle b bisis equal equal to 180 -‐ 40 Angle 40 = 140. Finally, Finally, a+b=120+140 =260. a+ b = 120 + 140 = 260. [Q]We can figure out two angles within the triangle: triangle: 100° 100° and and 50°. Because Because yy is an an exterior the exterior exterior angle, angle, we can can use use the exterior angle angle theorem theorem to get get its its value: value: yy:100+50=150 = 100 + 50 = 150 n . III Shaded Shaded Angles Angles = Angles Angles of Rectangle Rectangle + Angles Angles of Quadrilateral Quadrilateral = 360 + + 360 = = 720 = polygon sum 12. @] E] The The angles angles of any any polygon s u m to 180(n -‐‐ 2), where n is the number where the number of sides. sides. The angles of a hexagon angles a hexagon (6 sides) sides) sum s u m to 180(6 180(6 -‐ 2) = = 720. Because the the hexagon hexagon is regular, regular, all angles angles have have the same same measure measure.. Therefore, Therefore, each each angle angle is 720 7+ 6 = = 120° 120°.. FinalJy, Finally, X x = 120 -‐ 90 = 30 30 13. [Q] [Elb is an an alternate alternate interior interior angle angle to the the 45° angle, they 're equal: equal: bb = angle, which which means means they’re = 45. aa and c are are also also alternate alternate interior interior angles angles so so and z c = 180 -‐‐ 45 45 = 135. Using Using these values,, a= these values can see that that all all three three are are true true.. we can 14. two missing missing angles angles in the the smaller smaller IIIThe two triangle add add up up to 80°. The two bottom triangle two bottom angles in the larger larger triangle triangle add add up up to angles 70 = = 110. If If we we take the the two t w o missing missing 180 -‐ 70 angles smaller triangle away from from the the angles of the smaller triangle away two bottom angles of the larger triangle, we’ll two bottom angles larger triangle, we 'll end up with x + + y. end up with x + yy ==11 0 ==330 0 x+ ll00 -‐ 880 i, r. I I I t_ \ I "'· ) I. ' \ 323 323 THE EXERCISES ANSWERS TO THE CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS CHAPTER EXERCISES Triangles Chapter 22: Triangles EXERCISE: CHAPTER EXERCISE: CHAPTER 1. 1. always the hypotenuse is always Because the hypotenuse [f] Because 7. hypotenuse be the hypotenuse must side, x + largest side, largest + 5m u s t be Using the be the legs. Using must x and x ‐- 2 m while atand while u s t be pythagorean theorem, pythagorean theorem, 0 The side v'4:= 2. square is fl length of the square side length create ttwo triangle to create Draw wo height of the triangle Draw the height 30‐60‐90 triangles : 30-60-90 triangles: x2+(x‐2)2:(x+5)2 relationsrup, triangle relationship, 30--60-90 triangle Using the 30‐60‐90 2. @ Using 1 1 1 1 (10) = DC _ 53C _ E(10) _ 5. BC = DC = 2 2 relationslup, the 45-45-90 Using the 3. [f] Using 3. 45‐45‐90 triangle triangle relationship, xX = 6\/2. 6y1. 4. then triangle is then the triangle The area of the 1 similar . are similar. DCE are and DCE ABE and Triangles ABE [I]Triangles (2)( ./3) = 1§(2)(\/§) : v'3 \/5 Therefore, Therefore, CD CD AB AB 6 3 AB AB be x. piece be bottom piece the bottom height of the the height 8. @ Let the x. radii of the the radii and the cone and the cone height of the The height shown as shown triangles as similar triangles form ttwo circles form w o similar below. below. 5CE == BE E 5 =Z 4T AB 8 = AB 5.. measure, same measure, the same have the angles have w o angles Iss IIfIf ttwo I? same the same have the them have opposite them sides opposite then the sides then we perimeter, we largest perimeter, length. To get the largest length. perimeter be 20. The perimeter side to be third side choose the third choose is then = 55. then 15 + 20 + 20 = 6 .‑ 6. lli] Using similarity, Using the similarity, 1 2 - 1+X 6 Cross multiplying, Cross multiplying, M 4 4 2x = 6 22 ++ 2x 0 Drawing into ttwo wo base into the base splits the height splits the height Drawing the equal parts of length From the 3-4-5 3‐4‐5 length 4. From equal parts pythagorean height is 3. know the height triple, we know pythagorean triple, xx 2 =2 The area is : 12. ~ (8)(3) = then %(8)(3) is then 324 THE COLLEGE PANDA COLLEGE PANDA 9. I2.5 ITriangles GHC are similar. Triangles GEF and and GHC are similar. Solving for EF, Solving 02] 13. [E We We can can use use the the pythagorean pythagorean theorem theorem to to find find BC: Ac2 : 13C2 AC 2 + + A32 AB 2 = BC2 HC EF EG EZFTG HG 1222 + 9922 = = BC BC22 12 EF EF_10 10 T2 ‘ 5? 225 := BC2 BC 2 E EFF== 4 = BC 15 = Note that Note that this this is is a a multiple multiple of the the 3‐4‐5 3-4-5 triangle. triangle. Triangles ADF Triangles A D P and similar. So, and GEF are are also also similar. AD_ D _GE A § C D F OFF _ EEF AD 2 A_D_z = 5 5 ‘4 4 5 AD‐§_2.5 AD = 2 = 2.5 10.‑ [g 10. 0 X _!!_ 7T _57t = 547T x180°_ 225° 225 180° A 4 Now N o w ACDE .6.CDE is similar similar to ACAB. .6.CAB . The sides = 1.5 1.5 11. [f] The sides of triangle triangle DEF DEF are are 9 9+6 6= times longer times of longer than than the the respective respective sides sides triangle triangle ABC. ABC. Therefore, Therefore, EF = 9 x 1.5 = 13.5 13.5 and = 5 xx 1.5 = = 7.5. The of and DF OF = The perimeter perimeter of triangle + 13.5 + : 30. triangle DEF DEF is then then 9 + + 7.5 = 12. B 9 CB 2CE_ CB DE DE ‐ AB AB g CE_ 15 15 6 ' shortest side side in the the isosceles [g IfIf W BC is the the shortest isosceles 9 Cross Cross multiplying, multiplying, triangle, AB == AC triangle, then then AB AC and and [A L A is is the the smallest we w a n t to to smallest angle. angle . At the the same same time, time, want maximize L AA so that AB is minimized. N o maximize A so that L B minimized . Noww the triangle if all the the angles angles were were 60°, then then the triangle would be would beequilateral the equilateral and and EE BC wouldn’t wouldn't be be the shortest So we need need to decrease decrease L [AA to shortest side. side . So the minimizes the next next highest highest option, option, 50°, which which minimizes £3 = 65°. L B to 130 + 2 = 6) 9(CE) = : (15)( (15>(6) CE = 10 10 below and 14. []] Draw Draw the the extra extra lines lines shown shown below and use triangle. use the the 8‐15‐17 8-15-17 right right triangle. B W w 65° 8 17 1--------20 65° CL---------~A z 15 12 12 50° X 325 15 y CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS CHAPTER THE EXERCISES ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES 15. the [f] Draw Draw an an extra extra line line to to complete complete the 19. a [fJThe The smaller smaller triangle triangle in in the the first first quadrant quadrant is a is similar similar to a 3‐4‐5 3-4-5 triangle triangle and and is to triangle triangle AOB. AOB. Using Using the the similarity, similarity, rectangle . Then use the 7-24- 25 right triangle. 28 OB _ 3 3 @ =- 15 15 ‘ 5 24 24 24 24 OB == 9 Therefore, = -‐ 99.. Therefore, n = 28 7 20. 2 +2 +2 +7+ 2 244+ 288+ 255+ +2288 ==11 112 16. ~ Using Using the the pythagorean pythagorean theorem, theorem, 0 The radii radii extending extending to to the the comers comers of of the the triangle split triangle split the the circle into into three three equal equal parts, parts, so the measure measure of angle so the ADB is angle ADB + 3 = 120°. In radians, 360 + radians , this this is o n 200 TT: _ 271' 2n: 120 x 17305 _ ?. l X 180° = 3· 2 82+x2 =(x+2)2 8 + x2 = (x + 2) 2 21. 64+x2=x2+4x+4 64 + x 2 = x 2 + 4x + 4 6 =4 644= 4xx ++ 4 6 0= : 44xx 60 [fJ Because Because triangle triangle ABC ABC is 45‐45‐90, 45-45-90, AB = 2\/2. 2/2 . Because AB triangle ABO ABD is Because triangle is 2 30‐60‐90, 30--60-90, AD = ii;; \/§ 1 5== Xx 15 17. = DB _ [fJ Label Label what know.. what you you know B 2 XX 1 C 2 1 Y W W 1 2 2 2ELl~ A 11ZZ 2 D 22. All triangles triangles in the diagram 45‐45‐90, diagram are are 45-45-90, which means which : XY = = Jz‘ means wz WZ = /2 and and WX = zr ZY = N2. wx 2/2. The The perimeter perimeter of wxrz WXYZ is then fi + + fi/2+ + 2 \2/2 / § ++22/2 \ / § :=6 6/2. \/§. then /2 18. and and DB is twice twice that: that: 4 4_fl /2 $3 v'3 We can rationalize the We can rationalize the fraction fraction by multiplying multiplying both the top top and and bottom bottom by $3: both y'3: zflxéz‘h/E D B fi fi s [i] Because Because the the triangles triangles are are 45‐45‐90, 45-45-90, BC = is half BC: = i.~. The The radius radius of the the circle circle is half BC: \/§ ( ~) (é) ( ~) 2 = L2 ~. (é) [i] From = 7 and From the the coordinates, coordinates, AB = and Because [LAABC BC = 7. Because B C is a right right angle, angle, triangle A triangle ABC 45‐45‐90 triangle. BC is aa 45-45-90 triangle . Therefore, Therefore, the the measure ABAC = 45°, measure of L BAC = Finally, the area of the Finally, the area of the circle is 2 which is 45° x _!!_ which 182° = g radians. = !: radians . 180° 4 326 PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE 23. a on a triangle lies lies on equilateral triangle the equilateral Because the [Q]Because 25. ED] equal, are equal, sides are their sides side square, all their the square, side of the isosceles. are isosceles. DCE 6D and A 6 ABE means AA which BE and C E are which means have 36° both have and 6 6 XYZ and Outer AXYZ w WXZ a 2 both GI]Outer they are and share angles angles and share L.Z. 42. Therefore, Therefore, they are the angles Label the similar. Label similar. angles with with tick marks marks ifif similarity more this similarity see this want to see you more clearly. clearly. you want XZ with W correspond with 6 WXZ correspond XZ in AWXZ and W W WZ and XYZ, 6X YZ in A and Y Z , respectively respectively (sides (sides and W each correspond with angles correspond the 36° angles opposite the opposite with each sides opposite and sides other opposite the largest largest angles angles other and So, other) . 50, each other). with each correspond with correspond B C A D WXZ from 6 W2 AWXZ 6 WXZ _ XZ from from AWXZ WZ from 6 XYZ from AXYZ YZ from XYZ _ yz from 6 XZ from xz AXYZ xz wz ‐ k, .. WZ XZ Smce equal to k, be equal also be must also XZ = k, fiYZ must Smee E 24. equal to which XZ (the reciprocal) is equal (the reciprocal) ~~ means XE which means [ A E D= 2 60°, L.BAE [ B A E = L.CDE ZCDE = : 30°, which which L.AED means means 75° . [L.ABE A B E = = é A E B == ADCE = [L.DEC D E C = : 75°. L.DCE = L.AEB 1 1 k' k. Finally, Finally, ZBEC 150°.. L.BEC = 360° ‐- 75° -‐ 75° -‐ 60° = 150° Let AD [[I Let I I OD, is parallel parallel to fii AC is Since TC 26. 3.75 Since L.BOO. ~ ZBDO. L.BCA E and ZBCA [L.BAC B A Cg B O D and ~ [L.B00 similar. 6 BOD are similar. and ABOD_are 6 BBAC Therefore, A C and Therefore, A OD are and W that AC and OD = 8 and Notice and that are that CD Notice that imply corresponding given lengths lengths imply The given sides. The corresponding sides. a 30-60-90 ADE is a Because ADE 30‐60‐90 = x. Because that AE = 2x. Note and AE DE = triangle, DE triangle, = xy13 x 3 and Note that are all DCF are BEF, and 6 ADE, 6 AADE, ABEF, and 6 ADCF all congruent. congruent. B the sides that sides of are~2 the 6 BAC are sides of ABAC the sides that the will BO will length of 35 ABOD. o w finding the length finding the Now 6 BOD. N BC. length of W. allow the length determine the us to determine allow us point B down Draw vertical line from point down to the the line from Draw a vertical BO as x-axis to form with 35 as the the triangle with right triangle a right form a hypotenuse. triangle is this triangle base of this The base hypotenuse . The (they-coordinate 8 ‐- 2 z= 6 and height is 8 (the y-coordinate its height and its (a triangle (a of point 6-8-10 triangle This is aa 6‐8‐10 point B). This didn't multiple of the 3‐4~5 triangle). you didn’t If you triangle) . If the 3~5 multiple the used the know also used could've also you could’ve this, you know this, pythagorean BD. Since theorem to find BD. pythagorean theorem 3 BD : 10, BC= gum) = é(10) == 3.75. = ~(10) BC = ~(BD) BO = 2x A xX 0 D C triangle ABC The side side length ABC is 3x. outer triangle length of outer The DEF is xy13. triangle DEF inner triangle length of inner The side length x\/3. The side similar, the are similar, triangles are the ttwo Because w o triangles the ratio ratio Because the the square the equal of their areas is equal to the square of the areas their ratio sides: their sides: ratio of their Area ofA E F _ (x/3) (x\/3)22 __ 3x 3x22 _a 1 1 DEF 6D Area of 2 2 3 9x (3x) 6 ABC _ (3x)2 " 9x2 _ Area Area of AABC 327 CHAPTE R 30 ANSWERS ANSWERS TO THE CHAPTER THE EXERCISES 27. ~ IE]Draw Draw a a straight straight line line down down the middle. middle . The length length of this line top The line is 9 because because the the top part simply a radius part is simply radius of the the semicircle, semicircle, whose length length is half half the side side of the whose square, the square, 29. ~ y 6 --c+ 2 = 3. A Ah 3 B Draw the extra line shown above to form a 30-60-90 30‐60‐90 triangle are in aa ratio triangle (the (the sides sides are ratio of 11:: x/3 v'3:: 2). The segment The acute acute angle angle the the line line segment forms with forms with the the x-axis x-axjs is 30°, which which makes makes 0 = 9 z 360 -‐ 30 : 330°. In in radians, radians, this this is 30 = H _ 117r 3300 330° X x _!!__ = 117r_ 180° ‘ “ 6Z “ 180° Using Using the the pythagorean pythagorean theorem, theorem, ¥ 92 + 3§2 = = AAB§2 % A §2 90 = AB V90= AB JT=AB 3JE=AB 3M = AB Because DBCE DBCE is a square, square, DB = 3 and and 30. j 3.75 j Because triangles ABD ABO and and DEO DEO are are simjlar triangles similar (their (their angles are are the angles the pythagorean pythagorean the same). same) . Using Using the theorem, D0 theorem, 5. Using similarity, DO = 5. Using the the simjlarity, 28. @] E' Draw Draw the height height from A as asshown shown below. below. from A AADB turns out to bea 30‐60‐90 triangle. triangle. .0.ADB turns out be a 30-60-90 AD _ DO £ = @ D E DBB _ O OE A AD £3 3 3 5 ” 44 5 15 A D =z 44‐ = z 33B ..75 AD '---- D 3 B The area area is is ~%(6)(3\/3) The (6)(3v'3) -- -----""'- C 6 9\/3 = 9v'3 328 PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE THE 31. [g 34. A [g Notice that both outer triangle RQT and T. share L and share angles and right angles have right QST have triangle QST triangle 4 T. measures, angle same the have they Because Because they have the same angle measures, they similar. are similar. they are B I 4 R F 12 D Q Q cC T T correspond QST correspond triangle QST QT in triangle and W ST and Since 5‐7“ Since RQT, triangle RQT, outer triangle RT in outer and W QT and with CT with following the following equate the can equate we can respectively, respectively, we ratios: ratios: sides similar. The are similar. FBE are and FBE ADE and Triangles ADE Triangles The sides the than the longer than times longer are 3 times ADE are triangle ADE of triangle Because FBE triangle F sides of triangle respective sides respective BE.. Because the triangle, 45-45-90 a is triangle ABO triangle ABD a 45‐45‐90 triangle, the then BE = let BE we let BO is 12\1'2. length of BD length l z fi . ifIf we = x, then 2ST _ QTg DE 3x. DE =: 3x. RT QT -‘ RT QT x+3x = 12v'2 x+3x:12f2 4x=12\/f_2 4x = 12v'2 xX ==33V2 \/§ ST _ 15 $1 E 15 15 _ 17 17 15 15 z‐ (15) z~ 13.2 ST = ST 17(15) 13.2 17 Since 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, or 40 ISince 35. I30,31, I I 32. 7.2 Triangle ABC is a 5-12-13 triangle triangle Triangle ABC = 5). Triangle (BC = (BC ABC is similar similar to triangle equal). Using are equal). angles are (the angles AED Using this this AED (the triangles the ttwo because the tricky because similarity w o triangles similarity is tricky following is The following orientations . The different orientations. have have different setup: correct setup: a correct example of a one one example and L'..BAC and L'..BDE ~ AC, ABDE to E, parallel to DE ’‐‘_~’ ABAC DE is parallel and 6 B0£ and Therefore , ABDE L'..BCA . Therefore, [L'.. BBED E D~ E ABCA. are BAC are sides of 6ABAC The sides similar. The are similar. 6 BBAC A A C are 6+4 means which means 6 8D£, which sides of ABDE, the sides ~ the :4 = 149 as ~O as be ‐14‐0 also be the must also p, must 6 BAC, p, perimeter of ABAC, the perimeter AB AE A_E_A_B D C DEE ‐ BBC Thus, long 6 80£. Thus, perimeter of ABDE. the perimeter as the long as 12 AE A_E_e 33. 15 15 33 ‐ 55 AE AE 36 = 36 ‐5 == 7.2 z2 5 10 10 4( 12) ~ p ~ 4(16) (16) 30 ~ p ~ 40 where integer. an integer. where p is an [fil Since AC and OF cut through three into divided into are divided OF are and D? AC and lines , TC parallel lines, parallel the up the set up then set proportional can then We can parts. We proportional parts. multiply . following cross multiply. and cross equation and following equation xX 4 X xX = 2v'2 2 x2 x2 = 8 329 CHAPTER CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES EXERCISES Chapter23: Circles Chapter Circles CHAPTER EXERCISE: CHAPTER EXERCISE: 1. l. [[) E The The circumference circumference of the the circle is 2m. 2 m . The The square square divides the circle circle into into four equal arcs. arcs. divides the four equal 27rr 7rr . 2rrr rrr Therefore, Therefore, the the length length of arc AP APD is T = 7 D 1s 6. I6O IBecause A G is formed Because [LBBAC formed from from the the endpoints diameter, its measure endpoints of a a diameter, its measure is 90°. 90° . Since n d AC = 2, AABC Since AB = l aand .6.ABC is a 30‐60‐90 ABAC = 60° 60°.. 30-60-90 triangle triangle and and L BAC = 2. El [Q]Finding the radius radius of each each of the 2. Finding the the small small circles, circles, 7.‑ 7. [I] 4 2 2 nr2=367r rrr = 36rr 7rr2:97r rrr 2 = 9rr r =: 6 rr = =3 The circumference The circle is circumference of the the circle 2m = 27r(6) 2m 127r. Because the equilateral 2rr (6) ~_‐ = 12rr. Because the equilateral triangle splits splits the the circumference circumference of the triangle the circle The radius of the The radius the outer outer circle is equivalent equivalent to to three radii radii of the three the smaller smaller circles, circles, 3 x 3 = : 9. The then rr(9) The area area is then 7t(9)22 = : 8lrr. 817T. 3. into 3 equal equal pieces, into pieces, arc arc AB fl is one-third one-third of the the [I] First, the radius. radius. First, find find the circumference: ~ %x 127r = : 4m circumference: x 12rr 4rr . m22 = 36rr 3671 m 8. ~ The the circle The area area of the circle is mr r = 7 = rr(6 7'r(6)2 = 36rr. 3671. The The shaded shaded sector )2 = sector is = 6 rr = lOrr . circle, . 1e, which 1 0n: ” = ‐ i S of entire o f the t h e en tire cue w h 1.ch means means The the circle The circumference circumference of the circle is 2rrr (6) = 2m = : 2rr 27r(6) = 12rr. 127r. The The perimeter one perimeter of one region radii and and one-eighth region is made made up of ttwo w o radii one-eighth of the the circumference. circumference. if? 36 _ 18 18 5 central angle angle AC central u s t be ACBB m must be % of 360. 18 5 x 360° _ 1‐8 X 360o = ‐ 100° 100o ~ 1 6+6+;(12n) =12+1.57t 6 + 6 + (12rr ) = 12 + l.Srr 8 18 Converting to radians, radians, Converting this this to 4.@ 4.@] 0 lOO 7rr2:497r rrr2 = 49rr 2 = 49 rr2=49 r= : 7 rr 180 X Srr =9 Wecould’ve We could've gotten gotten this this answer answer directly directly by sticking The area area of aa sector sector is sticking to radians. radians. The 1 r 2 8 when when 8, the measure érze 9, the measure of the central the central 2 The form of a The standard standard form a circle with with center center 2 (h,k)) and and radius + (y -‐ k)2 = rr2. (h,k radius r is (x -‐ h)2 h) 2 + k) 2 = . So the equation of the So the equation the circle circle is +y2 (x + 2)2 2)2 + y 2 = 49. 5. angle, radians.. angle, is in radians 1 =107r -$39 r 8= lOn: 2 2 The arc measure XE is twice the [g The measure of AB twice the 1 2 1(6)26 ‐_1 lOrr 07r -( 6)28 = measure the inscribed inscribed angle. measure of the Therefore, angle . Therefore, 60° -A 60° 11 : 60,wh1chis ° which ' is ' ‐360° ‐ f t he AB AB = 60°, = ‐60 3600 6 of the circumference. circumference. 2 189 1071 188 = = lOrr 5 80=: gn - 1[ 9 330 330 THE THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA 9. I4, 5, 6, or 71The arc length can be determined by rOwhen r0 when 0, determine measure of the the 0, the the measure central angle, angle, is expressed expressed in radians. central radians. Therefore, the the arc length length must Therefore, m u s t be be greater greater than than 5 12. E] @]Circle Circle P and and circle U LI each each have have an an area area of 7r(3)22 = = 9rr. 971. To get get the shaded region, we rr(3) the shaded region , we need subtract out o u t the need to subtract the unshaded unshaded portions portions of both APH U is equilateral, both circles. Because Because b. PHU equilateral, AH PU and UP are L HPU and AH L HUP are both both 60°, which which means means the unshaded unshaded sectors are each the sectors are each one-sixth one-sixth of their respective their respective circles (60° is one‐sixth one-sixth of 360°). (g) ~z 3.92 and and less less than (i) than 5 ((g) i) ~z 7.85. We could've done Wecould’ve done this this question question by converting converting radians but the radians back back to degrees degrees but process the process would've taken taken aa lot longer. longer . would’ve 9rr + 9rr ‐97r +971 10. E] @]Draw square connecting connecting the Draw aa square the centers centers of each each circle: 13. 1 1 6 6 (9rr) - (9rr) = g(97T)‐%(97t) =157r 15rr [!] Let y be the angle at the top of the triangle . 2 _y rrr 22:= 247f rrr 7rr -_ _Jf._ 360m 247r 360 rr(6) rr(6) 2 = 24rr 7r(6)22 -‐ L firms? = 2471 360 l = 24 36 36 -_ y_ 10 24 10 get the the shaded need to subtract subtract To get shaded region, region, we we need out the the four four quarter-circles quarter -circles from from the the square out square.. The square square has has an an area area of 8 x 8 = The = 64. The The four quarter-circles make four quarter-circles make up up one one circle with with an area of rr(4) an area 7r(4)22 = = 16rr. 167i. The The area area of the the shaded shaded region region is then then 64 64 -‐ 167f. l67r. 11. _ y_ 1 12 = 10 12 _ 10 : y 120 = If then x and have to add add up to 60. If y is 120, then and x have Therefore, x = Therefore, = 30. [£] Unraveling Unraveling the the cylinder cylinder gives rectangle gives aa rectangle 14. ~ From the information information given, given, AB = From the : 8, = 4, and and because because AC is tangent BC = tangent to circle B, L ACB is aa right Using the ZACB right angle. angle. Using the pythagorean pythagorean theorem theorem to find A C, AC, with base equal the circumference and a a with aa base equal to the circumference and height equal equal to the height height of the height to the the cylinder: cylinder: AC2 + 42 = +42 = g2 82 h AC2=48 AC 2 = 48 A c :=44/3 \/§ AC 27rr 2rrr The area of the the cylinder the The surface surface area cylinder is is equal equal to the area this rectangle rectangle plus plus the the areas areas of the the two area of this two circles at end . at either either end. The area area of b.A ABC !( AC )( BC) = )( 4) = A B C = %(AC)(BC) = !l (4v'3 (4\/§)(4) = 88\/§ v'3 2 2 2mh 2m 2 = 27r(4)(5) 2rr(4)(5) + 2rr(4) 27rrh + 27'tr2 27r(4)22 15. [!]The center ( -‐ 22,, -‐ 44)) and and radius radius The circle has has center 2. If If you you draw 'll see that that draw this this circle oout, u t , you you’ll it's tangent tangent only it’s y‐axis. only to the the y-axis. = = 4071+ 40 7f + 327r 327f = 727f 7271 = 331 331 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS CHAPTER ANSWERS TO THE THE EXERCISES EXERCISES Chapter 24: 24: Trigonometry Trigonometry CHAPTER CHAPTER EXERCISE: EXERCISE: 1. 1. 0 Since (90 -‐ xx), ), Since cos cos x = sin sin(90 cos40 cos 40°° = sin50 sin 50°° = a. 2. []] Since Since tan tan x = 0.75 = z ~, 2, we can can draw draw aa ‘ 5. After drawing drawing the triangle, we we let 5. [f] After the right right triangle, let and the adjacent side the opposite opposite side the side be be m m and the adjacent side be 1. be 1. right right triangle triangle such such that that the the opposite opposite side side is is 33 and and the the adjacent adjacent side side is 4. 4. m m I 1 3 Using the pythago;ean orean theorem, theorem, the Using the pyth✓ the hypotenuse is \/ m + 1. hypotenuse m2+ 1. Therefore, Therefore, ,. m l 4 . Using Using the the pythagorean pythagorean theorem, theorem, the the hypotenuse is 5 (this is a 3-4-5 triangle) hypotenuse is 5 (this is a 3 4 ‐ 5 triangle).. ‐ .~= vm 2 + 1 Vm2+ 1 6. Therefore, cos cos xx = 2 4f = = 0.8 0.8 Therefore, [I!] The The fact that that AB AB = 55 is irrelevant irrelevant since since the ratios ratios of the the same the the sides sides will will always be be the same proportional triangles. for proportional triangles. Instead Instead of actually actually trying out the thellengths the sides, Sides, trying to to figure figure out lengths of of the let 5 use use a ea51er to to work With.. let's a triangle triangle that that'ss easier work with 5 3, [QJ El Since Since sin 9 2 cos (90 _ 9) and sin 0 = cos (90 - 0) and 3. ss1nx= m x _ . cost) = ‐ sin sm(90 9), cos0 (90 -‐ 0), B sine0 + cos(90 cosG +sin(90 9) = sin cos (90 -‐ 0) + cos 0+ sin (90 -‐ 0) sin0+sin9+c056+cose sin 0 + sin 0 + cos 0 + cos 0 = 225in9+2cos€ sin 0 + 2 cos 0 3 3 4. I25 IDrawing Drawing the triangle, 4. the triangle, A A 4 4 C Using the pythagorean theorem, theorem, BC BC = : 5 (it's (it’s Using the pythagorean a 3‐4‐5 triangle). a 3-4-5 triangle) . 30 4 ..mBB + c o sBB ‐ 4§+§ 33 ‐ 5 77 ‐ 1 . 4 sSm + COS = S + S =S = 1.4 C C B 5 cosA = = 5 ‐ cosA 6 6 7. 7‑ [IT] l AC z §5 A_C 30 6 . 1 = -_ S 'l n x = 4 smx 4 i3 _ 11 -4 BC BC 4 AC = = 25 25 Cross get BC BC:= 12. Cross multiply multiply to to get 332 THE COLLEGE PANDA COLLEGE PANDA AC = ‐3 . r:;-i .. AC 0 7 SmcecosxO= ‐3 6, Since AC z= 6, =-.4.SinceAC - , ‐= 4'AB 13. L.:JSmcecosx 5 12 , we can let 8. , 1 / Since tan B = 2.4 = 3 5 AC 12and pythagorean the pythagorean Using the AB = 5. Using and AB = 12 AC = theorem, w o triangles are triangles are the ttwo = 13. Since the BC 2 theorem, BC similar, similar, AB AB 5 BC 13 4 AB 3 Therefore, = 7. Therefore, k = are DBE are and DBE ABC and triangles ABC that triangles Notice that 14. j 12.s INotice equivalent is BAC angle BAC equivalent means angle similar, which means similar, which tangent of L'. the tangent to angle [ BBAC A C is BOE . Since the angle BDE. also 1.25. L'.BDE 1.25, the B D E is also tangent of é the tangent Opp op~ adj =: 1.25 adJ sin (5m -‐ 12) sin 58 = : sin(5m 5 = 5Sm m -‐ 112 2 588 = BE BE BE 1.25 = 1.25 DE '‐ 7 m 700 =5Sm m= 1 = 144 (1.25)( 10) = 12.5 (1.25)( DE) := (1.25)(1o) BE BE = (1.25)(DE) @]From the coordinates, AB = 5 - ( - 3) = 8 the Using the 12 - ((-‐ 33)) = BC := 12‐ and BC and : 15. Using AC , theorem to find AC, pythagorean theorem pythagorean it's because it’s measures 90° because B C measures @][L'.AABC 15. [E triangle semicircle. Therefore, inscribed in aa semicircle. inscribed Therefore, triangle be AB height be right triangle. a right ABC is a ABC triangle. Let the height AB hypotenuse the Since BC. be base the and and the base be hypotenuse 1, AC AC = 1, AC2 + 3c2 BC2 AB 2 + = A32 AC 2 = AC2=82+152 AC 2 = 82 + 152 AB sin0 == AB sine Ac2 : 2289 89 AC 2 = = ccos0 ost) = B C BC A C =: 117 7 AC BC _ 15 . BC Finally,cosC AC ‐= 1‐7.. Finally, cos C ‐= E 17 Area of = ~%(BC)(AB) ( BC )( AB ) triangle = of triangle 1 . = 1§(cosl9)(sm (cos0 )( sin09)) = 8 . o . 0o . 0o 8 - x 0 ))== ssin cos (90° ‐x m x ,, ssin mx = _‐_ fi' . @]Since 11. @Smcecos(90° 17 be angle x be the angle 50 opposite the side opposite the side can let the we can So we the Using the 8 and be 17. Using hypotenuse be the hypotenuse and the adjacent to pythagorean side adjacent theorem, the side pythagorean theorem, Finally, 82 = 15. Finally, J17 2 -‐ 82 has length angle x has angle length \/172 adjacent 15 15 adjacent : ‐ : ‐ , cosx 0o =-~-17 hypotenuse cosx hypotenuse 17 0cos 0 _ sin sinGcosH _ 16. 2 2 the asking for the basically asking question is basically This question [g This 0. For equal cos 6. can equal 0 can sin 9 which sin quadrants in which quadrants For the same have the must have be equal, they must them to beequal, them same since sine sign. sine is option II since out option rules out That rules sign. That cosine while quadrant second the in positive positive second quadrant while cosine are cosine are and cosine sine and quadrant I, sine negative. 1n is negative. In quadrant both sine is equal equal to cosine cosine and sine positive, and both positive, [I) Draw a triangle . Since the sine of one of J;, angle s is ?, acute angles the acute the 3 4 pythagorean theorem, pythagorean theorem, ./28= 2/7. ,/~64--- 3-6 := \/2_8=2\/7. JB 2 - 62 = \/64‐3 BC = \/82-62 BC= 9. [!Ij Since COS X = sin (90 - x), equation, an equation, up an Setting up sin 58°. Setting cos32 cos 32°° = sin 12. 4 AB = §(6) 8. Using the Using the = 8. (6) = (AC ) = = §(AC) AB = ‐ =z -13‐ cos B =z -BC N = :cosB cos N 10. 4 side can let the side we can hypotenuse the hypotenuse and the opposite v'3and be \/3 angle be the angle opposite the side the side theorem, the pythagorean theorem, the pythagorean Using the be 2. Using be length adjacent has length angle has the angle adjacent to the 45-45-90 your 45‐45‐90 when (remember your when 0 := 45° (remember are cosine are and cosine sine and lll, sine triangle?). quadrant III, 1n quadrant triangle?). In cosine equal to cosine both sine is equal and sine negative, and both negative, quadrant third quadrant when (this is the third 0 = 225° (this when 6 quadrant) . equivalent the first quadrant). equivalent of 45° in the a that this y'3)2 = J22 22‐- ((x/3)2 = l.1. Notice Notice that this is a complete , triangle complete, 30‐60‐90 triangle. With the triangle 30-60-90 triangle. angle is then acute angle other acute sine of the other the sine the then opposite opposite _ 1 hypotenuse ‐- 2 hypotenuse 2' 333 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES Chapter 25: Reading Data CHAPTER EXERCISE: 1. II] We estimate the total commute time for each point: I Point A B C D Commute Time 25 + 60 = 85 38 + 40 = 78 45 + 80 = 125 80 + 20 = 100 I “‑ ‑ Even though the represents the the greatest time . Even though the times times were were estimated, estimated, it's it’s clear clear that that C represents greatest commute commute time. II] The vertical distance between the points at 2004 and 2006 is the smallest among the answer choices. 3. II] The points corresponding to July through September are the highest in both 2013 and 2014. 2. 150 - 33 150 0 250 - 5 - 60 1/o lower than (to the 5. [I] E San San Diego Diego is the the only only city for which which the the estimated estimated bar bar is lower than (to the left left of) the the actual actual bar. bar. 6. [I] 1 Both Both line line graphs graphs go go downward downward every every year. year. E The lowest lowest point point with with respect respect to the the y-axis y-axis is at at a under 40 40 years age. 7. @The a little little under years of age. A The The graph's graph’s minimum, minimum, 16, must must be be the the weight weight of the when empty. empty. The graph’s maximum, maximum, 8. [}] the truck truck when The graph's must be be the the weight weight of the the truck truck at at maximum maximum capacity. capacity. Subtract Subtract the the two t w o to get get the the truck’s maximum 30, must truck's maximum capacity, 30 30 -‐ 16 16 = 14. capacity, 9. II] From 2010 to 2011, the percent ~ -~ ¥ 40 decrease was 1 ‐}1 4 =z : = . (percent decreases are negative) negative) -‐25% 25% (percent decreases are From From 2013 to 2014, the the percent percent increase increase was was 2 5-‐ 220 0 = !1 = 25ox 0 25 20 _Z_25/o 20 4 ° ag _z l27 120 2 lO. li_J 180 = 3 3 180 ‐ 3 11. IConsole A generated generated 250,000 250,000 x 100 = : [[j Console A 12. in Quarter Quarter 3, 3, Company Company Y's profit profit was was about about 66 million million and Company X's X’s profit was about 12million million [I) In and Company profit was about 12 $25, 000, 000. Console 2 5 , 000 x 150 = : $33,750,000. $33, 750,000. $25,000,000. Console Bgenerated B generated 225,000 Console D generated generated 125,000 125,000 x 250 = : $31,250,000. $31,250,000. Console 50,000 x 300 = $15,000,000. $15,000,000. Console E generated generated 50,000 Console Console B generated generated the the most m o s t revenue. revenue. Console (twice Company Company Y's). Y’s). In no no other other quarter quarter was w a s Company Company X's X’s profit profit as as close being twice twice Company (twice close to being Company Y’s. Y's. 334 THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA 13. 13. 15+ = [fJ Alabama Alabama spent spent a a combined combined 15 + 2.5 2.5 = 17.5 billion. billion. Alaska 7.5 + + 7.5 7.5 = = 15 15billion. Arizona spent spent 17.5 Alaska spent spent 7.5 billion. Arizona 12.5 + + 7.5 = = 20billion. Arkansas spent 10+ 5 = 15billion. Arizona spent the most. 20 billion. Arkansas spent 10 + 5 = 15 billion. Arizona spent the most. 14. I44 / During first two Jeremy answered answered 44 calls total of of 22 xx 4 During the first two hours, hours, Jeremy calls per per hour hour for for aa total 4 = 88 calls. calls. During During the hours, Jeremy Jeremy answered answered 8 calls per per hour During the the next next three three hours, hour for a a total total of 3 x 8 = 24 calls. During the final two hours, Jeremy answered a total total of 2 x 6 = t w o hours, Jeremy answered 6 calls calls per per hour hour for a z 12 12 calls. He answered total of answered a a total + 24 24 + +12 = 44 44 calls. 8+ 12 = that it takes takes Greg's glucose level level 2.5 hours hours to return return to its its initial initial value value (140 15. [}] From From the graph, graph, we we can can see that Greg’s glucose mg/ dL) after breakfast and 8 4 = 4 hours to return to its initial value (also 140 mg/ dL) after mg/dL) after breakfast and ‐ = hours return initial value mg/dL) after lunch lunch.. . 5=: 1.5 4 -~ 22.5 16. ~ At 30 per hour, hour, Car Car X X gets gets 25 for 5 5 hours hours at at 30 per hour hour covers covers a a 16. E At 30 miles miles per 25 miles miles per per gallon gallon.. Driving Driving for 30 miles miles per total distance of 5 x 30 = 150 miles total distance m i l e s ., 150 miles miles x 11gallon gallon . = 6 gallons 25 miles : 6 gallons 25 miles 335 - ANSWERSTO THEEXERCISES ‘ \‘ t. f½PTER30 HAPTER 30 ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES 2.6:Ptobability ‘/ 'Chaptet thapter 26: Probability CHAPTEREXERCISE: EXERCISE: CHAPTER 1.‑ Stop sign violations committed by truck drivers = 39 ~ 0.433 M = 3.9. x 0.433 Stop sign 90 Stop sign violations violations 90 + 2. The percentage of silver is 100 = 23. Red and silver silver make make up 20 + 23 = = 43 2. @] ElThe percentage of silver cars cars is 100 -‐ 20 20 -~ 33 33 ‐- 10 ‐- 14 = Red and percent of the the cars. cars. percent 3.@J 3. El Plumbers least 4 years Plumbers with with at at least years of experience _ + ‐45,376 45,‐376‐ z experience = 40,083 ~ 0.46 0.4 _ 40, ‐ ‐083‐ + 6 All plumbers 183,885 plumbers 183,885 4.‑ 4. @ 083 + 45, 376 z = 40, 40,083 45,376 ~ 0.22 _ ______ = 0 22 182, 410 + + 208, 757 182,410 208,757 Plumbers with with at at least least 4 years years of experience experience Plumbers Workers with with at least years of experience Workers least 4 years experience . _ _ ‐ ‐ _ _ _ . 5. Cg 5.‑ Games Games won w o n as asunderdogs 10 _ 22 underdogs _ 10 Games played as Games played asunderdogs 45 _ 9 underdogs 45 6. CgFilling Filling in the the table, 6. table, W e e k l] Week Week2 \ Week3 Week2 Week3 Weel<4 Week4 Total Total 20 55 150 springs Box springs 35 35 Mattresses Mattresses 47 61 68 22 198 Total 82 101 88 77 348 40 Box spring units sold during weeks 2 and 3 _ 40 + 20 _ 2 All box box spring spring units units sold -_ 150 - 5 !~ . 15W . 29 x 0.28. For Russia, the probability is g z 0.39. For Great Britain, 7. 7. @ For For the the USA, USA, the the probability probability is : ~ 0.28. For Russia, the probability is ~ 0.39. For Great Britain, !: 1 . . . 19 the probability probability is 15@ ~ z 0.29. 0.29. For For Germany Germany,, the the probability the probability is is 0.32. The ~ 2~ 0.32. The country country with with the the highest highest [11‐2 probability probability is is Russia. Russia. 8. 8. [I] Cartilaginous fish fish species in the Philippines Cartilaginous fish species species in Cartilaginous species in the Philippines Cartilaginous fish in New New Caledonia Caledonia Total fish species in Total Total fish species in the the Philippines PhjJippines Total fish fish species species in in New New Caledonia Caledonia : 336 336 400 _ 300 _ 1 1 1 1_ 300 -,--,----------400+8OO 5 _55 _ 400 + 800 3oo+1,2oo 300 + 1,200 ‘ 3 2 2 E 15 ‐‑ PANDA COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE THE table, the table, Filling in the 9. [g Filling 9. _ Lightning-caused Lightning-caused fires Human-caused fires Human-caused Total East Africa 55 ss 65 65 120 South Africa 30 70 100 Total 85 135 220 ‐_ Africa _ 65 _ 13 East Africa -caused fires in East Human 13 Human-caused Africa 24 East Africa Fires Fires in East _ 120 _ 24 10. []] Line A Assembly Line from Assembly Defective from Defective Defective Defective 11. 300 _@ ‘ 8800 00‘ -E 3 88 [Q] less 17 family members with 2 family Duplex with 12 + 12_ Duplex members or less_ 22 + 17 = 23 46 Duplex Duplex 46 23 (450 x 0.08) + Chemical A is (450 contaminated with samples contaminated number of samples total number The total 12. []] The with Chemical + (550 x 0.06) = = 69. Contaminated 69 = _ = ~ samples _ Contaminated samples 0 069 = 0.069 1, 000 samples All samples All _ 1, 13. and virus and the virus have the don't have who don’t patients who indicators for patients positive indicators gives positive when it gives incorrect when test is incorrect The test [fil The occurrences. = 80 occurrences. total of 30 + 50 = do, a total patients who indicators for patients negative indicators negative who do, 80 8 ‐ = =~= ‐ : ~ 100 1000 % 8% 8 weren't patients who number of patients The number 90 + 33 = 30. The pill is 90+ sugar pill the sugar by the cured by patients cured number of patients The number 14. []] The who weren’t 30 x ;g = pill is 30 sugar pill the sugar cured z 75. cured by the Drug Cured Cured 90 cured Not cured Not 30 75 Sugar Pill Sugar Pill 25 Given aa sugar sugar pill pill and 30 _2 =2 30 cured _ and cured_ Given 7 75 - 30 + pill Given aa sugar Given sugar pill =30 + 75 I I be x. equipment be gym equipment prefer gym who prefer seniors who number of seniors the number Let the 15. 240 Let L x X X _ 1 1 + + 160 _ 3 Cross multiplying, Cross multiplying, = xX ++ 160 3x = 2 60 =1160 2xx = x :=880 0 X school. the school. seniors at the + 160 := 240 seniors are 80 + There are There 337 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES Chapter 27: Statistics I CHAPTER EXERCISE: 1. is class is second class the second heights in the sum of the heights The sum = 882. The 63 = the first class heights in the [f] The sum sum of the heights class is 14 14 x 63 2. [f] average The average 2,310. The then 882 + class is then combined class 21 x 68 = 1,428. 1,428. The ssum u m of the the heights heights in the the combined + 1428 = 2,310. height height is Sum 310 = 2,310 = 2, heights the heights Sum of the 66 + 14 number of students students I 14+ 21 = 66 Total number The sum of all five of Kristie's test scores is 5 x 94 = 470. The sum of her last three test scores is = test scores: her first ttwo the sum between these difference between The difference 3 x 92 = 276. The these ttwo w o sums sums is the s u m of her w o test scores: 470 -‐ 276 = 194 . . = 97. then ‐2- = 1s then scores is test scores her first ttwo w o test average of her 194. The average 2 3. I]] A range of 3 days means 4. I]] Because there are 20 editors, 5. [QJThe median 6. [fil the difference between the longest shelf life and the shortest shelf life among the about the nothing about range says The range days. The 28 days. vs . 28 days vs. be 10 could be 3. This could units is 3. the 10days days vs. vs. 13 13days days or or 25 25days says nothing the units median. mean mean or median. the median is the average of the 10th and 11th editors' number of books which year, which last year, books last 15 books and 15 between 11 and read between both read the 10th graph, the the graph, From the read. From 10th and and 11th 11th editors editors both read. is 12. and 15 between 11 and choice between answer choice only answer be between must also means the average average must also be between 11 and and 15. The only 15is means the score, designated by the line segment in the middle of the "box", is approximately 83. plot, is approximately the plot, end of the the left end at the segment at designated by the line score, designated individual score, lowest individual The lowest The line segment approximately them is 83 between them 83 -‐ 72 = = 11. difference between 72. The difference (18x6)+(19x3)+(20><5)+(21x4)+(22x2)+(23><3)+(24x1) (18 X 6) + (19 X 3) + (20 X 5) + (21 X 4) + (22 X 2) + (23 X 3) + (24 X 1) : 24 ‐ 20.25 20.25 24 = = 24 24 7. I67 IThe median is represented by the average of the 14th and 15th days, both of which are 67°F. 8. [QJThe standard deviation decreases the most when the outliers, the data points furthest away from the the Vosges. and the Rhone and the Rhone are the here are outliers here The outliers mean, removed . The are removed. mean, are 9. 10. [QJBy definition, at least half the values are greater than or equal to the median and at least half the the median. values are less than median. equal to the than or equal values are out for Bus spread out are more themselves are times themselves same, the the travel travel times m o r e spread the same, are the frequencies are though the frequencies Even though GI]Even times deviation of travel standard deviation the standard Therefore, the together . Therefore, closer together. are much B. The travel much closer travel times times for Bus A are travel times for Bus A is smaller. smaller . 11. Company and Company Company A and both Company pounds for both the 10th weight is represented represented by the 10th kayak kayak (47 pounds median weight [f] The median both companies. same for both B). The companies. the same weight is the median weight The median 12. order, Arranging the scores in order, the scores I]] Arranging 75, 83, 87, 87, 90, 91, 98 75,83,87,87,90,91,98 + 9900 + 9911 +98 median is The median 87. mode iis 8 s‐7755‐++ 883 ‐3++78877‐++ ‐88:7‐+ ‐ +‐ ‐ +‐ 98‐ ~ at: 87.3. The mode s7. The i aalso slso 87. true . and IIll lI is false, and 75 = I I is true. numbers, I is false, I] these numbers, From these = 23. From The average iis The average range range is 98 -‐ 338 The The THE COLLEGE PANDA THE COLLEGE PANDA 13. I]] (5x2)+(6x1)+(8x4)‐+‐(9><2)+(10><1)_§_ Mean = (5 x 2) + (6 x 1) + (8 x 4) + (9 x 2) + (10 x 1) = 76 = 7.6 Mean : 7.6 2 ++ 1 ++ 44 ++ 2 ++ 1 “ 1100 ‘ n g e= l10e- ‐5 =s 5t Range 14. [Q] [E] Before the 900-calorie 900‐calorie meal added, the the median median is the the 5th meal is added, the average average of the 5th and and 6th 6th meals meals (550), (550), the the mode mode is 550, and and the range is 900 -‐ 500 = z 400. After becomes the range After the the 900-calorie 900-calorie meal meal is is added, added, the the median median becomes the 6th the 6th meal meal (still still 550, and of them them change. change. (still 550), the the mode mode is still and the the range range is is still still 400. None None of 15. [Q] The median E] The represented by the 10th class B is median in School School A is represented the 10th class (4 (4 films) and and the the median median in in School School B is represented represented by the 8th class The median same in schools.. N o w we the 8th class (also (also 44 films). The median is is the the same in both both schools Now we calculate calculate the the means: means: 1 x 2 + 2 x 3 + 3 xx 44 ++ 44 xx 5 5~ Mean in School A = 5 ++ 55 xx s MeaninSchoolA : 1 x 2 + 2 x 3 + 3 19 z3.42 3 .42 19 MeaninSchoolB=1X1+2X2+31x53+4><4+5x5¢=1367 M . Sch oo l B = 1 x 1 + 2 x 2 + 3 x 3 + 4 x 4 + 5 x 5 ~ 67 ean m 3. 15 The mean mean is greater The B.lntuitively, distribution for for School School A A has has aa greater in School School B. Intuitively, this this makes makes sense sense because because the the distribution higher proportion proportion of the the smaller higher numbers 1, 1,2, asshown These smaller numbers pull smaller numbers 2, and and 3 as shown by the the chart. chart. These smaller numbers pull down the the mean. mean . down 16. I]] Before removed, the Before the car car is removed, the median median is represented represented by the is removed, the 8th 8th car car (23 mpg). mpg). After After the the car car is removed, the median median is represented the represented by the average of the the 7th stays the the the average 7th and and 8th 8th cars cars (still (still 23 23 mpg). mpg). So So the the median median stays same. However, However, the same. standard deviation We’re removing removing aa data data point higher the mean mean and and the the standard deviation both both decrease. decrease. We're point higher than e a n decreases. We’re also the spread spread in in the the data so the than all all the the others others so so the the m mean decreases. We're also reducing reducing the data so the standard standard deviation deviation decreases. decreases. 17. [J] First, First, it's it’s easy easy to see see that that the mean will will decrease decrease since the mean since we're we're replacing replacing the the maximum maximum data data point point with with a N o w before = 45. After range a minimum. minimum. Now before the the replacement, replacement, the the range range is is 90 90 -‐ 45 45 = After the the replacement, replacement, the the range 65 ‐- 20 20 = 45, so is 65 so the range remains remains the same. Before the replacement, the median is represented the range the same. replacement, the median is represented by by the average average of the the and 10th 10th cars cars (57). After After the replacement, the median is is represented represented by 10th car the 9th 9th and the replacement, the median by 10th car (still 57, don't don’t forget forget to count the replacement replacement as value). The The median (still count the as the the first value). median also also remains remains the the same. same. Therefore, the mean Therefore, the most. mean changes changes the the most. 18. ~ To construct construct the the box box plot, plot, we need know the and maximum number of lectures need to know the minimum minimum number number and maximum number lectures given, the the median, median, the given, quartile, and and the the third third quartile. table indicates that the is 12 12 the first quartile, quartile . The The table indicates that the minimum minimum is and the and the maximum maximum is 40. The median The the 90-;90+ 2 = : 45th 45th and we can count up up in in median is the the average average of the and 46th 46th professors. professors. From From the the table, table, we can count order of the the number number of lectures order see that both gave gave 25 25 lectures, lectures, so so lectures given given and and see that the the 45th 45th and and 46th 46th professors professors both the median the median is 25. To find median to split split the into ttwo w o halves: the first find the the quartiles, quartiles, we we use use the the median the data data into halves: the first 45 45 professors professors and and the the last last 45 Note that the median 45 professors. professors . Note that since since the median is is the the average average of of the the 45th 45th and and 46th 46th professors, professors, it’s it's already already "excluded" from "excluded” from either either half. half. The The first quartile the first 45 by the 22.5 ➔ ‐) 23rd 23rd quartile is the the median median of the 45 professors, professors, represented represented by the 45 45 7+ 2 2 : 22.5 professor. From From the professor. the table, table, the the 23rd 23rd professor professor gave gave 15 the first quartile 15. 15 lectures, lectures, so so the quartile is is 15. 45 professors, The third third quartile quartile is the the median median of the the last last 45 professors, represented represented by by the the 45 45 7+ 2 2 = 22.5 22.5 ‐+ ➔ 23rd 23rd professor the 45th or the 45+ 23 : 68th professor overall. Again we count up in the table professor from from the 45th professor, professor, or the 45 + 23 = 68th professor overall . Again we count up in the table and see and is 28. see that that the the 68th 68th professor professor gave gave 28 28 lectures, lectures, so so the the third third quartile quartile is Now N o w that (min: 12, ql: q l : 15, med: max: 40), we can see that the correct that we have have these these statistics statistics (min: med: 25, q3: q3: 28, max: can see that the correct boxplot is the boxplot one in answer answer choice choice C. C. the one 339 CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS CHAPTER ANSWERS TO THE THE EXERCISES II Statistics 1! Chapter 28: Statistics EXERCISE: CHAPTEREXERCISE: CHAPTER the x-axis is 19. along the value along best fit when line of best above the line points above are 2 points 1. [I] There There are when the value 2. information. irrelevant information. size of 400 is irrelevant sample size that the sample Note that [I]Note be a let xx be we 'll let easier, we’ll things easier, make things To make percentage later, a percentage convert itit to a and convert decimal for nnow decimal o w and later, 3, 300x = : 66 3,300x x= z 0.02 = 2°/o 2% X 3. x-value is 75. the x-value when the 55 when a y-value gives a best fit gives line of best Cf]The line y‐value of 55 4. that's since that’s freshman class since university's freshman students from the university’s conducted with First, the survey survey should should be be conducted with students Cf]First, results. the results. valid the more valid sample, the more target. Secondly, intended target. the intended Secondly, the larger larger the sample, 5. Candidate B votes . Candidate 500,000 = ~~~ x 500,000 expected to receive Candidate A is expected proportions, Candidate Using proportions, receive %3 : 220,000 votes. GI]Using receive 280,000 ‑expected to receive Candidate B is expected So Candidate ~:~ x><500,000 = 280,000 votes receive £8 votes.. So expected to receive is expected votes . more votes. 220,000 220, 000 := 60, 000 more 6. time shopping time average shopping case, it's value of x is 0. In this case, the value value of y when They-intercept GI]The y‐intercept is the value when the it’s the average discount). (no discount). 0% (no discount is 0°/o store discount the store when the when revenue increase in revenue the increase it's the slope, it’s positive slope, a positive best fit has the line Because the run. Because over run. The slope 7. GI]The slope is rise rise over line of best has a expenses advertising and revenue both because that Note expenses. for every dollar increase in advertising expenses. Note that because both revenue and advertising expenses advertising increase dollar every have no and have out and the graph, dollars in the thousands of dollars expressed in thousands are graph, they they cancel out no effect on the interpretation interpretation are expressed (8). isn't (B). answer isn’t the answer why the of the slope. That's why slope . That's increase in box office slope, it's the increase positive slope, has a positive fit has over run 8. []] The slope slope is rise over run.. Because Because the line of best best fit minute increase sales sales per per minute increase in movie movie length. length. expected number case, it's In this case, value of x is 0. ln value of y when y-intercept is the value [QJThe y‐intercept 9. @ when the the value it’s the expected number of . prize) cash (no dollars O is prize 0 dollars (no cash prize). cash prize mistakes when the cash made when mistakes made 10. calories . At are 340 calories. there are grams of fat, there best fit. At 20 grams the line slope of the line of best asking for the slope question is asking [I]This question points, slope from ttwo Calculating the 25 calories. Calculating the slope w o points, are 380 calories. there are grams of fat, there 25 grams = 8 40 _ = 419 380 -‐ 340 _ 8 25 -‐ 20 20 _ 5 _ 11. size, sample size, From the sample population . From larger population. sample to the larger learn from the sample you learn what you Apply what [I]Apply . . Car Speeding Violations _ 83 Car Speeding total of 2,000: proportion to the same proportion apply this same Total Vi Violations ‐ @' . N o w we can can apply the state state total 2,000: Now = . li 284 ota I 10 1ations 83 282 Xx2,000~585 2,000 ~ 585 284 12. closest to point closest represented by the point best fit is represented line of best predicted by the line best predicted yield is best whose yield oat field whose [I]The oat that field. applied to that nitrogen applied amount of nitrogen which is the amount the line. That point x-value of 350, which an x-value has an point has line. That 340 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA PANDA 13. IE [Q]The point line of best best fit is at an x~value of 7. The number of point farthest farthest from the the line an x-value The total total number of seats seats at at the the food food court represented by this point court represented 80 = 560. point is 7 x 80 14. [Q] [B To draw reliable conclusion about the the effectiveness e w vaccine, vaccine, the patients m u s t be be draw a a reliable conclusion about effectiveness of the the n new patients must randomly assigned randomly answer (D) leads Note that answer assigned to their their treatment. treatment. Only Only answer leads to to random random assignment. assignment. Note that answer does not because the patients (C) does not because are allowed allowed to group group themselves patients are themselves as as they they desire. desire . For example, example, three three friends might friends want to remain the same same group, group, leading n o t random. might want remain in the leading to assignment assignment that that is is not random. 15. [g 16. [Q] The lower lower the the standard lElThe standard deviation (variability), the deviation (variability), the lower lower the margin margin of of error. error. Selecting Selecting students students who who Answer wrong because Answer (A) is wrong it’s possible possible that produced in in Week Week 11 had an because it's that most most of the the basketballs basketballs produced had an air pressure pressure of over 8.2 psi. air know for sure sure.. Answer Answer (B) is wrong because because psi. Likewise Likewise for Week 2. We don’t don't know is wrong it's too too definite. it’s Just because because the the sample sample means means were mean the which definite. Just were 0.5 psi psi apart apart doesn’t doesn't mean the true true means, means , which would take into would take into account account all the the basketballs produced in Week 1 and and Week 2, were basketballs produced were also also 0.5 psi psi apart. apart. That's there 's aa margin That’s why why there’s margin of error the samples samples.. Answer suggest error for the Answer (D) is is wrong wrong because because the the samples samples suggest the reverse: reverse: the mean the mean air e a n air a i r pressure for Week 2 afr pressure pressure for Week 1 (8.2 psi) psi) is greater greater than than the the m mean pressure for psi). Answer (C) (7.7 psi). size, the lower the margin of error. The The (C) is correct correct because because the the greater greater the sample sample size, lower the margin sample from Week 11 had had a sample lower margin margin of error error than the sample from Week 2. a lower than sample 2. are following following the the same same daily are plan will deviation because they are are daily diet diet plan will likely lead lead to the the lowest lowest standard standard deviation because they likely to be servings of vegetables. The other other answer would result result in in be eating eating the the same same number number of servings vegetables . The answer choices choices would much more more variability. much variability . 17. [g Answer best expresses Answer (C) (C) best expresses the the meaning meaning of a statistical a confidence confidence interval, interval, which which applies applies only only to the the statistical mean m e a n and and does does not n o t say anything about blue-spotted wrong anything about blue-spotted salamanders salamanders themselves. themselves . Answer Answer (D) is is wrong because the the study involved only because study involved blue-spotted salamanders, nnot o t all salamanders. only blue -spotted salamanders, salamanders . 18. I]] The most most that that we can conclude conclude is that that there there is a negative food and negative association association between between the the price price of food and the population population density density in U S . cities (as one one goes goes up, WeCANNOT U.S. up, the the other other goes goes down). down). We CANNOT conclude conclude that that there cause and there is aa cause relationship between between the two. We can’t say that one causes the other. and effect relationship the two . We can't say that one causes the other. 341 CHAYfER 30 ANSWERS ANSWERS TO THE EXERCISES CHAPTER EXERCISES Chapter29: Volume Chapter CHAPTER EXERCISE: CHAPTER EXERCISE: 1. 1. 0 : 7.5 5. \ 32.5 IThe width width of the the brick brick is 6(1.25) = inches, and and its height inches, z 4 inches. height is 6 -‐ 2 = inches . The brick's volume brick’s volume is then then lwh == (6)(7.5)(4) inches. Since 1 1 lwh (6)(7.5 )(4) =: 180 cubic inches. grams, the brick's kg = 1000 grams, brick's mass mass is 5,850 grams. Finally, grams. Finally, the the brick’s brick's density density is mass _ mass _ 5,850 5,850 grams volume - - ‐180 1grams in3 8 0 =‐ 32.5 32.5 grams grams per per volume = in3 cubic inch. inch. Each piece half the Each piece is half the cylinder. cylinder. _ V‐_12m 2h‐_127r(2)2(5) ‐107r 2. [!]The height height of the + 225 z 44 the box is 100 ...;5= (dividing the volume (dividing the volume by the base base by the the area area of the gives us us to the the height). gives of the base height). The sides sides the are rectangular box are x/E v'25= 5 inches inches long. long . The rectangular has dimensions dimensions 5 x 5 x 4. has 6. El volume of [illThis question question is asking asking for the volume the cylinder. cylinder . The the The radius radius of the base base is 2 and and since tennis ball is 4, the since the diameter diameter of each each tenni s ball height 3 = 12. height of the the cylinder cylinder is 44 x 3 4 5 vV =: 5 = 487r 487T 7. ~ The shortest shortest way way to do this question question is to pretend pretend that liquefied and that the block block is liquefied and poured poured into the aquarium. aquarium. How into How high level high would would the the level of the liquid liquid rise? and bottom bottom have have a a surface surface area The top and area of 2(5 x 5) = 50. The front and have aa and back have surface surface area area of 2(5 x 4) = 40. The left left and and right have right z 40. have a a surface surface area area of 2(5 x 4) = The total surface area 50 + + 40 40 + + 40 total surface area is 50 40 = 130. 3. 7Tr2h rrr 2 h = = n(2)2(12) rr(2)2 (12) V = lwh lwh 5. The cube has [f] Let the the side side of the cube cube be be s. cube has 5,000 = (80)(25)h (80) (25)11 2.5 = : h 2. six faces and and the area area of each each face is s$2. Solving Solving for ss in terms terms of a, The longer is to to find longer way way to do this question question is the original volume, add the block, original volume, add the block, find the the new and then then compare compare it to the new height, height, and original o t the original height. height. While nnot the fastest fastest method, method, it is certainly viable. certain ly viab le. 652 6s2 = 24112 24a2 = 4112 s522 = 4a 2 s = 2a 2a The volume then 53= volume is then s3 = (2a)3 =: 8a3. 8. 4. E] that can can be be filled in 3 [[] The cylindrical cylindrical tank tank that 2 (6) = 96rr. hours has hours volume of of rr(4) 7t(4)2(6) 967t. The has aa volume tank in question tank question has has aa volume volume of 7T(6)2(8) Using the tank as asa rr(6)2(8) = 28871. 288rr. Using the first tank a conversion factor, conversion 0 If you take the cubes cubes with with black black If you take away away all the paint them, you essentially uncovering uncovering paint on them, you are are essentially an with a an inner inner cube cube with a side side length length of 3. A front view is shown shown below. below . .-- - - I I hours 3 hours 28871 x --= 9 hours 2887T hours 9671 967T 3 ~ I I ,_- - - ., I I There z 27 cubes that are are unpainted unpainted.. There are 33 33 = cubes that 342 THE COLLEGE COLLEGE PANDA THE PANDA 9. ~ Since Since each each small small cube cube has volume of 9. has a a volume 22‘ = and the = 8 and the volume volume of the the outer outer box box is 3 = there must 883 z 512, there m u s t be be 512 -i+8= = 64 cubes cubes in the that box. If you you take take away away all all the the cubes cubes that the box. are are touching touching the the box, box, you you are are essentially essentially uncovering uncovering an an inner inner rectangular rectangular box box with with aa square square base base of side side 4 and and aa height height of 6. A front front view view is shown shown below. below. 1 V V = émzh rrr 2h 3 6na 4 67m4 1 = -énr2(2a2) rrr 2 (2a 2 ) 3 2 187m44 = 2 rrr 7rr2(2a2) 18na (2a 2 ) 4 2 2 18na = r 187m4 = 2rra 27mzr2 9a22 = : r2 9a r2 8 3 3aa== r I 61 I I 4 I •------~ 12. 8 form a a right triangle with and to form right triangle with the the radius radius and the slant slant height. triangle is a multiple height. This This triangle is a multiple of the the triangle: 9‐12‐15. 9-12-15. You the 3--4-5 3‐4‐5 right right triangle: could've used used the could’ve the pythagorean pythagorean theorem theorem 8 The The volume volume of this this inner inner rectangular rectangular box box is is 4x4x6= : 96. Since Since each each cube cube has has aa volume volume of 8, there there are cubes that are 96...,... 96 + 8 = = 12 12cubes that are are not not touching the touching the box, box, which which means means there there are are 64 = 52 that are 64‐- 12 12= 52 cubes cubes that are touching. touching. You also taken the also could've could’ve taken the straight-forward straight-forward approach approach of counting counting up up the the cubes cubes along along the the took this sides. sides. If you you took this route, route, you you should've should’ve gotten gotten something something along along the the lines lines of 1 6++16 1 6++88++88+ + 4 = 52. 16 10. instead aware of this. any instead if if you you weren't weren’t aware this. In any case, the height cone is 12 case, the height of the the cone 12cm. cm. volume of cone V= : volume cone + -+- volume volume of hemisphere hemisphere _1!rrr 22h + !1(4 V‐37rrh+§ 5m33) ) = (~rrr 3 2 3 V ~ 2 3 v = ~n(9) %n(9)2(12) V (12) + %(§n(9)3> (;rr (9) ) [Q] that have IE]The The only only cubes cubes that have exactly exactly one one face = 32471' + 486n 48671 = = 81071 V = 3247T+ 810n painted painted black black are are the the ones ones in the the middle middle of each side each side.. For For example, example, the the front front side side has has = 3 of these these cubes. cubes. 3x 1= , _ - - - 3 5 - - the radius radius rr is 2 inches longer than 13. ~ Since Since the inches longer than the height is r -‐ 2. Using the 2. Using the the height, height , the the height volume formula formula for aacylinder, cylinder, we get volume we get 2 2h = V 7rr2h : n7rr2(r 27rr2. V = nr r 2 (r -‐ 2) = 7rr3 nr 3 -‐ 2nr . 3 :-------;1 the middle middle of the [I] Draw Draw aa line line down down the the cone cone _1 14. []] This This question asking for the the question is essentially essentially asking volume, the amount amount of rroom volume, or the o o m, in the the crate. crate. The room room in the the crate crate can can be as a The be seen seen as rectangular with a length of rectangular box box with a length 1 c h e s ,aawidth w i d t of h o8f-8 ‐11- ‐ 11 = : 66 =i 8n inches, 100-‐ 11 ‐- 11: 8 inches, and and a height inches. inches, height of 3 -‐ 1 = 2 inches. 4 The The right right side side has has 2 x 1 = 2 of these these cubes, cubes, and and the the top top has has 3 x 2 = = 6 of these these cubes. cubes. So So + 2+ +6= z 11 of these these cubes. cubes. To far, we have have 3 + account left, and account for the the back, back, left, and bottom bottom sides, sides, we we double double this this to get get 22 22 cubes. cubes. 6 V :=8 > 8 <X 66 >X<22=: 996 343 EXERCISES CHAPTER ANSWERS TO THE THE EXERCISES CHAPTER 30 ANSWERS 15. blocks . into 3 blocks. vertically into staircase vertically Cut the staircase [I] Cut block 1 staircase = Volume of staircase = Volume of block block 2 + + Volume of block block 3 + + Volume of block V=(5x2x0.2)+(5x2x0.4)+(5x2x0.6) V = (5 X 2 X 0.2) + (5 X 2 X 0.4) + (5 X 2 X 0.6) = 22 + 4 + 6 = 112 2 = Density x Volume Mass = Density Mass = 560 kg = 130 x 12 = = 1, 1,560 344